SlideShare a Scribd company logo
Report of the World Commission on Environment and 
Development: Our Common Future 
Table of Contents 
Acronyms and Note on Terminology 
Chairman's Foreword 
From One Earth to One World 
Part I. Common Concerns 
1. A Threatened Future 
I. Symptoms and Causes 
II. New Approaches to Environment and Development 
2. Towards Sustainable Development 
I. The Concept of Sustainable Development 
II. Equity and the Common Interest 
III. Strategic Imperatives 
IV. Conclusion 
3. The Role of the International Economy 
The International Economy, the Environment, and 
Development 
I. 
II. Decline in the 1980s 
III. Enabling Sustainable Development 
IV. A Sustainable World Economy 
Part II. Common Challenges 
4. Population and Human Resources 
I. The Links with Environment and Development
The Population II. Perspective 
III. A Policy Framework 
5. Food Security: Sustaining the Potential 
I. Achievements 
II. Signs of Crisis 
III. The Challenge 
IV. Strategies for Sustainable Food Security 
V. Food for the Future 
6. Species and Ecosystems: Resources for Development 
I. The Problem: Character and Extent 
II. Extinction Patterns and Trends 
III. Some Causes of Extinction 
IV. Economic Values at Stake 
V. New Approach: Anticipate and Prevent 
VI. International Action for National Species 
VII. Scope for National Action 
VIII. The Need for Action 
7. Energy: Choices for Environment and Development 
I. Energy, Economy, and Environment 
II. Fossil Fuels: The Continuing Dilemma 
III. Nuclear Energy: Unsolved Problems 
IV. Wood Fuels: The Vanishing Resource 
V. Renewable Energy: The Untapped Potential
Energy Efficiency: Maintaining VI. the Momentum 
VII. Energy Conservation Measures 
VIII. Conclusion 
8. Industry: Producing More With Less 
I. Industrial Growth and its Impact 
II. Sustainable Industrial Development in a Global Context 
III. Strategies for Sustainable Industrial Development 
9. The Urban Challenge 
I. The Growth of Cities 
II. The Urban Challenge in Developing Countries 
III. International Cooperation 
Part III. Common Endeavours 
10. Managing The Commons 
I. Oceans: The Balance of Life 
II. Space: A Key to Planetary Management 
III. Antarctica: Towards Global Cooperation 
11. Peace, Security, Development, and the Environment 
I. Environmental Stress as a Source of Conflict 
II. Conflict as a Cause of Unsustainable Development 
III. Towards Security and Sustainable Development 
Towards Common Action: Proposals For Institutional and Legal 
Change 
12. 
I. The Challenge for Institutional and Legal Change 
II. Proposals for Institutional and Legal Change
III. A Call for Action 
Annexes 
Annexe 1: Summary of Proposed Legal Principles for 
Environmental Protection and Sustainable Development Adopted 
by the WCED Experts Group on Environmental Law 
Annexe 2: The Commission and its Work 
Throughout this report, quotes from some of the many people who spoke at WCED public 
hearings appear in boxes to illustrate the range of opinions the Commission was exposed to 
during its three years of work. They do not necessarily reflect the views of the Commission.
Our Common Future, Chairman's Foreword 
"A global agenda for change" - this was what the World Commission on Environment and 
Development was asked to formulate. It was an urgent call by the General Assembly of the 
United Nations: 
to propose long-term environmental strategies for achieving sustainable development 
by the year 2000 and beyond; 
to recommend ways concern for the environment may be translated into greater 
co-operation among developing countries and between countries at different stages of 
economical and social development and lead to the achievement of common and 
mutually supportive objectives that take account of the interrelationships between 
people, resources, environment, and development; 
to consider ways and means by which the international community can deal more 
effectively with environment concerns; and 
to help define shared perceptions of long-term environmental issues and the 
appropriate efforts needed to deal successfully with the problems of protecting and 
enhancing the environment, a long term agenda for action during the coming decades, 
and aspirational goals for the world community. 
When I was called upon by the Secretary-General of the United Nations in December 1983 to 
establish and chair a special, independent commission to address this major challenge to the 
world community, I was acutely aware that this was no small task and obligation, and that my 
day-to day responsibilities as Party leader made it seem plainly prohibitive. What the General 
Assembly asked for also seemed to be unrealistic and much too ambitious. At the same time, it 
was a clear demonstration of the widespread feeling of frustration and inadequacy in the 
international community about our own ability to address the vital global issues and deal 
effectively with them. 
The fact is a compelling reality, and should not easily be dismissed. Since the answers to 
fundamental and serious concerns are not at hand, there is no alternative but to keep on trying 
to find them. 
All this was on my mind when the Secretary-General presented me with an argument to which 
there was no convincing rebuttal: No other political leader had become Prime Minister with a 
background of several years of political struggle, nationally and internationally, as an 
environment minister. This gave some hope that the environment was not destined to remain 
a side issue in central, political decision making. 
In the final analysis, I decided to accept the challenge. The challenge of facing the future, and 
of safeguarding the interests of coming generations. For it was abundantly clear: We needed a 
mandate for change. 
We live in an era in the history of nations when there is greater need than ever for 
co-ordinated political action and responsibility. The United Nations and its Secretary-General 
are faced with an enormous task and burden. Responsibly meeting humanity's goals and
aspirations will require the active support of us all. 
My reflections and perspective were also based on other important parts of ray own political 
experience: the preceding work of the Brandt Commission on North South issues, and the 
Palme Commission on security and disarmament issues, on which I served. 
I was being asked to help formulate a third and compelling call for political action: After 
Brandt's Programme for Survival and Common Crisis, and after Palme's Common Security, 
would come Common Future. This was my message when Vice Chairman Mansour Khalid and 
I started work on the ambitious task set up by the United Nations. This report, as presented to 
the UN General Assembly in 1987, is the result of that process. 
Perhaps our most urgent task today is to persuade nations of the need to return to 
multilateralism. The challenge of reconstruction after the Second World War was the real 
motivating power behind the establishment of our post-war international economic system. 
The challenge of finding sustainable development paths ought to provide the impetus - indeed 
the imperative - for a renewed search for multilateral solutions and a restructured 
international economic system of co-operation. These challenges cut across the divides of 
national sovereignty, of limited strategies for economic gain, and of separated disciplines of 
science. 
After a decade and a half of a standstill or even deterioration in global co-operation, I believe 
the time has come for higher expectations, for common goals pursued together, for an 
increased political will to address our common future. 
There was a time of optimism and progress in the 1960s, when there was greater hope for a 
braver new world, and for progressive international ideas. Colonies blessed with natural 
resources were becoming nations. The locals of co-operation and sharing seemed to be 
seriously pursued. Paradoxically, the 1970s slid slowly into moods of reaction and isolation 
while at the same time a series of UN conferences offered hope for greater co-operation on 
major issues. The 1972 UN Conference on the Human Environment brought the industrialized 
and developing nations together to delineate the "rights" of the human family to a healthy and 
productive environment. A string of such meetings followed: on the rights of people to 
adequate food, to sound housing, to safe water, to access to means of choosing the size of their 
families. 
The present decade has been marked by a retreat from social concerns. Scientists bring to our 
attention urgent but complex problems bearing on our very survival: a warming globe, threats 
to the Earth's ozone layer, deserts consuming agricultural land. We respond by demanding 
more details, and by assigning the problems to institutions ill-equipped to cope with them. 
Environmental degradation, first seen as mainly a problem of the rich nations and a side effect 
of industrial wealth, has become a survival issue for developing nations. It is part of the 
downward spiral of linked ecological and economic decline in which many of the poorest 
nations are trapped. Despite official hope expressed on all sides, no trends identifiable today, 
no programmes or policies, offer any real hope of narrowing the growing gap between rich and 
poor nations. And as part of our "development", we have amassed weapons arsenals capable of 
diverting the paths that evolution has followed for millions of years and of creating a planet 
our ancestors would not recognize. 
When the terms of reference of our Commission were originally being discussed in 1982, there 
were those who wanted its considerations to be limited to "environmental issues" only. This
would have been a grave mistake. The environment does not exist as a sphere separate from 
human actions, ambitions, and needs, and attempts to defend it in isolation from human 
concerns have given the very word "environment" a connotation of naivety in some political 
circles. The word "development" has also been narrowed by some into a very limited focus, 
along the lines of "what poor nations should do to become richer", and thus again is 
automatically dismissed by many in the international arena as being a concern of specialists, of 
those involved in questions of "development assistance". 
But the "environment" is where we all live; and "development" is what we all do in attempting 
to improve our lot within that abode. The two are inseparable. Further, development issues 
must be seen as crucial by the political leaders who feel that their countries have reached a 
plateau towards which other nations must strive. Many of the development paths of the 
industrialized nations are clearly unsustainable. And the development decisions of these 
countries, because of their great economic and political power, will have a profound effect 
upon the ability of all peoples to sustain human progress for generations to come. 
Many critical survival issues are related to uneven development, poverty, and population 
growth. They all place unprecedented pressures on the planet's lands, waters, forests, and 
other natural resources, not least in the developing countries. The downward spiral of poverty 
and environmental degradation is a waste of opportunities and of resources. In particular, it is 
a waste of human resources. These links between poverty, inequality, and environmental 
degradation formed a major theme in our analysis and recommendations. What is needed now 
is a new era of economic growth - growth that is forceful and at the same time socially and 
environmentally sustainable. 
Due to the scope of our work, and to the need to have a wide perspective. I was very much 
aware of the need to put together a highly qualified and influential political and scientific team, 
to constitute a truly independent Commission. This was an essential part of a successful 
process. Together, we should span the globe, and pull together to formulate an 
interdisciplinary, integrated approach to global concerns and our common future. We needed 
broad participation and a clear majority of members from developing countries, to reflect 
world realities. We needed people with wide experience, and from all political fields, not only 
from environment or development and political disciplines, but from all areas of vital decision 
making that influence economic and social progress, nationally and internationally. 
We therefore come from widely differing backgrounds: foreign ministers, finance and planning 
officials, policymakers in agriculture, science, and technology. Many of the Commissioners are 
cabinet ministers and senior economists in their own nations, concerned largely with the 
affairs of those countries. As Commissioners, however, we were acting not in our national roles 
but as individuals; and as we worked, nationalism and the artificial divides between 
"industrialized" and "developing", between East and West, receded. In their place emerged a 
common concern for the planet and the interlocked ecological and economic threats with 
which its people, institutions, and governments now grapple. 
During the time we met as a Commission, tragedies such as the African famines, the leak at the 
pesticides factory at Bhopal, India, and the nuclear disaster at Chernobyl, USSR appeared to 
justify the grave predictions about the human future that were becoming commonplace during 
the mid-1980s. But at public hearings we held on five continents, we also heard from the 
individual victims of more chronic, widespread disasters: the debt crisis, stagnating aid to and 
investment in developing countries, falling commodity prices and falling personal incomes. We 
became convinced that major changes were needed, both in attitudes and in the way our 
societies are organized.
The question of population - of population pressure, of population and human rights - and the 
links between these related issues and poverty, environment, and development proved to be 
one of the more difficult concerns with which we had to struggle. The differences of 
perspective seemed at the outset to be unbridgeable, and they required a lot of thought and 
willingness to communicate across the divides of cultures, religions, and regions. 
Another such concern was the whole area of international economic relations. In these and in 
a number of other important aspects of our analysis and recommendations, we were able to 
develop broad agreement. 
The fact that we all became wiser, learnt to look across cultural and historical barriers, was 
essential. There were moments of deep concern and potential crisis, moments of gratitude and 
achievement, moments of success in building a common analysis and perspective. The result is 
clearly more global, more realistic, more forward looking than any one of us alone could have 
created. We joined the Commission with different views and perspectives, different values and 
beliefs, and very different experiences and insights. After these three years of working 
together, travelling, listening, and discussing, we present a unanimous report. 
I am deeply grateful to all the Commissioners for their dedication, their foresight and personal 
commitment to our common endeavour. It has been a truly wonderful team. The spirit of 
friendship and open communication, the meeting of minds and the process of learning and 
sharing, have provided an experience of optimism, something of great value to all of us, and, I 
believe, to the report and its message. We hope to share with others our learning process, and 
all that we have experienced together. It is something that many others will have to experience 
if global sustainable development is to be achieved. 
The Commission has taken guidance from people in all walks of life. It is to these people - to all 
the peoples of the world - that the Commission now addresses itself. In so doing we speak to 
people directly as well as to the institutions that they have established. 
The Commission is addressing governments, directly and through their various agencies and 
ministries. The congregation of governments, gathered in the General Assembly of the United 
Nations, will be the main recipients of this report. 
The Commission is also addressing private enterprise, from the one-person business to the 
great multinational company with a total economic turnover greater than that of many nations, 
and with possibilities for bringing about far-reaching changes and improvements. 
But first and foremost our message is directed towards people, whose well being is the 
ultimate goal of all environment and development policies. In particular, the Commission is 
addressing the young. The world's teachers will have a crucial role to play in bringing this 
report to them. 
If we do not succeed in putting our message of urgency through to today's parents and 
decision makers, we risk undermining our children's fundamental right to a healthy, 
life-enhancing environment. Unless we are able to translate our words into a language that can 
reach the minds and hearts of people young and old, we shall not be able to undertake the 
extensive social changes needed to correct the course of development. 
The Commission has completed its work. We call for a common endeavour and for new norms 
of behaviour at all levels and in the interests of all. The changes in attitudes, in social values, 
and in aspirations that the report urges will depend on vast campaigns of education, debate
and public participation. 
To this end, we appeal to "citizens" groups, to non governmental organizations, to educational 
institutions, and to the scientific community. They have all played indispensable roles in the 
creation of public awareness and political change in the past. They will play a crucial part in 
putting the world onto sustainable development paths, in laying the groundwork for Our 
Common Future. 
The process that produced this unanimous report proven that it is possible to join forces, to 
identify common goals, and to agree on common action. Each one of the Commissioners would 
have chosen different words if writing the report alone. Still, we managed to agree on the 
analysis, the broad remedies, and the recommendations for a sustainable course of 
development. 
In the final analysis, this is what it amounts to: furthering the common understanding and 
common spirit of responsibility so clearly needed in a divided world. 
Thousands of people all over the world have contributed to the work of the Commission, by 
intellectual means, by financial means, and by sharing their experiences with us through 
articulating their needs and demands. I am sincerely grateful to everyone who has made such 
contributions. Many of their names are found in Annexe 2 of the report. My particular 
gratitude goes to Vice Chairman Mansour Khalid, to all the other members of the Commission, 
and to Secretary-General Jim MacNeill and his staff at our secretariat, who went above and 
beyond the call of duty to assist us. Their enthusiasm and dedication knew no limits. I want to 
thank the chairmen and members of the Intergovernmental Inter-sessional Preparatory 
Committee, who co-operated closely with the Commission and provided inspiration and 
support. I thank also the Executive Director of the United Nations Environment Programme, 
Dr. Mostafa Tolba, for his valuable, continuous support and interest. 
Gro Harlem Brundtland 
Oslo, 20 March 1987
Our Common Future, From One Earth to One World 
An Overview by the World Commission on Environment and 
Development 
I. The Global Challenge 
1. Successes and failures 
2. The Interlocking Crises 
3. Sustainable Development 
4. The Institutional Gaps 
II. The Policy Directions 
1. Population and Human Resources 
2. Food Security: Sustaining the Potential 
3. Species and Ecosystems: Resources for Development 
4. Energy: Choices for Environment and Development 
5. Industry: Producing More with Less 
6. The Urban Challenge 
III. International Cooperation and Institutional Reform 
1. The Role of the International Economy 
2. Managing the Commons 
3. Peace, Security, Development, and the Environment 
4. Institutional and Legal Change 
4.1 Getting at the Sources 
4.2 Dealing with the Effects
4.3 Assessing Global Risks 
4.4 Making Informed Choices 
4.5 Providing the Legal Means 
4.6 Investing in our Future 
IV. A Call for Action 
1. In the middle of the 20th century, we saw our planet from space for the first time. Historians 
may eventually find that this vision had a greater impact on thought than did the Copernican 
revolution of the 16th century, which upset the human self-image by revealing that the Earth is 
not the centre of the universe. From space, we see a small and fragile ball dominated not by 
human activity and edifice but by a pattern of clouds, oceans, greenery, and soils. Humanity's 
inability to fit its activities into that pattern is changing planetary systems, fundamentally. 
Many such changes are accompanied by life-threatening hazards. This new reality, from which 
there is no escape, must be recognized - and managed. 
2. Fortunately, this new reality coincides with more positive developments new to this century. 
We can move information and goods faster around the globe than ever before; we can produce 
more food and more goods with less investment of resources; our technology and science gives 
us at least, the potential to look deeper into and better understand natural systems. From 
space, we can see and study the Earth as an organism whose health depends on the health of 
al its parts. We have the power to reconcile human affairs with natural laws and to thrive in the 
process. In this our cultural and spiritual heritages can reinforce our economic interests and 
survival imperatives. 
3. This Commission believes that people can build a future that is more prosperous, more just, 
and more secure. Our report, Our Common Future, is not a prediction of ever increasing 
environmental decay, poverty, and hardship in an ever more polluted world among ever 
decreasing resources. We see instead the possibility for a new era of economic growth, one 
that must be based on policies that sustain and expand the environmental resource base. And 
we believe such growth to be absolutely essential to relieve the great poverty that is deepening 
in much of the developing world. 
4. But the Commission's hope for the future is conditional on decisive political action now to 
begin managing environmental resources to ensure both sustainable human progress and 
human survival. We are not forecasting a future; we are serving a notice - an urgent notice 
based on the latest and best scientific evidence - that the time has come to take the decisions 
needed to secure the resources to sustain this and coming generations. We do not offer a 
detailed blueprint for action, but instead a pathway by which the peoples of the world may 
enlarge their spheres of cooperation. 
I. The Global Challenge 
1. Successes and failures 
5. Those looking for success and signs of hope can find many: infant mortality is falling; human
life expectancy is increasing; the proportion of the world's adults who can read and write is 
climbing; the proportion of children starting school is rising; and global food production 
increases faster than the population grows. 
6. But the same processes that have produced these gains have given rise to trends that the 
planet and its people cannot long bear. These have traditionally been divided into failures of 
'development' and failures in the management of our human environment. On the 
development side, in terms of absolute numbers there are more hungry people in the world 
than ever before, and their numbers are increasing. So are the numbers who cannot read or 
write, the numbers without safe water or safe and sound homes, and the numbers short of 
woodfuel with which to cook and warm themselves. The gap between rich and poor nations is 
widening - not shrinking - and there is little prospect, given present trends and institutional 
arrangements, that this process will be reversed. 
7. There are also environmental trends that threaten to radically alter the planet, that threaten 
the lives of many species upon it. including the human species. Each year another 6 million 
hectares of productive dryland turns into worthless desert. Over three decades, this would 
amount to an area roughly as large as Saudi Arabia. More than 11 million hectares of forests are 
destroyed yearly, and this, over three decades, would equal an area about the size of India. 
Much of this forest is converted to low-grade farmland unable to support the farmers who 
settle it. In Europe, acid precipitation kills forests and lakes and damages the artistic and 
architectural heritage of nations; it may have acidified vast tracts of soil beyond reasonable 
hope of repair. The burning of fossil fuels puts into the atmosphere carbon dioxide, which is 
causing gradual global warming. This 'greenhouse effect' may by early next century have 
increased average global temperatures enough to shift agricultural production areas, raise sea 
levels to flood coastal cities, and disrupt national economies. Other industrial gases threaten 
to deplete the planet's protective ozone shield to such an extent that the number of human 
and animal cancers would rise sharply and the oceans' food chain would be disrupted, 
industry and agriculture put toxic substances into the human food chain and into 
underground water tables beyond reach of cleansing. 
8. There has been a growing realization in national governments and multilateral institutions 
that it is impossible to separate economic development issues from environment issues; many 
forms of development erode the environmental resources upon which they must be based, and 
environmental degradation can undermine economic development. Poverty is a major cause 
and effect of global environmental problems. It is therefore futile to attempt to deal with 
environmental problems without a broader perspective that encompasses the factors 
underlying world poverty and international inequality. 
9. These concerns were behind the establishment in 1983 of the World Commission on 
Environment and Development by the UN General Assembly. The Commission is an 
independent body, linked to but outside the control of governments and the UN system. The 
Commission's mandate gave it three objectives: to re-examine the critical environment and 
development issues and to formulate realistic proposals for dealing with them; to propose new 
forms of international cooperation on these issues that will influence policies and events in the 
direction of needed changes; and to raise the levels of understanding and commitment to 
action of individuals, voluntary organizations, businesses, institutes, and governments. 
10. Through our deliberations and the testimony of people at the public hearings we held on 
five continents, all the commissioners came to focus on one central theme: many present 
development trends leave increasing numbers of people poor and vulnerable, while at the 
same time degrading the environment. How can such development serve next century's world
of twice as many people relying on the same environment? This realization broadened our 
view of development. We came to see it not in its restricted context of economic growth in 
developing countries. We came to see that a new development path was required, one that 
sustained human progress not just in a few pieces for a few years, but for the entire planet into 
the distant future. Thus 'sustainable development' becomes a goal not just for the 'developing' 
nations, but for industrial ones as well. 
2. The Interlocking Crises 
11. Until recently, the planet was a large world in which human activities and their effects were 
neatly compartmentalized within nations, within sectors (energy, agriculture, trade), and 
within broad areas of concern (environment, economics, social). These compartments have 
begun to dissolve. This applies in particular to the various global 'crises' that have seized 
public concern, particularly over the past decade. These are not separate crises: an 
environmental crisis, a development crisis, an energy crisis. They are all one. 
12. The planet is passing through a period of dramatic growth and fundamental change. Our 
human world of 5 billion must make room in a finite environment for another human world. 
The population could stabilize at between 8 and 14 billion sometime next century, according to 
UN projections. More than 90 per cent of the increase will occur in the poorest countries, and 
90 per cent of that growth in already bursting cities. 
13. Economic activity has multiplied to create a $13 trillion world economy, and this could grow 
five to tenfold in the coming half century. Industrial production has grown more than fiftyfold 
over the past century, four-fifths of this growth since 1950. Such figures reflect and presage 
profound impacts upon the biosphere, as the world invests in houses, transport, farms, and 
industries. Much of the economic growth pulls raw material from forests, soils, seas, and 
waterways. 
The World Commission on Environment and Development first met in October 1984. 
and published its Report 900 days later, in April 1987. Over those few days: 
The drought-triggered, environment-development crisis in Africa peaked, 
putting 36 million people at risk, killing perhaps a million. 
A leak from a pesticides factory in Bhopal, India, killed more than 2,000 
people and blinded and injured over 200,000 more. 
Liquid gas tanks exploded in Mexico City, killing 1,000 and leaving thousands 
more homeless. 
The Chernobyl nuclear reactor explosion sent nuclear fallout across Europe, 
increasing the risks of future human cancers. 
Agricultural chemicals, solvents, and mercury flowed into the Rhine River 
during a warehouse fire in Switzerland, killing millions of fish and threatening 
drinking water in the Federal Republic of Germany and the Netherlands. 
An estimated 60 million people died of diarrhoeal diseases related to unsafe 
drinking water and malnutrition; most of the victims were children.
14. A mainspring of economic growth is new technology, and while this technology offers the 
potential for slowing the dangerously rapid consumption of finite resources, it also entails high 
risks, including new forms of pollution and the introduction to the planet of new variations of 
life forms that could change evolutionary pathways. Meanwhile, the industries most heavily 
reliant on environmental resources and most heavily polluting are growing most rapidly in the 
developing world, where there is both more urgency for growth and less capacity to minimize 
damaging side effects. 
15. These related changes have locked the global economy and global ecology together in new 
ways. We have in the past been concerned about the impacts of economic growth upon the 
environment. We are now forced to concern ourselves with the impacts of ecological stress - 
degradation of soils, water regimes, atmosphere, and forests upon our economic prospects. 
We have in the more recent past been forced to face up to a sharp increase in economic 
interdependence among nations. We are now forced to accustom ourselves to an accelerating 
ecological interdependence among nations. Ecology and economy are becoming ever more 
interwoven locally, regionally, nationally, and globally into a seamless net of causes and effects. 
16. Impoverishing the local resource base can impoverish wider areas: deforestation by 
highland farmers causes flooding on lowland farms; factory pollution robs local fishermen of 
their catch. Such grim local cycles now operate nationally and regionally. Dryland degradation 
sends environmental refugees in their millions across national borders. Deforestation in Latin 
America and Asia is causing more floods, and more destructive floods, in downhill, 
downstream nations. Acid precipitation and nuclear fallout have spread across the borders of 
Europe. Similar phenomena are emerging on a global scale, such as global warming and loss of 
ozone. Internationally traded hazardous chemicals entering foods are themselves 
internationally traded. In the next century, the environmental pressure causing population 
movements may be increase sharply, while barriers to that movement may be even firmer than 
they are now. 
17. Over the past few decades, life-threatening environmental concerns have surfaced in the 
developing world. Countrysides are coming under pressure from increasing numbers of 
farmers and the landless. Cities are filling with people, cars, and factories. Yet at the same time 
these developing countries oust operate in a world in which the resources gap between most 
developing and industrial nations is widening, in which the industrial world dominates in the 
rule-making of some key international bodies and in which the industrial world has already 
used much of the planet's ecological capital. This inequality is the planet's main 
'environmental' problem; it is also its main 'development' problem. 
18. International economic relationships pose a particular problem for environmental 
management in many developing countries. Agriculture, forestry, energy production, and 
mining generate at least half the gross national product of many developing countries and 
account for even larger shares of livelihoods and employment. Exports of natural resources 
remain a large factor in their economies, especially for the least developed. Most of these 
countries face enormous economic pressures, both international and domestic, to overexploit 
their environmental resource base. 
19. The recent crisis in Africa best and most tragically illustrates the ways in which economics 
and ecology can interact destructively and trip into disaster. Triggered by drought, its real 
causes lie deeper. They are to be found in part in national policies that gave too little attention, 
too late, to the needs of smallholder agriculture and to the threats posed by rapidly rising 
populations. Their roots extend also to a global economic system that takes more out of a poor 
continent than it puts in. Debts that they cannot pay force African nations relying on
commodity sales to overuse their fragile soils, thus turning good land to desert. Trade barriers 
in the wealthy nations - and in many developing nations - make it hard for African nations to 
sell their goods for reasonable returns, putting yet more pressure on ecological systems. Aid 
from donor nations has not only been inadequate in scale, but too often has reflected the 
priorities of the nations giving the aid, rather than the needs of the recipients. 
The Commission has sought ways in which global development can be put on a 
sustainable path into the 21st Century. Some 5,000 days will elapse between the 
publication of our report and the first day of the 21st Century. What environmental 
crises lie in store over those 5,000 days? 
During the 1970s, twice as many people suffered each year from 'natural' disasters as 
during the 1960s. The disasters most directly associated with 
environment/development mismanagement - droughts and floods - affected the 
most people and increased most sharply in terms of numbers affected. Some 18.5 
million people were affected by drought annually in the 1960s, 24.4 million in the 
1970s. There were 5.2 million flood victims yearly in the 1960s, 15.4 million in the 
1970s. Numbers of victims of cyclones and earthquakes also shot up as growing 
numbers of poor people built unsafe houses on dangerous ground. 
The results are not in for the 1960s. But we have seen 35 billion afflicted by drought 
in Africa alone and tens of millions affected by the better managed and thus 
less-publicized Indian drought. Floods have poured off the deforested Andes and 
Himalayas with increasing force. The 1960s seem destined to sweep this dire trend 
on into a crisis-filled 1990s. 
20. The production base of other developing world areas suffers similarly from both local 
failures and from the workings of international economic systems. As a consequence of the 
'debt crisis' of Latin America, that continent's natural resources are now being used not for 
development but to meet financial obligations to creditors abroad. This approach to the debt 
problem is short-sighted from several standpoints: economic, political, and environmental. It 
requires relatively poor countries simultaneously to accept growing poverty while exporting 
growing amounts of scarce resources. 
21. A majority of developing countries now have lower per capita incomes than when the 
decade began. Rising poverty and unemployment have increased pressure on environmental 
resources as more people have been forced to rely more directly upon them. Many 
governments have cut back efforts to protect the environment and to bring ecological 
considerations into development planning. 
22. The deepening and widening environmental crisis presents a threat to national security - 
and even survival - that may be greater than well-armed, ill-disposed neighbours and 
unfriendly alliances. Already in parts of Latin America, Asia, the Middle East, and Africa, 
environmental decline is becoming a source of political unrest and international tension. The 
recent destruction of much of Africa's dryland agricultural production was more severe than if 
an invading army had pursued a scorched-earth policy. Yet most of the affected governments 
still spend far more to protect their people from invading armies than from the invading 
desert. 
23. Globally, military expenditures total about $1 trillion a year and continue to grow. In many
countries, military spending consumes such a high proportion of GNP that it itself does great 
damage to these societies' development efforts. Governments tend to base their approaches to 
'security' on traditional definitions. This is most obvious in the attempts to achieve security 
through the development of potentially planet-destroying nuclear weapons systems. Studies 
suggest that the cold and dark nuclear winter following even a limited nuclear war could 
destroy plant and animal ecosystems and leave any human survivors occupying a devastated 
planet very different from the one they inherited. 
24. The arms race - in all parts of the world - pre-empts resources that might be used more 
productively to diminish the security threats created by environmental conflict and the 
resentments that are fuelled by widespread poverty. 
25. Many present efforts to guard and maintain human progress, to meet human needs, and to 
realize human ambitions are simply unsustainable - in both the rich and poor nations. They 
draw too heavily, too quickly, on already overdrawn environmental resource accounts to be 
affordable far into the future without bankrupting those accounts. They may show profit on 
the balance sheets of our generation, but our children will inherit the losses. We borrow 
environmental capital from future generations with no intention or prospect of repaying. They 
may damn us for our spendthrift ways, but they can never collect on our debt to them. We act 
as we do because we can get away with it: future generations do not vote; they have no political 
or financial power; they cannot challenge our decisions. 
26. But the results of the present profligacy are rapidly closing the options for future 
generations. Most of today's decision makers will be dead before the planet feels; the heavier 
effects of acid precipitation, global warming, ozone depletion, or widespread desertification 
and species loss. Most of the young voters of today will still be alive. In the Commission's 
hearings it was the young, those who have the most to lose, who were the harshest critics of 
the planet's present management. 
3. Sustainable Development 
27. Humanity has the ability to make development sustainable to ensure that it meets the 
needs of the present without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own 
needs. The concept of sustainable development does imply limits - not absolute limits but 
limitations imposed by the present state of technology and social organization on 
environmental resources and by the ability of the biosphere to absorb the effects of human 
activities. But technology and social organization can be both managed and improved to make 
way for a new era of economic growth. The Commission believes that widespread poverty is no 
longer inevitable. Poverty is not only an evil in itself, but sustainable development requires 
meeting the basic needs of all and extending to all the opportunity to fulfil their aspirations for 
a better life. A world in which poverty is endemic will always be prone to ecological and other 
catastrophes. 
28. Meeting essential needs requires not only a new era of economic growth for nations in 
which the majority are poor, but an assurance that those poor get their fair share of the 
resources required to sustain that growth. Such equity would be aided by political systems that 
secure effective citizen participation in decision making and by greater democracy in 
international decision making. 
29. Sustainable global development requires that those who are more affluent adopt life-styles 
within the planet's ecological means - in their use of energy, for example. Further, rapidly 
growing populations can increase the pressure on resources and slow any rise in living
standards; thus sustainable development can only be pursued if population size and growth 
are in harmony with the changing productive potential of the ecosystem. 
30. Yet in the end, sustainable development is not a fixed state of harmony, but rather a 
process of change in which the exploitation of resources, the direction of investments, the 
orientation of technological development, and institutional change are made consistent with 
future as well as present needs. We do not pretend that the process is easy or straightforward. 
Painful choices have to be made. Thus, in the final analysis, sustainable development must rest 
on political will. 
4. The Institutional Gaps 
31. The objective of sustainable development and the integrated nature of the global 
environment/development challenges pose problems for institutions, national and 
international, that were established on the basis of narrow preoccupations and 
compartmentalized concerns. Governments' general response to the speed and scale of global 
changes has been a reluctance to recognize sufficiently the need to change themselves. The 
challenges are both interdependent and integrated, requiring comprehensive approaches and 
popular participation. 
32. Yet most of the institutions facing those challenges tend to be independent, fragmented, 
working to relatively narrow mandates with closed decision processes. Those responsible for 
managing natural resources and protecting the environment are institutionally separated from 
those responsible for managing the economy. The real world of interlocked economic and 
ecological systems will not change; the policies and institutions concerned must. 
33. There is a growing need for effective international cooperation to manage ecological and 
economic interdependence. Yet at the same time, confidence in international organizations is 
diminishing and support for them dwindling. 
34. The other great institutional flaw in coping with environment/development challenges is 
governments' failure to make the bodies whose policy actions degrade the environment 
responsible for ensuring that their policies prevent that degradation. Environmental concern 
arose from damage caused by the rapid economic growth following the Second World War. 
Governments, pressured by their citizens, saw a need to clean up the mess, and they 
established environmental ministries and agencies to do this. Many had great success within 
the limits of their mandates - in improving air and water quality and enhancing other 
resources. But much of their work has of necessity been after-the-fact repair of damage: 
reforestation, reclaiming desert lands, rebuilding urban environments, restoring natural 
habitats, and rehabilitating wild lands. 
35. The existence of such agencies gave many governments and their citizens the false 
impression that these bodies were by themselves able to protect and enhance the 
environmental resource base. Yet many industrialized and most developing countries carry 
huge economic burdens from inherited problems such an air and water pollution, depletion of 
groundwater, and the proliferation of toxic chemicals and hazardous wastes. These have been 
joined by more recent problems - erosion, desertification, acidification, new chemicals, and 
new forms of waste - that are directly related to agricultural, industrial, energy, forestry, and 
transportation policies and practices. 
36. The mandates of the central economic and sectoral ministries are also often too narrow, 
too concerned with quantities of production or growth. The mandates of ministries of industry
include production targets, while the accompanying pollution is left to ministries of 
environment. Electricity boards produce power, while the acid pollution they also produce is 
left to other bodies to clean up. The present challenge is to give the central economic and 
sectoral ministries the responsibility for the quality of those parts of the human environment 
affected by their decisions, and to give the environmental agencies more power to cope with 
the effects of unsustainable development. 
37. The same need for change holds for international agencies concerned with development 
lending, trade regulation, agricultural development, and so on. These have been slow to take 
the environmental effects of their work into account, although some are trying to do so. 
38. The ability to anticipate and prevent environmental damage requires that the ecological 
dimensions of policy be considered at the same time as the economic, trade, energy, 
agricultural, and other dimensions. They should be considered on the same agendas and in the 
same national and international institutions. 
39. This reorientation is one of the chief institutional challenges of the 1990s and beyond. 
Meeting it will require major institutional development and reform. Many countries that are 
too poor or small or that have limited managerial capacity will find it difficult to do this 
unaided. They will need financial and technical assistance and training. But the changes 
required involve all countries, large and small, rich and poor. 
II. The Policy Directions 
40. The Commission has focused its attention in the areas of population, food security, the 
loss of species and genetic resources, energy, industry, and human settlements - realizing that 
all of these are connected and cannot be treated in isolation one from another. This section 
contains only a few of the Commission's many recommendations. 
1. Population and Human Resources 
41. In many parts of the world, the population is growing at rates that cannot be sustained by 
available environmental resources, at rates that are outstripping any reasonable expectations 
of improvements in housing, health care, food security, or energy supplies. 
42. The issue is not just numbers of people, but how those numbers relate to available 
resources. Thus the 'population problem' must be dealt with in part by efforts to eliminate 
mass poverty, in order to assure more equitable access to resources, and by education to 
improve human potential to manage those resources. 
43. Urgent steps are needed to limit extreme rates of population growth. Choices made now 
will influence the level at which the population stabilizes next century within a range of 6 
billion people. But this is not just a demographic issue; providing people with facilities and 
education that allow them to choose the size of their families is a way of assuring - especially 
for women - the basic human right of self-determination. 
44. Governments that need to do so should develop long-term, multifaceted population 
policies and a campaign to pursue broad demographic goals: to strengthen social, cultural, and 
economic motivations for family planning, and to provide to all who want them the education, 
contraceptives, and services required. 
45. Human resource development is a crucial requirement not only to build up technical
knowledge and capabilities, but also to create new values to help individuals and nations cope 
with rapidly changing social, environmental, and development realities. Knowledge shared 
globally would assure greater mutual understanding and create greater willingness to share 
global resources equitably. 
46. Tribal and indigenous peoples will need special attention as the forces of economic 
development disrupt their traditional life-styles - life-styles that can offer modern societies 
many lessons in the management of resources in complex forest, mountain, and dryland 
ecosystems. Some are threatened with virtual extinction by insensitive development over 
which they have no control. Their traditional rights should be recognized and they should be 
given a decisive voice in formulating policies about resource development in their areas. (See 
Chapter 4 for a wider discussion of these issues and recommendations.) 
2. Food Security: Sustaining the Potential 
47. Growth in world cereal production has steadily outstripped world population growth. Yet 
each year there are more people in the world who do not get enough food. Global agriculture 
has the potential to grow enough food for all, but food is often not available where it is needed. 
48. Production in industrialized countries has usually been highly subsidized and protected 
from international competition. These subsidies have encouraged the overuse of soil and 
chemicals, the pollution of both water resources and foods with these chemicals, and the 
degradation of the countryside. Much of this effort has produced surpluses and their 
associated financial burdens. And some of this surplus has been sent at concessional rates to 
the developing world, where it has undermined the farming policies of recipient nations. There 
is, however, growing awareness in some countries of the environmental and economic 
consequences of such paths, and the emphasis of agricultural policies is to encourage 
conservation. 
49. Many developing countries, on the other hand, have suffered the opposite problem: 
farmers are not sufficiently supported. In some, improved technology allied to price incentives 
and government services has produced a major breakthrough in food production. But 
elsewhere, the food-growing small farmers have been neglected. Coping with often inadequate 
technology and few economic incentives, many are pushed onto marginal land: too dry, too 
steep, lacking in nutrients. Forests are cleared and productive drylands rendered barren. 
50. Most developing nations need more effective incentive systems to encourage production, 
especially of food crops. In short, the 'terms of trade' need to be turned in favour of the small 
farmer. Most industrialized nations, on the other hand, must alter present systems in order to 
cut surpluses, to reduce unfair competition with nations that may have real comparative 
advantages, and to promote ecologically sound farming practices. 
51. Food security requires attention to questions of distribution, since hunger often arises 
from lack of purchasing power rather than lack of available food. It can be furthered by land 
reforms, and by policies to protect vulnerable subsistence farmers, pastora1ists, and the 
landless - groups who by the year 2000 will include 220 million households. Their greater 
prosperity will depend on integrated rural development that increases work opportunities 
both inside and outside agriculture. (See Chapter 5 for a wider discussion of these issues and 
recommendations.)
3. Species and Ecosystems: Resources for Development 
52. The planet's species are under stress. There is a growing scientific consensus that species 
are disappearing at rates never before witnessed on the planet, although there is also 
controversy over those rates and the risks they entail. Yet there is still time to halt this 
process. 
53. The diversity of species is necessary for the normal functioning of ecosystems and the 
biosphere as a whole. The genetic material in wild species contributes billions of dollars yearly 
to the world economy in the form of improved crop species, new drugs and medicines, and raw 
materials for industry. But utility aside, there are also moral, ethical, cultural, aesthetic, and 
purely scientific reasons for conserving wild beings. 
54. A first priority is to establish the problem of disappearing species and threatened 
ecosystems on political agendas as a major economic and resource issue. 
55. Governments can stem the destruction of tropical forests and other reservoirs of biological 
diversity while developing them economically. Reforming forest revenue systems and 
concession terms could raise billions of dollars of additional revenues, promote more efficient, 
long-term forest resource use, and curtail deforestation. 
56. The network of protected areas that the world will need in the future must include much 
larger areas brought under so.ne degree of protection. Therefore, the cost of conservation will 
rise - directly and in terms of opportunities for development foregone. But over the long term 
the opportunities for development will be enhanced. International development agencies 
should therefore give comprehensive and systematic attention to the problems and 
opportunities of species conservation. 
57. Governments should investigate the prospect of agreeing to a 'Species Convention', similar 
in spirit and scope to other international conventions reflecting principles of 'universal 
resources'. They should also consider international financial arrangements to support the 
implementation of such a convention. (See Chapter 6 for a wider discussion of these issues 
and recommendations.) 
4. Energy: Choices for Environment and Development 
58. A safe and sustainable energy pathway is crucial to sustainable development; we have not 
yet found it. Rates of increase in energy use have been declining. However, the 
industrialization, agricultural development, and rapidly growing populations of developing 
nations will need much more energy. Today, the average person in an industrial market 
economy uses more than 80 times as much energy as someone in sub-Saharan Africa. Thus 
any realistic global energy scenario must provide for substantially increased primary energy 
use by developing countries. 
59. To bring developing countries' energy use up to industrialized country levels by the year 
2025 would require increasing present global energy use by a factor of five. The planetary 
ecosystem could not stand this, especially if the increases were based on non-renewable fossil 
fuels. Threats of global warming and acidification of the environment most probably rule out 
even a doubling of energy use bared on present mixes of primary sources. 
60. Any new era of economic growth must therefore be less energy intensive than growth in 
the past. Energy efficiency policies must be the cutting edge of national energy strategies for 
sustainable development, and there is much scope for improvement in this direction. Modern
appliances can be redesigned to deliver the same amounts of energy-services with only 
two-thirds or even one-half of the primary energy inputs needed to run traditional equipment. 
And energy efficiency solutions are often cost-effective. 
61. After almost four decades of immense technological effort, nuclear energy has become 
widely used. During this period, however, the nature of its costs, risks, and benefits have 
become more evident and the subject of sharp controversy. Different countries world-wide 
take up different positions on the use of nuclear energy. The discussion in the Commission 
also reflected these different views and positions. Yet all agreed that the generation of nuclear 
power is only justifiable if there are solid solutions to the unsolved problems to which it gives 
rise. The highest priority should be accorded to research and development on environmentally 
sound and ecologically viable alternatives, as well as on means of increasing the safety of 
nuclear energy. 
62. Energy efficiency can only buy time for the world to develop 'low-energy paths' based on 
renewable sources, which should form the foundation of the global energy structure during the 
21st Century. Most of these sources are currently problematic, but given innovative 
development, they could supply the same amount of primary energy the planet now 
consumes. However, achieving these use levels will require a programme of coordinated 
research, development, and demonstration projects commanding funding necessary to ensure 
the rapid development of renewable energy. Developing countries will require assistance to 
change their energy use patterns in this direction. 
63. Millions of people in the developing world are short of fuelwood, the main domestic energy 
of half of humanity, and their numbers are growing. The wood-poor nations must organize 
their agricultural sectors to produce large amounts of wood and other plant fuels. 
64. The substantial changes required in the present global energy mix will not be achieved by 
market pressures alone, given the dominant role of governments as producers of energy and 
their importance as consumers. If the recent momentum behind annual gains in energy 
efficiency is to be maintained and extended,governments need to make it an explicit goal of 
their policies for energy pricing to consumers, prices needed to encourage the adoption of 
energy-saving measures may be achieved through several means. Although the Commission 
expresses no preference, 'conservation pricing' requires that governments take a long-term 
view in weighing the costs and benefits of the various measures. Given the importance of oil 
prices on international energy policy, new mechanisms for encouraging dialogue between 
consumers and producers should be explored. 
65. A safe, environmentally sound, and economically viable energy pathway that will sustain 
human progress into the distant future is clearly imperative. It is also possible. But it will 
require new dimensions of political will and institutional cooperation to achieve it. (See 
Chapter 7 for a wider discussion of these issues and recommendations.) 
5. Industry: Producing More with Less 
66. The world manufactures seven times more goods today than it did as recently as 1950. 
Given population growth rates, a five- to tenfold increase in manufacturing output will be 
needed just to raise developing world consumption of manufactured goods to industrialized 
world levels by the time population growth rates level off next century. 
67. Experience in the industrialized nations has proved that anti-pollution technology has 
been cost-effective in terms of health, property, and environmental damage avoided, and that
it has made many industries more profitable by waking them more resource-efficient. While 
economic growth has continued, the consumption of raw materials has held steady or even 
declined, and new technologies offer further efficiencies. 
68. Nations have to bear the costs of any inappropriate industrialization, and many developing 
countries are realizing that they have neither the resources nor - given rapid technological 
change - the time to damage their environments now and clean up later. But they also need 
assistance and information from industrialized nations to make the best use of technology. 
Transnational corporations have a special responsibility to smooth the path of 
industrialization in the nations in which they operate. 
69. Emerging technologies offer the promise of higher productivity, increased efficiency, and 
decreased pollution, but many bring risks of new toxic chemicals and wastes and of major 
accidents of a type and scale beyond present coping mechanisms. There is an urgent need for 
tighter controls over the export of hazardous industrial and agricultural chemicals. Present 
controls over the dumping of hazardous wastes should be tightened. 
70. Many essential human needs can be net only through goods and services provided by 
industry, and the shift to sustainable development must be powered by a continuing flow of 
wealth from industry. (See Chapter 8 for a wider discussion of these issues and 
recommendations.) 
6. The Urban Challenge 
71. By the turn of the century, almost half of humanity will live in cities; the world of the 21st 
century will be a largely urban world. Over only 65 years, the developing world's urban 
population has increased tenfold, from around 100 million in 1920 to 1 billion today. In 1940, 
one person in 100 lived in a city of 1 million or more inhabitants; by 1980, one in 10 lived in 
such a city. Between 1985 and the year 2000, Third World cities could grow by another three-quarters 
of a billion people. This suggests that the developing world must, over the next few 
years, increase by 65 per cent its capacity to produce and manage its urban infrastructure, 
services, and shelter merely to maintain today's often extremely inadequate conditions. 
72. Few city governments in the developing world have the power, resources, and trained 
personnel to provide their rapidly growing populations with the land, services, and facilities 
needed for an adequate human life: clean water, sanitation, schools, and transport. The result 
is mushrooming illegal settlements with primitive facilities, increased overcrowding, and 
rampant disease linked to an unhealthy environment. Many cities in industrial countries also 
face problems - deteriorating infrastructure, environmental degradation, inner-city decay, and 
neighbourhood collapse. But with the means and resources to tackle this decline, the issue for 
most industrial countries is ultimately one of political and social choice. Developing countries 
are not in the same situation. They have a major urban crisis on their hands. 
73. Governments will need to develop explicit settlements strategies to guide the process of 
urbanization, taking the pressure off the largest urban centres and building up smaller towns 
and cities, more closely integrating them with their rural hinterlands. This will mean 
examining and changing other policies - taxation, food pricing, transportation, health, 
industrialization - that work against the goals of settlements strategies. 
74. Good city management requires decentralization of funds, political power, and personnel - 
to local authorities, which are best placed to appreciate and manage local needs. But the 
sustainable development of cities will depend on closer work with the majorities of urban poor
who are the true city builders, tapping the skills, energies and resources of neighbourhood 
groups and those in the 'informal sector'. Much can be achieved by 'site and service' schemes 
that provide households with basic services and help them to get on with building sounder 
houses around these. (See Chapter 9 for a wider discussion of these issues and 
recommendations.) 
III. International Cooperation and Institutional Reform 
1. The Role of the International Economy 
75. Two conditions must be satisfied before international economic exchanges can become 
beneficial for all involved. The sustainability of ecosystems on which the global economy 
depends must be guaranteed. And the economic partners must be satisfied that the basis of 
exchange is equitable. For many developing countries, neither condition is set. 
76. Growth in many developing countries is being stifled by depressed commodity prices, 
protectionism, intolerable debt burdens, and declining flows of development finance. If living 
standards are to grow so as to alleviate poverty, these trends must be reversed. 
77. A particular responsibility falls to the World Bank and the International Development 
Association as the main conduit for multilateral finance to developing countries. In the context 
of consistently increased financial flows, the World Bank can support environmentally sound 
projects and policies. In financing structural adjustment, the International Monetary Fund 
should support wider and longer term development objectives than at present: growth, social 
goals, and environmental impacts. 
78. The present level of debt service of many countries, especially in Africa and Latin America, 
is not consistent with sustainable development. Debtors are being required to use trade 
surpluses to service debts, and are drawing heavily on non-renewable resources to do so. 
Urgent action is necessary to alleviate debt burdens in ways that represent a fairer sharing 
between both debtors and lenders of the responsibilities and burdens. 
79. Current arrangements for commodities could be significantly improved: more 
compensatory financing to offset economic shocks would encourage producers to take a 
long-term view, and not to overproduce commodities; and more assistance could be given 
from diversification programmes. Commodity-specific arrangements can build on the model of 
the International Tropical Timber Agreement, one of the few that specifically includes 
ecological concerns 
80. Multinational companies can play an important role in sustainable development, especially 
as developing countries come to rely more on foreign equity capital. But if these companies are 
to have a positive influence on development, the negotiating capacity of developing countries 
vis a vis transnationals must be strengthened so they can secure terms which respect their 
environmental concerns. 
81. However, these specific measures must be located in a wider context of effective 
cooperation to produce an international economic system geared to growth and the 
elimination of world poverty. (See Chapter 3 for a more detailed discussion of issues and 
recommendations on the international economy.) 
2. Managing the Commons
82. Traditional forms of national sovereignty raise particular problems in managing the 'global 
commons' and their shared ecosystems - the oceans, outer space, and Antarctica. Some 
progress has been made in all three areas; much remains to be done. 
83. The UN Conference on the Law of the Sea was the most ambitious attempt ever to provide 
an internationally agreed regime for the management of the oceans. All nations should ratify 
the Law of the Sea Treaty as soon at possible. Fisheries agreements should be strengthened to 
prevent current overexploitation, as should conventions to control and regulate the dumping 
of hazardous wastes at sea. 
84. There are growing concerns about the management of orbital space, centering on using 
satellite technology for monitoring planetary systems; on making the most effective use of the 
limited capacities of geosynchronous orbit for communications satellites; and on limiting 
space debris. The orbiting and testing of weapons in space would greatly increase this debris. 
The international community should seek to design and implement a space regime to ensure 
that space remains a peaceful environment for the benefit of all. 
85. Antarctica is managed under the 1959 Antarctica Treaty. However, many nations outside 
of that pact view the Treaty System as too limited, both in participation and in the scope of its 
conservation measures. The Commission's recommendations deal with the safeguarding of 
present achievements; the incorporation of any minerals development into a management 
regime; and various options for the future. (See Chapter 10 for more discussion in issues and 
recommendations on the management of the commons.) 
3. Peace, Security, Development, and the Environment 
86. Among the dangers facing the environment, the possibility of nuclear war is undoubtedly 
the gravest. Certain aspects of the issues of peace and security bear directly upon the concept 
of sustainable development. The whole notion of security as traditionally understood in terms 
of political and military threats to national sovereignty - must be expanded to include the 
growing impacts of environmental stress - locally, nationally, regionally, and globally. There 
are no military solutions to 'environmental insecurity'. 
87. Governments and international agencies should assess the cost-effectiveness, in terms of 
achieving security, of money spent on armaments compared with money spent on reducing 
poverty or restoring a ravaged environment. 
88. But the greatest need is to achieve improved relations among those major powers capable 
of deploying weapons of mass destruction. This is needed to achieve agreement on tighter 
control over the proliferation and testing of various types of weapons of mass destruction - 
nuclear and non nuclear - including those that have environmental implications. (See Chapter 
11 for more discussion of issues and recommendations on the links between peace, security, 
development, and the environment.) 
4. Institutional and Legal Change 
89. The Report that follows contains throughout (and especially in Chapter 12), many specific 
recommendations for institutional and legal change. These cannot be adequately summarized 
here. However, the Commission's main proposals are embodied in six priority areas.
4.1 Getting at the Sources 
90. Governments must begin now to make the key national, economic, and sectoral agencies 
directly responsible and accountable for ensuring that their policies, programmes, and 
budgets support development that is economically and ecologically sustainable. 
91. By the same token, the various regional organizations need to do more to integrate 
environment fully in their goals and activities. New regional arrangements will especially be 
needed among developing countries to deal with transboundary environmental issues. 
92. All major international bodies and agencies should ensure that their programmes 
encourage and support sustainable development, and they should greatly improve their 
coordination and cooperation. The Secretary-General of the United Nations Organization 
should provide a high level centre of leadership for the UN system to assess, advise, assist, 
and report on progress made towards this goal. 
4.2 Dealing with the Effects 
93. Governments should also reinforce the roles and capacities of environmental protection 
and resource management agencies. This is needed in many industrialized countries, but most 
urgently in developing countries, which will need assistance in strengthening their 
institutions. The UN Environment Programme (UNEP) should be strengthened as the 
principal source on environmental data, assessment, and reporting and as the principal 
advocate and agent for change and international cooperation on critical environment and 
natural resource protection issues. 
4.3 Assessing Global Risks 
94. The capacity to identify, assess, and report on risks of irreversible damage to natural 
systems and threats to the survival, security, and well being of the world community must be 
rapidly reinforced and extended. Governments, individually and collectively, have the 
principal responsibility to do this. UNEP's Earthwatch programme should be the centre of 
leadership in the UN system on risk assessment 
95. However, given the politically sensitive nature of many of the most critical risks, there is 
also a need for an independent but complementary capacity to assess and report on critical 
global risks. A new international programme for cooperation among largely non-governmental 
organizations, scientific bodies, and industry groups should therefore be established for this 
purpose. 
4.4 Making Informed Choices 
96. Making the difficult choices involved in achieving sustainable development will depend on 
the widespread support and involvement of an informed public and of NGOs, the scientific 
community, and industry. Their rights, roles and participation in development planning, 
decision-making, and project implementation should be expanded.
4.5 Providing the Legal Means 
97. National and international law is being rapidly outdistanced by the accelerating pace and 
expanding scale of impacts on the ecological basis of development. Governments now need to 
fill major gaps in existing national and international law related to the environment, to find 
ways to recognize and protect the rights of present and future generations to an environment 
adequate for their health and well-being, to prepare under UN auspices a universal 
Declaration on environmental protection and sustainable development and a subsequent 
Convention, and to strengthen procedures for avoiding or resolving disputes on environment 
and resource management issues. 
4.6 Investing in our Future 
98. Over the past decade, the overall cost-effectiveness of investments in halting pollution has 
been demonstrated. The escalating economic and ecological damage costs of not investing in 
environmental protection and improvement have also been repeatedly demonstrated - often in 
grim tolls of flood and famine. But there are large financial implications: for renewable energy 
development, pollution control, and achieving less resource intensive forms of agriculture. 
99. Multilateral financial institutions have a crucial role to play. The World Bank is presently 
reorienting its programmes towards greater environmental concerns. This should be 
accompanied by a fundamental commitment to sustainable development by the Bank. It is also 
essential that the Regional Development Banks and the International Monetary Fund 
incorporate similar objectives in their policies and programmes. A new priority and focus is 
also needed in bilateral aid agencies. 
100. Given the limitations on increasing present flows of international aid, proposals for 
securing additional revenue from the use of international commons and natural resources 
should now be seriously considered by governments. 
IV. A Call for Action 
101. Over the course of this century, the relationship between the human world and the planet 
that sustains it has undergone a profound change. 
102. When the century began, neither human numbers nor technology had the power radically 
to alter planetary systems. As the century closes, not only do vastly increased human numbers 
and their activities have that power, but major, unintended changes are occurring in the 
atmosphere, in soils, in waters, among plants and animals, and in the relationships among all 
of these. The rate of change is outstripping the ability of scientific disciplines and our current 
capabilities to assess and advise. It is frustrating the attempts of political and economic 
institutions, which evolved in a different, more fragmented world, to adapt and cope. It deeply 
worries many people who are seeking ways to place those concerns on the political agendas. 
103. The onus lies with no one group of nations. Developing countries face the obvious 
life-threatening challenges of desertification, deforestation, and pollution, and endure most of 
the poverty associated with environmental degradation. The entire human family of nations 
would suffer from the disappearance of rain forests in the tropics, the loss of plant and animal 
species, and changes in rainfall patterns. Industrial nations face the life-threatening challenges
of toxic chemicals, toxic wastes, and acidification. All nations may suffer from the releases by 
industrialized countries of carbon dioxide and of gases that react with the ozone layer, and 
from any future war fought with the nuclear arsenals controlled by those nations. All nations 
will have a role to play in changing trends, and in righting an international economic system 
that increases rather than decreases inequality, that increases rather than decreases numbers 
of poor and hungry. 
104. The next few decades are crucial. The time has come to break out of past patterns. 
Attempts to maintain social and ecological stability through old approaches to development 
and environmental protection will increase instability. Security must be sought through 
change. The Commission has noted a number of actions that must be taken to reduce risks to 
survival and to put future development on paths that are sustainable. Yet we are aware that 
such a reorientation on a continuing basis is simply beyond the reach of present decision-making 
structures and institutional arrangements, both national and international. 
105. This Commission has been careful to base our recommendations on the realities of 
present institutions, on what can and must be accomplished today. But to keep options open 
for future generations, the present generation must begin now, and begin together. 
106. To achieve the needed changes, we believe that an active follow-up of this report is 
imperative. It is with this in mind that we call for the UN General Assembly, upon due 
consideration, to transform this report into a UN Programme on Sustainable Development. 
Special follow-up conferences could be initiated at the regional level. Within an appropriate 
period after the presentation of this report to the General Assembly, an international 
conference could be convened to review progress made, and to promote follow up 
arrangements that will be needed to set benchmarks and to maintain human progress. 
107. First and foremost, this Commission has been concerned with people - of all countries and 
all walks of life. And it is to people that we address our report. The changes in human attitudes 
that we call for depend on a vast campaign of education, debate, and public participation. This 
campaign must start now if sustainable human progress is to be achieved. 
108. The Members of the World Commission on Environment and Development came from 21 
very different nations. In our discussions, we disagreed often on details and priorities. But 
despite our widely differing backgrounds and varying national and international 
responsibilities, we were able to agree to the lines along which change must be drawn. 
109. We are unanimous in our conviction that the security, well-being, and very survival of the 
planet depend on such changes, now.
Our Common Future, Chapter 1: A Threatened Future 
I. Symptoms and Causes 
1. Poverty 
2. Growth 
3. Survival 
4. The Economic Crisis 
II. New Approaches to Environment and Development 
1. The Earth is one but the world is not. We all depend on one biosphere for sustaining our 
lives. Yet each community, each country, strives for survival and prosperity with little regard 
for its impact on others. Some consume the Earth's resources at a rate that would leave little 
for future generations. Others, many more in number, consume far too little and live with the 
prospect of hunger, squalor, disease, and early death. 
2. Yet progress has been made. Throughout much of the world, children born today can expect 
to live longer and be better educated than their parents. In many parts, the new-born can also 
expect to attain a higher standard of living in a wider sense. Such progress provides hope as we 
contemplate the improvements still needed, and also as we face our failures to make this Earth 
a safer and sounder home for us and for those who are to come. 
3. The failures that we need to correct arise both from poverty and from the short-sighted way 
in which we have often pursued prosperity. Many parts of the world are caught in a vicious 
downwards spiral: Poor people are forced to overuse environmental resources to survive from 
day to day, and their impoverishment of their environment further impoverishes them, 
making their survival ever more difficult and uncertain. The prosperity attained in some parts 
of the world is often precarious, as it has been secured through farming, forestry, and 
industrial practices that bring profit and progress only over the short term. 
4. Societies have faced such pressures in the past and, as many desolate ruins remind us, 
sometimes succumbed to them. But generally these pressures were local. Today the scale of 
ow interventions in nature is increasing and the physical effects of our decisions spill across 
national frontiers. The growth in economic interaction between nations amplifies the wider 
consequences of national decisions. Economics and ecology bind us in ever-tightening 
networks. Today, many regions face risks of irreversible damage to the human environment 
that threaten the basis for human progress. 
5. These deepening interconnections are the central justification for the establishment of this 
Commission. We travelled the world for nearly three years, listening. At special public hearings 
organized by the Commission, we heard from government leaders, scientists, and experts, 
from citizens' groups concerned about a wide range of environment and development issues, 
and from thousands of individuals farmers, shanty-town residents, young people, 
industrialists, and indigenous and tribal peoples.
6. We found everywhere deep public concern for the environment, concern that has led not 
just to protests but often to changed behaviour. The challenge is to ensure that these new 
values are more adequately reflected in the principles and operations of political and economic 
structures. 
7. We also found grounds for hope: that people can cooperate to build a future that is more 
prosperous, more just, and more secure; that a new era of economic growth can be attained, 
one based on policies that sustain and expand the Earth's resource base; and that the progress 
that some have known over the last century can be experienced by all in the years ahead. But 
for this to happen, we must understand better the symptoms of stress that confront us, we 
must identify the causes, and we must design new approaches to managing environmental 
resources and to sustaining human development 
I. Symptoms and Causes 
8. Environmental stress has often been seen as the result of the growing demand on scarce 
resources and the pollution generated by the rising living standards of the relatively affluent. 
But poverty itself pollutes the environment, creating environmental stress in a different way. 
Those who are poor and hungry will often destroy their immediate environment in order to 
survive: They will cut down forests; their livestock will overgraze grasslands; they will overuse 
marginal land; and in growing numbers they will crowd into congested cities. The cumulative 
effect of these changes is so far-reaching as to make poverty itself a major global scourge. 
9. On the other hand, where economic growth has led to improvements in living standards, it 
has sometimes been achieved in ways that are globally damaging in the longer term. Much of 
the improvement in the past has been based on the use of increasing amounts of raw 
materials, energy, chemicals, and synthetics and on the creation of pollution that is not 
adequately accounted for in figuring the costs of production processes. These trends have had 
unforeseen effects on the environment. Thus today's environmental challenges arise both 
from the lack of development and from the unintended consequences of some forms of 
economic growth. 
1. Poverty 
10. There are more hungry people in the world today than ever before in human history, and 
their numbers are growing. In 1980, there were 340 million people in 87 developing countries 
not getting enough calories to prevent stunted growth and serious health risks. This total was 
very slightly below the figure for 1970 in terms of share of the world population, but in terms of 
sheer numbers, it represented a 14 per cent increase. The World Bank predicts that these 
numbers are likely to go on growing. /1 
I think this Commission should give attention on how to look into the question of 
more participation for those people who are the object of development. Their 
basic needs include the right to preserve their cultural identity, and their right not to 
be alienated from their own society, and their own community. So the point I want 
to make is that we cannot discuss environment or development without discussing 
political development. And you cannot eradicate poverty, at least not only by 
redistributing wealth or income, but there must be more redistribution of power. 
Aristides Katoppo
Publisher 
WCED Public Hearing 
Jakarta, 26 March 1985 
11. The number of people living in slums and shanty towns is rising, not falling. A growing 
number lack access to clean water and sanitation and hence are prey to the diseases that arise 
from this lack. There is some progress, impressive in places. But, on balance, poverty persists 
and its victims multiply. 
12. The pressure of poverty has to be seen in a broader context. At the international level there 
are large differences in per capita income, which ranged in 1984 from $190 in low income 
countries (other than China and India) to $11,430 in the industrial market economies. (See 
Table 1-1) 
Table 1-1 
Population Size and per capita GDP by Groups of Countries 
Population Per capita GDP Average 
annual 
growth rate of 
per capita 
GDP, 
1965-1984 
(millions) (1984 dollars) (per cent) 
Countries 
Low-income countries 
(excluding China, India) 
611 190 0.9 
China and India 1,778 390 3.2 
Lower Middle-income Economies 691 740 1.0 
Upper Middle-income Economies 497 1,980 3.1 
High-Income Oil Exporters 19 11,350 3.2 
Industrial Market Economies 732 11,430 2.4 
Source: Based on data in World Bank, World Development Report, 1985. (New York, 
Oxford University Press, 1986) 
13. Such inequalities represent great differences not merely in the quality of life today, but also 
in the capacity of societies to improve their quality of life in the future. Most of the world's 
poorest countries depend for increasing export earnings on tropical agricultural products that 
are vulnerable to fluctuating or declining terms of trade. Expansion can often only be achieved 
at the price of ecological stress. Yet diversification in ways that will alleviate both poverty and
ecological stress is hampered by disadvantageous terms of technology transfer, by 
protectionism, and by declining financial flows to those countries that most need international 
finance./2 
14. Within countries, poverty has been exacerbated by the unequal distribution of land and 
other assets. The rapid rise in population has compromised the ability to raise living 
standards. These factors, combined with growing demands for the commercial use of good 
land, often to grow crops for exports, have pushed many subsistence farmers onto poor land 
and robbed them of any hope of participating in their nations' economic lives. The same forces 
have meant that traditional shifting cultivators, who once cut forests, grew crops, and then 
gave the forest time to recover, now have neither land enough nor time to let forests 
re-establish. So forests are being destroyed, often only to create poor farmland that cannot 
support those who till it. Extending cultivation onto steep slopes is increasing soil erosion in 
many hilly sections of both developing and developed nations. In any river valleys, areas 
chronically liable to floods are now farmed. 
15. These pressures are reflected in the rising incidence of disasters. During the 1970s, six 
times as many people died from 'natural disasters' each year as in the 1960s, and twice as 
many suffered from such disasters. Droughts and floods, disasters among whose causes are 
widespread deforestation and overcultivation, increased most in terms of numbers affected. 
There were 18.5 million people affected by droughts annually in the 1960s, but 24.4 billion in 
the 1970s; 5.2 billion people were victims of floods yearly in the 1960s, compared with 15.4 
million in the 1970s./3 The results are not in for the 1980s, but this disaster-prone decade 
seems to be carrying forward the trend, with droughts in Africa, India, and Latin America, and 
floods throughout Asia, parts of Africa, and the Andean region of Latin America. 
16. Such disasters claim most of their victims among the impoverished in poor nations, where 
subsistence farmers must make their land more liable to droughts and floods by clearing 
marginal areas, and where the poor make themselves tore vulnerable to all disasters by living 
on steep slopes and unprotected shores - the only lands left for their shanties. Lacking food 
and foreign exchange reserves their economically vulnerable governments are ill-equipped to 
cope with such catastrophes. 
17. The links between environmental stress and developmental disaster are most evident in 
sub-Saharan Africa. Per capita food production, declining since the 1960s, plummeted during 
the drought of the 1980s, and at the height of the food emergency some 35 million people were 
exposed to risk. Human overuse of land and prolonged drought threaten to turn the 
grasslands of Africa's Sahel region into desert./4 No other region more tragically suffers the 
vicious cycle of poverty leading to environmental degradation, which leads in turn to even 
greater poverty. 
If people destroy vegetation in order to get land, food, fodder, fuel, or timber, the 
soil is no longer protected. Rain creates surface runoff, and the soil erodes. When 
the soil is gone, no water is retained and the land can no longer produce enough 
food, fodder, fuel, or timber, so people need to turn to new land and start the 
process all over again. 
All major disaster problems in the Third World are essentially unsolved 
development problems. Disaster prevention is thus primarily an aspect of 
development, and this must be a development that takes place within the 
sustainable limits.
Odd Grann 
Secretary General, Norwegian Red Cross 
WCED Public Hearing 
Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 
2. Growth 
18. In some parts of the world, particularly since the mid-1950s, growth and development have 
vastly improved living standards and the quality of life. Many of the products and technologies 
that have gone into this improvement are raw material- and energy-intensive and entail a 
substantial amount of pollution. The consequent impact on the environment is greater than 
ever before in human history. 
19. Over the past century, the use of fossil fuels has grown nearly thirtyfold, and industrial 
production has increased move than fiftyfold. The bulk of this increase, about three-quarters 
in the case of fossil fuels and a little over four-fifths in the case of industrial production, has 
taken place since 1950. The annual increase in industrial production today is perhaps as large 
as the total production in Europe around the end of the 1930s./5 Into every year we now 
squeeze the decades of industrial growth and environmental disruption that formed the basis 
of the pre-war European economy. 
20. Environmental stresses also arise from more traditional forms of production. More land 
has been cleared for settled cultivation in the past 100 years than in all the previous centuries 
of human existence. Interventions in the water cycles have increased greatly. Massive dams, 
most of them built after 1960, impound a large proportion of the river flow. In Europe and 
Asia, water use has reached 10 per cent of the annual run off, a figure that is expected to rise to 
20-25 per cent by the end of the century./6 
21. The impact of growth and rising income levels can be seen in the distribution of world 
consumption of a variety of resource intensive produce. The more affluent industrialized 
countries use most of the world's metals and fossil fuels. Even in the case of food products a 
sharp difference exists, particularly in the products that are more resource-intensive. (See 
Table 1-2.) 
Table 1-2 
Distribution of World Consumption, Averages for 1980-83 
Developed Countries 
(26% of population) 
Developing Countries 
(74% of population) 
Units of Per 
Capita 
Consumption 
Share in 
World 
Consumption 
Share in 
World 
Consumption 
Commodity per cent per capita per cent per capita
Food 
Calories kcal/day 34 3,395 66 2,389 
Protein gms/day 38 99 62 
Fat gms/day 53 127 47 40 
Paper kg/year 85 123 15 8 
Steel kg/year 79 459 21 41 
Other Metals kg/year 86 26 14 2 
Commercial 
Energy 
/year 80 20 0.5 
Source: WCED estimates based on country-level data from FAO, UN Statistical Office, 
UNCTAD and American Metals Association 
22. In recent years, industrial countries have been able to achieve economic growth using less 
energy and raw materials per unit of output. This, along with the efforts to reduce the 
emission of pollutants, will help to contain the pressure on the biosphere. But with the 
increase in population and the rise in incomes, per capita consumption of energy and 
materials will go up in the developing countries, as it has to if essential needs are to be met. 
Greater attention to resource efficiency can moderate the increase, but, on balance, 
environmental problems linked to resource use will intensify in global terms. 
3. Survival 
23. The scale and complexity of our requirements for natural resources have increased greatly 
with the rising levels of population and production. Nature is bountiful, but it is also fragile 
and finely balanced. There are thresholds that cannot be crossed without endangering the 
basic integrity of the system. Today we are close to many of these thresholds; we must be ever 
mindful of the risk of endangering the survival of life on Earth. Moreover, the speed with 
which changes in resource use are taking place gives little time in which to anticipate and 
prevent unexpected effects. 
24. The 'greenhouse effect', one such threat to life support systems, springs directly from 
increased resource use. The burning of fossil fuels and the cutting and burning of forests 
release carbon dioxide (CO2). The accumulation in the atmosphere of CO2 and certain other 
gases traps solar radiation near the Earth's surface, causing global warming. This could cause 
sea level rises over the next 45 years large enough to inundate many low lying coastal cities 
and river deltas. It could also drastically upset national and international agricultural 
production and trade systems./7
The remarkable achievements of the celebrated Industrial Revolution are now 
beginning seriously to be questioned principally because the environment was not 
considered at the time. It was felt that the sky was so vast and clear nothing could 
ever change its colour, our rivers so big and their water so plentiful that no amount 
of human activity could ever change their quality, and there were trees and natural 
forests so plentiful that we will never finish them. After all, they grow again. 
Today we should know better. The alarming rate at which the Earth's surface is 
being denuded of its natural vegetative cover seems to indicate that the world may 
soon become devoid of trees through clearing for human developments. 
Hon. Victoria Chitepo 
Minister of Natural Resources and Tourism, Government of Zimbabwe 
WCED Opening Ceremony 
Harare, 18 Sept 1986 
25. Another threat arises from the depletion of the atmospheric ozone layer by gases released 
during the production of foam and the use of refrigerants and aerosols. A substantial loss of 
such ozone could have catastrophic effects on human and livestock health and on some life 
forms at the base of the marine food chain. The 1986 discovery of a hole in the ozone layer 
above the Antarctic suggests the possibility of a more rapid depletion than previously 
suspected./8 
26. A variety of air pollutants are killing trees and lakes and damaging buildings and cultural 
treasures, close to and sometimes thousands of miles from points of emission. The 
acidification of the environment threatens large areas of Europe and North America. Central 
Europe is currently receiving more than one gramme of sulphur on every square metre of 
ground each year./9 The loss of forests could bring in its wake disastrous erosion, siltation, 
floods, and local climatic change. Air pollution damage is also becoming evident in some newly 
industrialized countries. 
27. In many cases the practices used at present to dispose of toxic wastes, such as those from 
the chemical industries, involve unacceptable risks. Radioactive wastes from the nuclear 
industry remain hazardous for centuries. Many who bear these risks do not benefit in any way 
from the activities that produce the wastes. 
28. Desertification - the process whereby productive arid and semi-arid land is rendered 
economically unproductive - and large-scale deforestation are other examples of major threats 
to the integrity of regional ecosystems. Desertification involves complex interactions between 
humans, land, and climate. The pressures of subsistence food production, commercial crops, 
and meat production in arid and semi-arid areas all contribute to this process. 
29. Each year another 6 million hectares are degraded to desert-like conditions./10 Over three 
decades, this would amount to an area roughly as large as Saudi Arabia. More than 11 million 
hectares of tropical forests are destroyed per year and this, over 30 years, would amount to an 
area about the size of India./11 Apart from the direct and often dramatic impacts within the 
immediate area, nearby regions are affected by the spreading of sands or by changes in water 
regimes and increased risks of soil erosion and siltation. 
30. The loss of forests and other wild lands extinguishes species of plants and animals and 
drastically reduces the genetic diversity of the world's ecosystems. This process robs present
and future generations of genetic material with which to improve crop varieties, to make them 
less vulnerable to weather stress, pest attacks, and disease. The loss of species and subspecies, 
many as yet unstudied by science, deprives us of important potential sources of medicines and 
industrial chemicals. It removes forever creatures of beauty and parts of our cultural heritage; 
it diminishes the biosphere. 
31. Many of the risks stemming from our productive activity and the technologies we use 
cross-national boundaries; many are global. Though the activities that give rise to these 
dangers tend to be concentrated in a few countries, the risks are shared by all, rich and poor, 
those who benefit from them and those who do not. Most who share in the risks have little 
influence on the decision processes that regulate these activities. 
32. Little time is available for corrective action. In some cases we may already be close to 
transgressing critical thresholds. While scientists continue to research and debate causes and 
effects, in many cases we already know enough to warrant action. This is true locally and 
regionally in the cases of such threats as desertification, deforestation, toxic wastes, and 
acidification; it is true globally for such threats as climate change, ozone depletion, and species 
loss. The risks increase faster than do our abilities to manage them. 
33. Perhaps the greatest threat to the Earth's environment, to sustainable human progress, 
and indeed to survival is the possibility of nuclear war, increased daily by the continuing arms 
race and its spread to outer space. The search for a more viable future can only be meaningful 
in the context of a more vigorous effort to renounce and eliminate the development of means 
of annihilation. 
4. The Economic Crisis 
34. The environmental difficulties that confront us are not new, but only recently have we 
begun to understand their complexity. Previously our main concerns centred on the effects of 
development on the environment. Today, we need to be equally concerned about the ways in 
which environmental degradation can dampen or reverse economic development. In one area 
after another, environmental degradation is eroding the potential for development. This basic 
connection was brought into sharp focus by the environment and development crises of the 
1980s. 
35. The slowdown in the momentum of economic expansion and the stagnation in world trade 
in the 1980s challenged all nations' abilities to react and adjust. Developing countries that rely 
on the export of primary products have been hit particularly hard by falling commodity prices. 
Between 1980 and 1984, developing countries lost about $55 billion in export earnings because 
of the fall in commodity prices, a blow felt most keenly in Latin America and Africa./12 
36. As a consequence of this period of slow growth in the world economy - together with rising 
debt service obligations and a decline in the inflow of finance - many developing countries have 
facet) severe economic crises. Over half of all developing countries actually experienced 
declining per capita GDP in the years 1982-85 and per capita GDP has fallen, for developing 
countries as a whole, by around 10 per cent in the 1980s. (See Table 1-3.) 
Table 1-3 
37. The heaviest burden in international economic adjustment has been carried by the world's 
poorest people. The consequence has been a considerable increase in human distress and the 
Annual Rate of Increase of Gross Domestic Product in Developing 
overexploitation of land and natural resources to ensure survival in the short term. 
Countries, 1976-85
38. Many international economic problems remain unresolved: Developing country 
indebtedness remains serious; commodity and energy markets are highly unstable; financial 
flows to developing countries are seriously deficient; protectionism and trade wars are a 
serious threat. Yet at a time when multilateral institutions, and rules, are more than ever 
necessary, they have been devalued. And the notion of an international responsibility for 
development has virtually disappeared. The trend is towards a decline in multilateralism and 
an assertion of national dominance. 
II. New Approaches to Environment and Development 
39. Human progress has always depended on our technical ingenuity and a capacity for 
cooperative action. These qualities have often been used constructively to achieve 
development and environmental progress: in air and water pollution control, for example, and 
in increasing the efficiency of material and energy use. Many countries have increased food 
production and reduced population growth rates. Some technological advances, particularly in 
medicine, have been widely shared. 
40. But this is not enough. Failures to manage the environment and to sustain development 
threaten to overwhelm all countries. Environment and development are not separate 
challenges; they are inexorably linked. Development cannot subsist upon a deteriorating 
environmental resource base; the environment cannot be protected when growth leaves out of 
account the costs of environmental destruction. These problems cannot be treated separately 
by fragmented institutions and policies. They are linked in a complex system of cause and 
effect. 
41. First, environmental stresses are linked one to another. For example, deforestation, by 
increasing run off, accelerates soil erosion and siltation of rivers and lakes. Air pollution and 
acidification play their part in killing forests and lakes. Such links mean that several different 
problems must be tackled simultaneously. And success in one area, such as forest protection, 
can improve chances of success in another area, such as soil conservation. 
42. Second, environmental stresses and patterns of economic development are linked one to 
another. Thus agricultural policies may lie at the root of land, water, and forest degradation. 
Energy policies are associated with the global greenhouse effect, with acidification, and with 
deforestation for fuelwood in many developing nations. These stresses all threaten economic 
development. Thus economics and ecology must be completely integrated in decision making 
and lawmaking processes not just to protect the environment, but also to protect and promote 
development. Economy is not just about the production of wealth, and ecology is not just 
about the protection of nature; they are both equally relevant for improving the lot of 
humankind. 
How long can we go on and safely pretend that the environment is not the 
economy, is not health, is not the prerequisite to development, is not recreation? 
Is it realistic to see ourselves as managers of an entity out there called the 
environment, extraneous to us, an alternative to the economy, too expensive a 
value to protect in difficult economic times? When we organize ourselves starting 
from this premise, we do so with dangerous consequences to our economy, 
health, and industrial growth. 
We are now just beginning to realize that we must find an alternative to our 
ingrained behaviour of burdening future generations resulting from our misplaced
belief that there is a choice between economy and the environment. That choice, 
in the long term, turns out to be an illusion with awesome consequences for 
humanity. 
Charles Caccia 
Member of Parliament, House of Commons 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
43. Third, environmental and economic problems are linked to many social and political 
factors. For example, the rapid population growth that has so profound an impact on the 
environment and on development in many regions is driven partly by such factors as the 
status of women in society and other cultural values. Also, environmental stress and uneven 
development can increase social tensions. It could be argued that the distribution of power 
and influence within society lies at the heart of most environment and development 
challenges. Hence new approaches must involve programmes of social development, 
particularly to improve the position of women in society, to protect vulnerable groups, and to 
promote local participation in decision making. 
44. Finally, the systemic features operate not merely within but also between nations. National 
boundaries have become so porous that traditional distinctions between matters of local, 
national, and international significance have become blurred. Ecosystems do not respect 
national boundaries. Water pollution moves through shared rivers, lakes, and seas. The 
atmosphere carries air pollution over vast distances. Major accidents - particularly those at 
nuclear reactors or at plants or warehouses containing toxic materials - can have widespread 
regional effects. 
45. Many environment economy links also operate globally. For instance, the highly 
subsidized, incentive-driven agriculture of industrialized market economies generates 
surpluses that depress prices and erode the viability of the often neglected agriculture of 
developing countries. Soils and other environmental resources suffer in both systems. Each 
country may devise national agricultural policies to secure short-tern economic and political 
gains, but no nation alone can devise policies to deal effectively with the financial, economic, 
and ecological costs of the agricultural and trade policies of other nations.
To successfully advance in solving global problems, we need to develop new 
methods of thinking, to elaborate new moral and value criteria, and, no doubt, new 
patterns of behaviour. 
Mankind is on the threshold of a new stage in its development. We should not only 
promote the expansion of its material, scientific, and technical basis, but, what is 
most important, the formation of new value and humanistic aspirations in human 
psychology, since wisdom and humaneness are the 'eternal truths' that make the 
basis of humanity. We need new social, moral, scientific, and ecological concepts, 
which should be determined by new conditions for the life of mankind today and in 
the future. 
I.T. Frolov 
Editor-in-Chief, Communist Magazine 
WCED Public Hearing 
Moscow, 6 Dec 1986 
46. In the past, responsibility for environmental matters has been placed in environmental 
ministries and institutions that often have had little or no control over destruction caused by 
agricultural, industrial, urban development, forestry, and transportation policies and 
practices. Society has failed to give the responsibility for preventing environmental damage to 
the 'sectoral' ministries and agencies whose policies cause it. Thus our environmental 
management practices have focused largely upon after-the-fact repair of damage: 
reforestation, reclaiming desert lands, rebuilding urban environments, restoring natural 
habitats, and rehabilitating wild lands. The ability to anticipate and prevent environmental 
damage will require that the ecological dimensions of policy be considered at the same time as 
the economic, trade, energy, agricultural, and other dimensions. 
47. In most countries, environmental policies are directed at the symptoms of harmful growth; 
these policies have brought progress and rewards and must be continued and strengthened. 
But that will not be enough. What is required is a new approach in which all nations aim at a 
type of development that integrates production with resource conservation and enhancement, 
and that links both to the provision for all of an adequate livelihood base and equitable access 
to resources. 
48. The concept of sustainable development provides a framework for the integration of 
environment policies and development strategies - the term 'development' being used here in 
its broadest sense. The word is often taken to refer to the processes of economic and social 
change in the Third World. But the integration of environment and development is required in 
all countries, rich and poor. The pursuit of sustainable development requires changes in the 
domestic and international policies of every nation. 
You talk very little about life, you talk too much about survival. It is very important 
to remember that when the possibilities for life are over, the possibilities for 
survival start. And there are peoples here in Brazil, especially in the Amazon 
region, who still live, and these peoples that still live don't want to reach down to 
the level of survival. 
Speaker from the floor 
WCED Public Hearing
Sao Paulo, 26-29 Oct 1985 
49. Sustainable development seeks to meet the needs and aspirations of the present without 
compromising the ability to meet those of the future. Far from requiring the cessation of 
economic growth, it recognizes that the problems of poverty and underdevelopment cannot be 
solved unless we have a new era of growth in which developing countries play a large role and 
reap large benefits. 
50. Economic growth always brings risk of environmental damage, as it puts increased 
pressure on environmental resources. But policy makers guided by the concept of sustainable 
development will necessarily work to assure that growing economies remain firmly attached to 
their ecological roots and that these roots are protected and nurtured so that they may 
support growth over the long term. Environmental protection is thus inherent in the concept 
of sustainable development, as is a focus on the sources of environmental problems rather 
than the symptoms. 
51. No single blueprint of sustainability will be found, as economic and social systems and 
ecological conditions differ widely among countries. Each nation will have to work out its own 
concrete policy implications. Yet irrespective of these differences, sustainable development 
should be seen as a global objective. 
52. No country can develop in isolation from others. Hence the pursuit of sustainable 
development requires a new orientation in international relations. Long term sustainable 
growth will requite far-reaching changes to produce trade, capital, and technology flows that 
are more equitable and better synchronized to environmental imperatives. 
53. The mechanics of increased international cooperation required to assure sustainable 
development will vary from sector to sector and in relation to particular institutions. But it is 
fundamental that the transition to sustainable development be managed jointly by all nations. 
The unity of human needs requires a functioning multilateral system that respects the 
democratic principle of consent and accepts that not only the Earth but also the world is one. 
54. In the chapters that follow we examine these issues in greater detail and make a number of 
specific proposals for responding to the crises of a threatened future. Overall, our report 
carries a message of hope. But it is hope conditioned upon the establishment of a new era of 
international cooperation based on the premise that every human being - those here and those 
who are to come - has the right to life, and to a decent life. We confidently believe that the 
international community can rise, as it must, to the challenge of securing sustainable human 
progress. 
Footnotes 
1/ World Bank, Poverty and Hunger: Issues and Options for Food Security in 
developing Countries (Washington, DC: 1986). 
2/ Department of International Economic and Social Affairs, Doubling Development 
Finance: Meeting a Global Challenge, Views and Recommendations of the 
Committee on Development Planning (New York: UN, 1986) 
3/ G. Hagman et al., Prevention Better Than Cure, Report on Human and 
Environmental Disasters in the Third World (Stockholm: Swedish Red Cross, 1984).
4/ UN, General Assembly, 'The Critical Economic Situation in Africa: Report of the Secretary 
General', A/S-13/2, New York, 20 May 1986. 
5/ Based on data from W.W. Rostow, The World Economy: History and Prospect 
(Austin: University of Texas Press, 1976); UN, World Energy Supplies in Selected Years 
1929-1950 (New York: 1952); UN, Statistical Yearbook 1982 (New York: 1985); UNCTAD, 
Handbook of International Trade and Development Statistics 1985 Supplement 
(New York: 1985); W.S. and E.S. Woytinsky, World Population and Production: Trends 
and Outlook (New York: Twentieth Century Fund, 1953). 
6/ USSR Committee for the International Hydrological Decade, World Water Balance and 
Water Resources of the Earth (Paris: UNESCO, 1978). 
7/ WMO, A Report of the International Conference on the Assessment of Carbon 
Dioxide and other Greenhouse Gases in Climate Variations and Associated 
Impacts, Villach, Austria, 9-15 October 1985, WMO No. 661 (Geneva: WMO/ICSU/UNEP, 
1986). 
8/ National Science Foundation, 'Scientists Closer to Identifying Cause of Antarctic Ozone 
Layer Depletion news release. Washington, DC, 20 October 1986. 
9/ J. Lehmhaus et al., Calculated and Observed Data for 1900 Compared at EMEP 
Measurement Stations', Norwegian Meteorological Institute, EMEP/MSC-W Report 1-86, 
1986. 
10/ UNEP, 'General Assessment of Progress in the Implementation of the Plan of Action to 
Combat Desertification 1978-1984', Nairobi, 1984; WCED Advisory Panel on Food Security, 
Agriculture, Forestry and Environment', Food Security (London: Zed Books, 1987). 
11/ World Resources Institute/International Institute for Environment and Development, 
World Resources 1986 (New York: Basic Books, 1986). 
12/ UNCTAD, Trade and Development Report 1986 (New York: 1986).
Our Common Future, Chapter 2: Towards Sustainable Development 
The Concept of Sustainable I. Development 
II. Equity and the Common Interest 
III. Strategic Imperatives 
1. Reviving Growth 
2. Changing the quality of Growth 
3. Meeting Essential Human Needs 
4. Ensuring a Sustainable Level of Population 
5. Conserving and Enhancing the Resource Base 
6. Reorienting Technology and Managing Risk 
7. Merging Environment and Economics in Decision Making 
IV. Conclusion 
1. Sustainable development is development that meets the needs of the present without 
compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs. It contains within it 
two key concepts: 
the concept of 'needs', in particular the essential needs of the world's poor, to which 
overriding priority should be given; and 
the idea of limitations imposed by the state of technology and social organization on the 
environment's ability to meet present and future needs. 
2. Thus the goals of economic and social development must be defined in terms of 
sustainability in all countries - developed or developing, market-oriented or centrally planned. 
Interpretations will vary, but must share certain general features and must flow from a 
consensus on the basic concept of sustainable development and on a broad strategic 
framework for achieving it. 
3. Development involves a progressive transformation of economy and society. A development 
path that is sustainable in a physical sense could theoretically be pursued even in a rigid social 
and political setting. But physical sustainability cannot be secured unless development policies 
pay attention to such considerations as changes in access to resources and in the distribution 
of costs and benefits. Even the narrow notion of physical sustainability implies a concern for 
social equity between generations, a concern that must logically be extended to equity within 
each generation. 
I. The Concept of Sustainable Development 
4 The satisfaction of human needs and aspirations in the major objective of development. The 
essential needs of vast numbers of people in developing countries for food, clothing, shelter, 
jobs - are not being met, and beyond their basic needs these people have legitimate aspirations 
for an improved quality of life. A world in which poverty and inequity are endemic will always
be prone to ecological and other crises. Sustainable development requires meeting the basic 
needs of all and extending to all the opportunity to satisfy their aspirations for a better life. 
5. Living standards that go beyond the basic minimum are sustainable only if consumption 
standards everywhere have regard for long-term sustainability. Yet many of us live beyond the 
world's ecological means, for instance in our patterns of energy use. Perceived needs are 
socially and culturally determined, and sustainable development requires the promotion of 
values that encourage consumption standards that are within the bounds of the ecological 
possible and to which all can reasonably aspire. 
6. Meeting essential needs depends in part on achieving full growth potential, and sustainable 
development clearly requires economic growth in places where such needs are not being met. 
Elsewhere, it can be consistent with economic growth, provided the content of growth reflects 
the broad principles of sustainability and non-exploitation of others. But growth by itself is not 
enough. High levels of productive activity and widespread poverty can coexist, and can 
endanger the environment. Hence sustainable development requires that societies meet 
human needs both by increasing productive potential and by ensuring equitable opportunities 
for all. 
7. An expansion in numbers can increase the pressure on resources and slow the rise in living 
standards in areas where deprivation is widespread. Though the issue is not merely one of 
population size but of the distribution of resources, sustainable development can only be 
pursued if demographic developments are in harmony with the changing productive potential 
of the ecosystem. 
8. A society may in many ways compromise its ability to meet the essential needs of its people 
in the future - by overexploiting resources, for example. The direction of technological 
developments may solve some immediate problems but lead to even greater ones. Large 
sections of the population may be marginalized by ill-considered development. 
9. Settled agriculture, the diversion of watercourses, the extraction of minerals, the emission of 
heat and noxious gases into the atmosphere, commercial forests, and genetic manipulation are 
all examples or human intervention in natural systems during the course of development. Until 
recently, such interventions were small in scale and their impact limited. Today's interventions 
are more drastic in scale and impact, and more threatening to life-support systems both locally 
and globally. This need not happen. At a minimum, sustainable development must not 
endanger the natural systems that support life on Earth: the atmosphere, the waters, the soils, 
and the living beings. 
10. Growth has no set limits in terms of population or resource use beyond which lies ecological 
disaster. Different limits hold for the use of energy, materials, water, and land. Many of these 
will manifest themselves in the form of rising costs and diminishing returns, rather than in the 
form of any sudden loss of a resource base. The accumulation of knowledge and the 
development of technology can enhance the carrying capacity of the resource base. But 
ultimate limits there are, and sustainability requires that long before these are reached, the 
world must ensure equitable access to the constrained resource and reorient technological 
efforts to relieve the presume. 
A communications gap has kept environmental, population, and development 
assistance groups apart for too long, preventing us from being aware of our 
common interest and realizing our combined power. Fortunately, the gap is 
closing. We now know that what unites us is vastly more important than what
divides us. 
We recognize that poverty, environmental degradation, and population growth are 
inextricably related and that none of these fundamental problems can be 
successfully addressed in isolation. We will succeed or fail together. 
Arriving at a commonly accepted definition of 'sustainable development' remains a 
challenge for all the actors in the development process. 
'Making Common Cause' 
U.S. Based Development, Environment, Population NGOs 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
11. Economic growth and development obviously involve changes in the physical ecosystem. 
Every ecosystem everywhere cannot be preserved intact. A forest may be depleted in one part 
of a watershed and extended elsewhere, which is not a bad thing if the exploitation has been 
planned and the effects on soil erosion rates, water regimes, and genetic losses have been 
taken into account. In general, renewable resources like forests and fish stocks need not be 
depleted provided the rate of use is within the limits of regeneration and natural growth. But 
most renewable resources are part of a complex and interlinked ecosystem, and maximum 
sustainable yield must be defined after taking into account system-wide effects of exploitation. 
12. As for non-renewable resources, like fossil fuels and minerals, their use reduces the stock 
available for future generations. But this does not mean that such resources should not be 
used. In general the rate of depletion should take into account the criticality of that resource, 
the availability of technologies tor minimizing depletion, and the likelihood of substitutes being 
available. Thus land should not be degraded beyond reasonable recovery. With minerals and 
fossil fuels, the rate of depletion and the emphasis on recycling and economy of use should be 
calibrated to ensure that the resource does not run out before acceptable substitutes are 
available. Sustainable development requires that the rate of depletion of non renewable 
resources should foreclose as few future options as possible. 
13. Development tends to simplify ecosystems and to reduce their diversity of species. And 
species, once extinct, are not renewable. The loss of plant and animal species can greatly limit 
the options of future generations; so sustainable development requires the conservation of 
plant and animal species. 
14. So-called free goods like air and water are also resources. The raw materials and energy of 
production processes are only partly converted to useful products. The rest comes out as 
wastes. Sustainable development requires that the adverse impacts on the quality of air, water, 
and other natural elements are minimized so as to sustain the ecosystem's overall integrity. 
15. In essence, sustainable development is a process of change in which the exploitation of 
resources, the direction of investments, the orientation of technological development; and 
institutional change are all in harmony and enhance both current and future potential to meet 
human needs and aspirations. 
II. Equity and the Common Interest 
16. Sustainable development has been described here in general terms. How are individuals in 
the real world to be persuaded or made to act in the common interest? The answer lies partly
in education, institutional development, and law enforcement. But many problems of resource 
depletion and environmental stress arise from disparities in economic and political power. An 
industry may get away with unacceptable levels or air and water pollution because the people 
who bear the brunt of it are poor and unable to complain effectively. A forest may be destroyed 
by excessive felling because the people living there have no alternatives or because timber 
contractors generally have more influence then forest dwellers. 
17. Ecological interactions do not respect the boundaries of individual ownership and political 
jurisdiction. Thus: 
In a watershed, the ways in which a farmer up the slope uses land directly affect run-off 
on farms downstream. 
the irrigation practices, pesticides, and fertilizers used on one farm affect the 
productivity of neighbouring ones, especially among small farms. 
The efficiency of a factory boiler determines its rate of emission of soot and noxious 
chemicals and affects all who live and work around it. 
The hot water discharged by a thermal power plant into a river or a local sea affects the 
catch of all who fish locally. 
18. Traditional social systems recognized some aspects of this interdependence and enforced 
community control over agricultural practices and traditional rights relating to water, forests, 
and land. This enforcement of the 'common interest' did not necessarily impede growth and 
expansion though it may have limited the acceptance and diffusion of technical innovations. 
19. Local interdependence has, if anything, increased because of the technology used in 
modern agriculture and manufacturing. Yet with this surge of technical progress, the growing 
'enclosure' of common lands, the erosion of common rights in forests and other resources, and 
the spread of commerce and production for the market, the responsibilities for decision 
making are being taken away from both groups and individuals. This shift is still under way in 
many developing countries. 
If the desert is growing, forest disappearing, malnutrition increasing, and people in 
urban areas living in very bad conditions, it is not because we are lacking 
resources but the kind of policy implemented by our rulers, by the elite group. 
Denying people rights and peoples' interests is pushing us to a situation where it is 
only the poverty that has a very prosperous future in Africa. And it is our hope that 
your Commission, the World Commission, will not overlook these problems of 
human rights in Africa and will put emphasis on it. Because it is only free people, 
people who have rights, who are mature and responsible citizens, who then 
participate in the development and in the protection of the environment. 
Speaker from the floor 
WCED Public Hearing 
Nairobi, 23 Sept 1986 
20. It is not that there is one set of villains and another of victims. All would be better off if each 
person took into account the effect ooe" his or her acts upon others. But each is unwilling to 
assume that others will behave in this socially desirable fashion, and hence all continue to 
pursue narrow self-interest. Communities or governments can compensate for this isolation
through laws, education, taxes, subsidies, and other methods. Well-enforced laws and strict 
liability legislation can control harmful side effects. Most important, effective participation in 
decision-making processes by local communities can help them articulate and effectively 
enforce their common interest. 
21. Interdependence is not simply a local phenomenon. Rapid growth in production has 
extended it to the international plane, with both physical and economic manifestations. There 
are growing global and regional pollution effects, such as in the more than 200 international 
river basins and the large number of shared seas. 
22. The enforcement of common interest often suffers because areas of political jurisdiction 
and areas of impact do not coincide. Energy policies in one jurisdiction cause acid precipitation 
in another. The fishing policies of one state affect the fish catch of another. No supranational 
authority exists to resolve such issues, and the common interest can only be articulated 
through international cooperation. 
23. In the same way, the ability of a government to control its national economy is reduced by 
growing international economic interactions. For example, foreign trade in commodities makes 
issues of carrying capacities and resource scarcities an international concern. (See Chapter 3.) 
If economic power and the benefits of trade were more equally distributed, common interests 
would be generally recognized. But the gains from trade are unequally distributed, and 
patterns of trade in, say, sugar affect not merely a local sugar-producing sector, but the 
economies and ecologies of the many developing countries that depend heavily on this 
product. 
24. The search for common interest would be less difficult if all development and environment 
problems had solutions that would leave everyone better off. This is seldom the case, and there 
are usually winners and losers. Many problems arise from inequalities in access to resources. 
An inequitable landowner ship structure can lead to overexploitation of resources in the 
smallest holdings, with harmful effects on both environment and development. Internationally, 
monopolistic control over resources can drive those who do not share in them to excessive 
exploitation of marginal resources. The differing capacities of exploiters to commandeer 'free' 
goods - locally, nationally, and internationally - is another manifestation of unequal access to 
resources. 'Losers' in environment/development conflicts include those who suffer more than 
their fair share of the health, property, and ecosystem damage costs of pollution. 
25. As a system approaches ecological limits, inequalities sharpen. Thus when a watershed 
deteriorates, poor farmers suffer more because they cannot afford the same anti-erosion 
measures as richer farmers. When urban air quality deteriorates, the poor, in their more 
vulnerable areas, suffer more health damage than the rich, who usually live in more pristine 
neighbourhoods. When mineral resources become depleted, late-comers to the 
industrialization process lose the benefits of low-cost supplies. Globally, wealthier nations are 
better placed financially and technologically to cope with the effects of possible climatic change. 
26. Hence, our inability to promote the common interest in sustainable development is often a 
product of the relative neglect of economic and social justice within and amongst nations. 
III. Strategic Imperatives 
27. The world must quickly design strategies that will allow nations to move from their present, 
often destructive, processes of growth and development onto sustainable development paths. 
This will require policy changes in all countries, with respect both to their own development 
and to their impacts on other nations' development possibilities. (This chapter concerns itself 
with national strategies. The required reorientation in international economic relations is dealt
with in Chapter 3.) 
28. Critical objectives for environment and development policies that follow from the concept 
of sustainable development include: 
reviving growth; 
changing the quality of growth; 
meeting essential needs for jobs, food, energy, water, and sanitation; 
ensuring a sustainable level of population; 
conserving and enhancing the resource base: 
reorienting technology and managing risk; and 
merging environment and economics in decision making. 
1. Reviving Growth 
29. As indicated earlier, development that is sustainable has to address the problem of the 
large number of people who live in absolute poverty - that is, who are unable to satisfy even the 
most basic of their needs. Poverty reduces people's capacity to use resources in a sustainable 
manner; it intensifies pressure on the environment. Most such absolute poverty is in 
developing countries; in many, it has been aggravated by the economic stagnation of the 1980s. 
A necessary but not a sufficient condition for the elimination of absolute poverty is a relatively 
rapid rise in per capita incomes in the Third World. It is therefore essential that the stagnant or 
declining growth trends of this decade be reversed. 
30. While attainable growth rates will vary, a certain minimum is needed to have any impact on 
absolute poverty. It seems unlikely that, taking developing countries as a whole, these 
objectives can be accomplished with per capita income growth of under 3 per cent. (See Box 
2-1.) Given current population growth rates, this would require overall national income growth 
of around 5 per cent a year in the developing economies of Asia, 5.5 per cent in Latin America, 
and 6 per cent in Africa and West Asia. 
31. Are these orders of magnitude attainable? The record in South and East Asia over the past 
quarter-century and especially over the last five years suggests that 5 per cent annual growth 
can be attained in most countries, including the two largest, India and China. In Latin America, 
average growth rates on the order of 5 per cent were achieved during the 1960s and 1970s, but 
fell well below that in the first half of this decade, mainly because of the debt crisis./1 A revival 
of Latin American growth depends on the resolution of this crisis. In Africa, growth rates 
during the 1960s and 1970s were around 4-4.5 per cent, which at current rates of population 
growth would mean per capita income growth of only a little over 1 per cent./2 Moreover, 
during the 1980s, growth nearly halted and in two-thirds of the countries per capita income 
declined./3 Attaining a minimum level of growth in Africa requires the correction of short-term 
imbalances, and also the removal of deep-rooted constraints on the growth process. 
32. Growth must be revived in developing countries because that is where the links between 
economic growth, the alleviation of poverty, and environmental conditions operate most 
directly. Yet developing countries are part of an interdependent world economy; their 
prospects also depend on the levels and patterns of growth in industrialized nations. The
medium-term prospects for industrial countries are for growth of 3-4 per cent, the minimum 
that international financial institutions consider necessary if these countries are going to play a 
part in expanding the world economy. Such growth rates could be environmentally sustainable 
if industrialized nations can continue the recent shifts in the content of their growth towards 
less material- and energy-intensive activities and the improvement of their efficiency in using 
materials and energy. 
Box 2-1 Growth, Redistribution, and Poverty 
The poverty line is that level of income below which an individual or household 
cannot afford on a regular basis the necessities of life. The percentage of the 
population below that line will depend on per capita national income and the 
manner in which it is distributed. How quickly can a developing country expect 
to eliminate absolute poverty? The answer will vary from country to country, 
but much can be learned from a typical case. 
1. 
Consider a nation in which half the population lives below the poverty line and 
where the distribution of household incomes is as follows: the top one-fifth of 
households have 50 per cent of total income, the next fifth have 20 per cent, 
the next fifth have 14 per cent, the next fifth have 9 per cent, and the bottom 
fifth have just 7 per cent. This is a fair representation of the situation in many 
low-income developing countries. 
2. 
In this case, if the income distribution remains unchanged, per capita national 
income would have to double before the poverty ratio drops from 50 to 10 per 
cent. If income is redistributed in favour of the poor, this reduction can occur 
sooner. Consider the case in which 25 per cent of the incremental income of the 
richest one-fifth of the population is redistributed equally to the others. The 
assumptions here about redistribution reflect three judgements. First, in most 
situations redistributive policies can only operate on increases in income. 
Second, in low-income developing countries the surplus that can be skimmed 
off for redistribution is available only from the wealthier groups. Third, 
redistributive policies cannot be so precisely targeted that they deliver benefits 
only to those who are below the poverty line, so some of the benefits will accrue 
to those who are just a little above it. 
3. 
The number of years required to bring the poverty ratio down from 50 to 10 per 
cent ranges from: 
18-24 years if per capita income grows at 3 per cent, 
26-36 years if it grown at 2 per cent, and 
51-70 years if it grows only at 1 per cent. 
In each case, the shorter time is associated with the redistribution of 25 per 
cent of the incremental income of the richest fifth of the population and the 
longer period with no redistribution. 
4. 
So with per capita national income growing only at 1 per cent a year, the time 
required to eliminate absolute poverty would stretch well into the next century. 
If, however, the aim is to ensure that the world is well on its way towards 
5.
sustainable development by the beginning of the next century, it is necessary to 
aim at a minimum of 3 per cent per capita national income growth and to 
pursue vigorous redistributive policies. 
33. As industrialized nations use less materials and energy, however, they will provide smaller 
markets for commodities and minerals from the developing nations. Yet if developing nations 
focus their efforts upon eliminating poverty and satisfying essential human needs, then 
domestic demand will increase for both agricultural products and manufactured goods and 
some services. Hence the very logic of sustainable development implies an internal stimulus to 
Third World growth. 
34. Nonetheless, in large numbers of developing countries markets are very small; and for all 
developing countries high export growth, especially of non-traditional items, will also be 
necessary to finance imports, demand for which will be generated by rapid development. Thus 
a reorientation of international economic relations will be necessary for sustainable 
development, as discussed in Chapter 3. 
2. Changing the quality of Growth 
35. Sustainable development involves more than growth. It requires a change in the content of 
growth, to make it less Material- and energy-intensive and more equitable in its impact. These 
changes are required in all countries as part of a package of measures to maintain the stock of 
ecological capital, to improve the distribution of income, and to reduce the degree of 
vulnerability to economic crises. 
36. The process of economic development must be more soundly based upon the realities of 
the stock of capital that sustains it. This is rarely done in either developed or developing 
countries. For example, income from forestry operations is conventionally measured in terms 
of the value of timber and other products extracted, minus the costs of extraction. The costs of 
regenerating the forest are not taken into account, unless money is actually spent on such 
work. Thus figuring profits from logging rarely takes full account of the losses in future revenue 
incurred through degradation of the forest. Similar incomplete accounting occurs in the 
exploitation of other natural resources, especially in the case of resources that are not 
capitalized in enterprise or national accounts: air, water, and soil. In all countries, rich or poor, 
economic development must take full account in its measurements of growth of the 
improvement or deterioration in the stock of natural resources. 
37. Income distribution is one aspect of the quality of growth, as described in the preceding 
section, and rapid growth combined with deteriorating income distribution may be worse than 
slower growth combined with redistribution in favour of the poor. For instance, in many 
developing countries the introduction of large-scale commercial agriculture may produce 
revenue rapidly, but may also dispossess a large number of small farmers and make income 
distribution more inequitable. In the long run, such a path may not be sustainable; it 
impoverishes many people and can increase pressures on the natural resource base through 
overcommercialized agriculture and through the marginalization of subsistence farmers. 
Relying more on smallholder cultivation may be slower at first, but more easily sustained over 
the long term. 
People have acquired, often for the first time in history, both an idea of their
relative poverty and a desire to emerge from it and improve the quality of their 
lives. As people advance materially, and eat and live better, what, were once 
luxuries tend to be regarded as necessities. The net result is that the demand for 
food, raw materials, and power increases to an even greater degree than the 
population. As demand increases, a greater and greater strain is put on the finite 
area of the world's land to produce the products needed. 
Dr. I. P. Garbouchev 
Bulgarian Academy of Sciences 
WCED Public Hearing 
Moscow, 11 Dec 1986 
38. Economic development is unsustainable if it increases vulnerability to crises. A drought 
may force farmers to slaughter animals needed for sustaining production in future years. A 
drop in prices may cause farmers or other producers to overexploit natural resources to 
maintain incomes. But vulnerability can be reduced by using technologies that lower 
production risks, by choosing institutional options that reduce market fluctuations, and by 
building up reserves, especially of food and foreign exchange. A development path that 
combines growth with reduced vulnerability is more sustainable than one that does not. 
39. Yet it is not enough to broaden the range of economic variables taken into account. 
Sustainability requires views of human needs and well-being that incorporate such 
non-economic variables as education and health enjoyed for their own sake, clean air and 
water, and the protection of natural beauty. It must also work to remove disabilities from 
disadvantaged groups, many of whom live in ecologically vulnerable areas, such as many tribal 
groups in forests, desert nomads, groups in remote hill areas, and indigenous peoples of the 
Americas and Australasia. 
40. Changing the quality of growth requires changing our approach to development efforts to 
take account of all of their effects. For instance, a hydropower project should not be seen 
merely as a way of producing more electricity; its effects upon the local environment and the 
livelihood of the local community must be included in any balance sheets. Thus the 
abandonment of a hydro project because it will disturb a rare ecological system could be a 
measure of progress, not a setback to development./4 Nevertheless, in some cases, 
sustainability considerations will involve a rejection of activities that are financially attractive in 
the short run. 
41. Economic and social development can and should be mutually reinforcing. Money spent on 
education and health can raise human productivity. Economic developments can accelerate 
social development by providing opportunities for underprivileged groups or by spreading 
education more rapidly. 
3. Meeting Essential Human Needs 
42. The satisfaction of human needs and aspirations is so obviously an objective of productive 
activity that it may appear redundant to assert its central role in the concept of sustainable 
development. All too often poverty is such that people cannot satisfy their needs for survival 
and well-being even if goods and services are available. At the same time, the demands of those 
not in poverty may have major environmental consequences. 
43. The principal development challenge is to meet the needs and aspirations of an expanding 
developing world population. The most basic of all needs is for a livelihood: that is,
employment. Between 1985 and 2000 the labour force in developing countries will increase by 
nearly 800 million, and new livelihood opportunities will have to be generated for 60 million 
persons every year./5 The pace and pattern of economic development have to generate 
sustainable work opportunities on this scale and at a level of productivity that would enable 
poor households to meet minimum consumption standards. 
44. More food is required not merely to feed more people but to attack undernourishment. For 
the developing world to eat, person for person, as well as the industrial world by the year 
2000, annual increases of 5.0 per cent in calories and 5.8 per cent in proteins are needed in 
Africa; of 3.4 and 4.0 per cent, respectively, in Latin America; and of 3.5 and 4.5 per cent in 
Asia./6 Foodgrains and starchy roots are the primary sources of calories, while proteins are 
obtained primarily from products like milk, meat, fish, pulses, and oil-seeds. 
45. Though the focus at present is necessarily on staple foods, the projections given above also 
highlight the need for a high rate of growth of protein availability. In Africa, the task is 
particularly challenging given the recent declining per capita food production and the current 
constraints on growth. In Asia and Latin America, the required growth rates in calorie and 
protein consumption seem to be more readily attainable. But increased food production should 
not be based on ecologically unsound production policies and compromise long-term prospects 
for food security. 
46. Energy is another essential human need, one that cannot be universally met unless energy 
consumption patterns change. The most urgent problem is the requirements of poor Third 
World households, which depend mainly on fuelwood. By the turn of the century, 3 billion 
people may live in areas where wood is cut faster than it grows or where fuelwood is extremely 
scarce./7 Corrective action would both reduce the drudgery of collecting wood over long 
distances and preserve the ecological base. The minimum requirements for cooking fuel in 
most developing countries appear to be on the order of 250 kilogrammes of coal equivalent per 
capita per year. This is a fraction of the household energy consumption in industrial countries. 
In the developing world, mostly in the Third World, we realize that the main problem 
we have is that we do not have employment opportunities, and most of these 
people who are unemployed move from rural areas and they migrate into the cities 
and those who remain behind always indulge in processes - for example charcoal 
burning - and all this leads to deforestation. So maybe the environmental 
organizations should step in and look for ways to prevent this kind of destruction. 
Kennedy Njiro 
Student, Kenya Polytechnic 
WCED Public Hearing 
Nairobi, 23 Sept 1986 
47. The linked basic needs of housing, water supply, sanitation, and health care are also 
environmentally important. Deficiencies in these areas are often visible manifestations of 
environmental stress. In the Third World, the failure to meet these key needs is one of the 
major causes of many communicable diseases such as malaria, gastro-intestinal infestations, 
cholera, and typhoid. Population growth and the drift into cities threaten to make these 
problems worse. Planners must find ways of relying more on supporting community initiatives 
and self-help efforts and on effectively using low-cost technologies. See Chapter 9. 
4. Ensuring a Sustainable Level of Population
48. The sustainability of development is intimately linked to the dynamics of population 
growth. The issue, however, is not simply one of global population size. A child born in a 
country where levels of material and energy use are high places a greater burden on the Earth's 
resources than a child born in a poorer country. A similar argument applies within countries. 
Nonetheless, sustainable development can be pursued more easily when population size is 
stabilized at a level consistent with the productive capacity of the ecosystem. 
49. In industrial countries, the overall rate of population growth is under 1 per cent, and 
several countries have reached or are approaching zero population growth. The total 
population of the industrialized world could increase from its current 1.2 billion to about 1.4 
billion in the year 2025./8 
50. The greater part of global population increase will take place in developing countries, 
where the 1985 population of 3.7 billion may increase to 6.8 billion by 2025./9 The Third World 
does not have the option of migration to 'new' lands, and the time available for adjustment is 
much less than industrial countries had. Hence the challenge now is to quickly lower 
population growth rates, especially in regions such as Africa, where these rates are increasing. 
51. Birth rates declined in industrial countries largely because of economic and social 
development. Rising levels of income and urbanization and the changing role of women all 
played important roles. Similar processes are now at work in developing countries. These 
should be recognized and encouraged. Population policies should be integrated with other 
economic and social development programmes female education, health care, and the 
expansion of the livelihood base of the poor. But time is short, and developing countries will 
also have to promote direct measures to reduce fertility, to avoid going radically beyond the 
productive potential to support their populations. In fact, increased access to family planning 
services is itself a form of social development that allows couples, and women in particular, the 
right to self-determination. 
52. Population growth in developing countries will remain unevenly distributed between rural 
and urban areas. UK projections suggest that by the first decade of the next century, the 
absolute size of rural populations in most developing countries will start declining. Nearly 90 
per cent of the increase in the developing world will take place in urban areas, the population of 
which in expected to rise from 1.15 billion in 1985 to 3.25 million in 2025./10 The increase will be 
particularly marked in Africa and, to a lesser extent, in Asia. 
53. Developing-country cities are growing much faster than the capacity of authorities to cope. 
Shortages of housing, water, sanitation, and mass transit are widespread. A growing 
proportion of city-dwellers live in slums and shanty towns, many of them exposed to air and 
water pollution and to industrial and natural hazards. Further deterioration is likely, given that 
most urban growth will take place in the largest cities. Thus more manageable cities may be the 
principal gain from slower rates of population growth. 
54. Urbanization is itself part of the development process. The challenge is to manage the 
process so as to avoid a severe deterioration in the quality of life. Thus the development of 
smaller urban centres needs to be encouraged to reduce pressures in large cities. Solving the 
impending urban crisis will require the promotion of self-help housing and urban services by 
and for the poor, and a more positive approach to the role of the informal sector, supported by 
sufficient funds for water supply, sanitation, and other services. See Chapter 9. 
5. Conserving and Enhancing the Resource Base
55. If needs are to be met on a sustainable basis the Earth's natural resource base must be 
conserved and enhanced. Major changes in policies will be needed to cope with the industrial 
world's current high levels of consumption, the increases in consumption needed to meet 
minimum standards in developing countries, and expected population growth. However, the 
case for the conservation of nature should not rest only with development goals. It is part of 
our moral obligation to other living beings and future generations. 
56. Pressure on resources increases when people lack alternatives. Development policies must 
widen people's options for earning a sustainable livelihood, particularly for resource-poor 
households and in areas under ecological stress. In a hilly area, for instance, economic 
self-interest and ecology can be combined by helping farmers shift from grain to tree crops by 
providing them with advice, equipment, and marketing assistance. Programmes to protect the 
incomes of farmers, fishermen, and foresters against short-term price declines may decrease 
their need to overexploit resources. 
57. The conservation of agricultural resources is an urgent task because in many parts of the 
world cultivation has already been extended to marginal lands, and fishery and forestry 
resources have been overexploited. These resources must be conserved and enhanced to meet 
the needs of growing populations. Land use in agriculture and forestry must be based on a 
scientific assessment of land capacity, and the annual depletion of topsoil, fish stock, or forest 
resources must not exceed the rate of regeneration. 
58. The pressures on agricultural land from crop and livestock production can be partly 
relieved by increasing productivity. But short-sighted, short-term improvements in 
productivity can create different forms of ecological stress, such as the loss of genetic diversity 
in standing crops, salinization and alkalization of irrigated lands, nitrate pollution of ground-water, 
and pesticide residues in food. Ecologically more benign alternatives are available. 
Future increases in productivity, in both developed and developing countries, should be based 
on the better controlled application of water and agrochemicals, as well as on more extensive 
use of organic manures and non-chemical means of pest control. These alternatives can be 
promoted only by an agricultural policy based on ecological realities. (See Chapter 5.) 
59. In the case of fisheries and tropical forestry, we rely largely on the exploitation of the 
naturally available stocks. The sustainable yield from these stocks may well fall short of 
demand. Hence it will be necessary to turn to methods that produce more fish, fuelwood, and 
forest products under controlled conditions. Substitutes for fuelwood can be promoted. 
60. The ultimate limits to global development are perhaps determined by the availability of 
energy resources and by the biosphere's capacity to absorb the by-products of energy use./11/ 
These energy limits may be approached far sooner than the limits imposed by other material 
resources. First, there are the supply problems: the depletion of oil reserves, the high cost and 
environmental impact of coal mining, and the hazards of nuclear technology. Second, there are 
emission problems, most notably acid pollution and carbon dioxide build up leading to global 
warming. 
I work with rubber trees in the Amazon. I am here to speak about the tropical 
forest. 
We live from this forest they want to destroy. And we want to take this opportunity 
of having so many people here gathered with the same objective in mind to defend 
our habitat, the conservation of forest, of tropical forest.
In my area, we have about 14-16 native products that we extract from the forest, 
besides all the other activities we have. So I think this must be preserved. Because 
it is not only with cattle, not only with pasture lands, and not only with highways that 
we will be able to develop the Amazon. 
When they think of falling trees, they always think of building roads and the roads 
bring destruction under a mask called progress. Let us put this progress where the 
lands have already been deforested, where it is idle of labour and where we have 
to find people work, and where we have to make the city grow. But let us leave 
those who want to live in the forest, who want to keep it as it is. 
We have nothing written. I don't have anything that was created in somebody's 
office. There is no philosophy. It is just the real truth, because this is what our life 
is. 
Jaime Da Silva Araujo 
Rubber Tapper Council 
WCED Public Hearing 
Sao Paulo, 28-29 Oct 1985 
61. Some of these problems can be met by increased use of renewable energy sources. But the 
exploitation of renewable sources such as fuelwood and hydropower also entails ecological 
problems. Hence sustainability requires a clear focus on conserving and efficiently using 
energy. 
62. Industrialized countries must recognize that their energy consumption is polluting the 
biosphere and eating into scarce fossil fuel supplies. Recent improvements in energy efficiency 
and a shift towards less energy-intensive sectors have helped limit consumption. But the 
process must be accelerated to reduce per capita consumption and encourage a shift to non 
polluting sources and technologies. The simple duplication in the developing world of 
industrial countries' energy use patterns is neither feasible nor desirable. Changing these 
patterns for the better will call for new policies in urban development, industry location, 
housing design, transportation systems, and the choice of agricultural and industrial 
technologies. 
63. Non-fuel mineral resources appear to pose fewer supply problems. Studies done before 
1960 that assumed an exponentially growing demand did not envisage a problem until well into 
the next century./12 since then, world consumption of most metals has remained nearly 
constant, which suggests that the exhaustion of non-fuel minerals is even more distant. The 
history of technological developments also suggests that industry can adjust to scarcity 
through greater efficiency in use, recycling, and substitution. More immediate needs include 
modifying the pattern of world trade in minerals to allow exporters a higher share in the value 
added from mineral use, and improving the access of developing countries to mineral supplies, 
as their demands increase. 
Indigenous peoples are the base of what I guess could be called the environmental 
security system. We are the gate-keepers of success or failure to husband our 
resources. For many of us, however, the last few centuries have meant a major 
loss of control over our lands and waters. We are still the first to know about 
changes in the environment, but we are now the last to be asked or consulted.
We are the first to detect when the forests are being threatened, as they are under 
the slash and grab economics of this country. And we are the last to be asked 
about the future of our forests. We are the first to feel the pollution of our waters, 
as the Ojibway peoples of my own homelands in northern Ontario will attest. And, 
of course, we are the last to be consulted about how, when, and where 
developments should take place in order to assure continuing harmony for the 
seventh generation. 
The most we have learned to expect is to be compensated, always too late and 
too little. We are seldom asked to help avoid the need for compensation by lending 
our expertise and our consent to development. 
Louis Bruyere 
President, Native Council of Canada 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
64. The prevention and reduction of air and water pollution will remain a critical task of 
resource conservation. Air and water quality come under pressure from such activities as 
fertilizer and pesticide use, urban sewage, fossil fuel burning, the use of certain chemicals, and 
various other industrial activities. Each of these is expected to increase the pollution load on 
the biosphere substantially, particularly in developing countries. Cleaning up after the event is 
an expensive solution. Hence all countries need to anticipate and prevent these pollution 
problems, by, for instance, enforcing emission standards that reflect likely long-term effects, 
promoting low-waste technologies, and anticipating the impact of new products, technologies, 
and wastes. 
6. Reorienting Technology and Managing Risk 
65. The fulfilment of all these tasks will require the reorientation of technology the key link 
between humans and nature. First, the capacity for technological innovation needs to be 
greatly enhanced in developing countries so that they can respond more effectively to the 
challenges of sustainable development. Second, the orientation of technology development 
must be changed to pay greater attention to environmental factors. 
66. The technologies of industrial countries are not always suited or easily adaptable to the 
socio-economic and environmental conditions of developing countries. To compound the 
problem, the bulk of world research and development addresses few of the pressing issues 
facing these countries, such as arid-land agriculture or the control of tropical diseases. Not 
enough is being done to adapt recent innovations in materials technology, energy conservation, 
information technology, and biotechnology to the needs of developing countries. These gaps 
must be covered by enhancing research, design, development, and extension capabilities in the 
Third World. 
67. In all countries, the processes of generating alternative technologies, upgrading traditional 
ones, and selecting and adapting imported technologies should be informed by environmental 
resource concerns. Most technological research by commercial organizations is devoted to 
product and process innovations that have market value. Technologies are needed that 
produce 'social goods', such as improved air quality or increased product life, or that resolve 
problems normally outside the cost calculus of individual enterprises, such as the external 
costs of pollution or waste disposal.
68. The role of public policy is to ensure, through incentives and disincentives, that commercial 
organizations find it worthwhile to take fuller account of environmental factors in the 
technologies they develop. (See Chapter 6.) Publicly funded research institutions also need 
such direction, and the objectives of sustainable development and environmental protection 
must be built into the mandates of the institutions that work in environmentally sensitive 
areas. 
69. The development of environmentally appropriate technologies is closely related to 
questions of risk management. Such systems as nuclear reactors, electric and other utility 
distribution networks, communication systems, and mass transportation are vulnerable if 
stressed beyond a certain point. The fact that they are connected through networks tends to 
make them immune to small disturbances but more vulnerable to unexpected disruptions that 
exceed a finite threshold. Applying sophisticated analyses of vulnerabilities and past failures to 
technology design, manufacturing standards, and contingency plans in operations can make 
the consequences of a failure or accident much less catastrophic. 
70. The best vulnerability and risk analysis has not been applied consistently across 
technologies or systems. A major purpose of large system design should be to make the 
consequences of failure or sabotage less serious. There is thus a need for new techniques and 
technologies - as well as legal and institutional mechanisms - for safety design and control, 
accident prevention, contingency planning, damage mitigation, and provision of relief. 
71. Environmental risks arising from technological and developmental decisions impinge on 
individuals and areas that have little or no influence on those decisions. Their interests must 
be taken into account. National and international institutional mechanisms are needed to 
assess potential impacts of new technologies before they are widely used, in order to ensure 
that their production, use, and disposal do not overstress environmental resources. Similar 
arrangements are required for major interventions in natural systems, such as river diversion 
or forest clearance. In addition, liability for damages from unintended consequences must be 
strengthened and enforced. 
7. Merging Environment and Economics in Decision Making 
72. The common theme throughout this strategy for sustainable development is the need to 
integrate economic and ecological considerations in decision making. They are, after all, 
integrated in the workings of the real world. This will require a change in attitudes and 
objectives and in institutional arrangements at every level. 
73. Economic and ecological concerns are not necessarily in opposition. For example, policies 
that conserve the quality of agricultural land and protect forests improve the long-term 
prospects for agricultural development. An increase in the efficiency of energy and material use 
serves ecological purposes but can also reduce costs. But the compatibility of environmental 
and economic objectives is often lost in the pursuit of individual or group gains, with little 
regard for the impacts on others, with a blind faith in science's ability to find solutions, and in 
ignorance of the distant consequences of today's decisions. Institutional rigidities add to this 
myopia. 
74. One important rigidity is the tendency to deal with one industry or sector in isolation, 
failing to recognize the importance of intersectoral linkages. Modern agriculture uses 
substantial amounts of commercially produced energy and large quantities of industrial 
products. At the same time, the more traditional connection - in which agriculture is a source
of raw materials for industry - is being diluted by the widening use of synthetics. The energy-industry 
connection is also changing, with a strong tendency towards a decline in the energy 
intensity of industrial production in industrial countries. In the Third World, however, the 
gradual shift of the industrial base towards the basic material producing sectors is leading to an 
increase in the energy intensity of industrial production. 
75. These inter sectoral connections create patterns of economic and ecological 
interdependence rarely reflected in the ways in which policy is made. Sectoral organizations 
tend to pursue sectoral objectives and to treat their impacts on other sectors as side effects, 
taken into account only if compelled to do so. Hence impacts on forests rarely worry those 
involved in guiding public policy or business activities in the fields of energy, industrial 
development, crop husbandry, or foreign trade. Many of the environment and development 
problems that confront us have their roots in this sectoral fragmentation of responsibility. 
Sustainable development requires that such fragmentation be overcome. 
The issues that have been brought forward here, I think, are wide-ranging and 
maybe you know, maybe you don't know, the answers to all those issues. But at 
least by hearing all those questions, stories, all these expressions that have been 
put forward, at least you could have some idea. 
You don't know the answers nor the solutions, but you could suggest the way to 
solve many problems and this is by suggesting either to governments, or the UN, 
or international agencies, to solve any problem the best way: that is to include 
those with direct interests in it. The beneficiaries, as well as the victims of any 
development issue should be included, should be heard. 
I think that is the one thing, maybe that all of us are hearing here, or expecting: that 
in every development planning or development issue as much as possible to listen 
and to include, to consult the people concerned. If that is taken care of, at least 
one step of the problem is resolved. 
Ismid Hadad 
Chief Editor, Prisma 
WCED Public Hearing 
Jakarta, 26 March 1985 
76. Sustainability requires the enforcement of wider responsibilities for the impacts of 
decisions. This requires changes in the legal and institutional frameworks that will enforce the 
common interest. Some necessary changes in the legal framework start from the proposition 
that an environment adequate for health and well-being is essential for all human beings 
including future generations. Such a view places the right to use public and private resources in 
its proper social context and provides a goal for more specific measures. 
77. The law alone cannot enforce the common interest. It principally needs community 
knowledge and support, which entails greater public participation in the decisions that affect 
the environment. This is best secured by decentralizing the management of resources upon 
which local communities defend, and giving these communities an effective say over the use f 
these resources. It will also require promoting citizens' initiatives, empowering people's 
organizations, and strengthening local democracy./13 
78. Some large-scale projects, however, require participation on a different basis. Public 
inquiries and hearings on the development and environment impacts can help greatly in
drawing attention to different points of view. Free access to relevant information and the 
availability of alternative sources of technical expertise can provide an informed basis for public 
discussion. When the environmental impact of a proposed project is particularly high, public 
scrutiny of the case should be mandatory and, wherever feasible, the decision should be 
subject to prior public approval, perhaps by referendum. 
It has not been too difficult to push the environment lobby of the North and the 
development lobby of the South together. And there is now in fact a blurring of the 
distinction between the two, so they are coming to have a common consensus 
around the theme of sustainable development. 
The building blocks are there. Environmental concern is common to both sides. 
Humanitarian concern is common to both sides. The difference lies in the methods 
of each and the degree to which each side tries to achieve its own economic 
interest through the development assistance process. 
The time is right for bridging this gap for some very pragmatic political reasons. 
First of all, the people of the North do not want to see their taxes wasted. 
Secondly, they do not want to see growing poverty, and they obviously care for the 
environment, be it the environment of the North, where they live, or of the South. 
And the majority of people in the South do not want short-term overpass solutions. 
In effect, there is a political community of interest, North and South, in the concept 
of sustainable development that you can build upon. 
Richard Sandbrook 
International institute for Environment and Development 
WCED Public Hearing 
Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 
79. Changes are also required in the attitudes and procedures of both public and private-sector 
enterprises. Moreover, environmental regulation must move beyond the usual menu of safety 
regulations, zoning laws, and pollution control enactments; environmental objectives must be 
built into taxation, prior approval procedures for investment and technology choice, foreign 
trade incentives, and all components of development policy. 
80. The integration of economic and ecological factors into the law and into decision making 
systems within countries has to be matched at the international level. The growth in fuel and 
material use dictates that direct physical linkages between ecosystems of different countries 
will increase. Economic interactions through trade, finance, investment, and travel will also 
grow and heighten economic and ecological interdependence. Hence in the future, even more 
so than now, sustainable development requires the unification of economics and ecology in 
international relations, as discussed in the next chapter. 
IV. Conclusion 
81. In its broadest sense, the strategy for sustainable development aims to promote harmony 
among human brings and between humanity and nature. In the specific context of the 
development and environment crises of the 1980s, which current national and international 
political and economic institutions have not and perhaps cannot overcome, the pursuit of 
sustainable development requires:
a political system that secures effective citizen participation in decision making. 
an economic system that is able to generate surpluses and technical knowledge on a 
self-reliant and sustained basis 
a social system that provides for solutions for the tensions arising from disharmonious 
development. 
a production system that respects the obligation to preserve the ecological base for 
development, 
a technological system that can search continuously for new solutions, 
an international system that fosters sustainable patterns of trade and finance, and 
an administrative system that is flexible and has the capacity for self-correction. 
82. These requirements are more in the nature of goals that should underlie national and 
international action on development. What matters is the sincerity with which these goals are 
pursued and the effectiveness with which departures from them are corrected 
Footnotes 
1/ UNCTAD, Handbook of International Trade and Development Statistics 1985 
Supplement (New York: 1985). 
2/ Ibid. 
3/ Department of International Economic and Social Affairs (DIESA), Doubling 
Development Finance, Meeting a Global Challenge. Views and Recommendations 
of the Committee for Development Planning (New York: UN, 1986). 
4/ One example of such a decision to forgo a developmental benefit in the interest of 
conservation is provided by the dropping of the Silent Valley Hydro project in India. 
5/ Based on data from World Bank, World Development Report 1984 (New York: Oxford 
University Press, 1984). 
6/ Based on per capita consumption data from FAO, Production Yearbook 1984 (Rome: 
1985) and population projections from DIESA, World Population Prospects: Estimates 
and Projections as Assessed in 1984 (New York: UN, 1986). 
7/ FAO, Fuelwood Supplies in the Developing Countries, Forestry Paper No. 42 (Rome: 
1983). 
8/ DIESA, World Population Prospects, op. cit. 
9/ Ibid. 
10/ Ibid. 
11/ W. Hafele and W. Sassin, 'Resources and Endowments, An Outline of Future Energy 
Systems', in P.W. Hemily and M.N. Ozdas (eds.), Science and Future Choice (Oxford:
Clarendon Press, 1979). 
12/ See, for example, OECD, Interfutures: Facing the Future (Paris: 1979) and Council on 
Environmental Quality and U.S. Department of State, The Global 2000 Report to the 
President: Entering the Twenty-First Century, The Technical Report, Vol. Two 
(Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1980). 
13/ See 'For Municipal initiative and Citizen Power', in INDERENA, La Campana Verde y 
los Concejos Verdes (Bogota, Colombia: 1985).
Our Common Future, Chapter 3: The Role of the International 
Economy 
The International Economy, the Environment, I. and Development 
II. Decline in the 1980s 
1. The African Continent 
2. Latin American Debt 
III. Enabling Sustainable Development 
1. Enhancing the Flow of Resources to Developing Countries 
1.1 Increasing the Flow of Finance 
1.2 Lending for Sustainable Development 
2. Linking Trade. Environment, and Development 
2.1 International Commodity Trade 
2.2 Protectionism and International Trade 
2.3 'Pollution-intensive' Goods 
2.4 The Mandates of Multilateral Trade Forums 
3. Ensuring Responsibility in Transnational Investment 
4. Broadening the Technological Base 
4.1 The Diffusion of Environmentally Sound Technologies 
4.2 Building Up Technological Capabilities in Developing Countries 
IV. A Sustainable World Economy 
1. Through the ages, people have reached beyond their own borders to obtain essential, valued, 
or exotic materials. Today's surer communications and larger trade and capital movements 
have greatly enlarged this process, quickened its pace, and endowed it with far-reaching 
ecological implications. Thus the pursuit of sustainability requires major changes in 
international economic relations.
I. The International Economy, the Environment, and Development 
2. Two conditions must be satisfied before international economic exchanges can become 
beneficial for all involved. The sustainability of ecosystems on which the global economy 
depends must be guaranteed. And the economic partners must be satisfied that the basis of 
exchange is equitable; relationships that are unequal and based on dominance of one kind or 
another are not a sound and durable basis for interdependence. For many developing 
countries, neither condition is met. 
3. Economic and ecological links between nations have grown rapidly. This widens the impact 
of the growing inequalities in the economic development and strength of nations. The 
asymmetry in international economic relations compounds the imbalance, as developing 
nations are generally influenced by - but unable to influence - international economic 
conditions. 
4. International economic relationships pose a particular problem for poor countries trying to 
manage their environments, since the export of natural resources remains a large factor in 
their economies, especially those of the least developed nations. The instability and adverse 
price trends faced by most of these countries make it impossible for them to manage their 
natural resource bases for sustained production. The rising burden of debt servicing and the 
decline in new capital flows intensify those forces that lead to environmental deterioration and 
resource depletion occurring at the expense of long-term development. 
5. The trade in tropical timber, for example, is one factor underlying tropical deforestation. 
Needs for foreign exchange encourage many developing countries to cut timber faster than 
forests can be regenerated. This overcutting not only depletes the resource that underpins the 
world timber trade, it causes the lost of forest-based livelihoods, increases soil erosion and 
downstream flooding, and accelerates the loss of species and genetic resources. International 
trade patterns can also encourage the unsustainable development policies and practices that 
have steadily degraded the croplands and rangelands in the drylands of Asia and Africa; an 
example of that is provided by the growth of cotton production for export in the Sahel region. 
(See Box 3-1.)
Box 3-1 
Cotton Produced for Export in the Sahel 
In 1963-64, as drought and hunger were taking hold in the Sahel region of Africa, five 
Sahelian nations - Burkina Faso, Chad, Mali, Niger, and Senegal - produced record 
amounts of cotton. They harvested 154 million tons of cotton fibre, up from 22.7 
million tons in 1961-62. The Sahel as a whole set another record in 1984: It imported a 
record 1.77 million tons of cereals, up from 200,000 tons yearly in the early 1960s. 
Over the period that Sahelian cotton harvests were steadily rising, world cotton prices 
were steadily falling in real terms. These figures do not suggest that Sahelian nations 
should plough up all cotton to plant sorghum and millet. But the fact that farmers 
who can grow cotton cannot grow enough food to feed themselves suggests that cash 
crops are getting too much attention and food crops too little. 
Source: J. Giri, 'Retrospective de l'Economie Sahelienne', Club du Sahel, Paris, 1984. 
6. Growth in many developing countries also requires external capital inflows. Without 
reasonable flows, the prospect for any improvements in living standards is bleak. As a result, 
the poor will be forced to overuse the environment to ensure their own survival. Long-term 
development thus becomes much harder, and in some cases impossible. Yet trends in the 
movement of capital are worrying. Net resource flows to developing countries have fallen in 
real terms; in aggregate, there is now actually an outflow. (See Table 3-1) The increase of 
international capital flows to developing countries expected over the rest of the 1980s is only 
half that thought necessary to restore growth to levels where a reduction in poverty can 
occur./1 
7. A mere increase in flows of capital to developing countries will not necessarily contribute to 
development. Domestic efforts are of paramount importance. More external funding is also 
required, but it must come in ways that are sensitive to the environmental impacts. The point 
is that the reduction of poverty itself is a precondition for environmentally sound development. 
And resource flows from rich to poor flows improved both qualitatively and quantitatively are a 
precondition for the eradication of poverty. 
Table 3-1 
Net Transfer of Resources to Capital-Importing Developing Countries 
1979 1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985 
(billion dollars)
Net Transfer from 
Loans 
(all IDCs)* 
30.7 0.8 27.7 0.8 -8.6 -22.0 -41.0 
Net Transfer from 
all Resource Flows 
(all IDCs)** 
41.4 39.3 41.5 10.1 -0.3 -12.5 -31.0 
Net Transfer from 
all Resource Flows 
(to Latin America) 
15.6 11.9 11.4 -16.7 -25.9 -23.2 -30.0 
* Net transfers on loans are net capital flows minus net interest paid. All loans, official and 
private, short and long-term, are included together with IMF credit 
** Total net resource flows relate to net loan transfers, grants and net direct investment (less 
net direct investment income) 
Source: UN, World Economic Survey 1986 (New York: 1986). 
II. Decline in the 1980s 
8. The pressures of poverty and rising populations make it enormously difficult for developing 
countries to pursue environmentally sound policies even in the best of circumstances. But 
when international economic conditions are bad, the problems can become unmanageable. 
During the 1980s, economic growth rates declined sharply or even turned negative in much of 
the Third World, particularly in Africa and Latin America. Over the five years from 1981 to 
1985, population growth outstripped economic growth in most developing countries./2 
9. Deteriorating terms of trade, rising debt service obligations, stagnating flows of aid, and 
growing protectionism in the developed market economies caused severe external payment 
problems. The increased cost of foreign borrowing, at a time when exports were depressed, 
also helped to plunge many developing countries into debt crises. Austerity programmes laid 
down by the IMF as a prerequisite for extending credit to meet short-term balance-of- 
payments needs became particularly onerous after the debt crisis. Growth was cut back and 
many social objectives fell by the wayside, including those having to do with employment, 
health, education, environment, and human settlements. 
We know that the world lives through an international finance crisis, which 
increases the misery and the poverty in the Third World arid we sacrifice even 
more our environment, though we know that this situation can be reversed, if we 
can use correctly new technology and knowledge. But for this we have to find a 
new ethic that will include the relationship between man and nature above all. 
Sergio Dialetachi 
Speaker from the floor 
WCED Public Hearing 
Sao Paulo, 26-29 Oct 1985 
10. This was a radical change from the 1960s and 1970s. Then it was rapid economic growth
that was seen as an ecological threat. Now it is recession, austerity, and falling living standards. 
The decline of the 1980s has aggravated pressures on the environment in several ways: 
Austerity measures and general recessionary conditions have brought sharp declines in 
per capita incomes and increased unemployment. This forces more people back into 
subsistence agriculture, where they draw heavily on the natural resource base and thus 
degrade it. 
Austerity programmes inevitably include government cutbacks in both the staff and 
expenditure of fledgling, weak environmental agencies, undermining even the minimal 
efforts being made to bring ecological considerations into development planning. 
Conservation always taken a back seat in times of economic stress. As economic 
conditions have worsened in developing countries and debt pressures have mounted, 
planners have tended to ignore environmental planning and conservation in both 
industrial and rural development projects. 
11. The critical situations in sub Saharan Africa and the debt strapped countries of Latin 
America demonstrate, in an extreme way, the damaging impacts that unreformed international 
economic arrangements are having on both development and the environment. 
1. The African Continent 
12. Africa on the whole has been caught up in a series of downward spirals: 
poverty and hunger leading to environmental degradation, deteriorating agriculture, and 
hence more poverty and hunger; 
falling savings and a neglect of new investment in the wake of growing poverty; 
high infant mortality, poverty, and lack of education; 
high population growth rates; and 
a flight from rural hunger to the cities, leading to explosive levels of urban growth and 
squalor, compounding the problems of inadequate food supplies. 
13. The situation is not everywhere so bleak. Some nations have coped well, and some 
far-reaching and courageous policy reforms begun in the last few years have begun to bear 
fruit. Encouragement also comes from South Asia, where a comparable crisis 20 years ago has 
given way to an upward spiral of rising food production, diminishing (but still vast) poverty, 
slowing population growth, rising savings and investment, and greater attention to the 
long-term questions of environmental management and appropriate technology. 
14. Among the many causes of the African crisis, the workings of the international economy 
stand out. Sub-Saharan Africa's economic well-being depends even more than low-income 
Asia's on developments in the world economy. Within the last decade, many sub-Saharan 
countries have been hit by adverse trends in commodity terms of trade and external shocks 
such as higher oil prices, fluctuating exchange rates, and higher interest rates. Over the last 10 
years, the prices of major commodities such as copper, iron ore, sugar, ground-nuts, rubber, 
timber, and cotton have fallen significantly. In 1985, the terms of trade of sub-Saharan 
countries (except oil-exporting countries) were 10 per cent below 1970 levels. In countries 
eligible for funds from the International Development Association (IDA), the average fall was
well over 20 per cent, with even greater drops in some, including Ethiopia, Liberia, Sierra 
Leone, Zaire, and Zambia./3 
15. The problem has been compounded by growing difficulties in attracting development 
capital from the industrial world. At the same time, debt repayments and interest charges have 
risen Debt service rose in sub-Saharan Africa as a whole from 15 per cent of export earnings in 
1980 to 31 per cent in 1985./4 This combination of events has led to a situation where net 
resource transfers to the area fell from an estimated $10 billion a year in 1982 to $1 billion in 
1985./5 Thus nations have been able to import far less. In countries eligible for IDA loans, the 
import volume per person in 1984 was only 62 per cent of the volume in 1970./6 Imports for 
agriculture - machinery, fertilizers, and pesticides - and of essential supplies to meet basic 
needs have all been cut. The combination of diverse international and internal factors cut per 
capita incomes by 16 per cent in sub-Saharan Africa between 1960 and 1985./7 
16. The economic difficulties of sub-Saharan countries have had devastating social impacts. 
Declining per capita rood production has contributed to growing undernourishment. The 
recent drought placed some 35 million lives at risk in 1984/85, and as the drought receded 
some 19 million people continued to suffer famine./8 Malnutrition and hunger have weakened 
much of the population, reducing their productivity, and made more of them (especially 
children and the old) more susceptible to debilitating diseases and premature death. The crisis 
has reversed progress in supplying safe drinking water and sanitation. 
The seriousness of the African crisis cannot be overemphasized and in its entirety, 
it should really engage the whole world. The lives of 400 million people living in 
Africa today are imperilled. And many more people yet to be born will face a very 
bleak future unless effective solutions are found and found quickly. 
It requires of course very little imagination to appreciate the fact that it is not only 
Africa that is in danger. In the long term the entire world economy could be 
threatened not only because of the indivisibility of human welfare but because of 
Africa's crucial position in the global economy as a source of a large number of 
vital raw materials. 
Maxime Ferrari 
Director, UNEP Regional Office for Africa 
WCED Public Hearing 
Harare, 18 Sept 1986 
17. It is now more widely recognized that it is necessary to deal with the long-term causes 
rather than the symptoms. The vast misery brought on by the drought in Africa is now 
generally acknowledged, and the world community has responded with a substantial 
emergency programme. But emergency food aid is only a short-term reaction, and, at best, a 
partial answer. The roots of the problem lie in national and international policies that have bo 
far prevented African economies from realizing their full potential for economic expansion and 
thus for easing poverty and the environmental pressures that it generates. 
18. The resolution lies in large part with African decision makers, but the international 
community also has a heavy responsibility to support Africa's adjustment efforts with adequate 
aid and trade arrangements and to see to it that more capital flows into poorer nations than 
out. These two complementary aspects of the resolution of the problems have been fully 
recognized by the African countries themselves/9 and generally acknowledged by the
international community./10 The World Bank estimates that even if external economic 
conditions are favourable over the next five years, and even if African governments implement 
key policy reforms, a substantial gap will still remain between the finance or debt relief 
available on current donor policies and the amounts needed to prevent a further deterioration 
in the living standards of low-income Africa./11 And there is no money in this grim equation for 
restoring the damaged environment. 
19. The international community must realize that Africa cannot pull itself out of the planet's 
most serious economic and ecological crisis without much more long-term assistance than is 
currently envisioned. In addition, greatly increased external financing for development must 
be accompanied by policy changes that recognize the need to avoid environmental degradation. 
2. Latin American Debt 
20. Debt is an acute problem for many countries of Africa. But, because of the magnitudes of 
debt involved, it has had its most visible impact in some middle-income countries - particularly 
in Latin America. The debt crisis remains a threat to international financial stability, but its 
main impact so far has been on the process of development, both in its economic and ecological 
aspects. Of the total world debt of around $950 billion in 1985, roughly 30 per cent was owed 
by four countries: Argentina, Brazil, Mexico, and Venezuela. Their debts constitute roughly 
two-thirds of the outstanding loans of banks to developing countries./12 
21. In the 1970s, Latin America's economic growth was facilitated by external borrowing. 
Commercial banks were happy to lend to growing countries rich in natural resources. Then 
major changes in international conditions made the debt unsustainable. A global recession 
restricted export markets, and tight monetary policies forced up global interest rates to levels 
far exceeding any in living memory. Bankers, alarmed by deteriorating creditworthiness, 
stopped lending. A flight of indigenous capital from developing countries compounded the 
problem. 
22. The ensuing crisis forced governments into austerity policies to cut back imports. As a 
result, Latin American imports fell by 40 per cent in real terms over three years./13 The 
consequent economic contraction reduced per capita gross domestic product by an average of 
B per cent in the eight main Latin American countries./14 Much of the burden was carried by 
the poor, as real wages fell and unemployment rose. Growing poverty and deteriorating 
environmental conditions are clearly visible in every major Latin American country. 
23. Further, the lack of new credit and the continuing burden of debt service forced these 
countries to service their debts by running trade surpluses. The net transfers from seven major 
Latin American countries to creditors rose to almost $39 billion in 1984, and in that year 35 per 
cent of export earnings went to pay interest on overseas debt./15 This massive drain represents 
5 to 6 per cent of the region's GDP, around a third of the internal savings, and nearly 40 per 
cent of export earnings. It has been achieved by adjustment policies that impose severe and 
regressively skewed cuts in wages, social services, investment, consumption, and employment, 
both public and private, further aggravating social inequity and widespread poverty. Pressures 
on the environment and resources have increased sharply in the search for new and expanded 
exports and replacements for imports, together with the deterioration and overexploitation of 
the environment brought about by the swelling number of the urban and rural poor in 
desperate struggle for survival. A substantial part of Latin America's rapid growth in exports 
are raw materials, food, and resource-based manufactures.
The impact of the present crisis on Latin America has been compared, in its depth 
and extension, with the Great Depression of 1929-32. The crisis has made it clear 
that, although the need to protect the environment against the traditional problems 
of deterioration and depletion continues to be a valid objective, policy-makers 
responsible for environmental management ought to avoid negative attitudes in the 
face of the need for economic reactivation and growth. 
The expansion, conservation, maintenance, and protection of the environment can 
make an essential contribution to the improvement of the standard of living, to 
employment, and to productivity. 
Osvaldo Sunkel 
Coordinator, Joint ECLAC/UNEP Development and Environment Unit 
WCED Public Hearing 
Sao Paulo, 28-29 Oct 1985 
24. So Latin American natural resources ate being used not for development or to raise living 
standards, but to meet the financial requirements of industrialized country creditors. This 
approach to the debt problem raises questions of economic, political, and environmental 
sustainability. To require relatively poor countries to simultaneously curb their living 
standards, accept growing poverty, and export growing amounts of scarce resources to 
maintain external creditworthiness reflects priorities few democratically elected governments 
are likely to be able to tolerate for long. The present situation is not consistent with sustainable 
development. This conflict is aggravated by the economic policies of some major industrial 
countries, which have depressed and destabilized the international economy. In order to bring 
about socially and environmentally sustainable development it is indispensable, among other 
elements, for industrial countries to resume internationally expansionary policies of growth, 
trade, and investment. The Commission noted that, in these circumstances, some debtor 
countries have felt forced to suspend or limit the outflow of funds. 
25. Growing numbers of creditor banks and official agencies are realizing that many debtors 
simply will not be able to keep servicing their debts unless the burden is eased. Measures 
under discussion include additional new lending, forgiveness of part of the debt, longer-term 
rescheduling, and conversion to softer terms. But a necessary sense of urgency is lacking. Any 
such measures must incorporate the legitimate interests of creditors and debtors and 
represent a fairer sharing of the burden of resolving the debt crisis. 
III. Enabling Sustainable Development 
26. Developing countries have sought, for many years, fundamental changes in international 
economic arrangements so as to make them more equitable, particularly with regard to 
financial flows, trade, transnational investment, and technology transfer./16 Their arguments 
must now be recast to reflect the ecological dimensions, frequently overlooked in the past. 
27. In the short run, for most developing countries except the largest a new era of economic 
growth hinges on effective and coordinated economic management among major industrial 
countries - designed to facilitate expansion, to reduce real interest rates, and to halt the slide to 
protectionism. In the longer term, major changes are also required to make consumption and 
production patterns sustainable in a context of higher global growth. 
28. International cooperation to achieve the former is embryonic, and to achieve the latter, 
negligible. In practice, and in the absence of global management of the economy or the
environment, attention must be focused on the improvement of policies in areas where the 
scope for cooperation is already defined: aid, trade, transnational corporations, and technology 
transfer. 
1. Enhancing the Flow of Resources to Developing Countries 
29. Two interrelated concerns lie at the heart of our recommendations on financial flows: one 
concerns the quantity, the other the 'quality of resource flows to developing countries. The 
need for more resources cannot be evaded. The idea that developing countries would do better 
to live within their limited means is a cruel illusion. Global poverty cannot be reduced by the 
governments of poor countries acting alone. At the same time, more aid and other forms of 
finance, while necessary, are not sufficient. Projects and programmes must be designed for 
sustainable development. 
1.1 Increasing the Flow of Finance 
30. As regards the quantity of resources, the stringency of external finance has already 
contributed to an unacceptable decline in living standards in developing countries. The 
patterns and the needs of the heavily indebted countries that rely mainly on commercial 
finance have been described, along with those of low-income countries that depend on aid. But 
there are other poor countries that have made impressive progress in recent years but still face 
immense problems, not least in countering environmental degradation. Low-income Asia has a 
continuing need for large amounts of aid; in general, the main recipients in this region have a 
good record of aid management. Without such aid it will be much more difficult, to sustain the 
growth that, together with poverty-focused programmes, could improve the lot of hundreds of 
millions of the 'absolute poor'. 
The universal importance of ecological problems can hardly be denied. Their 
successful solution will increasingly require coordinated activities not only within 
every country's economy but also within the scope of international cooperation. 
Ecological problems are unprecedented in the history of mankind. 
Dr. Todor I. Bozninov 
Committee for Environment Protection, Bulgaria 
WCED Public Hearing 
Moscow, 8 Dec 1986 
31. To meet such needs requires that the main donors and lending institutions re-examine 
their policies. Official development assistance (ODA) levels have stagnated in absolute terms, 
and most donor countries fall well short of internationally agreed targets. Commercial lending 
and lending by export credit agencies has fallen sharply. As part of a concerted effort to reverse 
these trends it is vitally important for development that there should be a substantial increase 
in resources available to the World Bank and IDA. Increased commercial bank lending is also 
necessary for major debtors. 
1.2 Lending for Sustainable Development 
32. In the past, development assistance has not always contributed to sustainable development
and in some cases detracted from it. Lending for agriculture, forestry, fishing, and energy has 
usually been made on narrow economic criteria that take little account of environmental effects 
For instance, development agencies have sometimes promoted chemical-dependent 
agriculture, rather than sustainable, regenerative agriculture. It is important therefore that 
there should be a qualitative as well as a quantitative improvement. 
33. A larger portion of total development assistance should go to investments needed to 
enhance the environment and the productivity of the resource sectors. Such efforts include 
reforestation and fuelwood development, watershed protection, soil conservation, 
agroforestry, rehabilitation of irrigation projects, small scale agriculture, low-cost sanitation 
measures, and the conversion of crops into fuel. Experience has shown that the most effective 
efforts of this type are small projects with maximum grass-roots participation. The 
programmes most directly related to the objective of sustainable development may therefore 
involve higher local costs, a higher ratio of recurrent to capital costs, and a greater use of local 
technology and expertise. 
34. A shift towards projects of this kind would also require donors to re-examine the content of 
their aid programmes, particularly with regard to commodity assistance, which has sometimes 
served to reduce rather than enhance the possibilities for sustainable development. (See 
Chapter 5.) 
The industrialized world's demands for raw materials, higher productivity, and 
material goods have imposed serious environmental impacts and high economic 
costs not only in our own countries, but also on the developing world. The existing 
international patterns of financial, economic trade and investment policies further 
add to the problems. 
We must all be willing to examine our relations in international trade, investments, 
development assistance, industry, and agriculture in light of the consequences 
these may have for underdevelopment and environmental destruction in the Third 
World. We must even be willing to go further and implement the means necessary 
to alienate these symptoms. 
Rakel Surlien 
Former Minister of Environment 
Government of Norway 
WCED Opening Ceremony 
Oslo, 24 June 1985 
35. The major priority is for sustainability considerations to be diffused throughout the work of 
international financial institutions. The roles of the World Bank and the IMF are particularly 
crucial because their lending conditions are being used as benchmarks for parallel lending by 
other institutions - commercial banks and export credit agencies. It is important in this context 
that sustainability considerations be taken into account by the Bank in the appraisal of 
structural adjustment lending and other policy-oriented lending directed to resource-based 
sectors - agriculture, fishing, forestry, and energy in particular - as well as specific projects. 
36. A similar shift of emphasis is required in respect of adjustment programmes undertaken by 
developing countries. To date, 'adjustment' - particularly under IMF auspices - has led more 
often than not to cutbacks in living standards in the interest of financial stabilization. Implicit 
in many suggested plans for coping with the debt crisis is the growing recognition that future
adjustment should be growth-oriented. Yet it also needs to be environmentally sensitive. 
37. The IMF also has a mandate for structural adjustment lending, as in its new Structural 
Adjustment Facility. There has been a strongly expressed demand from developing-country 
borrowers for the Fund to take into account wider and longer-term development objectives 
than financial stabilization: growth, social goals, and environmental impacts. 
38. Development agencies, and the World Bank in particular, should develop easily usable 
methodologies to augment their own appraisal techniques and to assist developing countries to 
improve their capacity for environmental assessment. 
2. Linking Trade, Environment, and Development 
39. The importance of foreign trade to national development has greatly increased for most 
countries in the post-war period. (See Table 3-2.) This is one measure of the extent to which 
trade has made nations, economically and ecologically, more interdependent. Patterns of world 
trade also have changed markedly. First, the value of trade in manufactured goods grew at a 
faster rate than that in primary products other than fuel, and a growing number of developing 
countries have emerged as major exporters of such goods. Manufactured goods now account 
for twice the value of developing countries' non-oil exports./17 (See Chapter 8.) Second, the 
industrialized market economies have come to depend more on fuel imports from developing 
countries, which accounted for 43 per cent of consumption in 1980-81 compared with only 16 
per cent in 1959-60 and even less in pre-war years./18 
40. The dependence of the developed market economies on other mineral imports from the 
developing countries has also grown, and the share of these imports in consumption increased 
from 19 per cent in 1959-60 to 30 per cent in 1980-81./19 Non-renewable resources like fuels 
and minerals, as well as manufactured goods, are now far more important than tropical 
products and other agricultural materials in the flow of primary products from developing to 
industrial countries. In fact, the flow of food grains is in the opposite direction. 
41. The main link between trade and sustainable development is the use of non-renewable raw 
materials to earn foreign exchange. Developing countries face the dilemma of having to use 
commodities as exports, in order to break foreign exchange constraints on growth, while also 
having to minimize damage to the environmental resource base supporting this growth. There 
are other links between trade and sustainable development; if protectionism raises barriers 
against manufactured exports, for example, developing nations have less scope for diversifying 
away from traditional commodities. And unsustainable development may arise not only from 
overuse of certain commodities but from manufactured goods that are potentially polluting. 
2.1 International Commodity Trade 
42. Although a growing number of developing countries have diversified into manufactured 
exports, primary commodities other than petroleum continue to account for more than 
one-third of the export earnings of the group as a whole. Dependence on such exports is 
particularly high in Latin America (52 per cent) and Africa (62 per cent)./20 The countries 
recognized as 'least developed' for the purposes of the UN Special Programme use primary 
commodities for 73 per cent of their export earnings./21 
43. Non-oil commodity prices fell during the early 1980s, not only in real but also in nominal 
terms. By early 1985, the UNCTAD commodity price index was 30 per cent below the 1980
average./22 This recent weakness of commodity prices may not be only a temporary 
phenomenon. Commodity prices have not yet recovered from the depth of the world recession 
despite increased economic growth in consuming countries. The reasons may be partly 
technological (an acceleration in raw material substitution); partly monetary, caused by the 
high cost of holding stocks of commodities; and partly due to increases in supplies by countries 
desperate to earn foreign exchange. 
Table 3-2 
The Growing Importance of Trade 
1950 1982 
Economic Group (exports as a per cent of GDP or NMP) 
Developed Market Economies 7.7 15.3 
Developing Market Economies 15.5 23.8 
Socialist Countries of Eastern Europe 3.4* 16.6* 
Socialist Countries of Asia 2.9* 9.7* 
* percentages to net material product (NMP). 
Source: Based on UNCTAD, Handbook of International Trade and Development 
Statistics, 1985 Supplement (New York: United Nations, 1985). 
44. These countries are turning the terms of trade against themselves, earning less while 
exporting more. The promotion of increased volumes of commodity exports has led to cases of 
unsustainable overuse of the natural resource base. While individual cases may not exactly fit 
this generalization, it has been argued that such processes have been at work in ranching for 
beef, fishing in both coastal and deep sea waters, forestry, and the growing of some cash crops. 
Moreover, the prices of commodity exports do not fully reflect the environmental costs to the 
resource base. In a sense, then, poor developing countries are being caused to subsidize the 
wealthier importers of their products. 
45. The experience of oil has of course been different from that of most other commodities. 
(See Chapter 7.) It does provide one example of producers combining to restrict output and 
raise prices in ways that greatly increased export earnings while conserving the resource base 
and promoting energy saving and substitution on a large scale. Recent events suggest that 
regulation of the market by producers is very difficult in the long term, whether or not it is 
desirable in the wider, global interest, and in any event the conditions have not existed for 
other commodity exporters to operate in a like manner. Any arrangement encompassing 
measures to enhance the export earnings of producers, as well as to ensure the resource basis, 
would require consumer as well as producer support. 
46. In recent years, Third World commodity exporters have sought to earn more by doing the
first-stage processing of raw materials themselves. This first stage often involves subsidized 
energy, other concessions, and substantial pollution costs. But these countries often find that 
they do not gain much from this capital- and energy-intensive first-stage processing, as the 
price spread shifts in favour of downstream products, most of which continue to be 
manufactured mainly in industrial countries. Tariff escalation in the industrial market 
economies reinforces this tendency. 
47. The main international response to commodity problems has been the development of 
international commodity agreements to stabilize and raise developing countries' earnings from 
these exports. But real progress has been very limited and in fact there have been reversals. 
Moreover, environmental resource considerations have not played any part in commodity 
agreements, with the notable exception of the International Tropical Timber Agreement./23 
48. Commodity agreements have not been easy to negotiate, and regulation of commodity 
trade has been notoriously controversial and difficult. Current arrangements could be 
improved in two crucial respects: 
Larger sums for compensatory financing to even out economic shocks - as under the 
IMF's Compensatory Financing Facility - would encourage producers to take a long-term 
view, and not to overproduce commodities where production is close to the limits of 
environmental sustainability during periods of market glut. 
Where producers need to diversify from traditional, single-crop production patterns, 
more assistance could be given for diversification programmes. The second window of 
the Common Fund could be used for promoting resource regeneration and 
conservation./24 
49. Individual governments can better use renewable resources such as forests and fisheries to 
ensure that exploitation rates stay within the limits of sustainable yields and that finances are 
available to regenerate resources and deal with all linked environmental effects. As for 
non-renewable resources like minerals, governments should ensure that: 
the leaseholder undertakes exploration aimed at adding to proven reserves at least the 
amount extracted; 
that the ratio of production to proven reserve remains below a pre-specified limit; 
that the funds generated by royalties are used in a way that compensates for the 
declining income when the resource deposit is exhausted; and 
that the leaseholder is responsible for land restoration and other environmental control 
measures in the urea affected by mining. 
I think it is also of importance for the Commission to note the problem of 
negotiation of contracts on resource development. We have been trying for 10 
years to include provisions on environment. We have been successful only to get 
from the investors a very broad description of what should be done in 
environmental protection. If you go into details you get problems with the lawyers 
and so on. That hampers then the investment. 
For us, of course, it is a choice of whether to loosen the grip a little bit or if you 
maintain that, then of course, there will be no investment in the country. If an 
appeal could be made to the multinationals, mainly to understand that what has
been done in timber should also be applied to other agreements like coffee, tin, 
and others. I think this would be a great help. 
Speaker from the floor 
Government agency 
WCED Public Hearing 
Jakarta, 26 March 1985 
50. Relevant international organizations such as various UN agencies, the World Bank, and 
regional groups could develop further their work on model contracts and guidelines 
incorporating these principles. 
2.2 Protectionism and International Trade 
51. The increase in protectionism in industrial countries stifles export growth and prevents 
diversification from traditional exports. The success of some Far Eastern developing countries 
in increasing exports of labour-intensive manufactured goods shows the development 
potential of such trace. However, other countries - especially low-income Asian and Latin 
American nations - seeking to follow the same route have found themselves severely 
handicapped by growing trade barriers, particularly in textiles and clothing. If developing 
countries are to reconcile a need for rapid export growth with a need to conserve the resource 
base, it is imperative that they enjoy access to industrial country markets for non traditional 
exports where they enjoy a comparative advantage. In many cases, the problems of 
protectionism relate to manufactures; but there are cases - sugar is a good example - where 
industrial countries employ agricultural trade restrictions in ways that are damaging 
ecologically as well as economically. (See Box 3-2.) 
2.3 'Pollution-intensive' Goods 
52. The processing of certain raw materials - pulp and paper, oil, and alumina, for example - 
can have substantial environmental side effects. Industrial countries have generally been more 
successful than developing ones in seeing to it that export product prices reflect the costs of 
environmental damage and of controlling that damage. Thus in the case of exports from 
industrial countries, these costs are paid by consumers in importing nations, including those in 
the Third World. But in the case of exports from developing countries, such costs continue to 
be borne entirely domestically, largely in the form of damage costs to human health, property, 
and ecosystems. 
Box 3-2 
Sugar and Sustainable Development 
Thirty million poor people in the Third World depend on sugar cane for their survival. 
Many developing countries have a genuine comparative advantage in production and 
could earn valuable foreign exchange by expanding output. Some small states - Fiji, 
Mauritius, and several Caribbean islands - depend for their economic survival on cane 
sugar exports.
Industrial countries have actively promoted, and protected, beet sugar production, 
which competes with cane and has had quite damaging effects on developing 
countries: High-cost, protected beet production encourages artificial sweeteners; 
quotas have kept out Third World imports (except for some guaranteed imports as 
under the EEC's Sugar Protocol); and surpluses are dumped on world markets 
depressing prices. 
In the 1986 World Development Report, the World Bank estimated that 
industrial countries' sugar policies cost developing countries About $7.4 billion in lost 
revenues during 1963, reduced their real income by about $2.1 billion and increased 
price instability by about 25 per cent. 
Over and above the increased developing country poverty that results from these 
practices, the promotion of beet production in industrial countries has had adverse 
ecological side effects. Modern beet growing is highly capital-intensive, it depends 
heavily on chemical herbicides, and the crop has poorer regenerative properties than 
others. The same product could be grown in developing countries, as cane, more 
cheaply, using more labour and fewer chemical additives. 
53. In 1980 the industries of developing countries exporting to OECD members would have 
incurred direct pollution control costs of $5.5 billion if they had been required to meet the 
environmental standards then prevailing in the United States, according to a study conducted 
for this Commission./25 If the pollution control expenditures associated with the materials that 
went into the final product are also counted, the costs would have mounted to $14.2 billion. 
The evidence also suggests that OECD imports from developing countries involve products 
that entail higher average environmental and resource damage costs than do overall OECD 
imports./26 These hypothetical pollution control costs probably understate the real costs of 
environmental and resource damage in the exporting countries. Furthermore, these costs 
relate only to environmental pollution and net to the economic damage costs associated with 
resource depletion. 
54. The fact that these costs remain hidden means that developing countries are able to attract 
more investment to export manufactured goods than they would under a more rigorous system 
of global environmental control. Many Third World policymakers see this as beneficial in that it 
gives developing countries a comparative advantage in 'pollution-intensive' goods that should 
be exploited. They also see that passing along more of the real costs could reduce the 
competitive position of their country in some markets, and thus regard any pressure in this 
direction as a form of disguised protectionism from established producers. Yet it is in 
developing countries' own long-term interests that more of the environmental and resource 
costs associated with production be reflected in prices. Such changes must come from the 
developing countries themselves. 
2.4 The Mandates of Multilateral Trade Forums 
55. Although a number of UNCTAD research projects have considered the links between trade 
and environment, these issues have not been taken up systematically by intergovernmental 
organizations. The mandates of these organizations - principally GATT and UNCTAD - should 
include sustainable development. Their activities should reflect concern with the impacts of 
trading patterns on the environment and the need for more effective instruments to integrate
environment and development concerns into international trading arrangements. 
56. International organizations dealing with trade will find it easier to reorientate their 
activities if each nation designates a lead agency with a broad mandate to assess the effects of 
international trade on sustaining the environmental and resource base of economic growth. 
This agency could be responsible for raising sustainability issues in the work of UNCTAD, 
GATT, OECD, CMEA, and other relevant organizations. 
3. Ensuring Responsibility in Transnational Investment 
57. Overseas investment activity by companies in market economies has grown substantially 
over the past 40 years. (See Box 3-3.) Foreign affiliates now account for 40 per cent of sales, 33 
per cent of net assets, and 56 per cent of net earnings for 380 of the largest industrial 
corporations in the market economies, according to data compiled by the UN Centre for 
Transnational Corporations./27 A high proportion of transnational investment is within 
industrial market economies, another aspect of the growing integration of these economies. 
58. Transnationals play an important role as owners, as partners in joint ventures, and as 
suppliers of technology in the mining and manufacturing sectors in many developing countries, 
especially in such environmentally sensitive areas as petroleum, chemicals, metals, paper, and 
automobiles. They also dominate world trade in many primary commodities. 
59. In recent years, many developing countries have begun to take a more positive view of the 
role TNC investment can play in their development process. This has been somewhat 
influenced by these countries' needs for foreign exchange and their awareness of the role that 
foreign investment might play in providing it. Effective cooperation with TNCs is possible in 
creating equal conditions for all parties. This can be attained by a strict observance of the 
principle of sovereignty of the host country For their part, many corporations have recognized 
the need to share managerial skills and technological know-how with host country nationals 
and to pursue profit-seeking objectives within a framework of long-tern sustainable 
development. 
Box 3-3 
The Role of Transnational Corporations 
In 1983 chemicals accounted for roughly one-fourth of the stock of foreign 
direct investment in manufacturing in developing countries by companies from 
four leading countries - Japan (23 per cent), the United States (23 per cent), 
the United Kingdom (27 per cent), and the Federal Republic of Germany (14 per 
cent). 
Agriculture, mining, and other extractive industries accounted for 38 per cent 
of the stock of U.S. investment in developing countries in 1983, 29 per cent of 
the stock of Japanese investment in 1983, 21 per cent of the total FRG 
investment in 1981-83, and 9 per cent of the stock of U.K. investment in 1978. 
Eighty to ninety per cent of the trade in tea, coffee, cocoa, cotton, forest 
products, tobacco, jute, copper, iron ore, and bauxite is controlled in the case of 
each commodity by the three to six largest transnationals.
Source: UN Centre on Transnational Corporations, Environmental Aspects of 
the Activities of Transnational Corporations: A Survey (New York: UN, 
1985). 
60. But mutual suspicions still exist, usually because of an asymmetry in bargaining power 
between large corporations and small, poor, developing countries. Negotiations are often made 
one sided by a developing country's lack of information, technical unpreparedness, and 
political and institutional weaknesses. Suspicions and disagreements remain, particularly 
concerning the introduction of new technologies, the development of natural resources, and 
the use of the environment. If multinationals are to play a larger role in development, these 
conflicts and suspicions must be reduced. 
61. Strengthening the bargaining posture and response of developing countries vis a vis 
transnationals is therefore critical. Where nations lack indigenous capacity to deal with large 
TNCs, regional and other international institutions should assist. As indicated earlier, they 
could expand existing help in the form of model agreements with transnationals for different 
situations, such an lease agreements for the exploitation of a mineral resource. They could also 
field technical assistance and advisory teams when a country negotiates with a transnational. 
62. Transnational can have a substantial impact on the environment and resources of other 
countries and on the global commons. Both the home and host countries of TNCs share 
responsibilities and should work together to strengthen policies in this sphere. For example, 
information on policies and standards applied to and followed by corporations when investing 
in their own home country, especially concerning hazardous technologies, should be provided 
to host countries. Moreover, the policies of some industrialized countries that major 
investments are subject to prior environmental assessment should be considered for 
application to investments made elsewhere and should be broadened to include sustainability 
criteria. The information and recommendations thus arrived at should be shared with the host 
countries, which of course would retain the final responsibility. 
63. Despite their importance, international measures regarding transnational have been 
generally lacking and have proved extremely difficult to negotiate. The codes of conduct for 
transnational corporations formulated by the OECD and under discussion in the UN should 
deal explicitly with environmental matters and the objective of sustainable development. More 
detailed and specific instruments are needed for other problems. In particular, when 
introducing a new technology, plant, product, or process, or when setting up a joint venture in 
a developing country, the parties involved must also recognize and accept certain special 
responsibilities. (See Chapter 8.) 
4. Broadening the Technological Base 
64. The promotion of resource productivity is largely the work of domestic economic policy. 
But the international economy impinges on possibilities for productivity improvement in 
several ways, particularly in the transfer of technology from one country to another. 
4.1 The Diffusion of Environmentally Sound Technologies 
65. The promotion of sustainable development will require an organized effort to develop and 
diffuse new technologies, such as for agricultural production, renewable energy systems, and
pollution control. Much of this effort will be based on the international exchange of technology: 
through trade in improved equipment, technology-transfer agreements, provision of experts, 
research collaboration, and so on. Hence the procedures and policies that influence these 
exchanges must stimulate innovation and ensure ready and widespread access to 
environmentally sound technologies. 
66. The real challenge is to ensure that the new technologies reach all those who need them, 
overcoming such problems as the lack of information and in some cases an inability to pay for 
commercially developed technologies. The measures required at the national level to deal with 
these problems are discussed in Part II of this report. However, both these issues also arise in 
the international diffusion of technology. 
Transfer of technology should be also looked upon as being a social process. 
Actually, ideally, it is the people themselves who have to make the selection, not 
us. So, to sum it up I think, talking about technology it is very important to, 
perhaps, understand that we are dealing here with a process of change. 
Technologies cannot be directly transferred except by relating this to a social 
process. So, actually technology is not an independent variable in this case, but it 
is very much dependent of social change. 
M. Nashihin Hasan 
Speaker from the floor 
WCED Public Hearing 
Jakarta, 26 March 1985 
67. Developing countries paid about $2 billion in 1960 by way of royalties and fees, mainly to 
industrial countries./28 The gap in scientific and technological capabilities is particularly wide 
in areas of direct relevance to the objectives of sustainable development, including 
biotechnology and genetic engineering, new energy sources, new materials and substitutes, 
and low-waste and non-polluting technologies. 
68. The principal policy issue as regards the impact of payments is the impact of patents and 
proprietary rights. In 1980, industrialized market economies accounted for 65 per cent of the 
world total of patents granted, and the socialist countries of Eastern Europe held 29 per 
cent./29 Developing countries held only 6 per cent, and most of these had been granted to 
non-residents. Proprietary rights are a key element in the commercial development of 
technology. But their application in certain areas may hamper the diffusion of environmentally 
sound technologies and may increase inequities. 
69. In the past, publicly funded research provided new technology to small producers, 
particularly farmers, on a full or subsidized basis. The situation is not very different now, and 
in areas such as new seed varieties there is some reason to believe proprietary rights could act 
as a major barrier to developing countries' acquisition of new technologies. International 
cooperation is essential to maintain the flow of genetic material and to ensure an equitable 
sharing of gains. 
4.2 Building Up Technological Capabilities in Developing Countries 
70. At present, most of the global research and development effort is devoted to military 
purposes or the commercial objectives of large corporations. Little of this is of direct relevance
to conditions in developing countries. In many areas the gap in technological capabilities is 
narrowing, but these efforts must be supported by international assistance, especially in such 
key areas as biotechnology. Unless action is taken to accumulate biological knowledge, valuable 
information as well as vital genetic variety will be lost forever, and developing countries will be 
at a permanent disadvantage in adapting the new biotechnologies to their own needs. 
71. Developing countries therefore have to work, individually and together, to build up their 
technological capabilities. The creation and enhancement of the infrastructure for research and 
technology is a precondition for such cooperation. The countries concerned could share the 
burden by establishing cooperative research projects along the lines of the International 
Agricultural Research Centres./30 Mission-oriented cooperative research ventures could be 
developed in areas such as dryland agriculture, tropical forestry, pollution control in small 
enterprises, and low-cost housing. Specific responsibilities would be assigned to institutions 
and corporations in the participating countries, and the agreement could provide for the 
equitable sharing and widespread diffusion of the technologies developed. 
IV. A Sustainable World Economy 
72. If large parts of the developing world are to avert economic, social, and environmental 
catastrophes, it is essential that global economic growth be revitalized. In practical terms, this 
means more rapid economic growth in both industrial and developing countries, freer market 
access for the products of developing countries, lower interest rates, greater technology 
transfer, and significantly larger capital flows, both concessional and commercial. 
73. But many people fear that a more rapidly growing world economy will apply environmental 
pressures that are no more sustainable than the pressures presented by growing poverty. The 
increased demand for energy and other non-renewable raw materials could significantly raise 
the price of these items relative to other goods. 
74. The Commission's overall assessment is that the international economy must speed up 
world growth while respecting the environmental constraints. Some favourable trends have 
been noted in the pattern of consumption and production in industrial countries, which 
collectively still consume most of the world's non-renewable resources. 
75. Sustaining these trends will make it easier for developing countries to grow by diversifying 
their own economies. But for them to emerge from dependence a general acceleration of global 
economic growth is not enough. This would mean a mere perpetuation of existing economic 
patterns, though perhaps at a higher level of incomes. It must be ensured that the economies 
of developing countries grow fast enough to outpace their growing internal problems and fast 
enough for that first leap needed to acquire momentum. A continuation of economic growth 
and diversification, along with the development of technological and managerial skills, will help 
developing countries mitigate the strains on the rural environment, raise productivity and 
consumption standards, and allow nations to move beyond dependence on one or two primary 
products for their export earnings. 
76. Future patterns of agricultural and forestry development, energy use, industrialization, and 
human settlements can be made far less material-intensive (see Chapters 5, 7, 8, and 9), and 
hence both more economically and environmentally efficient. Under these conditions, a new 
era of growth in the world economy can widen the options available to developing countries. 
77. Reforms at an international level are now needed to deal simultaneously with economic and 
ecological aspects in ways that allow the world economy to stimulate the growth of developing 
countries while giving greater weight to environmental concerns. Such an agenda requires deep
commitment by all countries to the satisfactory working of multilateral institutions, such as the 
multilateral development banks; to the making and observance of international rules in fields 
such as trade and investment; and to constructive dialogue on the many issues where national 
interests do not immediately coincide but where negotiation could help to reconcile them. 
78. The Commission therefore regrets but cannot ignore the recent decline in multilateral 
cooperation in general and a negative attitude to dialogue on development in particular. At first 
sight, the introduction of an environmental dimension further complicates the search for such 
cooperation and dialogue. But it also injects an additional element of mutual self-interest, since 
a failure to address the interaction between resource depletion and rising poverty will 
accelerate global ecological deterioration. 
79. New dimensions of multilateralism are essential to human progress. The Commission feels 
confident that the mutual interests involved in environment and development issues can help 
generate the needed momentum and can secure the necessary international economic changes 
that it will make possible. 
Footnotes 
1/ Department of International Economic and Social Affairs (DIESA), Doubling Development 
Finance: Meeting a Global Challenge. Views and Recommendations of the 
Committee on Development Planning (New York: UN, 1986) 
2/ Ibid. 
3/ World Bank, Financing Adjustment with Growth in Sub-Saharan Africa 
(Washington, DC, 1986). 
4/ IMF, World Economic Outlook, October 1986. 
5/ UN, World Economic Survey 1986 (New York, 1986). 
6/ World Bank, op. cit. 
7/ Ibid. 
8/ UN, General Assembly, 'The Critical Economic Situation in Africa: Report of the Secretary 
General', A/S-13/2, New York, 20 May 1986. 
9/ Organization of African Unity Assembly of Heads of State of Government, Africa's 
Priority Programme of Action 1986-1991 (Addis Ababa, 1985). 
10/ UN General Assembly, United Nations Programme of Action for African 
Economic Recovery and Development (New York, 1986). 
11/ World Bank, op. cit. 
12/ Bank of International Settlements, International Banking and Financial Markets 
Developments. (Basle, 1986). 
13/ Inter-American Development Bank, Economic and Social Progress in Latin 
America (Washington, DC, 1986).
14/ Unpublished data from UN Economic Commission on Latin America. 
15/ Ibid. 
16/ See, for example, UN, 'Programme of Action on a New International Economic Order', 
General Assembly Resolution 3202 (S-VI), 1 May 1974. 
17/ see GATT, International Trade 1985-86 (Geneva, 1986). 
18/ UNCTAD, Handbook of International Trade and Development Statistics, 1977 
and 1985 Supplements (New York: UN, 1977 and 1985). 
19/ Ibid. 
20/ UNCTAD, Statistical Pocketbook (New York: UN, 1984). 
21/ Ibid. 
22/ UNCTAD, Trade and Development Report (New York: UN, 1986). 
23/ Alister MacIntyre, UNCTAD, statement at WCED Public Hearings, Oslo, 1985. 
24/ The Common Fund is an international arrangement for the stabilization of prices for a 
group of commodities of particular interest to developing countries. The Second Window of the 
fund is meant to provide resources for promotional and research measures. 
25/ I. Halter and J.H. Loudon, 'Environmental Costs and the Patterns of North-South Trade', 
prepared for WCED, 1986. 
26/ Ibid. 
27/ UN Centre on Transnational Corporations, Transnational Corporations in World 
Development Third Survey (New York: UN, 1983). 
28/ Ibid. 
29/ Commonwealth Working Group, Technological Change (London: Commonwealth 
Secretariat, 1985). 
30/ The reference is to the activities of the international institutes that work under the 
umbrella of the Consultative Group on International Agricultural Research of the World Bank.
Our Common Future, Chapter 4: Population and Human Resources 
I. The Links with Environment and Development 
II. The Population Perspective 
1. Growth in Numbers 
2. Changes in Mobility 
3. Improved Health and Education 
III. A Policy Framework 
1. Managing Population Growth 
2. Managing Distribution and Mobility 
3. From Liability to Asset 
3.1 Improving Health 
3.2 Broadening Education 
3.3 Empowering Vulnerable Groups 
Footnotes 
Chapter 4: Population and Human Resources 
1. In 1985. some 80 million people were added to a world population of 4.8 billion. Each year 
the number of human beings increases, but the amount of natural resources with which to 
sustain this population, to improve the quality of human lives. and to eliminate mass poverty 
remains finite. On the other hand, expanding knowledge increases the productivity of 
resources. 
2. Present rates of population growth cannot continue. They already compromise many 
governments' abilities to provide education, health care, and food security for people, much 
less their abilities to raise living standards. This gap between numbers and resources is all the 
more compelling because so much of the population growth is concentrated in low-income 
countries, ecologically disadvantaged regions, and poor households. 
3. Yet the population issue is not solely about numbers. And poverty and resource degradation 
can exist on thinly populated lands, such as the drylands and the tropical forests. People are 
the ultimate resource. Improvements in education, health, and nutrition allow them to better 
use the resources they command, to stretch them further. In addition, threats to the 
sustainable use of resources come as much from inequalities in people's access to resources 
and from the ways in which they use them as from the sheer numbers of people. Thus concern 
over the 'population problem' also calls forth concern for human progress and human equality. 
4. Nor are population growth rates the challenge solely of those nations with high rates of 
increase. An additional person in an industrial country consumer far more and places far 
greater pressure on natural resources than an additional person in the Third World. 
Consumption patterns and preferences are as important as numbers of consumers in the 
conservation of resources.
5. Thus many governments must work on several fronts to limit population growth; to control 
the impact of such growth on resources and, with increasing knowledge, enlarge their range 
and improve their productivity; to realize human potential so that people can better husband 
and use resources; and to provide people with forms of social security other than large 
numbers of children. The means of accomplishing these goals will vary from country to 
country, but all should keep in mind that sustainable economic growth and equitable access to 
resources are two of the more certain routes towards lower fertility rates. 
6. Giving people the means to choose the size of their families is not just a method of keeping 
population in balance with resources; it is a way of assuring - especially for women the basic 
human right of self-determination. The extent to which facilities for exercising such choices are 
made available is itself a measure of a nation's development. In the same way. enhancing 
human potential not only promotes development but helps to ensure the right of all to a full 
and dignified life. 
I. The Links with Environment and Development 
7. Population growth and development are linked in complex ways. Economic development 
generates resources that can be used to improve education and health. These improvements, 
along with associated social changes, reduce both fertility and mortality rates. On the other 
hand, high rates of population growth that eat into surpluses available for economic and social 
development can hinder improvements in education and health. 
8. In the past, the intensification of agriculture and the production of higher yields helped 
nations cope with the increasing population pressures on available land. Migration and 
international trade in food and fuels eased the pressure on local resources. They permitted and 
helped sustain the high population densities of some industrialized countries. 
9. The situation is different in most of the developing world. There, improvements in medicine 
and public health have led to a sharp drop in mortality rates and have accelerated population 
growth rates to unprecedented levels. But fertility rates remain high; much human potential 
remains unrealized, and economic development is stalled. Agricultural intensification can go 
some way towards restoring a balance between food production and population, but there are 
limits beyond which intensification cannot go. (See Box 4-1.) 
10. The very possibility of development can be compromised by high population growth rates. 
Moreover, most developing countries do not have the resources to wait for a few generations 
before population stabilizes. The option of migration to new lands is virtually closed. And low 
levels of economic and social development combined with changing trade production 
relationships limit possibilities of using international trade to augment access to resources. 
Hence, in the absence of deliberate measures, the imbalance between population growth and 
resource development will worsen. 
11. Population pressure is already forcing traditional farmers to work harder, often on 
shrinking fame on marginal land, just to maintain household income. In Africa and Asia, rural 
population nearly doubled between 1950 and 1985, with a corresponding decline in land 
availability./1 Rapid population growth also creates urban economic and social problems that 
threaten to make cities wholly unmanageable. (See Chapter 9.) 
12. Larger investments will be needed just to maintain the current inadequate levels of access 
to education, health care, and other services. In many cases, the resources required are just 
not available. Health, housing conditions, and the quality of education and public services all
deteriorate; unemployment, urban drift, and social unrest increase. 
Box 4-1 
The Food/Population Balance 
The potential population-supporting capacity of land in developing countries 
has been assessed in a joint study by FAO and the International Institute for 
Applied Systems Analysis. Data on soil and land characteristics were combined 
with climatic data to calculate the potential yields of major crops, to select the 
optimum crops, and to derive the overall potential for calorie production. 
Three levels of crop production were calculated: the first at a low level of 
technology with no fertilizer or chemicals, traditional crop varieties, and no soil 
conservation; the second at an intermediate level, where the most productive 
crop mix is used on half the land along with fertilizers, improved varieties, and 
some soil conservation; and the third at a high level of technology with an ideal 
crop mix and technology on all lands. The population-supporting capacity was 
determined by dividing the total calorie production by a minimum per capita 
intake level. This figure was then compared with the medium-variant UN 
population projections. 
The 117 developing countries covered in the study, taken together, can produce 
enough food to feed one-and-a-half times their projected population in the year 
2000. even at a low level of technology. But the picture is less hopeful in the 
cases of individual countries. At the low level of technology, 64 countries with a 
population of around 1.1 billion lack the resources to feed themselves. With the 
most advanced agricultural methods, the number of countries where food 
production potential would fall short of requirements drops to 19, with a total 
population of 100 million. Most are high-income West Asian countries and 
some small island states. Many of these countries have the capacity to earn 
enough foreign exchange to import their food requirements. In the others, the 
real issue is the modernization of agriculture on a sustainable basis. 
Some researchers have assessed the 'theoretical' potential for global food 
production. One study assumes that the area under food production can be 
around 1.5 billion hectares (close to the current level) and that average yields 
could go up to 5 tons of grain equivalent per hectare (as against the present 
average of 2 tons of grain equivalent}. Allowing for production from rangelands 
and marine sources, the total 'potential' is placed at 8 billion tons of grain 
equivalent. 
How many people can this sustain? The present global average consumption of 
plant energy for food, seed, and animal feed amounts to about 6,000 calories 
daily, with a range among countries of 3,000-15,000 calories, depending on the 
level of meat consumption. On this basis, the potential production could 
sustain a little more than 11 billion people. But if the average consumption rises 
substantially - say, to 9,000 calories - the population carrying capacity of the 
Earth comes down to 7.5 billion. These figures could be substantially higher if 
the area under food production and the productivity of 3 billion hectares of 
permanent pastures ran be increased on a sustainable basis. Nevertheless, the 
data do suggest, that meeting the food needs of an ultimate world population of
around 10 billion would require tone changes in food habits, as well as greatly 
improving the efficiency of traditional agriculture. 
B. Gilland. 'Considerations on World Population and Food Supply'. Population and 
Development Review. Vol. 9. No. 2. pp. 203-11; G M. Higgins et al., Potential 
Population supporting Capacities of Lands in the Developing World 
(Rome: FAO. 1982); D.J. Maler (ed.). Rapid Population Growth and Human 
Carrying Capacity. Staff Working Papers No. 690 (Washington, D.C.: World Bank, 
1985). 
13. Industrial countries seriously concerned with high population growth rates in other parts of 
the world have obligations beyond simply supplying aid packages of family planning hardware. 
Economic development, through its indirect impact on social and cultural factors, lowers 
fertility rates. International policies that interfere with economic development thus interfere 
with a developing nation's ability to manage its population growth. A concern for population 
growth must therefore be a part of a broader concern for a more rapid rate of economic and 
social development in the developing countries. 
14. In the final analysis, and in both the developed and developing worlds, the population issue 
is about humane and not about numbers. It is misleading and an injustice to the human 
condition to see people merely fit; consumers. Their well being and security old age security, 
declining child mortality, health care, and so on are the goal o( development Almost any 
activity that increases well-being and security lessens peoples' desires to have more children 
than they and national ecosystems can support. 
II. The Population Perspective 
1. Growth in Numbers 
15. Population growth accelerated in the middle of the 18th century with the advent of the 
Industrial Revolution and associated improvements in agriculture, not just in the regions that 
are more developed but elsewhere as well. The recent phase of deceleration started around 
1950 with the sharp reduction in mortality rates in the developing countries. 
Since 1970 it has been fashionable to draw a distinction between population and 
environment as two crisis areas, but often times we forget that population is in fact 
a very integral part of the environment and therefore when we are addressing 
ourselves to population we are looking at not only the physical, biological, and 
chemical environments, we are also looking at the socio-cultural or socio-economic 
environment in which these development programmes are being set. 
And population makes much more sense if you are talking of population within a 
context. 
Dr. J.O. Oucho 
Population Studies and Research institute 
WCED Public Hearing 
Nairobi. 23 Sept 1986 
16. Between 1950 and 1985. world population grew at an annual rate of 1.9 per cent, compared
with 0.8 per cent in the half-century preceding 1950./2 population growth is now concentrated 
in the developing regions of Asia, Africa, and Latin America, which accounted for 85 per cent of 
the increase of global population since 1950. (See Table 4-1.) 
17. The processes of population growth are changing in most developing countries as birth and 
death rates fall. In the early 1950s, practically all developing countries had birth rates over 40 
and death rates over 20, the major exception being the low death rates in Latin America. 
(These rates refer to the annual number of births and deaths per 1,000 population.) Today the 
situation is quite different: 
Thirty-two per cent of the people in the Third World live in countries - such as China and 
the Republic of Korea - with birth rates below 25 and death rates below 10. 
Forty-one per cent are in countries where birth rates have fallen, but not as much as 
death rates, and their populations are growing at around 2 per cent - doubling, in other 
words, every 34 years. Such countries include Brazil, India, Indonesia, and Mexico. 
The remaining 27 per cent live in countries, such as Algeria, Bangladesh. Iran, and 
Nigeria, where death rates have fallen slightly but birth rates remain high. Overall 
population growth is in the range of 2.5 to 3 per cent (doubling every 28 to 23 years), 
with even higher growth rates in some countries, such as Kenya./3 
18. In the industrial world, fertility rates have declined and the population is not growing 
rapidly. In fact, it has stabilized in many countries. Still, the population in North America, 
Europe, the USSR, and Oceania is expected to increase by 230 million by the year 2025. which 
is as many people as live in the United States today. 
Table 4-1 
World Population 1950-85: Key Facts 
Size and Rates 
1950 1960 1970 1980 1985 
Total Population (billions) 
World 2.5 3.0 3.7 4.4 4.8 
More developed regions 0.83 0.94 1.05 1.14 1.17 
Less developed regions 1.68 2.07 2.65 3.31 3.66 
Annual Growth * (per cent) 
World 1.8 2.0 1.9 1.7 
More developed regions 1.3 1.0 0.8 0.6 
Less developed regions 2.1 2.5 2.3 2.0 
Urban Population (per cent)
World 29 34 37 40 41 
More developed regions 54 67 67 70 72 
Less developed regions 17 22 25 29 31 
* Data are for growth over previous decade or, for last column, over previous five years. 
Source: Department of International Economic and Social Affairs, World Population 
Prospects: Estimates and Projections as Assessed in 1984 (New York: UN, 1986) 
19. The acceleration of population growth in the Third World and the decline in fertility levels 
in industrial countries are (changing age distribution patterns radically. In developing 
countries, the young predominate. In 1900, 39 per cent of developing country populations 
were younger than 15; the figure for industrialized countries was only 23 per cent./4 Yet in 
these countries, the proportion of the elderly is growing. Those 65 or older accounted for 11 per 
cent of the population in 1980; in developing countries, they represented only 4 per cent./5 
Thus in the industrial world, relatively fewer people of working age will bear the burden of 
supporting relatively larger numbers of older people. 
20. A changing age structure helps to set patterns of future population growth. The large 
number of young people in developing countries means large numbers of future parents, so 
that even if each person produces fewer children. The total number of births will continue to 
increase. Population growth can continue to grow for some decades after fertility rates decline 
to the 'replacement level' of slightly over two children on average per couple. Thus in many 
nations, high population growth over the next few generations are assured. 
21. Population projections indicate an increase in global population from 4.8 billion in 1985 to 
6.1 billion by 2000, and to 8.2 billion by 2025. (See Table 4 2.) More than 90 pet cent of this 
increase is expected in developing regions. Large differences exist among countries in these 
areas, and the momentum of population growth is higher in Africa than in Latin America or 
Asia. In some developing countries, such as China, population growth rates are already well 
below 2 per cent and are expected to fall below 1 per cent by the beginning of the next 
century./6 
22. Reflecting the 'momentum' of population growth, long term UN projections show that at 
the global level: 
if replacement-level fertility is reached in 2010, global population will stabilize at 7.7 
billion by 2060; 
if this rate is reached in 2025, population will stabilize at 10.2 billion by 2095; 
if. however, the rate is reached only in 2065, global population in 2100 would be 14.2 
billion./7 
23. These projections show that the world has real choices. Policies to bring down fertility rates 
could make a difference of billions to the global population next century. The greater part of 
the differences between the three variants is accounted for by South Asia. Africa, and Latin 
America. Hence much depends on the effectiveness of population policies in these regions. 
2. Changes in Mobility 
24. The number of people in Europe, Japan. North America. and the Soviet Union quintupled
between 1750 and 1950. and these regions' share in world population increased sharply over 
thin period./8 By the latter part of the 19th century, there was growing concern about 
population pressures in Europe. Migration to North America, Australia, and New Zealand 
helped to some extent. At its peak between 1881 and 1910, permanent emigration absorbed 
nearly 20 per rent of the increase in population in Europe./9 
25. Today, however, migration in not a major factor in determining population distribution 
among countries. Between 1970 and 1980 permanent emigration as a percentage of population 
increase fell to 4 per cent in Europe and was only 2.5 per cent in Latin America. The 
corresponding percentages in Asia and Africa were very much lower./10 Thus the option of 
emigration to new lands has not been and will not be a significant element in relieving 
demographic pressures in developing countries In effect, this reduces the time available to 
bring population into balance with resources. 
26. Within countries, populations are more mobile. Improved communications have enabled 
large movements of people. Sometimes as a natural response to the growth of economic 
opportunities in different places. Some governments have actively encouraged migration from 
densely to sparsely settled areas. A more recent phenomenon is the flight of 'ecological 
refugees' from areas of environmental degradation. 
Table 4-2 
Current and Projected Population Size and Growth Rates* 
Population Annual Growth Rate 
1950 1985 2000 
1985 2000 2025 to to to 
1985 2000 2025 
Region (billion) (per cent) 
World 4.8 6.1 8.2 1.9 1.6 1.2 
Africa 0.66 0.87 1.62 2.6 3.1 2.5 
Latin America 0.41 0.55 0.78 2.6 2.0 1.4 
Asia 2.82 3.55 4.54 2.1 1.6 1.0 
North America 0.26 0.30 0.35 1.3 0.8 0.6 
Europe 0.49 0.51 0.52 0.7 0.3 0.1 
USSR 0.28 0.31 0.37 1.7 0.8 0.6 
Oceania 0.02 0.03 0.04 1.9 1.4 0.9 
* Medium-variant projections. 
Source: Department of International Economic and Social Affairs, World Population 
Prospects; Estimates and Projections as Assessed in 1984 (New York: UN, 1986).
27. Much of the movement is from countryside to city. (See Chapter 9.) In 1985. some 40 per 
cent of the world's population lived in cities; the magnitude of the urban drift can be seen in 
the fact that since 1950, the increase in urban population has been larger than the increase in 
rural population both in percentage and in absolute terms. This shift is most striking in 
developing countries, where the number of city-dwellers quadrupled during this period./11 
3. Improved Health and Education 
28. Improvements in the health and education of all, but especially of women and in 
conjunction with other social changes that raise the status of women, can have a profound 
effect in bringing down population growth rates. In an initial period, however, better health 
care means that more babies live to reproduce and that women reproduce over longer time 
spans. 
Table 4-3 
Health Indicators 
Life Expectancy at Birth Infant Mortality Rates 
1950-55 1980-85 1960-65 1980-85 
Region (years) (deaths per 1,000 live births) 
World 49.9 64.6 117 81 
Africa 37.5 49.7 157 114 
Asia 41.2 57.9 133 87 
South America 52.3 64.0 101 64 
North America 64.4 71.1 43 27 
Europe 65.3 73.2 37 16 
USSR 61.7 70.9 32 25 
Oceania 61.0 67.6 55 39 
Source: WCED, based on data in World Resources Institute / International Institute for 
Environment and Development, World Resources 1986 (New York: Basic Books, 1986). 
29. The 'health status' of a society is a complex concept that cannot be measured easily. Two 
widely available indicators that reflect at least some aspects of a given society's health are life 
expectancy and infant mortality rates. (See Table 4-3.) These statistics suggest that health has 
improved virtually everywhere; and, at least with regard to these two indicators, the gap 
between industrial and developing regions has narrowed. 
30. Many factors can increase life expectancy and reduce mortality rates: two are worth 
emphasizing. First, although generally speaking national wealth buys national health, some 
relatively poor nations and areas, such as China, Sri Lanka, and the Indian state of Kerala, have 
achieved remarkable success in lowering infant mortality and improving health through 
increases in education, especially of women; the establishment of primary health clinics; and
other health care programmes./12 Second, the principal reductions in mortality rates in the 
industrial world came about before the advent of modern drugs; they were due to improved 
nutrition, housing, and hygiene. The recent gains in developing countries have also been 
largely due to public health programmes, particularly for the control of communicable diseases. 
31. Education is another key dimension of 'population quality'. The past few decades have seen 
a great expansion of educational facilities in virtually all countries. In terms of school 
enrolment, literacy rates, the growth in technical education, and the development of scientific 
skills, much progress has been achieved. (See Table 4-4.) 
III. A Policy Framework 
32. Excessive population growth diffuses the fruits of development over increasing numbers 
instead of improving living standards in many developing countries: a reduction of current 
growth rates is an imperative for sustainable development. The critical issues are the balance 
between population size and available resources and the rate of population growth in relation 
to the capacity of the economy to provide for the basic needs of the population, not just today 
but for generations. Such a long-term view is necessary because attitudes to fertility rarely 
change rapidly and because, even after fertility starts declining, past increases in population 
impart a momentum of growth as people reach child-bearing age. However a nation proceeds 
towards the goals of sustainable development and lower fertility levels, the two are intimately 
linked and mutually reinforcing. 
33. Measures to influence population size cannot be effective in isolation from other 
environment/development issues. The number, density, movement, and growth rate of a 
population cannot be influenced in the short run if these efforts are being overwhelmed by 
adverse patterns of development in other areas. Population policies must have a broader focus 
than controlling numbers: Measures to improve the quality of human resources in terms of 
health, education, and social development are as important. 
34. A first step may be for governments to abandon the false division between 'productive' or 
'economic' expenditures and 'social' expenditures. Policymakers must realize that spending on 
population activities and on other efforts to raise human potential is crucial to a nation's 
economic and productive activities and to achieving sustainable human progress - the end for 
which a government exists. 
1. Managing Population Growth 
35. Progress in population policies is uneven. Some countries with serious population 
problems have comprehensive policies. Some go no further than the promotion of family 
planning. Some do not do even that. 
36. A population policy should set out and pursue broad national demographic goals in relation 
to other socio-economic objectives. Social and cultural factors dominate all others in affecting 
fertility. The most important of these is the roles women play in the family, the economy, and 
the society at large Fertility rates fall as women's employment opportunities outside the home 
and farm, their access to education, and their age at marriage all rise. Hence policies meant to 
lower fertility rates not only must include economic incentives and disincentives, but must aim 
to improve the position of women in society. Such policies should essentially promote women's 
rights. 
Table 4-4
Male and Female Enrolment Ratios, by Region, 1960 and 1982 
Male Female 
Region 1960 1982 1960 1982 
World 
First Level 92.2 101.3 7.1 87.3 
Second Level 31.3 53.3 23.1 42.5 
Africa 
First Level 56.2 89.2 32.0 72.1 
Second Level 7.3 29.6 2.9 19.5 
Latin America and Caribbean 
First Level 75.0 106.2 71.2 103.3 
Second Level 14.9 46.6 13.6 48.5 
North America 
First Level 117.4 119.7 116.4 119.9 
Second Level 69.4 85.4 71.4 86.6 
Asia 
First Level 94.9 100.1 63.1 79.9 
Second Level 29.3 49.3 16.6 32.9 
Europe and USSR 
First Level 103.4 105.4 102.7 104.5 
Second Level 46.5 76.2 44.6 81.3 
Oceania 
First Level 102.2 102.9 100.7 98.9 
Second Level 53.8 71.1 58.8 72.0 
Note; The figures are percentages of appropriate groups receiving a given level of education. 
As many older children are in primary school percentages can be over 100. 
Source: WCED, based on data in UNESCO, 'A Summary Statistical Review of Education in 
the World, 1960-1982, Paris, July 1984. 
37. Poverty breeds high rates of population growth: Families poor in income, employment, and 
social security need children first to work and later to sustain elderly parents. Measures to 
provide an adequate livelihood for poor households, to establish and enforce minimum-age 
child labour laws, and to provide publicly financed social security will all lower fertility rates.
Improved public health and child nutrition programmes that bring down infant mortality rates 
- so parents do not need 'extra' children as insurance against child death - can also help to 
reduce fertility levels. 
The environment is the business of everybody, development is the business of 
everybody, life and living is the business of everybody. I think the solution will be 
found in encouraging mass environmental literacy so that there can be democratic 
and literate decisions, because if decisions are taken by a few without the 
incorporation of the opinion of the masses, the NGOs especially included, the 
likelihood is that the situations will not succeed. They will be imposed from above, 
the people will not respond positively to them, and the project is lost before it is 
launched. 
Joseph Ouma 
Dean of School of Environmental Studies, Moi University 
WCED Public Hearing 
Nairobi, 23 Sept 1986 
38. All these programmes are effective in bringing down birth rates only when their benefits are 
shared by the majority. Societies that attempt to spread the benefits of economic growth to a 
wider segment of the population may do better at lowering birth rates than societies with both 
faster and higher levels of economic growth but a less even sharing of the benefits of that 
growth. 
39. Thus developing-country population strategies must deal not only with the population 
variable as such but also with the underlying social and economic conditions of 
underdevelopment. They must be multifaceted campaigns: to strengthen social, cultural, and 
economic motivations for couples to have small families and. through family planning 
programmes, to provide to all who want them the education, technological means, and services 
required to control family size. 
40. Family planning services in many developing countries suffer by being isolated from other 
programmes that reduce fertility and even from those that increase motivation to use such 
services. They remain separate both in design and implementation from such fertility-related 
programmes as nutrition, public health, mother and child care, and preschool education that 
take place in the same area and that are often funded by the same agency. 
41. Such services must therefore be integrated with other efforts to improve access to health 
care and education. The clinical support needed for most modern contraceptive methods 
makes family planning services heavily dependent on the health system. Some governments 
have successfully combined population programme: with health, education, and rural 
development projects, and implemented them as part of major socio-economic programmes in 
villages or regions. This integration increases motivation, improves access, and raises the 
effectiveness of investments in family planning. 
42. Only about 1.5 per cent of official development aid now goes for population assistance./13 
Regrettably, some donor countries have cut back on their assistance for multilateral population 
programmes and so weakened them; this must be reversed. 
43. Zimbabwe is one nation that has successfully integrated its family planning efforts not only 
with its rural health services but also with efforts to improve women's abilities to organize
group activities and earn money through their own labour. The government's initial efforts 
were aimed less at limiting population growth than at assisting women to space births in the 
interests of mother and child health and at helping infertile women to bear children. But 
gradually families have begun to use the contraceptives made available for child spacing as a 
way to limit fertility. Zimbabwe now leads sub-Saharan Africa in the use of modern 
contraceptive methods./14 
2. Managing Distribution and Mobility 
44. Population distribution across a country's different regions is influenced by the 
geographical spread of economic activity and opportunity. Most countries are committed in 
theory to balancing regional development, but are rarely able to do this in practice. 
Governments able to spread employment opportunities throughout their nations and 
especially through their countrysides will thus limit the rapid and often uncontrolled growth of 
one or two cities. China's effort to support village-level industries in the countryside is perhaps 
the most ambitious of this sort of national programme. 
45. Migration from countryside to city is not in itself a bad thing; it is part of the process of 
economic development and diversification. The issue is not so much the overall rural urban 
shift but the distribution of urban growth between large metropolitan cities and smaller urban 
settlements. (See Chapter 9.) 
46. A commitment to rural development implies more attention to realizing the development 
potential of all regions, particularly those that are ecologically disadvantaged (See Chapter 6.) 
This would help reduce migration from these areas due to lack of opportunities. But 
governments should avoid going too far in the opposite direction, encouraging people to cove 
into sparsely populated areas such as tropical moist forests, where the land may not be able to 
provide sustainable livelihoods. 
Demographic phenomena constitute the heart of the African Development 
problematique. They are the data that lead most analysts to project a continuing 
and deepening crisis in Africa. There is no doubt of the imperative and urgent need 
for a far reaching population policy to be adopted and vigorously implemented by 
African governments. 
One issue of relevance that requires further research is the use of the tax system 
as a means for controlling population growth and discouraging rural-urban 
migration. 
To slow down population growth, should families without children be given a tax 
incentive or tax break? Should a tax penalty be imposed for each child after a fixed 
number of children, considering that the tax system has not solved the population 
migration problem? 
Adebayo Adedeji 
Executive Director, Economic Commission for Africa 
WCED Public Hearing 
Harare, 18 Sept 1986 
3. From Liability to Asset
47. When a population exceeds the carrying capacity of the available resources, it can become a 
liability in efforts to improve people's welfare. But talking of population just as numbers 
glosses over an important point: People are also a creative resource, and this creativity is an 
asset societies must tap. To nurture and enhance that asset, people's physical well-being must 
be improved through better nutrition, health care, and so on. And education must be provided 
to help them become more capable and creative, skilful, productive, and better able to deal 
with day-to-day problems. All this has to be achieved through access to and participation in the 
processes of sustainable development. 
3.1 Improving Health 
We in Asia, I feel, want to have an equilibrium between the spiritual and material 
life. I noticed that you have tried to separate religion from the technological side of 
life. Is that not exactly, the mistake in the West in developing technology, without 
ethics, without religion? If that is the case, and we have the chance to develop a 
new direction, should we not advise the group on technology to pursue a different 
kind of technology which has as its base not only the rationality, but also the 
spiritual aspect? Is this a dream or is this something we cannot avoid? 
Speaker from the floor 
WCED Public Hearing 
Jakarta, 26 March 1985 
48. Good health is the foundation of human welfare and productivity. Hence a broad-based 
health policy is essential for sustainable development. In the developing world, the critical 
problems of ill health are closely related to environmental conditions and development 
problems. 
49. Malaria is the most important parasitic disease in the tropics, and its prevalence is closely 
related to wastewater disposal and drainage. Large dams and irrigation systems have led to 
sharp increases in the incidence of schistosomiasis (snail fever) in many areas. Inadequacies in 
water supply and sanitation are direct causes of other widespread and debilitating diseases 
such as diarrhoeas and various worm infestations. 
50. Though much has been achieved in recent years, 1.7 billion people lack access to clean 
water, and 1.2 billion to adequate sanitation./15 Many diseases can be controlled not just 
through therapeutic interventions but also through improvements in rural water supply, 
sanitation, and health education. In this sense, they really require a developmental solution. In 
the developing world, the number of water taps nearby is a better indication of the health of a 
community than is the number of hospital beds. 
51. Other examples of links between development, environmental conditions, and health 
include air pollution and the respiratory illnesses it brings, the impact of housing conditions on 
the spread of tuberculosis, the effects of carcinogens and toxic substances, and the exposure to 
hazards in the workplace and elsewhere. 
52. Many health problems arise from the nutritional deficiencies that occur in virtually all 
developing countries, but most acutely in low-income areas. Most malnutrition is related to a 
shortage of calories or protein or both, but some diets also lack specific elements and 
compounds, such as iron and iodine. Health will be greatly improved in low-income areas by
policies that lead to the production of more of the cheap foods the poor traditionally eat - 
coarse grains and root crops. 
53. These health, nutrition, environment, and development links imply that health policy 
cannot be conceived of purely in terms of curative or preventive medicine, or even in terms of 
greater attention to public health. Integrated approaches are needed that reflect key health 
objectives in areas such as food production; water supply and sanitation: industrial policy, 
particularly with regard to safety and pollution; and the planning of human settlements. 
Beyond this, it is necessary to identify vulnerable groups and their health risks and to ensure 
that the socio-economic factors that underlie these risks are taken into account in other areas 
of development policy. 
54. Hence. WHO's 'Health for All' strategy should be broadened far beyond the provision of 
medical workers and clinics, to cover health-related interventions in all development 
activities./16 Moreover, this broader approach must be reflected in institutional arrangements 
to coordinate all such activities effectively. 
55. Within the narrower area of health care, providing primary health care facilities and making 
sure that everyone has the opportunity to use them are appropriate starting points. Maternal 
and child health care are also particularly important. The critical elements here are relatively 
inexpensive and can have a profound impact on health and well-being. An organized system of 
trained birth attendants, protection against tetanus and other childbirth infections, and 
supplemental feeding can dramatically reduce maternal mortality. Similarly, low-cost 
programmes to assure immunization, teach and supply oral dehydration therapy against 
diarrhoeas, and encourage breast-feeding (which in turn can reduce fertility) can increase child 
survival rates dramatically. 
56. Health care must be supplemented by effective health education. Some parts of the Third 
World may soon face growing numbers of the illnesses associated with life-styles in industrial 
nations - cancer and heart disease especially. Few developing nations can afford the expensive 
treatment required for the latter diseases, and should begin efforts now to educate their 
citizens on the dangers of smoking and of high-fat diets. 
57. A rapid spread of acquired immune deficiency syndrome (AIDS) in both developed and 
developing nations could drastically alter all countries' health priorities. AIDS is threatening to 
kill millions of people and disrupt the economies of many countries. Governments should 
overcome any lingering shyness and rapidly educate their people about this syndrome and 
about the ways in which it is spread. International cooperation on research and the handling of 
the disease is essential. 
58. Another major health problem with international ramifications is the increase in drug 
addiction. It is a problem closely linked to organized crime in the production of drugs, in 
large-scale international traffic in these drugs, and in the networks for distribution. It distorts 
the economy in many poor producing areas and destroys people the world over. International 
cooperation is essential in tackling this scourge. Some countries have to deploy considerable 
financial resources to halt the production and traffic in narcotics and to promote crop 
diversification and rehabilitation schemes in the producing areas, which are generally 
impoverished. To sustain their efforts, greater international assistance is essential 
59. Most medical research focuses on pharmaceuticals, vaccines. and other technological 
interventions for disease management. Much of this research is directed at the diseases of 
industrialized countries, as their treatment accounts for a substantial part of the sales of 
pharmaceutical companies. More research is urgently needed on the environmentally related
tropical diseases that are the major health problem in the Third World, This research should 
focus not merely on new medicines, but also on public health measures to control these 
diseases. Existing arrangements for international collaboration on tropical disease research 
should be greatly strengthened. 
Education and communication are vitally important in order to impress each 
individual of his or her responsibility regarding the healthy future of the earth. The 
best way for students to recognize that their action can make a difference is to 
have projects organized by the school or community on which the students can 
work. Once convinced that they can help, people tend to change both their attitude 
and their behaviour. New attitudes towards the environment will be reflected in 
decisions at home and in corporate boardrooms around the world. 
Bernice Goldsmith 
Student, North Toronto Collegiate 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
3.2 Broadening Education 
60. Human resource development demands knowledge and skills to help people improve their 
economic performance. Sustainable development requires changes in values and attitudes 
towards environment and development - indeed, towards society and work at home, on farms, 
and in factories. The world's religions could help provide direction and motivation in forming 
new values that would stress individual and joint responsibility towards the environment and 
towards nurturing harmony between humanity and environment. 
61. Education should also be geared towards making people more capable of dealing with 
problems of overcrowding and excessive population densities, and better able to improve what 
could be called 'social carrying capacities'. This is essential to prevent ruptures in the social 
fabric, and schooling should enhance the levels of tolerance and empathy required for living in 
a crowded world. Improved health, lower fertility, and better nutrition will depend on greater 
literacy and social and civic responsibility. Education can induce all these, and can enhance a 
society's ability to overcome poverty, increase incomes, improve health and nutrition, and 
reduce family size. 
62. The investment in education and the growth in school enrolment during the past few 
decades are signs of progress. Access to education is increasing and will continue to do so. 
Today almost all the world's boys are getting some form of primary education. In Asia and 
Africa, however, enrolment rates for girls are much lower than for boys at all levels. A large gap 
also exists between developed and developing countries in enrolment rates beyond primary 
schools, as Table 4-4 indicated. 
63. UN projections of enrolment rates for the year 2000 suggest a continuation of these 
trends. Thus despite the growth in primary education, illiteracy will continue to rise in terms of 
sheer numbers: there will be more than 900 million people unable to read and write at the end 
of the century. By then, girls' enrolment rates are still expected to be below the current rates 
for boys in Asia. As for secondary education, developing countries are not expected to attain 
even the 1960 industrial country levels by the year 2000./17
64. Sustainable development requires that these trends be corrected. The main task of 
education policy must be to make literacy universal and to close the gaps between male and 
female enrolment rates. Realizing these goals would improve individual productivity and 
earnings, as well as personal attitudes to health, nutrition, and child-bearing. It can also instill 
a greater awareness of everyday environmental factors. Facilities for education beyond primary 
school must be expanded to improve skills necessary for pursuing sustainable development. 
65. A major problem confronting many countries is the widespread unemployment and the 
unrest that it leads to. Education has often been unable to provide the skills needed for 
appropriate employment. This is evident in the large numbers of unemployed people who have 
been trained for white-collar employment in swelling urban populations. Education and 
training should also be directed towards the acquisition of practical and vocational skills, and 
particularly towards making people more self-reliant. All this should be supported by efforts to 
nurture the informal sector and the participation of community organizations. 
66. Providing facilities is only the beginning. Education must be improved in quality and in 
relevance to local conditions. In many areas, it should be integrated with children's 
participation in farm work, a process requiring flexibility in the school system. It should impart 
knowledge relevant for the proper management of local resources. Rural schools must teach 
about local soils, water, and the conservation of both, about deforestation and how the 
community and the individual can reverse it. Teachers must be trained and the curriculum 
developed so that students learn about the agricultural balance sheet of an area. 
67. Most people base their understanding of environmental processes and development on 
traditional beliefs or on information provided by a conventional education. Many thus remain 
ignorant about ways in which they could improve traditional production practices and better 
protect the natural resource base. Education should therefore provide comprehensive 
knowledge, encompassing and cutting across the social and natural sciences and the 
humanities, thus providing insights on the interaction between natural and human resources, 
between development and environment. 
68. Environmental education should be included in and should run throughout the other 
disciplines of the formal education curriculum at all levels - to foster a sense of responsibility 
for the state of the environment and to teach students how to monitor, protect, and improve it. 
These objectives cannot be achieved without the involvement of students in the movement for 
a better environment, through such things as nature clubs and special interest groups. Adult 
education, on-the-job training, television, and other less formal methods must be used to reach 
out to as wide a group of individuals as possible, as environmental issues and knowledge 
systems now change radically in the space of a lifetime. 
69. A critical point of intervention is during teacher training. The attitudes of teachers will be 
key in increasing understanding of the environment and its. links with development. To 
enhance the awareness and capabilities of teachers in this area, multilateral and bilateral 
agencies must provide support for the relevant curriculum development in teacher training 
institutions, for the preparation of teaching aids, and for other similar activities. Global 
awareness could be fostered by encouraging contacts among teachers from different countries, 
for instance in specialized centres set up for this purpose. 
I am here as the son of a small nation, the Krenak Indian Nation. We live in the 
valley of the Rio Doce. which is the frontier of Espirito Santo with the State of 
Minas Gerais. We are a micro-country - a micro-nation.
When the government took our land in the valley of Rio Doce, they wanted to give 
us another place somewhere else. But the State, the government will never 
understand that we do not have another place to go. 
The only possible place for the Krenak people to live and to re-establish our 
existence, to speak to our Gods, to speak to our nature, to weave our lives is 
where our God created us. It is useless for the government to put us in a very 
beautiful place, in a very good place with a lot of hunting and a lot of fish. The 
Krenak people, we continue dying and we die insisting that there is only one place 
for us to live. 
My heart does not become happy to see humanity's incapacity. I have no pleasure 
at all to come here and make these statements. We can no longer see the planet 
that we live upon as if it were a chess-board where people just move things 
around. We cannot consider the planet as something isolated from the cosmic. 
We are not idiots to believe that there is possibility of life for us outside of where 
the origin of our life is. Respect our place of living, do not degrade our living 
condition, respect this life. We have no arms to cause pressure, the only thing we 
have is the right to cry for our dignity and the need to live in our land. 
Ailton Krenak 
Coordinator of Indian Nations Union 
WCED Public Hearing 
Sao Paulo. 28-29 Oct 1985 
3.3 Empowering Vulnerable Groups 
70. The processes of development generally lead to the gradual integration of local 
communities into a larger social and economic framework. But some communities - so-called 
indigenous or tribal peoples - remain isolated because of such factors as physical barriers to 
communication or marked differences in social and cultural practices. Such groups are found in 
North America, in Australia, in the Amazon Basin, in Central America, in the forests and hills of 
Asia, in the deserts of North Africa, and elsewhere. 
71. The isolation of many such people has meant the preservation of a traditional way of life in 
close harmony with the natural environment. Their very survival has depended on their 
ecological awareness and adaptation. But their isolation has also meant that few of them have 
shared in national economic and social development; this may be reflected in their poor health, 
nutrition, and education. 
72. With the gradual advance of organized development into remote regions, these groups are 
becoming less isolated. Many live in areas rich in valuable natural resources that planners and 
'developers' want to exploit, and this exploitation disrupts the local environment so as to 
endanger traditional ways of life. The legal and institutional changes that accompany organized 
development add to such pressures. 
73. Growing interaction with the larger world is increasing the vulnerability of these groups, 
since they are often left out of the processes of economic development. Social discrimination, 
cultural barriers, and the exclusion of these people from national political processes makes 
these groups vulnerable and subject to exploitation. Many groups become dispossessed and
marginalized, and their traditional practices disappear. They become the victims of what could 
be described as cultural extinction. 
74. These communities are the repositories of vast accumulations of traditional knowledge and 
experience that links humanity with its ancient origins. Their disappearance is a loss for the 
larger society, which could learn a great deal from their traditional skills in sustainably 
managing very complex ecological systems. It is a terrible irony that as formal development 
reaches more deeply into rain forests, deserts, and other isolated environments, it tends to 
destroy the only cultures that have proved able to thrive in these environments. 
75. The starting point for a just and humane policy for such groups is the recognition and 
protection of their traditional rights to land and the other resources that sustain their way of 
life - rights they may define in terms that do not fit into standard legal systems. These groups' 
own institutions to regulate rights and obligations are crucial for maintaining the harmony with 
nature and the environmental awareness characteristic of the traditional way of life. Hence the 
recognition of traditional rights must go hand in hand with measures to protect the local 
institutions that enforce responsibility in resource use. And this recognition must also give 
local communities a decisive voice in the decisions about resource use in their area. 
76. Protection of traditional rights should be accompanied by positive measures to enhance the 
well-being of the community in ways appropriate to the group's life-style. For example, 
earnings from traditional activities can be increased through the introduction of marketing 
arrangements that ensure a fair price for produce, but also through steps to conserve and 
enhance the resource base and increase resource productivity. 
77. Those promoting policies that have an impact on the lives of an isolated, traditional people 
must tread a fine line between keeping them in artificial, perhaps unwanted isolation and 
wantonly destroying their life-styles. Hence broader measures of human resource development 
are essential. Health facilities must be provided to supplement and improve traditional 
practices; nutritional deficiencies have to be corrected, and educational institutions 
established. These steps should precede new projects that open up an area to economic 
development. Special efforts should also be made to ensure that the local community can 
derive the full benefit of such projects, particularly through jobs. 
78. In terms of sheer numbers, these isolated, vulnerable groups are small. But their 
marginalization is a symptom of a style of development that tends to neglect both human and 
environmental considerations. Hence a more careful and sensitive consideration of their 
interests is a touchstone of a sustainable development policy. 
Footnotes 
1/ Department of International Economic and Social Affairs (DIESA). World Population 
Prospects; Estimates and Projections as Assessed in 1984 (New York: United Nations, 
1986). 
2/ Ibid. 
3/ Based on data from UNCTAD, Handbook of International Trade and Development 
Statistics 1985 Supplement (New York: 1985). 
4/ World Bank, World Development Report 1984 (New York: Oxford University Press, 
1984).
5/ Ibid. 
6/ DIESA. op. cit. 
7/ UN. Population Bulletin of the United Nations. No. 14. 1982 (New York: 1983). 
8/ C. Clark, Population Growth and Land Use (New York: St. Martin's Press. 1957). 
9/ World Bank. op. cit. 
10/ Ibid. 
11/ DIESA, op. cit. 
12/ WHO, Intersectoral Linkages and Health Development, Case Studies in India 
(Kerala State), Jamaica. Norway. Sri Lanka and Thailand (Geneva: 1984). 
13/ World Bank, op. cit. 
14/ L. Timberlake. Only One Earth: Living for the Future (London: BBC/Earthscan. 
1987). 
15/ UNEP, The State of the Environment: Environment and Health (Nairobi: 1986). 
16/ WHO. Global Strategy for Health for All by the Year 2000 (Geneva: 1981). 
17/ UNESCO. A Summary Statistical Review of Education in the World. 1960-82 
(Paris: 1984).
Our Common Future, Chapter 5: Food Security: Sustaining The 
Potential 
I. Achievements 
II. Signs of Crisis 
1. Impact of Subsidies 
2. Neglect of the Small Producer 
3. Degradation of the Resource Base 
3.1 Loss of Soil Resources 
3.2 Impact of Chemicals 
3.3 Pressure on Forests 
3.4 Advancing Deserts 
III. The Challenge 
IV. Strategies for Sustainable Food Security 
1. Government Intervention 
2. A Global Perspective 
3. The Resource Base 
3.1 Land Use 
3.2 Water Management 
3.3 Alternatives to Chemicals 
3.4 Forestry and Agriculture 
3.5 Aquaculture 
4. Productivity and yields 
4.1 The Technological Base 
4.2 Human Resources 
4.3 Productivity of Inputs 
5. Equity 
5.1 Land Reforms 
5.2 Subsistence Farmers and Pastoralists 
5.3 Integrated Rural Development 
5.4 Food Availability Fluctuations 
V. Food for the Future 
Footnotes 
Chapter 5 
Food Security: Sustaining The Potential 
1. The world produces more food per head of population today than ever before in human 
history. In 1985, it produced nearly 500 kilogrammes per head of cereals and root crops, the 
primary sources of food./1 Yet amid this abundance, more than 730 million people did not eat 
enough to lead fully productive working lives./2 There are places where too little is grown;
there are places where large numbers cannot afford to buy food. And there are broad areas of 
the Earth, in both industrial and developing nations, where increases in food production are 
undermining the base for future production. 
2. The agricultural resources and the technology needed to feed growing populations are 
available. Much has been achieved over the past few decades. Agriculture does not lack 
resources; it lacks policies to ensure that the food is produced where it is needed and in a 
manner that sustains the livelihoods of the rural poor. He can meet this challenge by building 
on our achievements and devising new strategies for sustaining food and livelihood security. 
I. Achievements 
3. Between 1950 and 1985, cereal production outstripped population growth, increasing from 
around 700 million tons to over 1,800 million tons, an annual growth rate of around 2.7 per 
cent./3 This increase helped to meet escalating demands for cereals caused by population 
growth and rising incomes in developing countries and by growing needs for animal feed in 
developed countries. Yet regional differences in performance have been large. (See Table 5-1.) 
4. As production has increased sharply in some regions and demand in others, the pattern of 
world trade in foods, especially cereals, has changed radically. North America exported barely 5 
million tons of foodgrains yearly before the Second World War; it exported nearly 120 million 
tons during the 1980s. Europe's grain deficit is very much lower now. and the bulk of North 
American exports are to the USSR. Asia, and Africa. Three countries - China, Japan, and the 
USSR - took half the world exports in the early 1980s; much of the rest went to relatively 
wealthy developing countries, such as Middle Eastern oil exporters. Several poor agricultural 
countries, especially in sub-Saharan Africa, have become net importers of foodgrains. Still, 
although one-fourth of sub-Saharan Africa's population relied on imported grains in 1984, that 
region's imports have accounted for less than 10 per cent of world grain trade thus far in the 
1980s./4 
Table 5-1 
Two Decades of Agricultural Development 
Per Capita 
Food Production 
(Index 1961-64 = 
100) 
Per Capita 
Gross Cropped 
Area 
(Hectares) 
Per Hectare 
Fertilizer use 
(kg.) 
1961-64 1981-84 1964 1984 1964 1984 
World 100 112 0.44 0.31 29.3 85.3 
North America 100 121 1.05 0.90 47.3 93.2 
Western Europe 100 131 0.11 0.25 114.4 124.1 
Eastern Europe and USSR 100 128 0.84 0.71 30.4 122.1 
Africa 100 88 0.74 0.35 1.8 9.7 
Near East* 100 107 0.53 0.35 6.9 53.6
Far East** 100 116 0.10 0.20 4.4 45.4 
Latin America 100 108 0.49 0.45 11.6 11.4 
CPE's of Asia*** 100 135 0.17 0.10 15.5 170.3 
* An FAO grouping that includes West Asia plus Egypt, Libya and Sudan 
** An FAO grouping that covers South and South-East Asia excluding the centrally planned 
economies of Asia. 
*** An FAO grouping of Centrally Planned Economies of Asia which covers China, 
Kampuchea, North Korea. Mongolia and Vietnam. 
5. Other foods besides grains are changing the patterns of world food demand and production. 
Demand for milk and meat is growing as incomes rise in societies that prefer animal protein. 
and much agricultural development in the industrialized nations has been devoted to meeting 
these demands. In Europe, meat production more than tripled between 1950 and 1984, and 
milk production nearly doubled./5 Meat production for exports increased sharply, particularly 
in the rangelands of Latin America and Africa. World meat exports have risen from around 2 
million tons in 1950-52 to over 11 million tons in 1984./6 
6. To produce this milk and meat required in 1984 about 1.4 billion cattle and buffaloes, 1.6 
billion sheep and goats, 800 million pigs, and a great deal of poultry - all of which weigh more 
than the people on the planet./7 Most of these animals graze or browse or are fed local plants 
collected for them. However, rising demands for livestock feedgrains led to sharp increases in 
the production of cereals such as corn, which accounted for nearly two-thirds of the total 
increase in grain production in North America and Europe between 1950 and 1985. 
7. This unprecedented growth in food production has been achieved partly by an extension of 
the production base: larger cropped areas, more livestock, more fishing vessels, and so on. But 
most of it is due to a phenomenal rise in productivity. Population increases have meant a 
decline in the area of cropped land in most of the world in per capita terms. And as the 
availability of arable land has declined, planners and farmers have focused on increasing 
productivity. In the past 35 years this has been achieved by: 
using new seed varieties designed to maximize yields, facilitate multiple cropping, and 
resist disease; 
applying more chemical fertilizers, the consumption of which rose more than ninefold/8; 
using more pesticides and similar chemicals, the use of which increased thirty-two- 
fold/9; and 
increasing irrigated area, which more than doubled./10 
8. Global statistics mask substantial regional differences. (See Box 5-1.) The impacts of new 
technology have been uneven, and in some respects the agricultural technology gap has 
widened. For instance, average African foodgrain productivity declined in relation to European 
productivity from roughly one-half to about one-fifth over the past 35 years. Even in Asia, 
where new technology has spread rapidly, productivity in relation to European levels 
dropped./11 Similar 'technology gaps' have emerged between regions within countries. 
9. The past few decades have seen the emergence of three broad types of food production 
systems, 'Industrial agriculture', capital- and input-intensive and usually large-scale, is 
dominant in North America, Western and Eastern Europe, Australia and New Zealand, and in
some small areas in developing countries. 'Green Revolution agriculture' is found in uniform, 
resource-rich, often flat and irrigated areas in the agricultural heartlands of some developing 
countries. It is more widespread in Asia but is also found in parts of Latin America and North 
Africa. Though initially the new technologies may have favoured large farmers, they are today 
accessible to a growing number of small producers. 'Resource-poor agriculture' relies on 
uncertain rain rather than irrigation and is usually found in developing regions difficult to farm 
- drylands, highlands, and forests - with fragile soils. This includes most of sub-Saharan Africa 
and the remoter areas of Asia and Latin America. Here, per capita production has been 
declining and hunger is a critical problem. But today, all three systems of food production 
display signs of crises that endanger their growth. 
II. Signs of Crisis 
10. Agricultural policies in practically all countries have focused on output growth. Despite 
this, it has proved far more difficult to raise world agricultural output by a consistent 3 per cent 
a year in the mid-1980s than it was in the mid-1950s. Moreover, production records have been 
offset by the appearance 
Box 5-1 Regional Perspectives on Agricultural Development 
Africa 
a drop in per capita food output of about 1 per cent a year since the beginning of 
the 1970s 
a focus on cash crops and a growing dependence on imported food, fostered by 
pricing policies and foreign exchange compulsions 
major gaps in infrastructure for research, extension, input supply, and 
marketing 
degradation of the agricultural resource base due to desertification, droughts, 
and other processes 
large untapped potential of arable land, irrigation, and fertilizer use 
West Asia and North Africa 
improvements in productivity due to better irrigation, the cultivation of 
high-yielding varieties, and higher fertilizer use 
limited arable land and considerable amounts of desert, making food 
self-sufficiency a challenge 
a need for controlled irrigation to cope with dry conditions 
South and East Asia 
increased production and productivity, with some countries registering grain surpluses 
rapid growth in fertilizer use in some countries and extensive development of 
irrigation 
government commitments to be self-reliant in food, leading to national 
research centres, development of high-yielding seeds, and the fostering of 
location-specific technologies 
little unused land, and extensive, unabated deforestation 
growing numbers of rural landless
Latin America 
declining food imports since 1980, as food production kept pace with 
population growth over the last decade 
government support in the form of research centres to develop high-yielding 
seeds and other technologies 
inequitable distribution of land 
deforestation and degradation of the agricultural resource base, fueled partly 
by foreign trade and debt crisis 
a huge land resource and high productivity potential, though most of the 
potentially arable land is in the remote, lightly populated Amazon Basin, where 
perhaps only 20 per cent of the land is suitable for sustainable agriculture 
North America and Western Europe 
North America the world's leading source of surplus foodgrain, though the rate 
of increase in output per hectare and in total productivity slowed in the 1970s 
subsidies for production that are ecologically and economically expensive 
depressing effect of surpluses on world markets and consequent impact on 
developing countries 
a resource base increasingly degraded through erosion, acidification, and water 
contamination 
in North America, some scope for future agricultural expansion in frontier 
areas that can be intensively farmed only at high cost 
Eastern Europe and the Soviet Union 
food deficits met through imports, with the Soviet Union being the world's 
largest grain importer 
increased government investment in agriculture accompanied by eased farm 
distribution and organization to meet desires for food self-reliance, leading to 
production increases in meat and root crops 
pressures on agricultural resources through soil erosion. acidification, 
salinization, alkalization, and water contamination of linked economic and 
ecological crises: Industrialized countries are finding it increasingly difficult to 
manage their surplus food production, the livelihood base of millions of poor 
producers in developing countries is deteriorating, and the resource base for 
agriculture is under pressure virtually everywhere. 
1. Impact of Subsidies 
11. The food surpluses in North America and Europe result mainly from subsidies and other 
incentives that stimulate production even in the absence of demand. Direct or indirect 
subsidies, which now cover virtually the entire food cycle, have become extremely expensive. In 
the United States, the cost of farm support has grown from $2.7 billion in 1980 to $25.8 billion 
in 1986. In the EEC, such costs have risen from $6.2 billion in 1976 to $21.5 billion in 1986./12 
12. It has become politically more attractive, and usually cheaper, to export surpluses - often as 
food aid - rather than to store them. These heavily subsidized surpluses depress the 
international market prices of commodities such as sugar and have created severe problems for 
several developing countries whose economies are based on agriculture. Non-emergency food
aid and low-priced imports also keep down prices received by Third World farmers and reduce 
the incentive to improve domestic food production. 
13. The environmental consequences of a heavily subsidized production system are becoming 
evident within industrialized nations/13; 
lower productivity as soil quality declines due to intensive soil cultivation and overuse of 
chemical fertilizers and pesticides/14; 
the destruction of the countryside, through clearing of hedgerows, park: belts, and other 
protective cover and the levelling, occupation, and cultivation of marginal land and 
watershed protection areas; and 
nitrate pollution of ground-water aquifers due to the often subsidized overuse of nitrate 
fertilizers, 
14. The financial, economic, and environmental effects of the current incentive systems are 
beginning to be questioned by many governments and groups, including farm organizations. A 
particular area of concern is the impact of these policies on developing countries. They depress 
international prices of products, such as rice and sugar, that are important exports for many 
developing countries and so reduce exchange earnings of developing countries. They increase 
the instability of world prices. And they discourage the processing of agricultural commodities 
in the producing countries./15 
15. It is in the interests of all, including the farmers, that the policies be changed. Indeed, in 
recent years some conservation-oriented changes have taken place and some subsidy systems 
have increasingly stressed the need to retire land from production. The financial and economic 
burden of subsidies must be reduced. The harm that these policies do to the agriculture of 
developing countries by disrupting world markets must be eliminated. 
2. Neglect of the Small Producer 
16. The new technology behind increases in agricultural productivity requires scientific and 
technological skills, a system for technology extension and other services for farmers, and 
commercial orientation in farm management. In many' parts of Asia, in particular, small 
farmers have shown a remarkable capacity to use new technology once they are given 
incentives and adequate financial and infrastructural support. Small cash-crop farmers in 
Africa have demonstrated the potential of the smallholder on that continent, and in the last few 
years successes have been recorded in food crops also. But ecologically disadvantaged areas 
and land-poor rural masses have not benefited from advances in technology and will not until 
governments are willing and able to redistribute land and resources, and give them the 
necessary support and incentives. 
17. Agricultural support systems seldom take into account the special circumstances of 
subsistence farmers and herders. subsistence farmers cannot afford the high cash outlay of 
modern inputs. Many are shifting cultivators who do not have a clear title to the land they use. 
They may plant a variety of crops on one plot to meet their own needs, and are thus unable to 
use methods developed for large stands of a single crop. 
18. Many herders are nomadic and difficult to reach with education, advice, and equipment. 
They, like subsistence farmers, depend on certain traditional rights, which are threatened by 
commercial developments. They herd traditional breeds, which are hardy but rarely highly 
productive. 
19. Women farmers, though they play a critical role in food production, are often ignored by
programmes meant to improve production. In Latin America, the Caribbean, and Asia they 
form a large agricultural labour force, while most of sub-Saharan Africa's food is grown by 
women. Yet almost all agricultural programmes tend to neglect the special needs of women 
farmers. 
I think that at a forum like this there always tends to be someone standing up and 
saying you forgot my issue. I think my serious sensitivity to women!s role vis-a-vis 
the environment. 
Especially in Africa, I think it has been clearly stated over and again that women 
are responsible for between 60 to 90 per cent of the food production, processing, 
and marketing. No one can really address the food crisis in Africa or many of the 
other crises that seem to exist here without addressing the question of women, and 
really seeing that women are participants in decision-making processes at the very 
basic all the way through up the highest level. 
Mrs. King 
The Greenbelt Movement 
WCED Public Hearing 
Nairobi. 23 Sept 1986 
3. Degradation of the Resource Base 
20. Short-sighted policies are leading to degradation of the agricultural resource base on 
almost every continent: soil erosion in North America: soil acidification in Europe; 
deforestation and desertification in Asia. Africa, and Latin America; and waste and pollution of 
water almost everywhere. Within 40-70 years, global warming may cause the flooding of 
important coastal production areas. Some of these effects arise from trends in energy use and 
industrial production. Some arise from the pressure of population on limited resources. But 
agricultural policies emphasizing increased production at the expense of environmental 
considerations have also contributed greatly to this deterioration. 
3.1 Loss of Soil Resources 
21. Increases in cropped areas in recent decades have often extended cultivation in marginal 
lands prone to erosion. By the late 1970s, soil erosion exceeded soil formation on about a third 
of U.S. cropland, much of it in the midwestern agricultural heartland./16 In Canada, soil 
degradation has been costing farmers $1 billion a year./17 In the USSR, the extension of 
cultivation to the so-called Virgin Lands was a major plank of agricultural policy, but now it is 
believed that much of this land is marginal./18 In India, soil erosion affects 25-30 per cent of 
the total land under cultivation./19 Without conservation measures, the total area of rainfed 
cropland in developing countries in Asia, Africa, and Latin America would shrink by 544 million 
hectares over the long term because of soil erosion and degradation, according to an FAO 
study./20 
22. Erosion makes soil less able to retain water, depletes it of nutrients, and reduces the depth 
available for the roots to take hold. Land productivity declines. Eroded topsoil is carried to 
rivers. lakes, and reservoirs, silts up ports and waterways, reduces reservoir storage capacity, 
and increases the incidence and severity of floods.
23. Poorly designed and implemented irrigation systems have caused waterlogging, 
salinization, and alkalization of soils. FAO and UNESCO estimate that as much as half the 
world's irrigation schemes suffer in some degree from these problems./21 These estimates 
indicate that some 10 million hectares of irrigated land are being abandoned each year. 
24. Soil degradation erodes the overall resource base for agriculture. The loss of croplands 
encourages farmers to overuse the remaining land and to move into forests and onto 
rangelands. Sustainable agriculture cannot be based on methods that mine and deplete the 
soil, 
3.2 Impact of Chemicals 
25. Chemical fertilizers and pesticides have played a large role in production increases since 
the Second World War, but clear warnings have been raised against over-reliance on them. The 
run-off of nitrogen and phosphates from excess use of fertilizers damages water resources, and 
such damage is spreading. 
26. Using chemicals to control insects, pests, weeds, and fungi enhances productivity, but 
overuse threatens the health of humans and the lives of other species. Continuing, long-term 
exposure to pesticide and chemical residues in food, water, and even in the air is hazardous, 
particularly to children. A 1983 study estimated that approximately 10.000 people died each 
year in developing countries from pesticide poisoning and about 400,000 suffered acutely./22 
The effects are not limited to the area where pesticides are used but travel through the food 
chain. 
27. Commercial fisheries have been depleted, bird species endangered, and insects that prey on 
pests wiped out. The number of pesticide-resistant insect pest species worldwide has 
increased and many resist even the newest chemicals. The variety and severity of pest 
infestations multiply, threatening the productivity of agriculture in the areas concerned. 
28, The use of agricultural chemicals is not in itself harmful. In fact, the level of use is still quite 
low in many regions. In these areas, response rates are high and the environmental 
consequences of residues are not yet a problem. Hence these regions would benefit by using 
more agrochemicals. However, the growth in the use of chemicals tends to be concentrated 
precisely where they may be doing more overall harm than good. 
3.3 Pressure on Forests 
29. Forests are crucial for maintaining and improving the productivity of agricultural land. Yet 
agricultural expansion, a growing world timber trade, and woodfuel demand have destroyed 
much forest cover. Although this destruction has occurred worldwide, today the greatest 
challenge is in developing countries, particularly in tropical forests. (See Chapter 6.) 
30. Growing populations and the decreasing availability of arable land lead poor farmers in 
these countries to seek new land in forests to grow more food. Some government policies 
encourage the conversion of forests to pastures and others encourage large resettlement 
schemes in forests. There is nothing inherently wrong with clearing forests for farming, 
provided that the land is the best there is for new farming, can support the numbers 
encouraged to settle upon it, and is not already serving a more useful function, such as 
watershed protection. But often forests are cleared without forethought or planning.
31. Deforestation most severely disrupts mountainous areas and upland watersheds and the 
ecosystems that depend on them. The uplands influence precipitation, and the state of their 
soil and vegetation systems influence how this precipitation is released into the streams and 
rivers and onto the croplands of the plains below. The growing numbers and growing severity 
of both floods and droughts in many parts of the world have been linked to the deforestation of 
upland watersheds./23 
3.4 Advancing Deserts 
32. Some 29 per cent of the earth's land area suffers slight, moderate, or severe desertification; 
an additional 6 per cent is classified as extremely severely desertified./24 In 1984, the world's 
drylands supported some 850 million people, of whom 230 million were on lands affected by 
severe desertification./25 
33. The process of desertification affects almost every region of the globe, but it is most 
destructive in the drylands of South America, Asia, and Africa; for these three areas combined. 
18.5 per cent (870 million hectares) of productive lands are severely desertified. Of the 
drylands in developing countries. Africa's Sudano-Sahelian zones and, to a lesser extent, some 
countries south of this zone suffer the most. In their arid and semi-arid lands are to be found 
80 per cent of the moderately affected and 85 per cent of the severely affected people./26 
34. Land permanently degraded to desert-like conditions continues to grow at an annual rate 
of 6 million hectares./27 Each year. 21 million additional hectares provide no economic return 
because of the spread of desertification./28 These trends are expected to continue despite 
some local improvements. 
35, Desertification is caused by a complex mix of climatic and human effects. The human 
effects, over which we have more control, include the rapid growth of both human and animal 
populations, detrimental land use practices (especially deforestation), adverse terms of trade, 
and civil strife. The cultivation of cash crops on unsuitable rangelands has forced herders and 
their cattle onto marginal lands. The unfavourable international terms of trade for primary 
products and the policies of aid donors have reinforced pressures to encourage increasing 
cash-crop production at any cost. 
36. A Plan of Action conceived by UNEP and drawn up at the 1977 UN Conference on 
Desertification has led to some slight, mainly local gains./29 Progress on the plan has been 
hampered by lack of financial support from the international community, by inadequacies of 
the regional organizations established to respond to the regional nature of the problem, and by 
the lack of involvement of grass-roots communities. 
Small farmers are held responsible for environmental destruction as if they had a 
choice of resources to depend on for their livelihood, when they really don't. In the 
context of basic survival, today's needs tend to overshadow consideration for the 
environmental future. It is poverty that is responsible for the destruction of natural 
resources, not the poor. 
Geoffrey Bruce 
Canadian International Development Agency 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26/27 May 1986
III. The Challenge 
37. Food demand will increase as populations increase and their consumption patterns change. 
In the remaining years of this century, about 1.3 billion people will be added to the human 
family (see Chapter 4); rising incomes, however, may account for 30 to 40 per cent of the 
increased demand for food in developing countries and about 10 per cent in industrial 
nations./30 Thus over the next few decades, the global food system must be managed to 
increase food production by 3 to 4 per cent yearly. 
38. Global food security depends not only on raising global production, but on reducing 
distortions in the structure of the world food market and on shifting the focus of food 
production to food-deficit countries, regions, and households. Many of the countries not 
growing enough food to feed themselves possess the largest remaining reservoirs of untapped 
agricultural resources. Latin America and sub-Saharan Africa have much unused land. 
although its quality and quantity vary greatly from nation to nation and much of it is 
ecologically vulnerable./31 The Soviet Union and parts of North America have significant 
amounts of frontier land suitable for agriculture; only Asia and Europe are truly land-starved. 
39. Global food security also depends on ensuring that all people, even the poorest of the poor, 
can get food. While on the world scale this challenge requires a reappraisal of global food 
distribution, the task weighs more immediately and heavily on national governments. 
Inequitable distribution of production assets, unemployment, and underemployment are at 
the heart of the problem of hunger in many countries. 
40. Rapid, sound agricultural development will mean not only more food but more 
opportunities for people to earn money to purchase food. Thus when countries with untapped 
agricultural resources provide food by importing more, they are effectively importing 
unemployment. By the same token, countries that are subsidizing food exports are increasing 
unemployment in food-importing countries. This marginalizes people, and marginalized 
people are forced to destroy the resource base to survive. Shifting production to food-deficit 
countries and to the resource-poor farmers within those countries is a way of securing 
sustainable livelihoods. 
41. Conserving the agricultural resource base and livelihood security of the poor can be 
mutually supportive in three ways. First, secure resources and adequate livelihoods lead to 
good husbandry and sustainable management. Second, they ease rural-to-urban migration, 
stimulate agricultural production from resources that otherwise would be underused, and 
reduce the need for food to be produced elsewhere. Third, by combating poverty, they help to 
slow population growth. 
42. Shifting the focus of production to food-deficit countries will also reduce pressures on 
agricultural resources in the industrialized market economies, enabling them to move towards 
more sustainable agricultural practices. Incentive structures can be changed so that instead of 
encouraging overproduction, they encourage farm practices that improve soil and water 
quality. Government budgets will be relieved of the burdens of storing and exporting surplus 
products. 
43. This shift in agricultural production will be sustainable only if the resource base is secure. 
As indicated, this is far from the case today. Thus to achieve global food security, the resource 
base for food production must be sustained, enhanced, and, where it has been diminished or 
destroyed, restored.
There are many contradictions in agricultural development. The blind imitation of 
models developed under different circumstances will have to give way to the 
realities and conditions existing in Africa. Large areas of virgin land have been 
opened up for export crops whose prices keeps declining. This is not in the interest 
of developing countries. 
There are so many problems to be overcome that we forget that every problem is 
an opportunity to do something positive. This is an opportunity for us to think of 
conservation and environment in a broad educational context. In doing so, we will 
be able to capture the next generation and demonstrate the wonder and the 
benefits of the world around them. 
Adolfo Mascarenhas 
IUCN Harare Office 
WCED Public Hearing 
Harare. 18 Sept 1986 
IV. Strategies for Sustainable Food Security 
44. Food security requires more than good conservation programmes, which can be - and 
usually are - overridden and undermined by inappropriate agricultural, economic, and trade 
policies. Nor is it just a matter of adding an environmental component to programmes. Food 
strategies must take into account all the policies that bear upon the threefold challenge of 
shifting production to where it is most needed, of securing the livelihoods of the rural poor, 
and of conserving resources. 
1. Government Intervention 
45. Government intervention in agriculture is the rule in both industrial and developing 
countries, and it is here to stay. Public investment in agricultural research and extension 
services, assisted farm credit and marketing services, and a range of other support systems 
have all played parts in the successes of the last half-century. In fact, the real problem in many 
developing countries is the weakness of these systems. 
46. Intervention has taken other forms as well. Many governments regulate virtually the entire 
food cycle - inputs and outputs, domestic sales, exports, public procurement, storage and 
distribution, price controls and subsidies - as well as imposing various land use regulations: 
acreage, crop variety, and so on. 
47. In general, patterns of government intervention suffer three basic defects. First, the criteria 
that underlie the planning of these interventions lack an ecological orientation and are often 
dominated by short-term considerations. These criteria should discourage environmentally 
unsound farm practices and encourage farmers to maintain and improve their soils, forests, 
and waters. 
48. The second defect is that agricultural policy tends to operate within a national framework 
with uniform prices and subsidies, standardized criteria for the provision of support services, 
indiscriminate financing of infrastructure investments, and so forth. Policies that vary from 
region to region are needed to reflect different regional needs, encouraging farmers to adopt 
practices that are ecologically sustainable in their own areas.
The problem in agriculture is not faceless. I as a farmer am a potential victim of the 
system that we now operate under. Why are approximately a quarter of Canadian 
farmers facing the immediate prospects of farm bankruptcy? It is directly related to 
the general concept of a cheap food policy that has constituted a cornerstone of 
federal agricultural policy since the beginning of settlement. 
We regard the current cheap food policy as a form of economic violence that is 
contributing towards soil exploitation and the growing impersonal relationship 
between farmers and the soil for economic survival. It is a policy of 
industrialization that can lead only towards disaster economically for us as 
farmers, and environmentally for us all as Canadians and as world citizens. 
Wayne Easter 
President, National Farmers' Union 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26/27 May 1986 
49. The importance of regional policy differentiation can be easily illustrated: 
Hill areas may require incentive prices for fruits and subsidized supplies of foodgrains to 
induce farmers to shift towards horticulture, which may be ecologically more sustainable. 
In areas prone to wind and water erosion, public intervention through subsidies and 
other measures should encourage farmers to conserve soil and water. 
Farmers on land over recharge areas for underground aquifers subject to nitrate 
pollution might be given incentives to maintain soil fertility and increase productivity by 
means other than nitrate fertilizers. 
50. The third defect in government intervention lies in incentive structures. In industrialized 
countries, overprotection of farmers and overproduction represent the accumulated result of 
tax reliefs, direct subsidies, and price controls. Such policies are now studded with 
contradictions that encourage the degradation of the agricultural resource base and. in the long 
run, do more harm than good to the agricultural industry. Some governments now recognize 
this and are making efforts to change the focus of the subsidies from production growth to 
conservation. 
51. On the other hand, in most developing countries the incentive structure is weak. Market 
interventions are often ineffective for lack of an organizational structure for procurement and 
distribution. Farmers are exposed to a high degree of uncertainty, and price support systems 
have often favoured the urban dweller or are limited to a few commercial crops, leading to 
distortions of cropping patterns that add to destructive pressures on the resource base. In 
some cases, price controls reduce the incentive to produce. What is required, in many cases, is 
nothing less than a radical attempt to turn the 'terms of trade' in favour of farmers through 
pricing policy and government expenditure reallocation. 
52. Strengthening food security from a global point of view requires reducing incentives that 
force overproduction and non-competitive production in the developed market economies and 
enhancing those that encourage food production in developing countries. At the same time, 
these incentive structures must be redesigned to promote farming practices that conserve and 
enhance the agricultural resource base. 
2. A Global Perspective
53. Trade in agricultural products tripled between 1950 and 1970; it has doubled since then. 
Yet, when it comes to farming, countries are at their most conservative, continuing to think 
mainly in local or national terms and concerned, above all, to protect their own farmers at the 
expense of competitors. 
54. Shifting food production towards food-deficit countries will require a major shift in trading 
patterns. Countries must recognize that all parties lose through protectionist barriers, which 
reduce trade in food products in which some nations may have genuine advantage. They must 
begin by redesigning their trade, tax, and incentive systems using criteria that include 
ecological and economic sustainability and international comparative advantage. 
55. The incentive-driven surpluses in developed market economies increase pressures to 
export these surpluses at subsidized prices or as non-emergency food aid. Donor and receiving 
countries should be responsible for the impacts of aid and use it for long-term objectives. It can 
be beneficially used in projects to restore degraded lands, build up rural infrastructure, and 
raise the nutrition level of vulnerable groups. 
3. The Resource Base 
56. Agricultural production can only be sustained on a long-term basis if the land, water, and 
forests on which it is based are not degraded. As suggested, a reorientation of public 
intervention will provide a framework for this. But more specific policies that protect the 
resource base are needed to maintain and even enhance agricultural productivity and the 
livelihoods of all rural dwellers. 
3.1 Land Use 
57. The initial task in enhancing the resource base will be to delineate broad land categories: 
enhancement areas, which are capable of sustaining intensive cropping and higher 
population and consumption levels; 
prevention areas, which by common consent should not be developed for intensive 
agriculture or. where developed, should be converted to other uses; and 
restoration areas, where land stripped of vegetative cover has either totally lost its 
productivity or had it drastically reduced. 
58. Identifying land according to 'best use' criteria requires information that is not always 
available. Most industrial nations possess inventories and descriptions of their lands, forests, 
and waters that are detailed enough to provide a basis for delineating land categories. Few 
developing countries have such inventories, but they can and should develop them quickly 
using satellite monitoring and other rapidly changing techniques./32 
59. Selection of land for each category could be made the responsibility of a board or 
commission representing the interests involved, especially the poor and more marginalized 
segments of the population. The process must be public in character, with publicly agreed 
criteria that combine the best use approach with the level of development required to sustain 
livelihood. Classifying land according to best use will determine variations in infrastructure 
provision, support services, promotional measures, regulatory restrictions, fiscal subsidies, 
and other incentives and disincentives. 
60. Lands identified as prevention areas should be denied supports and subsidies that would 
encourage their development for intensive agriculture. But such areas might well support
certain ecologically and economically sustainable uses such as grazing. fuelwood plantations, 
fruit farming, and forestry. Those redesigning support systems and incentives should focus on 
a broader range of crops, including those that enhance grazing, soil and water conservation, 
and so on. 
61. In vast areas today natural factors and land use practices have reduced productivity to a 
point too low to sustain even subsistence farming. Treatment of these areas must vary from 
site to site. Governments should give priority to establishing a national policy and 
multidisciplinary programmes and to creating or strengthening institutions to restore such 
areas. Where these already exist, they should be better coordinated and designed. The UN Plan 
of Action to Combat Desertification, which is already in place, requires more support, 
particularly financial. 
62. Restoration may require limits on human activities so as to permit the regeneration of 
vegetation. This can be difficult where there are large herds of animals or large numbers of 
people. for the agreement and participation of the local people are of the highest importance. 
The state, with the cooperation of those living locally, could protect these areas by declaring 
them national reserves. Where these areas are privately held, the state might wish either to 
purchase the land from the owners or to provide incentives for its restoration. 
Intensive agriculture may quickly exhaust the soil cover. causing its degradation, 
unless some special soil protection measures aimed at constant restoration and 
expanded reproduction of fertility are taken. The task of agriculture is thus not 
confined to obtaining the biological product but extends to constant maintenance 
and augmentation of soil fertility. Otherwise we will very quickly consume what by 
right belongs to our children, grandchildren, and great-grandchildren, to say nothing 
of more distant descendants. 
It is this misgiving - that our generation lives to a certain extent at the expense of 
the coming generations, thoughtlessly drawing on the basic reserves of soil fertility 
accumulated in the millennia of the biospheric development. instead of living off the 
current annual increment - that causes the increasing concern of scientists dealing 
with the state of the planetary soil cover. 
B. G. Rozanov 
Moscow State University 
WCED Public Hearing 
Moscow, 11 Dec 1986 
3.2 Water Management 
63. Improvements in water management are essential to raise agricultural productivity and to 
reduce land degradation and water pollution. Critical issues concern the design of irrigation 
projects and the efficiency of water use. 
64. Where water is scarce, an irrigation project should maximize productivity per unit of water; 
where water is plentiful, it must maximize productivity per unit of land. But local conditions 
will dictate how much water can be used without damaging the soil. Salinization. alkalization, 
and waterlogging can be avoided by a more careful approach to drainage, maintenance, 
cropping patterns. the regulation of water quantities, and more rational water charges. Many of 
these objectives will be easier to realize in small-scale irrigation projects. But whether small or
large, the projects must be designed with the abilities and aims of the participating farmers in 
mind, and then involve them in the management. 
65. In some areas excessive use of ground-water is rapidly lowering the water table - usually a 
case where private benefits are being realized at society's expense. Where ground-water use 
exceeds the recharge capacity of local aquifers, regulatory or fiscal controls become essential. 
The combined use of ground and surface water can improve the timing of water availability and 
stretch limited supplies. 
3.3 Alternatives to Chemicals 
66. Many countries can and should increase yields by greater use of chemical fertilizers and 
pesticides, particularly in the developing world. But countries can also improve yields by 
helping farmers to use organic nutrients more efficiently. Hence governments must encourage 
the use of more organic plant nutrients to complement chemicals. Pest control must also be 
based increasingly on the use of natural methods. (See Box 5-2) These strategies require 
changes in public policies, which now encourage the increased use of chemical pesticides and 
fertilizers. The legislative, policy, and research capacity for advancing non-chemical and 
less-chemical strategies must be established and sustained. 
67. Chemical fertilisers and pesticides are heavily subsidized in many countries. These 
subsidies promote chemical use precisely in the more commercially oriented agricultural areas 
where their environmental damage may already outweigh any increases in productivity they 
bring. Hence different regions will require different policies to regulate and promote chemical 
use. 
68. Legislative and institutional frameworks for controlling agrochemicals must be greatly 
strengthened everywhere. 
69, Industrialized countries must tighten controls on pesticide exports. (See Chapter 8.) 
Developing countries must possess the basic legislative and institutional instruments to 
manage the use of agricultural chemicals within their countries. And they will need technical 
and financial assistance to do so. 
3.4 Forestry and Agriculture 
69. Undisturbed forests protect watersheds, reduce erosion. offer habitats for wild species, and 
play key roles in climatic systems. They are also an economic resource providing timber, 
fuelwood, and other products. The crucial task is to balance the need to exploit forests against 
the need to preserve them. 
70. Sound forest policies can be based only on an analysis of the capacity of the forests and the 
land under them to perform various functions. Such an analysis might lead to some forests 
being cleared for intensive cultivation, others for livestock; some forestland might be managed 
for increased timber production or agroforestry use and some left intact for watershed 
protection, recreation, or species conservation. The extension of agriculture into forest areas 
must be based on scientific classification of land capacities. 
71. Programmes to preserve forest resources must start with the local people who are both 
victims and agents of destruction, and who will bear the burden of any new management 
scheme./33 They should be at the centre of integrated forest management, which is the basis of 
sustainable agriculture.
72. Such an approach would entail changes in the way governments set development priorities, 
as well as the evolution of greater responsibility to local governments and communities. 
Contracts covering forest use will have to be negotiated, or overall environmental sustainability 
of forest exploitation and overall environmental and ecosystem conservation. Prices for forest 
products need to reflect the true resource value of the goods. 
Box 5-2 
Natural Systems of Nutrient Supply and Peat Control 
Crop residues and farmyard manure are potential sources of soil nutrients. 
Organic wastes reduce run-off, increase the take-up of other nutrients, and 
improve soil's water-holding and erosion-resistance capacity. 
Using farmyard manure, especially in conjunction with intercropping and crop 
rotation, can greatly lower production costs. 
Overall systems efficiency is enhanced if manure or vegetable biomass is 
anaerobically digested in biogas plants, yielding energy for cooking and to run 
pumps, motors, or electric generators. 
Natural systems of biological nitrogen fixation through the use of certain 
annual plants, trees, and micro-organisms have a high potential. 
Integrated pest management (IPM) reduces the need for agrochemicals. 
improves a country's balance of payments. releases foreign exchange for other 
development projects, and creates jobs where they are most needed. 
IPM requires detailed information about pests and their natural enemies, seed 
varieties tailored to resist pests, integrated cropping patterns, and farmers who 
support the approach and are willing to modify farm practices to adopt it. 
73. Portions of forests may be designated as prevention areas. These are predominantly 
national parks, which could be set aside from agricultural exploitation to conserve soil, water, 
and wildlife. They may also include marginal lands whose exploitation accelerates land 
degradation through erosion or desertification. In this connection, the reforestation of 
degraded forest areas is of utmost importance. Conservation areas or national parks can also 
conserve genetic resources in their natural habitats. (See Chapter 6.) 
74. Forestry can also be extended into agriculture. Farmers can use agroforestry systems to 
produce food and fuel. In such systems, one or more tree crops are combined with one or more 
food crops or animal farming on the same land, though sometimes at different times. 
Well-chosen crops reinforce each other and yield more food and fuel than when grown 
separately. The technology is particularly suitable for small farmers and for poor-quality lands. 
Agroforestry has been practised by traditional farmers everywhere. The challenge today is to 
revive the old methods, improve them, adapt them to the new conditions. and develop new 
ones./34 
75. International forestry research organizations should work in various tropical countries in 
various ecosystems along the lines now followed by the Consultative Group on International 
Agricultural Research. There is considerable scope for institution building and additional 
research on forestry's role in agricultural production, for example by developing models that 
better predict the effects on water and soil loss of removing specific portions of forest cover.
3.5 Aquaculture 
76. Fisheries and aquaculture are critical to food security in that they provide both protein and 
employment. The greater part of world fish supply comes from marine fisheries, which yielded 
76.8 million tons in 1983. Landings have increased by 1 million tons per year over the past few 
years; by the end of the century, a catch of around 100 million tons should be possible./35 This 
is well short of the projected demand. There are indications that much of the naturally 
available freshwater fish stocks are fully exploited or damaged by pollution. 
77. Aquaculture. or 'fish-farming', which differs from conventional fishing in that fish are 
deliberately reared in controlled water bodies, can help meet future needs. Yields from 
aquaculture have doubled during the last decade and now represent about 10 per cent of world 
production of fishery products./36 A five- to tenfold increase is projected by the year 2000, 
given the necessary scientific, financial, and organizational support./37 Aquaculture can be 
undertaken in paddy fields, abandoned raining excavations, small ponds, and many other areas 
with some water, as well as on various commercial scales: individual, family, cooperative, or 
corporate. The expansion of aquaculture should be given high priority in developing and 
developed countries. 
4. Productivity and yields 
78. The conservation and enhancement of agriculture's resource base will increase production 
and productivity. But specific measures are required to make inputs more effective. This is best 
done by strengthening the technological and human resource base for agriculture in developing 
countries. 
Thus at the root of this environmental problem is a land problem that has to be 
solved if any serious ecological policy is to be taken - and reorientation of the 
agricultural policy has to be undertaken. I believe that any conservationist policy 
has to be followed by a coherent agricultural policy that will meet the need not only 
of preservation as such but also meet the needs of the Brazilian population. 
Julio M.G. Gaiger 
President, National Indian Support Association 
WCED Public Hearing 
Sao Paulo. 28/29 Oct 1985 
4.1 The Technological Base 
Blends of traditional and modern technologies offer possibilities for improving nutrition and 
increasing rural employment on a sustainable basis. Biotechnology, including tissue culture 
techniques, technologies for preparing value-added products from biomass, micro-electronics, 
computer sciences, satellite imagery, and communication. technology are all aspects of frontier 
technologies that can improve agricultural productivity and resource management./38 
80. Providing sustainable livelihoods for resource-poor farmers presents a special challenge for 
agricultural research. The major advances in agricultural technology in recent decades are 
better suited to stable, uniform, resource-rich conditions with good soils and ample water 
supplies. New technologies are most urgently needed in sub-Saharan Africa and the remoter
areas of Asia and Latin America, which typically have unreliable rainfall, uneven topography, 
and poorer soils, and hence are unsuited to Green Revolution technologies. 
81. To serve agriculture in these areas, research has to be less centralized and more sensitive to 
farmers' conditions and priorities. Scientists will need to start talking to poor farmers and 
basing research priorities on growers' priorities. Researchers must learn from and develop the 
innovations of farmers and not just the reverse. More adaptive research should be done right 
on the farm, using research stations for referral and with farmers eventually evaluating the 
results. 
82. Commercial enterprises can help develop and diffuse technology, but public institutions 
must provide the essential framework for agricultural research and extension. Pew academic 
and research institutions in developing regions are adequately funded. The problem is most 
acute in the low-income countries, where expenditure on agricultural research and extension 
amounts to 0.9 per cent of total agricultural income, as against 1.5 per cent in the middle-income 
countries./39 Research and extension efforts must be greatly expanded, especially in 
areas where climate, soils, and terrain pose special problems. 
83. These areas particularly will need new seed varieties, but so will much developing-country 
agriculture. At present, 55 per cent of the world's scientifically stored plant genetic resources is 
controlled by institutions in industrial countries, 31 per cent by institutions in developing 
countries, and 14 per cent by International Agricultural Research centres./40 Much of this 
genetic material originated in developing countries. These gene banks must increase their 
inventories of material, improve their storage techniques, and ensure that the resources are 
readily accessible to research centres in developing countries. 
84. Private companies increasingly seek proprietary rights to improved seed varieties, often 
without recognizing the rights of the countries from which the plant matter was obtained. This 
could discourage countries rich in genetic resources from making these internationally 
available and thus reduce the options for seed development in all countries. The genetic 
research capabilities of developing countries are so limited that agriculture there could become 
excessively dependent on private gene banks and seed companies elsewhere. Thus 
international cooperation and a clear understanding on the sharing of gains are vital in critical 
areas of agricultural technology, such as the development of new seed varieties. 
4.2 Human Resources 
85. The technological transformation of traditional agriculture will be difficult without a 
matching effort to develop human resources. (See Chapter 4.) This means educational reforms 
to produce researchers more attuned to the needs of rural peoples and agriculture. Illiteracy is 
still widespread among the rural poor. But efforts to promote literacy should focus attention on 
functional literacy covering the efficient use of land, water, and forests. 
86. Despite women's critical role in agriculture, their access to education and their 
representation in research, extension, and other support services is woefully inadequate. 
Women should be given the same educational opportunities as men. There should be more 
female extension workers, and women should participate in field visits. Women should be 
given more power to take decisions regarding agricultural and forestry programmes. 
4.3 Productivity of Inputs 
87. In traditional agriculture, local organic material provided farmers with sources of energy,
nutrients, and ways of controlling pests. Today, these needs are increasingly met by electricity, 
petroleum products, chemical fertilizers, and pesticides. The cost of these inputs forms a 
growing proportion of agricultural costs, and wasteful use does economic and ecological harm. 
88. One of the most important energy-related needs is mechanical power for irrigation. The 
efficiency of pumps could be greatly improved by providing appropriate incentives for 
equipment producers and farmers, and through effective extension work. Energy for irrigation 
pumps can also be provided by wind generators or by conventional internal combustion 
engines running on biogas produced from local biomass wastes. Solar dryers and solar coolers 
can save agricultural products. These non-conventional sources should be promoted, 
particularly in areas poor in energy resources. 
89. Nutrients are lost when fertilizers are improperly applied. Often they leach away with the 
flow of water in a field and degrade local water supplies. Similar problems of waste and 
destructive side effects occur in the use of pesticides. Hence extension systems and chemical 
manufacturers will need to give priority to programmes to promote careful and economical use 
of these expensive, toxic materials. 
5. Equity 
90. The challenge of sustainable agriculture is to raise not just average productivity and 
incomes, but also the productivity and incomes of those poor in resources. And food security is 
not just a question of raising food production, but of ensuring that the rural and urban poor do 
not go hungry during the short term or midst a local food scarcity. All this requires the 
systematic promotion of equity in food production and distribution. 
5.1 Land Reforms 
91. In many countries where land is very unequally distributed land reform is a basic 
requirement. Without it, institutional and policy changes meant to protect the resource base 
can actually promote inequalities by shutting the poor off from resources and by favouring 
those with large farms, who are better able to obtain the limited credit and services available. 
By leaving hundreds of millions without options, such changes can have the opposite of their 
intended effect, ensuring the continued violation of ecological imperatives. 
92. Given institutional and ecological variations, a universal approach to land reform is 
impossible. Each country should work out its own programme of land reform to assist the 
land-poor and to provide a base for coordinated resource conservation. The redistribution of 
land is particularly important where large estates and vast numbers of the land-poor coexist. 
Crucial components include the reform of tenancy arrangements, security of tenure, and the 
clear recording of land rights. In agrarian reforms the productivity of the land and. in forest 
areas, the protection of forests should be a major concern. 
93. In areas where holdings are fragmented into many non-contiguous plots, land 
consolidation can ease the implementation of resource conservation measures. Promoting 
cooperative efforts by small farmers - in pest control or water management, for instance - 
would also help conserve resources. 
94. In many countries women do not have direct land rights; titles go to men only. In the 
interests of food security, land reforms should recognize women's role in growing food. 
Women, especially those heading households, should be given direct land rights.
5.2 Subsistence Farmers and Pastoralists 
95. Subsistence farmers, pastoralists, and nomads threaten the environmental resource base 
when processes beyond their control squeeze their numbers onto land or into areas that 
cannot support them. 
96. The traditional rights of subsistence farmers, particularly shifting cultivators, pastoralists. 
and nomads, must therefore be protected from encroachments. Land tenure rights and 
communal rights in particular must be respected. When their traditional practices threaten the 
resource base, their rights may have to be curtailed, but only when alternatives have been 
provided. Most of these groups will need to be helped to diversify their livelihoods by entering 
the market economy through employment programmes and some cash-crop production. 
97. Research should give early attention to the varied requirements of the mixed farming 
typical in subsistence agriculture. Extension and input supply systems must become more 
mobile to reach shifting cultivators and nomads and priority given to public investment to 
improve their cropland, grazing areas, and water sources. 
5.3 Integrated Rural Development 
98. Rural populations will continue to increase in many countries. With existing patterns of 
land distribution, the number of smallholders and landless households will increase by about 
50 million, to nearly 220 million, by the year 2000./41 Together, these groups represent three-quarters 
of the agricultural households in developing countries./42 Without adequate 
livelihood opportunities, these resource-poor households will remain poor and be forced to 
overuse the resource base to survive. 
99. Considerable effort has gone into creating strategies of integrated rural development, and 
the requirements and pitfalls are well known. Experience has shown that land reform is 
necessary but alone is not enough without support through the distribution of inputs and rural 
services. Smallholders, including - indeed especially - women, must be given preference when 
allocating scarce resources, staff, and credit. Small farmers must also be more involved in 
formulating agricultural policies. 
100. Integrated rural development also requires resources to absorb the large increases in 
rural working populations expected in most developing countries through non-agricultural 
work opportunities, which should be promoted in rural areas. Successful agricultural 
development and the growth in incomes should open up opportunities in service activities and 
small-scale manufacturing if supported by public policy. 
5.4 Food Availability Fluctuations 
101. Environmental degradation can make food shortages more frequent and more severe. 
Hence sustainable agricultural development will reduce the season-to-season variability in 
food supplies. But such systems cannot eliminate it. There will be weather-induced 
fluctuations, and the growing dependence on only a few crop varieties over large areas may 
amplify the effects of weather and pest damage. Often it is the poorest households and the 
ecologically disadvantaged regions that suffer most from these shortages. 
102. Food stocks are crucial in dealing with shortages. At present, the world stock of cereals is
on the order of 20 per cent of annual consumption: The developing world controls about 
one-third of the stock and the industrial world, two-thirds. More than half the developing-country 
stock is in two countries - China and India. Stock levels in most of the others provide 
only for immediate operational requirements; there is little by way of a reserve./43 
As agriculture production is being developed, a rising number of farmers have 
been able to purchase tractors. But they find that, after using them for a year, it 
becomes much more expensive than they expected because they have to spend a 
tremendous amount of money on expensive spare parts. Perhaps we might 
recommend that Indonesia establish a factory that makes these spare parts, 
before they continue encouraging introduction of tractors in agriculture. 
For this reason, a number of loans that the government has been providing for 
farmers to modernize their agricultural techniques, particularly buying tractors, have 
not been paid back. If the tractors were still running, they could probably pay back 
their loans. In fact, now these tractors are becoming a problem themselves, 
because they sit around getting rusty. and thus turning into pollution. 
Andi Mappasala 
Chairman. Yayasan Tellung Poccoe 
WCED Public Hearing 
Jakarta. 26 March 1985 
103. The food stocks of industrialized countries are essentially surpluses, and provide a basis 
for emergency assistance, which must be maintained. But emergency food aid is a precarious 
basis for food security: developing countries should build up national stocks in surplus years to 
provide reserves as well as encouraging development of food security at the household level. 
To do this, they will need an effective system of public support for measures facilitating the 
purchase, transportation, and distribution of food. The provision of strategically located 
storage facilities is critical both to reduce post-harvest losses and to provide a base for quick 
interventions in emergencies. 
104. During most food shortages, poor households not only cannot produce food but also lose 
their usual sources of income and cannot buy the food that is available. Hence food security 
also requires that machinery is available promptly to put purchasing power in the hands of 
disaster-struck households, through emergency public works programme, and through 
measures to protect small farmers from crop failures. 
V. Food for the Future 
105. The challenge of increasing food production to keep pace with demand, while retaining the 
essential ecological integrity of production systems, is colossal both in its magnitude and 
complexity. But we have the Knowledge we need to conserve our land and water resources. 
New technologies provide opportunities for increasing productivity while reducing pressures 
on resources. A new generation of farmers combine experience with education. With these 
resources at our command, we can meet the needs of the human family. Standing in the way is 
the narrow focus of agricultural planning and policies. 
106. The application of the concept of sustainable development to the effort to ensure food 
security requires systematic attention to the renewal of natural resources. It requires a holistic 
approach focused on ecosystems at national, regional. and global levels, with coordinated land
use and careful planning of water usage and forest exploitation. The goal of ecological security 
should be embedded firmly in the mandates of FAO. other UN organizations that deal with 
agriculture, and all other appropriate international agencies. It will also require an 
enhancement and reorientation of international assistance. (See Chapter 3.) 
107. The agricultural systems that have been built up over the past few decades have 
contributed greatly to the alleviation of hunger and the raising of living standards. They have 
served their purposes up to a point. But they were built for the purposes of a smaller, more 
fragmented world. New realities reveal their inherent contradictions. These realities require 
agricultural systems that focus as much attention on people as they do on technology, as much 
on resources as on production, as much on the long term as on the short term. Only such 
systems can meet the challenge of the future. 
Footnotes 
1/ Based on data from FAO, Production Yearbook 1985 (Rome: 1986). 
2/ Based on World Bank estimates for 1980, according to which 340 million people in 
developing countries (excluding China) did not have enough income to attain a minimum 
calorie standard that would prevent serious health risks and stunted growth in children, and 
730 million were below a higher standard that would allow an active working life. See World 
Bank, Poverty and Hunger: Issues and Options for Food Security in Developing 
Countries (Washington. DC: 1986). 
3/ FAO, Yearbook of Food and Agriculture Statistics, 1951 (Home: 1952); FAO, 
Production Yearbook 1985. op. cit. 
4/ FAO, Yearbook of Food and Agricultural Statistics, Trade Volume, Part 2 1951 
and Trade Yearbook 1982 and 1984 (Rome: 1952. 1983, and 1985). 
5/ FAO, Trade Yearbook 1968 and Commodities Review and Outlook 1984-85 
(Rome: 1969 and 1986). 
6/ FAO, Yearbook of Food and Agricultural Statistics, Trade Volume, Part 2 1954 
(Rome: 1955); FAO, Commodities Review, op. cit. 
7/ FAO, Production Yearbook 1984 (Rome: 1985). 
8/ L.R. Brown. 'Sustaining World Agriculture,' in L.R. Brown et al., State of the World 1987 
(London: W.W. Norton. 1987). 
9/ A. Gear (ed.), The Organic Food Guide (Essex: 1983). 
10/ USSR Committee for the International Hydrological Decade, World Water Balance and 
Water Resources of the Earth (Paris: UNESCO, 1978). 
11/ FAO, Yearbook of Food and Agricultural Statistics 1951 and Production 
Yearbook 1984. op. cit. 
12/ 'Dairy, Prairie', The Economist, 15 November 1986. 
13/ WCED Advisory Panel on Food Security, Agriculture, Forestry and Environment, Food 
Security (London: Zed Books. 1987).
14/ The term pesticides is used in a generic sense in this report and covers insecticides, 
herbicides. fungicides, and similar agricultural inputs. 
15/ World Bank. World Development Report 1986 (New York: Oxford University Press. 
1986). 
16/ Brown, op. cit. 
17/ Standing Committee on Agriculture. Fisheries and Forestry. Soil at Risk: Canada's 
Eroding Future, A Report on Soil Conservation to the Senate of Canada (Ottawa: 1984). 
18/ Brown, op. cit. 
19/ Centre for Science and Environment, The State of India's Environment 1984-85 
(New Delhi: 1985). 
20/ FAO, Land, Food and People (Rome: 1984). 
21/ I. Szabolcs. 'Agrarian Change', prepared for WCED, 1985. 
22/ Gear. op. cit./ 
23/ J. Bandyopadhyay, 'Rehabilitation of Upland Watersheds', prepared for WCED, 1985. 
24/ UNEP. 'General Assessment of Progress in the Implementation of the Plan of Action to 
Combat Desertification 1978-1984'. Nairobi, 1984; WCED Advisory Panel, op. cit. 
25/ UNEP, op. cit. 
26/ Ibid. 
27/ Ibid. 
28/ Ibid. 
29/ Ibid. 
30/ FAO, Agriculture Towards 2000 (Rome: 1981) 
31/ FAO, Potential Population Supporting Capacities of Lands in the Developing 
World (Rome: 1982). 
32/ The land capability classification developed by the U.S. Bureau of Land Management is an 
example of how the problem could be approached. A broader type of classification is implicit in 
FAO, Potential Population Supporting Capacities. 
33/ INDERENA, Caguan-Cagueta Report (Bogota, Colombia: 1985). 
34/ The agroforestry programmes implemented in India are examples of such an approach. 
They have been adopted enthusiastically by many farmers. 
35/ FAO. World Food Report (Rome: 1985); WCED Advisory Panel, op. cit. 
36/ WCED Advisory Panel, op. cit. 
37/ Ibid.
38/ Ibid. 
39/ FAO, World Food Report, op. cit. 
40/ Data from Dag Hammarskjold Foundation, Sweden, in Centre for Science and 
Environment, op. cit. 
41/ FAO estimates quoted in WCED Advisory Panel, op. cit. 
42/ Ibid. 
43/ FAO, Food Outlook (Rome: 1986).
Our Common Future, Chapter 6: Species and Ecosystems: Resources 
for Development 
I. The Problem: Character and Extent 
II. Extinction Patterns and Trends 
III. Some Causes of Extinction 
IV. Economic Values at Stake 
V. A New Approach; Anticipate and Prevent 
VI. International Action for National Species 
1. Some Current Initiatives 
2. Setting Priorities 
VII. Scope for National Action 
VIII. The Need for Action 
Footnotes 
Chapter 6 
Species and Ecosystems: Resources for Development 
1. Conservation of living natural resources - plants, animals, and micro-organisms, and the 
non-living elements of the environment on which they depend - is crucial for development. 
Today, the conservation of wild living resources is on the agenda of governments; nearly 4 per 
cent of the Earth's land area is managed explicitly to conserve species and ecosystems, and all 
but a small handful of countries have national parks. The challenge facing nations today is no 
longer deciding whether conservation is a good idea, but rather how it can be implemented in 
the national interest and within the means available in each country. 
I. The Problem: Character and Extent 
2. Species and their genetic materials promise to play an expanding role in development, and a 
powerful economic rationale is emerging to bolster the ethical, aesthetic, and scientific cases 
for preserving them. The genetic variability and germplasm material of species make 
contributions to agriculture, medicine, and industry worth many billions of dollars per year. 
3. Yet scientists have intensively investigated only one in every 100 of Earth's plant species, 
and a far smaller proportion of animal species. If nations can ensure the survival of species, the 
world can look forward to new and improved foods, new drugs and medicines, and new raw 
materials for industry. This - the scope for species to make a fast-growing contribution to 
human welfare in myriad forms - is a major justification for expanded efforts to safeguard 
Earth's millions of species.
4. Equally important are the vital life processes carried out by nature, including stabilization of 
climate, protection of watersheds and soil, preservation of nurseries and breeding grounds, 
and so on. Conserving these processes cannot be divorced from conserving the individual 
species within natural ecosystems. Managing species and ecosystems together is clearly the 
most rational way to approach the problem. Numerous examples of workable solutions to local 
problems are available./1 
5. Species and natural ecosystems make many important contributions to human welfare. Yet 
these very important resources are seldom being used in ways that will be able to meet the 
growing pressures of future high demands for both goods and services that depend upon these 
natural resources. 
6. There is a growing scientific consensus that species are disappearing at rates never before 
witnessed on the planet. But there is also controversy over those rates and the risks they 
entail. The world is losing precisely those species about which it knows nothing or little; they 
are being lost in the remotest habitats. The growing scientific concern is relatively new and the 
data base to support it fragile. But it firms yearly with each new field report and satellite study. 
7. Many ecosystems that are rich biologically and promising in material benefits are severely 
threatened. Vast stocks of biological diversity are in danger of disappearing just as science is 
learning how to exploit genetic variability through the advances of genetic engineering. 
Numerous studies document this crisis with examples from tropical forests, temperate forests, 
mangrove forests, coral reefs, savannas, grasslands, and arid zones./2 Although most of these 
studies are generalized in their documentation and few offer lists of individual species at risk or 
recently extinct, some present species-by-species details. (See Box 6-1.) 
8. Habitat alteration and species extinction are not the only threat. The planet is also being 
impoverished by the loss of races and varieties within species. The variety of genetic riches 
inherent in one single species can be seen in the variability manifested in the many races of 
dogs, or the many specialized types of maize developed by breeders./3 
9. Many species are losing whole populations at a rate that quickly reduces their genetic 
variability and thus their ability to adapt to climatic change and other forms of environmental 
adversity. For example, the remaining gene pools of major crop plants such as maize and rice 
amount to only a fraction of the genetic diversity they harboured only a few decades ago, even 
though the species themselves are anything but threatened. Thus there can be an important 
difference between loss of species and loss of gene reservoirs. 
10. Some genetic variability inevitably will be lost, but all species should be safeguarded to the 
extent that it is technically, economically, and politically feasible. The genetic landscape is 
constantly changing through evolutionary processes, and there is more variability than can be 
expected to be protected by explicit government programmes. So in terms of genetic 
conservation, governments must be selective, and ask which gene reservoirs most merit a 
public involvement in protective measures. However, as a more general proposition, 
governments should enact national laws and public policies that encourage individual, 
community, or corporate responsibility for the protection of gene reservoirs. 
11. But before science can focus on new ways to conserve species, policy makers and the general 
public for whom policy is made must grasp the size and the urgency of the threat. Species that 
are important to human welfare are not just wild plants that are relatives of agricultural crops, 
or animals that are harvested. Species such as earthworms, bees, and termites may be far more 
important in terms of the role they play in a healthy and productive ecosystem. It would be
grim irony indeed if just as new genetic engineering techniques begin to let us peer into life's 
diversity and use genes more effectively to better the human condition, we looked and found 
this treasure sadly depleted. 
Box 6-1 
Some Examples of Species Extinction 
In Madagascar, until about mid-century, there were 12,000 plant species and 
probably around 190,000 animal species, with at least 60 per cent of them 
endemic to the island's eastern strip of forest (that is, found nowhere else on 
Earth). At least 93 per cent of the original primary forest has been eliminated. 
Using these figures, scientists estimate that at least half the original species 
have already disappeared, or are on the point of doing so. 
Lake Malawi in Central Africa holds over 500 cichlid fish species, 99 per cent of 
them endemic. The lake is only one-eighth the size of North America's Great 
Lakes, which feature just 173 species, fewer than 10 per cent of which are 
endemic. Yet Lake Malawi is threatened through pollution from industrial 
installations and the proposed introduction of alien species. 
Western Ecuador is reputed to have once contained between 8,000 and 10,000 
plant species, some 40 and 60 per cent of them endemic. Given that there are 
between 10 and 30 animal species for every one plant species in similar areas, 
western Ecuador must have contained about 200,000 species. Since 1960, 
almost all the forests of western Ecuador have been destroyed to make way for 
banana plantations, oil wells, and human settlements. The number of species 
thus eliminated is difficult to judge, but the total could well number 50.000 or 
more - all in just 25 years. 
The Pantanal area of Brazil contains 110,000 square kilometres of wetlands, 
probably the most extensive and richest in the world. They support the largest 
and most diversified populations of waterfowl in South America. The area has 
been classified by UNESCO as 'of international importance'. Yet it suffers 
increasingly from agricultural expansion, dam construction, and other forms of 
disruptive development. Sources: W. Rauh. 'Problems of Biological 
Conservation in Madagascar', in D. Bramwell (ed.), Plants and Islands 
(London: Academic Press, 1979): D.C.N. Barel et al., 'Destruction of Fisheries in 
Africa's Lakes', Nature, Vol. 315, pp. 19-20, 1985; A.H. Gentry. 'Patterns of 
Neotropical Plant Species Diversity', Evolutionary Biology. Vol. 15, pp.1-84, 
1982; D.A. Scott and M. Carbonell, 'A Directory of Neotropical Wetlands', 
IUCN. Gland. Switzerland. 1985. 
Our Atlantic forest, this mass of tropical forest that is a narrow stretch from the 
North to the South, has been reduced drastically. 
This forest is characterised by a large number of endemic species, that is species 
that only exist in this area, and only exist in Brazil. And consequently, it is up to us, 
Brazilians, to shoulder the responsibility of keeping these species in existence. 
Ibsen de Gusmao Camara 
President, Brazilian Foundation for Preservation of Nature
WCED Public Hearing 
Sao Paulo. 28-29 Oct 1985 
II. Extinction Patterns and Trends 
12. Extinction has been a fact of life since life first emerged. The present few million species are 
the modern-day survivors of the estimated half-billion species that have ever existed. Almost 
all past extinctions have occurred by natural processes, but today human activities are 
overwhelmingly the main cause of extinctions. 
13. The average duration of a species is some 5 million years. The best current estimates are 
that on average 900,000 species have become extinct every 1 million years during the last 200 
million years, so the average 'background rate' of extinction has been very roughly one in every 
one and one-ninth years./4 The present human-caused rate is hundreds of times higher, and 
could easily be thousands of times higher./5 We do not know. We have no accurate figures on 
the current rates of extinctions, as most of the species vanishing are those least documented, 
such as insects in tropical forests. 
14. Although tropical moist forests are by far the richest biological units in terms of genetic 
diversity and by far the most threatened through human activities, other major ecological 
zones are also under pressure. Arid and semi-arid lands harbour only a very small number of 
species compared with tropical forests. But because of the adaptations of these species to 
harsh living conditions, they feature many potentially valuable biochemicals, such as the liquid 
wax of the jojoba shrub and the natural rubber of the guayule bush. Many of these are 
threatened by. among other things, the expansion of livestock herding. 
15. Coral reefs, with an estimated half-million species in their 400,000 square kilometres, are 
being depleted at rates that may leave little but degraded remnants by early next century. This 
would be a great loss, in that coral-reef organisms, by virtue of the 'biological warfare' they 
engage in to ensure living space in crowded habitats, have generated an unusual number and 
variety of toxins valuable in modern medicine./6 
16. Tropical moist forests cover only 6 per cent of the Earth's land surface but contain at least 
half the Earth's species (which totals 5 million at a minimum, but could be as many as 30 
million). They may contain 90 per cent or even more of all species. The mature tropical forests 
that still exist cover only 900 million hectares, out of the 1.5-1.6 billion hectares that once 
stood. Between 7.6 million and 10 million hectares are eliminated outright each year, and at 
least a further 10 million hectares are grossly disrupted annually./7 But these figures come 
from surveys of the late 1970s, and since then deforestation rates have probably accelerated. 
17. By the end of the century, or shortly thereafter, there could be little virgin tropical moist 
forest left outside of the Zaire Basin and the western half of Brazilian Amazonia, plus some 
areas such as the Guyana tract of forest in northern South America and parts of the island of 
New Guinea. The forests in these zones are unlikely to survive beyond a few further decades, as 
world demand for their produce continues to expand and as the number of forestland farmers 
increases. 
18. If deforestation were to continue in Amazonia at present rates until the year 2000, but then 
halted completely (which is unlikely), about 15 per cent of plant species would be lost. Were 
Amazonia's forest cover to be ultimately reduced to those areas now established as parks and 
reserves, 66 per cent of plant species would eventually disappear, together with almost 69 per 
cent of bird species and similar proportions of all other major categories of species. Almost 20
per cent of the Earth's species are found in Latin American forests outside of Amazonia; 
another 20 per cent are found in forests of Asia and Africa outside the Zaire Basin./8 All these 
forests are threatened, and if they were to disappear, the species loss could amount to 
hundreds of thousands. 
19. Unless appropriate management measures are taken over the longer term, at least 
one-quarter, possibly one-third, and conceivably a still larger share of species existing today 
could be lost. Many experts suggest that at least 20 per cent of tropical forests should be 
protected, but to date well under 5 per cent has been afforded protection of any sort - and 
many of the tropical forest parks exist only on paper. 
20. Even the most effectively managed parks and protected areas are unlikely to provide a 
sufficient answer. In Amazonia, if as much as half the forest were to be safeguarded in some 
way or another but the other half were to be eliminated or severely disrupted, there might well 
not be enough moisture in the Amazonian ecosystem to keep the remaining forest moist./9 It 
could steadily dry up until it became more like an open woodland - with the loss of most of the 
species adapted to tropical moist forest conditions. 
21. More widespread climatic changes are likely to emerge within the foreseeable future as the 
accumulation of 'greenhouse gases' in the atmosphere leads to global warming early in the next 
century. (See Chapter 7.) Such a change will produce considerable stress for all ecosystems, 
making it particularly important that natural diversity be maintained as a means of adaptation. 
Twenty years ago, as we decided to intensify our forest exploitation, we just 
thought the resource is available, and we just took it. At the time, we also thought 
the intensive selecting out of the trees being cut wouldn't destroy forest 
regeneration. Because not all of the trees were being cut. But we forgot that we 
don't know yet about how the tropical forest should be rehabilitated. 
An indigenous species such as meranti, I don't know the name in English, meranti, 
rami, is our high-valued wood, a timber that cannot make a shadow in its particular 
period of growth. And it cannot survive without that shadow. And we still didn't think 
about it, we just accepted the technology from the West that we have to cut, to 
exploit our forest. 
Emmy H. Dharsono 
NGO Network for Forest Conservation 
WCED Public Hearing 
Jakarta, 26 March 1985 
III. Some Causes of Extinction 
22. The tropics, which host the greatest number and diversity of species, also host most 
developing nations, where population growth is fastest and poverty is most widespread. If 
farmers in these countries are forced to continue with extensive agriculture, which is 
inherently unstable and leads to constant movement, then farming will tend to spread 
throughout remaining wildlife environments. But if they are helped and encouraged to practise 
more intensive agriculture, they could make productive use of relatively limited areas, with less 
impact on wildlands. 
23. They will need help: training, marketing support, and fertilizers, pesticides, and tools they 
can afford. This will require the full support of governments, including ensuring that
conservation policies are designed with the benefit of agriculture foremost in mind. It may be 
expedient to stress the value to farmers rather than to wildlife of this programme, but in fact 
the destinies of the two are intertwined. Species conservation is tied to development, and the 
problems of both are more political than technical. 
24. Population growth is a major threat to conservation efforts in many developing nations. 
Kenya has allocated 6 per cent of its territory as parks and reserves in order to protect its 
wildlife and to earn foreign exchange through tourism. But Kenya's present population of 20 
million people is already pressing so hard on parks that protected land is steadily being lost to 
invading farmers. And the country's population is projected to grow fourfold in the next 40 
years./10 
25. Similar population pressures threaten parks in Ethiopia, Uganda. Zimbabwe, and other 
countries in which a growing but impoverished peasantry is forced to depend on a dwindling 
natural resource base. The prospects are bleak for parks that do not make important and 
recognizable contributions to national development objectives. 
26. Brazil, Colombia, Indonesia. Cote d'lvoire, Kenya, Madagascar, Peru, the Philippines. 
Thailand, and other nations with an unusual abundance of species already suffer a massive 
flow of farmers from traditional homelands into virgin territories. These areas often include 
tropical forests. perceived by the migrants encouraged to farm there as 'free' lands available for 
unimpeded settlement. The people who are already living on such lands at low population 
densities and with only traditional rights to the land are often swept aside in the rush to 
develop lands that might better be left in extensively used forest. 
27. Many tropical countries with large forest resources have provoked wasteful 'timber booms' 
by assigning harvesting rights to concessionaires for royalty, rent, and tax payments that are 
only a small fraction of the net commercial value of the timber harvest. They have compounded 
the damage caused by these incentives by offering only short-term leases, requiring 
concessionaires to begin harvesting at once, and adopting royalty systems that induce loggers 
to harvest only the best trees while doing enormous damage to the remainder. In response, 
logging entrepreneurs in several countries have leased virtually the entire productive forest 
area within a few years and have overexploited the resource with little concern for future 
productivity (while unwittingly opening it for clearing by slash-and-burn cultivators)./11 
28. In Central and South America, many governments have encouraged the large-scale 
conversion of tropical forests to livestock ranches. Many of these ranches have proved 
ecologically and economically unsound, as the underlying soils are soon depleted of nutrients; 
weed species replace planted grasses, and pasture productivity declines abruptly. Yet tens of 
millions of hectares of tropical forest have been lost to such ranches, largely because 
governments have underwritten the conversions with large land grants, tax credits and tax 
holidays, subsidized loans, and other inducements./12 
29. The promotion of tropical timber imports into certain industrial countries, through low 
tariffs and favourable trade incentives, combined with weak domestic forest policies in tropical 
countries and with high costs and disincentives to harvesting in industrial countries, also 
drives deforestation. Some industrial countries typically import unprocessed logs either 
duty-free or at minimal tariff rates. This encourages developed country industries to use logs 
from tropical forests rather than their own, a pattern that is reinforced by domestic restrictions 
on the amounts that can be cut in domestic forests. 
All of us in Africa are slowly waking up to the fact the African crisis is essentially an
environmental problem that has precipitated such adverse symptoms as drought, 
famine, desertification, overpopulation, environmental refugees, political instability, 
widespread poverty, etc. 
We are awaking to the fact that if Africa is dying it is because her environment has 
been plundered, overexploited, and neglected. 
Many of us in Africa are also waking up to the realization that no good Samaritans 
will cross the seas to come to save the African environment. Only we Africans can 
and should be sufficiently sensitive to the well-being of our environment. 
Mrs. Rahab W. Mwatha 
The Greenbelt Movement 
WCED Public Hearing 
Nairobi, 23 Sept 1986 
IV. Economic Values at Stake 
30. Species conservation is not only justified in economic terms. Aesthetic, ethical, cultural, 
and scientific considerations provide ample grounds for conservation. For those who demand 
an accounting, the economic values inherent in the genetic materials of species are alone 
enough to justify species preservation. 
31. Today, industrialized nations record far greater financial benefits from wild species than do 
developing countries, though unrecorded benefits to people living in the tropical countryside 
can be considerable. But the industrial countries have the scientific and industrial capacity to 
convert the wild material for industrial and medical use. And they also trade a higher 
proportion of their agricultural produce than do developing nations. Northern crop breeders 
are increasingly dependent on genetic materials from wild relatives of maize and wheat, two 
crops that play leading roles in the international grain trade. The U.S. Department of 
Agriculture estimates that contributions from plant genetic material lead to increases in 
productivity that average around l per cent annually, with a farm-gate value of well over $1 
billion (1980 dollars)./13 
32. The U.S. maize crop suffered a severe setback in 1970. when a leaf fungus blighted 
croplands, causing losses to farmers worth more than $2 billion. Then fungus-resistant genetic 
material was found in genetic stocks that had originated in Mexico./14 More recently, a 
primitive species of maize was discovered in a montane forest of south-central Mexico./15 This 
wild plant is the most primitive known relative of modern maize and was surviving in only 
three tiny patches covering a mere four hectares in an area threatened with destruction by 
farmers and loggers. The wild species is a perennial; all other forms of maize are annuals. Its 
cross-breeding with commercial varieties of maize opens up the prospect that farmers could be 
spared the annual expense of ploughing and sowing, since the plant would grow again yearly of 
its own accord. The genetic benefits of this wild plant, discovered when not more than a few 
thousand last stalks remained, could total several thousand million dollars a year./16 
33. Wild species likewise contribute to medicine. Half of all prescriptions dispensed have their 
origins in wild organisms./17 The commercial value of these medicines and drugs in the United 
States now amounts to some $14 billion a year./18 Worldwide, and including non-prescription 
materials plus pharmaceuticals, the estimated commercial value exceeds $40 billion a year./19 
Industry also benefits from wildlife./20 
34. Wildlife-derived materials contribute gums, oils, resins, dyes, tanning, vegetable fats and
waxes, insecticides, and many other compounds. Many wild plants bear oil-rich seeds that can 
help in the manufacture of fibres, detergents, starch, and general edibles. For instance, the 
Fevillea genus of rain-forest vines in western Amazonia bear seeds with such a high oil content 
that a hectare of such vines in an original forest could produce more oil than a hectare of 
commercial oil palm plantation./21 
35. A few plant species contain hydrocarbons rather than carbohydrates./22 Certain of these 
plants can flourish in areas that have been rendered useless through such activities as strip-mining. 
Hence land that has been degraded by extraction of hydrocarbons such as coal could 
be rehabilitated by growing hydrocarbons on the surface. Moreover, unlike an oil well, a 
'petroleum plantation' need never run dry. 
36. The emerging field of genetic engineering, by which science devises new variations of life 
forms, does not render wild genes useless. In fact, this new science must be based on existing 
genetic material and makes such material even more valuable and useful. Extinction, according 
to Professor Tom Eisner of Cornell University, 'no longer means the simple loss of one volume 
from the library of nature. It means the loss of a loose-leaf book whose individual pages, were 
the species to survive, would remain available in perpetuity for selective transfer and 
improvement of other species./23 And Professor Winston Brill of the University of Wisconsin 
has noted: 'We are entering an age in which genetic wealth, especially in tropical areas such as 
rain forests, until now a relatively inaccessible trust fund, is becoming a currency with high 
immediate value./24 
37. Genetic engineering may mean that agriculture's Green Revolution will be superseded by a 
'Gene Revolution'. This technology raises hopes of eventually harvesting crops from deserts, 
from seawater, and from other environments that did not previously support farming. Medical 
researchers foresee their own Gene Revolution bringing more innovative advances during the 
last two decades of this century than occurred during the previous 200 years. 
38. Many of the nations with the least capacity for managing living resources are those richest 
in species; the tropics, which contain at least two-thirds of all species and a still greater 
proportion of threatened species, roughly coincide with the area generally referred to as the 
Third World. Many developing nations recognize the need to safeguard threatened species but 
lack the scientific skills, institutional capacities, and funds necessary for conservation. 
Industrial nations seeking to reap some of the economic benefits of genetic resources should 
support the efforts of Third World nations to conserve species; they should also seek ways to 
help tropical nations and particularly the rural people most directly involved with these species 
realize some of the economic benefits of these resources. 
It will not be possible to restore the population of 'oomurasaki' - our purple 
emperor butterfly - to the previous level. The forest for oomurasaki requires 
weeding, planting of trees, and care and maintenance. The forest will be handed 
down to the succeeding generations. Isn't it wonderful to think that you are linked to 
the succeeding generations by handing down the forest where many oomurasaki 
fly and people enjoy themselves? 
It would be nice if we could develop into the hearts of the children the love and 
affection for nature. We hope to make the forest we are making our gift to the 
children who will live in the 21st century. 
Mika Sakakibara 
Student, Tokyo University of Agriculture and Technology
WCED Public Hearing 
Tokyo. 27 Feb 1987 
V. A New Approach; Anticipate and Prevent 
39. The historical approach of establishing national parks that are somehow isolated from the 
greater society has been overtaken by a new approach to conservation of species and 
ecosystems that can be characterized as 'anticipate and prevent.' This involves adding a new 
dimension to the now-traditional and yet viable and necessary step of protected areas. 
Development patterns must be altered to make them more compatible with the preservation of 
the extremely valuable biological diversity of the planet. Altering economic and land use 
patterns seems to be the best long-term approach to ensuring the survival of wild species and 
their ecosystems. 
40. This more strategic approach deals with the problems of species depletion at their sources 
in development policies. anticipates the obvious results of the more destructive policies, and 
prevents damage now. A useful tool in promoting this approach is the preparation of National 
Conservation Strategies (NCS), which bring the processes of conservation and development 
together. Preparing an NCS involves government agencies, non-governmental organizations, 
private interests, and the community at large in analysis of natural resource issues and 
assessment of priority actions. In this way. it is hoped that sectoral interests will better 
perceive their interrelationships with other sectors and new potentials for conservation and 
development will be revealed. 
41. The link between conservation and development and the need to attack the problem at the 
source can be seen clearly in the case of tropical forests. Sometimes it is government policy, not 
economic necessity, that drives the overexploitation and destruction of these resources. The 
direct economic and fiscal costs of this overexploitation - in addition to those of species 
extinction - are huge. The result has been wasteful exploitation of the tropical forests, the 
sacrifice of most of their timber and non-timber values. enormous losses of potential revenue 
to the government, and the destruction of rich biological resources. 
42. Third World governments can stem the destruction of tropical forests and other reservoirs 
of biological diversity while achieving economic goals. They can conserve valuable species and 
habitat while reducing their economic and fiscal burdens. Reforming forest revenue systems 
and concession terms could raise billions of dollars of additional revenues, promote more 
efficient, long-term forest resource use. and curtail deforestation. Governments could save 
themselves enormous expense and revenue loss, promote more sustainable land uses, and 
slow down the destruction of tropical forests by eliminating incentives for livestock ranching. 
43. The link between conservation and development also requires some changes in trade 
patterns. This has been recognized in the establishment in 1986 of the International Tropical 
Timber Organization, based in Yokohama, Japan, which seeks to rationalize trade flows. It has 
been set up to implement the first commodity agreement that incorporates a specific 
conservation component. 
44. Numerous other opportunities can be found to encourage both species conservation and 
economic productivity. Many governments maintain unrealistically low taxes on rural land, 
while allowing settlers to establish title to 'virgin' land by converting it to farmland. Thus 
wealthy landowners can keep huge, underused estates at little or no cost, while land-hungry 
peasants are encouraged to clear forests to establish marginal holdings. Reforms of tax and 
tenure systems could increase productivity on existing holdings and reduce the pressures to
expand cultivation into forests and upland watersheds. 
45. Well-designed ecosystem conservation contributes to the predominant' goals of sustainable 
development in a number of ways. Safeguards for critical tracts of wildlands can serve also to 
safeguard agricultural land, for example. This is particularly true for upland forests of the 
tropics, which protect valley fields from floods and erosion, and waterways and irrigation 
systems from siltation. 
46. A case in point is the Duraoga-Bone Reserve in Indonesia's northern Sulawesi, covering 
some 3,000 square kilometres of upland forest. It protects large populations of most of 
Sulawesi's endemic mammals, and many of the island's 80 endemic bird species. It also 
protects the Dumoga Valley Irrigation Scheme, funded by a World Bank loan, set up in the 
flatlands below to achieve a tripling of rice production on more then 13,000 hectares of prime 
agricultural land./25 Similar examples include the Canaima National Park in Venezuela, which 
protects domestic and industrial water supplies for a major hydropower facility that, in turn, 
provides electricity to the nation's key industrial centre and its capital city. 
47. One conclusion from this connection is that governments could think of 'parks for 
development', insofar as parks serve the dual purpose of protection for species habitats and 
development processes at the same time. National efforts to anticipate and prevent the 
adverse consequences of development policies in any of these areas would surely yield much 
more for species conservation than all the measures of the past 10 years in support of park 
building, ranger patrols, anti-poaching units, and the other conventional forms of wildlife 
preservation. The 3rd World Congress on National Parks, held in Bali, Indonesia, in October 
1982, brought this message from protected area managers to the policy makers of the world, 
demonstrating the many contributions that protected areas managed in the modern way are 
making to sustaining human society. 
VI. International Action for National Species 
48. Species and their genetic resources - whatever their origins - plainly supply benefits to all 
human beings. Wild genetic resources from Mexico and Central America serve the needs of 
maize growers and consumers globally. The principal cocoa-growing nations are in West Africa, 
while the genetic resources on which modern cocoa plantations depend for their continued 
productivity are found in the forests of western Amazonia. 
49. Coffee growers and drinkers depend for the health of the crop on constant supplies of new 
genetic material from coffee's wild relatives, principally located in Ethiopia. Brazil, which 
supplies wild rubber germplasm to Southeast Asia's rubber plantation, itself depends on 
germplasm supplies from diverse parts of the world to sustain its sugar-cane, soybean, and 
other leading crops. Without access to foreign sources of fresh germplasm year by year, the 
nations of Europe and North America would quickly find their agricultural output declining. 
50. The Earth's endowment of species and natural ecosystems will soon be seen as assets to be 
conserved and managed for the benefit of all humanity. This will necessarily add the challenge 
of species conservation to the international political agenda. 
51. At the heart of the issue lies the fact that there is often a conflict between the short-term 
economic interest of the individual nations and the long-term interest of sustainable 
development and potential economic gains of the world community at large. A major thrust in 
actions to conserve genetic diversity must therefore be directed at making it more economically 
attractive both in the short term and in the longer perspective to protect wild species and their 
ecosystems. Developing countries must be ensured an equitable share of the economic profit
from the use of genes for commercial purposes. 
1. Some Current Initiatives 
52. A number of international measures are already being tried. But they are limited in scope, 
only partially successful, and reactive in nature. UNESCO operates a clearing-house for 
information on natural areas and genetic resources. Its World Heritage Fund supports the 
management of a handful of exceptional ecosystems around the world, but all these activities 
receive small budgets. UNESCO has sought to establish a global system of Biosphere Reserves 
representing the Earth's 200 'biotic provinces' and harbouring sample communities of species. 
But only one-third of the needed reserves have been established, even though instituting and 
operating the rest would cost only about $150 million a year./26 
53. UN agencies such as FAO and UNEP run programmes concerned with threatened species, 
genetic resources, and outstanding ecosystems. But their combined activities are tiny in the 
face of the large needs. Among national agencies, the U.S. Agency for International 
Development leads the field in recognizing the value of species conservation. Legislation 
passed by the U.S. Congress in 1986 will make available $2.5 million a year for this purpose./27 
Again, this should be considered an important gesture compared with what has been done to 
date by bilateral agencies, but trifling compared with the needs and opportunities. 
54. IUCN, working in close collaboration with UNEP, WWF, the World Bank, and various 
international technical assistance agencies, has established a 'Conservation Monitoring 
Centre', to provide data on species and ecosystems for any part of the world quickly and easily. 
This service, which is available to all, can help ensure that development projects are designed 
with full information available about the species and ecosystems that might be affected. 
Technical assistance is also available for nations, sectors, and organizations interested in 
establishing local data bases for their own applications. 
55. Species problems tend to be perceived largely in scientific and conservationist terms rather 
than as a leading economic and resource concern. Thus the issue lacks political clout. One 
important initiative that attempts to put conservation more squarely on the agenda of 
international development concerns has been the Tropical Forestry Action Plan. This 
collaborative effort coordinated by FAO involves the World Bank, IUCN, the World Resources 
Institute, and UNDP, along with numerous other collaborating institutions. The broad-based 
effort proposes the formulation of national forestry reviews, national forestry plans, 
identification of new projects, enhanced cooperation between development aid agencies at 
work in the forestry sector. and increased flows of technical and financial resources into 
forestry and related fields such as' smallholder agriculture. 
56. Establishing norms and procedures with respect to resource issues is at least as important 
as increased funding. Precedents for such norms include the Convention on Wetlands of 
International Importance, the Convention on Conservation of Islands for Science (both of 
which safeguard prime habitats and their species), and the Convention on International Trade 
in Endangered Species. These three precedents all help, although the first two are essentially 
reactive attempts to devise 'species refuges'. 
As deforestation progresses, it reduces the quality of life of millions of people in 
developing countries; their survival is threatened by the loss of the vegetation upon 
which they depend for their sources of household energy and many other goods. If 
tropical forests continue to be cleared at the current rate, at least 556 million acres
(225 million hectares) will be cleared by the year 2000; if destruction of the tropical 
rain forests continues unabated, an estimated 10 to 20 per cent of the earth's plant 
and animal life will be gone by the year 2000. 
Reversing deforestation depends on political leadership and appropriate policy 
changes by developing-country governments to support community-level 
initiatives. The key ingredient is active participation by the millions of small farmers 
and landless people who daily use forests and trees to meet their needs. 
J. Gustave Speth 
President, World Resources Institute 
WCED Public Hearing 
Sao Paulo. 28-29 Oct 1985 
2. Setting Priorities 
57. A first priority is to establish the problem of disappearing species and threatened 
ecosystems on political agendas as a major resource issue. The World Charter for Nature, 
adopted by the UN in October 1982, was an important step towards this objective. 
58. Governments should investigate the prospect of agreeing to a 'Species Convention', similar 
in spirit and scope to the Law of the Sea Treaty and other international conventions reflecting 
principles of 'universal resources'. A Species Convention, such as a draft prepared by IUCN, 
should articulate the concept of species and genetic variability as a common heritage. 
59. Collective responsibility for the common heritage would not mean collective international 
rights to particular resources within nations. This approach need not interfere with concepts of 
national sovereignty. But it would mean that individual nations would no longer be left to rely 
on their own isolated efforts to protect species within their borders. 
60. Such a Convention would need to be supported by a financial arrangement that would have 
the active backing of the community of nations. Any such arrangement, and there are several 
possibilities, must not only seek to ensure the conservation of genetic resources for all people, 
but assure that the nations that possess many of these resources obtain an equitable share of 
the benefits and earnings derived from their development. This would greatly encourage the 
conservation of species. One such arrangement might be a Trust Fund to which all nations 
could contribute, with those benefiting most from the use of these resources contributing an 
appropriate share. Governments of tropical forest nations could receive payments to support 
the conservation of given areas of forest, with such payments rising or falling depending on the 
degree to which the forests are maintained and protected./28 
61. The sums required for effective conservation are large. Traditional-type conservation needs 
in tropical forests alone require outlays of $170 million a year for at least five years./29 
However, the network of protected areas that the world will need by the year 2050 must 
include much larger areas brought under some degree of protection and a sophisticated degree 
of flexibility in management techniques./30 
62. More funds will also be required for conservation activities outside protected areas: wildlife 
management, ecodevelopment areas, education campaigns, and so on. Other approaches of a 
less expensive sort include the conservation of wild gene reservoirs of special significance 
through 'genetic conservation areas' in countries well endowed with biological wealth. Much of 
this work can be carried out by citizens' groups and other non-governmental means.
63. International development agencies - the World Bank and other major lending banks. UN 
agencies, and bilateral agencies -should give comprehensive and systematic attention to the 
problems and opportunities of species conservation. Although the international trade in 
wildlife and wildlife products is considerable, to date the economic values inherent in genetic 
variability and ecological processes have been generally disregarded. Possible measures include 
environmental impact analyses of development projects with particular attention to species' 
habitats and life-support systems, identification of crucial localities featuring exceptional 
concentrations of species with exceptional levels of endemism that face exceptional degrees of 
threat, and special opportunities for linking species conservation with development aid. 
VII. Scope for National Action 
64. As indicated earlier, governments need to follow a new approach in this field - one of 
anticipating the impact of their policies in numerous sectors and acting to prevent undesirable 
consequences. They should review programmes in areas such as agriculture, forestry, and 
settlements that serve to degrade and destroy species' habitats. Governments should 
determine how many more protected areas are needed, especially in the spirit of how such 
areas can contribute to national development objectives, and make further provision for 
protection of gene reservoirs (for instance, primitive cultivated varieties) that may not 
normally be preserved through conventional protected areas. 
65. In addition, governments need to reinforce and expand existing strategies. Urgent needs 
include better wildlife and protected-area management, more protected areas of a 
non-conventional type (such as the ecological stations that are proving reasonably successful in 
Brazil), more game cropping and ranching projects (such as the crocodile schemes in India, 
Papua New Guinea, Thailand, and Zimbabwe), more promotion of wildlife-based tourism, and 
stronger anti-poaching measures (even though relatively few species are threatened by 
poaching, compared with the vast numbers threatened by habitat loss). National Conservation 
Strategies, such as those already prepared in over 25 countries, can be important tools for 
coordinating conservation and development programmes. 
66. Other measures governments could take to confront the crisis of disappearing species, 
recognizing that it constitutes a major resource and development challenge, include 
consideration of species conservation needs and opportunities in land use planning and the 
explicit incorporation of their genetic resource stocks into national accounting systems. This 
could entail establishing a natural-resource accounting system that directs particular attention 
to species as high-value yet little-appreciated resources. Finally, they should support and 
expand programmes of public education to ensure that the species question receives the 
attention it deserves throughout the entire population. 
67. Every nation has only limited resources at its disposal for dealing with conservation 
priorities. The dilemma is how to use these resources most effectively. Cooperation with 
neighbouring nations sharing species and ecosystems can help streamline programmes as well 
as share expenses for regional initiatives. Explicit efforts to save particular species will be 
possible for only relatively few of the more spectacular or important ones. Agonizing as it will 
be to make such choices, planners need to make conservation strategies as systematically 
selective as possible. No one cares for the prospect of consigning threatened species to 
oblivion. But insofar as choices are already being made, unwittingly, they should be made with 
selective discretion that takes into account the impact of the extinction of a species upon the 
biosphere or on the integrity of a given ecosystem. 
68. But even though public effort may be concentrated on a few species, all species are
important and deserve some degree of attention; this might take the form of tax credits to 
farmers willing to maintain primitive cultivars. an end to incentives to clear virgin forest, the 
promotion of research attention from local universities, and the preparation of basic 
inventories of native flora and fauna by national institutions. 
The world is unfortunately not what we would like it to be. The problems are many 
and great. Actually, they can only be solved with cooperation and quick-wittedness. 
I represent an organization called 'Nature and Youth'. I know that I have full support 
among our members when I say that we are worried about the future if drastic 
changes do not take place, concerning the world's way of treating our essential 
condition, nature. 
We who work with youth, and are youth ourselves in Norway today, know very well 
how the destroying of nature leads to an apathetic fear among youth concerning 
their future and how it will turn out. 
It is of great importance that common people get the chance to take part in 
deciding how nature should be treated. 
Frederic Hauge 
Nature and Youth 
WCED Public Hearing 
Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 
VIII. The Need for Action 
69. There are numerous signs that the loss of species and their ecosystems is being taken 
seriously as a phenomenon that carries practical implications for people all around the world, 
now and for generations to come. 
70. The recent rise in public concern can be seen in such developments as the growth in 
Kenya's Wildlife Clubs. now numbering more than 1,500 school clubs with around 100.000 
members./31 A parallel development in conservation education has occurred in Zambia. In 
Indonesia, some 400 conservation groups have joined together under the banner of the 
Indonesian Environmental Forum and exert strong political influence./32 In the United States, 
membership of the Audubon Society reached 385,000 in 1985./33 In the Soviet Union, nature 
clubs have over 35 million members./34 All of these indicate that the public puts a value on 
nature that is beyond the normal economic imperatives. 
71. In response to this popular concern, governments have been moving to help species 
threatened within their borders, primarily through the establishment of additional protected 
areas. Today, the worldwide network of protected areas totals more than 4 million square 
kilometres, roughly equivalent to the size of most of the countries of Western Europe 
combined, or twice the size of Indonesia. In terms of continental coverage, protected areas in 
Europe (outside the USSR) amounted by 1985 to 3.9 per cent of territory; in the USSR, to 2.5 
per cent; in North America, to 8.1 per cent; in South America, to 6.1 per cent; in Africa, to 6.5 
per cent; and in Asia (outside the USSR) and Australia, to 4.3 per cent each./35 
72. Since 1970, the networks have expanded in extent by more than 80 per cent, around 
two-thirds of which are in the Third World. But a great deal more remains to be done; a 
consensus of professional opinion suggests that the total expanse of protected areas needs to
be at least tripled if it is to constitute a representative sample of Earth's ecosystems./36 
73. There is still time to save species and their ecosystems. It is an indispensable prerequisite 
for sustainable development. Our failure to do so will not be forgiven by future generations. 
Footnotes 
1/ J. McNeely and K. Miller (eds.), National Parks Conservation and Development; The 
Role of Protected Areas in Sustaining Society, Proceedings of the World Congress on 
National Parks (Washington, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1984). 
2/ W.B. Banage. 'Policies for the Maintenance of Biological Diversity', prepared for WCED, 
1986; P.R. Ehrlich and A.H. Ehrlich. Extinction (New York: Random House. 1981); D. 
Western (ed.), Conservation 2100, Proceedings of Wildlife Conservation International and 
New York Zoological Society Conference, 21-24 October 1986 (New York: Zoological Society, in 
press); N. Myers, 'Tropical Deforestation and Species Extinctions, The Latest News', Futures, 
October 1985; R. Lewin, 'A Mass Extinction Without Asteroids', Science, 3 October 1986; P.H. 
Raven. 'Statement from Meeting of IUCN/WWF Plant Advisory Group', Las Palmas, Canary 
Islands, 24-25 November 1985; M.E. Soule (ed.), Conservation Biology: Science of 
Scarcity and Diversity (Sunderland, Mass.: Sinauer Associates, 1986); E.O. Wilson (ed.), 
Biodiversity, Proceedings of National Forum held by National Academy of 
Sciences and Smithsonian Institution, 21-24 September 1986 (Washington, DC: 
National Academy Press, forthcoming). 
3/ O.H. Frankel and M.E. Soule. Conservation and Evolution (Cambridge: Cambridge 
University Press, 1981): CM. Schonewald-Cox et al. (eds.). Genetics and Conservation 
(Menlo Park. Calif.: Benjamin/Cummings Publishing Company Inc., 1983). 
4/ D.D. Raup. 'Biological Extinction in Earth History', Science. 28 March 1986. 
5/ Wilson, op. cit.; Ehrlich and Ehrlich, op. cit.; Myers. 'The Latest News', op. cit.; Soule. op. 
cit. 
6/ G.D. Ruggieri and N.D. Rosenberg, The Healing Sea (New York: Dodd Mead and Co., 
1978). 
7/ FAO/UNEP. Tropical Forest Resources. Forestry Paper No. 30 (Rome: 1982); J.M. 
Melillo et al., 'A Comparison of Recent Estimates of Disturbance in Tropical Forests', 
Environmental Conservation. Spring 1985; N. Myers. The Primary Source (New York: 
W.W. Norton, 1984); Myers 'The Latest News', op. cit.; J. Molofsky et al., 'A Comparison of 
Tropical Forest Surveys', Carbon Dioxide Program. U.S. Department of Energy. Washington 
DC. 1986. 
8/ D. Simberloff, 'Are We On the Verge of a Mass Extinction in Tropical Rain Forests?' in D.K. 
Elliott (ed.), Dynamics of Extinction (Chichester. UK: John Wiley & Sons. 1986); Raven. op. 
cit. 
9/ E. Salati and P.B. Vose, 'Amazon Basin: A System in Equilibrium', Science, 13 July 1984. 
10/ Department of International Economic and Social Affairs, World Population 
Prospects: Estimates and Projections as Assessed in 1984 (New York: UN. 1986). 
11/ R. Repetto. 'Creating Incentives for Sustainable Forestry Development', World Resources
Institute. Washington. DC, August 1985. 
12/ Ibid. 
13/ Agricultural Research Service, Introduction, Classification. Maintenance. 
Evaluation, and Documentation of Plant Germplasm (Washington. DC: U.S. 
Department of Agriculture. 1985). 
14/ L.A. Tatum. 'The Southern Corn Leaf Blight Epidemic', Science. Vol. 171. pp. 1113-16, 1971. 
15/ H.H. Iltis et al., 'Zea diploperennis (Gramineae), a New Teosinte from Mexico', Science, 12 
January 1979. 
16/ A.C. Fisher. 'Economic Analysis and the Extinction of Species', Department of Energy and 
Resources. University of California. Berkeley. 1982. 
17/ N.R. Farnsworth and D.D. Soejarto. 'Potential Consequence of Plant Extinction in the 
United States on the Current and Future Availability of Prescription Drugs', Economic 
Botany, Vol. 39. pp. 231-40. 1985. 
18/ N. Myers, A Wealth of Wild Species (Boulder, Colo.: Westview Press. 1983). 
19/ Ibid. 
20/ M.L. Oldfield, 'The Value of Conserving Genetic Resources', National Park Service. U.S. 
Department of the Interior. Washington, DC, 1984; L.H. Princen, 'New Crop Development for 
Industrial Oils', Journal of the American Oil Chemists' Society, Vol. 56, pp. 845-48, 
1979. 
21/ A.H. Gentry and R. Wettach, 'Fevillea - A New Oilseed from Amazonian Peru', Economic 
Botany, Vol. 40, pp. 177-85, 1986. 
22/ M. Calvin. 'Hydrocarbons from Plants: Analytical Methods and Observations', 
Naturwissenschaften. Vol. 67, pp. 525-33, 1980; C.W. Hinman et al., 'Five Potential New 
Crops for Arid Lands', Environmental Conservation. Winter 1985. 
23/ T. Eisner. 'Chemicals. Genes, and the Loss of Species'. Nature Conservancy News, Vol. 
33. No. 6, pp. 23-24, 1983. 
24/ W.J. Brill. 'Nitrogen Fixation: Basic to Applied', American Scientist, Vol. 67, pp. 458-65. 
1979. 
25/ McNeely and Miller, op. cit. 
26/ UNESCO, International Coordinating Council of Man and the Biosphere. MAB 
Report Series No. 58 (Paris: 1985). 
27/ Letter to N. Myers, Consultant in Environment and Development, from Senator W. Roth 
(R-Del.), U.S. Congress, Washington. DC. 
28/ R.A. Sedjo, Testimony before the Subcommittee on Human Rights and international 
Organizations. Foreign Affairs Committee, U.S. House of Representatives, 12 September 1984. 
29/ International Task Force. Tropical Forests: A Call for Action (Washington, DC: World 
Resources Institute, 1985).
30/ R.L. Peters and J.D.S. Darling, 'The Greenhouse Effect of Nature Reserves', Bioscience, 
Vol. 35, pp. 707-17. 1984. 
31/ 'Kenya's Wildlife Clubs' (Brochure). Ed Wilson. WWF Regional Office for East and Central 
Africa, personal communication, 3 February 1987. 
32/ Centre for Environmental Studies, Environmental NGO's in Developing Countries 
(Copenhagen: 1985). 
33/ Membership figure from Audubon circulation in Ulrich's Periodicals (New York: R.W. 
Bowker, 1985). 
34/ Prof. Yazan, IUCN Vice-President and Regional Counsellor, IUCN Bulletin. Vol. 17, Nos. 
7-9. 
35/ List of National Parks and Equivalent Reserves (IUCN: 1985). 
36/ McNeely and Miller, op. cit.
Our Common Future, Chapter 7: Energy: Choices for Environment 
and Development 
Energy, Economy, I. and Environment 
II. Fossil Fuels: The Continuing Dilemma 
1. Managing Climatic change 
2. Reducing Urban-Industrial Air Pollution 
3. Damage from the Long-Range Transport of Air Pollution 
III. Nuclear Energy: Unsolved Problems 
1. The Peaceful Atom 
2. The Growing Understanding of Nuclear Issues 
3. The Current International Situation 
4. Conclusions and Recommendations 
IV. Wood Fuels: The Vanishing Resource 
V. Renewable Energy: The Untapped Potential 
VI. Energy Efficiency: Maintaining the Momentum 
VII. Energy Conservation Measures 
VIII. Conclusion 
1. Energy is necessary for daily survival. Future development crucially depends on its long-term 
availability in increasing quantities from sources that are dependable, safe, and 
environmentally sound. At present, no single source or mix of sources is at hand to meet this 
future need. 
2. Concern about a dependable future for energy is only natural since energy provides 
'essential services' for human life - heat for warmth, cooking, and manufacturing, or power for 
transport and mechanical work. At present, the energy to provide these services comes from 
fuels - oil, gas, coal, nuclear, wood, and other primary sources (solar, wind, or water power) - 
that are all useless until they are converted into the energy services needed, by machines or 
other kinds of end-use equipment, such as stoves, turbines, or motors. In many countries 
worldwide, a lot of primary energy is wasted because of the inefficient design or running of the 
equipment used to convert it into the services required; though there is an encouraging growth
in awareness of energy conservation and efficiency. 
3. Today's primary sources of energy are mainly non-renewable: natural gas, oil, coal, peat, and 
conventional nuclear power. There are also renewable sources, including wood, plants, dung, 
falling water, geothermal sources, solar, tidal, wind, and wave energy, as well as human and 
animal muscle-power. Nuclear reactors that produce their own fuel ('breeders') and eventually 
fusion reactors are also in this category. In theory, all the various energy sources can 
contribute to the future energy mix worldwide. But each has its own economic, health, and 
environmental costs, benefits, and risks - factors that interact strongly with other 
governmental and global priorities. Choices must be made, but in the certain knowledge that 
choosing an energy strategy inevitably means choosing an environmental strategy. 
4. Patterns and changes of energy use today are already dictating patterns well into the next 
century. We approach this question from the standpoint of sustainability. The key elements of 
sustainability that have to be reconciled are: 
sufficient growth of energy supplies to meet human needs (which means accommodating 
a minimum of 3 per cent per capita income growth in developing countries); 
energy efficiency and conservation measures, such that waste of primary resources is 
minimized; 
public health, recognizing the problems of risks to safety inherent in energy sources; and 
protection of the biosphere and prevention of more localized forms of pollution. 
5. The period ahead must be regarded as transitional from an era in which energy has been 
used in an unsustainable manner. A generally acceptable pathway to a safe and sustainable 
energy future has not yet been found. We do not believe that these dilemmas have yet been 
addressed by the international community with a sufficient sense of urgency and in a global 
perspective. 
I. Energy, Economy, and Environment 
6. The growth or energy demand in response to industrialization, urbanization, and societal 
affluence has led to an extremely uneven global distribution of primary energy consumption./1 
The consumption of energy per person in industrial market economies, for example, is more 
than 80 times greater than in sub-Saharan Africa. (See Table 7-1.) And about a quarter of the 
world's population consumes three-quarters of the world's primary energy. 
Table 7-1 
Global Primary Energy Consumption Per Capita, 1984 
GNP Per 
Capita 
Energy 
Consumption 
Mid-1984 
Population 
Total 
Consumption 
(1984 dollars) (kW per 
capita*) 
(million) (TW) 
World Bank GNP Economy 
Category
Low Income 260 0.41 2,390 0.99 
Sub-Saharan Africa 210 0.08 258 0.02 
Lower-middle 740 0.57 691 0.39 
Upper-middle 1,950 1.76 497 0.87 
Sub-Saharan Africa 660 0.25 148 0.04 
High-Income Oil Exporters 11,250 5.17 19 0.10 
Industrial Market 
Economies 
11,430 7.01 733 5.14 
East European 
Non-Market Economies 
6.27 389 2.44 
World 2.11** 4.718 9.94 
*kW per capita is kW years/year per capita. 
** Population-weighted average energy consumption (kW/capita) for first three main 
categories is 0.654 and for industrial market and East European categories is 6.76. 
Source: Based on World Bank, World Development Report 1985 (New York: Oxford 
University Press, 1986). 
7. In 1980, global energy consumption stood at around 10TW./2 (See Box 7-1.) if per capita use 
remained at the same levels as today, by 2025 a global population of 6.2 billion/3 would need 
about 14TW (over 4TW in developing and over 9TW in industrial countries) - an increase of 40 
per cent over 1980. But if energy consumption per head became uniform worldwide at current 
industrial country levels, by 2025 that same global population would require about 55TW. 
Box 7-1 Energy Units 
A variety of units are used to measure energy production and use in physical terms. 
This chapter user; the kilowatt (kW); the Gigawatt (GW), which is equal to 1 million 
kW; and the Terawatt (TW), which is equal to 1 billion kilowatts. One kilowatt - a 
thousand watts of energy - if emitted continuously for a year is lkW year. Consuming 1 
kW year/year is equivalent to the energy liberated by burning 1,050 kilogrammes - 
approximately 1 ton - of coal annually. Thus a TW year is equal to approximately 1 
billion tons of coal. Throughout the chapter, TW years/year is written as TW. 
8. Neither the 'low' nor the 'high' figure is likely to prove realistic, but they give a rough idea of 
the range within which energy futures could move, at least hypothetically. Many other 
scenarios can be generated in-between, some of which assume an improved energy base for the 
developing world. For instance, if the average energy consumption in the low- and middle-income 
economies trebled and doubled, respectively, and if consumption in the high-income 
oil-exporting and industrial market and non-market countries remained the same as today,
then the two groups would be consuming about the same amounts of energy. The low- and 
middle-income categories would need 10.5TW and the three 'high' categories would use 9.3TW 
- totalling 20TW globally, assuming that primary energy is used at the same levels of efficiency 
as today. 
9. How practical are any of these scenarios? Energy analysts have conducted many studies of 
global energy futures to the years 2020-2030./4 Such studies do not provide forecasts of future 
energy needs, but they explore how various technical, economic, and environmental factors 
may interact with supply and demand. Two of these are reviewed in Box 7-2, though a much 
wider range of scenarios - from 5TW up to 63TW - are available. In general, the lower scenarios 
(14.4TW by 2030,/5 11.2TW by 2020./6 and 5.2 by 2030/7) require an energy efficiency 
revolution. The higher scenarios (18.8TW by 2025./8 24.7TW by 2020,/9 and 35.2 by 2030/10) 
aggravate the environmental pollution problems that we have experienced since the Second 
World War.
Box 7-2 Two Indicative Energy Scenarios 
Case A: High Scenario 
By the year 2030, a 35TW future would involve producing 1.6 tines as much oil, 3.4 
times as much natural gas, and nearly 5 times as much coal as in 1960. This increase 
in fossil fuel use implies bringing the equivalent of a new Alaska pipeline into 
production every one to two years. Nuclear capacity would have to be increased 30 
times over 1960 levels - equivalent to installing a new nuclear power station 
generating 1-gigawatt of electricity every two to four days. This 35TW scenario is still 
well below the 55TW future that assumes today's levels of energy consumption per 
capita in industrial countries are achieved in all countries. 
Case B: Low Scenario 
Taking the 11.2TW scenario as a highly optimistic example of a strong conservation 
strategy. 2020 energy demand in developing and industrial countries is quoted as 
7.3TW and 3.9TW respectively, as compared with 3.3TW and 7.0TW in 1980. This 
would mean a saving of 3.1TW in industrial countries by 2020 and an additional 
requirement of 4.0TW in developing countries. Even if developing countries were 
able to acquire the liberated primary resource, they would still be left with a shortfall 
of 0.9TW in primary supply. Such a deficit is likely to be much greater (possibly two 
to three times), given the extreme level of efficiency required for this scenario, which 
is unlikely to be realized by most governments. In 1980, the following breakdown of 
primary supply was quoted: oil, 4.2TW; coal, 2.4; gas, 1.7; renewables, 1.7; and 
nuclear, 0.2. The question is - where will the shortfall in primary energy supply come 
from? This rough calculation serves to illustrate that the postulated average growth 
of around 30 per cent per capita in primary consumption in developing countries will 
still require considerable amounts of primary supply even under extremely efficient 
energy usage regimes. 
Sources: The 35TW scenario was originated in Energy Systems Group of the 
International Institute for Applied Systems Analysis, Energy in a Finite World - 
A Global Systems Analysis, (Cambridge, Mass.: Ballinger, 1981); all other 
calculations are from J. Goldemberg et al., 'An End-Use Oriented Global Energy 
Strategy', Annual Review of Energy, Vol. 10, 1985. 
10. The economic implications of a high energy future are disturbing. A recent World Bank 
Study indicates that for the period 1960-95, a 4.1 per cent annual growth in energy 
consumption, approximately comparable to Case A in Box 7-2, would require an average annual 
investment of some $130 billion (in 1982 dollars) in developing countries alone. This would 
involve doubling the share of energy investment in terms of aggregate gross domestic 
product./11 About half of this would have to come from foreign exchange and the rest from 
internal spending on energy in developing countries. 
11. The environmental risks and uncertainties of a high energy future are also disturbing and 
give rise to several reservations. Four stand out: 
the serious probability of climate change generated by the 'greenhouse effect' of gases
emitted to the atmosphere, the most important of which is carbon dioxide (CO2) 
produced from the combustion of fossil fuels/12; 
urban-industrial air pollution caused by atmospheric pollutants from the combustion of 
fossil fuels/13; 
acidification of the environment from the same causes/14; and 
the risks of nuclear reactor accidents, the problems of waste disposal and dismantling of 
reactors after their service life is over, and the dangers of proliferation associated with 
the use of nuclear energy. 
Along with these, a major problem arises from the growing scarcity of fuelwood in developing 
countries. If trends continue, by the year 2000 around 2.4 billion people may be living in areas 
where wood is extremely scarce./15 
12. These reservations apply at even lower levels of energy use. A study that proposed energy 
consumption at only half the levels of Case A (Box 7-2) drew special attention to the risks of 
global warning from CO2./16 The study indicated that a realistic fuel mix - a virtual quadrupling 
of coal and a doubling of gas use, along with 1.4 times as much oil - could cause significant 
global warming by the 2020s. No technology currently exists to remove CO2 emissions from 
fossil fuel combustion. The high coal use would also increase emissions of oxides of sulphur 
and nitrogen, much of which turns to acids in the atmosphere. Technologies to remove these 
latter emissions are now required in some countries in all new and even some old facilities, but 
they can increase investment costs by 15-25 per cent./17 If countries are not prepared to incur 
these expenses, this path becomes even more infeasible, a limitation that applies much more to 
the higher energy futures that rely to a greater extent on fossil fuels. A near doubling of global 
primary energy consumption will be difficult without encountering severe economic, social, 
and environmental constraints. 
Energy is, put most simply, the fundamental unit of the physical world. As such, we 
cannot conceive of development without changes in the extent or the nature of 
energy flows. And because it is so fundamental, every one of those changes of 
flows has environmental implications. The implications of this are profound. It 
means that there is no such thing as a simple energy choice. They are all complex. 
And they all involve trade-offs. However, some of the choices and some of the 
trade-offs appear to be unequivocally better than others, in the sense that they 
offer more development and less environmental damage. 
David Brooks 
Friends of the Earth 
WCED Public Hearings 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
13. This raises the desirability of a lower energy future, where GDP growth is not constrained 
but where investment effort is switched away from building more primary supply sources and 
put into the development and supply of highly efficient fuel-saving end-use equipment. In this 
way, the energy services needed by society could be supplied at much reduced levels of primary 
energy production. Case B in Box 7-2 allows for a 50 per cent fall in per capita primary energy 
consumption in industrial countries and a 30 per cent increase in developing countries./18 By 
using the most energy-efficient technologies and processes now available in all sectors of the
economy, annual global per capita GDP growth rates of around 3 per cent can be achieved. This 
growth is at least as great as that regarded in this report as a minimum for reasonable 
development. But this path would require huge structural changes to allow market penetration 
of efficient technologies, and it seems unlikely to be fully realizable by most governments 
during the next 40 years. 
14. The crucial point about these lower, energy-efficient futures is not whether they are 
perfectly realisable in their proposed time frames. Fundamental political and institutional 
shifts are required to restructure investment potential in order to move along these lower, 
more energy-efficient paths. 
15. The Commission believes that there is no other realistic option open to the world for the 
21st century. The ideas behind these lower scenarios are not fanciful. Energy efficiency has 
already shown cost-effective results. In many industrial countries, the primary energy required 
to produce a unit of GDP has fallen by as much as a quarter or even a third over the last 13 
years, much of it from implementing energy efficiency measures./19 Properly managed, 
efficiency measures could allow industrial nations to stabilize their primary energy 
consumption by the turn of the century. They would also enable developing countries to 
achieve higher levels of growth with much reduced levels of investment, foreign debt, and 
environmental damage. But by the early decades of the 21st century they will not alleviate the 
ultimate need for substantial new energy supplies globally. 
II. Fossil Fuels: The Continuing Dilemma 
16. Many forecasts of recoverable oil reserves and resources suggest that oil production will 
level off by the early decades of the next century and then gradually fall during a period of 
reduced supplies and higher prices. Gas supplies should last over 200 years and coal about 
3.000 years at present rates of use. These estimates persuade many analysts that the world 
should immediately embark on a vigorous oil conservation policy. 
17. In terms of pollution risks, gas is by far the cleanest fuel, with oil next and coal a poor third. 
But they all pose three interrelated atmospheric pollution problems: global warming,/20 urban 
industrial air pollution,/21 and acidification of the environment./22 Some of the wealthier 
industrial countries may possess the economic capacity to cope with such threats. Most 
developing countries do not. 
18. These problems are becoming more widespread particularly in tropical and subtropical 
regions, but their economic, social, and political repercussions are as yet not fully appreciated 
by society. With the exception of CO2, air pollutants can be removed from fossil fuel 
combustion processes at costs usually below the costs of damage caused by pollution./23 
However, the risks of global warming make heavy future reliance upon fossil fuels problematic. 
1. Managing Climatic change 
19. The burning of fossil fuels and, to a lesser extent, the loss of vegetative cover, particularly 
forests, through urban-industrial growth increase the accumulation of CO2 in the atmosphere. 
The pre-industrial concentration was about 280 parts of carbon dioxide per million parts of air 
by volume. This concentration reached 340 in 1980 and is expected to double to 560 between 
the middle and the end of the next century./24 Other gases also play an important role in this 
'greenhouse effect', whereby solar radiation is trapped near the ground, warming the globe and 
changing the climate.
20. After reviewing the latest evidence on the greenhouse effect in October 1985 at a meeting in 
Villach, Austria, organized by the WMO, UNEP, and ICSU, scientists from 29 industrialized 
and developing countries concluded that climate change must be considered a 'plausible and 
serious probability. They further concluded that: 'Many important economic and social 
decisions are being made today on ... major water resource management activities such as 
irrigation and hydropower; drought relief; agricultural land use; structural designs and coastal 
engineering projects; and energy planning - all based on the assumption that past climatic 
data, without modification, are a reliable guide to the future. This is no longer a good 
assumption'./25 
21. They estimated that if present trends continue, the combined concentration of CO2 and 
other greenhouse gases in the atmosphere would be equivalent to a doubling of CO2 from 
pre-industrial levels, possibly as early as the 2030s, and could lead to a rise in global mean 
temperatures 'greater than any in man's history'./26 Current modelling studies and 
'experiments' show a rise in globally averaged surface temperatures, for an effective CO2 
doubling, of somewhere between 1.5°C and 4.5°C, With the warming becoming more 
pronounced at higher latitudes during winter than at the equator. 
22. An important concern is that a global temperature rise of 1.5-4.5°C, with perhaps a two to 
three times greater warming at the poles, would lead to a sea level rise of 25-140 
centimetres./27 A rise in the upper part of this range would inundate low-lying coastal cities 
and agricultural areas, and many countries could expect their economic, social, and political 
structures to be severely disrupted. It would also alow the 'atmospheric heat-engine', which is 
driven by the differences between equatorial and polar temperatures, thus influencing rainfall 
regimes./28 Experts believe that crop and forest boundaries will move to higher latitudes; the 
effects of warmer oceans on marine ecosystems or fisheries and food chains are also virtually 
unknown. 
23. There is no way to prove that any of this will happen until it actually occurs. The key 
question is: How much certainty should governments require before agreeing to take action? If 
they wait until significant climate change is demonstrated, it may be too late for any 
countermeasures to be effective against the inertia by then stored in this massive global 
system. The very long time lags involved in negotiating international agreement on complex 
issues involving all nations have led some experts to conclude that it is already late./29 Given 
the complexities and uncertainties surrounding the issue, it is urgent that the process start 
now. A four track strategy is needed, combining: 
improved monitoring and assessment of the evolving phenomena; 
increased research to improve knowledge about the origins, mechanisms, and effects of 
the phenomena; 
the development of internationally agreed policies for the reduction of the causative 
gases; and 
adoption of strategies needed to minimize damage and cope with the climate changes, 
and rising sea level. 
24. No nation has either the political mandate or the economic power to combat climatic 
change alone. However, the Villach statement recommended such a four track strategy for 
climate change, to be promoted by governments and the scientific community through WMO, 
UNEP, and ICSU - backed by a global convention if necessary./30
It is difficult to imagine an issue with more global impacts on human societies and 
the natural environment than the greenhouse effect. The signal is unclear but we 
may already be witnessing examples, if not actual greenhouse effects, in Africa. 
The ultimate potential impacts of a greenhouse warming could be catastrophic. It is 
our considered judgement that it is already very late to start the process of policy 
consideration. The process of heightening public awareness, of building support 
for national policies, and finally for developing multilateral efforts to slow the rate 
of emissions growth will take time to implement. 
The greenhouse issue is an opportunity as well as a challenge; not surprisingly, it 
provides another important reason to implement sustainable development 
strategies. 
Irving Mintzer 
World Resources Institute 
WCED Public Hearing 
Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 
25. While these strategies are being developed, more immediate policy measures can and 
should be adopted. The most urgent are those required to increase and extend the recent 
steady gains in energy efficiency and to shift the energy mix more towards renewables. Carbon 
dioxide output globally could be significantly reduced by energy efficiency measures without 
any reduction of the tempo of GDP growth./31 These measures would also serve to abate other 
emissions and thus reduce acidification and urban-industrial air pollution. Gaseous fuels 
produce less carbon dioxide per unit of energy output than oil or coal and should be promoted, 
especially for cooking and other domestic uses. 
26. Gases other than carbon dioxide are thought to be responsible for about one-third of 
present global warming, and it is estimated that they will cause about half the problem around 
2030./32 some of these, notably chlorofluorocarbons used as aerosols, refrigeration chemicals, 
and in the manufacture of plastics, may be more easily controlled than CO2. These, although 
not strictly energy-related, will have a decisive influence on policies for managing carbon 
dioxide emissions. 
27. Apart from their climatic effect, chlorofluorocarbons are responsible to a large extent for 
damage to the earth's stratospheric ozone./33 The chemical industry should make every effort 
to find replacements, and governments should require the use of such replacements when 
found (as some nations have outlawed the use of these chemicals as aerosols). Governments 
should ratify the existing ozone convention and develop protocols for the limitation of 
chlorofluorocarbon emissions, and systematically monitor and report implementation. 
28. A lot of policy development work is needed. This should proceed hand in hand with 
accelerated research to reduce remaining scientific uncertainties. Nations urgently need to 
formulate and agree upon management policies for all environmentally reactive chemicals 
released into the atmosphere by human activities, particularly those that can influence the 
radiation balance on earth. Governments should initiate discussions leading to a convention on 
this matter. 
29. If a convention on chemical containment policies cannot be implemented rapidly, 
governments should develop contingency strategies and plans for adaptation to climatic
change. In either case, WMO, UNEP, WHO, ICSU, and other relevant international and 
national bodies should be encouraged to coordinate and accelerate their programmes to 
develop a carefully integrated strategy of research, monitoring, and assessment of the likely 
impacts on climate, health, and environment of all environmentally reactive chemicals released 
into the atmosphere in significant quantities. 
2. Reducing Urban-Industrial Air Pollution 
30. The past three decades of generally rapid growth worldwide have seen dramatic increases 
in fuel consumption for heating and cooling, automobile transport, industrial activities, and 
electricity generation. Concern over the effects of increasing air pollution in the late 1960s 
resulted in the development of curative measures, including air-quality criteria, standards, and 
add-on control technologies that can remove pollutants cost-effectively. All these greatly 
reduced emissions of some of the principal pollutants and cleaned air over many cities. Despite 
this, air pollution has today reached serious levels in the cities of several industrial and newly 
industrialized countries as well as in those of most developing countries, which in some cases 
are by now the world's most polluted urban areas. 
31. The fossil fuel emissions of principal concern in terms of urban pollution, whether from 
stationary or mobile sources, include sulphur dioxide, nitrogen oxides, carbon monoxide, 
various volatile organic compounds, fly ash, and other suspended particles. They can injure 
human health and the environment, bringing increased respiratory complaints, some 
potentially fatal. But these pollutants can be contained so as to protect human health and the 
environment and all governments should take steps to achieve acceptable levels of air quality. 
32. Governments can establish and monitor air quality goals and objectives, allowable 
atmospheric loadings, and related emission criteria or standards, as some successfully do 
already. Regional organizations can support this effort. Multilateral and bilateral development 
assistance agencies and development banks should encourage governments to require that the 
most energy-efficient technology be used when industries and energy utilities plan to build new 
or extend existing facilities. 
3. Damage from the Long-Range Transport of Air Pollution 
33. Measures taken by many industrialized countries in the 1970s to control urban and 
industrial air pollution (high chimney stacks, for example) greatly improved the quality of the 
air in the cities concerned. However, it quite unintentionally sent increasing amounts of 
pollution across national boundaries in Europe and North America, contributing to the 
acidification of distant environments and creating new pollution problems. This was manifest 
in growing damage to lakes, soils, and communities of plants and animals./34 Failure to control 
automobile pollution in some regions has seriously contributed to the problem. 
34. Thus atmospheric pollution, once perceived only as a local urban-industrial problem 
involving people's health, is now also seen as a much more complex issue encompassing 
buildings, ecosystems, and maybe even public health over vast regions. During transport in the 
atmosphere, emissions of sulphur and nitrogen oxides and volatile hydrocarbons are 
transformed into sulphuric and nitric acids, ammonium salts, and ozone. They fall to the 
ground, sometimes many hundreds or thousands of kilometres from their origins, as dry 
particles or in rain, snow, frost, fog, and dew. Few studied of their socio-economic costs are 
available, but these demonstrate that they are quite large and suggest that they are growing 
rapidly./35 They damage vegetation, contribute to land and water pollution, and corrode
buildings, metallic structures and vehicles, causing billions of dollars in damage annually. 
35. Damage first became evident in Scandinavia in the 1960s. Several thousand lakes in 
Europe, particularly in southern Scandinavia/36, and several hundreds in North America/37 
have registered a steady increase in acidity levels to the point where their natural fish 
populations have declined or died out. The same acids enter the soil and groundwater, 
increasing corrosion of drinking water piping in Scandinavia./38 
36. The circumstantial evidence indicating the need for action on the sources of acid 
precipitation is mounting with a speed that gives scientists and governments little time to 
assess it scientifically. Some of the greatest observed damage has been reported in Central 
Europe, which is currently receiving more than one gramme of sulphur on every square metre 
of ground each year, at least five times greater than natural background./39 There was little 
evidence of tree damage in Europe in 1970. In 1962, the Federal Republic of Germany reported 
visible leaf damage in its forest plot samples nationwide, amounting in 1983 to 34 per cent, and 
rising in 1985 to BO per cent./40 Sweden reported light to moderate damage in 30 per cent of 
its forests, and various reports from other countries in Eastern and Western Europe are 
extremely disquieting. So far an estimated 14 per cent of all European forestland is affected./41 
37. The evidence is not all in, but many reports show soils in parts of Europe becoming acid 
throughout the tree rooting layers,/42 particularly nutrient-poor soils such as those of 
Southern Sweden/43 The precise damage mechanisms are not known, but all theories include 
an air pollution component. Root damage/44 and leaf damage appear to interact - affecting the 
ability of the trees both to take up water from the soil and to retain it in the foliage, so that they 
become particularly vulnerable to dry spells and other stresses. Europe may be experiencing an 
immense change to irreversible acidification, the remedial costs of which could be beyond 
economic reach./45 (See Box 7-3.) Although there are many options for reducing sulphur, 
nitrogen, and hydrocarbon emissions, no single pollutant control strategy is likely to be 
effective in dealing with forest decline. It will require a total integrated mix of strategies and 
technologies to improve air quality, tailored for each region. 
A forest in an ecosystem that exists under certain environmental conditions, and if 
you change the conditions, the system is going to change. It is a very difficult task 
for ecologists to foresee what changes are going to be because the systems are 
so enormously complex. 
The direct causes behind an individual tree dying can be far removed from the 
primary pressure that brought the whole system into equilibrium. One time it might 
be ozone, another time it may be SO2, a third time it may be aluminium poisoning. 
I can express myself by an analogy: If there is famine, there are relatively few 
people who die directly from starvation: they die from dysentery or various 
infectious diseases. And in such a situation, it is not of very much help to send 
medicine instead of food. That means that in this situation, it is necessary to 
address the primary pressures against the ecosystem. 
Alf Johnels 
Swedish Museum of Natural History 
WCED Public Hearing 
Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 
38. Evidence of local air pollution and acidification in Japan and also in the newly
industrialized countries of Asia, Africa, and Latin America is beginning to emerge. China and 
the Republic of Korea seem particularly vulnerable, as do Brazil, Colombia, Ecuador, and 
Venezuela. So little is known about the likely environmental loading of sulphur and nitrogen in 
these region and about the acid-neutralizing capacity of tropical lakes and forest soils that a 
comprehensive programme of investigation should be formulated without delay./46 
39. Where actual or potential threats from acidification exist, governments should map 
sensitive areas, assess forest damage annually and soil impoverishment every five years 
according to regionally agreed protocols, and publish the findings. They should support 
transboundary monitoring of pollution being carried out by agencies in their region and, where 
there is no such agency, create one or give the job to any suitable regional body. Governments 
in many regions could gain significantly from early agreement to prevent transboundary air 
pollution and the enormous damage to their economic base now being experienced in Europe 
and North America. Even though the exact causes of the damage are hard to prove, reduction 
strategies are certainly within reach and economic. They could be viewed as a cheap insurance 
policy compared with the vast amount of potential damage these strategies avoid.
Box 7-3 The Damage and Control Costs of Air Pollution 
It is very difficult to quantify damage control costs, not least because cost figures are 
highly dependent on the control strategy assumed. However, in the eastern United 
States, it has been estimated that halving the remaining sulphur dioxide emissions 
from existing sources would cost $5 billion a year, increasing present electricity rates 
by 2-3 per cent. If nitrogen oxides are figured in, the additional costs might be as high 
as $6 billion a year. Materials corrosion damage alone is estimated to cost $7 billion 
annually in 17 states in the eastern United states. 
Estimates of the annual costs of securing a 55 to 65 per cent reduction in the 
remaining sulphur emissions in the countries of the European Economic Community 
between 1980 and 2000 range from $4.6 billion to $6.7 billion (1982 dollars) per year. 
Controls on stationary boilers to reduce nitrogen levels by only 10 per cent annually 
by the year 2000 range between $100,000 and $400,000 (1982 dollars). These 
figures translate into a one-time increase of about 6 per cent in the price of electrical 
power to the consumer. Studies place damage costs due to material and fish losses 
alone at $3 billion a year, while damage to crops, forests, and health are estimated to 
exceed $10 billion per year. Technologies for drastically reducing oxides of nitrogen 
and hydrocarbons from automobile exhaust gases are readily available and routinely 
used in North America and Japan, but not in Europe. 
Japanese laboratory studies indicate that air pollution and acid rain can reduce some 
wheat and rice crop production, perhaps by as much as 30 per cent. 
Sources: U.S. Congress, Office of Technology Assessment, Acid Rain and 
Transported Air Pollutants: Implications for Public Policy (Washington, 
DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1985); U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, 
Acid Deposition Assessment (Washington, DC: 1985); I.M. Torrens, 'Acid Rain 
and Air Pollution: A Problem of Industrialization', prepared for WCED, 1985; P. 
Mandelbaum, Acid Rain - Economic Assessment (New York: Plenum Press, 
1985); M. Hashimoto, 'National Air quality Management Policy of Japan', prepared 
for WCED, 1985; OECD, The State of the Environment (Paris: 1985). 
III. Nuclear Energy: Unsolved Problems 
1. The Peaceful Atom 
40. In the years following the Second World War, the nuclear knowledge that under military 
control had led to the production of atomic weapons was redeployed for peaceful 'energy' 
purposes by civilian technologists. Several benefits were obvious at the time. 
41. It was also realized that no energy source would ever be risk-free. There was the danger of 
nuclear war, the spread of atomic weapons, and nuclear terrorism. But intensive international 
cooperation and a number of negotiated agreements suggested that these dangers could be 
avoided. For instance, the Nonproliferation Treaty (NPT), drafted in its final form in 1969, 
included a promise by signatory governments possessing nuclear weapons and expertise to 
pursue and undertake nuclear disarmament ad also to assist the non-nuclear signatories in
developing nuclear power, but strictly for peaceful purposes only. Other problems, such as 
radiation risks, reactor safety, and nuclear waste disposal were all acknowledged as very 
important but, with the right amount of effort, containable. 
42. And now, after almost four decades of immense technological effort to support nuclear 
development, nuclear energy has become widely used. Some 30 governments produce from 
nuclear generators a total of about 15 per cent of all the electricity used globally. Yet it has not 
met earlier expectations that it would be the key to ensuring an unlimited supply of low-cost 
energy. However, during this period of practical experience with building and running nuclear 
reactors, the nature of the costs, risks and benefits have become much more evident and as 
such, the subject of sharp controversy. 
2. The Growing Understanding of Nuclear Issues 
43. The potential for the spread of nuclear weapons is one of the most serious threats to world 
peace. It is in the interest of all nations to prevent proliferation of nuclear weapons. All nations 
therefore should contribute to the development of a viable non-proliferation regime. The 
nuclear weapon states must deliver on their promise to reduce the number and ultimately 
eliminate nuclear weapons in their arsenals and the role those weapons play in their strategies. 
And the non-nuclear-weapon states must cooperate in providing credible assurances that they 
are not moving towards a nuclear weapon capability. 
The health risks for the development of peaceful uses of nuclear technology, 
including nuclear electricity, are very small when compared with the benefits from 
the use of nuclear radiation for medical diagnosis treatment. 
The safe application of nuclear radiation technology promises many benefits in 
environmental clean-up and in increasing world food supplies by eliminating 
spoilage. 
With a recent and very notable exception, the international cooperation that has 
marked the development of nuclear power technology provides an excellent model 
by which to address common environmental and ethical problems posed by the 
development of other technologies. 
Ian Wilson 
Vice-President, Canadian Nuclear Association 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
44. Most schemes for non-proliferation mandate an institutional separation between military 
and civilian uses of nuclear energy. But for countries with full access to the complete nuclear 
fuel cycle, no technical separation really exists. Not all states operate the necessary clear-cut 
administrative separation of civilian and military access. Cooperation is needed also among 
suppliers and buyers of civilian nuclear facilities and materials and the International Atomic 
Energy Agency, in order to provide credible safeguards against the diversion of civilian reactor 
programmes to military purposes, especially in countries that do not open all their nuclear 
programmes to IAEA inspection. Thus, there still remains a danger of the proliferation of 
nuclear weapons.
2.1 Costs 
45. The costs of construction and the relative economics of electricity generating stations - 
whether powered by nuclear energy, coal, oil or gas - are conditioned by the following factors 
throughout the service life of a plant: 
the cost of borrowing money to finance plant construction, 
the impact of inflation; 
the duration of the period of planning, licensing, and construction; 
the cost of fuel and maintenance ; 
the costs of protective measures, to ensure safe operation; and 
waste disposal costs (land, air, and water pollution containment) and the costs of 
dismantling at the end of service life. 
46. All these factors vary widely depending on differing institutional, legal, and financial 
arrangements in different countries. Cost generalizations and comparisons are therefore 
unhelpful or misleading. However, costs associated with several of these factors have increased 
more rapidly for nuclear stations during the last 5-10 years, so that the earlier clear cost 
advantage of nuclear over the service life of the plant has been reduced or lost altogether./47 
Nations should therefore look very closely at cost comparisons to obtain the best value when 
choosing an energy path. 
2.2 Health and Environment Risks 
47. Very strict codes of safety practice are implemented in nuclear plants so that under 
officially approved operating conditions, the danger from radiation to reactor personnel and 
especially to the general public is negligible. However, an accident occurring in a reactor may in 
certain very rare canes be serious enough to cause an external release of radioactive 
substances. Depending upon the level of exposure, people are under a certain level of risk of 
becoming ill from various forms of cancer or from alteration or genetic material, which may 
result in hereditary defects. 
48. Since 1928, the International Commission on Radiological Protection (ICRP) has issued 
recommendations on radiation dosage levels above which exposure is unacceptable. These 
have been developed for occupationally exposed workers and for the general public. The 
'Nuclear Safety Standards (NUSS) codes of IAEA were developed in 1975 to reduce safety 
differences among member states. Neither system is in any way binding on governments, if an 
accident occurs, individual governments have the responsibility of deciding at what level of 
radioactive contamination pasture land, drinking water, milk, meat, eggs, vegetables, and fish, 
are to be banned for consumption by livestock or humans. 
49. Different countries - even different local government authorities within a country - have 
different criteria. Some have none at all, ICRP and NUSS notwithstanding. States with more 
rigorous standards may destroy large amounts of food or may ban food imports from a 
neighbour states with more permissive criteria. This causes great hardship to farmers who may 
not receive any compensation for their losses. It may also cause trade problems and political
tension between states. Both of these difficulties occurred following the Chernobyl disaster, 
when the need to develop at least regionally conformable contamination criteria and 
compensation arrangements was overwhelmingly demonstrated. 
2.3 Nuclear Accidents Risks 
50. Nuclear safety returned to the newspaper headlines following the Three Mile Island 
(Harrisburg, United States) and the Chernobyl (USSR) accidents. Probabilistic estimates of the 
risks of component failure, leading to a radioactive release in Western style light water reactors 
wore made in 1975 by the U.S. Nuclear Regulatory Commission./48 The most serious category 
of release through containment failure was placed at around 1 in 1,000,000 years of reactor 
operation. Post-accident analysis of both Harrisburg and Chernobyl - a completely different 
type of reactor - have shown that in both cases, human operator error was the main cause. 
They occurred after about 2,000 and 4,000 reactor-years respectively./49 The frequencies of 
such occurrences are well nigh impossible to estimate probabilistically. However, available 
analyses indicate that although the risk of a radioactive release accident is small, it is by no 
means negligible for reactor operations at the present time. 
51. The regional health and environment effects of an accident are largely predictable from 
radioactive fall-out studies following early atomic weapons testing in the atmosphere and have 
been confirmed in practice following the Chernobyl accident. What could not be confidently 
predicted before Chernobyl were the local effects of such an accident. A much clearer picture is 
now emerging as a result of the experiences there when a reactor exploded, following a series of 
infringements of the official safety regulations, on 26 April 1986, causing the worst reactor 
accident ever experienced. As a result, the whole district had to be managed on something like 
a 'war footing' and efforts resembling a large military operation were needed to contain the 
damage. 
2.4 Radioactive Waste Disposal 
52. Civil nuclear energy programmes worldwide have already generated many thousands of 
tons of spent fuel and high-level waste. Many governments have embarked on large-scale 
programmes to develop ways of isolating these from the biosphere for the many hundreds of 
thousands of years that they will remain hazardously radioactive. 
53. But the problem of nuclear waste disposal remains unsolved. Nuclear waste technology has 
reached an advanced level of sophistication./50 This technology has not however been fully 
tested or utilized and problems remain about disposal. There is particular concern about future 
recourse to ocean dumping and the disposal of contaminated waste in the territories of small 
or poor states that lack the capacity to impose strict safeguards. There should be a clear 
presumption that all countries that generate nuclear waste dispose of it within their own 
territories or under strictly monitored agreements between states. 
3. The Current International Situation 
54. During the last 25 years, a growing awareness of the difficulties outlined above has resulted 
in a wide range of reactions from technical experts, the public, and governments. Many experts 
still feel that so much can be learned from the problems experienced up to now. They argue 
that if the public climate allows then to solve the nuclear waste disposal and decommissioning 
issues and the cost of borrowing money remains reasonably below its 1980-82 peak, in the
absence of viable new supply alternatives there is no reason why nuclear energy should not 
emerge as a strong runner in the 1990s. At the other extreme, many experts take the view that 
there are so many unsolved problems and too many risks for society to continue with a nuclear 
future. Public reactions also vary. Some countries have exhibited little public reaction, in others 
there appears to be a high level of anxiety that expresses itself in anti-nuclear results in public 
opinion polls or large anti-nuclear campaigns. 
Today the assessment of practical consequences can be based on practical 
experience. The consequences of Chernobyl has made Soviet specialists once 
again pose a question: Is not the development of nuclear energy on an industrial 
scale premature? Will it not be fatal to our civilization, to the ecosystem of our 
planet? On our planet so rich in all sorts of energy sources, this question can be 
discussed quite calmly. We have a real choice in this, both on a state and a 
governmental level, and also on the level of individuals and professionals. 
We must put all our efforts to improve the technology itself, to develop and 
elaborate strict standards and norms of quality, of safety of a technology. We 
must work for the creation of anti-accident centres and centres devoting 
themselves to compensating for the losses to the environment. The upgrading of 
the industrial level of safety and the solution of the problem of the relations 
between man and machine would be a lot more natural thing to do than 
concentrating the efforts on only one element of the energy structure in the world. 
This would benefit the whole of humanity. 
V. A. Legasov 
Member, Academy of Sciences of the USSR 
WCED Public Hearing 
Moscow, 8 Dec 1986 
55. And so, whilst some states still remain nuclear-free, today nuclear reactors supply about 15 
per cent of all the electricity generated. Total electricity production worldwide is in turn 
equivalent to around 15 per cent of global primary energy supply. Roughly one-quarter of all 
countries worldwide have reactors. In 1986, there were 366 working and a further 140 
planned,/51 with 10 governments possessing about 90 per cent of all installed capacity (more 
than 5 GW (e)). Of these, there are 8 with a total capacity of more than 9 GW (e),/52 which 
provided the following percentages of electric power in 1985: France, 65; Sweden, 42; Federal 
Republic of Germany, 31; Japan, 23; United Kingdom, 19; United States, 16; Canada, 13; and 
USSR, 10. According to IAEA, in 1985 there were 55 research reactors worldwide, 33 of them in 
developing countries./53 
56. Nevertheless, there is little doubt that the difficulties referred to above have in one way or 
another contributed to a scaling back of future nuclear plans - in some countries, to a de facto 
nuclear pause. In Western Europe and North America, which today have almost 75 per cent of 
current world capacity, nuclear provides about one-third of the energy that was forecast for it 
10 years ago. Apart from France, Japan, the USSR, and several other East European countries 
that have decided to continue with their nuclear programmes, ordering, construction, and 
licensing prospects for new reactors in many other countries look poor. In fact, between 1972 
and 1986, earlier global projections of estimated capacity for the year 2000 have been revised 
downwards by a factor of nearly seven. Despite this, the growth of nuclear at around 15 per 
cent a year over the last 20 years is still impressive./54
57. Following Chernobyl, there were significant changes in the nuclear stance of certain 
governments. Several - notably China, the Federal Republic of Germany, France, Japan, 
Poland, United Kingdom, United States, and the USSR - have maintained or reaffirmed their 
pro-nuclear policy. Others with a 'no nuclear' or a 'phase-out' policy (Australia, Austria, 
Denmark, Luxembourg, New Zealand, Norway, Sweden - and Ireland with an unofficial 
anti-nuclear position) have been joined by Greece and the Philippines. Meanwhile, Finland, 
Italy, the Netherlands, Switzerland, and Yugoslavia are re-investigating nuclear safety and/or 
the anti-nuclear arguments, or have introduced legislation tying any further growth of nuclear 
energy and export/import of nuclear reactor technology to a satisfactory solution of the 
problem of disposal of radioactive wastes. Several countries have been concerned enough to 
conduct referenda to test public opinion regarding nuclear power. 
4. Conclusions and Recommendations 
58. These national reactions indicate that as they continue to review and update all the 
available evidence, governments tend to take up three possible positions: 
remain non-nuclear and develop other sources of energy: 
regard their present nuclear power capacity as necessary during a finite period of 
transition, to safer alternative energy sources; or 
adopt and develop nuclear energy with the conviction that the associated problems and 
risks can and must, be solved with a level of safety that is both nationally and 
internationally acceptable. 
The discussion in the Commission also reflected these tendencies, views, and positions. 
59. But whichever policy is adopted, it is important that the vigorous promotion of energy-efficient 
practices in all energy sectors and large-scale programmes of research, development, 
and demonstration for the safe and environmentally benign use of all promising energy 
sources, especially renewables, be given the highest, priority. 
60. Because of potential transboundary effects, it is essential that governments cooperate to 
develop internationally agreed codes of practice covering technical, economic, social (including 
health and environment aspects), and political components of nuclear energy. In particular, 
international agreement must be reached on the following specific items: 
full governmental ratification of the conventions on 'Early Notification of a Nuclear 
Accident' (including the development of an appropriate surveillance and monitoring 
system) and on 'Assistance in the Case of a Nuclear Accident or Radiological Emergency' 
as recently developed by IAEA; 
emergency response training - for accident containment and for decontamination and 
long-term clean-up of affected sites, personnel, and ecosystems; 
the transboundary movement of all radioactive materials - including fuels, spent fuels, 
and other wastes by land, sea, or air; 
a code of practice on liability and compensation; 
standards for operator training and international licensing;
codes of practice for reactor operation, including minimum safety standards; 
the reporting of routine and accidental discharges from nuclear installations; 
effective, internationally harmonized minimum radiological protection standards; 
agreed site selection criteria as well as consultation and notification prior to the siting of 
all major civil nuclear - related installations; 
standards for waste repositories; 
standards for the decontamination and dismantling of time-expired nuclear reactors; 
and 
problems posed by the development of nuclear powered shipping. 
61. For many reasons, especially including the failure of the nuclear weapons states to agree on 
disarmament, the Nonproliferation Treaty has not proved to be a sufficient instrument to 
prevent the proliferation of nuclear weapons, which still remains a serious danger to world 
peace. We therefore recommend in the strongest terms the construction of an effective 
international regime covering all dimensions of the problem. Both nuclear weapons states and 
non nuclear weapons states, should undertake to accept safeguards in accordance with the 
statutes of IAEA. 
62. Additionally, an international regulatory function is required, including inspection of 
reactors internationally. This should be quite separate from the role of IAEA in promoting 
nuclear energy. 
63. The generation of nuclear power is only justifiable if there are solid solutions to the 
presently unsolved problems to which it gives rise. The highest priority must be accorded to 
research and development on environmentally sound and economically viable alternatives, as 
well as on means of increasing the safety of nuclear energy. 
IV. Wood Fuels: The Vanishing Resource 
64. Seventy per cent of the people in developing countries use wood and, depending on 
availability, burn anywhere between an absolute minimum of about 350 kilogrammes to 2,900 
kilogrammes of dry wood annually, with the average being around 700 kilogrammes per 
person./55 Rural woodfuel supplies appear to be steadily collapsing in many developing 
countries, especially in Sub-Saharan Africa./56 At the same time, the rapid growth of 
agriculture, the pace of migration to cities, and the growing numbers of people entering the 
money economy are placing unprecedented pressures on the biomass base/57 and increasing 
the demand for commercial fuels: from wood and charcoal to kerosene, liquid propane, gas, 
and electricity. To cope with this, many developing country governments have no option but to 
immediately organize their agriculture to produce large quantities of wood and other plant 
fuels. 
65. Wood is being collected faster than it can regrow in many developing countries that still rely 
predominantly on biomass wood, charcoal, dung, and crop residues - for cooking, for heating 
their dwellings, and even for lighting. FAO estimates suggest that in 1900, around 1.3 billion 
people lived in wood-deficit areas./58 If this population-driven overharvesting continues at 
present rates, by the year 2000 some 2.4 billion people may be living in areas where wood is 
'acutely scarce or has to be obtained elsewhere'. These figures reveal great human hardship. 
Precise data on supplies are unavailable because much of the wood is not commercially traded
but collected by the users, principally women and children, but there is no doubt that millions 
are hard put to find substitute fuels, and their numbers are growing. 
66. The fuelwood crisis and deforestation - although related are not the same problems. Wood 
fuels destined for urban and industrial consumers do tend to come from forests. But only a 
small proportion of that used by the rural poor comes from forests. Even in these cases, 
villagers rarely chop down trees; most collect dead branches or cut them from trees./59 
67. When fuelwood is in short supply, people normally economize; when it is no longer 
available, rural people are forced to burn such fuels as cow dung, crop stems and husks, and 
weeds. Often this does no harm, since waste products such as cotton stalks are used. But the 
burning of dung and certain crop residues may in some cases rob the soil of needed nutrients. 
Eventually extreme fuel shortages can reduce the number of cooked meals and shorten the 
cooking time, which increases malnourishment. 
68. Many urban people rely on wood, and most of this is purchased. Recently, as the price of 
wood fuels has been rising, poor families have been obliged to spend increasing proportions of 
their income on wood. In Addis Ababa and Maputo, families may spend a third to half of their 
incomes this way./60 Much work has been done over the past 10 years to develop fuel-efficient 
stoves, and some of these new models use 30-50 per cent less fuel. These, as well as aluminium 
cooking pots and pressure cookers that also use much less fuel, should be made more widely 
available in urban areas. 
Fuelwood and charcoal are, and will remain, the major sources of energy for the 
great majority of rural people in developing countries. The removal of trees in both 
semiarid and humid land in African countries is a result to a large extent of 
increasing 
V. Renewable Energy: The Untapped Potential 
73. Renewable energy sources could in theory provide 10-13TW annually - equal to current 
global energy consumption./63 Today they provide about 2TW annually, about 21 per cent of 
the energy consumed worldwide, of which 15 per cent is biomass and 6 per cent hydropower. 
However, most of the biomass is in the form of fuelwood and agricultural and animal wastes. 
As noted above, fuelwood can no longer be thought of as a 'renewable' resource in many areas, 
because consumption rater have overtaken sustainable yields. 
74. Although worldwide reliance on all these sources has been growing by more than 10 per 
cent a year since the late 1970s, it will be some time before they make up a substantial portion 
of the world's energy budget. Renewable energy systems are still in a relatively primitive stage 
of development. But they offer the world potentially huge primary energy sources, sustainable 
in perpetuity and available in one form or another to every nation on Earth. But it, will require 
a substantial and sustained commitment to further research and development if their potential 
is to be realized. 
75. Wood as a renewable energy source is usually thought of as naturally occurring trees and 
shrubs harvested for local domestic use. Wood, however, is becoming an important feedstock, 
specially grown for advanced energy conversion processes in developing as well as industrial 
countries for the product ion of process heat, electricity, and potentially for other fuels, such as 
combustible gases and liquids. 
76. Hydropower, second to wood among the renewables, has been expanding at nearly 4 per
cent annually. Although hundreds of thousands of megawatts of hydropower have been 
harnessed throughout the world, the remaining potential is huge./64 In neighbouring 
developing countries, interstate cooperation in hydropower development could revolutionize 
supply potential especially in Africa. 
In the choice of resources to be utilized we should not stare at renewable 
resources of energy blindly, we should not blow it out of proportion, we should not 
promote it for the sake of the environment per se. Instead we should develop and 
utilize all resources available, renewable sources of energy included, as a 
long-term endeavour requiring a continuous and sustained effort that will not be 
subject to short-term economic fluctuations, in order that we, in Indonesia, will 
achieve a successful and orderly transition to a more diversified and balanced 
structure of energy supply and environmentally sound energy supply system, which 
is the ultimate goal of our policy. 
Speaker from the floor 
WCED Public Hearings 
Jakarta, 26 March 1985 
77. Solar energy use is small globally, but it is beginning to assume an important place in the 
energy consumption patterns of some countries. Solar water and household heating is 
widespread in many parts of Australia, Greece, and the Middle East. A number of East 
European and developing countries have active solar energy programmes, and the United 
States and Japan support solar sales of several hundred million dollars a year. With constantly 
improving solar thermal and solar electric technologies, it is likely that their contribution will 
increase substantially. The cost of photovoltaic equipment has fallen from around $500-600 
per peak watt to $5 and is approaching the $1-2 level where it can compete with conventional 
electricity production./65 But even at $5 per peak watt, it still provides electricity to remote 
places more cheaply than building power lines. 
78. Wind power has been used for centuries - mainly for pumping water. Recently its use has 
been growing rapidly in regions such as California and Scandinavia. In these cases the wind 
turbines are used to generate electricity for the local electricity grid. The costs of 
wind-generated electricity, which benefited initially from substantial tax incentives, have fallen 
dramatically in California in the last five years and may possibly be competitive with other 
power generated there within a decade./66 Many countries have successful but small wind 
programmes, but the untapped potential is still high. 
79. The fuel alcohol programme in Brazil produced about 10 billion litres of ethanol from 
sugar-cane in 1984 and replaced about 60 per cent of the gasoline that would have been 
required./67 The cost has been estimated at $50-60 per barrel of gasoline replaced. When 
subsidies are removed, and a true exchange rate is used, this is competitive at 1981 oil prices. 
With present lower oil prices, the programme has become uneconomical. But it saves the 
nation hard currency, and it provides the additional benefits of rural development, 
employment generation, increased self-reliance, and reduced vulnerability to crises in the 
world oil markets. 
80. The use of geothermal energy, from natural underground heat sources, has been increasing 
at more than 15 per cent per year in both industrial and developing countries. The experience 
gained during the past decades could provide the basis for a major expansion of geothermal-capacity./ 
68 By contrast, technologies for low-grade heat via heat pumps or from solar ponds
and ocean thermal gradients are promising but still mostly at the research and development 
stage. 
81. These energy sources are not without their health and environment risks. Although they 
range from rather trivial to very serious problems, public reactions to them are not necessarily 
in proportion to the damage sustained. For instance, some of the commonest difficulties with 
solar energy are, somewhat surprisingly, the injuries from roof falls during solar thermal 
maintenance and the nuisance of sun-glare off their glass surfaces. Or a modern wind turbine 
can be a significant noise nuisance to people living nearby. Yet, these apparently small 
problems often arouse very strong public reactions. 
82. But these are still minor issues compared with the ecosystem destruction at hydropower 
sites or the uprooting of homesteads in the areas to be flooded, as well as the health risks from 
toxic gases generated by rotting submerged vegetation and soils, or from waterborne diseases 
such as schistosomiasis (snail fever). Hydrodams also act as an important barrier to fish 
migration and frequently to the movement of land animals. Perhaps the worst problem they 
pose is the danger of catastrophic rupture of the dam-wall and the sweeping away or flooding 
of human settlements downstream - about once a year somewhere in the world. This risk is 
small but not insignificant. 
83. One of the most widespread chronic problems is the eye and lung irritation caused by 
woodsmoke in developing countries. When agricultural wastes are burned, pesticide residues 
inhaled from the dusts or smoke of the crop material can be a health problem. Modern biofuel 
liquids have their own special hazards. Apart from competing with food crops for good 
agricultural land, their production generates large quantities of organic waste effluent, which if 
not used as a fertilizer can cause serious water pollution. Such fuels, particularly methanol, 
may produce irritant or toxic combustion products. All these and many other problems, both 
large and small, will increase as renewable energy systems are developed. 
84. Most renewable energy systems operate best at small to medium scales, ideally suited for 
rural and suburban applications. They are also generally labour-intensive, which should be an 
added benefit where there if surplus labour. They are less susceptible than fossil fuels to wild 
price fluctuations and foreign exchange costs. Most countries have some renewable resources, 
and their use can help nations move towards self-reliance. 
85. The need for a steady transition to a broader and more sustainable mix of energy sources is 
beginning to become accepted. Renewable energy sources could contribute substantially to 
this, particularly with new and improved technologies, but their development will depend in 
the short run on the reduction or removal of certain economic and institutional constraints to 
their use. These are formidable in many countries. The high level of hidden subsidies for 
conventional fuels built into the legislative and energy programmes of most countries distorts 
choices against renewables in research and development, depletion allowances, tax write-offs, 
and direct support of consumer prices. Countries should undertake a full examination of all 
subsidies and other forms of support to various sources of energy and remove those that are 
not clearly justified. 
86. Although the situation is changing rapidly in some jurisdictions, electrical utilities in most 
have a supply monopoly on generation that allows them to arrange pricing policies that 
discriminate against other, usually small, suppliers./69 In some countries a relaxation of this 
control, requiring utilities to accept power generated by industry, small systems, and 
individuals, has created opportunities for the development of renewables. Beyond that, 
requiring utilities to adopt an end-use approach in planning, financing, developing, and 
marketing energy can open the door to a wide range of energy-saving measures as well as
renewables. 
87. Renewable energy sources require a much higher priority in national energy programmes. 
Research, development, and demonstration projects should command funding necessary to 
ensure their rapid development and demonstration. With a potential of 10TW or so, even if 
3-4TW were realized, it would make a crucial difference to future primary supply, especially in 
developing countries, where the background conditions exist for the success of renewables. 
The technological challenges of renewables are minor compared with the challenge of creating 
the social and institutional frameworks that will ease these sources into energy supply systems. 
88. The Commission believes that every effort should be made to develop the potential for 
renewable energy, which should form the foundation of the global energy structure during the 
21st Century. A much more concerted effort must be mounted if this potential is to be realized. 
But a major programme of renewable energy development will involve large costs and high 
risks, particularly massive-scale solar and biomass industries. Developing countries lack the 
resources to finance all but a small fraction of this cost although they will be important users 
and possibly even exporters. Large-scale financial and technical assistance will therefore be 
required. 
VI. Energy Efficiency: Maintaining the Momentum 
89. Given the above analysis, the Commission believes that energy efficiency should be the 
cutting edge of national energy policies for sustainable development. Impressive gains in 
energy efficiency have been made since the first oil price shock in the 1970s. During the past 13 
years, many industrial countries saw the energy content of growth fall significantly as a result 
of increases in energy efficiency averaging 1.7 per cent annually between 1973 and 1983./70 And 
this energy efficiency solution costs less, by savings made on the extra primary supplies 
required to run traditional equipment. 
90. The cost-effectiveness of 'efficiency' as the most environmentally benign 'source' of energy 
is well established. The energy consumption per unit of output from the most efficient 
processes and technologies is one-third to less than one-half that of typically available 
equipment./71 
91. This is true of appliances for cooking, lighting and refrigeration, and space cooling and 
heating - needs that are growing rapidly in most countries and putting severe pressures on the 
available supply systems. It is also true of agricultural cultivation and irrigation systems, of the 
automobile, and of many industrial processes and equipment. 
92. Given the large disproportion in per capita energy consumption between developed and 
developing countries in general, it is clear that the scope and need for energy saving is 
potentially much higher in industrial than in developing countries. Nonetheless, energy 
efficiency is important everywhere. The cement factory, automobile, or irrigation pump in a 
poor country is fundamentally no different from its equivalent in the rich world. In both, there 
is roughly the same scope for reducing the energy consumption or peak power demand of 
these devices without loss of output or welfare. But poor countries will gain much more from 
such reductions. 
93. The woman who cooks in an earthen pot over an open fire uses perhaps eight times more 
energy than an affluent neighbour with a gas stove and aluminium pans. The poor who light 
their homes with a wick dipped in a jar of kerosene get one-fiftieth of the illumination of a 
100-watt electric bulb, but use just as much energy. These examples illustrate the tragic 
paradox of poverty. For the poor, the shortage of money is a greater limitation than the
shortage of energy. They are forced to use 'free' fuels and inefficient equipment because they 
do not have the cash or savings to purchase energy-efficient fuels and end-use devices. 
Consequently, collectively they pay much more for a unit of delivered energy services. 
94. In most cases, investments in improved end-use technologies save money over time 
through lowered energy-supply needs The costs of improving the end-use equipment is 
frequently much less than the cost of building more primary supply capacity. In Brazil, for 
example, it has been shown that for a discounted total investment of $4 billion in more efficient 
end-use technologies (such as more efficient refrigerators, street-lighting, or motors) it would 
be feasible to defer construction of 21 gigawatts of new electrical supply capacity, 
corresponding to a discounted capital savings for new supplies of $19 billion in the period 1986 
to 2000./72 
We must change our attitude towards consumption goods in developed countries 
and we must create technological advances that will allow us to carry on economic 
development using less energy. We must ask ourselves can we solve the problems 
of underdevelopment without using or increasing the tremendous amount of energy 
used by these countries. 
The idea that developing countries use very little energy is an incorrect idea. We 
find that the poorest countries of all have a different problem; their problem is 
inefficient use of energy. Medium countries such as Brazil use more efficient and 
modern sources of fuel. The great hope for these countries is that the future will be 
built not based on technologies of the past, but using advanced technology. This 
will allow them to leap forward in relation to countries that are already developed. 
Jose Goldemberg 
President, Companhia Energetica de Sao Paulo 
WCED Public Hearing 
Brasilia, 30 Oct 1985 
95. There are many examples of successful energy efficiency programmes in industrial 
countries. The many methods used successfully to increase awareness include information 
campaigns in the media, technical press, and schools; demonstrations of successful practices 
and technologies; free energy audits; energy 'labelling' of appliances; and training in energy-saving 
techniques. These should be quickly and widely extended. Industrialized countries 
account for such a large proportion of global energy consumption that even small gains in 
efficiency can have a substantial impact on conserving reserves and reducing the pollution load 
on the biosphere. It is particularly important that consumers, especially large commercial and 
industrial agencies, obtain professional audits of their energy use. This kind of energy 'book-keeping' 
will readily identify those places in their consumption patterns where significant 
savings can be made. 
96. Energy pricing policies play a critical role in stimulating efficiency. At present, they 
sometimes include subsidies and seldom reflect the real costs of producing or importing the 
energy, particularly when exchange rates are undervalued. Very rarely do they reflect the 
external damage costs to health, property, and the environment. Countries should evaluate all 
hidden and overt subsidies to see how far real energy costs can be passed on to the consumer. 
The true economic pricing of energy - with safeguards for the very poor - needs to be extended 
in all countries. Large numbers of countries both industrial and developing are already 
adopting such policies.
97. Developing countries face particular constraints in saving energy. Foreign exchange 
difficulties can make it hard to purchase efficient but costly energy conversion and end-use 
devices. Energy can often be saved cost-effectively by fine-tuning already functioning 
systems./73 But governments and aid agencies may find it less attractive to fund such measures 
than to invest in new large-scale energy supply hardware that is perceived as a more tangible 
symbol of progress. 
98. The manufacture, import, or sale of equipment conforming to mandatory minimal energy 
consumption or efficiency standards is one of the most powerful and effective tools in 
promoting energy efficiency and producing predictable savings. International cooperation may 
be required when such equipment is traded from nation to nation. Countries and appropriate 
regional organizations should introduce and extend increasingly strict efficiency standards for 
equipment and mandatory labelling of appliances. 
99. Many energy efficiency measures cost nothing to implement. But where investments are 
needed, they are frequently a barrier to poor households and small-scale consumers, even 
when pay-back times are short. In these latter cases, special small loan or hire-purchase 
arrangements are helpful. Where investment costs are not insurmountable, there are many 
possible mechanisms for reducing or spreading the initial investment, such as loans with 
favourable repayment periods and 'invisible' measures such as loans repaid by topping up the 
new, reduced energy bills to the pre-conservation levels. 
100. Transport has a particularly important place in national energy and development 
planning. It is a major consumer of oil, accounting for 50-60 per cent of total petroleum use in 
most developing countries./74 It is often a major source of local air pollution and regional 
acidification of the environment in industrial and developing countries. Vehicle markets will 
grow much more rapidly in developing countries, adding greatly to urban air pollution, which 
in many cities already exceeds international norms. Unless strong action is taken, air pollution 
could become a major factor limiting industrial development in many Third World cities. 
101. In the absence of higher fuel prices, mandatory standards providing for a steady increase 
in fuel economy may be necessary. Either way, the potential for substantial future gains in fuel 
economy is enormous. If momentum can be maintained, the current average fuel consumption 
of approximately 10 litres per 100 kilometres in the fleet of vehicles in use in industrial 
countries could be cut in half by the turn of the century./75 
102. A key issue is how developing countries can rapidly improve the fuel economy of their 
vehicles when these are, on average, used for twice as long those as in industrial countries, 
cutting rates of renewal and improvement in half. Licensing and import agreements should be 
reviewed to ensure access to the best available fuel efficient designs and production processes. 
Another important fuel-saving strategy especially in the growing cities of developing countries 
is the organizing of carefully planned public transport systems. 
103. Industry accounts for 40 60 pet cent of all energy consumed in industrial countries and 
10-40 per cent in developing countries. (See Chapter 6.) There has been significant 
improvement in the energy efficiency of production equipment, processes, and products. In 
developing countries, energy savings of as much as 20-30 per cent could be achieved by such 
skilful management of industrial development. 
104. Agriculture worldwide is only a modest energy consumer, accounting for about 3.5 per 
cent of commercial energy use in the industrial countries and 4.5 per cent in developing 
countries as a whole./76 A strategy to double food production in the Third World through
increases in fertilizers, irrigation, and mechanization would add 140 million tons of oil 
equivalent to their agricultural energy use. This is only some 5 per cent of present world energy 
consumption and almost certainly a small part of the energy that could be saved in other 
sectors in the developing world through appropriate efficiency measures./77 
105. Buildings offer enormous scope for energy savings, and perhaps the most widely 
understood ways of increasing energy efficiency are in the home and workplace. Buildings in 
the tropics are now commonly designed to avoid as much direct solar heating as possible by 
having very narrow east- and west-facing walls, but with long sides facing north and south and 
protected from the overhead sun by recessed windows or wide sills. 
106. An important method of heating buildings is by hot water produced during electricity 
production and piped around whole districts, providing both heat and hot water. This 
extremely efficient use of fossil fuels demands a coordination of energy supply with local 
physical planning, which few countries are institutionally equipped to handle./78 Where it has 
been successful, there has usually been local authority involvement in or control of regional 
energy-services boards, such as in Scandinavia and the USSR. Given the development of these 
or similar institutional arrangements, the cogeneration of heat and electricity could 
revolutionize the energy efficiency of buildings worldwide. 
VII. Energy Conservation Measures 
107. There is general agreement that the efficiency gains achieved by some industrialized 
countries over the past 13 years were driven largely by higher energy prices, triggered by higher 
oil prices. Prior to the recent fall in oil prices, energy efficiency was growing at a rate of 2.0 per 
cent annually in some countries, having increased gradually year by year./79 
108. It is doubtful whether such steady improvements can be maintained and extended if 
energy prices are held below the level needed to encourage the design and adoption of more 
energy-efficient homes, industrial processes, and transportation vehicles. The level required 
will vary greatly within and between countries, depending on a wide range of factors. But 
whatever it is, it should be maintained. In volatile energy markets, the question is how. 
109. Nations intervene in the 'market price' of energy in a variety of ways. Domestic taxes (or 
subsidies) on electrical power rates, oil, gas and other fuels are most common. They vary 
greatly between and even within countries where different states, provinces, and sometimes 
even municipalities have the right to add their own tax. Although taxes on energy have seldom 
been levied to encourage the design and adoption of efficiency measures, they can have that 
result if they cause energy prices to rise beyond a certain level - a level that varies greatly 
among jurisdictions. 
110. Some nations also maintain higher than market prices on energy through duties on 
imported electricity, fuel, and fuel products. Others have negotiated bilateral pricing 
arrangements with oil and gas producers in which they stabilize prices for a period of time. 
111. In most countries, the price of oil eventually determines the price of alternative fuels. 
Extreme fluctuations in oil prices, such as the world has experienced recently, endanger 
programmes to encourage conservation. Many positive energy developments worldwide that 
made sense with oil above $25 per barrel, are harder to justify at lower prices. Investments in 
renewables, energy-efficient industrial processes, transport vehicles, and energy-services may 
be reduced. Most are needed to ease the transition to a safer and more sustainable energy 
future beyond this century. This goal requires a long, uninterrupted effort to succeed.
112. Given the importance of oil prices on international energy policy, the Commission 
recommends that new mechanisms for encouraging dialogue between consumers and 
producers be explored. 
113. If the recent momentum behind annual gains in energy efficiency is to be maintained and 
extended, governments need to make it an explicit goal of their policies for energy pricing to 
consumers. Prices needed to encourage the adoption of energy-saving measures may be 
achieved by any of the above means or by other means. Although the Commission expresses no 
preference, conservation pricing requires that governments take a long-term view in weighing 
the costs and benefits of the various measures. They need to operate over extended periods, 
dampening wild fluctuations in the price of primary energy, which can impair progress towards 
energy conservation. 
VIII. Conclusion 
114. It is clear that a low energy path is the best way towards a sustainable future. But given 
efficient and productive uses of primary energy, this need not mean a shortage of essential 
energy services. Within the next 50 years, nations have the opportunity to produce the same 
levels of energy services with as little as half the primary supply currently consumed. This 
requires profound structural changes in socio-economic and institutional arrangements and is 
an important challenge to global society. 
115. More importantly, it will buy the time needed to mount major programmes on sustainable 
forms of renewable energy, and so begin the transition to a safer, more sustainable energy era. 
The development of renewable sources will depend in part on a rational approach to energy 
pricing to secure a stable matrix for such progress. Both the routine practice of efficient energy 
use and the development of renewables will help take pressure off traditional fuels, which are 
most needed to enable developing countries to realize their growth potential worldwide. 
116. Energy is not so much a single product as a mix of products and services, a mix upon which 
the welfare of individuals, the sustainable development of nations, and the life-supporting 
capabilities of the global ecosystem depend. In the past, this mix has been allowed to flow 
together haphazardly, the proportions dictated by short-term pressures on and short-term 
goals of governments, institutions, and companies. Energy is too important for its development 
to continue in such a random manner. A safe, environmentally sound, and economically viable 
energy pathway that will sustain human progress into the distant future is clearly imperative. 
It is also possible. But it will require new dimensions of political will and institutional 
cooperation to achieve it. 
Footnotes 
1/ World Bank, World Development Report 1986 (New York: Oxford University Press, 
1986). 
2/ British Petroleum Company, BP Statistical Review of World Energy (London: 1986). 
3/ Medium variant in Department of International Economic and Social Affairs, World 
Population Prospects as Assessed in 1980, Population Studies No. 78 (Annex), and Long 
Range Population Projections of the World and Major Regions 2025-2150, Five 
Variants as Assessed in 1980 (New York: UN, 1981).
4/ For a useful comparison of various scenarios, see J. Goldemberg et al., 'An End-Use 
Oriented Global Energy strategy', Annual Review of Energy, Vol. 10, 1985; and W. Keepin 
et al., 'Emissions of CO2 into the Atmosphere', in B. Bolin et al. (eds.), The Greenhouse 
Effect, Climate Change and Ecosystems (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1986). 
5/ U. Colombo and O. Bernadini, 'A Low Energy Growth Scenario and the Perspectives for 
Western Europe', Report for the Commission of the European Communities Panel on 
Low Energy Growth, 1979. 
6/ Goldemberg et al., 'Global Energy Strategy', op. cit. 
7/ A.B. Lovins et al., 'Energy Strategy for Low Climatic Risk', Report for the German Federal 
Environment Agency, 1981. 
8/ J.A. Edmonds et al., 'An Analysis of Possible Future Atmospheric Retention of Fossil Fuel 
CO2', Report for U.S. Department of Energy, DOE/OR/21400 1, Washington, DC, 1984. 
9/ J-R Frisch (ed.), Energy 2000-2020: World Prospects and Regional Stresses, 
World Energy Conference (London: Graham and Trotman, 1983). 
10/ Energy Systems Group of the International Institute for Applied Systems Analysis, 
Energy in a Finite World - A Global Systems Analysis (Cambridge, Mass.: Ballinger, 
1981). 
11/ World Bank, The Energy Transition in Developing Countries (Washington, DC: 
1983). 
12/ World Meteorological Organization, A Report of the International Conference on 
the Assessment of the Role of Carbon Dioxide and of Other Greenhouse Gases in 
Climate Variations and Associated Impacts, Villach, Austria, 9-15 October 1985, WMO 
No. 661 (Geneva: WMO/ICSU/UNEP, 1986). 
13/ B.N. Lohani, 'Evaluation of Air Pollution control Programmes and Strategies in Seven Asian 
Capital Cities', prepared for WCED, 1986; H. Weidner, 'Air Pollution Control Strategies and 
Policies in the Federal Republic of Germany', prepared for WCED, 1986; M. Hashimoto, 
'National Air quality Management Policy of Japan', prepared for WCED, 1985; CETESB, 'Air 
Pollution Control Programme and Strategies in Brazil - Sao Paulo and Cubatao Areas, 1985', 
prepared for WCED, 1985. 
14/ National Research Council, Acid Deposition: Long Term Trends (Washington, DC: 
National Academy Press, 1985); L.P. Muniz and H. Leiverstad, 'Acidification Effects on 
Freshwater Fish', in D. Drablos and A. Tollan (eds.), Ecological Impact of Acid 
Precipitation (Oslo: SNSF, 1980); L. Hallbacken and C.O. Tamm, 'Changes in Soil Acidity 
from 1927/ to 1982- 4 in a Forest Area of South West Sweden', Scandinavian Journal of 
Forest Research, No. 1, pp. 219-32, 1986. 
15/ FAO, Fuelwood Supplies in the Developing Countries, Forestry Paper No. 42 
(Rome: 1983); Z. Mikdashi, 'Towards a New Petroleum Order', Natural Resources Forum, 
October 1986. 
16/ Edmonds et al., op. cit. 
17/ I.M. Torrens, 'Acid Rain and Air Pollution, A Problem of Industrialization', prepared for 
WCED, 1985.
18/ Goldemberg et al., 'Global Energy Strategy', op. cit. 
19/ British Petroleum Company, op. cit. 
20/ WMO, Report of International Conference, op. cit.; I. Mintzer, 'Societal Responses to 
Global Warming', submitted to WCED Public Hearings, Oslo, 1985; F.K. Hare, 'The Relevance 
of Climate', submitted to WCED Public Hearings, Ottawa, 1986. 
21/ Lohani, op. cit.; Weidner, op. cit.; Hashimoto, op. cit.; CETESB, op. cit. 
22/ Torrens, op. cit.; F. Lixun and D. Zhao, 'Acid Rain in China', prepared for WCED, 1985; H. 
Rodhe, 'Acidification in Tropical Countries', prepared for WCED, 1985; G.T. Goodman, 
'Acidification of the Environment, A Policy Ideas Paper', prepared for WCED, 1986. 
23/ Torrens, op. cit. 
24/ Bolin et al., op. cit. 
25/ WMO, Report of International Conference, op. cit. 
26/ Ibid. 
27/ Ibid. 
28/ Goldemberg et al., 'Global Energy Strategy', op. cit. 
29/ Mintzer, op. cit. 
30/ WMO, Report of International Conference, op. cit. 
31/ D.J. Rose et al., Global Energy Futures and CO2 - Induced Climate Change, 
MITEL Report 83-015 (Cambridge, Mass.: Massachusetts Institute of Technology, 1983); A.M. 
Perry et al., 'Energy Supply and Demand Implication of CO2', Energy, Vol. 7, pp. 991-1004, 
1982. 
32/ Bolin et al., op. cit. 
33/ G. Brasseur, The Endangered Ozone Layer: New Theories on Ozone Depletion', 
Environment, Vol. 29, No. 1, 1987. 
34/ National Research Council, op. cit.; Muniz and Leiverstad, op. cit. 
35/ OECD, The State of the Environment (Paris: 1985). 
36/ Muniz and Leiverstad, op. cit. 
37/ National Research Council, op. cit. 
38/ National Swedish Environmental Protection Board, Air Pollution and Acidification 
(Solna, Sweden, 1986). 
39/ J. Lehmhaus et al., 'Calculated and Observed Data for 1980 Compared at EMEP 
Measurement Stations', Norwegian Meteorological Institute, EMEP/MSO W Report 1 86, 1986; 
C.B. Epstein and M. Oppenheimer, 'Empirical Relation Between Sulphur Dioxide Emissions 
and Acid Deposition Derived from Monthly Data', Nature, No. 323, pp. 245-47, 1985.
40/ 'Neuartige Waldschaden in der Bundesrepublik Deutschland', Das Bundesministerium fur 
Ernahrung, Landwirtschaft und Forsten, 1983; 'Waldschaden Sernebungen', Das 
Bundesministerium fur Ernahrung, Landwirtschaft und Forsten, 1985; S. Nilsson, 'Activities of 
Teams of Specialists: Implications of Air Pollution Damage to Forests for Roundwood Supply 
and Forest Products Markets: Study on Extent of Damage', TIM/R 124 Add.1 (Restricted), 
1986. 
41/ S. Postel, 'Stabilizing Chemical Cycles' (after Allgemeine Forst Zeitschrift, Nos. 46 
(1985) and 41 (1986)); in L.R. Brown et al., State of the World 1987 (London: W.W. Norton, 
1987). 
42/ T. Paces, 'Weathering Rates of Eneiss and Depletion of Exchangeable Cations in Soils 
Under Environmental Acidification', Journal Ecological Society, No. 143, pp. 673-77, 1986; 
T. Paces, 'Sources of Acidification in Contra] Europe Estimated from Elemental Budgets in 
Small Basins', Nature, No. 315, pp. 31-36, 1985. 
43/ Hallbacken and Tamm, op. cit. 
44/ G. Tyler et al., 'Metaller i Skogsmark - Deposition och omsattning', SNV PM 1692, Solna, 
Sweden, 1983. 
45/ 'Neuartige Waldschaden', 1983, op. cit; Paces, 'Weathering Rates', op. cit. 
46/ Rodhe, op. cit, 
47/ R. Eden et al., Energy Economics (New York: Cambridge University Press, 1981); 
Nuclear Energy Agency, Projected Costs of Generating Electricity from Nuclear and 
Coal-Fired Power Stations for Commissioning in 1995 (Paris: OECD, 1986). 
48/ Nuclear Regulatory Commission, Physical Processes in Reactor Meltdown 
Accidents, Appendix VIII to Reactor Safety Study (WASH-1400) (Washington, DC: U.S. 
Government Printing Office, 1975). 
49/ S. Islam and K. Lindgren, 'How many reactor accidents will there be?', Nature, No. 122, 
pp. 691-92, 1986; A.W.K. Edwards, 'How many reactor accidents?' Nature, No. 324, pp 417-18, 
1986. 
50/ F.L. Parker et al., The Disposal of High Level Radioactive Waste - 1984, Vols. 1 & 2 
(Stockholm: The Beijer Institute, 1984); F.L. Parker and R.E. Kasperson, International 
Radwaste Policies (Stockholm: The Beijer Institute, in press). 
51/ International Atomic Energy Agency, Nuclear Power: Status and Trends, 1986 
Edition (Vienna: 1986). 
52/ 'World List of Nuclear Power Plants', Nuclear News, August 1986. 
53/ IAEA Bulletin, Summer 1986. 
54/ C, Flavin, 'Reassessing Nuclear Power', in Brown et al., op. cit.; British Petroleum 
Company, op. cit. 
55/ G. Foley, 'Wood Fuel and Conventional Fuel Demands in the Developing World', Ambio, 
Vol. 14 No. 5, 1985. 
56/ FAO, Fuelwood Supplies, op. cit.; FAO/UNEP, Tropical Forest Resources, Forestry
Paper No. 30 (Rome: 1982). 
57/ The Beijer Institute, Energy, Environment and Development in Africa, Vols, 1-10 
(Uppsala, Sweden: Scandinavian Institute of African Studies, 1984 87); 'Energy Needs in 
Developing Countries', Ambio, Vol. 14, 1985; E.N. Chidumayo, 'Fuelwood and Social Forestry', 
prepared for WCED, 1985; G.T. Goodman, 'Forest-Energy in Developing Countries: Problems 
and Challenges', International Union of Forest Research Organizations, Proceedings, 
Ljubljana, Yugoslavia, 1986. 
58/ FAO, Fuelwood Supplies, op. cit. 
59/ Beijer Institute, op. cit.; J. Bandyopadhyay, 'Rehabilitation of Upland Watersheds', 
prepared for WCED, 1986. 
60/ Beijer Institute, op. cit. 
61/ R. Overend, 'Bioenergy Conversion Process: A Brief State of the Art and Discussion of 
Environmental Implications', International Union of Forestry Research Organization, 
Proceedings, Ljubljana, Yugoslavia, 1986. 
62/ W. Fernandes and S. Kulkarni (eds.), Towards a New Forest Policy: People's Rights 
and Environmental Needs (New Delhi, India: Indian Social Institute, 1983); P.N. Bradley et 
al., 'Development Research and Energy Planning in Kenya', Ambio, Vol. 14, No. 4; R. Hosier, 
'Household Energy Consumption in Rural Kenya', Ambio, Vol 14, No. 4, 1985; 1985; R. 
Engelhard et al., 'The Paradox of Abundant On-Farm Woody Biomass, Yet Critical Fuelwood 
Shortage: A Case Study of Kakamega District (Kenya)', International Union of Forest Research 
Organization, Proceedings, Ljubljana, Yugoslavia, 1986. 
63/ D. Deudney and C. Flavin, Renewable Energy: The Power to Choose (London: W.W. 
Norton, 1983). 
64/ World Resources Institute/International Institute Environment and Development, World 
Resources 1987 (New York, Basic Books, in press). 
65/ Ibid. 
66/ Ibid. 
67/ Goldemberg et al., 'Global Energy Strategy', op. cit.; J. Goldemberg et al., 'Ethanol Fuel: A 
Use of Biomass Energy in Brazil', Ambio, Vol. 14, pp. 293-98, 1985; J. Goldemberg et al., 'Basic 
Needs and Much More, With One Kilowatt Per Capita', Ambio, Vol. 14, pp. 190-201, 1985. 
68/ WRI/IIED, op. cit. 
69/ N.J.D. Lucas, 'The Influence of Existing Institutions on the European Transition from Oil', 
The European, pp. 173-89, 1981. 
70/ OECD, op. cit. 
71/ E. Hirst et al., 'Recent Changes in U.S. Energy Consumption, What Happened and Why?' in 
D.J. Rose (ed.), Learning About Energy (New York: Plenum Press, 1986). 
72/ H.S. Geller, 'The Potential for Electricity Conservation in Brazil', Companhia Energetica de 
Sao Paulo, Sao Paulo, Brazil, 1985.
73/ World Bank, Energy Transition in Developing Countries, op. cit. 
74/ G. Leach et al., Energy and Growth; A Comparison of Thirteen Industrialized 
and Developing Countries (London: Butterworth, 1986). 
75/ MIT International Automobile Program, The Future of the Automobile (London: 
George Allen & Unwin, 1984). 
76/ FAO, Agriculture; Towards 2000 (Rome: 1981). 
77/ Ibid. 
78/ Lucas, op. cit. 
79/ OECD, op. cit.
Our Common Future, Chapter 8: Industry: Producing More With 
Less 
Industrial Growth I. and its Impact 
1. The Changing structure of World Industry 
2. Environmental Decline and Response 
II. Sustainable Industrial Development in a Global Context 
1. Industrialization in the Third World 
2. Use of Energy and Raw Materials 
3. Promises and Risks of New Technologies 
III. Strategies for Sustainable Industrial Development 
Establish Environmental Goals, Regulations, Incentives, and 
Standards 
1. 
2. Make More Effective Use of Economic Instruments 
3. Broaden Environmental Assessments 
4. Encourage Action by Industry 
5. Increase Capacity to Deal with Industrial Hazards 
6. Strengthen International Efforts to Help Developing Countries 
1. Industry is central to the economies of modern societies and an indispensable motor of 
growth. It is essential to developing countries, to widen their development base and meet 
growing needs. And though industrialized countries are said to be moving into a post 
industrial, information-based era, this shift must be powered by a continuing flow of wealth 
from industry./1 
2. Many essential human needs can be met only through goods and services provided by 
industry. The production of food requires increasing amounts of agrochemicals and machinery. 
Beyond this, the products of industry form the material basis of contemporary standards of 
living. Thus all nations require and rightly aspire to efficient industrial bases to meet changing 
needs. 
3. Industry extracts materials from the natural resource base and inserts both products and
pollution into the human environment. It has the power to enhance or degrade the 
environment; it invariably does both. (See Chapter 2 for a discussion of the concept of 
sustainable development within the context of industry and resource use.) 
I. Industrial Growth and its Impact 
4. As recently as 1950, the world manufactured only one-seventh of the goods it does today, 
and produced only one-third of the minerals. Industrial production grew most rapidly between 
1950 and 1973, with a 7 per cent annual growth in manufacturing and a 5 per cent growth in 
mining. Since then growth rates have slowed, to about 3 per cent yearly between 1973 and 1985 
in manufacturing and virtually zero growth in mining./2 
5. That earlier, rapid growth in production was reflected in the rising importance of 
manufacturing in the economies of virtually all countries. By 1982, the relative share of value 
added to gross domestic product by manufacturing (the 'manufacturing value added', or MVA) 
ranged from 19 per cent in developing countries as a whole to 21 per cent in industrialized 
market economies and 51 per cent of net material product in centrally planned economies. (See 
Table 8-1.) If the extractive industries are taken into account, the share is even higher. 
Table 8-1 
Share of Manufacturing Value Added in GDP, 
by Economic Grouping and Income Group 
1960 1970 1980 1962 
Group of Countries per cent 
Developing Countries 14.2 16.6 19.0 19.0 
Low income 11.2 13.8 15.0 15.0 
Lower-middle income 11.0 13.5 16.4 16.6 
Intermediate income 10.6 14.4 17.1 17.6 
Upper-middle income 19.4 21.6 24.1 23.3 
High income 17.2 16.2 17.2 17.9 
Developed Market Economies 25.6 26.3 27.9 27.1 
Centrally Planned Economies* 32.0 42.4 50.5 50.8 
* Figures refer to the share of manufacturing value added (estimated) in net material 
product. Data are constant (1975) prices. 
Source: UNIDO, World Industry: A Statistical Review 1985 (Vienna: 1966). 
1. The Changing structure of World Industry 
6. In recent years, the trend of the 1950s and 1960s has been reversed. Manufacturing has 
declined in importance relative to other sectors of the economy. In many countries, this decline
has been in progress since 1973. It is most noticeable in the case of industrial market 
economies, but the share of MVA in GDP has also declined in nearly half the 95 developing 
countries surveyed by UNIDO./3 This may reflect the growing interaction between industry 
and all fields of science and technology and the increasing integration of industry and services, 
as well as industry's ability to produce more with less. 
7. The relative importance of industry as an employer has been declining for some time in 
developed countries. But the shift in jobs towards the service sector has accelerated sharply 
over the past 15 years with the increasing adoption of new processes and technologies. 
Economists continue to argue over whether the advent of an information-based economy will 
further depress employment in industry or will expand job opportunities overall./4 
8. Most developing countries started at independence with virtually no modern industry. Then 
during the 1960s and 1970s their industrial production, employment, and trade consistently 
grow faster than these sectors in developed market economies. By 1984, developing countries 
accounted for 11.6 per cent of world MVA (still well short of the 'Lima target' of 25 per cent 
adopted by UNIDO in 1975). The centrally planned economies of Eastern Europe had raised 
their share of world MVA from 15.2 per cent in 1963 to 24.9 per cent in 1984./5 
9. The international trade in manufactured goods, which has consistently grown fatter than has 
world manufacturing output, is one of the factors underlying the changing geography of 
industrialization. Many developing nations, particularly newly industrialized countries (NICs), 
have shared in this growth and made spectacular progress in industrialization. Taking the 
Third World as a whole, exports of manufactured goods have grown steadily relative to primary 
exports, rising from 13.3 per cent of their total non-oil exports in 1960 to 54.7 per cent in 1982. 
(See Table 8-2.) 
10. In general, developing-country industrial production is diversifying and moving into more 
capital intensive areas such as metal products, chemicals, machinery, and equipment. And 
heavy industries, traditionally the most polluting, have been growing in relation to light 
industries. At the same time, the share of industries involved in food products, and to a lesser 
extent in textiles and clothing, has fallen significantly. 
2. Environmental Decline and Response 
11. Industry and its products have an impact on the natural resource base of civilization 
through the entire cycle of raw materials exploration and extraction, transformation into 
products, energy consumption, waste generation, and the use and disposal of products by 
consumers. These impacts may be positive, enhancing the quality of a resource or extending its 
uses. Or they may be negative, as a result of process and product pollution and of depletion or 
degradation of resources. 
12. The negative environmental impacts of industrial activity were initially perceived as 
localized problems of air, water, and land pollution. Industrial expansion following the Second 
World War took place without much awareness of the environment and brought with it a rapid 
rise in pollution, symbolized by the Lob Angeles smog; the proclaimed 'death' of Lake Erie; the 
progressive pollution of major rivers like the Meuse, Kibe, and Rhine; and chemical poisoning 
by mercury in Minamata. These problems have also been found in many parts of the Third 
World as industrial growth, urbanization, and the use of automobiles spread./6 
13. Public concern grew rapidly and forced a broad debate on environment conservation and 
economic growth. The possibility that the process of industrial growth would run into material
resource constraints became an important theme in this debate. Although non-renewable 
resources are by definition exhaustible, recent assessments suggest that few minerals are likely 
to run out in the near future. 
Table 8-2 
Composition of the Merchandise Trade of Developing Countries 
Exports Imports 
1960 1970 1980 1982 1960 1970 1980 1982 
Item (billions of dollars) 
Primary 
Commodities 
25 45 452 369 11 17 166 166 
Non-oil 17 27 107 93 8 12 79 73 
Petroleum 6 18 345 277 3 5 87 92 
Manufactures 3 9 101 112 17 39 288 296 
Total 27 55 553 481 28 56 454 462 
Total Non-oil 20 36 208 204 25 51 367 370 
(per cent) 
Primary 
Commodities 
Including Oil 
90.4 82.6 81.8 76.8 38.8 30.1 36.6 35.9 
Non-oil 62.3 49.2 19.4 19.2 28.4 21.7 17.5 15.9 
Petroleum 28.1 33.4 62.4 57.5 10.4 8.4 19.1 20.0 
Manufactures 9.6 17.4 18.1 23.2 61.2 69.9 63.4 64.1 
Share in Non-oil Exports Share in Non-oil Imports 
Primary 
Commodities 
(Non-oil) 
86.7 73.9 51.6 45.3 32.7 23.7 71.6 19.8 
Manufactures 13.3 26.1 48.4 54.7 68.3 76.3 78.4 80.2 
Source: UNIDO, Industry in a Changing World (New York 1983); for 1982, WCED 
estimates based on UN, 1983 International Trade Statistics Yearbook, Vol. 1 (New 
York: 1985) 
14. By the late 1960s, growing awareness and public concern led to action by governments and 
industry in both industrial and some developing countries. Environmental protection and 
resource conservation policies and programmes were established, along with agencies to 
administer them. Initially policies focused on regulatory measures aimed at reducing
emissions. Later a range of economic instruments were considered - taxation, pollution 
charges, and subsidies for pollution control equipment - but only a few countries introduced 
them. Expenditures rose, gradually at first, reaching 1.0 per cent and as high as 2.0 per cent of 
GNP in some industrial countries by the late 1970s. 
15. Industry also responded to these problems by developing new technologies and industrial 
processes designed to reduce pollution and other adverse environmental impacts. 
Expenditures on pollution control measures rose rapidly in some highly polluting industries; 
and corporations began to set up their own environmental policy and control units. Guidelines 
and codes of conduct were published covering safety of products and plant operations, trade 
practices, technology transfer, and international cooperation./7 National and international 
industry associations have also developed guidelines and voluntary codes of practice./8 
I am one of the patients of air pollution. When Japanese economy grew very 
rapidly, my asthma deteriorated. I am 39 years old. I was hospitalized when I was 
18 until I was 23 because of my severe asthma. I had no joy of life, no joie de vivre 
in those five years. I got a job and went to work but I cannot work as long a time as 
ordinary people. For the last 10 years I can hardly work. And when the law was 
enacted, the law concerning the abatement of pollution, it has given me 
compensation. That is my only income, from the compensation that this law 
provides. And if I should suffer another disease on top of asthma, I really don't 
know what to do. 
Yoshi Suzuki 
Association of Patients of Pollution and Their Families 
WCED Public Hearing 
Tokyo, 27 Feb 1987 
16. The results were mixed, but during the decade a number of industrial countries 
experienced a significant improvement in environmental quality. There was a considerable roll 
back in air pollution in many cities and water pollution in many lakes and rivers. Certain 
chemicals were controlled. 
17. But these achievements were limited to some industrial countries. Taking the world as a 
whole, fertilizer run-off and sewage discharges into rivers, lakes, and coastal waters have 
increased, with resulting impacts on fishing, drinking water supply, navigation, and scenic 
beauty. The water quality of most major rivers has not markedly improved over the years. It is, 
in fact, worsening in many of them, as it is in many smaller rivers. Industrialized countries still 
suffer from 'traditional' forms of air and land pollution. Levels of sulphur and nitrogen oxides 
(NOV), suspended particulates, and hydrocarbons remain high and in some cases have 
increased. Air pollution in parts of many Third World cities has risen to levels worse than 
anything witnessed in the industrial countries during the 1960s./9 
18. It is becoming increasingly clear that the sources and causes of pollution are far more 
diffuse, complex, and interrelated - and the effects of pollution more widespread, cumulative, 
and chronic - than hitherto believed. Pollution problems that were once local are now regional 
or even global in scale. Contamination of soils, ground-water, and people by agrochemicals is 
widening and chemical pollution has spread to every corner of the planet. The incidence of 
major accidents involving toxic chemicals has grown. Discoveries of hazardous waste disposal 
sites - at Love Canal in the United States, for example, and at Lekkerkek in the Netherlands, 
Vac in Hungary, and Georgswerder in the Federal Republic of Germany - have drawn attention
to another serious problem. 
It is absolutely clear now that the present scale and rate of development of the 
productive forces require a different approach to the questions connected with 
environmental protection and rational utilization of natural resources. This is a task 
of immense economic and social significance. For actually it is a question of 
people's health and a caring approach to the national wealth of each country. 
Moreover, it is also a question of the future. And on the solution depends the 
conditions in which the coming generations will live. 
A. P. Semyonov 
Central Council of Trade Unions 
WCED Public Hearing 
Moscow, 8 Dec 1986 
19. In the light of this and the growth trends projected through the next century, it is evident 
that measures to reduce, control, and prevent industrial pollution will need to be greatly 
strengthened. If they are not, pollution damage to human health could become intolerable in 
certain cities and threats to property and ecosystems will continue to grow. Fortunately, the 
past two decades of environmental action have provided governments and industry with the 
policy experience and the technological means to achieve more sustainable patterns of 
industrial development. 
20. At the beginning of the 1970s, both governments and industry were deeply worried about 
the costs of proposed environmental measures. Some felt that they would depress investment, 
growth, jobs, competitiveness, and trade, while driving up inflation. Such fears proved 
misplaced. A 1984 survey by OECD of assessments undertaken in a number of industrial 
countries concluded that expenditures on environmental measures over the past two decades 
had a positive short term effect on growth and employment as the increased demand they 
generated raised the output of economies operating at less than full capacity. The benefits, 
including health, property, and ecosystem damages avoided, have been significant. More 
important, these benefits have generally exceeded costs./10 
21. Costs and benefits have naturally varied among industries.One method of estimating the 
cost of pollution abatement in industry compares expenditures on new plants and equipment 
that have pollution control facilities to hypothetical expenditures on new plants without such 
features. Studies using this comparison in the United States found that pollution abatement 
expenditures foe new plant and equipment for all manufacturing industries in that country in 
1984 amounted to $4.53 billion, or 3.3 per cent of total new expenditures. The chemical 
industry spent $580 million (3.8 per cent) on such equipment./11 Similar studies in the 
Japanese steel industry found that new investment in pollution control equipment reached as 
high as 21.3 per cent of total investment in 1976 and even today remains around 5 per cent./12 
22. Firms involved in food processing, iron and steel, non-ferrous metals, automobiles, pulp 
and paper, chemicals, and electric power generation - all major polluters have borne a high 
proportion of the total pollution control investment by industry. Such costs provided a strong 
incentive for many of these industries to develop a broad range of new processes and cleaner 
and more efficient products and technologies. In fact, some firms that a decade ago established 
teams to research and develop innovative technologies to meet new environmental standards 
are today among the most competitive in their fields, nationally and internationally.
23. Waste recycling and reuse have become accepted practices in many industrial sectors. In 
some industrialized countries technologies to scrub sulphur and nitrogen compounds from 
smokestack gases made remarkable advances in a relatively short time. New combustion 
techniques simultaneously raise combustion efficiency and reduce pollutant emissions./13 
Innovative products and process technologies are also currently under development that 
promise energy- and resource-efficient modes of production, reducing pollution and 
minimizing risks of health hazards and accidents. 
24. Pollution control has become a thriving branch of industry in its own right in several 
industrialized countries. High-pollution industries such as iron and steel, other metals, 
chemicals, and energy production have often led in expanding into the fields of pollution 
control equipment, detoxification and waste disposal technology, measurement instruments, 
and monitoring systems. Not only have these industries become more efficient and 
competitive, but many have also found new opportunities for investment, sales, and exports. 
Looking to the future, a growing market for pollution control systems, equipment, and services 
is expected in practically all industrialized countries, including NICs. 
II. Sustainable Industrial Development in a Global Context 
25. If industrial development is to be sustainable over the long term, it will have to change 
radically in terms of the quality of that development, particularly in industrialized countries. 
But this is not to suggest that industrialization has reached a quantitative limit, particularly in 
developing countries. Even today, according to UNIDO, world industrial output would have to 
be increased by a factor of 2.6 if consumption of manufactured goods in developing countries 
were to be raised to current industrial country levels./14 Given expected population growth, a 
five- to tenfold increase in world industrial output can be anticipated by the time world 
population stabilizes sometime in the next century. Such growth has serious implications for 
the future of the world's ecosystems and its natural resource base. 
Our ecological movement is not against industry, but we must think of the social 
function of industries and that pollution and progress are not the same thing. 
Pollution is not the synonym of progress and therefore time has come for new 
development concepts to come up. Pollution should not be a synonym of progress 
because we know that pollution is controlled and when you do not control pollution 
you are transferring this pollution to the community of the whole. 
Fabio Feldman 
Lawyer for Victims of Cubatao 
WCED Public Hearing 
Sao Paulo, 28-29 Oct 1985 
26. In general, industries and industrial operations should be encouraged that are more 
efficient in terms of resource use, that generate less pollution and waste, that are based on the 
use of renewable rather than non renewable resources, and that minimize irreversible adverse 
impacts on human health and the environment. 
1. Industrialization in the Third World 
27. Growing populations and high proportions of young people in the Third World are leading 
to large increases in the labour force. Agriculture cannot absorb them. Industry must provide
these expanding societies not only with employment but with products and services. They will 
experience massive increases in the production of basic consumer goods and a concomitant 
build-up of industrial infrastructure - iron and steel, paper, chemicals, building materials, and 
transportation. All this implies considerable increase in energy and raw material use, industrial 
hazards and wastes, accidents, and resource depletion. 
28. The problems and prospects for industrial development vary among the countries of the 
Third World, which differ greatly in size and resources. There are some large countries with 
abundant natural resources and a substantial domestic market that provide a base for 
wide-ranging industrial development. Smaller, resource-rich countries are trying to build up an 
export-oriented processing industry. Several developing countries have based much of their 
industrial development on export industries in garments, consumer electronics, and light 
engineering. In many countries, however, industrial development is restricted to a few 
consumer-goods industries that cater to relatively small domestic markets. 
29. The developing countries' share in world production of iron and steel rose from 3.6 per cent 
in 1955 to 17.3 per cent in 1984, when four countries - Brazil, China, India, and the Republic of 
Korea - produced more than 10 million tons of steel each, as much as in many medium-sized 
industrialized countries./15 At the same time that this industry is contracting in many 
developed countries, it is expected to expand by 38 million tons between 1982 and 1990 in the 
developing world. Latin America is projected to account for 41 per cent of this rise, Southeast 
Asia for 36 per cent, the Middle East for 20 per cent, and Africa for 1.3 per cent./16 
30. Many developing countries still depend heavily on their exports of minerals and other 
commodities, mostly in unprocessed or only intermediately processed forms. In the case of 
several major minerals such as aluminium and nickel, a few transnational corporations control 
the whole industry, from mining through final processing./17 Some countries have been 
moderately successful in increasing the share of refined products in their exports. Yet most of 
these 'manufactured' goods are processed further in the industrial country that imports them. 
Thus in 1980, only 39 per cent of all Third World exports of manufactured goods were ready for 
final use, while 43 per cent of its total exports were unprocessed./18 This ratio should improve 
as developing nations move into the further stages of processing. These improvements should 
be speeded up. 
31. The expected growth in basic industries foreshadows rapid increases in pollution and 
resource degradation unless developing countries take great care to control pollution and 
waste, to increase recycling and reuse, and to minimize hazardous wastes. These countries do 
not have the resources to industrialize now and repair the damage later; nor will they have the 
time, given the rapid pace of technological progress. They can profit from the improvements in 
resource and environmental management being achieved in industrialized countries, and so 
avoid the need for expensive clean-ups. Such technologies can also help them reduce ultimate 
costs and stretch scarce resources. And they can learn from the mistakes of developed 
countries, 
32. Economies of scale are no longer always the primary consideration. New technologies in 
communications, information, and process control allow the establishment of small-scale, 
decentralized, widely dispersed industries, thus reducing levels of pollution and other impacts 
on the local environment. There may, however, be trade-offs to be made: small-scale raw 
material processing, for example, is often labour-intensive and widely dispersed but intensive 
in the use of energy. Such dispersed industries could relieve big cities of some of their 
population and pollution pressures. They could provide non-farming jobs in the countryside, 
produce consumer goods that cater to local markets, and help spread environmentally sound 
technologies.
2. Use of Energy and Raw Materials 
33. Industrial growth is widely seen as inevitably accompanied by corresponding increases in 
energy and raw material consumption. In the past two decades, however, this pattern appears 
to have fundamentally changed. As growth has continued in the developed market economies, 
the demand for many basic materials, including energy and water, has levelled off; in some 
cases, it has actually declined in absolute terms. 
34. Energy consumption per unit of GDP in OECD countries has been dropping at a rate of 1-3 
per cent every year since the late 1960s. Between 1973 and 1983, these nations improved 
energy efficiency by 1.7 per cent annually./19 Industrial water consumption per unit of 
production has also declined. Older pulp and paper mills typically used about 160 cubic metres 
of water per ton of pulp; those built during the 1970s, however, used only 70. With advanced 
techniques that keep water circulating within a closed system, and with proper staff training, 
use rates could be lowered to 20-30 cubic metres per ton of pulp./20 
35. An integrated steel mill uses about 80-200 tons of water for every ton of crude steel. 
However, since only about 3 tons of water per ton of crude steel are lost, mostly by 
evaporation, recycling can greatly reduce consumption./21 Closed water circulation systems are 
not unique to the steel industry or to developed market economies. Between 1975 and 1980, 
the chemical industry's output in the USSR increased by 76 per cent, but the total consumption 
of fresh water remained at the 1975 level./22 And between 1981 and 1986, Soviet industrial 
output increased by 25 per cent but industrial water consumption remained constant./23 
36. Declines in consumption of other raw materials began much earlier. In fact, the amount of 
raw materials needed for a given unit of economic output has been dropping over this entire 
century, except in wartime, for practically all non-agricultural commodities./24 A recent study 
of consumption trends of seven basic materials in the United States bears this out,/25 as do 
studies in Japan. Japan used only 60 per cent as much raw materials for every unit of 
industrial production in 1984 as it used in 1973./26 These efficiency trends do not result from a 
decline in manufacturing in favour of service industries, for over these periods the output of 
the manufacturing sector continued to grow The productivity and efficiency of resource use are 
constantly improving, and industrial production is steadily switching away from heavily 
material intensive products and processes. 
37. The two oil price hikes of the 1970s shocked many countries into saving money by 
promoting conservation measures, switching to other fuels, and raising overall energy 
efficiency. These events demonstrated the importance of energy pricing policies that take into 
account their current stock, depletion rates, availability of substitutes, and any unavoidable 
environmental damage associated with their extraction or processing. (See Chapter 7.) They 
also indicated the potential of similar pricing policies for other raw materials. 
I think there must be a persistent push, a persistent effort towards establishing 
some kind of international code for areas of technologies having high 
environmental risks. At the moment not many in Indonesia would be considered as 
very knowledgeable industries. We need also this kind of thing in order to 
guarantee some kind of minimum safety for countries like ours to develop within 
the context of international economic relations. 
Speaker from the floor
WCED Public Hearing 
Jakarta, 26 March 1985 
38. Some have referred to these processes as the increasing 'de-materialization' of society and 
the world economy. Yet even the most industrially advanced economies still depend on a 
continued supply of basic manufactured goods. Whether made domestically or imported, their 
production will continue to require large amounts of raw materials and energy, even if 
developing countries progress rapidly in the adoption of resource-efficient technologies. To 
sustain production momentum on a global level, therefore, policies that inject resource 
efficiency considerations into economic, trade, and other related policy domains are urgently 
needed, particularly in industrial countries, along with strict observance of environmental 
norms, regulations, and standards. 
3. Promises and Risks of New Technologies 
39. Technology will continue to change the social, cultural, and economic fabric of nations and 
the world community. With careful management, new and emerging technologies offer 
enormous opportunities for raising productivity and living standards, for improving health, 
and for conserving the natural resource base. Many will also bring new hazards, requiring an 
improved capacity for risk assessment and risk management. (See Chapter 12.) 
40. Information technology based chiefly on advances in micro-electronics and computer 
science is of particular importance. Coupled with rapidly advancing means of communication, 
it can help improve the productivity, energy and resource efficiency, and organizational 
structure of industry. 
41. New materials such it fine ceramics, rare metals and metal alloys, high-performance 
plastics, and now composites allow more flexible approaches to production. They also 
contribute to energy and resource conservation, as in general they require less energy to 
manufacture and, being lighter, contain less matter than conventional materials. 
42. Biotechnology will have major implications for the environment. The products of genetic 
engineering could dramatically improve human and animal health. Researchers are finding new 
drugs, new therapies, and new ways of controlling disease vectors. Energy derived from plants 
could increasingly substitute for non-renewable fossil fuels. New high-yield crop varieties and 
those resistant to unfavourable weather conditions and pests could revolutionize agriculture. 
Integrated pest management will become more common. Biotechnology could also yield 
cleaner and more efficient alternatives to many wasteful processes and polluting products. 
New techniques to treat solid and liquid wastes could help solve the pressing problem of 
hazardous waste disposal./27 
43. Advances in space technology, now the almost exclusive domain of industrial countries, 
also hold promise for the Third World, even for agriculture-based economies. Weather 
forecasting services provided through a satellite and communications network can help 
farmers in deciding when to plant, water, fertilize, and harvest crops. Remote sensing and 
satellite imagery could facilitate optimal use of the Earth's resources, permitting the 
monitoring and assessment of long-term trends in climatic change, marine pollution, soil 
erosion rates, and plant cover. (See Chapter 10.) 
44. These new technologies and the Green Revolution blur the traditional distinctions between 
agriculture, industry, and services. And they make it possible for developments in one sector to
more radically affect those in another. Agriculture has become virtually an 'industry' in 
developed countries. Agriculture-related services - especially for regional weather forecasting, 
storage, and transport - are becoming ever more important. New techniques of tissue culture 
and genetic engineering could soon generate plant strains able to fix nitrogen from the air, a 
development that would drastically affect the fertilizer industry, but that would also reduce the 
threat of pollution by agrochemicals. 
45. The chemical and energy industries are moving increasingly into the seeds business, 
providing new seeds that meet specific local conditions and requirements - but that may also 
need specific fertilizers and pesticides. Here research and development, production, and 
marketing need to be carefully guided so as not to make the world even more dependent on a 
few crop varieties - or on the products of a few large transnational 
46. Yet new technologies are not all intrinsically benign, nor will they have only positive 
impacts on the environment. The large-scale production and widespread use of new materials, 
for example, may create hitherto unknown health hazards (such as the use of gallium arsenate 
in the microchip industry.)/28 Risk research might be carried out and products manufactured 
where safeguards are weak or where people are unaware of the dangers. The need for caution 
in introducing a new technology is reinforced by the experience of the Green Revolution, 
which, despite formidable achievements, raises concerns over dependence on relatively few 
crop strains and large doses of agrochemicals. New life forms produced by genetic engineering 
should be carefully tested and assessed for their potential impact on health and on the 
maintenance of genetic diversity and ecological balance before they are introduced to the 
market, and thus to the environment./29 
III. Strategies for Sustainable Industrial Development 
47. Resource and environmental considerations must be integrated into the industrial planning 
and decision-making processes of government and industry. This will allow a steady reduction 
in the energy and resource content of future growth by increasing the efficiency of resource 
use, reducing waste, and encouraging resource recovery and recycling. 
1. Establish Environmental Goals, Regulations, Incentives, and Standards 
48. In dealing with industrial pollution and resource degradation, it is essential that industry, 
government, and the public have clear benchmarks. Where the workforce and financial 
resources permit, national governments should establish clear environmental goals and 
enforce environmental laws, regulations, incentives, and standards on industrial enterprises. 
In formulating such policies, they should give priority to public health problems associated 
with industrial pollution and hazardous wastes. And they must improve their environmental 
statistics and data base relating to industrial activities. 
49. The regulations and standards should govern such matters as air and water pollution, 
waste management, occupational health and safety of workers, energy and resource efficiency 
of products or processes, and the manufacture, marketing, use, transport, and disposal of toxic 
substances. This should normally be done at the national level, with local governments being 
empowered to exceed, but not to lower, national norms. In preparing environmental 
regulations, it is important that flexible systems are adopted without specifying a particular 
process or technology and recognizing that governments differ greatly in their capacity to 
formulate legal standards and enforce them. 
50. Regulations to control the impacts of industrial activity across national boundaries and on
the international commons are also needed. Existing or future international conventions 
dealing with transfrontier pollution or management of shared natural resources should 
enshrine certain key principles: 
the responsibility of every state not to harm the health and environment of other 
nations, 
liability and compensation for any damage caused by transfrontier pollution, and 
equal right of access to remedial measures by all parties concerned. 
2. Make More Effective Use of Economic Instruments 
51. Pollution is a form of waste, and a symptom of inefficiency in industrial production. When 
industries recognize pollution as a cost, they are sometimes motivated to make investments in 
improved products and processes to increase efficiency and hence to reduce the pollution and 
waste they generate, particularly when there are economic incentives to do so, it largely 
depends on whether such investments will increase their economic performance. 
52. But there are limits to what society can expert industry operating in competition with other 
industries to do voluntarily. Regulations imposing uniform performance standards are 
essential to ensure that industry makes the investments necessary to reduce pollution and 
waste and to enable them to compete on an equal footing. 
53. Air and water have traditionally been regarded as 'free' goods, but the enormous costs to 
society of past and present pollution show that they are not free. The environmental costs of 
economic activity are not encountered until the assimilative capacity of the environment has 
been exceeded. Beyond that point, they cannot be avoided. They will be paid. The policy 
question is how and by whom they will be paid, not whether. Basically, there are only two ways. 
The costs can be 'externalized' - that is, transferred to various segments of the community in 
the form of damage costs to human health, property, and ecosystems. Or they can 
'internalized' - paid by the enterprise. The enterprise may invest in measures to prevent the 
damages and, if the market for its product allows, pass the costs along to the consumer. Or it 
may invest in measures to restore unavoidable damage replanting forests, restocking fish, 
rehabilitating land after mining. Or it may compensate victims of health and property damage. 
In these cases, too, the costs may be passed on to the consumer. 
54. Enterprises may be encouraged to invest in preventive, restorative, or compensatory 
measures with subsidies of various kinds. Indeed, in most industrialized and many developing 
countries, subsidies are a common way of encouraging companies to invest in measures 
needed to prevent external damage. But in this case, of course, it is the taxpayer who pays, 
rather than the consumer of the product. Moreover, if the subsidies are large and paid to 
industries operating in an international market, they can lead to trade distortions and should 
be avoided. 
55. In 1972, the member countries of OECD agreed to base their environmental policies on a 
Polluter Pays Principle (PPP)./30 Essentially an economic efficiency measure, PPP is intended 
to encourage industries to internalize environmental costs and reflect them in the prices of 
products. At the same time, state regulations in CMEA countries are carried out through 
government bodies that allow environmental concerns to be taken into account. 
We move towards attacking the sources and not the effects. But we also meet
environmental questions in our markets, among our own employees and in our 
local environment. This definitely provides experiences that underline the need for 
a more complete and comprehensive thinking about the systems of which 
environment becomes an integral part. We also, as industry, meet the problems of 
international relations and environment, unfortunately very often in the way of 
hidden trade barriers or difficulties in cooperation between authorities. 
Rolf Marstrander 
Director, Environment Affairs, Norsk Hydro 
WCED Public Hearing 
Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 
56. In the case of OECD, the guidelines on PPP were intended to discourage subsidies that 
could lead to distortions in trade. Countries agreed to phase out the use of subsidies over 
varying periods of time. (See Chapter 3 for the application of PPP to international trade and 
investment.) 
57. Incentives to reduce pollution can be enhanced by other measures. Energy and water 
pricing policies, for example, can push industries to consume less. Product redesign and 
technological innovations leading to safer products, more efficient processes, and recycling of 
raw materials can also be promoted by a more effective, integrated use of economic incentives 
and disincentives, such as investment tax breaks, low-interest loans, depreciation allowances, 
pollution or waste charges, and non-compliance fees. 
58. Sometimes the way in which other policy objectives are promoted unintentionally reduces 
the effectiveness of environmental programmers. For example, subsidies on raw materials or 
water supply or energy to promote the development of industry in remote areas may well 
dilute the pressure to conserve resources. Governments should examine whether existing 
economic policies, instruments, or subsidies provided to various industry-based programmes 
and projects contribute effectively to the promotion of environmentally sound and resource 
efficient practices. 
3. Broaden Environmental Assessments 
59. An increasing number of countries require that certain major investments be subject to an 
environmental impact assessment. This broader environmental assessment should he applied 
not only to products and projects, but also to policies and programmed, especially major 
macroeconomic, finance, and sectoral policies that induce significant impacts on the 
environment. 
60. Many developing countries, particularly in Asia and Latin America, have adopted systems 
for environmental impact assessment. But the lack of institutional capacity and skilled 
personnel mean that these are often conducted by outside consultants, without quality checks. 
In some cases, government authorities would benefit from a second opinion on the 
environmental documentation they receive. Interested governments should create an 
independent international assessment body to help developing countries, upon request, 
evaluate the environmental impact and sustainability of planned development projects. 
4. Encourage Action by Industry 
61. Industry's response to pollution and resource degradation has not been and should not be
limited to compliance with regulations. It should accept a broad sense of social responsibility 
and ensure an awareness of environmental considerations at a levels. Towards this end, all 
industrial enterprises, trade associations, and labour unions should establish company wide or 
industry-wide policies concerning resource and environmental management, including 
compliance with the laws and requirements of the country in which they operate. 
62. International trade associations play a major role in Betting standards and disseminating 
information, which must be significantly expanded. They should establish and make widely 
available sectoral guidelines for assessing the sustainability and potential hazards of new 
facilities, for developing accident contingency plans, and for selecting pollution control or 
waste treatment technologies. Such key industry associations as the International Chamber of 
Commerce and the European Council of Chemical Manufacturers' Federation that have taken 
important and encouraging leadership roles in dealing with environmental issues should now 
take a lead in addressing the broader concerns inherent in sustainable development. 
63. With limited resources at their disposal, small and medium- sized industries often find 
themselves unable to afford the changes necessary to meet environmental regulations and 
product controls. Small scale businesses such as metal working, machine tools, printing, and 
tanning and dying are frequently among the worst offenders of environmental regulations in 
any country. New technologies, especially micro-electronics, already allow small industries 
inexpensive means to control an entire production process. Energy-saving biological systems 
may be well suited to the needs of small and medium sized industries for pollution control or 
waste disposal. 
64. Small and medium scale enterprises, constituting the largest segment of industry in most 
nations, need information and may in some cases require financial and technical assistance 
from the public sector. Management and worker training can help them incorporate cleaner 
technologies and environmental planning into work patterns. Governments should encourage 
cooperative efforts smaller firms in joint research and development on environmental issues, 
for example, or joint use of pollution control or waste treatment facilities. 
5. Increase Capacity to Deal with Industrial Hazards 
65. Chemical products have greatly improved health and life expectancies; increased 
agricultural production; raised comfort, convenience, and the general quality of life; and 
expanded economic opportunities. The chemical industry is also one of the most dynamic 
sectors in most countries, including many developing ones. Yet this industry, together with its 
products, can have a particularly severe impact on the environment. It has given rise to a host 
of new problems both of product and process pollution. It continues to generate an 
increasingly wider range of products and wastes whose effects, especially long-term ones, on 
human health and the environment are not precisely known. Major accidents have taken place, 
and the safety record of the industry has been challenged in recent years. 
66. In a world more and more dependent on chemical products and highly complex large-scale 
technologies, accidents with catastrophic consequences are likely to increase. Some of the 
heavy metals and non-metallic minerals, such as asbestos, also pose serious hazards to health 
and the environment. Various hazardous products and processes are already built into current 
systems of production and the technological structure of contemporary society, and it will be a 
long time before these can be replaced with less dangerous, inherently safer technologies and 
systems. Some highly toxic chemicals that are known to cause cancer and birth defects and 
have long-term genetic effects are already in the environment in significant concentrations, and 
may take decades to be diffused.
5.1 Chemicals 
67. Chemicals represent about 10 per cent of total world trade in terms of value,/31 some 
70,000-80,000 chemicals are now on the market - and hence in the environment./32 The 
figure is only an informed estimate because no complete inventory has been done. Some 
1,000-2,000 new chemicals enter the commercial market each year, many without adequate 
prior testing or evaluation of effects. 
68. According to a U.S. National Research Council sample of 65,725 chemicals in common use, 
data required for complete health hazard evaluations were available for only 10 per cent of 
pesticides and 18 per cent of drugs. No toxicity data existed for nearly 80 per cent of the 
chemicals used in commercial products and processes inventoried under the Toxic Substances 
Control Act./33 This situation is now beginning to change as governments move gradually from 
a system of post-market testing to one of pre-market testing of all new chemicals. 
69. By 1986, more than 500 chemicals and chemical products had been banned altogether or 
had their uses severely restricted in the country of origin./34 In addition, an unknown number 
of chemicals are withdrawn from clearance processes every year in the light of control agency 
concerns, or are never submitted to national control agencies for clearance. Some of these end 
up on the export market. 
70. In industrial countries, in an increasingly interdependent and effective system, chemical 
control agencies share test results and notify each other of new restrictions on chemicals. A 
ban or restriction in one country is thus often quickly followed by a review and appropriate 
action in the others. 
71. Importing developing countries do not, as a rule, share in this system. Recently, some 
industrial countries undertook to require their industry to provide a one-time notification to 
importing countries of chemicals that they have formally banned or severely restricted. They 
agreed to provide prior notification of the proposed export/import of such chemicals and they 
also agreed to provide the importing country with the information that led them to ban or 
restrict the chemical, if it is requested. While the intent behind this system is laudable, it is 
difficult to see how it can work for importing countries that have no control institutions to 
receive the notification or professional capacity to assess the information. 
72. Third World importers have no way to effectively control trade in chemicals that have been 
banned or severely restricted in exporting countries. Thus these countries badly need the 
infrastructure to assess the risks associated with chemical use. In view of the seriousness of 
this situation, the Commission recommends that all governments, particularly those of the 
major chemical-producing countries, should: 
undertake that no new chemicals be placed on international markets until the health and 
environmental impacts have been tested and assessed; 
reinforce on-going efforts to obtain international agreement on the selection of existing 
chemicals for priority testing, on criteria and procedures for their assessment, and on a 
system for international sharing of the tasks and the resources required; 
strictly regulate the export to developing countries of those chemicals for which 
authorization for domestic sale has not been sought or given, by extending requirements 
for prior notification and information exchange to them; and
support the establishment in existing regional organizations of units qualified to receive 
such prior notification and information, to assess it and to advise governments in the 
region on the risks associated with the use of these chemicals, in order to permit 
individual governments to weigh these risks against benefits they may perceive from 
importation of the chemicals. 
73. Consumer awareness should be increased. Governments should encourage the 
establishment of information centres on chemical products used by consumers and strengthen 
the international networks of information exchange, assessment, and data banks now evolving 
in the UN and elsewhere./35 Another essential step is the adoption and enforcement of 
regulations on the packaging and labelling of chemicals whose use may be potentially harmful, 
to ensure that clear directions are provided in common local languages. Consumer unions and 
other non-governmental organizations should take the lead in collecting and distributing 
comparative risk information on ingredients in consumer products such as cleaning agents and 
pesticides. 
The most explosive development in the establishment of chemical and pollutive 
industry has come in developing countries. This is an outright danger. The last 
accidents are but a few of those that may come. However, we recognize that 
considerable responsibility tests on the trade union movement in the individual 
countries in pressing for influence on authorities and managements to avoid both 
such accidents and investments from companies that do net follow acceptable 
standards. 
Technology development has improved environment in the industrial parts of the 
world. The new production and information systems make it more difficult, then, for 
the developing countries to use cheap labour as a means to attract industry to their 
countries. The future for these countries does not look very bright, unless the 
international society takes it upon itself to affect a sharing of production 
technology and resources. This is politically difficult indeed. 
Juul Bjerke 
International Confederation of Free Trade Unions 
WCED Public Hearing 
Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 
74. The chemical producer and user industries, as the source of the risks associated with 
chemicals and as the greatest beneficiary of their use should bear the responsibility for 
ensuring (and the liability for not ensuring) that their products meet the highest standards of 
safety, have the fewest adverse side effects on health and the environment, and are handled 
with appropriate care by workers and users. This will require the fullest possible disclosure of 
information about the properties and production processes of chemical substances and on 
comparative risks, not only to the regulatory authorities but also to the workers, consumers, 
and residents of the community in which a chemical industry operates. 
5.2 Hazardous Wastes 
75. Industrialized countries generate about 90 per cent of the world's hazardous wastes. 
Although all estimates have a wide margin of error, given considerable differences in definition 
of 'hazardous waste', in 1984 some 325 million to 375 million tons were generated
worldwide,/36 around 5 million tons of which were in the newly industrialized and developing 
areas of the world./37 
76. In OECD member countries alone, thousands of waste disposal sites exist, many of which 
are likely to require some form of remedial action. Clean-up is expensive: Estimates include 
$10 billion for the Federal Republic of Germany, more than $1.5 billion for the Netherlands, 
$20-100 billion for the United States, and at least $60 million for Denmark (in 1966 dollars)./38 
A large number of potentially hazardous sites may also exist in concentrated industrial-urban 
areas in centrally planned economies as well as in developing countries. Some form of 
government intervention is required through regulatory action or financial support. 
77. Waste management in developing countries suffers from a variety of problems. Frequent 
and heavy rains in the tropics, for instance, leach wastes into the soils under landfills or even 
cause them to overflow. With little or no pretreatment of wastes, this could contaminate water 
supplies or cause local people to be directly exposed to the wastes. Land-filling generally 
occurs close to industrial states that are surrounded by poor neighbourhoods or shanty 
towns./39 These dangers point up the need for land use planning in developing countries, and 
the mote urgent need to actually implement and enforce such plans. 
78. The overriding policy objective must be to reduce the amount of waste generated and to 
transform an increasing amount into resources for use and reuse. This will reduce the volume 
that otherwise must be treated or disposed of through incineration, land disposal, or dumping 
at sea. This is first and foremost a problem of industrialized countries. But it is also a problem 
in NICs and developing countries, where rapid industrialization is bringing the same severe 
problems of hazardous waste management. 
78. The amount of wastes crossing national frontiers is increasing and is likely to continue to 
do so. Between 1962 and 1983, wastes transported in Western Europe for disposal in another 
country virtually doubled, reaching some 250,000- 425,000 tons (1-2 per cent of the total 
hazardous wastes generated)./40 This increase may be attributed partly to the availability of 
relatively low-cost, legal, land-based disposal facilities in some countries. For example, about 
4,000 shipments of hazardous wastes went from the Netherlands to the German Democratic 
Republic in 1984. And the Federal Republic of Germany sent about 20,000 shipments to the 
German Democratic Republic the preceding year. International transport of wastes meant for 
disposal at sea, either by incineration or dumping, amounted to about 1.8 million tons in 
1983./41 Small and poor countries are especially vulnerable to offshore dumping, as has 
occurred in the waters of the Pacific and the Caribbean. 
80. Some countries have recently proposed what amounts to a commodity trade in hazardous 
(including radioactive) wastes. Strengthened international cooperation in this area is vitally 
important, and several international bodies have taken up the matter./42 An international 
agreement currently being developed by OECD is to be based on three important principles: 
equally strict controls on shipments to non member countries; prior notification to and 
consent from the country of final destination, whether member or non-member country; and a 
guarantee of existence of adequate disposal facilities in the recipient country. UNEP has drawn 
up extensive draft guidelines, but as of now there is no effective mechanism either to monitor 
or to control hazardous waste trade and dumping./43 Governments and international 
organizations must more actively support efforts to achieve an effective international regime to 
control the transfrontier movement of hazardous wastes. 
5.3 Industrial Accidents
81. Accidents involving toxic chemicals and radioactive materials can occur in plants in any 
region. According to a survey carried out by the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, 6,928 
accidents of varying severity occurred at U.S. plants between 1980 and 1965 - an average of five 
a day./44 
82. In 1984, liquid gas storage tanks exploded in Mexico City, killing 1,000 people and leaving 
thousands more homeless. Only months after the Bhopal tragedy in India, which killed over 
2,000 people and injured 200,000 more, an accident at a plant in West Virginia in the United 
States operated by the parent company of the Bhopal facility resulted in emergency evacuation 
of residents and some health problems. The accidental release in 1976 of the highly toxic and 
mutagenic chemical dioxin at Seveso, Italy, and the ensuing saga of drums of contaminated soil 
being passed around Europe, also showed that in industrial countries regulations can be 
evaded and minimum safety standards breached. 
83. In early November 1986, a fire at a warehouse of a chemicals manufacturer in Basel, 
Switzerland, sent toxic fumes into France and the Federal Republic of Germany and released 
toxic chemicals into the Rhine, causing massive fish kills and affecting the vital water supply in 
countries downstream, all the way to the Netherlands. Scientists investigating the Rhine 
agreed that it could be years before the damaged riverine ecosystems would return to their 
former statue./45 
84. Thus incidents at Mexico City, Bhopal, Chernobyl, and Basel - all occurring within the short 
lifetime of this Commission raised public concern about industrial disasters. They also 
demonstrated the likelihood of significant increases in the frequency and magnitude of 
industrial accidents with catastrophic consequences. 
85. These events point to the need to strengthen national capabilities and the framework for 
bilateral and regional cooperation. National and local governments should: 
survey hazardous industrial operations and adopt, and enforce regulations or guidelines 
on the safe operation of industrial plants and on the transport, handling, and disposal of 
hazardous materials; 
adopt land use policies or regional development plans that would require or provide 
incentives to industries that have a high pollution or accident potential to locate away 
from population centres, and that would discourage people from moving close to plants 
and waste disposal sites; 
ensure that plant workers are provided with full information about the products and 
technologies they handle, and are given adequate training in safe operational procedures 
and emergency preparedness; and 
involve local governments and community residents in major siting decisions and 
emergency preparedness planning. 
In industry, we feel it must now be made mandatory for any firm that is potentially 
polluting nature through liquid gas or particle emissions to enrol their staff in short 
but instructive courses of environmental education. Too often firms pollute not just 
through accident or design but through gross ignorance by the labour involved of 
the destructive effect on the environment. 
Donald Aubrey
Society to Overcome Pollution 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
86. Increasingly, the consequences of accidents may seriously affect neighbouring countries. 
Nations should enter into arrangements with other nations that could be seriously affected by 
an accident in hazardous facilities located on its territory, under which they would agree to: 
notify each other of the location and essential characteristics of existing hazardous 
installations, an accident in which could spill over and affect lives, property, and 
ecosystems in the other; 
prepare contingency plans covering potential accidents in these installations; 
provide prompt alert, full information, and mutual assistance in case of accidents; 
establish criteria for selection of sites for new hazardous facilities, which would then be 
subject to the above; and 
establish standards for the liability and compensation for any damage caused by 
transfrontier pollution. 
87. Industrial accidents and their consequences are to a large extent unpredictable. In order to 
better identify risks, governments, international organizations, and industry itself should 
promote further development of technology/risk assessment methodologies, establish data 
banks on such assessments conducted, and make them easily available to all countries. 
6. Strengthen International Efforts to Help Developing Countries 
88. Pollution-intensive, resource-based industries are growing fastest in developing countries. 
These governments will thus have to substantially strengthen their environmental and 
resource management capabilities. Even where policies, laws, and regulations on the 
environment exist, they may not be consistently enforced. Many developing nations have 
begun to build up their educational and scientific infrastructure, but their technical and 
institutional capacity for making the most of imported or new technologies remains small. 
Some countries thus continue to depend on outside technical and managerial skills for the 
maintenance of industrial operations. For lack of capital, they often find that a new industry 
can only be started with the support of foreign aid, commercial loans, a direct investment, or a 
joint venture with a transnational corporation. 
89. The importance of private investment and the key role of transnational corporations have 
already been highlighted. (See Chapter 3.) It is inconceivable that a successful transition to 
sustainable development can be achieved unless the policies and practices are reoriented 
around sustainable development objectives. Those external agencies that support and facilitate 
private investment, particularly export credit and investment insurance organizations, should 
also incorporate sustainable development criteria into their policies and practices. 
90. The problems of developing-country governments are compounded by the vagaries of the 
international economic system, such as high debts, high interest rates, and declining terms nf 
trade for commodities. These do not encourage hard-pressed governments to spend high 
proportions of their meagre resources on environmental protection and resource management. 
(See Chapter 3.)
91. The developing countries themselves will eventually have to bear the consequences of 
inappropriate industrialization, and the ultimate responsibility for ensuring the sustainability 
of their development rests with each government. They must define their own environmental 
goals and development objectives, and establish clear priorities among competing demands on 
their scarce resources. They will also need to search for more self-reliant means of industrial 
and technological development. The choices are theirs, but they will need all the assistance - 
technical, financial, and institutional - that the international community can muster to help 
them set an environmentally sound and sustainable course of development. 
92. Large industrial enterprises, and transnational corporations in particular, have a special 
responsibility. They are repositories of scarce technical skills, and they should adopt the 
highest safety and health protection standards practicable and assume responsibility for safe 
plant and process design and for staff training. The transnational should also institute 
environmental and safety audits of their plants measured against standards at other 
subsidiaries, not just against those of other local companies, which may have less stringent 
requirements These audits and their follow-up should be made available to governments and 
other interested parties. 
93. Particular care is required in dealing with toxic chemicals and hazardous wastes, and in 
contingency planning for accidents. The views of non-governmental organizations and the local 
community should be sought in planning new industrial facilities. The relevant national and 
local authorities must be fully informed about the properties, potentially harmful effects, and 
any potential risks to the community of the technology, process, or product being introduced. 
The necessary information should be disclosed to nearby residents in an easily understandable 
manner. The enterprises must cooperate with the local government, and community in 
contingency planning and in devising clearly defined mechanisms for relief and compensation 
to pollution or accident victims. 
94. Many developing countries need information on the nature of industry-based resource and 
environmental problems, on risks associated with certain processes and products, and on 
standards and other measures to protect health and ensure environmental sustainability. They 
also need trained people to apply such information to local circumstances. International trade 
associations and labour unions should develop special environmental training programmes for 
developing countries and disseminate information on pollution control, waste minimization, 
and emergency preparedness plans through local chapters. 
Footnotes 
1/ As will be noted later in this chapter, the conventional classification of economic activities 
into three sectors - primary (agriculture and mining), secondary (manufacturing), and tertiary 
(commerce and other services) - has become increasingly ambiguous. Some economic activities 
cut across all three. Furthermore, the services sector has begun to occupy an important place 
of its own in industrialized economies. In this chapter, however, the term 'industry' will be 
used in the traditional sense to include mining and quarrying, manufacturing, construction, 
electricity, water, and gas. 
2/ GATT, International Trade 1985-66 (Geneva: 1986). 
3/ UNIDO, Industry in the 1980s: Structural Change and Interdependence (New 
York: 1985).
4/ See, for example, W.W. Leontief, The Impact of Automation (Oxford: Oxford University 
Press, 1986); F. Duchin, 'Automation and its Effects on Employment', in E. Collings and L. 
Tanner (eds.), Employment Implications of the Changing Industrial Base (New York: 
Ballinger Books, 1984); J. Rada, The Impact of Micro-electronics (Geneva: ILO, 1980); 
and D. Werneke, Microelectronics and Office Jobs (Geneva: ILO, 1983). 
5/ UNIDO, Industry and Development: Global Report 1985 (New York: 1985). 
6/ WHO, Urban Air Pollution 1973-1980 (Geneva: 1984); World Resources 
Institute/International Institute for Environment and Development, World Resources 
1986 (New York: Basic Books, 1986). 
7/ The UN Commission on Transnational Corporations has been working on a comprehensive 
code since 1977 but the sections on environmental and consumer protection have been 
virtually agreed. For other examples, see FAO, 'Code of Conduct on the Distribution and Use of 
Pesticides', Rome, 1985; UNEP, 'Guidelines on Risk Management and Accident Prevention in 
the Chemical Industry', adopted in 1982; and OECD, 'Declaration of OECD Member Countries 
on International Investment and Multinational Enterprise', 1976. and 'Clarification of the 
Environmental Concerns Expressed in Paragraph 2 of the General Policies Chapter of the 
OECD Guidelines for Multinational Enterprises', Paris, 1985. 
8/ See, for example, International Chamber of Commerce, 'Environmental Guidelines for 
World industry', Paris, 1976 (revised in 1981 and 1986); Hellenic Marine Environment 
Protection Association, 'To Save the Seas, Declaration of a Voluntary Commitment' and 
'Guidelines for the Officers of HELMEPA Member Vessels', Athens, 1982; and U.S. National 
Agricultural Chemicals Association, 'Guidelines on Labelling Practices for Pesticide Products in 
Developing Areas of the World', Washington, DC, 1985. 
9/ UNEP, State of the Environment 1982 (Nairobi: 1982). 
10/ OECD, 'The Impact of Environmental Measures on the Rate of Economic Growth, Rate of 
Inflation, Productivity and International Trade', Background Papers Prepared for the 
International Conference on Environment and Economics, Vol. I (Paris: 1984). 
11/ U.S. Department of Commerce, 'Plant and Equipment Expenditures by Business for 
Pollution Abatement', Survey of Current Business, February 1986. 
12/ Japanese Ministry of International Trade and Industry, data compiled annually for the 
Industrial Structural Council, Tokyo, 1970-86. 
13/ The UN Economic Commission for Europe compiles and publishes a 'compendium of low-and 
non-waste technologies'. A special department in the French Ministry of Environment 
collects and disseminates information on clean processes and technologies ('les techniques 
propres'). 
14/ UNIDO, Industry in the 1980s, op. cit. 
15/ N. Namiki, 'International Redeployment of Pollution-Intensive Industries and The Role of 
Multinational Corporations', prepared for WCED, 1986. 
16/ OECD, Developments in Steel Making Capacity in Non-OECD Market Economy 
Countries (Paris: 1985). 
17/ Namiki, op. cit.
18/ UNIDO, Industry in a Changing World (New York: 1983). 
19/ OECD, The State of the Environment 1985 (Paris: 1985). 
20/ 'Industry Experience with Environmental Problem Solving', background paper prepared 
for the World Industry Conference on Environmental Management, organized by the 
International Chamber of Commerce and the UN Environmental Programme, Versailles, 14-16 
November 1984. 
21/ Ibid. 
22/ UNEP, The World Environment 1972-1982 (Nairobi: 1982). 
23/ V. Anikeev, Director of the Department on Environment and Rational Use of Natural 
Resources, GOSPLAN, during a visit by WCED to the GOSPLAN headquarters, Moscow, 12 
December 1986. 
24/ P.F. Drucker, 'The Changed World Economy', Foreign Affairs, Spring 1986. 
25/ E.D. Larson et al. 'Beyond the Era of Materials', Scientific American, June 1986. 
26/ Drucker, op. cit. 
27/ For a discussion of various possibilities for industrial application of biotechnology, see J. 
Elkington, Double Dividends? U.S. Biotechnology and Third World Development, 
WRI Papers, No. 2 (Washington, DC: World Resources Institute, 1986). 
28/ The 1986 annual report of the Japanese Environment Agency to the Parliament dealt 
extensively with this topic of the potential environmental impacts and risks posed by the new 
technologies. Quality of the Environment in Japan 1986 (Tokyo: 1987). 
29/ The U.S. Government recently announced a comprehensive regulatory policy for ensuring 
the safety of biotechnology research and products. See 'Coordinated Framework for Regulation 
of Biotechnology', Federal Register, 26 June 1986. 
30/ See OECD, 'Guiding Principles Concerning International Economic Aspects of 
Environmental Policies', Council Recommendation C(72)128, Paris, 26 May 1972. 
31/ OECD, Economic Aspects of International Chemicals Control (Paris: 1983). 
32/ The Conservation Foundation, 'Chemicals Policy in the Global Environment', paper 
prepared for WCED, 1986. 
33/ National Research Council, Toxicity Testing (Washington, DC: National Academy Press, 
1984). 
34/ See 'Consolidated List of Products Whose Consumption and/or Sale Have Been Banned, 
Withdrawn, Severely Restricted or Not Approved by Governments', compiled by the United 
Nations, 1st revised edition, DIESA/WP/1, 1986. 
35/ Notable examples include the International Programme on Chemical Safety (UNEP/WHO 
/ILO), International Register of Potentially Toxic Chemicals (UNEP), International Agency for 
Research on Cancer (WHO), and the UN's 'Consolidated List', op. cit. 
36/ H. Yakowitz, 'Global Aspects of Hazardous Waste Management', prepared for WCED, 1985;
U.S. Congress, Office of Technology Assessment, Superfund Strategy (Washington DC: U.S. 
Government Printing Office, 1985). U.S. estimates include wastewater in very dilute form. The 
result is a much larger estimate of total hazardous wastes for the United States than for other 
countries. 
37/ Some other sources quote figures as high as 34 million tons for Brazil alone, and 22 million 
and 13.6 million tons for Mexico and India, respectively. See H. J. Leonard, 'Hazardous Wastes: 
The Crisis Spreads' National Development, April 1986. 
38/ Estimates quoted in an OECD Secretariat paper, Paris, 1986. 
39/ UNEP, 'Transfrontier Movements of Hazardous Wastes With Regard to Developing 
Countries', prepared for the Working Group of Experts on Environmentally Sound 
Management of Hazardous Wastes, Munich, 1984. 
40/ Yakowitz, op. cit. 
41/ OECD, Background Papers for Conference on International Cooperation Concerning 
Transfrontier Movements of Hazardous Wastes, Basel, Switzerland, 26-27 March 1985. 
42/ See EEC, 'Supervision and Control of Transfrontier Shipments of Hazardous Waste', 
Council Directive, Brussels, December 1984; OECD, Resolution of the Council C(85)100, Paris, 
June 1985. 
43/ UNEP "Transfrontier Movements', op. cit. See also M.J. Suess and J.W. Huismans (eds.), 
Management of Hazardous Waste: Policy Guidelines and Code of Practice 
(Copenhagen: WHO Regional Office for Europe, 1983). 
44/ Preliminary findings of a study conducted for U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, 
'Acute Hazardous Data Base Washington', D.C., 1985, quoted in Yakowitz, op. cit. 
45/ See, for example, La Suisse, 3-9 November; Die Welt, 10 November; Die Zeit, 14 
November; Der Spiegel, 17 November; International Herald Tribune, 14-16 November 1986.
Our Common Future, Chapter 9: The Urban Challenge 
I. The Growth of Cities 
1. The Crisis in Third World Cities 
2. The Situation in Industrial World Cities 
II. The Urban Challenge in Developing Countries 
1. National Urban Strategies 
2. Strengthening Local Authorities 
3. Self-Reliance and Citizen Involvement 
4. Housing and Services for the Poor 
5. Tapping More Resources 
III. International Cooperation 
1. Cooperation Among Developing Countries 
2. International Support 
1. By the turn of the century, almost half the world will live in urban areas - from small towns to 
huge megacities./1 The world's economic system is increasingly an urban one, with overlapping 
networks of communications, production, and trade./2 This system, with its flows of 
information, energy, capital, commerce, and people, provides the backbone for national 
development. A city's prospects - or a town's - depend critically on its place within the urban 
system, national and international. So does the fate of the hinterland, with its agriculture, 
forestry, and mining, on which the urban system depends. 
2. In many nations, certain kinds of industries and service enterprises are now being developed 
in rural areas. But they receive high-quality infrastructure and services, with advanced 
telecommunications systems ensuring that their activities are part of the national (and global) 
urban-industrial system. In effect, the countryside is being 'urbanized'. 
Table 9-1 
Proportion of Population Living In Urban Areas, 1950-2000 
1950 1985 2000
(Per cent) 
World Total 29.2 41.0 46.6 
More Developed Regions 53.8 71.5 74.4 
Less Developed Regions 17.0 31.2 39.3 
Africa 15.7 29.7 39.0 
Latin America 41.0 69.0 76.8 
(Temperate South America) (64.8) (84.3) 88.6 
(Tropical South America) (35.9) (70.4) (79.4) 
Asia 16.4 28.1 35.0 
(China) (11.0) (20.6) (25.1) 
(India) (17.3) (25.5) (34.2) 
(in Millions) 
World Total 734.2 1982.8 2853.6 
More Developed Regions 447.3 838.8 949.9 
Less Developed Regions 1144.0 1903.7 
Africa 35.2 164.5 340.0 
Latin America 67.6 279.3 419.7 
Asia 225.8 791.1 1242.4 
Source: 'Urban and Rural Population Projections. 1984 Unofficial Assessment', Population 
Division. United Nations, New York. 
I. The Growth of Cities 
3. This is the century of the 'urban revolution'. In the 35 years since 1950, the number of 
people living in cities almost tripled, increasing by 1.25 billion. In the more developed regions, 
the urban population nearly doubled, from 447 million to 838 million. In the less developed 
world, it quadrupled, growing from 286 million to 1.14 billion. (See Table 9-1.) 
4. Over only 60 years, the developing world's urban population increased tenfold, from around 
100 million in 1920 to close to 1 billion in 1980. At the same time, its rural population more 
than doubled. 
In 1940, only one person in eight lived in an urban centre, while about one in 100 lived in 
a city with a million or more inhabitants (a 'million city'). 
By 1960, more than one in five persons lived in an urban centre, and one in 16 in a 
'million city'. 
By 1980, nearly one in three persons was an urban dweller and one in 10 a 'million city'
resident./3 
5. The population of many of sub-Saharan Africa's larger cities increased more than sevenfold 
between 1950 and 1980 Nairobi, Dar es Salaam, Nouakchott, Lusaka, Lagos, and Kinshasa 
among them./4 (See Table 9-2.) During these same 30 years, populations in many Asian and 
Latin American cities (such as Seoul, Baghdad, Dhaka, Amman, Bombay, Jakarta, Mexico City, 
Manila, Sao Paulo, Bogota, and Managua) tripled or quadrupled. In such cities, net 
immigration has usually been a greater contributor than natural increase to the population 
growth of recent decades. 
6. In many developing countries, cities have thus grown far beyond anything imagined only a 
few decades ago and at speeds without historic precedent. (See Box 9-1.) But some experts 
doubt that developing nations will urbanize as rapidly in the future as in the last 10-40 years, 
or that megacities will grow as large as UN projections suggest. Their argument is that many of 
the most powerful stimuli to rapid urbanization in the past have less influence today, and that 
changing government policies could reduce the comparative attractiveness of cities, especially 
the largest cities, and slow rates or urbanization. 
7. The urban population growth rate in developing countries as a whole has been slowing down 
from 5.2 per cent per annum in the late 1950s to 3.4 per cent in the 1950s./5 It is expected to 
decline even further in the coming decades. Nevertheless, if current trends hold. Third World 
cities could add a further three-quarters of a billion people by the year 2000. Over the same 
time, the cities of the industrial world would grow by a further 111 million./6 
8. These projections put the urban challenge firmly in the developing countries, in the space of 
just 15 years (or about 5,500 days), the developing world will have to increase by 65 per cent its 
capacity to produce and manage its urban infrastructure, services, and shelter - merely to 
maintain present conditions. And in many countries, this must be accomplished under 
conditions of great economic hardship and uncertainty, with resources diminishing relative to 
needs and rising expectations. 
Table 9-2 
Examples of Rapid Population Growth in Third World Cities 
1950 Most Recent Figure UN Projections 
for 2000 
Mexico City 3.05 16.0 (1982) 22.3 
Sao Paulo 2.7 12.6 (1980) 24.0 
Bombay 3.0 (1951) 8.2 (1981) 16.0 
Jakarta 1.45 6.2 (1977) 12.8 
Cairo 2.5 8.5 (1979) 13.2 
Delhi 1.4 (1951) 5.8 (1981) 9.6 
Manila 1.78 5.5 (1980) 11.1 
Lagos 0.27 (1952) 4.0 (1980) 8.3
Bogota 0.61 3.9 (1985) 9.6 
Nairobi 0.14 0.83 (1979) 5.3 
Dar es Salaam 0.15 (1960) 0.9 (1981) 4.6 
Greater Khartoum 0.18 1.05 (1978) 4.3 
Amman 0.03 0.78 (1978) 1.5 
Nouakchott 0.0058 0.25 (1982) 1.1 
Managua 0.11 0.51 (1980) 1.1 
Santa Cruz 0.059 0.26 (1976) 1.0 
Source: Recent census data used whenever possible; if none available, an estimate by the 
city government or a local research group has been used. UN projections for the year 2000 
from Department of International Economic and Social Affairs, Estimates and 
Projections of Urban. Rural and City Populations 1950-2025 (the 1982 
Assessment). ST/ESA/SER.R/58. New York. 1985 and from UN, Urban, Rural and City 
Populations 1950-2000 (as Assessed in 1978). Population Studies No. 68 (New York, 
1980). Other data from Jorge E. Hardoy and David Satterthwaite, Shelter: Need and 
Response (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1981), with some figures updated with more 
recent census data. 
1. The Crisis in Third World Cities 
9. Few city governments in the developing world have the power, resources, and trained staff 
to provide their rapidly growing populations with the land, services, and facilities needed for an 
adequate human life: clean water, sanitation, schools, and transport. The result is 
mushrooming illegal settlements with primitive facilities, increased overcrowding, and 
rampant disease linked to an unhealthy environment. 
Box 9-1 
Dominating Cities 
Nairobi, Kenya: In 1975, Nairobi had 57 per cent of all Kenya's manufacturing 
employment and two-thirds of its industrial plants. In 1979, Nairobi contained 
around 5 per cent of the national population. 
Manila, Philippines: Metropolitan Manila produces one-third of the nation's gross 
national product, handles 70 per cent of all imports, and contains 60 per cent of the 
manufacturing establishments. In 1981, it contained around 13 per cent of the 
national population. 
Lima, Peru: The metropolitan area of Lima accounts for 43 per cent of gross 
domestic product, for four-fifths of bank credit and consumer goods production, and 
for more than nine-tenths of capital goods production in Peru. In 1981, it was home to 
around 21 per cent of Peruvians.
Lagos, Nigeria: In 1978, Lagos' metropolitan area handled over 40 per cent of the 
nation's external trade, accounted for over 57 per cent of total value added in 
manufacturing, and contained over 40 per cent of Nigeria's highly skilled workers. It 
contains only some 5 per cent of the national population. 
Mexico City, Mexico: In 1970, with some 24 per cent of Mexicans living there, the 
capital contained 30 per cent of the manufacturing jobs, 28 per cent of employment 
in commerce, 38 per cent of jobs in services, 69 per cent of employment in national 
government, 62 per cent of national investment in higher education, and 80 per cent 
of research activities. In 1965, it contained 44 per cent of national bank deposits and 
61 per cent of national credits. 
Sao Paulo, Brazil: Greater Sao Paulo, with around one-tenth of Brazil's national 
population in 1980, contributed one-quarter of the net national product and over 40 
per cent of Brazil's industrial value-added. 
Source: J.E. Hardoy and D. Satterthwaite, 'Shelter, Infrastructure and Services in 
Third World Cities', Habitat International, Vol. 10, No 4, 1986. 
10. In most Third World cities, the enormous pressure for shelter and services has frayed the 
urban fabric. Much of the housing used by the poor is decrepit. Civic buildings are frequently in 
a state of disrepair and advanced decay. So too is the essential infrastructure of the city; public 
transport is overcrowded and overused, as are roads, buses and trains, transport stations, 
public latrines, and washing points. Water supply systems leak, and the resulting low water 
pressure allows sewage to seep into drinking water. A large proportion of the city's population 
often has no piped water, storm drainage, or roads./7 
Given the distribution of incomes, given the foreseeable availability of resources 
national, local, and worldwide given present technology, and given the present 
weakness of local government and the lack of interest of national governments in 
settlement problems, I don't see any solution for the Third World city. 
Third World cities are and they will increasingly become centres of competition for 
a plot to be invaded where you can build a shelter, for a room to rent, for a bed in 
a hospital, for a seat in a school or in a bus, essentially for the fewer stable 
adequately paid jobs, even for the space in a square or on a sidewalk where you 
can display and sell your merchandise, on which so many households depend. 
The people themselves organize and help construct most new housing units in 
Third World cities and they do so without the assistance from architects, planners, 
and engineers, nor from local or national governments. Furthermore, in many 
cases, national and local governments are frequently harassing these groups. The 
people themselves are becoming increasingly the true builders and designers of 
Third World cities and quite often the managers of their own districts. 
Jorge Hardoy 
International Institute for Environment and Development 
WCED Public Hearing 
Sao Paulo, 28-29 Oct 1985
11. A growing number of the urban poor suffer from a high incidence of diseases; most are 
environmentally based and could be prevented or dramatically reduced through relatively 
small investments. (See Box 9-2.) Acute respiratory diseases, tuberculosis, intestinal parasites, 
and diseases linked to poor sanitation and contaminated drinking water (diarrhoea, dysentery, 
hepatitis, and typhoid) are usually endemic; they are one of the major causes of illness and 
death, especially among children. In parts of many cities, poor people can expect to see one in 
four of their children die of serious malnutrition before the age of five, or one adult in two 
suffering intestinal worms or serious respiratory infections./8 
12. Air and water pollution might be assumed to be less pressing in Third World cities because 
of lower levels of industrial development. But in fact hundreds of such cities have high 
concentrations of industry. Air, water, noise, and solid waste pollution problems have 
increased rapidly and can have dramatic impacts on the life and health of city inhabitants, on 
their economy, and on jobs. Even in a relatively small city, just one or two factories dumping 
wastes into the only nearby river can contaminate everyone's drinking, washing, and cooking 
water. Many slums and shanties crowd close to hazardous industries, as this is land no one else 
wants. This proximity has magnified the risks for the poor, a fact demonstrated by great loss of 
life and human suffering in various recent industrial accidents. 
Box 9-2 
Environmental Problems in Third World Cities 
Out of India's 3,119 towns and cities, only 209 had partial and only 8 had full sewage 
and sewage treatment facilities. On the river Ganges, 114 cities each with 50,000 or 
more inhabitants dump untreated sewage into the river every day. DDT factories, 
tanneries, paper and pulp mills, petrochemical and fertilizer complexes, rubber 
factories, and a host of others use the river to get rid of their wastes. The Hoogly 
estuary (near Calcutta) is choked with untreated industrial wastes from more than 
150 major factories around Calcutta. Sixty per cent of Calcutta's population suffer 
from pneumonia, bronchitis, and other respiratory diseases related to air pollution. 
Chinese industries, most of which use coal in outdated furnaces and boilers, are 
concentrated around 20 cities and ensure a high level of air pollution. Lung cancer 
mortality in Chinese cities is four to seven times higher than in the nation as a whole, 
and the difference is largely attributable to heavy air pollution. 
In Malaysia, the highly urbanized Klang Valley (which includes the capital, Kuala 
Lumpur) has two to three times the pollution levels of major cities in the United 
States, and the Klang river system is heavily contaminated with agricultural and 
industrial effluents and sewage. 
Sources: Centre for science and Environment, State of India's Environment: A 
Citizens' Report (New Delhi: 1983); Vaclav Smil, The Bad Earth: 
Environmental Degradation in China (London: Zed Press, 1986); Sahabat Alam 
Malaysia, The State of Malaysian Environment 1983-84 - Towards Greater 
Environmental Awareness (Penang, Malaysia: 1983).
13. The uncontrolled physical expansion of cities has also had serious implications for the 
urban environment and economy. Uncontrolled development makes provision of housing, 
roads, water supply, sewers, and public services prohibitively expensive. Cities are often built 
on the most productive agricultural land, and unguided growth results in the unnecessary loss 
of this land. Such losses are most serious in nations with limited arable land, such as Egypt. 
Haphazard development also consumes land and natural landscapes needed for urban parks 
and recreation areas. Once an area is built up, it is both difficult and expensive to re-create 
open space. 
14. In general, urban growth has often preceded the establishment of a solid, diversified 
economic base to support the build-up of housing, infrastructure, and employment. In many 
places, the problems are linked to inappropriate patterns of industrial development and the 
lack of coherence between strategies for agricultural and urban development. The link between 
national economies and international economic factors has been discussed in Part I of this 
report. The world economic crisis of the 1980s has not only reduced incomes, increased 
unemployment, and eliminated many social programmes, it has also exacerbated the already 
low priority given to urban problems, increasing the chronic shortfall in resources needed to 
build, maintain, and manage urban areas./9 
2. The Situation in Industrial World Cities 
15. The Commission's focus on the urban crisis in developing countries is not meant to imply 
that what transpires in the cities of the industrial world is not of crucial importance to 
sustainable development globally. It is. These cities account for a high share of the world's 
resource use, energy consumption, and environmental pollution. Many have a global reach and 
draw their resources and energy from distant lands, with enormous aggregate impacts on the 
ecosystems of those lands. 
16. Nor is the emphasis on Third World cities meant to imply that problems within the cities of 
industrialized countries are not serious. They are. Many face problems of deteriorating 
infrastructure, environmental degradation, inner-city decay, and neighbourhood collapse. The 
unemployed, the elderly, and racial and ethnic minorities can remain trapped in a downward 
spiral of degradation and poverty, as job opportunities and the younger and better-educated 
individuals leave declining neighbourhoods. City or municipal governments often face a legacy 
of poorly designed and maintained public housing estates, mounting costs, and declining tax 
bases. 
17. But most industrial countries have the means and resources to tackle inner-city decay and 
linked economic decline. Indeed, many have succeeded in reversing these trends through 
enlightened policies, cooperation between the public and private sectors, and significant 
investments in personnel, institutions, and technological innovation./10 Local authorities 
usually have the political power and credibility to take initiatives and to assess and deploy 
resources in innovative ways reflecting unique local conditions. This gives them a capacity to 
manage, control, experiment, and lead urban development. In centrally planned economies, 
the ability to plan and implement plans for urban development has been significant. The 
priority given to collective goods over private consumption may also have increased the 
resources available for urban development. 
18. The physical environment in many cities of the industrial world has improved substantially 
over the decades. According to the historical records of many major centres - like London, 
Paris, Chicago, Moscow, and Melbourne - it was not too long ago that a major part of their
population lived in desperate circumstances amid gross pollution. Conditions have improved 
steadily during the past century, and this trend continues, although the pace varies between 
and within cities. 
Large cities by definition are centralized, manmade environments that depend 
mainly on food, water, energy, and other goods from outside. Smaller cities, by 
contrast, can be the heart of community-based development and provide services 
to the surrounding countryside. 
Given the importance of cities, special efforts, and safeguards are needed to 
ensure that the resources they demand are produced sustainably and that urban 
dwellers participate in decisions affecting their lives. Residential areas are likely to 
be more habitable if they are governed as individual neighbourhoods with direct 
local participation. To the extent that energy and other needs can be met on a local 
basis, both the city and surrounding areas will be better off. 
'Sustainable Development and How to Achieve It' 
Global Tomorrow Coalition 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
19. In most urban areas, almost everyone is served by refuse collection today. Air quality has 
generally improved, with a decline in the emission of particles and sulphur oxides. Efforts to 
restore water quality have met with a mixed record of success because of pollution from 
outside of cities, notably nitrates and other fertilizers and pesticides. Many coastal areas, 
however, close to major sewage outlets, show considerable deterioration. There is rising 
concern about chemical pollutants in drinking water and about the impacts of toxic wastes on 
groundwater quality. And noise pollution has tended to increase. 
20. Motor vehicles greatly influence environmental conditions in the cities of the industrial 
world. A recent slowdown in the growth rate of vehicle numbers, stricter emission standards 
for new vehicles, the distribution of lead-free gasoline, improvements in fuel efficiency, 
improved traffic management policies, and landscaping have all helped reduce the impacts of 
urban traffic. 
21. Public opinion has played a critical role in the drive to improve urban conditions. In some 
cities, public pressure has triggered the abandonment of massive urban development projects, 
fostered residential schemes on a more human scale, countered indiscriminate demolition of 
existing buildings and historic districts, modified proposed urban highway construction, and 
led to transformation of derelict plots into playgrounds. 
22. The problems that remain are serious but they affect relatively limited areas, which makes 
them much more tractable than those of Cairo or Mexico City, for example. Certain aspects of 
urban decline even provide opportunities for environmental enhancement. The exodus of 
population and economic activities, while creating severe economic and social difficulties, 
reduces urban congestion, allows new uses for abandoned buildings, protects historic urban 
districts from the threat of speculative demolition and reconstruction, and contributes to 
urban renewal. The de-industrialization of these cities is often counterbalanced by the growth 
of the services sector, which brings its own problems. But this trend creates opportunities to 
remove heavy industrial pollution sources from residential and commercial areas.
23. The combination of advanced technology, stronger national economies, and a developed 
institutional infrastructure give resilience and the potential for continuing recovery to cities in 
the industrial world. With flexibility, space for manoeuvre, and innovation by local leadership, 
the issue for industrial countries is ultimately one of political and social choice. Developing 
countries are not in the same situation. They have a major urban crisis on their hands. 
II. The Urban Challenge in Developing Countries 
24. Settlements - the urban network of cities, towns, and villages - encompass all aspects of the 
environment within which societies' economic and social interactions take place. 
Internationally, the major cities of the world constitute a network for the allocation of 
investment and for the production and sale of most goods and services. These centres are the 
first to be plugged into this network, through air- and seaports and telecommunications. New 
technologies usually arrive and are first put into practice in large and then smaller cities. Only if 
centres are firmly connected to this network can they hope to attract investment in 
technologies and manufacturing goods for world markets. Nationally, cities are veritable 
incubators of economic activities. Some enterprises are large-scale but the vast majority are 
small, doing everything from selling snack foods to mending shoes and building houses. The 
growth of these activities is the foundation of the domestic economy. 
1. National Urban Strategies 
25. The natural evolution of this network of settlements, however, has caused apprehension in 
most developing countries. Of particular concern has been the phenomenal growth of often one 
or two major cities. In some countries, the desire to limit this growth has led to spatial policies 
designed to accelerate the development of secondary centres. Underlying this has been a 
particular concern that unbalanced growth is increasing interregional disparities and creating 
economic and social imbalances that can have serious consequences in terms of national unity 
and political stability. 
26. Although far from conclusive, the available evidence suggests that most attempts by central 
governments to balance spatial development have been both expensive and ineffective. Major 
macroeconomic, social, and sectoral policies have often been directly opposed to the 
decentralization policy. Investments supported by governments and aid agencies have 
followed the same centralizing logic as private investments, and have built transportation 
facilities, educational and health institutions, and urban infrastructure and services where the 
demand exists - in the major city. Rural-urban migration has followed the same pattern. A 
major reason why so many migrants in recent decades went to cities such as Nairobi, Manila, 
Lagos, Mexico City, Sao Paulo, Rangoon, or Port au Prince was the dominant role each centre 
came to play in its national economy. 
We see that the increasing urban drift is inevitable: There are a lot of 'push' factors 
working in the rural areas. Rural pluralization is caused by absence of land reform, 
by the increase of absentee landownership, by the displacement of the Green 
Revolution. 
Resides the 'push' factors of the rural areas, there are, of course, the 'pull' factors, 
the glamour of the Big city, the higher pay of urban jobs as compared to rural 
income possibilities. So the informal sector of Jakarta has grown; maybe from the 
7 million population of Jakarta, 3 or 4 million - at least two-thirds - are the result of 
the urban drift.
George Adicondro 
Director, Irian Jaya, Rural Community Development Foundation 
WCED Public Hearing 
Jakarta, 26 March 1985 
27. The macroeconomic and pricing policies pursued by governments further reinforced this 
concentration. The major cities, often the capital, usually receive a disproportionately large 
share of the total national expenditure on education and on subsidies to reduce the prices of 
water, corn, electric power, diesel fuel, and public transport. Railroad freight rates sometimes 
favour routes that pass through the capital. Property taxes in the city and surrounding districts 
may be undervalued. New or expanded industries given a boost by the import substitution 
policies are encouraged to establish in or near the capital./11 
28. Agricultural and food policies have also tended to promote rapid growth of larger cities. 
Low or even negative economic supports for agricultural products have driven smallholders off 
their land and added to the numbers of the rural poor. Urban food prices, held low by 
subsidies, have served to attract many of them to cities. In recent years, however, some 
developing countries have found it possible to begin to shift more income from the major cities 
to the rural areas and smaller towns. In some cases, policies to promote small landholdings 
and intensive farming have had this effect. Increasing production, a growth in agricultural 
employment, and higher average incomes have stimulated the development of small and 
intermediate centres in the agricultural regions they serve./12 
29. There are some important lessons to be learned about spatial strategies for urban 
development: 
Nothing much short of coercion will prevent the growth of the major city in the early 
stages of development. 
The key to successful intervention is timing, to encourage deconcentration only when the 
advantages of concentration are diminishing. 
Avoid policy interventions that increase the attractiveness of the major city, particularly 
subsidies on food and energy, overly generous provision of urban infrastructure and 
other services, and excessive concentration of administrative power in the capital. 
The best way to encourage the growth of secondary centres is to build on the natural 
economic advantages of their regions, especially in resource processing and marketing, 
and the decentralized provision of government services. 
Rural and urban development strategies and approaches should be complementary 
rather than contradictory: The development of secondary centres is to the direct 
economic benefit of the resource areas they serve. 
30. The job opportunities and housing provided by cities are essential to absorb the population 
growth that the countryside cannot cope with; as long as price controls and subsidies do not 
interfere, the urban market should offer advantages to rural producers. But there are obviously 
conflicts of interest between developing country city-dwellers and farmers. A major thrust of 
the discussion on food security (see Chapter 5) was to assert the importance of decisively 
turning the 'terms of trade' in favour of farmers, especially small farmers, through pricing and 
exchange rate policies. Many developing countries are not implementing such policies, partly 
for fear of losing the support of politically powerful urban factions. Thus they fail both to stem
urban drift and to improve food security. 
31. These considerations can provide the basis for developing an explicit national settlements 
strategy and policies within which innovative and effective local solutions to urban problems 
can evolve and flourish. Every government has such a strategy in effect, but it is most often 
implicit in a range of macroeconomic, fiscal, budget, energy, and agricultural policies. These 
policies have usually evolved incrementally in response to the pressures of the day and, almost 
invariably, they contradict each other and the stated settlement goals of the government. A 
national urban strategy could provide an explicit set of goals and priorities for the development 
of a nation's urban system and the large, intermediate, and small centres within it. Such a 
strategy must go beyond physical or spatial planning, it requires that governments take a much 
broader view of urban policy than has been traditional. 
32. With an explicit strategy, nations can begin to reorient those central economic and major 
sectoral policies that now reinforce megacity growth, urban decline, and poverty. They can 
likewise promote more effectively the development of small and intermediate urban centres, 
the strengthening of their local governments, and the establishment of services and facilities 
needed to attract development initiatives and investment. Ministries of Planning, Finance, 
Industry, Agriculture, and so on would have clear goals and criteria against which to assess the 
effects of their policies and expenditures on urban development. Contradictory policies and 
programmes could be changed. At the very least, the spatial biases inherent in macroeconomic 
and fiscal policies, annual budgets, pricing structures, and sectoral investment plans could be 
exposed and assessed. Within such a strategy, the traditional tools of urban policy, including 
land use planning and control, would stand a better chance of being effective. 
33. The formulation of such a strategy is clearly a central government responsibility. Beyond 
this, however, the role of central governments should be primarily to strengthen the capacity of 
local governments to find and carry through effective solutions to local urban problems and 
stimulate local opportunities. 
2. Strengthening Local Authorities 
34. The institutional and legal structures of local government in most developing nations are 
inadequate for these purposes. In most African and Asian nations the structure of urban 
government goes hack to the colonial period and was designed to deal with predominantly 
rural and agricultural societies. It was never intended to cope with rapid urbanization or to 
manage cities of several million inhabitants. Newly independent governments inherited a 
framework of laws and procedures totally inappropriate to deal with the urban processes they 
were about to confront. Yet in many nations, this inherited framework remains largely in place. 
35. Where the immediate colonial past is less evident, as in most Latin American nations, the 
political, institutional, and legal frameworks for local government are often just as 
inappropriate and inadequate. As in Asia and Africa, most are based on models imported from 
Europe or North America. This has made it difficult for them to influence the direction of 
urbanization and to manage the problems of large, rapidly expanding urban centres. It has 
created cities that are energy and material-intensive and dependent on imports, and that add 
to the burden on the national economy, including pressures on trade and balance of payments. 
36. Urban development cannot be based on standardized models, imported or indigenous. 
Development possibilities are particular to each city and must be assessed within the context of 
its own region. What works in one city may be totally inappropriate in another. Although 
technical help from central agencies may be needed, only a strong local government can ensure
that the needs, customs, urban forms, social priorities, and environmental conditions of the 
local area are reflected in local plans for urban development. But local authorities have not 
been given the political power, decision making capacity, and access to revenues needed to 
carry out their functions. This leads to frustration, to continuing criticism of local government 
for insufficient and inefficient services, and to a downward spiral of weakness feeding on 
weakness. 
A lot of youth in the Third World countries and even adults are unemployed. We 
want simple technologies whereby one particular person can do a kind of a job that 
could have provided job opportunities to several hundreds. What are we doing with 
the surplus potential energy? So again I say that development is people, it is not 
high technology, it is not modernization, it is not westernization. But it should be 
culturally relevant. 
Jan Selego 
World Vision International 
WCED Public Hearing 
Nairobi, 23 Sept 1986 
37. The lack of political access is a major weakness of local government in many developing 
countries. Most local governments have difficulties getting enough revenue to cover their 
operating expenses, let alone to make new investments to extend services and facilities. Even 
richer city governments have access to the equivalent of only $10-50 per inhabitant to invest 
each year. Despite these weaknesses, the trend in recent decades has been for national 
governments to reduce the financial capacity of local governments in real terms. 
38. The result is growing centralization and continuing weaknesses at both the central and 
local level. Instead of doing a few things well, central authorities end up doing too many things, 
none of them well. Human and financial resources get stretched too thin. Local governments 
do not gain the expertise, authority, and credibility needed to deal with local problems. 
39. To become key agents of development, city governments need enhanced political, 
institutional, and financial capacity, notably access to more of the wealth generated in the city. 
Only in this way can cities adapt and deploy some of the vast array of tools available to address 
urban problems - tools such as land title registration, land use control, and tax sharing. 
3. Self-Reliance and Citizen Involvement 
40. In most developing countries between one-fourth and one-half of the economically active 
urban population cannot find adequate, stable livelihoods. With few jobs available in 
established businesses or government services, people have to find or create their own sources 
of income. These efforts have resulted in the rapid growth of what has been termed the 
'informal sector', which provides much of the cheap goods and services essential to city 
economies, business, and consumers. 
41. Thus, while many poor people may not be officially employed, most are working - in 
unregistered factories end construction firms, selling goods on street corners, making clothes 
in their homes, or as servants or guards in better-off neighbourhoods. Most of the so-called 
unemployed are in fact working 10-15 hours a day, six to seven days a week. Their problem is 
not so much underemployment as underpayment.
42. Most house building, maintenance, or upgrading in the cities of developing countries is 
done outside official plans and usually in illegal settlements. This process mobilizes untapped 
resources, contributes to capital formation, and stimulates employment. These informal sector 
builders represent an important source of urban employment, in particular for low and 
unskilled labour. They are not capital- or technology-intensive, they are not energy-intensive, 
and as a rule they do not impose a drain on foreign exchange. In their way, they contribute 
their share to attaining some of the nation's major development objectives. Moreover, they are 
flexible in responding to local needs and demands, catering in particular to poorer households, 
which usually have nowhere else to turn. Many governments have begun to see the wisdom of 
tolerating rather than quashing their work. Large-scale bulldozing of squatter communities is 
now rarer, although it still happens. 
43. Governments should give more support to the informal sector, recognizing its vital 
functions in urban development. Some governments have done so, facilitating loans and credit 
to small entrepreneurs, building cooperatives, and neighbourhood improvement associations. 
Providing tenure to those living in illegal settlements is basic to this process, as is easing some 
building and housing regulations. 
44. Multilateral and bilateral development assistance agencies should follow suit, and some are 
beginning to do so. Non-governmental and private voluntary organizations are springing up in 
many countries to provide cost-effective channels for assistance, ensuring that it gets to those 
who can use it. A much larger proportion of assistance could be channelled directly through 
these organizations. 
45. The above measures would also reinforce self-reliance and local governance by the poor in 
their own neighbourhood associations. Left to their own devices, the poor in many Third World 
cities have organized to fill gaps in services left by the local government. Among other things, 
community groups mobilize and organize fund-raising or mutual self-help to deal with security, 
environmental, and health problems within the immediate area. 
46. Governments should move from a position of neutrality or antagonism to active support for 
such efforts. A few have actually institutionalized such programmes so that public ministries or 
agencies work continuously with community organizations. In the Indian city of Hyderabad, 
for example, an Urban Community Development Department set up by the municipal 
corporation works directly with community groups and non-government organizations in 
poorer neighbourhoods. By 1983, some 223 organizations had been formed by residents in 
low-income areas, plus 135 youth organizations and 99 women's groups./13 In this way 
governments can become partners and sponsors of the people who are the main builders of 
their cities. 
The shantytowns have found their own technique, their own resources without any 
assistance from anyone else, and they solved their housing problems. The real 
problem is not that. It is the poverty, the lack of planning, the lack of technical 
assistance, the lack of financing to buy construction materials, the lack of urban 
equipment. 
To change this housing policy for human settlements, they should stimulate 
self-construction, instead of financing these large housing complexes. It would 
have been much better and would have cost less to help the people to carry out the 
self-construction.
Generally speaking, it seems clear that without meeting the basic needs of human 
beings, concern for the environment has to be secondary. Man has to survive, 
answer, and attend first to his basic survival needs - food, housing, sanitation - and 
then to the environment. 
Walter Pinto Costa 
President, Environmental and Sanitation Association 
WCED Public Hearing 
Sao Paulo, 28-29 Oct 1985 
4. Housing and Services for the Poor 
47. In most developing-world cities, there is little low-cost housing. Generally those on low 
incomes either rent rooms - whether in tenements or cheap boarding-houses, or in someone 
else's house or shack - or they build or buy a house or shack in an illegal settlement. There are 
many kinds and degrees of illegality, and these influence the extent to which governments 
tolerate the existence of such settlements, or even provide them with public services and 
facilities. 
48. Whatever form it takes, low-income accommodation generally shares three characteristics. 
First, it has inadequate or no infrastructure and services - including piped water, sewers, or 
other means of hygienically disposing of human wastes. Second, people live in crowded and 
cramped conditions under which communicable diseases can flourish, particularly when 
malnutrition lowers resistance. Third, poor people usually build on land ill-suited for human 
habitation: floodplains, dusty deserts, hills subject to landslide, or next to polluting industries. 
They choose these sites because the land's low commercial value means they stand a better 
chance of not being evicted. 
49. Landownership structures and the inability or unwillingness of governments to intervene in 
these structures are perhaps the main factors contributing to 'illegal' settlements and chaotic 
urban sprawl. When half or more of a city's workforce has no chance of obtaining a legal plot on 
which a house can be built, let alone of affording to buy or rent a house legally, the balance 
between private landownership rights and the public good must be quickly rethought. 
50. Given urbanization trends in most developing countries, there is no time to wait for slow 
and uncertain programmes. Government intervention must be reoriented so that limited 
resources are put to maximum effect in improving housing conditions for the poor. The options 
for intervention are many (see Box 9-3), but governments should be guided by these seven 
priorities: 
provide legal tenure to those living in 'illegal' settlements, with secure titles and basic 
services provided by public authorities; 
ensure that the land and other resources people need to build or improve their housing 
are available; 
supply existing and new housing areas with infrastructure and services; 
set up neighbourhood offices to provide advice and technical assistance on how housing 
can be built better and cheaper, and on how health and hygiene can be improved;
plan and guide the city's physical expansion to anticipate and encompass needed land 
for new housing, agricultural land, parks, and children's play areas; 
consider how public intervention could improve conditions for tenants and those living 
in cheap rooming or boarding-houses; and 
change housing finance systems to make cheap loans available to lower-income and 
community groups. 
51. Most cities urgently need a large and continuous increase in the availability of cheap 
housing plots convenient to the main centres of employment. Only government intervention 
can achieve this, but no general prescriptions are possible. Societies differ too much in how 
they view private landownership and land use rights, in how they use different instruments 
such as direct grants, tax write-offs, or deduction of mortgage interest, and in how they treat 
land speculation, corruption, and other undesirable activities that often accompany processes 
of this kind. Although the means are particular to each nation, the end must be the same: 
governments ensuring that there are cheaper, better-serviced, better-located, legal alternatives 
to illegal plots. If this need is not met, the uncontrolled growth of cities - and its accompanying 
high costs - will not be stopped. 
52. Besides land, building materials are another major cost for people putting up their own 
houses. Government support for the production of materials and of certain structural 
components, fixtures, and fittings could reduce housing costs and create many jobs. Small 
neighbourhood workshops often have cost advantages because of the low cost of transport 
from the workshop to the building site. 
Box 9-3 
Three Ways to Use $20 Million to Improve Conditions in a City of 
1 Million 
Option 1: 
Build 2,000 public housing units for poor families (with an average of six family 
members), each costing $10,000. Conditions are improved for 12,000 people, but 
little cost recovery is possible for poor families. If the city's population grows at 5 per 
cent annually, 630.000 new inhabitants will be added over 10 years, so only a tiny 
fraction of total population will have benefited. 
Option 2: 
Establish a 'site-and-service scheme', whereby poor families are responsible for 
building their houses on an allocated site supplied with piped water, connection to a 
sewer system, and electricity, roads, and drainage. At $2,000 per plot, this means 
housing for some 60,000 people - about 10 per cent of the city's population growth 
over 10 years. 
Option 3: 
Allocate $100,000 to a neighbourhood organization representing 1,000 poor 
households (6,000 people) in an existing low-income settlement. It chooses to 
improve drainage and roads, build a health clinic, establish a cooperative to produce
inexpensive building materials and components, and reblock the settlement to 
improve access roads and provide 50 new plots. With $10 million, 100 such 
community initiatives are supported, reaching 600,000 people and providing 5,000 
new housing plots. Many new jobs are stimulated. The remaining $10 million is spent 
on installing piped water; at $100 per household, all 600,000 people reached. 
53. The majority of building codes and standards are ignored because following them would 
produce buildings too expensive for most people. A more effective approach might be to set up 
neighbourhood offices to provide technical advice on how health and safety can be improved at 
minimum cost. Good professional advice can lower building costs and improve quality, and 
might be more effective than prescribing what can or cannot be built. 
54. Many poor people rent accommodation; half or more of a city's entire population may be 
tenants. Increasing the availability of house sites, materials, and credits does little for those 
who must rent. One possibility is financial support to non-governmental, non-profit 
organizations to purchase end develop property specifically for rental units. A second is 
support for tenants to buy out landlords and convert tenancy into cooperative ownership. 
55. Governments, especially those strapped for resources, may claim that piped water supplies 
and sewage disposal systems are too expensive. As a consequence, poor people may have to 
pay water vendors far more per litre of water than middle- or upper-income groups pay public 
agencies to pipe water into their homes. Western water-borne sewage systems and treatment 
plants may be prohibitively expensive. But other techniques and systems cost between 
one-tenth and one-twentieth as much per household, and most of these use much less water. 
Moreover, lower-cost technology can be upgraded over time, as money becomes available./14 
56. Major improvements can be made relatively cheaply in all these areas. But costs will remain 
low only if low-income groups are encouraged to participate fully in defining what they need, in 
deciding what they will contribute to the new services, and in doing the job with their own 
hands. This cooperation depends on establishing the new relationship between citizens and 
government called for earlier. 
5. Tapping More Resources 
57. The available resources in or close to cities are often underused. Many landowners leave 
well-located sites undeveloped in order to benefit later from their increasing value as the city 
grows. Many public agencies have land that could be put to better use, such as the area next to 
stations and harbours controlled by railway and port authorities. Several countries have 
introduced special programmes to encourage public and private cooperation in the 
development of such lands, a trend that should be encouraged. There is a general need to find 
innovative and effective ways of pooling land for the common good. Most cities have 
mechanisms for acquiring land either at market rates (which means that schemes are never 
implemented), or at arbitrarily low confiscatory rates (where the alliance of political forces and 
landlords blocks the acquisition anyway). 
58. Governments should also consider supporting urban agriculture. This may have less 
relevance in cities where land markets are highly commercialized and land for housing is in 
short supply. But in most cities, especially those with less commercialized land markets, 
considerable potential exists. Many African cities already realize this. Urban agriculture, 
especially on city fringes, is undertaken by people as a way to feed themselves, in other
instances, the process is more commercialized, with enterprises specializing in vegetable 
production for sale within the city. 
59. Officially sanctioned and promoted urban agriculture could become an important 
component of urban development and make more food available to the urban poor. The 
primary purposes of such promotion should be to improve the nutritional and health 
standards of the poor, help their family budgets (50-70 per cent of which is usually spent on 
food), enable them to earn some additional income, and provide employment. Urban 
agriculture can also provide fresher and cheaper produce, more green space, the clearing of 
garbage dumps, and recycling of household waste./15 
I'm an expert in slum dwelling. We're establishing a small, tiny organization trying to 
organize slum dwellers, because we see so many slums. Slums in the city, slums in 
the villages, slums in the forests. 
I have worked for four years to motivate my fellow slum dwellers to become 
transmigrants, and they finally migrated to ten places all over Indonesia. They are 
still in very good communication with me. They're still sending me letters, and they 
say that life is not better in the transmigration areas. Living in the shadows in the 
urban slums or living in the shadows in the transmigration site is just the same. 
When I go back to my people, the slum dwellers, tonight they will ask me what I 
have got from this meeting in the big hotel. They won't ask for information, just 
'Have you brought some money for us to build new houses?' 
Syamsuddin Nainggolan 
Founder, Yayasan Panca Bakti 
WCED Public Hearing 
Jakarta, 26 March 1986 
60. Another poorly used resource is solid wastes, the disposal of which has become a major 
problem in many cities, with much of it dumped and uncollected. Promoting the reclamation, 
reuse, or recycling of materials can reduce the problem of solid waste, stimulate employment, 
and result in savings of raw materials. Composting can support urban agriculture. If a 
municipal government lacks the resources to collect household wastes regularly, it can support 
existing community-based schemes. In many cities, literally thousands of people already make 
a living sorting through wastes by hand on municipal tips. Investing in a more capital-intensive, 
automatic recycling plant could be doubly counterproductive if it unnecessarily 
consumes scarce capital or if a plant would destroy many people's livelihoods. But an 
immediate need here is to give health advice and provide health care services to those who are 
making a living off municipal tips./16 
III. International Cooperation 
61. The future will be predominantly urban, and the most immediate environmental concerns 
of most people will be urban ones. The effectiveness of efforts to improve urban life depends 
largely on the health of national economies. In many developing countries, this is linked closely 
to the state of the world economy. An improvement in international economic relations (see 
Chapter 3) would perhaps do more than anything else to enhance the capacity of developing 
countries to address their linked urban and environmental problems. But beyond that is the 
need to strengthen cooperation among developing countries and to increase various types of
direct support from the international community. 
1. Cooperation Among Developing Countries 
62. Developing countries can do a great deal together to develop the policy concepts, 
programmes, and institutions needed to tackle the urban crisis they share. Although the 
management problems confronting Caracas, Dakar, or Delhi have little relevance to those 
confronting London or Paris, the cities of Latin America, West Africa, or South Asia have much 
in common. As they formulate broad national urban strategies, it is important that they share 
experiences on the management of their growing megacities, on the development of small and 
intermediate centres, on strengthening local government, on upgrading illegal settlements, on 
crisis-response measures, and on a range of other problems that are more or less unique to the 
Third World. 
63. Further research could provide the basis for rethinking the Third World city. It could also 
feed in-country training programmes (or, for smaller nations, regional training programmes) 
for city and municipal government staff. Good policy proposals and good training courses 
depend on good local information and analysis; far too little of all three of these is found within 
developing countries and cities. 
2. International Support 
64. A greater flow of international resources is required to support the efforts of developing 
countries to tackle the unfolding urban crisis. An agreed definition of 'urban development 
assistance' does not exist, but the Development Assistance Committee recently estimated that 
total bilateral and multilateral aid for urban programmes averaged about $900 million per year 
over 1980-84./17 It is also estimated that to date fewer than 5 per cent of the developing world's 
urban population has been reached by a housing or neighbourhood upgrading project 
sponsored by a development assistance agency. This level of support needs to be increased 
significantly. Moreover, the scope of support should be broadened and its quality and terms 
improved. 
65. In addition, development assistance agencies should increase aid and technical assistance 
in three areas: 
to set up infrastructure funds for local governments; 
to undertake tasks such as reorganizing local tax assessments and collection, preparing 
or updating maps of property ownership, and setting up technical teams to advise 
households and community groups on improving housing; 
for in-country training courses and on-the job training for local officials. 
66. Part of the increased aid should go directly to community groups, using intermediaries 
such as national or international NGOs. Several bilateral aid programmes have already 
demonstrated the cost-effectiveness of this approach; various NGOs have been responsible for 
many successful community based schemes to improve housing and provide basic services. 
They are generally more successful at reaching the poorest. More aid should also go to 
supporting independent research groups working in housing and urban issues, particularly 
those providing advice to local governments and community groups; many are doing so 
already, especially in Latin America.
Box 9-4 
Misunderstanding Women's Needs in Housing Projects 
Housing projects often use a gridiron layout that does not allow women to work in 
their house and at the same time keep an eye on their own or their neighbours' 
children. House designs and plot sizes rarely consider the fact that many women will 
want to use their houses as workshops (to make clothes, for instance) or as shops, 
which in fact are often forbidden in low-income housing projects. Application 
procedure for low-income housing sometimes requires 'husbands' to apply; this 
excludes women-headed households - between 30 and 50 per cent of all households. 
Women's special needs in different cultures are ignored - in Islamic societies, for 
example, women's need for private open space within the house is rarely considered 
in house designs, while their need for relatively sheltered pathways to get to shops 
and clinics is not acknowledged in site layouts. 
Source: Based on C.O.N. Moser, 'Housing Policy: Towards a Gender Awareness 
Approach', Working Paper #71, Development Planning Unit, London, 1985. 
67. International cooperation can also contribute to developing low cost technologies for urban 
needs and studying ways of meeting the housing needs of women. (See Box 9-4.) 
68. Many technical agencies within the UN system have the appropriate knowledge bases to 
play a valuable role in advising and supporting governments, notably the UN Centre for 
Human Settlements (UNCHS, or Habitat). They should identify the information and guidelines 
that city governments need and the form in which it can be made accessible and usable by 
them. This could be patterned, for example, upon the ongoing efforts to prepare guidebooks 
for community workers on identifying disease vectors and mobilizing communities to deal with 
them, and on interventions to promote child survival and health. More generally. Habitat can 
strengthen international cooperation at the global level, as in the UN International Year of 
Shelter for the Homeless. The capacity of the UN system to provide leadership on human 
settlements issues through Habitat needs to be strengthened. 
Footnotes 
1/ This chapter draws heavily on four background papers prepared for WCED: I. Burton, 
'Urbanization and Development', 1985; J.E. Hardoy and D. Satterthwaite, 'Shelter, 
Infrastructure and Services in Third World Cities', 1985 (printed in Habitat International, 
Vol. 10, No. 4, 1986); J.E. Hardoy and D. Satterthwaite, 'Rethinking the Third World City, 1986; 
and I. Sachs, 'Human Settlements: Resource and Environmental Management', 1985. 
2/ See J. Jacobs, Cities and the Wealth of Nations (New York: Random House, 1984). 
3/ UN, The Growth in the World's Urban and Rural Population 1920-1980, 
Population Studies No. 44 (New York: 1969); UN, Urban, Rural and City Populations 
1950-2000 (as assessed in 1978), Population Studies No. 68 (New York: 1980). 
4/ The expansion of 'city' or 'metropolitan area' boundaries accounts for some of the
population growth in Table 9 2. The UN projections are based on extrapolating past trends. 
This method often provides a poor guide to future trends, especially long-term ones. But the 
data base with which to make better projections ie not available. 
5/ UNCHS (Habitat) position paper for October 1986 DAC meeting on Urban Development, 
OECD document DAC (86)47, 27 August 1986. 
6/ Department of International Economic and Social Affaire, 'Urban and Rural Population 
Projections, 1984' (unofficial assessment), UN, New York, 1986. 
7/ J.E. Hardoy and D. Satterthwaite, Shelter: Need and Response; Housing, Land and 
Settlement Policies in Seventeen Third World Nations (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & 
Sons, 1981). For the situation in Sao Paulo, See Jorge Wilhelm, 'Sao Paulo: Environmental 
Problems of the Growing Metropolis', submitted to WCED Public Hearings, Sao Paulo, 1985. 
8/ J.E. Hardoy and D. Satterthwaite, 'Third World Cities and the Environment of Poverty', 
Geoforum, Vol. 15, No. 3, 1984. See also World Social Prospects Association, The Urban 
Tragedy (Geneva: UNITAR, 1986). 
9/ See Osvaldo Sunkel, 'Debt, Development and Environment', submitted to WCED Public 
Hearings, Sao Paulo, 1985; Ricardo Jordan S., 'Population and the Planning of Large Cities in 
Latin America', paper submitted to the International Conference on Population and the Urban 
Future, Barcelona, Spain, 19-22 May 1986. 
10/ G. Scimemi, 'Cita e Ambiente', DAEST, Instituto Universtario di Architectura, Venezia, 
1987. See also, The State of the Environment in OECD Member Countries (Paris: 
OECD, 1979 and 1985). 
11/ I. Scott, Urban and Spatial Development in Mexico (London: Johns Hopkins 
University Press, 1982). 
12/ See Chapter 8 in J.E. Hardoy and D. Satterthwaite (eds.), Small and Intermediate Urban 
Centres; Their role in Regional and National Development in the Third World 
(London: Hodder and Stoughton, 1986). 
13/ UNCHS, 'Habitat Hyderabad Squatter Settlement Upgrading Project, India', project 
monograph produced for the International Year of Shelter for the Homeless, Nairobi, 1986 
14/ J. M. Kalbermatten et al., Appropriate Technology for Water Supply and 
Sanitation; a Summary of Technical and Economic Options (Washington DC: World 
Bank, 1980). 
15/ D. Silk, 'Urban Agriculture', prepared for WCED, 1986. 
16/ N. Khouri-Dagher, 'Waste Recycling: Towards Greater urban Self-Reliance', prepared for 
WCED, 1985. 
17/ See draft annotated agenda for October 1986, DAC Meeting on Urban Development. OECD 
document DAC (86)15. The World Bank definition of urban development assistance was used, 
which includes fostering urban efficiency and alleviating poverty, shelter, urban transport, 
integrated urban development, and regional development on secondary cities.
Our Common Future, Chapter 10: Managing The Commons 
Oceans: I. The Balance of Life 
1. The Balance Under Threat 
2. Oceans Management 
II. Space: A Key to Planetary Management 
1. Remote Sensing from Space 
2. The Geosynchronous Orbit 
3. The Pollution of Orbital Space 
4. Nuclear Power in Orbit 
5. Towards a Space Regime 
III. Antarctica: Towards Global Cooperation 
1. Guard Present Achievements 
2. Anticipate Pressures for Mineral Development 
3. Promote Evolution of Antarctic Treaty System 
4. Establish a Means for More Effective Communication 
1. The traditional forms of national sovereignty are increasingly challenged by the realities of 
ecological and economic interdependence. Nowhere is this more true than in shared 
ecosystems and in 'the global commons' - those parts of the planet that fall outside national 
jurisdictions. Here, sustainable development can be secured only through international 
cooperation and agreed regimes for surveillance, development, and management in the 
common interest. But at stake is not just the sustainable development of shared ecosystems 
and the commons, but of all nations whose development depends to a greater or lesser extent 
on their rational management. 
2. By the same token, without agreed, equitable, and enforceable rules governing the rights and 
duties of states in respect of the global commons, the pressure of demands on finite resources 
will destroy their ecological integrity over time. Future generations will be impoverished, and 
the people who suffer most will be those who live in poor countries that can least assert their 
own claims in a free-for-all.
3. Management of the various commons - the oceans, outer space, and Antarctica - is at 
different stages of evolution, as is the very 'commonality' of these areas. In the Law of the Sea, 
the international community has developed one of the most ambitious and advanced of 
international conventions ever for the seas and the sea-bed. But a few countries have so far 
declined to adhere to the multilateral regime that had been the subject of protracted global 
negotiations, and this is blocking implementation of certain key aspects. Boundaries have been 
drawn on the oceans to separate the common seas from national Exclusive Economic Zones 
(EEZs), but as the common and claimed waters form interlocked ecological and economic 
systems, and as the health of one depends on the health of the other, both are discussed in this 
chapter. As for outer space, the least tapped global commons, discussion of joint management 
has only just begun. Antarctica has been covered for over a quarter of a century by a binding 
Treaty. Many states that are not party to it feel they should by right have a stake in the 
management of what they see as a part of the global commons. 
I. Oceans: The Balance of Life 
4. In the Earth's wheel of life, the oceans provide the balance./1 Covering over 70 per cent of the 
planet's surface, they play a critical role in maintaining its life-support systems, in moderating 
its climate, and in sustaining animals and plants, including minute, oxygen-producing 
phytoplankton. They provide protein, transportation, energy, employment, recreation, and 
other economic, social, and cultural activities. 
5. The oceans also provide the ultimate sink for the by-products of human activities. Huge, 
closed septic tanks, they receive wastes from cities, farms, and industries via sewage outfalls, 
dumping from barges and ships, coastal run-off, river discharge, and even atmospheric 
transport. In the last few decades, the growth of the world economy, the burgeoning demand 
for food and fuel, and accumulating discharges of wastes have begun to press against the 
bountiful limits of the oceans. 
6. The oceans are marked by a fundamental unity from which there is no escape, 
interconnected cycles of energy, climate, marine living resources, and human activities move 
through coastal waters, regional seas, and the closed oceans. The effects of urban, industrial, 
and agricultural growth are contained within no nation's Exclusive Economic Zone; they pass 
through currents of water and air from nation to nation, and through complex food chains from 
species to species, distributing the burdens of development, if not the benefits, to both rich and 
poor. 
7. Only the high seas outside of national jurisdiction are truly 'commons'; but fish species, 
pollution, and other effects of economic development do not respect these legal boundaries. 
Sound management of the ocean commons will require management of land-based activities as 
well. Five zones bear on this management: inland areas, which affect the oceans mostly via 
rivers; coastal lands - swamps, marshes, and so on - close to the sea, where human activities 
can directly affect the adjacent waters; coastal waters - estuaries, lagoons, and shallow waters 
generally - where the effects of land-based activities are dominant; offshore waters, out roughly 
to the edge of the continental shelf; and the high seas, largely beyond the 200-mile EEZs of 
coastal states' control. 
8. Major fisheries are found mostly in offshore waters, while pollution affecting them comes 
mostly from inland sources and is concentrated in coastal waters. Formal international 
management is essential in the areas beyond the EEZs, although greater international 
cooperation, including improved frameworks to coordinate national action, is needed for all 
areas.
1. The Balance Under Threat 
9. Today, the living resources of the sea are under threat from overexploitation, pollution, and 
land-based development. Most major familiar fish stocks throughout the waters over the 
continental shelves, which provide 95 per cent of the world's fish catch, are now threatened by 
overfishing. 
10. Other threats are more concentrated. The effects of pollution and land development are 
most severe in coastal waters and semi-enclosed seas along the world's shore-lines. The use of 
coastal areas for settlement, industry, energy facilities, and recreation will accelerate, as will 
the upstream manipulation of estuarine river systems through dams or diversion for 
agriculture and municipal water supplies. These pressures have destroyed estuarine habitats 
as irrevocably as direct dredging, filling, or paving. Shore-lines and their resources will suffer 
ever increasing damage if current, business-as-usual approaches to policy, management, and 
institutions continue. 
The world's environmental problems are greater than the sum of those in each 
country. Certainly, they can no longer be dealt with purely on a nation-state basis. 
The World Commission on Environment and Development must strike at this 
fundamental problem by recommending specific ways for countries to cooperate 
to surmount sovereignty, to embrace international instruments in order to deal with 
global threats. The growing trend towards isolationism demonstrates that the 
current rhythm of history is out of harmony with human aspirations, even with its 
chances for survival. 
The challenge ahead is for us to transcend the self-interests of our respective 
nation-states so as to embrace a broader self-interest -- the survival of the human 
species in a threatened world. 
Hon. Tom McMillan 
Minister of Environment, Government of Canada 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
11. Certain coastal and offshore waters are especially vulnerable to ecologically insensitive 
onshore development, to competitive overfishing, and to pollution. The trends are of special 
concern in coastal areas where pollution by domestic sewage, industrial wastes, and pesticide 
and fertilizer run-off may threaten not only human health but also the development of 
fisheries. 
12. Even the high seas are beginning to show some signs of stress from the billions of tons of 
contaminants added each year. Sediments brought to the oceans by great rivers such as the 
Amazon can be traced for as much as 2,000 kilometres out to sea./2 Heavy metals from 
coal-burning plants and some industrial processes also reach the oceans via the atmosphere. 
The amount of oil spilled annually from tankers now approaches 1.5 million tons./3 The marine 
environment, exposed to nuclear radiation from past nuclear weapons tests, is receiving more 
exposure from the continuing disposal of low-level radioactive wastes. 
13. New evidence of a possible rapid depletion of the ozone layer and a consequent increase in 
ultraviolet radiation poses a threat not only to human health but to ocean life. Some scientists
believe that this radiation could kill sensitive phytoplankton and fish larvae floating near the 
ocean's surface, damaging ocean food chains and possibly disrupting planetary support 
systems./4 
14. High concentrations of substances such as heavy metals, organochlorines, and petroleum 
have been found on the oceans' surface. With continued accumulation, these could have 
complex and long lasting effects./5 The sea-floor is a region of complex physical, chemical, and 
biological activity where microbial processes play a major role, but as yet serious damage is 
known to have occurred only in very localized regions. Although these findings are 
encouraging, given accelerating pressures and the inadequacy of present data, they provide no 
grounds for complacency. 
2. Oceans Management 
15. Looking to the next century, the Commission is convinced that sustainable development, if 
not survival itself, depends on significant advances in the management of the oceans. 
Considerable changes will be required in our institutions and policies and more resources will 
have to be committed to oceans management. 
16. Three imperatives lie at the heart of the oceans management question: 
The underlying unity of the oceans requires effective global management regimes. 
The shared resource characteristics of many regional seas make forms of regional 
management mandatory. 
The major land-based threats to the oceans require effective national actions based on 
international cooperation. 
17. Mutual dependence has increased in recent years. The Law of the Sea Convention, with the 
establishment of the 200-mile EEZs, has put an additional 35 per cent of the oceans surface 
under national control with regard to management of natural resources. It has also provided an 
institutional setting that could lead to better management of these areas, given that single 
governments may be expected to manage more rationally resources over which they have sole 
control. However, this expectation ignores the realities of short sighted political and economic 
goals. 
18. An international ecosystem approach is required for the management of these resources for 
sustained use. Significant gains have been made in past decades, nationally and internationally, 
and many essential components have been put in place. But they do not add up to a system 
that reflects the imperatives mentioned above. Where the EEZs of several states come together 
in semi-enclosed or regional seas, integrated management requires varying degrees of 
international cooperation, such as joint monitoring and research on migratory species and 
measures to combat pollution and regulate actions whose effects reach across boundaries. 
19. When it comes to the high seas beyond national jurisdiction, international action is 
essential. The sum of the multiple conventions and programmes now in place do not and 
cannot represent such a regime. Even the separate UN programmes cannot easily be 
coordinated, given the structure of the United Nations./6 
20. The Commission believes that a number of actions are urgently needed to improve regimes 
for oceans management. Thus the Commission proposes measures to:
strengthen capacity for national action, especially in developing countries; 
improve fisheries management; 
reinforce cooperation in semi-enclosed and regional seas; 
strengthen control of ocean disposal of hazardous and nuclear wastes; and 
advance the Law of the Sea. 
2.1 National Action 
21. Coastal governments should launch an urgent review of the legal and institutional 
requirements for integrated management of their EEZs, and of their roles in arrangements for 
international cooperation. This review should be undertaken within the framework of a clear 
statement of national goals and priorities. Reducing overexploitation of fisheries in coastal and 
offshore waters might be one such goal. The rapid clean-up of municipal and industrial 
pollution discharging into critical marine habitats could be another. Others might include 
strengthening national research and management capacity, and producing an inventory of 
coastal and marine resources. 
22. Given the increased pressures on coastal and marine resources projected through the year 
2000, all coastal states should have a complete inventory of these assets. Drawing on senior 
experts from national and international agencies, nations could deploy the latest satellite 
mapping and other techniques to put together an inventory of these resources and then 
monitor changes in them. 
23. Many developing countries will require assistance to strengthen their legal and institutional 
frameworks needed for integrated management of coastal resources. Many small island and 
maritime developing countries lack the economic or military means to prevent the exploitation 
of their coastal resources or the pollution of their waters by powerful countries or companies. 
This has become a major concern in the Pacific in particular, and threatens the political 
stability of the region. International development banks and development assistance agencies 
should establish programmes to support the development of this Institutional capacity. 
2.2 Fisheries Management 
24. World fisheries have been expanding since the Second World War, with the global catch 
rising at a steady 6-7 per cent annually from 20 million to 65 million tons between 1950 and 
1969. But after 1970, as more and more stocks were depleted, the average annual growth in 
catches fell to only about 1 per cent. (See Table 10-1.) With conventional management practices, 
the growth era in fisheries is over. Even assuming restored productivity in now depleted 
stocks, and an increased harvest from underutilized fisheries, FAO sees only a gradual increase 
in catches, perhaps rising from current levels of over 80 million tons to about 100 million. This 
does not augur well for future food security, especially in low-income countries where fish are a 
principal source of animal protein and where millions secure their livelihoods from fisheries 
activities./7 
25. Overexploitation threatens many stocks as economic resources. Several of the world's 
largest fisheries - the Peruvian anchoveta, several North Atlantic herring stocks, and the
Californian sardine - have collapsed following periods of heavy fishing. In some of the areas 
affected by these collapses, and in other rich fisheries such as the Gulf of Thailand and off West 
Africa, heavy fishing has been followed by marked changes in species composition./8 The 
reasons for these changes are not well understood, and more research is needed into the 
responses of marine resources to exploitation so that managers can receive better scientific 
advice. Greater support for such work is urgently needed, and this support must include 
additional assistance to developing countries in increasing their research capacity and their 
knowledge of their own resources. 
26. One factor leading to the establishment of extended EEZs was the concern of coastal states, 
both industrialized and developing, over the depletion of fisheries off their coasts. A large 
number of conventions had been established covering most major fisheries, but they proved 
inadequate in most cases. Participating countries were in general unable to overcome the 
difficulties of allocating shares to limited common resources. Improved management was seen 
as an urgent need, and open access was perceived as the main obstacle to it. 
27. The advent of extended EEZs under the Law of the Sea Convention was expected to solve or 
at least alleviate the problem. Coastal states were required to introduce effective conservation 
and management of the living resources in their EEZs. They could also control the activities of 
foreign fishermen and develop their own fisheries. 
28. Industrial countries have been much more successful in doing this than developing 
countries. In the north-west Atlantic, the annual catch by long-range fleets has declined from 
over 2 million tons before 1974 to around a quarter of a million tons in 1983, and the share of 
the catch taken by the United States and Canada has risen from under 50 per cent to over 90 
per cent. 
Table 10-1 
World Fish Catch in Major Fisheries, 1979-84 
1979 1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 
Region (thousand tons) 
North Atlantic 14,667 14,676 14,489 13,597 13,891 13,940 
North Pacific 20,303 20,733 21,908 22,603 23,666 26,416 
Central Atlantic 6,064 6,867 6,833 7,239 7,210 1,164 
Central Pacific 7,536 7,910 6,478 8,175 7,648 8,531 
Indian Ocean 3,541 3,693 3,728 3,852 4,061 4,362 
South Atlantic 4,420 3,895 4,037 4,340 4,314 3,957 
South Pacific 7,242 6,619 7,240 8,328 6,724 8,684 
Inland 7,240 7,603 8,138 8,455 9,131 9,716 
Total* 71,014 71,996 74,850 76,590 76,846 82,770
Developed 37,143 38,234 38,890 39,265 37,991 42,412 
Developing 33,871 33,758 35,961 37,326 36,655 40,358 
Developing countries 
catch as per cent of 
world total 
47.7 46.9 48.0 48.7 48.0 46.6 
* Columns do not add to totals due to rounding. 
Source: Based on data in FAO, Yearbooks of Fishery Statistics (Rome: 1979-84). 
29. Yet long-range industrial fishing fleets still catch about 5 million tons annually in 
developing regions. Off West Africa, for example, over half the total catch is still taken by such 
fleets./9 This is due partly to the fact that many of the biggest resources lie off thinly populated 
areas - the western edge of the Sahara and off Namibia. But it is also due to the common lack of 
locally available capital, and to a shortage of local expertise in many technical aspects of 
fisheries, especially processing and marketing. 
30. Coastal developing countries can usually obtain some modest revenue in the form of 
licence fees, but this represents only a fraction of what they could earn from a full national use 
of the resource. Another 10-15 million tons of so far underutilized or unexploited resources 
could be added to the existing fisheries off their coasts./10 There is a pressing need for these 
resources to be managed sustainably, for the benefit of developing countries and in ways that 
help to meet global nutritional needs. 
The opinion of the public is what you see here in this room. You see important 
leaders from all over Brazil, from all over the country that have come here, from 
the rubberman that was under a palmtree yesterday and was here speaking to the 
U.N. Commission and leaders that are independent. The Brazilian population 
yearned to have someone to speak to. Someone who will listen, who will not sort 
of mystify things, and someone who will not trick them. So there is an enormous 
expectation with regards to the seriousness of your Commission. 
Randau Marques 
Journalist 
WCED Public Hearing 
Sao Paulo, 28-29 Oct 1985 
31. Whaling offers another example. Recognizing that the history of whaling up to the 1960s 
was that of overexploitation, the International Whaling Commission (IWC), the main 
international body regulating whaling, has taken a series of conservation measures since the 
early 1970s and now all stocks that are below a certain level have been classified as protected 
from commercial whaling. 
32. In its early days, the IWC was dominated by whaling nations. After 1979, non-whaling 
nations became an increasingly significant majority of the membership. This change was 
reflected in the IWC's decisions, which increasingly opted in cases of scientific doubt for a 
cautious approach and the reduction of catch levels or the cessation of whaling altogether on 
certain stocks.
33. This trend culminated in the moratorium decision of 1982. Members have the right to 
object and continue commercial whaling or to catch whales for scientific purposes. There is a 
strongly held view in conservation circles that whaling for scientific purposes can be used as a 
loophole by whaling nations. Permissions for such hunting should be stringently applied by 
IWC members, or the IWC's credibility will be undermined. 
34. An important political factor in recent developments hat been the ability of the U.S. 
Government to invoke legislation that enables contracts for fishing in U.S. waters to be 
withheld from nations that undermine marine conservation agreements. The value of such 
fishery concessions is large and the legislation has significant political and economic leverage. 
Another important factor has been the strength of the NGOs in organizing support for 
anti-whaling actions, lobbying governments and organizing boycotts of fish and other products 
from whaling nations. 
35. By early 1987, whaling was restricted to scientific catches by Iceland and the Republic of 
Korea and to a small catch by Norway, which continued to object to the moratorium, but which 
planned to halt its commercial whaling following the 1967 season. And there were catches by 
Japan and the Soviet Union. The Soviet Union had indicated it would observe the moratorium 
after the 1987 Antarctic season, and Japan had withdrawn its objection to the moratorium with 
effect from 1988. However, Japan may continue whaling for scientific purposes./11 In addition, 
some whaling was being performed by native peoples in the Soviet Union and Alaska. 
36. If the moratorium is observed and whaling for scientific purposes is not abused, 
commercial whaling will no longer be a major threat to the conservation of whale stocks taken 
as a whole. The annual rate of increase of these stocks, however, is unlikely to exceed a few per 
cent. Thus substantial whale populations will probably not be observed much before the 
second half of the next century. 
2.3 Cooperation on Regional Seas 
37. A large number of agreements have been entered into on regional seas. The Commission 
has not attempted to evaluate them all, but given the Commission's origin in the UNEP 
Governing Council and the General Assembly resolution, it has given special attention to 
UNEP's Regional Seas Programme. This programme now brings together over 130 states 
bordering 11 different shared seas around the world, states that have an interest in cooperating 
for their own and mutual benefit. 
38. UNEP provides the initial impetus by bringing governments together to develop a flexible 
legal framework within which further agreements can be negotiated as needs require and 
politics allow. UNEP also provides some initial seed money for programme development, but 
the governments of the region themselves are meant to take over funding and management, 
drawing on the technical advice of UN and other agencies. The result is a gradually evolving 
action-oriented programme rooted in the needs of the regions as perceived by the governments 
concerned. Fourteen UN agencies and over 40 international and regional organizations 
participate in the worldwide programme. 
39. The political strategy behind the programme' and the requirement that management and 
financing be undertaken by the participating countries have clearly been crucial to its success. 
But it is one thing to contribute a few million dollars for research, and quite another to 
incorporate the resulting findings into land-based development plans and to enforce strong 
pollution control programmes. The massive U.S.-Canadian clean up of the Great Lakes over the
past 15 years cost $8.85 billion for partial treatment of municipal and industrial wastes./12 
Huge investments will also be required to roll back land-based pollution along UNEP's regional 
seas. Yet nowhere have the sums been committed under agreed schedules to construct the 
necessary urban and industrial pollution control systems and to underwrite policies to control 
agricultural run-off. The programme now has to confront the regional seas challenge through 
the year 2000 - moving beyond general agreement on goals and research to a solid schedule of 
investment on a scale that will make a difference. 
2.4 Measures to Control Ocean Disposal of Waste 
40. The Convention on the Prevention of Marine Pollution by Dumping of Wastes and Other 
Matter (London Dumping Convention), which has world-wide application, was concluded in 
November 1972 and entered into force on 30 August 1975./13 Its political evolution parallels 
that of the International Whaling Commission. Initially, it consisted largely of dumping states, 
but non-dumping states are now in the majority. At present it has 61 contracting parties, and 
secretariat facilities are provided by the International Maritime Organization. The dumping of 
wastes is regulated by the three annexes to the Convention:/14 on extremely dangerous 
substances including high-level radioactive wastes, the dumping of which is prohibited, (Annex 
I); on somewhat less noxious substances, the dumping or which can be permitted only by 'prior 
special permit' (Annex II); and all other substances, which can be dumped only after a general 
permit has been obtained from national authorities (Annex III). Although the Convention 
applies to all wastes dumped deliberately at sea, the ocean disposal of radioactive wastes has 
attracted the most attention. It is this question that the Commission considers here. 
41. Prior to 1963, the United Kingdom, Switzerland, Belgium, and the Netherlands had been 
dumping low-level wastes regularly at the north-east Atlantic dumpsite in international waters 
off the coast of Spain. Despite protests from representatives of these nations at the London 
Dumping Convention meeting that they would ignore a moratorium resolution on low-level 
wastes and carry out dumping during 1983, a de facto moratorium - which all countries honour 
but to which some have not formally agreed - went into and remains in effect. Under it, no 
disposal should take place until it can be demonstrated that it is environmentally safe. 
42. In 1985, the London Dumping Convention voted to extend indefinitely the moratorium on 
the ocean dumping of low-level radioactive wastes./15 As a result, the burden of proof that such 
activities are safe was effectively reversed, being put on those nations who want to dump. This 
revolutionary reversal, though not binding, reflects the changed composition of the London 
Dumping Convention. 
43. In 1986, the London Dumping Convention established an intergovernmental panel of 
experts to examine the issue of comparative risks of land- and sea-based options for disposal of 
radioactive waste. Without prejudging this assessment, the Commission would urge all states 
to continue to refrain from disposing of either low or high- level wastes at sea or in the sea-bed. 
Moreover, it would seem prudent to anticipate continuing opposition to sea dumping and to 
actively pursue the siting and development of environmentally safe, land based methods of 
disposal. 
Why must we gamble with the lives of innocent children in order to generate 
plutonium for bombs? Even to contemplate dumping radioactive waste in waters 
that belong to all of us as part of our global heritage is an outrage. For us to make 
such important decisions on behalf of future generations without taking into
account the morality of using international waters as an exclusive rubbish bin is an 
arrogant act. 
Peter Wilkinson 
Greenpeace 
WCED Public Hearing 
Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 
44. Several other conventions regulate the dumping of wastes in the north-east Atlantic and 
North Sea, the Mediterranean Sea, and the Baltic Sea. Most of the Regional Seas Conventions 
also include a general provision calling on contracting parties to take all appropriate measures 
to prevent and reduce pollution caused by dumping. 
45. Land-based sources of nuclear waste have become significant in the North Sea, where high 
levels of radioactivity have been found in fish, and could threaten other seas./16 The 
Convention for the Prevention of Marine Pollution from Land Based Sources (Paris 
Convention) was ratified in 1978 by eight states and the European Economic Community. 
While it has achieved some international cooperation, its silence on nuclear plants and its 
acceptance of the 'best available technology' principle in determining permitted levels of 
radioactive discharges clearly needs to be reviewed. 
46. The Law of the Sea Convention requires states to establish national laws and regulations to 
'prevent, reduce and control pollution of the marine environment from dumping'. It also 
requires express prior approval by the coastal state for dumping in the territorial sea, in the 
EEZs, and onto the continental shelf. The legislative history of this Article indicates that coastal 
states have not only the right to act but a duty to do so. States also have an obligation under the 
Law of the Sea to ensure that their activities do not injure the health and environment of 
neighbouring states and the commons. 
47. The Commission encourages the London Dumping Convention to reaffirm the rights and 
responsibilities of states to control and regulate dumping within the 200-mile EEZ. It is urgent 
that they do so, as oceans and food chains respect no boundaries. 
48. Moreover, all states should undertake to report releases of toxic and radioactive substances 
from land-based sources into any body of water to the appropriate Convention Secretariat so 
that they may begin to report on the aggregate releases into various seas. Competent 
authorities must be designated to keep records of the nature and quantities of wastes dumped. 
Beyond that, regional institutions should forward this information to the London Dumping 
Convention Secretariat. 
2.5 The Law of the Sea 
49. The United Nations Conference on the Law of the Sea was the most ambitious attempt ever 
to provide an internationally agreed regime for the management of the oceans. The resulting 
Convention represents a major step towards an integrated management regime for the oceans. 
It has already encouraged national and international action to manage the oceans./17 
50. The Convention reconciled widely divergent interests of states, and established the basis 
for a new equity in the use of the oceans and their resources. It confirmed that coastal states 
are empowered to exercise sovereignty over their territorial sea, sea- bed and subsoil, and the 
superjacent air space, up to a distance of 12 nautical miles. It redefined the rights of coastal
states concerning the continental shelf. It established Exclusive Economic Zones of up to 200 
nautical miles within which the coastal state may exercise sovereign rights with regard to the 
management of national resources, living and non-living, in the waters, sea bed, and subsoil. 
51. The Convention removed 35 per cent of the oceans as a source of growing conflict between 
states. It stipulates that coastal states must ensure that the living resources of the EEZs are not 
endangered by overexploitation. Thus, governments now have not only the legal power and the 
self-interest to apply sound principles of resource management within this area, but they have 
an obligation to do so. The Convention calls for regional cooperation in formulating and 
implementing conservation and management strategies for living marine resources, including 
cooperation in the exchange of scientific information, the conservation and development of 
stocks, and the optimum use of highly migratory species. 
52. Similarly, coastal states now have a clear interest in the sound management of the 
continental shelf and in the prevention of pollution from land- and sea-based activities. Under 
the Convention, coastal states may adopt laws and regulations for their EEZs compatible with 
international rules and standards to combat pollution from vessels. 
53. The Convention also defines the waters, sea bed, and subsoil beyond the limits of national 
jurisdiction, and recognizes this as international. Over 45 per cent of the planet's surface, this 
sea-bed area and its resources are declared to be the 'common heritage of mankind', a concept 
that represents a milestone in the realm of international cooperation. The Convention would 
bring all mining activities in the sea-bed under the control of an International Seabed 
Authority. 
54. By early 1987, the Convention had been signed by 159 nations, and 32 countries had ratified 
it. However, a small number of significant states had indicated that they were unlikely to ratify 
it./18 The reasons for this rest largely with the regime proposed to manage the common sea 
bed. 
55. Despite this, many of the Convention's other provisions have been broadly accepted and 
have already entered into international law and practice in various ways. This process should 
be encouraged, especially as regards those provisions that relate to the environment. This 
Commission believes that the Convention should be ratified by the major technological powers 
and come into force. Indeed, the most significant initial action that nations can take in the 
interests of the oceans' threatened life-support system is to ratify the Law of the Sea 
Convention. 
II. Space: A Key to Planetary Management 
56. Outer space can play a vital role in ensuring the continued habitability of the Earth, largely 
through space technology to monitor the vital signs of the planet and aid humans in protecting 
its health. According to the 1967 Outer Space Treaty, outer space, including the moon and 
other celestial bodies, is not subject to national appropriation by claim of sovereignty, by 
means of use of occupation, or by any other means. The UN Committee on the Peaceful Uses of 
Outer Space has been labouring to see that these ideals remain on the agenda. This 
Commission, in view of these developments, considers space as a global commons and part of 
the common heritage of mankind. 
57. The future of the space as a resource will depend not so much on technology as on the slow 
and difficult struggle to create sound international institutions to manage this resource. It will 
depend most of all upon humanity's ability to prevent an arms race in space.
1. Remote Sensing from Space 
58. If humanity is going to respond effectively to the consequences of changes human activity 
has induced - the build-up of atmospheric carbon dioxide, depletion of stratospheric ozone, 
acid precipitation, and tropical forest destruction - better data on the Earth's natural systems 
will be essential. 
59. Today several dozen satellites contribute to the accumulation of new knowledge about the 
Earth's systems: for example, about the spread of volcanic gases, enabling scientists for the 
first time to describe the specific links between a major natural disturbance of the upper 
atmosphere and changes in the weather thousands of miles away./19 
60. Satellites also played a key scientific role after the 1986 discovery of a 'hole' in the ozone 
layer over Antarctica. When ground-based observers noted this phenomenon, archived 
satellite data were examined and provided a record of seasonal ozone fluctuation extending 
back nearly a decade./20 And scientists have been able to follow closely the unfolding of the 
drought in the Sahel region of Africa in the 1980s. Satellite-generated maps correlating rainfall 
patterns and biomass have served as a tool in understanding droughts and helped in the 
targeting of relief aid. 
We need a kind of new earth/space monitoring system. I think that it goes farther 
than simply an earth environmental system. It's a combined earth/space monitoring 
system, a new agency that would have the resources to be able to monitor, report, 
and recommend in a very systematic way on the earth/space interaction that is so 
fundamental to a total ecological view of the biosphere. 
Maxwell Cohen 
University of Ottawa 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
61. Recently, an international and interdisciplinary group of scientists has proposed a major 
new initiative - the International Geosphere-Biosphere Programme (IGBP) to be coordinated 
through ICSU. It would investigate the biosphere using many technologies, including satellites. 
This proposal seemed in 1987 to be gaining momentum; it was already influencing the budget 
decisions of several nations on allocations for future satellite launches and is increasing 
coordination between existing efforts. 
62. The primary frustration about this wealth of data is that the information is dispersed 
among governments arid institutions, rather than being pooled. UNEP's Global Environment 
Monitoring System is a modest effort to pool space data relevant to the Earth's habitability. It 
should be strengthened. But most such efforts are underfunded, undercoordinated, and 
inadequate to the tasks. 
63. The primary responsibility for action rests initially with national governments, cooperating 
to pool, store and exchange data. In time, international efforts might be funded through some 
direct global revenue source or through contributions from individual nations. (See Chapter 
12.)
2. The Geosynchronous Orbit 
64. From an economic point of view, the most valuable part of the Earth's orbital space is the 
geosynchronous orbit, a band of space 36,000 kilometres, above the equator./21 Most 
communication and many weather satellites - as well as many military orbits - are in 
geosynchronous orbit. To prevent signals to and from the satellites interfering with one 
another, satellites must be placed some distance apart, effectively limiting the number that can 
use this valuable band to 180. Thus, the geosynchronous orbit is not only a valuable but also a 
scarce and limited global resource. 
65. The growth in satellite communication traffic during the 1970s led to many predictions that 
slots would soon be saturated. Thus conflict emerged over the use and ownership of the 
geosynchronous orbit, largely between industrial nations that have the capacity to put 
satellites in this orbit and the equatorial developing nations that do not but that lie beneath 
this band of space. 
66. The first effort to devise a property regime for geosynchronous orbit was the 1976 Bogota 
Declaration, signed by seven equatorial countries./22 These countries declared that the orbits 
above them were extensions of their territorial airspace. The Bogota Declaration has been 
challenged by some nations that see it as contradicting the 'non-appropriation' principle of the 
Outer Space Treaty. Another group of developing countries proposed a licensing system for 
the use of geosynchronous orbits./23 Countries would be awarded slots that could then be sold, 
rented, or reserved for future use. 
67. Another way of managing this resource and capturing its rental value for the common 
interest would be for an international body to own and license the slots to bidders at an 
auction. Such an alternative would be analogous to the Seabed Authority in the Law of the Sea 
Convention. 
66. Industrial countries have opposed the creation of a property rights regime for 
geosynchronous orbit, especially a regime that granted rights to slots to countries that cannot 
now use them. They argue that a regime of prior allocation would drive up costs and reduce the 
incentive of the private sector to develop and use this orbit. Others, who see a rapidly growing 
role for satellite communications, argue that regulatory regimes should be established before 
competition makes such a step more difficult. 
69. Since satellite communications involve the use of radio waves, a de facto regime for the 
parcelling out of slots in geosynchronous orbit has emerged through the activities of the 
International Telecommunications Union (ITU) in the past several years. The ITU allocates the 
use of the radio waves (those parts of the electromagnetic spectrum used for 
communication)./24 The highly technical character of the task of parcelling out radio waves, 
combined with the fact that strict compliance is necessary to allow any user to enjoy access to 
this resource, has produced a successful international resource regime, based on three regional 
conferences, for effective management of the resource./25 Whether this approach will endure 
depends in large part upon the perceived justice of the decisions reached by the regional 
conferences. 
3. The Pollution of Orbital Space 
70. Debris in orbit is a growing threat to human activities in space. In 1981, a panel of experts 
convened by the American Institute of Aeronautics and Astronautics concluded that the
growth of space debris could pose 'an unacceptable threat' to life in space within a decade./26 
This debris consists of spent fuel tanks, rocket shells, satellites that no longer function, and 
shrapnel from explosions in space: it is concentrated in the region between 160 and 1,760 
kilometres above the Earth. 
71. With greater care in the design and disposal of satellites, much of it could be avoided. 
However, the creation of debris is an integral and unavoidable consequence of the testing and 
use of space weapons. The contribution of military activities to the Earth's 'debris belt' could 
grow greatly if plans to place large numbers of satellite based weapons and weapons-related 
sensors are realized. 
72. The most important measure to minimize space debris, therefore, is to prevent the further 
testing and deployment of space based weapons or weapons designed tor use against objects in 
space. 
73. Clean up would be expensive. It has been proposed that the major powers lead an 
international effort to retrieve the larger pieces of space debris from orbit. Such work would 
involve the design, construction, and launch of vehicles that could manoeuvre in space and 
grapple with large, jagged, tumbling space objects. The proposal has elicited little enthusiasm. 
4. Nuclear Power in Orbit 
74. Many spacecraft are nuclear-powered and threaten contamination if they fall to the 
Earth./27 There are two basic approaches to the problem: Ban or regulate. The option of 
banning all radioactive materials from space is the simplest to enact. It would eliminate the 
problem and would also severely stunt the further development of space-based warfare 
systems. A total ban should exempt scientific uses in deep-space, as small amounts of 
fissionable materials have been essential for the powering of deep-space probes. A ban on 
reactors in space would be easy to monitor, because reactors produce waste heat detectable by 
infrared sensors at great distances. Verifying the absence of small nuclear power systems 
would be more difficult, but still possible. 
75. A wide variety of methods are available for regulating the use of radioactive materials in 
space. The most important include limiting the size of reactors permitted in orbit, requiring 
shielding around radioactive material sufficient to withstand reentry into the Earth's 
atmosphere, and requiring deep space disposal of spacecraft that contain radioactive material. 
All are technologically feasible, but would add cost and complexity to missions. Nevertheless, 
these measures should be implemented, as a minimum step. 
5. Towards a Space Regime 
76. Soon after the aeroplane was invented, it became obvious that collisions would occur unless 
a general air traffic control regime was established. This model offers a useful way to think 
about the need for and contents of a space regime. The creation of 'rules of the road' for orbital 
space could ensure that the activities of some do not degrade the resource for all. 
Utilization of spacecraft for solving the problems of forestry provides a good 
example of the peaceful use of space. Taking into account the interests of the 
present and future generations, there is no other more favourable area of space 
technology application than environmental protection, to study the natural
resources of Earth and control their rational utilization and reproduction. We think 
that in the forthcoming years international cooperation in this field will be further 
expanded. 
L. E. Mikhailov 
USSR State Committee on Forestry 
WCED Public Hearing 
Moscow, 11 Dec 1986 
77. Orbital space cannot be effectively managed by any one country acting alone. The inherently 
international character of orbital space has been recognized by a majority of nations in the 
Outer Space Treaty. The international community should seek to design and implement a 
space regime to ensure that space remains a peaceful environment for the benefit of all. 
78. An essential step towards efficient management of the space resource is to abandon the 
notion that because outer space in general is unlimited, orbital space can absorb all human 
activity. Because of the speeds involved, orbital space is for practical purposes much 'closer' 
than the atmosphere. A system of space traffic control in which some activities were forbidden 
and others harmonized cuts a middle path between the extremes of a sole Space Authority and 
the present near anarchy. 
79. The electromagnetic spectrum has been effectively regulated by international agreement, 
and through this regulation has begun to emerge the beginnings of a space regime for 
geosynchronous orbital space. An extension of this type of approach to control debris and the 
use of nuclear materials in orbit is the next logical step. 
80. A fine balance must be struck between regulating activities too late and regulating 
non-existent activities too soon. Regulating activities on the Moon, for example, beyond the 
general principles laid out in the Outer Space Treaty is clearly premature. But regulating space 
debris and nuclear materials in Earth orbit is clearly overdue. 
III. Antarctica: Towards Global Cooperation 
81. The Antarctic continent - larger than the United states and Mexico combined - for over a 
generation has been managed under a regime of multilateral cooperation that has secured 
environmental protection. Signed on 1 December 1959, the Antarctic Treaty has been the 
vehicle for a number of important initiatives in pursuit of its two primary objectives: to 
maintain Antarctica for peaceful uses only, prohibiting all military activities, weapons testing, 
nuclear explosions, and disposal of radioactive wastes; and to promote freedom of scientific 
investigation in Antarctica and international cooperation to that end./28 
82. The fact that the 'question of Antarctica' is today on the UN agenda/29 indicates the reality 
that there is a debate in the international community over the future management of the 
continent. Under the combined pressures of economic, technological, environmental, and 
other trends, there are new initiatives to establish a regime for minerals exploitation. New 
questions about equitable management are presenting challenges that may reshape the 
political context of the continent within the next decade./30 
83. During the forthcoming period of change, the challenge is to ensure that Antarctica is 
managed in the interests of all humankind, in a manner that conserves its unique environment, 
preserves its value for scientific research, and retains its character as a demilitarized, 
non-nuclear zone of peace.
84. Responsibility for guiding change at present rests initially with the countries party to the 
Antarctic Treaty./31 Eighteen nations now enjoy full decision-making status under the Treaty, 
with these consultative parties exercising their rights and carrying out their obligations in 
peaceful cooperation despite their divergent views on the territorial claims to parts of the 
continent. An additional 17 nations have observer status at the biennial Antarctic Treaty 
System (ATS) meetings. 
85. The Antarctic Treaty is open to accession by any state that is a member of the United 
Nations, and by others invited to accede. To become a Consultative Party, a state must 
demonstrate concrete interest in Antarctica by conducting substantial scientific research there. 
The Treaty nations feel that this system is applied flexibly and opens the Treaty to all nations 
with a genuine interest in Antarctica. Many developing nations without the resources to 
conduct research on the continent feel that this condition effectively excludes most of the 
world's nations./32 
86. But the question of participation is not polarized between industrial and developing 
countries. Not all industrialized countries are members of the Treaty, and Argentina, Brazil, 
Chile, China, India, and Uruguay have consultative status under it, while several additional 
developing countries have acceded to it. However, the overwhelming majority of developing 
countries, including all those of Africa, remain outside the arrangements. 
87. There is furthermore no general agreement as to whether Antarctica is part of the 
international commons. For example, seven states maintain territorial claims. Moreover, many 
developing countries reject the idea that what they regard as the common heritage of mankind 
should be managed by some countries to the exclusion of others. Many of them see the 
Antarctic Treaty System as the exclusive preserve of the rich and technologically advanced 
countries. Some object to what they consider the exclusivity of the Treaty system, with 
countries self-appointed to determine the future of the continent. Although the Consultative 
Parties assert that they have managed Antarctica in the interests of all peoples, several nations 
maintain that these interests should not be defined by the Consultative Parties alone; this view 
has gained many new sources of expression since 1959. Despite the present debate over the 
continent's future, many nations outside the Treaty have recognized the trusteeship role 
played by the Treaty nations in protecting the environment of Antarctica./33 
88. The Commission does not propose to adjudicate the status of Antarctica. But it sees it as 
essential that the continent be managed and protected in a responsible manner that takes into 
account the common interests at stake, it notes also that the legal and management regimes 
are in the midst of a process of change leading to wider participation. 
89. The Antarctic Treaty Consultative Parties have endeavoured to demonstrate a strong 
concern for the protection of the continent's environment and the conservation of its natural 
resources. (See Box 10-1.) In 1964, they adopted the 'Agreed Measures for the Conservation of 
Antarctic Fauna and Flora',/34 which amount to a conservation protocol to the Treaty. At 
subsequent biennial meetings, they have continued to develop environmental principles and 
measures to guide the planning and execution of their activities. Additional measures would 
improve the scope and effectiveness of environmental protection, and it would be useful to 
consider means to ensure that the record of compliance with these measures is widely known. 
90. The Consultative Parties have also played a leading role in the promulgation of two 
important international conventions relating to conservation of living resources: the 1972 
Convention on the Conservation of Antarctic Seals and the 1980 Convention on the 
Conservation of Antarctic Marine Living Resources./35 The second arose out of concern that
the depletion of Antarctic fish stocks, particularly shrimp like krill, could have severe and 
unpredictable effects on related and dependent species. It adopts an 'ecosystem approach' to 
resource management./36 
91. Taken together, these legal instruments and accompanying protocols and 
recommendations, along with the non governmental body the Scientific Committee on 
Antarctic Research (SCAR), constitute what is referred to as the Antarctic Treaty System. This 
system demonstrates the evolution that has taken place under the Antarctic Treaty since it 
entered into force. 
92. Several international NGOs have begun to monitor the adequacy of and compliance with 
environmental protection and conservation measures in Antarctica and have frequently been 
critical of these measures. They have also sought observer status at ATS meetings and greater 
involvement in the formulation and review of Antarctic policies. Some UK agencies are 
concerned with southern hemisphere meteorology, oceanography, or fishing and have become 
involved in Antarctic science and politics. A concrete result of this interest has been invitations 
extended to WMO, FAO, IOC, IUCN, IWC, SCAR, and the Scientific Committee on Oceanic 
Research to attend as observers meetings of the Commission for the Conservation of Antarctic 
Marine Living Resources (CCAMLR). The European Economic Community is also a CCAMLR 
member as a result of its member states ceding competence to it with respect to fisheries 
management policies. 
Box 10-1 
Antarctica's Unique Treaty Arrangements 
Under the Antarctic Treaty, the seven states claiming territory there have agreed 
with non-claimant parties to the Treaty to Bet aside the disputed territorial status of 
Antarctica in order to carry out agreed-upon activities in the area. 
While the Treaty is in force, no acts or activities taking place will 'constitute a basis for 
asserting, supporting or denying a claim to territorial sovereignty in Antarctica', nor 
may any new claim, or enlargement of an existing claim, be asserted. 
Decisions are taken by consensus, which guarantees to both claimant and 
non-claimant states that no activity or management practice prejudicial to their 
position on the territorial status of Antarctica will be approved. The Treaty provides 
for on-site inspection at any time in any or all areas of Antarctica by designated 
nationals of the consultative parties. 
Source: Based on Lee Kimball, 'Testing the Great Experiment' Environment, 
September 1985. 
93. For the ATS to remain viable into the next century, it will need to continue to evolve and 
adapt itself to deal with new issues and new circumstances. Although the Treaty could run 
indefinitely, in 1991 any of the Consultative Parties may call for a general conference of the 
signatory nations, to review its operation. 
1. Guard Present Achievements
94. Although further change in the management status of Antarctica is inevitable, it is essential 
that such change not jeopardize the achievements of the Treaty System in the areas of peace, 
science, conservation, and environment. Antarctica has been an agreed zone of peace for nearly 
30 years, free of all military activities, nuclear tests, and radioactive wastes. This is a 
foundation on which humanity must build. 
95. Cooperation in scientific investigation has steadily expanded; it must be further 
strengthened, especially concerning Antarctica's role in global atmospheric and oceanic 
circulation and world climate. At the same time, more efforts should be made to secure full 
participation in such research. Means must be found to expand consultation and participation 
and to extend the benefits of international cooperation in Antarctic science and technology to 
the international community as a whole. 
The most cruel environmental threat comes from the environmental movement 
itself as we see the animal rights laws systematically destroy our way of life and 
violate our right as aboriginal peoples to our traditions and values. Yet our people, 
including the Arctic people, need development. The challenge is to find strategies 
for development that meet the needs of the people and the environment. 
Rhoda Inuksu 
Inuit Indian 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
96. Several suggestions along these lines have been made. They include establishing a fund to 
facilitate the participation of interested developing countries in Antarctic science, and inviting 
more scientists from developing nations to join projects and visit scientific stations. Given the 
costly technologies involved in Antarctic science, possibilities should be explored for sharing 
Antarctic base and logistics capabilities with interested non-consultative states. The right to 
consultative status could be extended to states participating in scientific activities on a joint 
basis. 
97. As Antarctic activities multiply, sound conservation will also require increased data 
collection, monitoring, and environmental assessment. The interactive and cumulative effects 
of these projects must be carefully reviewed and areas of unique scientific and environmental 
value protected. 
2. Anticipate Pressures for Mineral Development 
98. Minerals of various kinds are known to exist in Antarctica, but the minerals talks have 
triggered false assumptions about the imminence of their development. Even given the most 
optimistic growth trends, it seems clear that more accessible sources will be developed 
elsewhere long before Antarctica attracts major investment. Only two minerals have been 
found that might exist in concentrations suitable for exploitation - coal in the Transantarctic 
Mountains and iron in the Prince Charles Mountains. Mining them would be a fool's venture./37 
The costs would be prohibitive, and sufficient coal and iron can be found closer to the main 
markets. 
99. Circumstantial evidence suggests the existence of offshore oil and gas, but no deposits have 
yet been discovered. The USSR, Japan, France, the United Kingdom, and the Federal Republic
of Germany have surveyed Antarctica's continental shelves. The surveys were of a scientific 
nature, but, coinciding as they did with the first serious discussions of a minerals regime, were 
viewed by some observers as signalling commercial interests. 
100. The 18 Consultative Parties are conducting negotiations among themselves to complete an 
agreed legal framework for determining the environmental acceptability of possible minerals 
exploration and development in Antarctica and to govern any such activities./38 Treaty 
members felt that it would be more difficult to agree on such a regime after actual finds have 
been made. The negotiations in many ways are an expression of the idea that prevention is 
better than cure, forethought preferable to afterthought. 
101. Antarctica is an enormous continent where claims to sovereignty are in dispute and where 
there are no agreed legal bases for issuing licences, leasing or selling mineral rights, or 
receiving royalty payments. These delicate questions have now been raised and will not lie 
silent until they have been answered within an internationally agreed framework. Until these 
matters are resolved, and protection of the Antarctic environment is assured, it seems unlikely 
that any nation or group of nations will be able to invest securely in developing the continent's 
mineral resources./39 
102. Given the absence of technologies tested in the ultimate extremities of Antarctic 
conditions, the lack of agreement on procedures to assess and take account of the impacts of 
any development, and the sparse data base, it could take a generation or more of dedicated 
research and technological development to ensure that minerals exploitation would not 
destroy the Antarctic's fragile ecosystem and its place in global environmental processes. Thus 
it is important that no minerals activity takes place until these conditions have changed, and 
then only in consonance with a regime that guarantees implementation of the most stringent 
standards needed to protect the continent's environment and share the proceeds equitably. 
3. Promote Evolution of Antarctic Treaty System 
103. In the years ahead, activities in Antarctica will expand in kind and scale, as will the 
numbers of participants in such activities. Further efforts must be made to ensure effective 
management of those activities and an orderly expansion of participation in such management. 
A variety of options are being discussed by the international community. More effective 
management, including expanded participation, could evolve gradually through the existing 
Treaty System. But given the extent of probable change and the lure of mineral wealth, 
however remote, such an approach could be too slow to retain political support. Another is that 
the above goals might be reached through the negotiation of an entirely new system. However, 
neither of these approaches would be free of difficulty. Yet another alternative would be to 
intensify efforts to make the Treaty System more universal, more open, and responsive to 
expressions of concrete and legitimate concern and interest in Antarctica. 
4. Establish a Means for More Effective Communication 
104. As activities under the different treaties increase, so does the importance of coordination 
among the advisory and decision making authorities responsible for various areas. Antarctica 
may require the establishment of somewhat more formal institutions than have governed the 
first generation of activities, in order to foster better communication and coordination both 
within and outside the Treaty System.
Some unique objects like Lake Baikal and Siberia, the Great Lakes in Africa and 
North America, are part of our global patrimony. They are some of the absolute 
values our planet possesses and their significance transcends any national 
boundaries. We should learn how to foresee their future and how to anticipate the 
after-effects of large-scale engineering projects. 
Since people's interests vary, it cannot be taken for granted that people will accept 
scholars' recommendations and come to agreement on that score. And their 
agreement is of special importance in situations where global problems are 
involved and where the human race as a whole may be threatened with perils 
generated by the absence of such agreement. 
What is needed today is the moulding of a new ethos and new arrangements for 
building an understanding among people, countries, and regions. And as a first 
step we should produce new knowledge, concentrate our research efforts on 
maintaining life on earth, and develop a system distributing and disseminating 
knowledge and new moral criteria in a way that makes it available to billions of 
people who inhabit our planet. 
Academician N.N. Moiseev 
USSR Academy of Sciences 
WCED Public Hearing 
Moscow, 8 Dec 1986 
105. Antarctica is on the agenda of the UN General Assembly and will probably remain so. 
Nothing will happen, however, unless the participants in the debate find terms of reference 
that can command broad-based support and an agreed upon means to explore and give effect 
to improved management. 
106. To focus on longer-term strategies to preserve and build on the achievements of the 
existing Treaty System, nations must create the means to foster dialogue among politicians, 
scientists, environmentalists, and industries from countries within and outside it. A good place 
to start would be the development of closer working relationships between the parties to 
Antarctic regimes and the international organizations within and outside the UN system that 
have responsibilities for science and technology, conservation, and environmental 
management. 
107. National policy processes could also be structured to provide for dialogue with concerned 
industries, public interest organizations, and expert advisors, perhaps through an Antarctic 
advisory committee. The U.S. Government has been in the forefront of those countries 
appointing industry and public interest advisors to its delegations to Consultative Parties 
meetings. Australia, New Zealand, and Denmark have more recently followed suit. 
108. Hammering out an internationally supported consensus on Antarctica is a huge task 
requiting time and patience. And the lure of minerals increases with every new rumour of a 
find. Yet such a consensus is the only way to prevent a tragic plundering of the silent continent, 
and to maintain Antarctica as a symbol of peaceful international cooperation and 
environmental protection. 
Footnotes
1/ This section draws on F. Szekely, 'The Marine and Coastal Environment', prepared for 
WCED, 1986; J. Beddington, 'Whaling', prepared for WCED, 1986; V. Sebek, 'Policy Paper on 
Dumping', prepared for WCED, 1986. 
2/ M.W. Holdgate et al., 'The Marine Environment', in The World Environment 1972-1982 
(Dublin: Tycooly International Publishing Ltd., 1982). 
3/ See National Academy of Sciences, Oil in the Sea (Washington, DC: National Academy 
Press, 1985); and OECD, Maritime Transport, 1984 (Paris: 1986). 
4/ 'Scientists Closer to Identifying Cause of Antarctic Ozone Depletion', National Science 
Foundation News, 20 October 1986; Ad Hoc Working Group of Legal and Technical Experts 
for the Elaboration of a Protocol on the Control of Chlorofluorocarbons to the Vienna 
Convention for the Protection of the Ozone Layer (Vienna Group), 'Report of the Second Part 
of the Workshop on the Control of Chlorofluorocarbons, Leesburg, USA, UNEP/WG.151 
/Background 2, Na.86-2184, UNEP, Nairobi, 15 October 1986; A.S. Miller and I.M. Mintzer, 
The Sky Is the Limit: Strategies for Protecting the Ozone Layer, WRI Research 
Report No. 3 (Washington, DC: World Resources Institute, 1986). 
5/ GESAMP in a recent evaluation of the present state of the health of the oceans, 'The Health 
of the Oceans', Regional Seas Reports and Studies No. 16, UNEP, Nairobi, 1982. 
6/ M. Bertrand, 'Some Reflections on Reform of the United Nations', Joint Inspection Unit, 
United Nations, Geneva, 1985. 
7/ E.P. Eckholm, Down to Earth (London: Pluto Press, Ltd., 1982). 
8/ J.A. Gulland and S. Garcia, 'Observed! Patterns in Multispecies Fisheries.' in R.M. May (ed.), 
Exploitation of Marine Communities (Berlin: Springer-Verlag, 1984); FAO, 'Review of the 
State of World Fishery Resources', Fisheries Circular 710 (rev. 4), Rome, 1985. 
9/ Dr J. Gulland, Marine Resources Assessment Group, Imperial College of Science and 
Technology, London, personal communication, 20 January 1987. 
10/ FAO, op. cit. 
11/ IWC, Report of the IWC 36th Session, 1986 (Cambridge: forthcoming). 
12/ 1965 Report on Great Lakes Water Quality: Great Lakes Water quality Board 
Report to the International Joint Commission (Windsor, Ont.: IJC, 1985). 
13/ IMO, 'The Provisions of the London Dumping Convention, 1972', and Decisions made by 
the Consultative Meetings of Contracting Parties, 1975-1984. 
14/ Dumping in the Convention means any deliberate disposal at sea of material and 
substances of any kind, form, or description from vessels, aircraft, platform, or other artificial 
structures, as well as the disposal of vessels, aircraft, platforms, or other artificial structures 
themselves. 
15/ Twenty-five nations, led by Spain, Australia, and New Zealand, supported the resolution, 
while Canada, France, South Africa, Switzerland, the United Kingdom, and the United States 
voted against. 
16/ U. Grimas and A. Svansson, Swedish Report on the Skagerak (Stockholm: National 
Environmental Protection Board, 1985).
17/ United Nations, Final Act of the Third Conference on the Law of the Sea, Montego Bay, 
Jamaica, December 1982. In its final form, the Convention is composed of 17 main parts (320 
articles), dealing with the territorial sea and contiguous zone; straits used for international 
navigation; archipelagic states; exclusive economic zone; continental shelf; high seas; regime of 
islands; enclosed or semi-enclosed seas; right of access of land-locked states to and from the 
sea and freedom of transit; the area, protection, and preservation of the marine environment; 
marine scientific research; development and transfer of marine technology; settlement of 
disputes; general provisions; and final provisions. There are nine annexes to the Convention: 
highly migratory species; Commission on the Limits of the Continental Shelf; basic conditions 
of prospecting; exploration and exploitation; statute of the International Tribunal for the Law 
of the Sea; Statute of the Enterprise; conciliations; arbitration and special arbitration and 
participation by international organizations. Under the Convention, coastal states may adopt 
laws and regulations in the EEZ compatible with international rules and standards to combat 
pollution from vessels. 
18/ Among other things, declaration by the President of the United States, on 9 July 1982, and 
L.O.S. Bulletin, July 1985, issued by the Office of the Special Representative of the Secretary 
General for the Law of the Sea Convention. 
19/ W. Sullivan, 'Eruption in Mexico Tied to Climate Shift Off Peru.' New York Times, 12 
December 1982. 
20/ R. Kerr, 'Taking Shots at Ozone Hole Theories,' Science, 14 November 1986. 
21/ When the speed of a satellite matches the speed of the planet's rotation, the satellite is 
stationary relative to particular places on the Earth. There is only one band or arc, directly 
above the equator, where it is possible to achieve geosynchronous orbit. 
22/ The general case for a regulatory regime and several alternative regimes are spelled out in 
K.G. Gibbons, 'Orbital Saturation: The Necessity for International Regulation of 
Geosynchronous Orbits', California Western International Law Journal, Winter 1979 
23/ A summary of Third World views is found in H.J. Levin, 'Orbit and Spectrum Resource 
Strategies: Third World Demands', Telecommunications Policy, June 1981. 
24/ The allocation is done every 10 years at World Administrative Radio Conferences (WARCs), 
the last of which was held in 1979. U.S. Congress, Office ooe Technology Assessment, 
Radiofrequency Use and Management: Impacts from the World Administrative 
Radio Conference of 1979 (Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1980). 
25/ These conferences are described in G. Coding, Jr., 'The USA and the 1985 Space WARC', 
and A.M. Rutkowski, 'Space WARC: The Stake of the Developing Countries, the GEO and the 
WARC-ORB 85 Conference', Space Policy, August 1985. 
26/ AIAA Technical Committee on Space Systems, Space Debris, July 1981. 
27/ The United States has launched 23 spacecraft that relied at least in part upon nuclear 
power sources: one source was a reactor; the rest were radioactive materials the decay heat of 
which is converted into electricity (thermoelectric generators). By the end of 1986 the Soviet 
Union had launched 31 nuclear-powered spacecraft, almost all of which contained fission 
reactors, and it currently operates all of the reactor-powered satellites. 
28/ 'Antarctic: A Continent in Transition', Fact Sheet Folio, International Institute for 
Environment and Development, London, 1986.
29/ In 1983, the Seventh Summit Conference of the Non-Aligned Countries included a 
paragraph on Antarctica in its communique. That same year, the question of Antarctica was 
put on the agenda of the UN General Assembly. The debate resulted in a consensus resolution 
asking for the elaboration of a special report by the Secretary General, which was debated by 
the UN General Assembly at its 39th Session in November 1984. The consensus has not been 
maintained. At subsequent General Assembly sessions, resolutions on Antarctica have been 
passed over the objections of the parties to the Treaty, moat of whom chose not to participate 
in the vote. 
30/ L. Kimball, 'Testing the Great Experiment', Environment, September 1985. 
31/ 'Antarctic Treaty', concluded 1 December 1959 and entered into force 23 June 1961, 
summarized in M.J. Bowman and D.J. Harris (eds.), Multilateral Treaties: Index and 
Current Status (London: Butterworths, 1964). 
32/ They include the original seven claimants: Argentina, Australia, Chile, France, New 
Zealand, Norway, and the United Kingdom; an additional five who were original signatories: 
Belgium, Japan, South Africa, USSR and the United States; plus six who have since acceded to 
the Treaty and become full Consultative Parties: Poland (1977), the Federal Republic of 
Germany (1981), Brazil and India (1983), and China and Uruguay (1985). Any country can 
accede to the Treaty, becoming a full 'Consultative Party' providing, and during such time as, it 
demonstrates an interest in the continent through the presence of a substantial scientific 
activity. Seventeen other countries have acceded to the Treaty, but do not hold consultative 
status. Since 1983, they have been invited to attend Antarctic Treaty meetings as observers. 
33/ Both in their declaration of principles concerning the environment and in the text of the 
Convention on the Conservation of Antarctic Marine Living Resources, the Consultative 
Parties insist that the primary responsibility for these matters lies with them by virtue of their 
status as Consultative Parties, a proposition that Parties to the Convention who are not also 
Parties to the Treaty are obliged to affirm. 
34/ 'Agreed Measures for the Conservation of Antarctic Fauna and Flora', agreed 2-13 June 
1984, reprinted in W.M. Bush (ed.), Antarctica and International Law (London: Oceana 
Publications, 1982). 
35/ 'Convention for the Conservation of Antarctic Seals', concluded 11 February 1972 and 
entered into force 11 March 1978, summarized in Bowman and Harris, op. cit.; 'Convention on 
the Conservation of Antarctic Marine Living Resources', concluded 20 May 1980 and entered 
into force 7 April 1981, summarized in ibid. See also J.N. Barnes, 'The Emerging Convention on 
the Conservation of Antarctic Marine Living Resources: An Attempt to Meet the New Realities 
of Resource Exploitation in the Southern Ocean', in J.I. Charney (ed.), New Nationalism 
and the Use of Common Spaces (Totowa, NJ: Allenheld Publishers, 1982). 
36/ J.A. Beddington and R.M. May, 'The Harvesting ooe Interacting Species in a Natural 
Ecosystem', Scientific American, November 1982. 
37/ J.H. Zumborge, 'Mineral Resources and Geopolitics in Antarctica', American Scientist, 
January-February 1979: G. Pontecorvo, 'The Economics of the Resources of Antarctica', in 
Charney, op. cit. 
38/ L. Kimball, 'Unfreezing International Cooperation in Antarctica', Christian Science 
Monitor, 1 August 1982. 
39/ D. Shapley, 'Antarctic Up for Grabs', Science 82, November 1982.
Our Common Future, Chapter 11: Peace, Security, Development, and 
the Environment 
Environmental Stress as a I. Source of Conflict 
II. Conflict as a Cause of Unsustainable Development 
1. Nuclear War - Threat to Civilization 
2. Other Weapons of Mass Destruction 
3. The Costs of the 'Arms Culture' 
4. World Armaments and the Growth of the 'Arms Culture' 
III. Towards Security and Sustainable Development 
1. Principles 
2. Cooperative Management 
3. The Importance of Early Warning 
4. Disarmament and Security 
1. Among the dangers facing the environment, the possibility of nuclear war, or military conflict 
of a lesser scale involving weapons of mass destruction, is undoubtedly the gravest. Certain 
aspects of the issues of peace and security bear directly upon the concept of sustainable 
development. Indeed, they are central to it. 
2. Environmental stress is both a cause and an effect of political tension and military conflict./1 
Nations have often fought to assert or resist control over raw materials, energy supplies, land, 
river basins, sea passages, and other key environmental resources. Such conflicts are likely to 
increase as these resources become scarcer and competition for them increases. 
3. The environmental consequences of armed conflict would be most devastating in the case of 
thermo-nuclear war. But there are damaging effects too from conventional, biological, and 
chemical weapons, as well as from the disruption of economic production and social 
organization in the wake of warfare and mass migration of refugees. But even where war is 
prevented, and where conflict is contained, a state of 'peace' might well entail the diversion into 
armament production of vast resources that could, at least in part, be used to promote 
sustainable forms of development. 
4. A number of factors affect the connection between environmental stress, poverty, and 
security, such as inadequate development policies, adverse trends in the international 
economy, inequities in multi-racial and multi-ethnic societies, and pressures of population
growth. These linkages among environment, development, and conflict are complex and, in 
many cases, poorly understood. But a comprehensive approach to international and national 
security must transcend the traditional emphasis on military power and armed competition 
The real sources of insecurity also encompass unsustainable development, and its effects can 
become intertwined with traditional forms of conflict in a manner that can extend and deepen 
the latter. 
I. Environmental Stress as a Source of Conflict 
5. Environmental stress is seldom the only cause of major conflicts within or among nations. 
Nevertheless, they can arise from the marginalization of sectors of the population and from 
ensuing violence. This occurs when political processes are unable to handle the effects of 
environmental stress resulting, for example, from erosion and desertification. Environmental 
stress can thus be an important part of the web of causality associated with any conflict and can 
in some cases be catalytic. 
6. Poverty, injustice, environmental degradation, and conflict interact in complex and potent 
ways. One manifestation of growing concern to the international community is the 
phenomenon of 'environmental refugees'/2 The immediate cause of any mass movement of 
refugees may appear to be political upheaval and military violence. But the underlying causes 
often include the deterioration of the natural resource base and its capacity to support the 
population. 
7. Events in the Horn of Africa are a case in point. In the early 1970s, drought and famine 
struck the nation of Ethiopia. Yet it has been found that the hunger and human misery were 
caused more by years of overuse of soils in the Ethiopian highlands and the resulting severe 
erosion than by drought. A report commissioned by the Ethiopian Relief and Rehabilitation 
Commission found: 'The primary cause of the famine was not drought of unprecedented 
severity, but a combination of long-continued bad land use and steadily increased human and 
stock populations over decades'./3 
8. Wars have always compelled people to leave their homes and their lands, to become 
refugees. Also, the wars in our time have forced large numbers of people to leave their 
homelands. In addition, we now have the phenomenon of environmental refugees. In 1984-85, 
some 10 million Africans fled their homes, accounting for two-thirds of all refugees worldwide. 
Their flight was not surprising in a region where 35 million suffered from famine. Many of them 
swarmed into cities. But many others moved across national boundaries, heightening 
interstate tensions. Cote d'Ivoire, Ghana, and Nigeria have been generous in welcoming 
refugees from the desertified Sahel. Tanzania, Zambia, and Zimbabwe have also been receiving 
large numbers of refugees. Yet, the Cote d'Ivoire, for instance, which depends for much of its 
export revenues on timber, is suffering rapid deforestation caused in part by land hunger, and 
one-third of landless people are immigrants. Agriculture destroys 4.5 times as much forestland 
in the Cote d'Ivoire as logging does./4 
9. Almost 1 million Haitian 'boat people', one-sixth of the entire populace, have fled that island 
nation, an exodus fuelled in large part by environmental degradation. Haiti suffers some of the 
world's most severe erosion, down to bedrock over large parts of some regions, so that even 
farmers with reasonable amounts of land cannot make a living. According to a US Agency for 
International Development (USAID) report, 'The social and economic effects of environmental 
degradation are great, and contribute to the growing outflow from rural areas. Thousands of 
rural Haitians leave their homes each year for Port au Prince, other Caribbean islands and the 
United States in search of employment and better living conditions./5 El Salvador, one of the
most troubled nations of Central America, is also one of the most environmentally 
impoverished, with some of the worst erosion rates in the region. The fundamental causes of 
the present conflict are as much environmental as political, stemming from problems of 
resource distribution in an overcrowded land, according to a draft USAID environmental 
profile of El Salvador./6 
Today we cannot secure security for one state at the expense of the other. 
Security can only be universal, but security cannot only be political or military, it 
must be as well ecological, economical, and social. It must ensure the fulfilment of 
the aspirations of humanity as a whole. 
A. S. Timoshenko 
Institute of State and Law, USSR Academy of Sciences 
WCED Public Hearing 
Moscow, 11 Dec 1986 
10. South Africa reveals similar problems. The inhuman policy of apartheid is at the core of the 
state of political conflict in Southern Africa. One of the many ways by which apartheid 
institutionalizes both conflict and environmental degradation is by allocating, through the 
'homelands' system, 14 per cent of the nation's land to 72 per cent of the population./7 Young 
working-age blacks flee the overcultivated and overgrazed 'homelands' to seek work in the 
cities, where, on top of the squalor of overcrowded townships, they encounter extreme socio-economic 
inequality and racial segregation. They fight back. Repression intensifies, and the 
victims seek refuge over the border - whereupon the South African regime widens the conflict 
into neighbouring states. The entire region is becoming caught up in the ensuing violence, 
which could well ignite wider conflict drawing in major powers. 
11. In addition to the interrelated problems of poverty, injustice, and environmental stress, 
competition for non-renewable raw materials, land, or energy can create tension. It was the 
quest for raw materials that underlay much of the competition between colonial powers and 
the subjugation of their holdings. Conflicts in the Middle East inevitably contain the seeds of 
great power intervention and global conflagration, in part because of the international interest 
in oil. 
12. As unsustainable forms of development push individual countries up against environmental 
limits, major differences in environmental endowment among countries, or variations in stocks 
of usable land and raw materials, could precipitate and exacerbate international tension and 
conflict. And competition for use of the global commons, such as ocean fisheries and 
Antarctica, or for use of more localized common resources in fixed supply, such as rivers and 
coastal waters, could escalate to the level of international conflict and to threaten international 
peace and security. 
13. Global water use doubled between 1940 and 1980, and it is expected to double again by 
2000, with two thirds of the projected water use going to agriculture. Yet 80 countries, with 40 
per cent of the world's population, already suffer serious water shortages./8 There will be 
growing competition for water for irrigation, industry, and domestic use. River water disputes 
have already occurred in North America (the Rio Grande), South America (the Rio de la Plata 
and Parana), South and Southeast Asia (the Mekong and the Ganges), Africa (the Nile), and the 
Middle East (the Jordan, Litani, and Orontes, as well as the Euphrates).
How can the world of nature and the community of peoples with their national 
economies be harmonized? Posing the question this way suggests that the two are 
separate. But not so. Humanity, the human species, exists and it supported within 
the world of nature. And I mean that not figuratively but literally. 
We are deep-air animals living inside an ecological system. We draw boundaries, 
of course, on the ecosphere for national and regional purposes. But it is all of one 
piece. 
When, therefore, we optimistically declare that economic development and 
environmental maintenance can go along hand in hand, this qualifier must 
immediately be added: only if the maintenance of the ecosphere is made the first 
priority. Economic development must be secondary, guided by strict ecological 
standards. These fundamental ideas are far from being universally accepted. 
Stanley Rowe 
Saskatchewan Environmental Society 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
14. Fisheries, whether coastal or oceanic, are fundamental to the diets of many countries. For 
some countries, fishing is a key economic sector, and overfishing poses immediate dangers to 
several national economies. In 1974 Iceland, largely dependent on its fishing industry, found 
itself embroiled with the United Kingdom in a 'cod war'. Similar tensions exist in the Japanese 
and Korean seas and on both sides of the South Atlantic. The 1986 declaration of an exclusive 
fishery zone around the Falkland/Malvinas Islands has further unsettled relations between 
Britain and Argentina. Disputes over fishing rights in the South Pacific and the search for tuna 
by distant-water fleets led to increased competition for diplomatic and fisheries advantages by 
the major powers in that region in 1986. Fisheries-related disputes may well become more 
frequent as nations harvest fish stocks beyond the level of sustainable yields. 
15. Environmental threats to security are now beginning to emerge on a global scale. The most 
worrisome of these stem from the possible consequences of global warming caused by the 
atmospheric build-up of carbon dioxide and other gases./9 (See Chapter 7.) Any such climatic 
change would quite probably be unequal in its effects, disrupting agricultural systems in areas 
that provide a large proportion of the world's cereal harvests and perhaps triggering mass 
population movements in areas where hunger is already endemic. Sea levels may rise during 
the first half of the next century enough to radically change the boundaries between coastal 
nations and to change the shapes and strategic importance of international waterways - effects 
both likely to increase international tensions. The climatic and sea-level changes are also likely 
to disrupt the breeding grounds of economically important fish species. Slowing, or adapting 
to, global warming is becoming an essential task to reduce the risks of conflict. 
II. Conflict as a Cause of Unsustainable Development 
16. Arms competition and armed conflict create major obstacles to sustainable development. 
They make huge claims on scarce material resources. They pre-empt human resources and 
wealth that could be used to combat the collapse of environmental support systems, the 
poverty, and the underdevelopment that in combination contribute so much to contemporary 
political insecurity. They may stimulate an ethos that is antagonistic towards cooperation 
among nations whose ecological and economic interdependence requires them to overcome
national or ideological antipathies. 
17. The existence of nuclear weapons and the destructive potential inherent in the velocity and 
intensity of modern conventional warfare have given rise to a new understanding of the 
requirements for security among nations. In the nuclear age nations can no longer obtain 
security at each other's expense. They must seek security through cooperation, agreements, 
and mutual restraint; they must seek common security./10 Hence interdependence, which is so 
fundamental in the realm of environment and economics, is a fact also in the sphere of arms 
competition and military security. Interdependence has become a compelling fact, forcing 
nations to reconcile their approach to 'security'. 
1. Nuclear War - Threat to Civilization 
18. The likely consequences of nuclear war make other threats, to the environment pale into 
insignificance. Nuclear weapons represent a qualitatively new step in the development of 
warfare. One thermo-nuclear bomb can have an explosive power greater than that of all the 
explosives Used in wars since the invention of gunpowder. In addition to the destructive 
effects of blast and heat, immensely magnified by these weapons, they introduce a new lethal 
agent - ionizing radiation - that extends lethal effects over both space and tine. 
19. In recent years, scientists have in addition called our attention to the prospect of 'nuclear 
winter'. It has been most authoritatively explored by some 300 scientists from the United 
States, the USSR, and more than 30 other countries - working on a collaborative basis in some 
cases across ideological divides./11 
All youth organizations believe that environmental issues stand high on the priority 
list of global problems. However, their solution depends on the preservation of 
peace on our planet. The quest of solutions to ecological problems is impossible 
without the curbing of the arms race, for the arms race absorbs tremendous 
intellectual and material resources of mankind. The solution of ecological problems 
also depends on the way of life of young people and their value orientation. 
Dr. I.I. Russin 
Moscow State University 
WCED Public Hearing 
Moscow, 8 Dec 1986 
20. The theory contends that the smoke and dust ejected into the atmosphere by a nuclear war 
could absorb enough solar radiation to remain aloft for some time, preventing sunlight from 
reaching the surface of the earth, causing a widespread and prolonged cooling of land areas. 
There would be severe repercussions for plant life generally and for agriculture in particular, 
disrupting the production of food to sustain survivors of the war. Great uncertainties remain 
about the scale and linkages determining environmental effects, but large-scale environmental 
perturbations are considered probable. A nuclear war cannot be won, and must never be 
fought. In the aftermath, there would be no difference between so called victor and 
vanquished. The nuclear-weapon states must spare no effort to conclude a verifiable 
agreement on banning all nuclear weapon tests. 
21. The findings on nuclear winter are vitally important too for non-aligned nations, 
predominantly in the South, which are not parties to the East West conflict. They cannot
expect to avoid the potentially disastrous environmental consequences of nuclear war in the 
northern hemisphere. The aftermath of such a war would envelop the world. There is a danger 
that nuclear weapons will spread to more and more countries and be used in what begins as a 
limited regional conflict. Beyond the five recognized nuclear-weapon states, at least six others 
have a widely acknowledged potential nuclear weapons capability; a dozen others are not far 
behind. The nuclear-weapon states cannot expect the non-nuclear-weapon states to abstain 
from exercising the nuclear option in the absence of real progress on the road to nuclear 
disarmament. It is imperative, therefore, that the probable consequences of nuclear war be 
recognized universally and that all states become involved in efforts to prevent the 
proliferation - and above all the use of nuclear weapons. 
2. Other Weapons of Mass Destruction 
22. Other forms of war and other weapons of mass destruction have large scale effects or both 
human societies and the human environment. Biological warfare could release new agents of 
disease that would prove difficult to control. Recent advances in biotechnology multiply the 
potentially lethal applications of such weapons. Likewise, the deliberate manipulation of the 
environment (for example, through artificial earthquakes and floods) would have 
consequences far beyond the borders of those involved in a conflict, were they ever used. 
Chemical agents can seriously damage the environment, as demonstrated by the defoliants 
used in South-east Asia. The dangerous and environmentally unpredictable consequences of 
biological and chemical weapons have led to international agreements banning their use./12 But 
there is need for further efforts to strengthen the regimes to which these agreements 
contribute. In particular, the Geneva protocol prohibiting the use of chemical weapons should 
be supplemented by agreements prohibiting the production and stockpiling of such weapons. 
23. Military applications of new technologies now threaten lo make outer space a focus of 
international competition and conflict. (See Chapter 10.) Most countries in the international 
community see space as a global commons that should benefit humanity as a whole and be 
preserved from military competition - a feeling reflected in the 1967 Outer Space Treaty, under 
which nations agreed not to deploy weapons of mass destruction there. Governments should 
now agree on measures to prevent an arms race in space and stop it on Earth. Failing such 
agreement, the arms race could expand, with dire consequences for humanity. 
3. The Costs of the 'Arms Culture' 
24. The absence of war is not peace; nor does it necessarily provide the conditions for 
sustainable development. Competitive arms races breed insecurity among nations through 
spirals of reciprocal fears. Nations need to muster resources to combat environmental 
degradation and mass poverty. By misdirecting scarce resources, arms races contribute further 
to insecurity. 
25. The coexistence of substantial military spending with unmet human needs has long evoked 
concern. President Eisenhower, for example, observed at the end his term in office that 'every 
gun that is made, every warship launched, every rocket fired represents, in the final analysis, a 
theft from those who hunger and are not fed, who are cold and are not clothed'./13 
26. Global military spending in 1985 was well in excess of $900 billion./14 This was more than 
the total income of the poorest half of humanity. It represented the equivalent of almost 
$1,000 for every one of the world's 1 billion poorest. Put another way, military spending 
surpassed the combined gross national products of China, India, and the African countries
south of the Sahara. Moreover, global military spending has risen not only absolutely but 
proportionately - from an estimated 4.7 per cent of world output in 1960 to over 6 per cent - 
representing an increase of about 150 per cent in real (constant price) terms. Three-quarters of 
current expenditure is in the industrial world./15 
27. The true cost of the arms race is the loss of what could have been produced instead with 
scarce capital, labour skills, and raw materials. The plants that manufacture weapons, the 
transport of those weapons, and the mining of minerals for their production all place enormous 
demands on energy and mineral resources and are a major contributor to pollution and 
environmental deterioration. 
28. The distorting effects of the 'arms culture' are most striking in the deployment of scientific 
personnel. Half a million scientists are employed on weapons research world-wide, and they 
account to: around half of all research and development expenditure./16 This exceeds the total 
combined spending on developing technologies for new energy sources, improving human 
health, raising agricultural productivity, and controlling pollution. Military research and 
development - $70-80 billion world-wide in 1984 - is growing at twice the rate of military 
spending as a whole./17 At the same time, there is a paucity of resources available for 
monitoring global climatic change, for surveying the ecosystems of disappearing rain forests 
and spreading deserts, and for developing agricultural technologies appropriate to rainfed, 
tropical agriculture. 
29. Nations are seeking a new era of economic growth. The level of spending on arms 
diminishes the prospects for such an era - especially one that emphasizes the more efficient 
use of raw materials, energy, and skilled human resources. It also has a bearing, albeit indirect, 
on the willingness of rich countries to provide development assistance to developing countries. 
Clearly, there is no simple correspondence between reduced defence spending and increased 
aid. There are other reasons aside from domestic resource constraints for a reluctance to 
expand aid, and nations cannot wait for disarmament before devoting more resources to 
ensuring sustainable development. Nonetheless, increased defence spending puts pressure on 
other budgetary items, and aid is an easy target, despite being a relatively small outlay for most 
donor countries./18 
30. Although redeployment is clearly possible, resources currently employed in military 
applications cannot be redeployed quickly or easily elsewhere in other sectors or other 
countries. There are technical problems in achieving such a transformation, not least the 
contribution made by military spending to jobs in economies with high unemployment. And 
beyond the technical problems are questions of political will. Nonetheless, some countries - 
China, Argentina, and Peru, for example - have recently shown that it is both technically and 
politically possible to make substantial shifts from military to civilian spending within a short 
time./19 
4. World Armaments and the Growth of the 'Arms Culture' 
31. Traditionally, nations have adhered to an 'arms culture'. They find themselves locked into 
arms competitions fuelled among other things by powerful vested interests in the 'military-industrial 
complex' as well as in the armed forces themselves. Industrial nations account for 
most of the military expenditures and the production and transfer of arms in international 
society. However, the influence of this 'arms culture' is not confined to these nations. It is 
present also in the developing world, fostered both by the desire of many governments to seek 
security through acquisition of arms and by a burgeoning world arms trade.
I have here listened to people speaking about financial crises, famine, pollution, 
and social injustice at various levels. As an ecologist, I cannot see any of these 
questions without linking them to the armaments question and to the nuclear issue. 
Poverty generates tensions and conflicts, urban and rural violence. The indigenous 
people are still awaiting solutions for their problems. All this depends on money 
and nevertheless we are spending money on our nuclear programmes. They say 
that this has peaceful objectives. This is not true because precious money is being 
spent on this. 
The greatest crime: the death of hope, the death of all of the rights we all have, 
especially that of the young of believing in a future, the hope for a normal life, a 
difficult life but something that appears as a challenge to live it the best we can. We 
have a right to this chance. 
Cacilda Lanuza 
Brazilian Ecological Movement 
WCED Public Hearing 
Sao Paulo, 28- 29 Oct 1985 
32. Since the early 1960s, military spending in developing countries as a whole has increased 
fivefold. Their share of total spending increased from under one-tenth to almost a quarter of a 
far larger total./20 Some developing countries, such as the Republic of Korea, have achieved a 
high level of development in spite of military spending. But systematic analysis suggests that 
increases in military spending have had negative effects on economic performance./21 
33. Moreover, defence expenditure is one of the most import-intensive of activities, usually 
creating a large secondary demand for imported spares, ammunition, servicing, training, and 
fuel. It has been estimated that 20 per cent of the external debt acquired by non-oil developing 
countries in the decade to 1982 could be attributed to arms imports./22 And high levels of arms 
spending motivated by a variety of reasons have undoubtedly contributed to the severity of the 
crises of development in Africa, where military spending rose, in real terms, by 7.8 per cent per 
annum between 1971 and 1982, and arms imports rose by 18.5 per cent./23 it should be noted in 
this connection that in the case of the Frontline States they have been compelled to expand 
their armed forces because of the threat from South Africa. 
34. The development of an 'arms culture' in many developing countries presents particular 
dangers in the context of environmental and poverty-induced stresses. There are already 
numerous simmering disputes in the Third World - over 40 unresolved - many arising from 
boundaries defined in colonial times. 
35. Sophisticated weapons can help convert the potential into actual conflict. According to the 
UN Group of Governmental Experts on the Relationship Between Disarmament and 
Development: 
There can no longer be the slightest doubt that resource scarcities and ecological 
stresses constitute real and imminent threats to the future well-being of all people and 
nations. These challenges are fundamentally non-military and it is imperative that they 
be addressed accordingly. If this is not recognized, ... there is a grave risk that the 
situation will deteriorate to the point of crisis where, even with low probability of 
success, the use of force could be seen as a way to produce results quickly enough. This 
is far from being a remote possibility. In recent years, there has been a marked tendency
in international relations to use or to threaten to use military force in response to 
non-military challenges to security./24 
36. The situation in many developing countries presents particular dangers in the context of 
environmental and poverty-induced stresses. Large-scale movements of refugees, competition 
for scarce water and fertile lands, deposits of oil and raw materials, ill-defined boundaries, and 
so on all add to tensions and increase possibilities for conflict. The importation of armaments 
by developing countries has increased also because of these real or potential conflicts. It is 
sometimes encouraged by the arms manufacturers because of the important profits that can 
themselves sustain the manufacture of arms in the exporting countries. The export of arms 
have been evaluated at more than $35 billion annually. The arms trade is estimated to have 
absorbed over $300 billion over the last two decades, three-quarters in the form of sales to 
developing countries./25 
III. Towards Security and Sustainable Development 
1. Principles 
37. The first step in creating a more satisfactory basis for managing the interrelationships 
between security and sustainable development is to broaden our vision. Conflicts may arise not 
only because of political and military threats to national sovereignty; they may derive also from 
environmental degradation and the pre-emption of development options. 
38. There are, of course, no military solutions to 'environmental insecurity'. And modern 
warfare can itself create major internationally shared environmental hazards. Furthermore, the 
idea of national sovereignty, has been fundamentally modified by the fact of interdependence 
in the realm of economics, environment, and security. The global commons cannot be managed 
from any national centre: The nation state is insufficient to deal with threats to shared 
ecosystems. Threats to environmental security can only be dealt with by joint management and 
multilateral procedures and mechanisms. 
Environment must also be an approach to development. Environment is a social 
justice issue and environment even is a peace and security issue. The barriers to 
achieving sustainable development are great, as might be expected in a major 
historical transformation, but they are far from insurmountable. 
We approach the millennium in a world in which global interdependence is the 
central reality, but where absolute poverty and environmental degradation cloud our 
vision of a common future, and where a geopolitical climate dominated by nuclear 
terrorism and increasing militarization saps the idealism of the young and the will to 
dream in us all. 
Ralph Torrie 
On Behalf of Canadian Environment, Development and Peace Organizations 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
2. Cooperative Management 
39. Already, environmental stresses are encouraging cooperation among nations, giving some
indication of ways to proceed. Antarctica is subject to a far-reaching agreement that provides a 
collective approach to management. (See Chapter 10.) There are now various institutional 
systems, often of complex and advanced form, to foster bilateral and regional cooperation for 
marine fisheries in order to regulate maximum sustainable yields and the distribution of 
catches. One of the main threats to the oceans the dumping of highly toxic wastes has so far 
been managed by the London Dumping Convention. As for international water bodies, 
impressive progress has been made by the bilateral U.S.-Canadian Commission for the Great 
Lakes. The Mediterranean Convention, only one of the many such treaties concluded within 
the context of the UNEP Regional Seas Programme, brings together coastal nations in an 
arrangement to monitor and combat pollution at sea. 
40. Some of the most challenging problems require cooperation among nations enjoying 
different systems of government, or even subject to antagonistic relations. The 1986 Chernobyl 
reactor accident in the Soviet Union has resulted in two agreements covering international 
cooperation in cases of such accidents. In the future, the nation concerned will immediately 
alert neighbouring states; they, in turn, will offer assistance at cost and free of liability./26 The 
1979 Convention on Transboundary Pollution has provided a framework for monitoring and 
assessing damage from pollutants causing acid rain in Europe./27 
41. Cooperation on environmental issues among developing countries has often been made 
difficult by poor communications. Nonetheless, many now participate in UNEP's Regional Seas 
Programme. The nations of the Sahel have formed a regional organization to deal with 
desertification, and there ie emerging a body of successful case histories with respect to river 
basin development: Witness the joint management programmes in Africa for the Senegal River 
Basin.
Box 11-1 
Spending on Military Versus Environmental Security 
The world spent well over $900 billion on military purposes in 1985, more than $2.5 
billion a day. The real cost is what the same resources might otherwise be used for: 
An Action Plan for Tropical Forests would cost $1.3 billion a year over the 
course of five years. This annual sum is the equivalent of half a day of military 
expenditure worldwide. 
Implementing the UN Action Plan for Desertification would cost $4.5 billion a 
year during the last two decades of this century - the equivalent of less than two 
days of military spending. 
One of the greatest environmental hazards in the Third World is lack of clean 
water for household use, contributing to 80 per cent of disease. The UN Water 
and Sanitation Decade, although given only a small fraction of support needed, 
would have cost $30 billion a year during the 1980s. This is the approximate 
equivalent of 10 days of military spending. 
To supply contraceptive materials to all women already motivated to use family 
planning would cost an additional $1 billion per year on top of the $2 billion 
spent today. This additional $1 billion is the equivalent of 10 hours of military 
spending. 
Sources: International Task Force, Tropical Forests: A Call for Action 
(Washington, DC: World Resources Institute, 1965); Dr M.K. Tolba, 'Desertification 
and the Economics of Survival', UNEP Information 86/2. 25 March 1986; A. 
Agarwal et al., Water, Sanitation and Health for All? (London: IIED/Earthscan, 
1981); World Bank, World Development Report, 1984 (New York: Oxford 
University Press, 1984). 
3. The Importance of Early Warning 
42. Since it is often uncertainty and insecurity that prompts international conflict, it is of the 
utmost importance that governments become aware of imminent environmental stress before 
the damage actually threatens core national interests. Governments are usually not well 
equipped with this kind of foresight. 
43. It would be highly desirable if the appropriate international organizations, including 
appropriate UN bodies and regional organizations, were to pool their resources and draw on 
the most sophisticated surveillance technology available - to establish a reliable early wanting 
system for environmental risks and conflict. (See Chapter 12.) such a system would monitor 
indicators of risks and potential disputes, such as soil erosion, growth in regional migration, 
and uses of commons that are approaching the thresholds of sustainability. The organizations 
would also offer their services for helping the respective countries to establish principles and 
institutions for joint management.
4. Disarmament and Security 
44. Action to reduce environmental threats to security requires a redefinition of priorities, 
nationally and globally. Such a redefinition could evolve through the widespread acceptance of 
broader forms of security assessment and embrace military, political, environmental, and other 
sources of conflict. 
45. A broader approach to security assessment would no doubt find many cases in which 
national, regional, and global security could be enhanced through expenditures quite small in 
relation to the levels of military spending. Four of the most urgent global environmental 
requirements - relating to tropical forests, water, desertification, and population - could be 
funded with the equivalent of less than one month's global military spending. (See Box 11-1.) It 
is difficult to shift budgetary resources, but individual governments have already shown that 
transformation is possible, given political will. In some of the countries most seriously affected 
by environmental stress and poverty, the sums required to alleviate these conditions are small 
in relation to what is now spent on disaster relief, let alone military activities./28 However, 
these sums must be spent quickly, before deteriorating conditions require much larger 
expenditures. 
46. But in terms of the aggregate resources involved in arms spending and the potential throat 
to the environment from war, the greatest need is to improve relations among those major 
powers capable of deploying weapons of mass destruction. This is needed to achieve 
agreement on tighter control over the proliferation and testing of various types of weapons of 
mass destruction nuclear and non-nuclear including those that have environmental 
implications./29 
47. A substantial number of agreements already show the potential for negotiated, multilateral 
solutions. President Reagan and General Secretary Gorbachev made substantial progress 
towards strategic arms agreement, which must be carried forward to reverse the alarming 
trends of several decades. Apparently, the two major powers came close to agreeing on 
intermediate range systems in Europe, to be followed by agreements banning forward 
deployment of shorter range systems. It would alleviate significantly the pressures exercised 
by nuclear weapons on the security order in Europe. In addition, they are moving towards, a 50 
per cent reduction agreement on strategic systems, followed by total elimination agreements. 
They also need to agree on effective measures to prevent an arms race in space. Successful 
negotiations would contribute significantly to stemming the spread of nuclear weapons as the 
major nuclear-weapon states would deliver on their promise to build down their nuclear 
arsenals. Such progress is consistent with the basic needs of our times and the right of 
humanity to have the spectre of nuclear destruction removed from the face of the Earth. 
48. Nations must turn away from the destructive logic of an 'arms culture' and focus instead or 
their common future. The level of armaments and the destruction they could bring about bear 
no relation to the political conflict that triggered the arms competition in the first place. 
Nations must not become prisoners of their own arms race. They must face the common 
danger inherent in the weapon of the nuclear age. They must face the common challenge of 
providing for sustainable development and act in concert to remove the growing environmental 
sources of conflict. 
Footnotes
1/ For some preliminary analyses along these lines, see L. Timberlake and J. Tinker, 
'Environment and Conflict: Links Between Ecological Decay, Environmental Bankruptcy and 
Political and Military Instability, Earthscan Briefing Document. Earthscan, London, 1964; N. 
Myers, 'The Environmental Dimension to Security Issues', The Environmentalist, Winter 
1986; R.H. Ullman, 'Redefining Security', International Security, Summer 1983; and A.H, 
Westing (ed.), Global Resources and International Conflict (Oxford: Oxford University 
Press, 1986). 
2/ E. El-Hinnawi, Environmental Refugees (Nairobi: UNEP, 1985). 
3/ Relief and Rehabilitation Commission, 'Drought and Rehabilitation in Wollo and Tigrai', 
Addis Ababa, 1975. 
4/ L. Timberlake, Africa in Crisis (London: International Institute for Environment and 
Development/Earthscan, 1985). 
5/ Project Paper for Haiti Agroforestry Outreach Project (Project 521-0122), U.S. Agency for 
International Development, Washington, DC, 1981. 
6/ National Park Service/U.S. Man and the Biosphere Secretariat, 'Draft Environmental Profile 
of El Salvador', Bureau of Science and Technology, U.S. Agency for International Development, 
Washington, DC, April 1982. See also T.P. Anderson, The War of the Dispossessed: 
Honduras and El Salvador 1969 (Lincoln, Neb.: University of Nebraska Press, 1981); W.H. 
Durham, Scarcity and Survival in Central America: Ecological Origins of the 
Soccer War (Stanford, Calif.: Stanford University Press, 1979). 
7/ D. Smith, 'Update: Apartheid in South Africa', Queen Mary College, London, 1984. 
8/ M. Falkenmark, 'New Ecological Approach to the Water Cycle: Ticket to the Future', 
Ambio, Vol. 13, No. 3, 1964; S. Postel, Water: Rethinking Management in an Age of 
Scarcity, Worldwatch Paper 62 (Washington, DC: WorldWatch Institute, 1984). 
9/ B. Bolin et al., The Greenhouse Effect: Climatic Change and Ecosystems 
(Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1986); National Research Council, Changing Climate 
(Washington, DC: National Academy Press, 1983); S. Seidel and D. Keyes, Can We Delay a 
Greenhouse Warming? (Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, 1983). 
10/ Independent Commission on Disarmament and Security Issues under the Chairmanship of 
Olof Palme, Common Security (London: Pan Books, 1982). 
11/ SCOPE, Environmental Consequences of Nuclear War (Chichester, UK: John Wiley 
& Sons, 1985). Some of the other major studies on the nuclear winter scenario are R. Turco et 
al., 'Nuclear Winter: Global Consequences of Multiple Nuclear Explosions', Science, 23 
December 1983; P. Ehrlich et al., The Cold and the Dark: The World After Nuclear War 
(New York: W.W. Norton, 1984); M.A. Hartwell and T.C. Hutchinson, Environmental 
Consequences of Nuclear War, Volume II: Ecological and Agricultural Effects 
(Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1985); National Research Council, The Effects on the 
Atmosphere of a Major Nuclear Exchange (Washington, DC: National Academy Press, 
1985); A. Ginsberg et al., 'Global Consequences of a Nuclear War: A Review of Recent Soviet 
Studies', World Armaments and Disarmament, SIPRI Yearbook 1985 (London: 
Taylor & Francis, 1985); A.B. Pittock et al., Environmental Consequences of Nuclear 
War, Volume I: Physical and Atmospheric Effects (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 
1986); S.L. Thompson and S.H. Schneider, 'Nuclear Winter Reappraised', Foreign Affairs, 
Summer 1986. The effects of nuclear war are explored in Y.I. Chazor et al., The Danger of
Nuclear War: Soviet Physicians' Viewpoint (Moscow: Novosti Press, 1982); S. Glasstone 
and P.J. Dolan (eds.), The Effects of Nuclear Weapons, 3rd ed. (Washington, DC: U.S. 
Government Printing office, 1977); National Academy of Sciences, Long-term Worldwide 
Effects of Multiple Nuclear Weapon Detonations (Washington, DC: National Academy 
Press, 1975); Office of Technology Assessment, U.S. Congress, The Effects of Nuclear War 
(Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1980); UN, Comprehensive Study of 
Nuclear Weapons (A/35/392) (New York: 1980); World Health Organization, Effects of 
Nuclear War on Health and Health Services (Geneva: 1984). 
12/ Outright banning of particularly lethal weapons has its origin in the St. Petersburg 
Declaration banning the use of 'dum-dum bullets' and the Hague war rules outlining the use of 
shaped charges (1899). Also relevant are the Geneva Protocol banning the military use of 
chemical and bacteriological weapons (1925); the Convention on the Prohibition of the 
Development, Production, and Stockpiling of Bacteriological and Toxin Weapons (1975); and 
the Convention on the Prohibition of Military or Any Other Hostile Use of Environmental 
Modification Techniques (1978). 
13/ The Eisenhower quote is taken from his final, valedictory address (Speech to the American 
Society of Newspaper Editors Washington, DC, April, 1953) which also includes the more 
famous reference to the 'military-industrial complex'. 
14/ Estimates from R.L. Sivard, World Military and Social Expenditures (Washington, 
DC: World Priorities, Inc., 1986). More details in M. Brzoska et al., 'World Military Expenditure 
and Arms Production', SIPRI Yearbook, op. cit. The figure of total military spending is 
necessarily approximate because of the enormous problems of aggregating spending in 
different - and often non-convertible - currencies and from countries with different statistical 
conventions. According to Sivard, total military spending in 1983 was $728 billion. On the basis 
of trends and preliminary data, a figure of at least $900 billion and possibly $1,000 billion in 
current prices and exchange rates seems appropriate for 1986. 
15/ Sivard, 1986 edition, op. cit., SIPRI Yearbook, op. cit. 
16/ Sivard, 1986 edition, op. cit., SIPRI Yearbook, op. cit. 
17/ M. Ackland-Hood, 'Military Research and Development Expenditure', SIPRI Yearbook, 
op. cit. 
18/ According to calculations based on OECD Development Assistance Committee data, which 
are not universally accepted, together with Sivard, total non-military development aid 
measured in net concessional flows from industrial to developing countries represents roughly 
5 per cent of the amount spent by all industrial countries on armaments. For the United States, 
foreign aid accounts for 4 per cent of armaments spending, and for the USSR, 1.5 per cent. In 
Austria, Denmark, the Netherlands, Norway, and Sweden, by contrast, the proportion is close 
to 30 per cent, and it is over 10 per cent for Australia, Belgium, Canada, France, FRG, and 
Switzerland, 
19/ According to L.H. Brown et al., in State of the World 1986 (London: W.W. Norton, 1986), 
China in 1972 spent 14 per cent of its gross national product (GNP) on military purposes, one of 
the highest levels in the world. Since 1970 (except for 1979), the government has systematically 
reduced this until by 1985 it amounted to only 7.5 per cent In mid 1985 the government 
announced it would cut the armed forces to 3.2 million, a drop of 24 per cent. In Argentina, by 
1984 new President Raul Alfonsin had cut arms outlays to half their peak level of 1980 (nearly 4 
per cent of GNP) by reordering priorities and shifting resources to social programmes.
Peruvian President Alan Garcia Perez, on taking office in mid-1985, announced he would 
reduce military outlays, which then totalled 5 per cent of GNP, or one-quarter of the federal 
budget. First he cancelled half the order for 26 French Mirage fighter planes. 
20/ Over 1960-81, Third World military expenditures grew by some 7 per cent per year, as 
compared with 3.7 per cent in the industrial world. In 1960, Third World military expenditures 
accounted for less than one-tenth of the global total 1981 for more than one fifth of a far larger 
total. R.L. Sivard, World Military and Social Expenditures (Washington, DC: World 
Priorities, Inc., 198b). 
21/ L. Taylor, 'Military Economics in the Third World', prepared for The Independent 
Commission on Disarmament and Security Issues, 1981. 
22/ R. Tullberg, 'Military Related Debt in Non-Oil Developing Countries', SIPRI Yearbook, 
op. cit. 
23/ R. Luckham, 'Militarization in Africa', SIPRI Yearbook, op. cit. 
24/ I. Thorsson et al., Relationship Between Disarmament and Development, 
Disarmament Study Review No. 5 (A/36/536) (New York: UN Department of Political and 
Security Council Affairs, 1982). 
25/ Arms Export from L.R. Brown et al., op. cit, based on U.S. Arms Control and Disarmament 
Agency; estimate of cumulative spending on the arine trade in Sivard, 1985 edition, op. cit. 
26/ 'Negotiations on Agreement Concerning Nuclear Safety Reach Consensus', press release 
(PR8-86/17), IAEA, 15 August 1986. 
27/ 'Convention on Long-Range Transboundary Air Pollution' concluded 13 November 1979 
and entered into force 16 March 1983, summarized in M.J. Bowman and D.J. Harris (eds.), 
Multilateral Treaties: Index and Current Status (London: Butterworths, 1984). 
28/ The amount that the United Nations has recently budgeted for Ethiopia to cater for 
anti-erosion, reforestation, and related measures under its Anti-Desertification Plan suggests 
that no more than $50 million a year would have been required to counter much of the 
highlands' problem if the investment had been undertaken in due time. By contrast, the 
amount required to counter Ethiopia's famine during 1985 amounted to $500 million for relief 
measures alone. Between 1976 and 1980 Ethiopia spent an average of $225 million a year on 
military activities. 
29/ Among international treaties specifically designed to protect the global commons from 
militarization are the Antarctic Treaty (1959); the Moscow Treaty Banning Nuclear Weapons 
Tests in the Atmosphere, in Outer Space and Under Water (1963); the Outer Space Treaty 
(1967); the Treaty of Tlatelolco (1967); the Treaty on the Non Proliferation of Nuclear 
Weapons (1968); and the Sea Bed Treaty (1971).
Our Common Future, Chapter 12: Towards Common Action: 
Proposals For institutional and Legal Change 
The Challenge for Institutional I. and Legal Change 
1. Shifting the Focus to the Policy Sources 
2. New Imperatives for International Cooperation 
II. Proposals for Institutional and Legal Change 
1. Getting at the Sources 
1.1 National Policies and Institutions 
1.2 Regional and Interregional Action 
1.3 Global Institutions and Programmes 
2. Dealing With the Effects 
2.1 National Environmental Protection and Natural 
Resources Management Agencies 
2.2 Strengthen the United Nations Environment Programme 
2.2.1 Focus on Environmental Protection Issues 
2.2.2 Priority to Global Environmental Assessment and Reporting 
2.2.3 Strengthen International Environmental Cooperation 
2.2.4. Increase the Revenue and Focus of the Environment Fund 
3. Assessing Global Risks 
4. Making Informed Choices 
4.1 Increase the Role of the Scientific Community and 
Non-Governmental Organizations 
4.2 Increase Cooperation with Industry
Providing 5. the Legal Means 
5.1 Recognizing Rights and Responsibilities 
5.2 A Universal Declaration and a Convention on 
Environmental Protection and Sustainable Development 
5.3 Strengthen and Extend Existing International 
Conventions and Agreements 
5.4 Avoiding and Settling Environmental Disputes 
6. Investing in Our Future 
6.1 National Action 
6.2 International Action 
6.2.1 Reorienting Multilateral Financial Institutions 
6.2.2 Reorienting Bilateral Aid Agencies 
6.2.3 New Sources of Revenue and Automatic Financing 
III. A Call for Action 
1. In the middle or the 20th century, we saw our planet from space for the first time. 
Historians may eventually find that this vision had a greater impact on thought than did the 
Copernican revolution of the 16th century, which upset humans' self-image by revealing that 
the Earth is not the centre of the universe. From space, we see a small and fragile ball 
dominated not by human activity and edifice but by a pattern of clouds, oceans, greenery, and 
soils. Humanity's inability to fit its activities into that pattern is changing planetary systems 
fundamentally. Many such changes are accompanied by life-threatening hazards, from 
environmental degradation to nuclear destruction. These new realities, from which there is no 
escape, must be recognized - and managed. 
2. The issues we have raised in this report are inevitably of far reaching importance to the 
quality of life on earth - indeed to life itself. We have tried to show how human survival and 
well-being could depend on success in elevating sustainable development to a global ethic. In 
doing so, we have called for such major efforts as greater willingness and cooperation to 
combat international poverty, to maintain peace and enhance security world-wide, and to 
manage the global commons. We have called for national and international action in respect of 
population, food, plant and animal species, energy, industry, and urban settlements. The 
previous chapters have described the policy directions required. 
3. The onus for action lies with no one group of nations. Developing countries face the 
challenges of desertification, deforestation, and pollution, and endure most of the poverty 
associated with environmental degradation. The entire human family of nations would suffer 
from the disappearance of rain forests in the tropics, the loss of plant and animal species, and
changes in rainfall patterns. Industrial nations face the challenges of toxic chemicals, toxic 
wastes, and acidification. All nations may suffer from the releases by industrialized countries 
of carbon dioxide and of gases that react with the ozone layer, and from any future war fought 
with the nuclear arsenals controlled by those nations. All nations will also have a role to play in 
securing peace, in changing trends, and in righting an international economic system that 
increases rather than decreases inequality, that increases rather than decreases numbers of 
poor and hungry. 
In the case of environmental problems, it is obvious that the problems cannot be 
solved by one group, one group working in separation. You cannot say because 
people are dying of poisoning, it is the Ministry of Health that will solve it. Or to 
say because it comes from factories, it is the Ministry of Industry. That is 
impossible. 
I think the problems need a more holistic approach. The United Nations 
Organization, as a professional organization, has developed this fragmentation. It 
started automatically with no bad intention at all. But at the same time, the member 
countries requested and national bodies also requested entry points in recipient 
countries. So WHO corresponds with the Ministry of Health, UNESCO 
corresponds with the Ministry of Education, FAO corresponds with the Ministry of 
Agriculture the fragmentation is getting worse. 
Speaker from the floor 
Government Agency 
WCED Public Hearing 
Jakarta, 26 March 1985 
4. The time has come to break out of past patterns. Attempts to maintain social and ecological 
stability through old approaches to development and environmental protection will increase 
instability. Security must be sought through change. The Commission has noted a number of 
actions that must be taken to reduce risks to survival and to put future development on paths 
that are sustainable. 
5. Without such reorientation of attitudes and emphasis, little can be achieved. We have no 
illusions about 'quick-fix' solutions. We have tried to point out some pathways to the future. 
But there is no substitute for the journey itself, and there is no alternative to the process by 
which we retain a capacity to respond to the experience it provides. We believe this to hold 
true in all the areas covered in this report. But the policy changes we have suggested have 
institutional implications, and it is to these we now turn emphasizing that they are a 
complement to, not a substitute for, the wider policy changes for which we call. Nor do they 
represent definitive solutions, but rather first steps in what will be a continuing process. 
6. In what follows we put forward, in the first place, what are essentially conceptual guidelines 
for institutions at the national level. We recognize that there are large differences among 
countries in respect of population size, resources, income level, management capacity, and 
institutional traditions, only governments themselves can formulate the changes they should 
make. Moreover, the tools for monitoring and evaluating sustainable development are 
rudimentary and require further refinement. 
7. We also address, in more specific terms, the question of international institutions. The 
preceding chapters have major implications for international cooperation and reforms, both
economic and legal. The international agencies clearly have an important role in making these 
changes effective, and we endeavour to set out the institutional implications, especially as 
regards the United Nations system. 
I. The Challenge for Institutional and Legal Change 
1. Shifting the Focus to the Policy Sources 
8. The next few decades are crucial for the future of humanity. Pressures on the planet are now 
unprecedented and are accelerating at rates and scales new to human experience: a doubling 
of global population in a few decades, with most of the growth in cities; a five- to tenfold 
increase in economic activity in less than half a century; and the resulting pressures for growth 
and changes in agricultural, energy, and industrial systems. Opportunities for more 
sustainable forms of growth and development are also growing. New technologies and 
potentially unlimited access to information offer great promise. 
9. Each area of change represents a formidable challenge in its own right, but the fundamental 
challenge stems from their systemic character. They lock together environment and 
development, once thought separate; they lock together 'sectors' such as industry and 
agriculture; and they lock countries together as the effects of national policies and actions spill 
over national borders. Separate policies and institutions can no longer cope effectively with 
these interlocked issues. Nor can nations, acting unilaterally. 
10. The integrated and interdependent nature of the new challenges and issues contrasts 
sharply with the nature of the institutions that exist today. These institutions tend to be 
independent, fragmented, and working to relatively narrow mandates with closed decision 
processes. Those responsible for managing natural resources and protecting the environment 
are institutionally separated from those responsible for managing the economy. The real world 
of interlocked economic and ecological systems will not change; the policies and institutions 
concerned must. 
11. This new awareness requires major shifts in the way governments and individuals approach 
issues of environment, development, and international cooperation. Approaches to 
environment policy can be broadly characterized in two ways. One, characterized as the 
'standard agenda', reflects an approach to environmental policy, laws, and institutions that 
focuses on environmental effects. The second reflects an approach concentrating on the 
policies that are the sources of those effects./1 These two approaches represent distinctively 
different ways of looking both at the issues and at the institutions to manage them. 
12. The effects-oriented 'standard agenda' has tended to predominate as a result of growing 
concerns about the dramatic decline in environmental quality that the industrialized world 
suffered during the 1950s and 1960s. New environmental protection and resource 
management agencies were added on to the existing institutional structures, and given mainly 
scientific staffs./2 
13. These environment agencies have registered some notable successes in improving 
environmental quality during the past two decades./3 They have secured significant gains in 
monitoring and research and in defining and understanding the issues in scientific and 
technical terms. They have raised public awareness, nationally and internationally. 
Environmental laws have induced innovation and the development of new control 
technologies, processes, and products in most industries, reducing the resource content of 
growth./4
14. However, most of these agencies have been confined by their own mandates to focusing 
almost exclusively on the effects. Today, the sources of these effects must be tackled. While 
these existing environmental protection policies and agencies must be maintained and even 
strengthened, governments now need to take a much broader view of environmental problems 
and policies. 
15. Central agencies and major sectoral ministries play key roles in national decision making. 
These agencies have the greatest influence on the form, character, and distribution of the 
impacts of economic activity on the environmental resource base. It is these agencies, through 
their policies and budgets, that determine whether the environmental resource base is 
enhanced or degraded and whether the planet will be able to support human and economic 
growth and change into the next century. 
16. The mandated goals of these agencies include increasing investment, employment, food, 
energy, and other economic and social goods. Most have no mandate to concern themselves 
with sustaining the environmental resource capital on which these goals depend. Those with 
such mandates are usually grouped in separate environment agencies or, sometimes, in minor 
units within sectoral agencies. In either case, they usually learn of new initiatives in economic 
and trade policy, or in energy and agricultural policy, or of new tax measures that will have a 
severe impact on resources, long after the effective decisions have been taken. Even if they 
were to learn earlier, most lack the authority to ensure that a given policy is implemented. 
17. Environmental protection and sustainable development must be an integral part of the 
mandates of all agencies of governments, of international organizations, and of major private-sector 
institutions. These must be made responsible and accountable for ensuring that their 
policies, programmes, and budgets encourage and support activities that are economically and 
ecologically sustainable both in the short and longer terms.They must be given a mandate to 
pursue their traditional goals in such a way that those goals are reinforced by a steady 
enhancement of the environmental resource base of their own national community and of the 
small planet we all share. 
2. New Imperatives for International Cooperation 
18. National boundaries have become so porous that traditional distinctions between local, 
national, and international issues have become blurred. Policies formerly considered to be 
exclusively matters of 'national concern' now have an impact on the ecological bases of other 
nations' development and survival. Conversely, the growing reach of some nations' policies - 
economic, trade, monetary, and most sectoral policies - into the 'sovereign' territory of other 
nations limits the affected nations' options in devising national solutions to their 'own' 
problems. This fast-changing context for national action has introduced new imperatives and 
new opportunities for international cooperation. 
19. The international legal framework must also be significantly strengthened in support of 
sustainable development. Although international law related to environment has evolved 
rapidly since the 1972 Stockholm Conference, major gaps and deficiencies must still be 
overcome as part of the transition to sustainable development. Much of the evidence and 
conclusions presented in earlier chapters of this report calls into question not just the 
desirability but even the feasibility of maintaining an international system that cannot prevent 
one or several states from damaging the ecological basis for development and even the 
prospects for survival of any other or even all other states.
20. However, just at the time when nations need increased international cooperation, the will 
to cooperate has sharply declined. By the mid-1980s, multilateral institutions were under 
siege for many, and often contradictory, reasons. The UN system has come under increasing 
attack for either proposing to do too much or, more frequently, for apparently doing too little. 
Conflicting national interests have blocked significant institutional reforms and have increased 
the need for fundamental change./5 By the mid-1980s, funds for many international 
organizations had levelled off or declined in both relative and absolute terms. 
21. Bilateral development assistance has declined as a percentage of GNP in many industrial 
countries, falling even further below the targets proposed in the early 1970s./6 The benefits 
and effectiveness of aid have come under serious question, in part because of criticism based 
on environmental considerations./7 Yet, sustainable development creates the need for even 
greater international aid and cooperation. 
22. Nations must now confront a growing number, frequency, and scale of crises. A major 
reorientation is needed in many policies and institutional arrangements at the international as 
well as national level. The time has come to break away. Dismal scenarios of mounting 
destruction of national and global potential for development - indeed, of the Earth's capacity 
to support life - are not inescapable destiny. One of the most hopeful characteristics of the 
changes the world is racing through is that invariably they reflect great opportunities for 
sustainable development, providing that institutional arrangements permit sustainable policy 
options to be elaborated, considered, and implemented. 
II. Proposals for Institutional and Legal Change 
23. The ability to choose policy paths that are sustainable requires that the ecological 
dimensions of policy be considered at the same time as the economic, trade, energy, 
agricultural, industrial, and other dimensions - on the same agendas and in the same national 
and international institutions. That is the chief institutional challenge of the 1990s. 
24. There are significant proposals for institutional and legal change in previous chapters of 
our report. The Commission's proposals for institutional and legal change at the national, 
regional, and international levels are embodied in six priority areas: 
getting at the sources, 
dealing with the effects, 
assessing global risks, 
making informed choices, 
providing the legal means, and 
investing in our future. 
Together, these priorities represent the main directions for institutional and legal change 
needed to make the transition to sustainable development. Concerted action is needed under 
all six. 
1. Getting at the Sources
1.1 National Policies and Institutions 
25. The way countries achieve sustainable development will vary among the many different 
political and economic systems around the world. Governments differ greatly in their capacity 
to monitor and evaluate sustainable development, and many will need assistance. Several 
features should be common to most countries. 
26. Sustainable development objectives should be incorporated in the terms of reference of 
those cabinet and legislative committees dealing with national economic policy and planning 
as well as those dealing with key sectoral and international policies. As an extension of this, 
the major central economic and sectoral agencies of governments should now be made directly 
responsible and fully accountable for ensuring that their policies, programmes, and budgets 
support development that is ecologically as well as economically sustainable. 
27. Where resources and data permit, an annual report and an audit on changes in 
environmental quality and in the stock of the nation's environmental resource assets are 
needed to complement the traditional annual fiscal budget and economic development 
plans./8 These are essential to obtain an accurate picture of the true health and wealth of the 
national economy, and to assess progress towards sustainable development./9 
All governments should develop a 'foreign policy for the environment' as one 
major way of improving the international coordination of national environmental 
policies. 
But in the long-term perspective, and here I think the World Commission could 
have an important message, I think that it will be politically sound and wise to get 
support from the NGOs to prepare for changes that have to take place anyway 
sooner or later. So I think it would be politically wise to look into that in a much 
broader way than what has been done so far. 
Mats Segnestam 
Swedish Society for the Conservation of Nature 
WCED Public Hearing 
Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 
28. Governments who have not done so should consider developing a 'foreign policy for the 
environment'./10 A nation's foreign policy needs to reflect the fact that its policies have a 
growing impact on the environmental resource base of other nations and the commons, just as 
the policies of other nations have an impact on its own. This is true of certain energy, 
agricultural, and other sectoral policies discussed in this report, as well as certain foreign 
investment, trade, and development assistance policies and those concerning the import or 
export of hazardous chemicals, wastes, and technology. 
1.2 Regional and Interregional Action 
29. The existing regional and subregional organisations within and outside the UN system 
need to be strengthened and made responsible and accountable for ensuring that their 
programmes and budgets encourage and support sustainable development policies and
practices. In some areas, however, especially among developing countries, new regional and 
subregional arrangements will be needed to deal with transboundary environmental resource 
issues. 
30. Some countries already enjoy comparatively well developed bilateral and regional 
structures, although many of them lack the mandate and support required to carry out the 
greatly expanded role they must assume in the future. These include many specialized 
bilateral organizations such as the Canada/USA International Joint Commission; subregional 
agencies in Europe such as the different Commissions for the Rhine River, the Danube River, 
and the Baltic Sea; and organizations such as the CMEA, OECD, and EEC. These bodies 
provide member countries with a strong foundation on which to build. Although most of them 
have effective programmes for international cooperation on environmental protection and 
natural resources management, these programmes will need to be strengthened and adapted 
to new priorities. The regional organizations in particular need to do more to integrate 
environment fully in their macroeconomic, trade, energy, and other sectoral programmes. 
31. Similar organizations among developing countries should be strengthened, particularly at 
bilateral and subregional levels. Organizations such as the Organization of African Unity, the 
Southern Africa Development Coordination Conference, the Gulf Cooperation Council, the 
Arab League, the Organisation of American States, the Association of South East Asian 
Nations, and the South Asian Association for Regional Cooperation could work together to 
develop contingency plans and the capacity to respond quickly to critical situations and issues. 
They need in such bodies to develop comparable economic and environmental statistics, 
base-line quantity and quality surveys of shared resources, and early-warning capabilities to 
reduce environment and development hazards. They could develop and apply in concert basic 
common principles and guidelines concerning environmental protection and resource use, 
particularly with respect to foreign trade and investment. In this respect, developing countries 
have much to gain through sharing their common experiences and taking common action. 
32. A new focus on the sustainable use and management of transboundary ecological zones, 
systems, and resources is also needed. There are, for example, over 200 distinct biogeographic 
zones in the world. Moreover, most non-island countries in the world share at least one 
international river basin. The entire national territories of nearly one-quarter of those 
countries is part of an international river, basin. Yet over one-third of the 200 major 
international river basins in the world are not covered by any international agreement, and 
fewer than 30 have any cooperative institutional arrangements. These gaps are particularly 
acute in Africa, Asia, and Latin America, which together have 144 international river basins./11 
33. Governments, directly and through UNEP and IUCN, should support the development of 
regional and subregional cooperative arrangements for the protection and sustained use of 
transboundary ecological systems with joint action programmes to combat common problems 
such as desertification and acidification. 
1.3 Global Institutions and Programmes 
34. At the global level, an extensive institutional capacity exists that could be redirected 
towards sustainable development. The United Nations, as the only intergovernmental 
organization with universal membership, should clearly be the locus for new institutional 
initiatives of a global character. 
35. Although the funds flowing to developing countries through UN programmes represents a
relatively small portion of total ODA flows, the UN can and should be a source of significant 
leadership in the transition to sustainable development and in support of developing countries 
in effecting this transition. Under existing conditions the UN system's influence is often 
fragmented and less effective than it might be because of the independent character of the 
specialized agencies and endemic weaknesses of coordination. However, recent moves 
towards organizational reform and greater economy and efficiency could improve the capacity 
of the UN to provide this leadership, and should include sustainable development as an 
important criterion. 
In retrospect, even if the institutional and policy goals of the decade had been 
achieved, one is left with the feeling that most developing countries would be only 
marginally better off than they are today. The reason for this is a striking and 
humbling one. Although governments, environmentalists, and the aid agencies kept 
their eye on the environmental ball during the 1970s and the early 1980s, recent 
events have starkly demonstrated that they were watching the wrong ball. While 
the world was worrying about the environmental impacts of investments, 
controlling pollution, and conserving resources, we collectively failed to notice the 
dramatic decline in what had complacently been called 'renewable resources'. 
David Runnals 
International Institute for Environment and Development 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
36. All major international bodies and agencies of the UN system should be made responsible 
and accountable for ensuring that their programmes and budgets encourage and support 
development policies and practices that are sustainable. Governments, through parallel 
resolutions in the respective governing bodies, should now begin to reorient and refocus the 
mandates, programmes, and budgets of key agencies to support sustainable development. 
They should also insist on much greater coordination and cooperation among them. 
37. Each agency will need to redeploy some staff and financial resources to establish a small 
but high-level centre of leadership and expertise. That centre should be linked to the 
programme planning and budget processes. 
38. Each agency should be directly responsible (or ensuring that the environmental and 
resource aspects of programmes and projects are properly taken into account when they are 
being planned, and that the financial resources needed are provided directly from its own 
budget. In line with these new responsibilities, the following bodies should also assume full 
financial responsibility within their own budgets for certain programmes presently supported 
by the Environment Fund of UNEP: WHO on 'Environmental Health', FAO on 'Agricultural 
Chemicals and Residues', UNDRO on 'Natural Disasters', UNIDO on 'Industry and Transport', 
ILO on 'Working Environment', UNDA on 'Arms Race and the Environment', DIESA on 
'Environmental Aspects of Development Planning and Cooperation', UNESCO on 'Education', 
and UNDP on 'Technical Cooperation'. UNEP (discussed extensively in the next section) 
should continue to cooperate closely with these agencies and help identify new programme 
needs and monitor performance. 
39. As in each agency, there is also a need for a high-level centre of leadership for the UN 
system as a whole with the capacity to assess, advise, assist, and report on progress made and 
needed for sustainable development. That leadership should be provided by the Secretary-
General of the United Nations Organization. 
40. Governments at the UN General Assembly should therefore take the necessary measures 
to reinforce the system-wide responsibility and authority of the UN Secretary-General 
concerning interagency coordination and cooperation generally, and for achieving sustainable 
development specifically. This will require that the representatives of those same governments 
in the governing bodies of all major UN organizations and specialized agencies take 
complementary measures. This could be done as an integral part of the parallel resolutions 
just proposed on building sustainable development objectives and criteria into the mandates, 
programmes, and budget of each agency 
41. To help launch and guide the interagency coordination and cooperation that will be 
needed, the UN Secretary-General should constitute under his chairmanship a special UN 
Board for Sustainable Development. The principal function of the Board would be to agree on 
combined tasks to be undertaken by the agencies to deal effectively with the many critical 
issues of sustainable development that cut across agency and national boundaries. 
2. Dealing With the Effects 
42. Governments should also strengthen the role and capacity of existing environmental 
protection and resource management agencies./12 
2.1 National Environmental Protection and Natural Resources Management 
Agencies 
43. Strengthening of environmental agencies is needed most urgently in developing countries. 
Those that have not established such agencies should do so as a matter of priority. In both 
cases, bilateral and multilateral organizations must be prepared to provide increased 
assistance for institutional development. Some of this increased financial support should go to 
community groups and NGOs, which are rapidly emerging as important and cost-effective 
partners in work to protect and improve the environment locally and nationally, and in 
developing and implementing national conservation strategies. 
44. Industrialized countries also need greatly strengthened environmental protection and 
resource management agencies. Most face a continuing backlog of pollution problems and a 
growing range of environment and resource management problems too. In addition, these 
agencies will be called upon to advise and assist central economic and sectoral agencies he 
they take up their new responsibilities for sustainable development. Many now provide 
institutional support, technical advice, and assistance to their counterpart agencies in 
developing countries, and this need will grow. And, almost inevitably, they will play a larger 
and more direct role in international cooperation, working with other countries and 
international agencies trying to cope with regional and global environmental problems. 
2.2 Strengthen the United Nations Environment Programme 
45. When UNEP was established in 1972, the UN General Assembly gave it a broad and 
challenging mandate to stimulate, coordinate, and provide policy guidance for environmental 
action throughout the UN system./13 That mandate was to be carried out by a Governing 
Council of 58 member states, a high-level UN interagency Environment Coordination Board 
(ECB),/14 a relatively small secretariat located in Nairobi, and a voluntary fund set initially at a
level of $100 million for the first five years. UNEP's principal task was to exercise leadership 
and a catalytic influence on the programmes and projects of other international organizations, 
primarily in but also outside the UN system. Over the past 10 years, the Environment Fund 
has levelled off at around $30 million annually, while its range of tasks and activities have 
increased substantially. 
46. This Commission has recommended a major reorientation and refocusing of programmes 
and budgets on sustainable development in and among all UN organizations. Within such a 
new system-wide commitment to and priority effort on sustainable development, UNEP 
should be the principal source on environmental data, assessment, reporting, and related 
support for environmental management as well as be the principal advocate and agent for 
change and cooperation on critical environment and natural resource protection issues. The 
major priorities and functions of UNEP should be: 
to provide leadership, advice, and guidance in the UN system on restoring, protecting, 
and improving the ecological basis for sustainable development; 
to monitor, assess, and report regularly on changes in the state of the environment and 
natural resources (through its EarthWatch programme); 
to support priority scientific and technological research on critical environmental and 
natural resource protection issues; 
to develop criteria and indicators for environmental quality standards and guidelines for 
the sustainable use and management of natural resources; 
to support and facilitate the development of action plans for key ecosystems and issues 
to be implemented and financed by the governments directly concerned; 
to encourage and promote international agreements on critical issues identified by 
Earthwatch and to support and facilitate the development of international law, 
conventions, and cooperative arrangements for environmental and natural resource 
conservation and protection; 
to support the development of the institutional and professional capacity of developing 
countries in all of these areas and help them develop specific programmes to deal with 
their problems and advise and assist development assistance agencies in this respect; 
and 
to provide advice and assistance to the United Nations Development Programme, the 
World Bank, and other UN organizations and agencies regarding the environmental 
dimensions of their programmes and technical assistance projects, including training 
activities. 
The environment has quickly deteriorated in certain areas and we don't know 
where to put the thresholds for nature's tolerance. We must move very fast 
towards a consensus on the necessity for taking urgent action. There is a strong 
popular support for this in our country. The findings of several opinion polls tell us 
that ecological issues have heightened priority. People feel anxious about the 
legacy our generation will be passing on to the next one. A new environmental 
awareness has germinated among large sections of the community and mainly 
among young people.
Dr. Litre V. Nagy 
Environment Protection Committee of the Patriotic People's Front, Hungary 
WCED Public Hearing 
Moscow, 6 Dec 1986 
2.2.1 Focus on Environmental Protection Issues 
47. UNEP has been a key agent in focusing the attention of governments on critical 
environmental problems (such as deforestation and marine pollution), in helping develop 
many global and regional action plans and strategies (as on desertification), in contributing to 
the negotiation and implementation of international conventions (on Protection of the Ozone 
Layer, for example), and in preparing global guidelines and principles for action by 
governments (such as on marine pollution from land-based sources). UNEP's Regional Seas 
Programme has been particularly successful, and could serve as a model for some other areas 
of special concern, especially international river basins. 
48. UNEP's catalytic and coordinating role in the UN system can and should be reinforced and 
extended. In its future work in critical environmental protection issues, UNEP should focus 
particularly on: 
developing, testing, and helping to apply practical and simple methodologies for 
environmental assessment at project and national levels; 
extending international agreements (such as on chemicals and hazardous wastes) more 
widely; 
extending the Regional Seas Programme; 
developing a similar programme for international river basins; and 
identifying the need for and advising other UN organizations and agencies in 
establishing and carrying out technical assistance and training courses for 
environmental protection and management. 
2.2.2 Priority to Global Environmental Assessment and Reporting 
49. Although more is known about the state of the global environment now than a decade ago, 
there are still major gaps and a limited international capability for monitoring, collecting, and 
combining basic and comparable data needed for authoritative overviews of key environmental 
issues and trends. Without such, the information needed to help set priorities and develop 
effective policies will remain limited. 
50. UNEP, as the main UN source for environmental data, assessment, and reporting, should 
guide the global agenda for scientific research and technological development "or 
environmental protection. To this end, the data collection, assessment, and state of the 
environment reporting sections (Earthwatch) of UNEP need to be significantly strengthened 
as a major priority. The Global Environment Monitoring System should be expanded as rapidly 
as possible, and the development of the Global Resource Information Database should be 
accelerated to bridge the gap between environmental assessment and management. Special 
priority should be accorded to providing support to developing countries to enable them to 
participate fully in and derive maximum benefits from these programmes.
2.2.3 Strengthen International Environmental Cooperation 
51. The UNEP Governing Council cannot fulfil its primary role of providing leadership and 
policy guidance in the UN system nor have a significant influence on national policies unless 
governments increase their participation and the level of representation. National delegations 
to future meetings should preferably be led by Ministers, with their senior policy and scientific 
advisers. Special provisions should be made for expanded and more meaningful participation 
by major non governmental organizations at future sessions. 
2.2.4. Increase the Revenue and Focus of the Environment Fund 
52. The UNEP voluntary funding base of $30 million annually is too limited and vulnerable for 
an international fund dedicated to serving and protecting the common interests, security, and 
future of humanity. Six countries alone provided over 75 per cent of the 1985 contributions to 
the Environment Fund (the United States, Japan, USSR, Sweden, FRG, and UK)./15 
Considering the critical importance of renewed efforts on environmental protection and 
improvement, the Commission appeals to all governments to substantially enlarge the 
Environment Fund both through direct contributions by all members of the UN and through 
some of the sources cited later in this chapter in the section 'Investing in Our Future'. 
53. A substantial enlargement of the Environment Fund seems unlikely in the current climate 
of financial austerity. Any additional funds made available by states for UN development 
programmes and activities will likely be channelled largely through UNDP and the 
development programmes of other UN agencies. Moreover, as recommended earlier, the 
budgets of all of those agencies should be deployed so that environmental considerations are 
built into the planning and implementation of all programmes and projects. 
54. The Environment Fund can be made more effective by refocusing the programme on fewer 
activities. As other UN agencies assume full responsibility for certain activities now provided 
through the Environment Fund and finance them entirely from their own budgets, some 
resources will be released for other purposes. These should be concentrated on the principal 
functions and priority areas identified earlier. 
55. Expanding support and cooperation with NGOs capable of carrying out elements of 
UNEP's programme will also increase the effectiveness of the Environment Fund. Over the last 
decade, non-governmental organizations and networks have become increasingly important in 
work to improve environmental protection locally, nationally, and internationally. However, 
financial support from the Environment Fund for cooperative projects with NGOs declined in 
both absolute and relative terms in the last 10 years, from $4.5 million (23 per cent of the 
Fund) in 1976 to $3.6 million (13 per cent) in 1985./16 The amount and proportion of 
Environment Fund resources for cooperation and projects with NGOs should be significantly 
increased by using the capacities of those NGOs that can contribute to UNEP's programmes on 
a cost-effective basis. 
3. Assessing Global Risks 
56. The future - even a sustainable future - will be marked by increasing risk./17 The risks 
associated with new technologies are growing./18 The numbers, scale, frequency, and impact of 
natural and human-caused disasters are mounting.19/ The risks of irreversible damage to 
natural systems regionally (for example through acidification, desertification, or deforestation) 
and globally (through ozone layer depletion or climate change) are becoming significant./20
57. Fortunately, the capacity to monitor and map Earth change and to assess risk is also 
growing rapidly. Data from remote sensing platforms in space can now be merged with data 
from conventional land-based sources. Augmented by digital communications and advanced 
information analysis, photos, mapping, and other techniques, these data can provide 
up-to-date information on a wide variety of resource, climatic, pollution, and other 
variables./21 High-speed data communications technologies, including the personal computer, 
enable this information to be shared by individuals as well as corporate and governmental 
users at costs that are steadily falling. Concerted efforts should be made to ensure that all 
nations gain access to them and the information they provide either directly or through the 
UNEP Earthwatch and other special programmes. 
58. Governments, individually and collectively, have the principal responsibility to collect their 
information systematically and use it to assess risks, but to date only a few have developed a 
capacity to do so. Some intergovernmental agencies have a capacity to collect and assess 
information required for risk assessment, such as FAO on soil and forest cover and on 
fisheries; WMO on climate; UNEP on deserts, pollutants, and regional seas; quasi-governmental 
organizations like IUCN have a similar capacity. These are only a few examples 
from a long list. But no intergovernmental agency has been recognized as the centre of 
leadership to stimulate work on risk assessment and to provide an authoritative source of 
reports and advice on evolving risks. This gap needs to be filled both within and among 
governments. Beyond our proposal that the global environment assessment and reporting 
functions of UNEP should be significantly strengthened, the Commission would now propose 
that UNEP's Earthwatch be recognized as the centre of leadership on risk assessment in the 
UN system. 
59. But neither UNEP nor other intergovernmental organizations can be expected to carry out 
these important functions alone. To be effective, given the politically sensitive nature of many 
of the most critical risks, intergovernmental risk assessment needs to be supported by 
independent capacities outside of government. Several national science academies and 
international scientific groups such as ICSU and its Scientific Committee on Problems of the 
Environment, with special programmes such as the newly inaugurated International 
Geosphere-Biosphere Programme (see Chapter 10); the Man and the Biosphere Programme of 
UNESCO; quasi-governmental bodies such as IUCN; and certain industry groups and NGOs 
are active in this field. But, again, there is no recognized international non-governmental 
centre of leadership through which the efforts of these groups can be focused and coordinated. 
60. During the 1970s, the growing capacity of computers led various governments, institutes, 
and international bodies to develop models for integrated policy analysis. They have provided 
significant insights and offer great promise as a means of anticipating the consequences of 
interdependent trends and of establishing the policy options to address them./22 Without 
suggesting any relationship between them, early attempts were all limited by serious 
inconsistencies in the methods and assumptions employed by the various sources on which 
they depended for data and information./23 Although significant improvements have been 
made in the capability of models and other techniques, the data base remains weak./24 
61. There is an urgent need to strengthen and focus the capacities of these and other bodies to 
complement and support UNEP's monitoring and assessment functions by providing timely, 
objective, and authoritative assessments and public reports on critical threats and risks to the 
world community. To meet this need, we recommend the establishment of a Global Risks 
Assessment Programme: 
to identify critical threats to the survival, security, or well-being of all or a majority of
people, globally or regionally; 
to assess the causes and likely human, economic, and ecological consequences of those 
threats, and to report regularly and publicly on their findings; 
to provide authoritative advice and proposals on what should or must be done to avoid, 
reduce, or, if possible, adapt to those threats; and 
to provide an additional source of advice and support to governments and 
intergovernmental organizations for the implementation of programmes and policies 
designed to address such threats. 
62. The Global Risk Assessment Programme would not requite the creation of a new 
international institution as such, as it should function primarily as a mechanism for 
cooperation among largely non-governmental national and international organizations, 
scientific bodies, and industry groups. To provide intellectual leadership and guide the 
programme, there should be a steering group composed of eminent individuals who together 
would reflect a broad cross-section of the major areas of knowledge, vocations, and regions of 
the world, as well as the major bodies active in the field. 
63. The steering group would serve as the focal point for identifying the risks to be addressed 
by the programme, agreeing on the research needed to assess those risks, and coordinating 
the work among the various participating bodies. It could form special consortia and task 
forces made up of experts from these bodies and it would also establish special expert and 
advisory groups consisting of world-known authorities in specialized areas of science, 
economics, and law. The steering group would be responsible for the overall evaluation of 
results, for their wide dissemination, and for follow-up activities. 
64. The steering group would also be charged with helping mobilize funds for implementing 
the programme through contributions by the Environment Fund of UNEP, states, 
foundations, and other private sources. Funding would principally be for the purpose of 
financing the various activities that would be carried out by other organizations as part of the 
programme, with only a small portion required to meet the costs of the steering group. 
4. Making Informed Choices 
65. As is evident from this report, the transition to sustainable development will require a 
range of public policy choices that are inherently complex and politically difficult. Reversing 
unsustainable development policies at the national and international level will require 
immense efforts to inform the public and secure its support. The scientific community, private 
and community groups, and NGOs can play a central role in this. 
If the NGO community is to translate its commitment to sustainable development 
into effective action, we will need to see a matching level of commitment from the 
governmental and intergovernmental communities, in genuine partnership with 
NGOs. The success and cost-effectiveness of NGO action is to an important 
degree a function of their spontaneity and freedom of action. 
Both among NGOs and amongst governments, we must find ways to engender a 
new period of international cooperation. The urgency of our tasks no longer 
permits us to spill our energies in fruitless and destructive conflict. Whilst we fight 
our wars of ideology on the face of this planet, we are losing our productive
relationship with the planet itself. 
David Bull 
Environmental Liaison Centre 
WCED Public Hearing 
Nairobi, 23 Sept 1986 
4.1 Increase the Role of the Scientific Community and Non-Governmental 
Organizations 
66. Scientific groups and NGOs have played - with the help of young people/25 - a major part in 
the environmental movement from its earliest beginnings. Scientists were the first to point out 
evidence of significant environmental risks and changes resulting from the growing intensity of 
human activities. Other non-governmental organizations and citizens' groups pioneered in the 
creation of public awareness and political pressures that stimulated governments to act. 
Scientific and non-governmental communities played a vital role in the United Nations 
Conference on the Human Environment in Stockholm./26 
67. These groups have also played an indispensable role since the Stockholm Conference in 
identifying risks, in assessing environmental impacts and designing and implementing 
measures to deal with them, and in maintaining the high degree of public and political interest 
required as a basis for action. Today, major national 'State of the Environment' reports are 
being published by some NGOs (in Malaysia, India, and the United States, for instance)./27 
Several international NGOs have produced significant reports on the status of and prospects 
for the global environment and natural resources./28 
68. The vast majority of these bodies are national or local in nature, and a successful transition 
to sustainable development will require substantial strengthening of their capacities. To an 
increasing extent, national NGOs draw strength from association with their counterparts in 
other countries and from participation in international programmes and consultations. NGOs 
in developing countries are particularly in need of international support - professional and 
moral as well as financial - to carry out their roles effectively. 
69. Many international bodies and coalitions of NGOs are now in place and active. They play an 
important part in ensuring that national NGOs and scientific bodies have access to the support 
they require. These include regional groups providing networks linking together environment 
and development NGOs in Asia, Africa, Eastern and Western Europe, and North and South 
America. They also include a number of regional and global coalitions on critical issues such as 
pesticides, chemicals, rain, seeds, genetic resources, and development assistance. A global 
network for information exchange and joint action is provided through the Environment 
Liaison Centre (ELC) in Nairobi. ELC has over 230 NGO member groups, with the majority 
from developing countries, and is in contact with 7,000 others. 
70. Only a few international NGOs deal on a broad basis with both environment and 
development issues, but this is changing rapidly. One of them, the International Institute for 
Environment and Development, has long specialized in these issues and pioneered the 
conceptual basis for the environment/development relationship. Most of them work with and 
support related organizations in the developing world. They facilitate their participation in 
international activities and their links with counterparts in the international community. They 
provide instruments for leadership and cooperation among a wide variety of organizations in 
their respective constituencies. These capabilities will be ever more important in the future.
An increasing number of environment and development issues could not be tackled without 
them. 
71. NGOs should give a high priority to the continuation of their present networking on 
development cooperation projects and programmes, directed at the improvement of the 
performance of NGO bilateral and multilateral development programmes. They could increase 
their efforts to share resources, exchange skills, and strengthen each other's capacities 
through greater international cooperation in this area. In setting their own house in order, 
'environment' NGOs should assist 'development' NGOs in reorienting projects that degrade 
the environment and in formulating projects that contribute to sustainable development. The 
experience gained would provide a useful basis for continuing discussions with bilateral and 
multilateral agencies as to steps that these agencies might take to improve their performance. 
72. In many countries, governments need to recognize and extend NGOs' right to know and 
have access to information on the environment and natural resources; their right to be 
consulted and to participate in decision making on activities likely to have a significant effect 
on their environment; and their right to legal remedies and redress when their health or 
environment has been or may be seriously affected. 
73. NGOs and private and community groups can often provide an efficient and effective 
alternative to public agencies in the delivery of programmes and projects. Moreover, they can 
sometimes reach target groups that public agencies cannot. Bilateral and multilateral 
development assistance agencies, especially UNDP and the World Bank, should draw upon 
NGOs in executing programmes and projects. At the national level, governments, foundations, 
and industry should also greatly extend their cooperation with NGOs in planning, monitoring, 
and evaluating as well as in carrying out projects when they can provide the necessary 
capabilities on a cost-effective basis. To this end, governments should establish or strengthen 
procedures for official consultation and more meaningful participation by NGOs in all relevant 
intergovernmental organizations. 
74. International NGOs need substantially increased financial support to expand their special 
roles and functions on behalf of the world community and in support of national NGOs. In the 
Commission's view, the increased support that will allow these organizations to expand their 
services represents an indispensable and cost-effective investment. The Commission 
recommends that these organizations be accorded high priority by governments, foundations, 
and other private and public sources of funding. 
4.2 Increase Cooperation with Industry 
75. Industry is on the leading edge of the interface between people and the environment. It is 
perhaps the main instrument of change that affects the environmental resource bases of 
development, both positively and negatively. (See Chapter 8.) Both industry and government, 
therefore, stand to benefit from working together more closely. 
76. World industry has taken some significant steps through voluntary guidelines concerning 
industry practices on environment, natural resources, science, and technology. Although few 
of these guidelines have been extended to or applied regionally in Africa, Asia, or Latin 
America, industry continues to address these issues through various international 
associations. 
77. These efforts were advanced significantly by the 1984 World Industry Conference on 
Environmental Management (WICEM)./29 Recently, as a follow-up to WICEM, several major
corporations from a number of developed countries formed the International Environment 
Bureau to assist developing countries with their environment/development needs. Such 
initiatives are promising and should be encouraged. Cooperation between governments and 
industry would be further facilitated if they established joint advisory councils for sustainable 
development - for mutual advice, assistance, and cooperation in helping to shape and 
implement policy, laws, and regulations for more sustainable forms of development. 
Internationally, governments in cooperation with industry, and NGOs should work through 
appropriate regional organizations to develop basic codes of conduct for sustainable 
development, drawing on and extending relevant existing voluntary codes, especially in Africa, 
Asia, and Latin America. 
78. The private sector also has a major impact on development through commercial bank loans 
from within and outside countries. In 1983, for example, the proportion of the total net 
receipts of developing countries from private sources, mostly in the form of commercial bank 
loans, was greater than all ODA that year. Since 1963, as indebtedness worsened, commercial 
bank lending to developing countries has declined./30 
79. Efforts are being made to stimulate private investment. These efforts should be geared to 
supporting sustainable development. The industrial and financial corporations making such 
investments, and the export credit, investment insurance, and other programmes that 
facilitate them, should incorporate sustainable development criteria into their policies. 
5. Providing the Legal Means 
80. National and international law has traditionally lagged behind events. Today, legal regimes 
are being rapidly outdistanced by the accelerating pace and expanding scale of impacts on the 
environmental base of development. Human laws must be reformulated to keep human 
activities in harmony with the unchanging and universal laws of nature. There is an urgent 
need; 
to recognize and respect the reciprocal rights and responsibilities of individuals and 
states regarding sustainable development, 
to establish and apply new norms for state and interstate behaviour to achieve 
sustainable development, 
to strengthen and extend the application of existing laws and international agreements 
in support of sustainable development, and 
to reinforce existing methods and develop new procedures for avoiding and resolving 
environmental disputes. 
5.1 Recognizing Rights and Responsibilities 
81. Principle 1 of the 1972 Stockholm Declaration said that 'Man has the fundamental right to 
freedom, equality and adequate conditions of life, in an environment of a quality that permits a 
life of dignity and well-being'./31 It further proclaimed the solemn responsibility of 
governments to protect and improve the environment for both present and future 
generations. After the Stockholm Conference, several states recognized in their Constitutions 
or laws the right to an adequate environment and the obligation of the state to protect that 
environment.
82. Recognition by states of their responsibility to ensure an adequate environment for 
present as well as future generations is an important step towards sustainable development. 
However, progress will also be facilitated by recognition of, for example, the right of 
individuals to know and have access to current information on the state of the environment 
and natural resources, the right to be consulted and to participate in decision making on 
activities likely to have a significant effect on the environment, and the right to legal remedies 
and redress for those whose health or environment has been or may be seriously affected. 
What are we to do? It is axiomatic that we as individuals or groups of individuals 
share territory in resources. We need to define common norms of behaviour. This 
is true whether we are speaking of a family, small town, a province or country, or 
the world community. However, the definition of common norms of behaviour is 
not in itself sufficient for the creation of a body of rules and regulation. 
To operate effectively, certain basic conditions must be fulfilled: the existence of a 
general will among members of the community to accept and adhere to 
regulations; the existence of a political framework not only for defining and 
quantifying common behaviour or norms, but also for adopting existing rules to 
change within the community; a means of determining compliance with 
international rules and regulations; and, finally, the means for enforcement. 
Fergus Watt 
World Association of World Federalists 
WCED Public Hearing 
Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 
83. The enjoyment of any right requires respect for the similar rights of others, and 
recognition of reciprocal and even joint responsibilities. States have a responsibility towards 
their own citizens and other states: 
to maintain ecosystems and related ecological processes essential for the functioning of 
the biosphere; 
to maintain biological diversity by ensuring the survival and promoting the conservation 
in their natural habitats of all species of flora and fauna; 
to observe the principle of optimum sustainable yield in the exploitation of living natural 
resources and ecosystems; 
to prevent or abate significant environmental pollution or harm; 
to establish adequate environmental protection standards; 
to undertake or require prior assessments to ensure that major new policies, projects, 
and technologies contribute to sustainable development; and 
to make all relevant information public without delay in all cases of harmful or 
potentially harmful releases of pollutants, especially radioactive releases. 
84. It is recommended that governments take appropriate steps to recognize these reciprocal 
rights and responsibilities./32 However, the wide variation in national legal systems and
practices makes it impossible to propose an approach that would be valid everywhere. Some 
countries have amended their basic laws or constitution; others are considering the a 'option 
of a special national law or charter setting out the rights and responsibilities of citizens and the 
state regarding environmental protection and sustainable development Others may wish to 
consider the designation of a national council or public representative or 'ombudsman' to 
represent the interests and rights of present and future generations and act as an 
environmental watchdog, alerting governments and citizens to any emerging threats. 
5.2 A Universal Declaration and a Convention on Environmental Protection 
and Sustainable Development 
85. Building on the 1972 Stockholm Declaration, the 1982 Nairobi Declaration, and many 
existing international conventions and General Assembly resolutions, there is now a need to 
consolidate and extend relevant legal principles in a new charter to guide state behaviour in 
the transition to sustainable development. It would provide the basis for, and be subsequently 
expanded into, a Convention, setting out the sovereign rights and reciprocal responsibilities of 
all states on environmental protection and sustainable development. The charter should 
prescribe new norms for state and interstate behaviour needed to maintain livelihoods and life 
on our shared planet, including basic norms for prior notification, consultation, and 
assessment of activities likely to have an impact on neighbouring states or global commons. 
These could include the obligation to alert and inform neighbouring states in the event of an 
accident likely to have a harmful impact on their environment. Although a few such norms 
have evolved in some bilateral and regional arrangements, the lack of wider agreement on such 
basic rules for interstate behaviour undermines both the sovereignty and economic 
development potential of each and all states. 
86. We recommend that the General Assembly commit itself to preparing a universal 
Declaration and later a Convention on environmental protection and sustainable development. 
A special negotiating group could be established to draft a Declaration text for adoption in 
1986. Once it is approved, that group could then proceed to prepare a Convention, based on 
and extending the principles in the Declaration, with the aim of having an agreed Convention 
text ready for signature by states within three to five years. To facilitate the early launching of 
that process the Commission has submitted for consideration by the General Assembly, and as 
a starting point for the deliberations of the special negotiating group, a number of proposed 
legal principles embodied in 22 Articles which were prepared by its group of international legal 
experts. These proposed principles are submitted to assist the General Assembly in its 
deliberations and have not been approved or considered in detail by the Commission. A 
summary of the principles and Articles appears as Annexe 1 of this report. 
5.3 Strengthen and Extend Existing International Conventions and 
Agreements 
87. In parallel, governments should accelerate their efforts to strengthen and extend existing 
and more specific international conventions and cooperative arrangements by: 
acceding to or ratifying existing global and regional conventions dealing with 
environment and development, and applying them with more vigour and rigour; 
reviewing and revising those relevant conventions that need to be brought in line with 
the latest available technical and scientific information; and
negotiating new global and regional conventions or arrangements aimed at promoting 
cooperation and coordination in the field of environment and development (including, 
for example, new conventions and agreements on climate change, on hazardous 
chemicals and wastes, and on preserving biological diversity). 
Law does not stand alone. It depends on the functioning of many things. 
Experience from the past 15 years of development has taught us that there is a 
danger that bureaucracy with all its strength coming from the West, in Indonesia's 
case because of the oil and gas revenues, will strangle the community with so 
many laws. They have, for instance, laws that ask every gathering of five or more 
people to have permission from the police. Sometimes I feel that maybe the best 
government is the one who governs the least. In this case, I feel that sometimes 
the Asian countries learn from each other. 
Adi Sasono 
Institute for Development Studies 
WCED Public Hearing 
Jakarta, 26 March 1985 
88. It is recommended that the UNEP secretariat, in close cooperation with the IUCN 
Environmental Law Centre, should help in these efforts. 
5.4 Avoiding and Settling Environmental Disputes 
89. Many disputes can be avoided or more readily resolved if the principles, rights, and 
responsibilities cited earlier are built into national and international legal frameworks and are 
fully respected and implemented by many states. Individuals and states are more reluctant to 
act in a way that might lead to a dispute when, as in many national legal systems, there is an 
established and effective capacity as well as ultimately binding procedures for settling 
disputes. Such a capacity and procedures are largely lacking at the international level, 
particularly environmental and natural resource management issues./33 
90. it is recommended that public and private organizations and NGOs help in this area by 
establishing special panels or rosters of experts with experience in various forms of dispute 
settlement and special competence on the legal and substantive aspects of environmental 
protection, natural resources management, and sustainable development. In addition, a 
consolidated inventory and referral system or network for responding to requests for advice 
and assistance should be established in avoiding or receiving such disputes. 
91. To promote the peaceful and early settlement of international disputes on environmental 
and resource management problems, it is recommended that the following procedure be 
adopted. States should be given up to 18 months to reach mutual agreement on a solution or 
on a common dispute settlement arrangement. If agreement is not reached, then the dispute 
can be submitted to conciliation at the request of any one of the concerned states and, if still 
unresolved, thereafter to arbitration or judicial settlement. 
92. This proposed new procedure raises the possibility of invoking a binding process of 
dispute settlement at the request of any state. Binding settlement is not the preferred method 
for settling international disputes. But such a provision is now needed not only as a last resort 
to avoid prolonged disputes and possible serious environmental damage, but also to
encourage and provide an incentive for all parties to reach agreement within a reasonable time 
on either a solution or a mutually agreed means, such as mediation. 
93. The capabilities of the Permanent Court of Arbitration and the International Court of 
Justice to deal with environmental and resource management problems also should be 
strengthened. States should make greater use of the World Court's capacity under Article 26 
of its Statute to form special chambers for dealing with particular cases or categories of cases, 
including environmental protection or resource management cases. The Court has declared its 
willingness and readiness to deal with such cases fully and promptly. 
6. Investing in Our Future 
94. We have endeavoured to show that: it makes long-term economic sense to pursue 
environmentally sound policies. But potentially very large financial outlays will be needed in 
the short term in such fields as renewable energy development, pollution control equipment, 
and integrated rural development. Developing countries will need massive assistance for this 
purpose, and more generally to reduce poverty. Responding to this financial need will be a 
collective investment in the future 
6.1 National Action 
95. Past experience teaches us that these outlays would be good investments. By the late 
1960s, when some industrial countries began to mount significant environmental protection 
programmes, they had already incurred heavy economic costs in the form of damage to human 
health, property, natural resources, and the environment. After 1970, in order to roll back 
some of this damage, they saw expenditures on environmental pollution measurer, alone rise 
from about 0.3 per cent of GNP in 1970 to somewhere between 1.5 per cent and, in some 
countries, 2.0 per cent around the end of the decade. Assuming low levels of economic growth 
in the future, these same countries will probably have to increase expenditures on 
environmental protection somewhere between 20 to 100 per cent just to maintain current 
levels of environmental quality./34 
First, if the problems of environmental degradation and of poverty, particularly in 
the Third World, are to be solved, a continued economic development is essential. 
Second, we must reconcile environmental protection with economic growth. There 
is a growing consensus that this is perfectly possible and desirable. Third, there is 
also a great consensus that the application of strict environmental standards is 
good for economic growth, as well as for the environment, and that they 
encourage innovation, promote inventiveness and efficiency, and generate 
employment. Fourth, to achieve the goals of sustainable development, good 
environment, and decent standards of life for all involves very large changes in 
attitude. 
Stanley Clinton-Davis 
Commissioner for Environment European Economic Community 
WCED Public Hearing 
Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 
96. These figures relate only to expenditures to control environmental pollution.
Unfortunately, similar figures are not available on the level of expenditures made to 
rehabilitate lands and natural habitats, re-establish soil fertility, reforest areas, and undertake 
other measures to restore the resource base. But they would be substantial. 
97. Nations, industrial and developing, that did not make these investments have paid much 
more in terms of damage costs to human health, property, natural resources, and the 
environment. And these costs continue to rise at an accelerating pace. Indeed, countries that 
have not yet instituted strong programmes now face the need for very large investments. Not 
only do they need to roll back the first generation of environmental damage, they also need to 
begin to catch up with the rising incidence of future damage. If they do not, their fundamental 
capital assets, their environmental resources, will continue to decline. 
98. In strictly economic terms, the benefits of these expenditures have been generally greater 
than the costs in those countries that have made them./35 Beyond that, however, many of 
these countries found that economic, regulatory, and other environmental measures could be 
applied in ways that would result in innovation by industry. And those companies that did 
respond innovatively are today often in the forefront of their industry. They have developed 
new products, new processes, and entire plants that use less water, energy, and other 
resources per unit of output and are hence more economic and competitive. 
99. Nations that begin to reorient major economic and sectoral policies along the lines 
proposed in this report can avoid much higher future levels of spending on environmental 
restoration and curative measures and also enhance their future economic prospects. By 
making central and sectoral agencies directly responsible for maintaining and enhancing 
environmental and resource stocks, expenditures for environmental protection and resource 
management would gradually be built into the budgets of those agencies for measures to 
prevent damage. The unavoidable costs of environmental and resource management would 
thus be paid only once. 
We must have a true participation of all of the society in the decision-making and 
More particularly in the allocation of resources. And why so? because all of us are 
perfectly aware that there will never be sufficient resources for everything that we 
wish, but if the population participates in the decision making it will benefit those 
who need the most and it will express their thought about the allocation of 
resources and it will give us the certainty that that which is bring done is the 
legitimate aspiration of the people. 
Aristides Marquee 
National Council for Urban Development 
WCED Public Hearing 
Brasilia, 30 Oct 1985 
6.2 International Action 
100. Developing countries, as noted earlier, need a significant increase in financial support 
from international sources for environmental restoration, protection, and improvement and to 
help them through the necessary transition to sustainable development. 
101. At the global level, there is an extensive institutional capacity to channel this support. 
This consists of the United Nations and its specialized agencies: the multilateral development
banks, notably the World Bank; other multilateral development cooperation organizations, 
such as those of the European Economic Community; national development assistance 
agencies, most of whom cooperate within the framework of the Development Assistance 
Committee of OECD or of OPEC; and other international groups, such as the Consultative 
Group on International Agricultural Research, that play an important role and influence on 
the quality and nature of development assistance. Together, the development organizations 
and agencies are responsible for the transfer of about $35 billion of ODA annually to 
developing countries. In addition, they are the source of most technical assistance and policy 
advice and support to developing countries. 
102. These organizations and agencies are the principal instruments through which the 
development partnership between industrial and developing countries operates and, 
collectively, their influence is substantial and pervasive. It is imperative that they play a 
leading role in helping developing countries make the transition to sustainable development. 
Indeed, it is difficult to envisage developing countries making this transition in an effective 
and timely manner without their full commitment and support. 
6.2.1 Reorienting Multilateral Financial Institutions 
103. The World Bank, IMF, and Regional Development Banks warrant special attention 
because of their major influence on economic development throughout the world. As indicated 
in Chapter 3, there is an urgent need for much larger flows of concessional and 
non-concessional finance through the multilateral agencies. The role of the World Bank is 
especially important in this respect, both as the largest single source of development lending 
and for its policy leadership, which exerts a significant influence on both developing countries 
and donors. The World Bank has taken a significant lead in reorienting its lending 
programmes to a much higher sensitivity to environmental concerns and to support for 
sustainable development. This is a promising beginning. But it will not be enough unless and 
until it is accompanied by a fundamental commitment to sustainable development by the 
World Bank and the transformation of its internal structure and processes so as to ensure its 
capacity to carry this out. The same is true of other multilateral development banks and 
agencies. 
104. The IMF also exerts a major influence on the development policies of developing 
countries and, as described in Chapter 3, there is deep concern in many countries that the 
conditions that accompany its lending are undermining sustainable development. It is 
therefore essential that the IMF, too, incorporate sustainable development objectives and 
criteria into its policies and programmes. 
105. Several countries have already formally instructed their representatives on the Board of 
the World Bank to ensure that the environmental impacts of projects proposed for approval 
have been assessed and adequately taken into account. We recommend that other 
governments take similar action, not only with regard to the World Bank but also in the 
Regional Banks and the other institutions. In this way they can support the ongoing efforts 
within the Banks and other institutions to reorient and refocus their mandates, programmes, 
and budgets to support sustainable development. The transition to sustainable development 
by the development assistance agencies and the IMF would be facilitated by the establishment 
of a high-level office in each agency with the authority and resources to ensure that all policies, 
projects, and loan conditions support sustainable development, and to prepare and publish 
annual assessments and reports on progress made and needed. A first step is to develop 
simple methodologies for such assessments, recognizing that they are at present experimental 
and need further work.
106. In making these changes, the multilateral financial institutions fortunately have some 
base on which to build. In 1980, they endorsed a Declaration of Environmental Policies and 
Procedures Relating to Economic Development. Since then they have been meeting and 
consulting through the Committee of International Development Institutions on the 
Environment (CIDIE)./36 Some have articulated clear policies and project guidelines for 
incorporating environmental concerns and assessments into their planning and decision 
making, but only a few have assigned staff and resources to implementing them, notably the 
World Bank, which is now considering even further institutional changes to strengthen this 
work. Overall, as pointed out by the UNEP Executive Director in his statement reviewing the 
first five years of work. CIDIE has not yet truly succeeded in getting environmental 
considerations firmly ingrained in development policies. "There has been a distinct lack of 
action by several multilaterals." CIDIE members have "gone along with the Declaration in 
principle more than in major shifts in action."/37 
107. In order to marshal and support investing its in conservation projects and national 
conservation strategies that enhance the resource base for development, serious consideration 
should be given to the development of a special international banking programme or facility/38 
linked to the World Bank. Such a special conservation banking programme or facility could 
provide leans and facilitate joint financing arrangements for the development and protection 
of critical habitats and ecosystems, including those of international significance, 
supplementing efforts by bilateral aid agencies, multilateral financial institutions, and 
commercial banks. 
106. In the framework of the Council of Mutual Economic Assistance (CMEA), there has been 
since the early 1970s a Committee for Environmental Protection with the participation of the 
heads of appropriate organizations in the member states. This Committee coordinates the 
relevant research and development programmes and, in some cases, organizes technical 
assistance for the interested member states, involving the Investment Bank of CMEA. 
6.2.2 Reorienting Bilateral Aid Agencies 
109. Bilateral aid agencies presently provide nearly four times as much total ODA as is 
provided by international organizations. As indicated in Chapter 3, a new priority and focus in 
bilateral aid agencies is needed in three main areas: 
new measures to ensure that all projects support sustainable development; 
special programmes to help restore, protect, and improve the ecological basis for 
development in many developing countries; and 
special programmes for strengthening the institutional and professional capacities 
needed for sustainable development. 
110. Proposals for special bilateral aid programmes in the areas of agriculture, forestry, energy, 
industry, human settlements, and genetic resources are made in earlier chapters of this 
report. The first two priority areas in this chapter also contain proposals for strengthening the 
institutional and professional capacities in developing countries. The focus here is therefore 
on the first area: new measures to ensure that all bilateral aid projects support sustainable 
development. 
The problems of today do not come with a tag marked energy or economy or
CO2 or demography, nor with a label indicating a country or a region. The 
problems are multi-disciplinary and transnational or global. 
The problems are not primarily scientific and technological. In science we have the 
knowledge and in technology the tools. The problems are basically political, 
economic, and cultural. 
Per Lindblom 
International Federation of Institutes of Advanced Studies 
WCED Public Hearing 
Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 
111. Over the past decade, bilateral aid agencies have gradually given more attention to the 
environmental dimensions of their programmes and projects. A 1980 survey of the 
environmental and practices of six major bilateral aid agencies indicated that only one, USAID, 
had systematic and enforceable procedures backed by the staff resources necessary to carry 
them out./39 Since then, others have made some progress on the policy level, increased funds 
for environmental projects, and produced guidelines or checklists to guide their programmes. 
However, a 1983 study of those guidelines concluded that there was little evidence of their 
systematic application./40 
112. An important step towards concerted action was taken in 1986 with the adoption by OECD 
of a recommendation to member governments to include an environmental assessment policy 
and effective procedures for applying it in their bilateral aid programmes./41 It is based on a 
detailed analysis and studies carried out by a joint group of governmental experts from both 
the Development Assistance Committee and the Environmental Committee./42 The 
recommendation includes proposals for adequate staff and financial resources to undertake 
environmental assessments and a central office in each agency to supervise implementation 
and to assist developing countries wishing to improve their capacities for conducting 
environmental assessments. We urge all bilateral aid agencies to implement this 
recommendation as quickly as possible, it is essential, of course, that this should not reduce 
aid flows in the aggregate or slow disbursements or represent a new form of aid conditionality. 
6.2.3 New Sources of Revenue and Automatic Financing 
113. We have made a series of proposals for institutional change within and among the 
organizations and specialized agencies of the UN system in the sections on 'Getting at the 
Sources' and 'Dealing with the Effects'. Most of those changes will not require additional 
financial resources but can be achieved through a reorientation of existing mandates, 
programmes, and budgets and a redeployment of present staff. Once implemented, those 
measures will make a major difference in the effective use of existing resources in making the 
transition to sustainable development. 
114. Nevertheless, there is also a need to increase the financial resources for new multilateral 
efforts and programmes of action for environmental protection and sustainable development. 
These new funds will not be easy to come by if the international organizations through which 
they flow have to continue to rely solely on traditional sources of financing: assessed 
contributions from governments, voluntary contributions by governments, and funds 
borrowed in capital markets by the World Bank and other international financial institutions. 
115. Assessed contributions from governments have traditionally been used largely for the 
administrative and operating costs of international organizations; they are not intended for
multilateral assistance. The total assessed contributions from governments are much smaller 
than the amount provided through voluntary contributions and the prospects of raising 
significant, additional funds through assessed contributions are limited. 
116. Voluntary contributions by governments give the overall revenue system some flexibility, 
but they cannot be adjusted readily to meet new or increased requirements. Being voluntary, 
the flow of these funds is entirely discretionary and unpredictable. The commitments are also 
extremely short-term, as pledges are normally made only one or two years in advance. 
Consequently, they provide little security or basis for effective planning and management of 
international actions requiring sustained, longer-term efforts. Most of the limited funds 
provided so far for international environmental action have come through voluntary 
contributions, channelled principally through UNEP and NGOs. 
117. Given the current constraints on major sources and modes of funding, it is necessary to 
consider new approaches as well as new sources of revenue for financing international action 
in support of sustainable development. The Commission recognizes that such proposals may 
not appear politically realistic at this point in time. It believes, however, that - given the trends 
discussed in this report - the need to support sustainable development will become so 
imperative that political realism will come to require it. 
118. The search for other, and especially more automatic, sources and means for financing 
international action goes almost as far back as the UN itself. It was not until 1977, however, 
when the Plan of Action to Combat Desertification was approved by the UN General Assembly 
that governments officially accepted, but never implemented, the principle of automatic 
transfers. That Plan called for the establishment of a special account that could draw resources 
not only from traditional sources but also from additional measures of financing, 'including 
fiscal measures entailing automaticity'./43 
119. Since then, a series of studies and reports/44 have identified and examined a growing list 
of new sources of potential revenue, including: 
revenue from the use of international commons (from ocean fishing and transportation, 
from sea-bed mining, from Antarctic resources, or from parking charges for 
geostationary communications satellites, for example; 
taxes on international trade (such as a general trade tax; taxes on specific traded 
commodities, on invisible exports, or on surpluses in balance of trade; or a consumption 
tax on luxury goods); and 
international financial measures (a link between special drawing rights and development 
finance, for example, or IMF gold reserves and sales). 
120. In its 1980 report, the Brandt Commission called for raising additional funds from more 
automatic sources such as those cited above. In its follow-up report in 1983, the Brandt 
Commission strongly urged that these most 'futuristic' of all the Report's proposals not be lost 
completely from view./45 Nevertheless, they again rank below the short term horizon of the 
international agenda. 
121. The World Commission on Environment and Development was specifically given the 
mandate by the UN General Assembly to look once again beyond that limited horizon. We have 
done so and, given the compelling nature, pace, and scope of the different transitions affecting 
our economic and ecological systems as described in this report, we consider that at least some 
of those proposals for additional and more automatic sources of revenue are fast becoming
less futuristic and more necessary. This Commission particularly considers that the proposals 
regarding revenue from the use of international commons and natural resources now warrant 
and should receive serious consideration by governments and the General Assembly. 
III. A Call for Action 
122. Over the course of this century, the relationship between the human world and the planet 
that sustains it has undergone a profound change. When the century began, neither human 
numbers nor technology had the power to radically alter planetary systems. As the century 
closes, not only do vastly increased human numbers and their activities have that power, but 
major, unintended changes are occurring in the atmosphere, in soils, in waters, among plants 
and animals, and in the relationships among all of these. The rate of change is outstripping the 
ability of scientific disciplines and our current capabilities to assess and advise. It is frustrating 
the attempts of political and economic institutions, which evolved in a different, more 
fragmented world, to adapt and cope. It deeply worries many people who are seeking ways to 
place those concerns on the political agendas. 
123. We have been careful to base our recommendations on the realities of present 
institutions, on what can and must be accomplished today. But to keep options open for future 
generations, the present generation must begin now, and begin together, nationally and 
internationally. 
124. To achieve the needed change in attitudes and reorientation of policies and institutions, 
the Commission believes that an active follow-up of this report is imperative. It is with this in 
mind that we call for the UN General Assembly, upon due consideration, to transform this 
report into a UN Programme of Action on Sustainable Development. Special follow-up 
conferences could be initiated at the regional level. Within an appropriate period after the 
presentation of the report to the General Assembly, an international Conference could be 
convened to review progress made and promote follow-up arrangements that will be needed 
over time to set benchmarks and to maintain human progress within the guidelines of human 
needs and natural laws. 
125. The Commissioners came from 21 very different nations. In our discussions, we disagreed 
often on details and priorities. But despite our widely differing backgrounds and varying 
national and international responsibilities, we were able to agree to the lines along which 
institutional change must be drawn. 
126. We are unanimous in our conviction that the security, well-being, and very survival of the 
planet depend on such changes, now. 
Footnotes 
1/ The characteristics and differences of the two approaches are described in our inaugural 
report, 'Mandate for Change: Key Issues, Strategy and Workplan', Geneva, 1985. 
2/ L.G. Uy, 'Combating the Notion of Environment as Additionality: A study of the Integration 
of Environment and Development and a Case for Environmental Development as Investment', 
Centre for Environmental Studies, University of Tasmania, Hobart, Tasmania, 1985 (to be 
published). 
3/ OECD, Environment and Economics, Vols. I and II. Background Papers for the
International Conference on Environment and Economics (Paris: 1984). 
4/ OECD, 'The Impact of Environmental Policies on Industrial Innovation', in Environment 
and Economics, Vol. III. op. cit. 
5/ R. Bertrand, 'Some Reflections on Reform of the United Nations'. Joint Inspection Unit, 
UN, Geneva, 1985. 
6/ V. Fernando, 'Development Assistance, Environment and Development', paper prepared 
for WCED, Geneva, 1985. 
7/ 'List of Projects with Possible Environmental Issues' transmitted to Congress by U.S. 
Agency for International Development, 1967, as included in Public Law 9? -591. 
8/ L. Gagnon, Union Québecoise pour la Conservation de la Nature, Québec, 'Pour Une 
Révision des Sciences Economiques', submitted to WCED Public Hearings, Ottawa, 1986. See 
also the review of the state-of-the art concerning natural resource accounts, including detailed 
case studies from Norway and France, in OECD, Information and Natural Resources 
(Paris: 1986). 
9/ T. Friend, 'Natural Resource Accounting ant? its Relationship with Economic and 
Environmental Accounting', Statistics Canada, Ottawa, September 1966. 
10/ The need for an explicit 'foreign policy for environment' was raised in different ways in the 
discussion at many WCED public hearings, but originally in a joint submission by Nordic NGOs 
to the Public Hearings in Oslo, 1985. 
11/ See 'Report of the Secretary-General: Technical and Economic Aspects of International 
River Basin Development', UN E/C.7/35, New York, 1972. An updated list of relevant 
international agreements was provided by the IUCN Environmental Law Centre. See also 
Department of Technical Cooperation for Development, Experiences in the Development 
and Management of International River and Lake Basins, Proceedings of the UN 
Interregional Meeting of International River Organizations held at Dakar, Senegal, in May 1981 
(New York: UN, 1983). 
12/ In 1982, there were environment and natural resource management agencies operating in 
144 countries. At the time of the 1972 Stockholm Conference, only 15 industrial countries and 
11 developing countries had such agencies. World Environment Centre, World 
Environment Handbook (New York: 1985). 
13/ See General Assembly resolution 2997 (XXVII) of 16 December 1972 on 'Institutional and 
financial arrangements for international environmental cooperation'. 
14/ The Environment Coordination Board was abolished in 1977 and its functions assumed by 
the Administrative Committee on Coordination (ACC). See General Assembly Resolution 
32/197, Annex, para 54. The ACC subsequently established a Committee of Designated 
Officials for Environmental Matters (DOEM). 
15/ In addition to the Environment Fund there were 1.8 special Trust Funds with 
contributions totalling $5-6 million in 1985. See UNEP, 1985 Annual Report (Nairobi: 
1986). 
16/ Ibid., Annex V, Table B.
17/ J. Urquhart and K. Heilmann, Risk Watch: The Odds of Life (Bicester, UK: Facts on 
File, 1984). 
18/ 'Risk Assessment and Risk Control', Issue Report, Conservation Foundation, 
Washington, DC, 1985: C. Schweigman et al., '"Agrisk", Appraisal of Risks in Agriculture in 
Developing Countries', University of Groningen, The Netherlands, 1981. 
19/ A. Wijkman and L. Timberlake, Natural Disasters: Acts of God and Acts of Men? 
(London: Earthscan for the International Institute for Environment and Development and the 
Swedish Red Cross, 1984). 
20/ WMO, A Report of the International Conference on the Assessment of the 
Role of Carbon Dioxide and of Other Greenhouse Gases in Climate Variations 
and Associated impacts. Villach, Austria, 9-15 October 1985, WMO No. 661 (Geneva: 
WMO/ICSU/UNEP, 1986). 
21/ For an overview of the current technological capabilities and possibilities, see A. Khosla, 
Development Alternatives, New Delhi, 'Decision Support Systems for Sustainable 
Development', prepared for WCED, 1986. 
22/ See M.C. McHale et al., Ominous Trends and Valid Hopes: A Comparison of Five 
World Reports (Minneapolis, Minn.: Hubert Humphrey Institute of Public Affairs, (year?) 
for a comparison of North-South: A Programme for Survival (Cambridge, Mass.: MIT 
Press, 1980); World Bank, World Development Report 1980 (Washington, DC: 1980); 
U.S. Department of State and Council on Environmental quality, Global 2000 Report to 
the President: Entering the Twenty First Century (Washington, DC: U.S. Government 
Printing Office, 1980); IUCN/WWF/UNEP, World Conservation Strategy (Gland, Switzerland: 
1980); and OECD, Interfutures: Facing the Future, Mastering the Probable and 
Managing the Unpredictable (Paris: 1979). See also D. Meadows et al. Groping In the 
Dark - The First Decade of Global Modelling (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1982) 
for an analysis of various models. 
23/ See C.O. Barney, Study Director, Global 2000 Report, op. cit. 
24/ See OECD, Economic and Ecological Interdependence. (Paris: 1982). 
25/ The importance of involving youth in nature conservation and environmental protection 
and improvement activities were emphasized in many presentations at WCED Public 
Hearings. See, for example the report 'Youth Nature Conservation Movement in the Socialist 
Countries' to the Public Hearing at Moscow, December 1986. 
26/ For an overview of the role and contribution of NGOs to environment and development 
action at the national and international levels, see 'NGOs and Environment-Development 
Issues', report to WCED by the Environment Liaison Centre, Nairobi, 1986. It includes a 
selection of 20 case studies of successful NGO environmental action around the world. 
27/ NGOs in Chile, Colombia, the Federal Republic of Germany, and Turkey have also 
published 'State of the Environment' reports. Official reports have appeared in Australia, 
Austria, Canada, Denmark, Finland, France, Ireland, Israel, Japan, the Netherlands, the 
Philippines, Poland, Spain, Sweden, the United States, and Yugoslavia. 
28/ See, for example, the annual State of the World report by WorldWatch Institute, the 
World Resources Report by World Resources Institute and the International Institute for 
Environment and Development, and the World Conservation Strategy by IUCN.
29/ Report of the World Industry Conference on Environmental Management 
sponsored by the International Chamber of Commerce and UNEP, 1984; see particularly the 
principles adopted by OECD in 1985 as a clarification of the OECD Guiding Principles for 
Multinational Enterprises in International Legal Materials, vol 25, No. 1 (1986); see also 
the presentation to WCED Public Hearings, Oslo, June 1985, on 'World Industry Conference 
Follow-Up' by the Chairman of the Environment Committee of the International Chamber of 
Commerce. 
30/ See P.S. Thacher 'International Institutional Support: The International System, Funding 
and Technical Assistance', paper presented to the World Conservation Strategy Conference, 
Ottawa, Canada, June 1986. 
31/ United Nations, Report of the United Nations Conference on the Human 
Environment, document A/CONF.48/14/Rev.1, Chapter 1 (New York: 1972). 
32/ These and other principles have been developed as proposed Articles for a Convention in 
the report to WCED by its Experts Group on Environmental Law. Their report also contains a 
commentary on the legal precedents and references for each Article. See Legal Principles 
for Environmental Protection and Sustainable Development (Dordrecht, The 
Netherlands: Martinus Nijhoff, in press). 
33/ For an overview of dispute settlement procedures, mechanisms, and needs, see R.E. Stein 
and G. Grenville Wood, 'The Settlement of Environmental Disputes: A Forward Look', 
prepared for WCED, 1985. 
34/ OECD, Environment and Economics, Vol. I, op. cit. 
35/ OECD, Environment and Economics, Results of the International Conference on 
Environment and Economics (Paris: 1985. 
36/ For a summary report on the work of the Committee of International Development 
Institutions on the Environment, see UNEP, 1985 Annual Report, op. cit. 
37/ Statement by Dr M.K. Tolba, UNEP Executive Director, at the opening of the sixth session 
of CIDIE, hosted by the Organization of American States, Washington, DC, June 1985. 
38/ A proposal for a World Conservation Bank was made by M. Sweatman of the International 
Wilderness Leadership Foundation at the WCED Public Hearings, Ottawa, 1986. 
39/ R.D.G. Johnson and R.O. Blake, Environmental and Bilateral Aid (London: 
International Institute for Environment and Development, 1960). 
40/ J. Horberry, Environmental Guidelines Survey: An Analysis of Environmental 
Procedures and Guidelines Governing Development Aid (London and Gland: IIED 
and IUCN, 1963). 
41/ 'Environmental Assessment ooe Development Assistance Projects and Programmes', OECD 
Council Recommendation C(85)104 (Paris: OECD, 20.6.85); 'Measures Required to Facilitate 
the Environmental Assessment of Development Assistance Projects and Programmes' OECD 
Council Recommendation C(86)26 (final) OECD, Paris, 20 November 1986. 
42/ 'Final Report on Environmental Assessment and Development Assistance' OECD 
Environment Monograph No 4 (Paris: OECD, 1986).
43/ Report of the United Nations Conference on Desertification, document 
A/CONF.74/36 (New York: UN, 1977). 
44/ See for example, E.B. Steinberg and J.A. Yager, 'New Means of Financing International 
Needs', The Brookings Institution, Washington, DC, 1978; 'Additional Measures and 
Means of Financing for the Implementation of the Plan of Action to Combat Desertification', 
document UNEP/GC.6/9/Add.1, 1978; UN, 'Study on Financing the United Nations Plan of 
Action to Combat Desertification: report of the Secretary-General', General Assembly 
document A/35/396, 1980; Dag Hammarskjold Foundation 'The Automatic Mobilization of 
Resources for Development', Development Dialogue, No. 1, 1981; UN, 'Study on Financing 
the Plan of Action to Combat Desertification: Report of the Secretary-General', General 
Assembly document A/36/141, 1981. 
45/ Independent Commission on International Development Issues, North-South: A 
Programme for Survival (London: Pan Books, 1980); Common Crisis, North-South: 
Cooperation for World Recovery (London: Pan Books, 1983).
Our Common Future, Annexe 1: Summary of Proposed Legal 
Principles for Environmental Protection and Sustainable 
Development Adopted by the WCED Experts Group on 
Environmental Law 
I. General Principles, Rights, and Responsibilities 
Fundamental Human Right 
1. All human beings have the fundamental right to an environment adequate for their health 
and well being. 
Inter-Generational Equity 
2. States shall conserve and use the environment and natural resources for the benefit of 
present and future generations. 
Conservation and Sustainable Use 
3. States shall maintain ecosystems and ecological processes essential for the functioning of 
the biosphere, shall preserve biological diversity, and shall observe the principle of optimum 
sustainable yield in the use of living natural resources and ecosystems. 
Environmental Standards and Monitoring 
4. States shall establish adequate environmental protection standards and monitor changes in 
and publish relevant data on environmental quality and resource use. 
Prior Environmental Assessments 
5. States shall make or require prior environmental assessments of proposed activities which 
may significantly affect the environment or use of a natural resource. 
Prior Notification, Access, and Due Process 
6. States shall inform in a timely manner all persons likely to be significantly affected by a 
planned activity and to grant them equal access and due process in administrative and judicial 
proceedings. 
Sustainable Development and Assistance 
7. States shall ensure that conservation is treated as an integral part of the planning and 
implementation of development activities and provide assistance to other States, especially to 
developing countries, in support of environmental protection and sustainable development.
General Obligation to Cooperate 
8. States shall cooperate in good faith with other States in implementing the preceding rights 
and obligations. 
II. Principles, Rights and Obligations Concerning Transboundary 
Natural Resources and Environmental Interferences 
Reasonable and Equitable Use 
9. States shell use transboundary natural resources in a reasonable and equitable manner. 
Prevention and Abatement 
10. States shall prevent or abate any transboundary environmental interference which could 
cause or causes significant harm (but subject to certain exceptions provided for in #11 and #12 
below). 
Strict Liability 
11. States shall take all reasonable precautionary measures to limit the risk when carrying out 
or permitting certain dangerous but beneficial activities and shall ensure that compensation is 
provided should substantial transboundary harm occur even when the activities were not 
known to be harmful at the time they were undertaken. 
Prior Agreements When Prevention Costs Greatly Exceed Harm 
12. States shall enter into negotiations with the affected State on the equitable conditions 
under which the activity could be carried out when planning to carry out or permit activities 
causing transboundary harm which is substantial but far less than the cost of prevention. (If 
no agreement can be reached, see Art. 22). 
Non-Discrimination 
13. States shall apply as a minimum at least the same standards for environmental conduct 
and impacts regarding transboundary natural resources and environmental interferences as 
are applied domestically (i.e., do not do to others what you would not do to your own citizens). 
General Obligation to Cooperate on Transboundary Environmental 
Problems 
14. States shall cooperate in good faith with other States to achieve optimal use of 
transboundary natural resources and effective prevention or abatement of transboundary 
environmental interferences. 
Exchange of Information
15. States of origin shall provide timely and relevant information to the other concerned States 
regarding transboundary natural resources or environmental interferences. 
Prior Assessment and Notification 
16. States shall provide prior and timely notification and relevant information to the other 
concerned States and shall make or require an environmental assessment of planned activities 
which may have significant transboundary effects. 
Prior Consultations 
17. States of origin shall consult at an early stage and in good faith with other concerned States 
regarding existing or potential transboundary interferences with their use of a natural 
resource or the environment. 
Cooperative Arrangements for Environmental Assessment and Protection 
18. States shall cooperate with the concerned States in monitoring, scientific research and 
standard setting regarding transboundary natural resources and environmental interferences. 
Emergency Situations 
19. States shall develop contingency plans regarding emergency situations likely to cause 
transboundary environmental interferences and shall promptly warn, provide relevant 
information to and co-operate with concerned States when emergencies occur. 
Equal Access and Treatment 
20. States shall grant equal access, due process and equal treatment in administrative and 
judicial proceedings to all persons who are or may be affected by transboundary interferences 
with their use of a natural resource or the environment. 
III. State Responsibility 
21. States shall cease activities which breach an international obligation regarding the 
environment and provide compensation for the harm caused. 
IV. Peaceful Settlement of Disputes 
22. States shall settle environmental disputes by peaceful means. If mutual agreement on a 
solution or on other dispute settlement arrangements is not reached within 18 months, the 
dispute shall be submitted to conciliation and, if unresolved thereafter, to arbitration or 
judicial settlement at the request of any of the concerned States. 
Footnote 
* This summary is based on the more detailed legal formulations in the report to the
Commission by the international legal experts group. (See Annexe 2 for a list of group 
members.) This summary highlights only the main thrusts of the principles and Articles and is 
not a substitute for the full text is published in Legal Principles for Environmental Protection 
and Sustainable Development (Dordrecht, The Netherlands: Martinus Nijhoff Publishers, in 
press).
Our Common Future, Annexe 2: The Commission and its Work 
The Commissioners 
Chairman 
Vice-Chairman 
Members 
The Commission's Mandate 
The Commission's Work 
Members of the Secretariat 
Senior Professional Staff: 
General Services and Support Staff: 
Inaugural Meeting & Workplan 
Public Hearings 
Expert Special Advisors 
Advisory Panel on Energy 
Advisory Panel on Industry 
Advisory Panel of Food Security 
Advisory Panel Reports 
Financia1 Contributions 
Other Contributions 
Further Activities 
Acknowledgements 
The World Commission on Environment and Development was created as a consequence of 
General Assembly resolution 38/161 adopted at the 38th Session of the United Nations in the 
fall of 1983. That resolution called upon the Secretary General to appoint the Chairman and
Vice Chairman of the Commission rind in turn directed them to jointly appoint the remaining 
members, at least half of whom were to be selected from the developing world. The Secretary 
General appointed Mrs. Gro Harlem Brundtland of Norway, then leader of the Norwegian 
Labour Party, as Chairman and Dr. Mansour Khalid, the former Minister of Foreign Affairs 
from Sudan, as Vice-Chairman. They together appointed the remaining members of the 
Commission. 
The Commission has functioned as an independent body. All its members have served the 
Commission in their individual capacities, not as representatives of their governments. The 
Commission has thus been able to address any issues, to solicit any advice, and to formulate 
and present any proposals and recommendations that it considered pertinent and relevant. 
In pursuing its mandate, the commission has paid careful attention to the Terms of Reference 
suggested by the General Assembly in Resolution 38/161 and has operated in close 
collaboration with the Intergovernmental Inter-sessional Preparatory Committee of the 
Governing Council of the UN Environment Programme, which has itself been preparing an 
intergovernmental report on environmental perspectives to the year 2000 and beyond. 
After the Commission's report has been discussed by UNEP's Governing Council, it is to be 
submitted to the General Assembly of the United Nations for its consideration during its 42nd 
Session in the fall of 1987. 
The Commissioners 
Chairman 
Gro Harlem Brundtland, Norway. Prime Minister, Parliamentary Leader of the Labour Party 
1981 86, Member of Parliament from 1977, Minister of Environment 1974-79. Associate 
Director Oslo school Health Services 1968-74. 
Vice-Chairman 
Mansour Khalid, Sudan. Deputy Prime Minister 1976, Minister of Education 1975-76, 
President, UN Security Council 1972, Minister of Foreign Affairs 1971 75, Minister of Youth and 
Social Affairs 1969-71. 
Members 
Susanna Agnelli, Italy. Italian Senator, writer, Undersecretary of State for Foreign Affairs. 
Member of the Independent Commission on International Humanitarian Issues. Member of 
the European Parliament 1979-81, Mayor of Monte Argentario 1974-84, Member of Chamber of 
Deputies 1976-83. 
Saleh Abdulrahman Al-Athel, Saudi Arabia. President of King Abdulaziz City for Science and 
Technology; Vice-President for Graduate Studies and Research, King Saud University 1976-64; 
Dean, College of Engineering, King Saud University 1975-76. 
Pablo Gonzalez Casanova, Mexico. Professor of Political and social Sciences, National 
Autonomous University of Mexico, President of the Latin American Association of Sociology. 
[In August 1986, for personal reasons, Pablo Gonzalez Casanova ceased to participate in the 
work of the Commission.]
Bernard T. G. Chidzero, Zimbabwe. Minister of Finance, Economic Planning and Development; 
Chairman, Development Committee of the World Bank and the International Monetary Fund; 
Member, UN Committee for Development Planning; Member, Board of the World Institute for 
Development Economics and Research; Director, Commodities Division, United Nations 
Conference on Trade and Development (UNCTAD) 1968-1977; Deputy Secretary General, 
UNCTAD 1977-80. 
Lamine Mohamed Padika, Cote d'Ivoire. Minister of Marine Affairs, Chairman of the National 
Council for Environment, Secretary of State for Marine Affairs 1974-76. 
Volker Hauff, Federal Republic of Germany. Member of Parliament; Vice Chairman, Social 
Democratic Party Parliamentary Group, Responsible for Environment; Minister for 
Transportation 1980-82; Minister for Research and Technology 1979-80; Parliamentary 
Secretary of State for Science Research and Technology 1972-78. 
Istvan Lang, Hungary. Secretary General of the Hungarian Academy of Sciences; Deputy 
Secretary General 1970-85, and Executive secretary 1963-70, Section of Biology, Hungarian 
Academy of Sciences; Research Institute of Soil Science and Agricultural Chemistry, 
Hungarian Academy of Sciences 1955-63. 
Ma Shijun, Peoples Republic of China. Director of the Research Center of Ecology, Academia 
Sinica, Chairman of the Commission of Environmental Sciences, President of the Ecological 
Society of China. 
Margarita Marino do Botero, Colombia. Chairman, Fundacion El Colegio de Villa de Leyva (The 
Green College); Director General, National Institute of Renewable Natural Resources and the 
Environment (INDERENA) 1983-86; Director, Office of International Affairs, INDERENA 
1978-83; Regional Consultant, United Nations Environment Programme 1973-77. 
Nagendra Singh, India. President of the International Court of Justice, President of IMO 
Assembly 1969, President of ILO Maritime Session 1971, President of the Indian Academy of 
Environmental Law and Research, President of the National Labour Law Association of India, 
Life Member of the Board of Governors of the International Council for Environmental Law, 
Member of the Permanent Court of Arbitration; Deputy Chairman of CEPLA (IUCN); 
Chancellor of the University of Goa; Fellow of the British Academy. 
Paulo Nogueira-Neto, Brazil. Federal District Secretary of Environment, Science and 
Technology, National Council of Environment; Federal Secretary of the Environment 1974-86; 
Associate Professor, Department of Ecology, University of Sao Paulo; President, Association 
for the Defence of the Environment 1954-83; President, Sao Paulo State Forest Council 
1967-74. 
Saburo Okita, Japan. President, International University; Advisor to the Ministry of Foreign 
Affairs; Advisor to the Environment Agency; Executive Committee Member of the Club of 
Rome; Chairman, World Wildlife Fund Japan; Chairman, Advisory Committee for External 
Economic Issues 1984-85; Government Representative for External Economic Relations 
1980-81; Foreign Minister 1979-80; Member of the Pearson Commission 1968-69. 
Shridath S. Ramphal, Guyana. Secretary General of the Commonwealth of Nations, Minister 
for Foreign Affairs 1972-75, Minister of Justice 1973-75, Minister of State for Foreign Affairs 
1967-72, Attorney General 1966-72. 
William Doyle Ruckelshaus, United States. Attorney, Perkins, Coie; Administrator, U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency 1970-73, 1983-84; Senior Vice President for Law and 
Corporate Affairs, Weyerhaeuser company 1976-83; Acting Director of the Federal Bureau of 
Investigation 1973; Deputy Attorney General, US Department of Justice 1973. 
Mohamed Sahnoun, Algeria. Algerian Ambassador to the United States; Chief of Algerian 
Permanent Mission to the United Nations 1982-84; Algerian Ambassador, Paris 1979-82; 
Algerian Ambassador, Bonn 1975-79; Deputy Secretary General, Arab League 1973-74; Deputy 
Secretary General, Organization of African Unity 1964-73. 
Emil Salim, Indonesia. Minister of State for Population and the Environment; Minister of State 
for Development Supervision and the Environment 1978-83; Member People's Consultative 
Assembly 1977-32; Minister of Communications 1973-78; Minister of State for Administrative 
Reform; Deputy Chairman, National Planning Board 1971-81. 
Bukar Shaib, Nigeria. Minister of Agriculture, Water Resources and Rural Development 
1983-86, Special Advisor to the President of Nigeria 1980-83, Nigerian Ambassador to Rome 
1979, Permanent Secretary, Federal Ministry of Agriculture and Water Resources 1968-78. 
Vladimir Sokolov, USSR. Director, Institute of Evolutionary Animal Morphology and Ecology, 
USSR Academy of Sciences; Professor and Head of Department oh Vertebrate Zoology, Faculty 
of biology, Moscow State University; Deputy Chairman, Section of Chemical and Technological 
and Biological Sciences, Presidium, USSR Academy of Sciences. 
Janez Stanovnik, Yugoslavia. Member, Presidium of the Socialist Republic of Slovenia; 
Professor, University of Ljubljana; Executive Secretary, UN Economic Commission for Europe 
1967-83: Member of the Federal Cabinet and Federal Executive Council 1966-67. 
Maurice Strong, Canada. President, American Water Development, Inc.: former Under- 
Secretary General and Special Advisor to the Secretary-General of the United Nations; 
Executive Director of the United Nations Office for Emergency Operations in Africa 1985-86; 
Chairman of the Board, Petro-Canada 1976-78; Executive Director, United Nations 
Environment Programme 1973-75; Secretary-General, United Nations Conference on the 
Human Environment 1970-72. 
Jim MacNeill, Canada. Secretary-General of the Commission and ex officio member; Director 
of Environment, OECD 1978-84; Secretary (Deputy Minister), Canadian Ministry of State for 
Urban Affaire 1974-76; Canadian Commissioner General, UN Conference on Human 
Settlements 1975-76; Assistant Secretary, Canadian Ministry of State for Urban Affairs 
1972-74. 
The Commission's Mandate 
The Commission's Mandate, officially adopted at its Inaugural Meeting in Geneva on 1-3 
October 1984, states: 
The World Commission on Environment and Development has been established at a 
time of unprecedented growth in pressures on the global environment, with grave 
predictions about the human future becoming commonplace. 
The Commission is confident that it is possible to build a future that is more 
prosperous, more just, and more secure because it rests on policies and practices 
that serve to expand and sustain the ecological basis of development.
The Commission is convinced, however, that this will no happen without significant 
changes in current approaches: changes in perspectives, attitudes and life styles; 
changes in certain critical policies and the ways in which they are formulated and 
applied; changes in the nature of cooperation between governments, business, 
science, and people; changes in certain forms of international cooperation which 
have proved incapable of tackling many environment and development issues; 
changes, above all, in the level of understanding and commitment by people, 
organizations and governments. 
The World Commission on Environment and Development therefore invites 
suggestions, participation, and support in order to assist it urgently: 
to re-examine the critical issues of environment and development and to 
formulate innovative, concrete, and realistic action proposals to deal with 
them; 
1. 
to strengthen international cooperation on environment and development and 
to assess and propose new forms of cooperation that can break out of existing 
patterns and influence policies and events in the direction of needed change; 
and 
2. 
to raise the level of understanding and commitment to action on the part of 
individuals, voluntary organizations, businesses, institutes, and governments. 
3. 
The Commission solicits the views of those individuals, scientific institutes, 
non-governmental organizations, specialized agencies, and other bodies of the 
United Nations, and national governments concerned with environment and 
development issues. It requests their support and it will facilitate their participation 
in the work of the Commission. It wishes especially to hear the views of youth. 
In fulfilling its tasks, the Commission will pay careful attention to the Terms of 
Reference suggested by the General Assembly of the United Nations in resolution 
38/161, in which the General Assembly welcomed the establishment of the 
Commission. 
The Commission's Work 
In May of 1984, an Organizational Meeting of the Commission was held in Geneva to adopt its 
rules of procedure and operation and to appoint a Secretary General to guide its work. In July 
of 1964, a Secretariat was established in Geneva, temporarily at the Centre de Morillon and 
later at the Palais Wilson. 
Members of the Secretariat 
Members of the Secretariat have included: 
Secretary General: Jim MacNeill 
Senior Professional Staff:
Nitin Desai, Senior Economic Advisor 
Vitus Fernando, Senior Programme Officer 
Branislav Gosovic, Senior Programme Officer 
Marie-Madeleine Jacquemier, Finance and Administrative Officer 
Kazu Kato, Director of Programmes 
Warren H. Lindner, Secretary of the Commission and Director of Administration 
Elisabeth Monosovski, Senior Programme Officer 
Gustavo Montero, Programme Planning Officer 
Shimwaa'i Muntemba, Senior Programme Officer 
Janos Pasztor, Senior Programme Officer 
Peter Robbs, Senior Public Information Advisor 
Vicente Sanchez, Director of Programmes 
Linda Starke, Editor 
Peter Stone, Director of Information 
Edith Surber, Finance and Administrative Officer 
General Services and Support Staff: 
Brita Baker 
Elisabeth Bohler-Goodship 
Marie-Pierre Destouet 
Marian Doku 
Tamara Dunn 
Teresa Harmand 
Aud Loen 
Jelka de Marsano 
Chedra Mayhew 
Christel Ollesch 
Ellen Permato 
Guadalupe Quesado
Mildred Raphoz 
Evelyn Salvador 
Iona D'Souza 
Kay Streit 
Vicky Underhill 
Shane Vanderwert 
Inaugural Meeting & Workplan 
The Commission held its first official meeting in Geneva on 1-3 October 1984. During that 
meeting, the Commission agreed upon its Mandate, the key issues it would address in the 
course of its deliberations, the strategy it would employ to achieve its objectives, and the 
workplan and timetable that would be used to guide its work. Immediately following that 
meeting, the Commission publicly released its principal working document, 'Mandate for 
Change'. 
At its Inaugural Meeting, the Commission selected eight key issues for analysis during the 
course of its work: 
Perspectives on Population, Environment, and Sustainable Development; 
Energy: Environment and Development; 
Industry: Environment and Development; 
Food Security, Agriculture, Forestry, Environment, and Development; 
Human Settlements: Environment and Development; 
International Economic Relations, Environment, and Development; 
Decision Support Systems for Environmental Management; and 
International Cooperation. 
It agreed that it would examine these issues from the perspective of the year 2000 and beyond 
and from the perspective of their common sources in economic, social, and sectoral policies. 
At its Inaugural Meeting, the Commission also decided that its processes would be open, 
visible, and participatory and that in conducting its work, strategies would be employed to 
ensure it of receiving the broadest range of views and advice on the key issues it was 
addressing. 
Public Hearings 
The Commission therefore decided that it would hold deliberative meetings in all regions of 
the world and that it would take the occasion of those meetings to get a first hand view of 
environment and development issues in those regions. It also decided to use these visits to 
hold open Public Hearings where senior government representatives, scientists and experts, 
research institutes, industrialists, representatives of non-governmental organizations, and the
general public could openly express their concerns to the Commission and submit their views 
and advice on issues of common concern. 
These Public Hearings, which are a unique feature of the Commission, have become its 
'trademark', demonstrating both to the Commissioners and the participants that the issues 
addressed by the Commission are indeed of global concern and do transcend national 
boundaries and disparate cultures. Hundreds of organizations and individuals gave testimony 
during the Public Hearings and over 800 written submissions constituting more than 10,000 
pages of material were received by the Commission in connection with them. The Public 
Hearings have been of immeasurable benefit to the Commissioners and the Secretariat, and 
the gratitude of the Commission is extended to all who contributed to their success. 
Deliberative meetings, site visits, and/or Public Hearings of the Commission were held in 
Jakarta, Indonesia, 27-31 March 1985: Oslo, Norway, 21-28 June 1985; Sao Paulo and Brasilia, 
Brazil, 25 October-4 November 1985; Vancouver, Edmonton, Toronto, Ottawa, Halifax, and 
quebec City, Canada, 21-31 May 1986; Harare, Zimbabwe, 15-19 September, Nairobi, Kenya, 
20-23 September 1986; Moscow, USSR, 6-12 December 1986; and Tokyo, Japan, 23-28 
February 1987. Special working group meetings of the Commission were also held in Geneva, 
Moscow, and Berlin (West). 
Expert Special Advisors 
To further widen its base of information and advice, the Commission appointed a group of 
expert Special Advisors to assist it and the Secretariat in the analysis of the key issues. These 
included Edward S. Ayensu on Food Security and Forestry, Gamani Corea on International 
Economic Relations, Gordon T. Goodman on Energy. Ashok Khosla on Decision Support 
Systems for Environmental Management, Robert D. Munro on International Cooperation and 
Legal Regimes, Michael Royston on Industry, Johan Jorgen Hoist on Environment and 
Security, and Guy-Olivier Segond on Youth. The Chairman was also advised by Hans Christian 
Bugge and Morten Wetland. Later in its work, the Commission appointed Lloyd Timberlake as 
Special Editorial Advisor. 
To assist it in its work in three of the key issue areas - Energy, Industry, and Food Security - 
the Commission constituted Advisory Panels of leading experts to advise it on the 
recommendations and conclusions it should consider making. The chairmen and members of 
the Commission's Advisory Panels were: 
Advisory Panel on Energy 
Chairman: 
Enrique Iglesias, Foreign Minister of Uruguay 
Members: 
Abdlatif Y. Al-Hamad (Kuwait) 
Toyoaki Ikuta (Japan) 
Gu Jian (China) 
Al Noor Kassum (Tanzania)
Ulf Lantzke (deceased) (Federal Republic of Germany) 
Wangari Maathai (Kenya) 
David J. Rose (deceased) (United States) 
Prero Shankar Jha (India) 
Carl Tham (Sweden) 
Gyorgy Vajda (Hungary) 
Advisory Panel on Industry 
Chairman: Umberto Colombo (Italy), President of ENfcA 
Members: 
Betsy Ancker-Johnson (United States) 
M.J. Flux (United Kingdom) 
Arnoldo Jose Gabaldon (Venezuela) 
Alexander C. Helfrich (Netherlands) 
Charles Levinson (Canada) 
Finn Lied (Norway) 
George P. Livanos (Greece) 
Mohamed Mazouni (Algeria) 
Thomas McCarthy (United States) 
Jose E. Mind]in (Brazil) 
Keichi Oshima (Japan) 
Roger Strelow (United States) 
Naval Tata (India) 
Erna Witoelar (Indonesia) 
Advisory Panel of Food Security 
Chairman: 
M.S. Swarainathan (India), Director General of the International Rice Research Institute 
Members: 
Nyle Brady (United States)
Robert Chambers (United Kingdom) 
K. Chowdhry (India) 
Gilberto Gallopin (Argentina) 
Joe Hulse (Canada) 
Kenneth King (Guyana) 
V. Malima (Tanzania) 
Samir Radwan (Egypt) 
Lu Liang Shu (China) 
Advisory Panel Reports 
The reports of the three Advisory Panels were submitted to the Commission for its 
consideration during its meeting in Canada in May of 1986 and have since been published 
under the titled Energy 2000, Industry 2000, and Food 2000. 
The Commission was also assisted in its review of legal rights and principles by a group of 
international legal experts chaired by Robert Munro (Canada) with Johan G. Lammers 
(Netherlands) as Rapporteur. The members of the group included Andronico Adede (Kenya), 
Francoise Burhenne (Federal Republic of Germany), Alexandre-Charles Kiss (France), Stephen 
McCaffrey (United States), Akio Morishima (Japan), Zaki Mustafa (Sudan), Henri Smets 
(Belgium), Robert Stein (United States), Alberto Szekely (Mexico), Alexandre Timoehenko 
(USSR), and Amado Tolentino (Philippines) Their report was submitted to and considered by 
the Commission during its meeting in Harare in September 1986. It will be published under 
the title Legal Principles for Environmental Protection and Sustainable Development. 
During the course of its work, the Commission also engaged experts, research institutes, and 
academic centres of excellence from around the globe to prepare more than 75 studies and 
reports relating to the eight key issues for the Commission's review and consideration. These 
studies and reports provided an invaluable resource base for the final reports of the 
Commission's Advisory Panels and for the final chapters of this report. 
Financial Contributions 
Initial funding to permit the Commission to commence its work came from the governments of 
Canada, Denmark, Finland, Japan, the Netherlands, Norway, Sweden, and Switzerland. Each 
of these 'sponsoring' governments had been instrumental in the creation of the Commission 
and during the course of the Commibeion'r work, each of them increased their contribution 
beyond their original pledge. 
In addition to the 'sponsoring' group of countries, the Commission has also received untied 
financial contributions from the governments of Cameroon, Chile, the Federal Republir of 
Germany, Hungary, Oman, Portugal, and Saudi Arabia. Significant contributions have also 
been received from the Kord Foundation and the John D. and Catherine T. MacArthur 
Foundation, as well as from NOPAD and SIDA. 
Other Contributions
The City and Canton of Geneva restored and furnished one wing of the Palais Wilson and 
provided that to the Commission's Secretariat free of rent and utilities. The local costs of the 
Commission's meetings in Indonesia, Brazil, Zimbabwe, and the USSR were covered by the 
host governments. The costs of the Commission's working group meeting in Moscow were also 
covered by the Soviet Government. The costs of the working group meeting in Berlin (West) 
were covered by the Federal Republic of Germany. The Arab Fund for Economic and Social 
Development hosted and covered all of the costs of a meeting in Kuwait of the Advisory Panel 
on Energy. The accounts of the Commission have been audited by Hunzikei and Associates of 
Geneva. 
The Commission's sincere appreciation is extended to all the governments, foundations, and 
institutes that provided the financial and other support necessary for it to complete its work, 
including those that contributed funds too late to be acknowledged here. 
Further Activities 
Between the issuance of this report and its consideration by the UN General Assembly during 
its 42nd Session in the fall of 1987, the Commission will be meeting during a series of regional 
presentational meetings with senior governmental representatives, the business and scientific 
communities, non-governmental organizations, and the press to discuss this report and, it is 
hoped, to build a body of public and governmental support for the recommendations and 
conclusions. 
There are no plans for the Commission to continue after its report has been considered by the 
General Assembly, and it will officially cease its operations on 31 December 1987. 
Acknowledgements 
Since its creation in late 1963, the Commission has received advice and support from 
thousands of individuals, institutes, and organizations the world over, many of whom are 
listed here. Many laboured long hours in preparing submissions for the Public Hearings, 
reports for the Advisory Panels, and studies for submission to the Commission. Without their 
dedication, cooperation, and advice as well as that of the Special Advisors and the chairmen 
and members of the Advisory Panels and Legal Experts Group, this report would not have 
been possible. The Commission's sincerest appreciation is extended to them all. (Affiliations 
and titles are as of the date of communication with the Commission. Verification of all the 
following names and titles was not possible, and the Commission apologizes for any 
inaccuracies.)

More Related Content

PDF
Natural Resources and Pro-Poor Growth
PDF
2008 The Little Green Data Book
PDF
Overconsumption: Our use of the Worlds Natural Resources
PDF
Achieving Sustainable Development and Promoting Development Cooperation
PDF
Introduction to: UNIDO Inclusive and Sustainable Industrial Development
PPTX
PPTX
Sustainable development brundtland report, ppp, equity
PPT
Sustainable development
Natural Resources and Pro-Poor Growth
2008 The Little Green Data Book
Overconsumption: Our use of the Worlds Natural Resources
Achieving Sustainable Development and Promoting Development Cooperation
Introduction to: UNIDO Inclusive and Sustainable Industrial Development
Sustainable development brundtland report, ppp, equity
Sustainable development

What's hot (17)

PDF
Brundtland report
PDF
Intangible capital: Key factor of Sustainable development in Morocco
PDF
Brundtland report and more
PPTX
WORLD SUMMIT ON SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT 2002
PPTX
Presentation un sustainable development summit (final)
PPTX
Brundtland commission
PDF
Sustainable Development concept
PPTX
PPTX
Stockholm Declaration
PPTX
Sustainable Development Goals and the Climate Change Agreement
DOC
Principles of sustainable development
PPT
BRUNDTLAND REPORT : OUR COMMON FUTURE
PPTX
Environmental sustainability ppt
PDF
PPT
A short introduction to sustainable development br lpges fp safi morocco 2012
PDF
World Economic and Social Survey 2011: The Great Green Technological Transfor...
PPTX
Sustainable development in environment studies
Brundtland report
Intangible capital: Key factor of Sustainable development in Morocco
Brundtland report and more
WORLD SUMMIT ON SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT 2002
Presentation un sustainable development summit (final)
Brundtland commission
Sustainable Development concept
Stockholm Declaration
Sustainable Development Goals and the Climate Change Agreement
Principles of sustainable development
BRUNDTLAND REPORT : OUR COMMON FUTURE
Environmental sustainability ppt
A short introduction to sustainable development br lpges fp safi morocco 2012
World Economic and Social Survey 2011: The Great Green Technological Transfor...
Sustainable development in environment studies
Ad

Viewers also liked (6)

PDF
Africa 2050 Realizing the Continents Full Potential
PDF
Natural Resources Definitions Trade Patterns and Globalisation
PDF
UNIDO Constitution
PDF
Strategic plan 2014 - 2017 for the African Union Commission
PDF
Extractive Resources for Development 2014 Trade, Fiscal and Industrial consid...
PDF
Building Trade Capacities for Africa's Trasformation: A Critical Review of Ai...
Africa 2050 Realizing the Continents Full Potential
Natural Resources Definitions Trade Patterns and Globalisation
UNIDO Constitution
Strategic plan 2014 - 2017 for the African Union Commission
Extractive Resources for Development 2014 Trade, Fiscal and Industrial consid...
Building Trade Capacities for Africa's Trasformation: A Critical Review of Ai...
Ad

Similar to Report of the world commission on environment and development (20)

PDF
Report of the World Commission on Environment and Development: Our Common Future
PDF
Brundtland report
PDF
Our common future
DOCX
Eng 1012
PDF
Evaluating Sustainable Development in US Cities and States_finalpaper_
PDF
What is sustainable development
PDF
Sustainable development
PDF
cop21 at paris
PDF
Interconnectivity of Country and the World.pdf
PDF
Times04 2005
PDF
The United Nations ( Un ) Conference On Sustainable...
PDF
Madrid_International plan of Action on Ageing
PDF
220100_CPD - Sustainable Development Goals_20240704_094038.pdf
PPTX
Introduction to sustainable develpment
DOCX
Rowley 11Sustainable Development in Belarus.docx
PDF
Contributions of the Environmental Non Governmental Organisations and interna...
PDF
Habitat Meeting Reflection
Report of the World Commission on Environment and Development: Our Common Future
Brundtland report
Our common future
Eng 1012
Evaluating Sustainable Development in US Cities and States_finalpaper_
What is sustainable development
Sustainable development
cop21 at paris
Interconnectivity of Country and the World.pdf
Times04 2005
The United Nations ( Un ) Conference On Sustainable...
Madrid_International plan of Action on Ageing
220100_CPD - Sustainable Development Goals_20240704_094038.pdf
Introduction to sustainable develpment
Rowley 11Sustainable Development in Belarus.docx
Contributions of the Environmental Non Governmental Organisations and interna...
Habitat Meeting Reflection

Recently uploaded (20)

PPTX
Introduction_to_the_Study_of_Globalization.pptx
PDF
CXPA Finland Webinar: Rated 5 Stars - Delivering Service That Customers Truly...
PPTX
Presentatio koos kokos koko ossssn5.pptx
PPTX
Parliamentary procedure in meeting that can be use
PPTX
Empowering Teens with Essential Life Skills 🚀
PPTX
Weekly Report 17-10-2024_cybersecutity.pptx
PDF
About Karen Miner-Romanoff - Academic & nonprofit consultant
DOCX
EAPP.docxdffgythjyuikuuiluikluikiukuuuuuu
PPTX
Workshop-Session-1-LGU-WFP-Formulation.pptx
PPTX
Quiz - Saturday.pptxaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa
PPTX
11Sept2023_LTIA-Cluster-Training-Presentation.pptx
PPT
The Central Civil Services (Leave Travel Concession) Rules, 1988, govern the ...
PPTX
True Fruits_ reportcccccccccccccccc.pptx
PDF
CXPA Finland Webinar - Modern Components of Service Quality - Alec Dalton - ...
PDF
PPT Item # 4 - 328 Albany St compt. review
DOC
LU毕业证学历认证,赫尔大学毕业证硕士的学历和学位
PDF
PPT Item # 2 -- Announcements Powerpoint
PPTX
Developing_An_Advocacy_Agenda_by_Kevin_Karuga.pptx
PDF
Item # 3 - 934 Patterson Final Review.pdf
PDF
Item # 2 - 934 Patterson Specific Use Permit (SUP)
Introduction_to_the_Study_of_Globalization.pptx
CXPA Finland Webinar: Rated 5 Stars - Delivering Service That Customers Truly...
Presentatio koos kokos koko ossssn5.pptx
Parliamentary procedure in meeting that can be use
Empowering Teens with Essential Life Skills 🚀
Weekly Report 17-10-2024_cybersecutity.pptx
About Karen Miner-Romanoff - Academic & nonprofit consultant
EAPP.docxdffgythjyuikuuiluikluikiukuuuuuu
Workshop-Session-1-LGU-WFP-Formulation.pptx
Quiz - Saturday.pptxaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa
11Sept2023_LTIA-Cluster-Training-Presentation.pptx
The Central Civil Services (Leave Travel Concession) Rules, 1988, govern the ...
True Fruits_ reportcccccccccccccccc.pptx
CXPA Finland Webinar - Modern Components of Service Quality - Alec Dalton - ...
PPT Item # 4 - 328 Albany St compt. review
LU毕业证学历认证,赫尔大学毕业证硕士的学历和学位
PPT Item # 2 -- Announcements Powerpoint
Developing_An_Advocacy_Agenda_by_Kevin_Karuga.pptx
Item # 3 - 934 Patterson Final Review.pdf
Item # 2 - 934 Patterson Specific Use Permit (SUP)

Report of the world commission on environment and development

  • 1. Report of the World Commission on Environment and Development: Our Common Future Table of Contents Acronyms and Note on Terminology Chairman's Foreword From One Earth to One World Part I. Common Concerns 1. A Threatened Future I. Symptoms and Causes II. New Approaches to Environment and Development 2. Towards Sustainable Development I. The Concept of Sustainable Development II. Equity and the Common Interest III. Strategic Imperatives IV. Conclusion 3. The Role of the International Economy The International Economy, the Environment, and Development I. II. Decline in the 1980s III. Enabling Sustainable Development IV. A Sustainable World Economy Part II. Common Challenges 4. Population and Human Resources I. The Links with Environment and Development
  • 2. The Population II. Perspective III. A Policy Framework 5. Food Security: Sustaining the Potential I. Achievements II. Signs of Crisis III. The Challenge IV. Strategies for Sustainable Food Security V. Food for the Future 6. Species and Ecosystems: Resources for Development I. The Problem: Character and Extent II. Extinction Patterns and Trends III. Some Causes of Extinction IV. Economic Values at Stake V. New Approach: Anticipate and Prevent VI. International Action for National Species VII. Scope for National Action VIII. The Need for Action 7. Energy: Choices for Environment and Development I. Energy, Economy, and Environment II. Fossil Fuels: The Continuing Dilemma III. Nuclear Energy: Unsolved Problems IV. Wood Fuels: The Vanishing Resource V. Renewable Energy: The Untapped Potential
  • 3. Energy Efficiency: Maintaining VI. the Momentum VII. Energy Conservation Measures VIII. Conclusion 8. Industry: Producing More With Less I. Industrial Growth and its Impact II. Sustainable Industrial Development in a Global Context III. Strategies for Sustainable Industrial Development 9. The Urban Challenge I. The Growth of Cities II. The Urban Challenge in Developing Countries III. International Cooperation Part III. Common Endeavours 10. Managing The Commons I. Oceans: The Balance of Life II. Space: A Key to Planetary Management III. Antarctica: Towards Global Cooperation 11. Peace, Security, Development, and the Environment I. Environmental Stress as a Source of Conflict II. Conflict as a Cause of Unsustainable Development III. Towards Security and Sustainable Development Towards Common Action: Proposals For Institutional and Legal Change 12. I. The Challenge for Institutional and Legal Change II. Proposals for Institutional and Legal Change
  • 4. III. A Call for Action Annexes Annexe 1: Summary of Proposed Legal Principles for Environmental Protection and Sustainable Development Adopted by the WCED Experts Group on Environmental Law Annexe 2: The Commission and its Work Throughout this report, quotes from some of the many people who spoke at WCED public hearings appear in boxes to illustrate the range of opinions the Commission was exposed to during its three years of work. They do not necessarily reflect the views of the Commission.
  • 5. Our Common Future, Chairman's Foreword "A global agenda for change" - this was what the World Commission on Environment and Development was asked to formulate. It was an urgent call by the General Assembly of the United Nations: to propose long-term environmental strategies for achieving sustainable development by the year 2000 and beyond; to recommend ways concern for the environment may be translated into greater co-operation among developing countries and between countries at different stages of economical and social development and lead to the achievement of common and mutually supportive objectives that take account of the interrelationships between people, resources, environment, and development; to consider ways and means by which the international community can deal more effectively with environment concerns; and to help define shared perceptions of long-term environmental issues and the appropriate efforts needed to deal successfully with the problems of protecting and enhancing the environment, a long term agenda for action during the coming decades, and aspirational goals for the world community. When I was called upon by the Secretary-General of the United Nations in December 1983 to establish and chair a special, independent commission to address this major challenge to the world community, I was acutely aware that this was no small task and obligation, and that my day-to day responsibilities as Party leader made it seem plainly prohibitive. What the General Assembly asked for also seemed to be unrealistic and much too ambitious. At the same time, it was a clear demonstration of the widespread feeling of frustration and inadequacy in the international community about our own ability to address the vital global issues and deal effectively with them. The fact is a compelling reality, and should not easily be dismissed. Since the answers to fundamental and serious concerns are not at hand, there is no alternative but to keep on trying to find them. All this was on my mind when the Secretary-General presented me with an argument to which there was no convincing rebuttal: No other political leader had become Prime Minister with a background of several years of political struggle, nationally and internationally, as an environment minister. This gave some hope that the environment was not destined to remain a side issue in central, political decision making. In the final analysis, I decided to accept the challenge. The challenge of facing the future, and of safeguarding the interests of coming generations. For it was abundantly clear: We needed a mandate for change. We live in an era in the history of nations when there is greater need than ever for co-ordinated political action and responsibility. The United Nations and its Secretary-General are faced with an enormous task and burden. Responsibly meeting humanity's goals and
  • 6. aspirations will require the active support of us all. My reflections and perspective were also based on other important parts of ray own political experience: the preceding work of the Brandt Commission on North South issues, and the Palme Commission on security and disarmament issues, on which I served. I was being asked to help formulate a third and compelling call for political action: After Brandt's Programme for Survival and Common Crisis, and after Palme's Common Security, would come Common Future. This was my message when Vice Chairman Mansour Khalid and I started work on the ambitious task set up by the United Nations. This report, as presented to the UN General Assembly in 1987, is the result of that process. Perhaps our most urgent task today is to persuade nations of the need to return to multilateralism. The challenge of reconstruction after the Second World War was the real motivating power behind the establishment of our post-war international economic system. The challenge of finding sustainable development paths ought to provide the impetus - indeed the imperative - for a renewed search for multilateral solutions and a restructured international economic system of co-operation. These challenges cut across the divides of national sovereignty, of limited strategies for economic gain, and of separated disciplines of science. After a decade and a half of a standstill or even deterioration in global co-operation, I believe the time has come for higher expectations, for common goals pursued together, for an increased political will to address our common future. There was a time of optimism and progress in the 1960s, when there was greater hope for a braver new world, and for progressive international ideas. Colonies blessed with natural resources were becoming nations. The locals of co-operation and sharing seemed to be seriously pursued. Paradoxically, the 1970s slid slowly into moods of reaction and isolation while at the same time a series of UN conferences offered hope for greater co-operation on major issues. The 1972 UN Conference on the Human Environment brought the industrialized and developing nations together to delineate the "rights" of the human family to a healthy and productive environment. A string of such meetings followed: on the rights of people to adequate food, to sound housing, to safe water, to access to means of choosing the size of their families. The present decade has been marked by a retreat from social concerns. Scientists bring to our attention urgent but complex problems bearing on our very survival: a warming globe, threats to the Earth's ozone layer, deserts consuming agricultural land. We respond by demanding more details, and by assigning the problems to institutions ill-equipped to cope with them. Environmental degradation, first seen as mainly a problem of the rich nations and a side effect of industrial wealth, has become a survival issue for developing nations. It is part of the downward spiral of linked ecological and economic decline in which many of the poorest nations are trapped. Despite official hope expressed on all sides, no trends identifiable today, no programmes or policies, offer any real hope of narrowing the growing gap between rich and poor nations. And as part of our "development", we have amassed weapons arsenals capable of diverting the paths that evolution has followed for millions of years and of creating a planet our ancestors would not recognize. When the terms of reference of our Commission were originally being discussed in 1982, there were those who wanted its considerations to be limited to "environmental issues" only. This
  • 7. would have been a grave mistake. The environment does not exist as a sphere separate from human actions, ambitions, and needs, and attempts to defend it in isolation from human concerns have given the very word "environment" a connotation of naivety in some political circles. The word "development" has also been narrowed by some into a very limited focus, along the lines of "what poor nations should do to become richer", and thus again is automatically dismissed by many in the international arena as being a concern of specialists, of those involved in questions of "development assistance". But the "environment" is where we all live; and "development" is what we all do in attempting to improve our lot within that abode. The two are inseparable. Further, development issues must be seen as crucial by the political leaders who feel that their countries have reached a plateau towards which other nations must strive. Many of the development paths of the industrialized nations are clearly unsustainable. And the development decisions of these countries, because of their great economic and political power, will have a profound effect upon the ability of all peoples to sustain human progress for generations to come. Many critical survival issues are related to uneven development, poverty, and population growth. They all place unprecedented pressures on the planet's lands, waters, forests, and other natural resources, not least in the developing countries. The downward spiral of poverty and environmental degradation is a waste of opportunities and of resources. In particular, it is a waste of human resources. These links between poverty, inequality, and environmental degradation formed a major theme in our analysis and recommendations. What is needed now is a new era of economic growth - growth that is forceful and at the same time socially and environmentally sustainable. Due to the scope of our work, and to the need to have a wide perspective. I was very much aware of the need to put together a highly qualified and influential political and scientific team, to constitute a truly independent Commission. This was an essential part of a successful process. Together, we should span the globe, and pull together to formulate an interdisciplinary, integrated approach to global concerns and our common future. We needed broad participation and a clear majority of members from developing countries, to reflect world realities. We needed people with wide experience, and from all political fields, not only from environment or development and political disciplines, but from all areas of vital decision making that influence economic and social progress, nationally and internationally. We therefore come from widely differing backgrounds: foreign ministers, finance and planning officials, policymakers in agriculture, science, and technology. Many of the Commissioners are cabinet ministers and senior economists in their own nations, concerned largely with the affairs of those countries. As Commissioners, however, we were acting not in our national roles but as individuals; and as we worked, nationalism and the artificial divides between "industrialized" and "developing", between East and West, receded. In their place emerged a common concern for the planet and the interlocked ecological and economic threats with which its people, institutions, and governments now grapple. During the time we met as a Commission, tragedies such as the African famines, the leak at the pesticides factory at Bhopal, India, and the nuclear disaster at Chernobyl, USSR appeared to justify the grave predictions about the human future that were becoming commonplace during the mid-1980s. But at public hearings we held on five continents, we also heard from the individual victims of more chronic, widespread disasters: the debt crisis, stagnating aid to and investment in developing countries, falling commodity prices and falling personal incomes. We became convinced that major changes were needed, both in attitudes and in the way our societies are organized.
  • 8. The question of population - of population pressure, of population and human rights - and the links between these related issues and poverty, environment, and development proved to be one of the more difficult concerns with which we had to struggle. The differences of perspective seemed at the outset to be unbridgeable, and they required a lot of thought and willingness to communicate across the divides of cultures, religions, and regions. Another such concern was the whole area of international economic relations. In these and in a number of other important aspects of our analysis and recommendations, we were able to develop broad agreement. The fact that we all became wiser, learnt to look across cultural and historical barriers, was essential. There were moments of deep concern and potential crisis, moments of gratitude and achievement, moments of success in building a common analysis and perspective. The result is clearly more global, more realistic, more forward looking than any one of us alone could have created. We joined the Commission with different views and perspectives, different values and beliefs, and very different experiences and insights. After these three years of working together, travelling, listening, and discussing, we present a unanimous report. I am deeply grateful to all the Commissioners for their dedication, their foresight and personal commitment to our common endeavour. It has been a truly wonderful team. The spirit of friendship and open communication, the meeting of minds and the process of learning and sharing, have provided an experience of optimism, something of great value to all of us, and, I believe, to the report and its message. We hope to share with others our learning process, and all that we have experienced together. It is something that many others will have to experience if global sustainable development is to be achieved. The Commission has taken guidance from people in all walks of life. It is to these people - to all the peoples of the world - that the Commission now addresses itself. In so doing we speak to people directly as well as to the institutions that they have established. The Commission is addressing governments, directly and through their various agencies and ministries. The congregation of governments, gathered in the General Assembly of the United Nations, will be the main recipients of this report. The Commission is also addressing private enterprise, from the one-person business to the great multinational company with a total economic turnover greater than that of many nations, and with possibilities for bringing about far-reaching changes and improvements. But first and foremost our message is directed towards people, whose well being is the ultimate goal of all environment and development policies. In particular, the Commission is addressing the young. The world's teachers will have a crucial role to play in bringing this report to them. If we do not succeed in putting our message of urgency through to today's parents and decision makers, we risk undermining our children's fundamental right to a healthy, life-enhancing environment. Unless we are able to translate our words into a language that can reach the minds and hearts of people young and old, we shall not be able to undertake the extensive social changes needed to correct the course of development. The Commission has completed its work. We call for a common endeavour and for new norms of behaviour at all levels and in the interests of all. The changes in attitudes, in social values, and in aspirations that the report urges will depend on vast campaigns of education, debate
  • 9. and public participation. To this end, we appeal to "citizens" groups, to non governmental organizations, to educational institutions, and to the scientific community. They have all played indispensable roles in the creation of public awareness and political change in the past. They will play a crucial part in putting the world onto sustainable development paths, in laying the groundwork for Our Common Future. The process that produced this unanimous report proven that it is possible to join forces, to identify common goals, and to agree on common action. Each one of the Commissioners would have chosen different words if writing the report alone. Still, we managed to agree on the analysis, the broad remedies, and the recommendations for a sustainable course of development. In the final analysis, this is what it amounts to: furthering the common understanding and common spirit of responsibility so clearly needed in a divided world. Thousands of people all over the world have contributed to the work of the Commission, by intellectual means, by financial means, and by sharing their experiences with us through articulating their needs and demands. I am sincerely grateful to everyone who has made such contributions. Many of their names are found in Annexe 2 of the report. My particular gratitude goes to Vice Chairman Mansour Khalid, to all the other members of the Commission, and to Secretary-General Jim MacNeill and his staff at our secretariat, who went above and beyond the call of duty to assist us. Their enthusiasm and dedication knew no limits. I want to thank the chairmen and members of the Intergovernmental Inter-sessional Preparatory Committee, who co-operated closely with the Commission and provided inspiration and support. I thank also the Executive Director of the United Nations Environment Programme, Dr. Mostafa Tolba, for his valuable, continuous support and interest. Gro Harlem Brundtland Oslo, 20 March 1987
  • 10. Our Common Future, From One Earth to One World An Overview by the World Commission on Environment and Development I. The Global Challenge 1. Successes and failures 2. The Interlocking Crises 3. Sustainable Development 4. The Institutional Gaps II. The Policy Directions 1. Population and Human Resources 2. Food Security: Sustaining the Potential 3. Species and Ecosystems: Resources for Development 4. Energy: Choices for Environment and Development 5. Industry: Producing More with Less 6. The Urban Challenge III. International Cooperation and Institutional Reform 1. The Role of the International Economy 2. Managing the Commons 3. Peace, Security, Development, and the Environment 4. Institutional and Legal Change 4.1 Getting at the Sources 4.2 Dealing with the Effects
  • 11. 4.3 Assessing Global Risks 4.4 Making Informed Choices 4.5 Providing the Legal Means 4.6 Investing in our Future IV. A Call for Action 1. In the middle of the 20th century, we saw our planet from space for the first time. Historians may eventually find that this vision had a greater impact on thought than did the Copernican revolution of the 16th century, which upset the human self-image by revealing that the Earth is not the centre of the universe. From space, we see a small and fragile ball dominated not by human activity and edifice but by a pattern of clouds, oceans, greenery, and soils. Humanity's inability to fit its activities into that pattern is changing planetary systems, fundamentally. Many such changes are accompanied by life-threatening hazards. This new reality, from which there is no escape, must be recognized - and managed. 2. Fortunately, this new reality coincides with more positive developments new to this century. We can move information and goods faster around the globe than ever before; we can produce more food and more goods with less investment of resources; our technology and science gives us at least, the potential to look deeper into and better understand natural systems. From space, we can see and study the Earth as an organism whose health depends on the health of al its parts. We have the power to reconcile human affairs with natural laws and to thrive in the process. In this our cultural and spiritual heritages can reinforce our economic interests and survival imperatives. 3. This Commission believes that people can build a future that is more prosperous, more just, and more secure. Our report, Our Common Future, is not a prediction of ever increasing environmental decay, poverty, and hardship in an ever more polluted world among ever decreasing resources. We see instead the possibility for a new era of economic growth, one that must be based on policies that sustain and expand the environmental resource base. And we believe such growth to be absolutely essential to relieve the great poverty that is deepening in much of the developing world. 4. But the Commission's hope for the future is conditional on decisive political action now to begin managing environmental resources to ensure both sustainable human progress and human survival. We are not forecasting a future; we are serving a notice - an urgent notice based on the latest and best scientific evidence - that the time has come to take the decisions needed to secure the resources to sustain this and coming generations. We do not offer a detailed blueprint for action, but instead a pathway by which the peoples of the world may enlarge their spheres of cooperation. I. The Global Challenge 1. Successes and failures 5. Those looking for success and signs of hope can find many: infant mortality is falling; human
  • 12. life expectancy is increasing; the proportion of the world's adults who can read and write is climbing; the proportion of children starting school is rising; and global food production increases faster than the population grows. 6. But the same processes that have produced these gains have given rise to trends that the planet and its people cannot long bear. These have traditionally been divided into failures of 'development' and failures in the management of our human environment. On the development side, in terms of absolute numbers there are more hungry people in the world than ever before, and their numbers are increasing. So are the numbers who cannot read or write, the numbers without safe water or safe and sound homes, and the numbers short of woodfuel with which to cook and warm themselves. The gap between rich and poor nations is widening - not shrinking - and there is little prospect, given present trends and institutional arrangements, that this process will be reversed. 7. There are also environmental trends that threaten to radically alter the planet, that threaten the lives of many species upon it. including the human species. Each year another 6 million hectares of productive dryland turns into worthless desert. Over three decades, this would amount to an area roughly as large as Saudi Arabia. More than 11 million hectares of forests are destroyed yearly, and this, over three decades, would equal an area about the size of India. Much of this forest is converted to low-grade farmland unable to support the farmers who settle it. In Europe, acid precipitation kills forests and lakes and damages the artistic and architectural heritage of nations; it may have acidified vast tracts of soil beyond reasonable hope of repair. The burning of fossil fuels puts into the atmosphere carbon dioxide, which is causing gradual global warming. This 'greenhouse effect' may by early next century have increased average global temperatures enough to shift agricultural production areas, raise sea levels to flood coastal cities, and disrupt national economies. Other industrial gases threaten to deplete the planet's protective ozone shield to such an extent that the number of human and animal cancers would rise sharply and the oceans' food chain would be disrupted, industry and agriculture put toxic substances into the human food chain and into underground water tables beyond reach of cleansing. 8. There has been a growing realization in national governments and multilateral institutions that it is impossible to separate economic development issues from environment issues; many forms of development erode the environmental resources upon which they must be based, and environmental degradation can undermine economic development. Poverty is a major cause and effect of global environmental problems. It is therefore futile to attempt to deal with environmental problems without a broader perspective that encompasses the factors underlying world poverty and international inequality. 9. These concerns were behind the establishment in 1983 of the World Commission on Environment and Development by the UN General Assembly. The Commission is an independent body, linked to but outside the control of governments and the UN system. The Commission's mandate gave it three objectives: to re-examine the critical environment and development issues and to formulate realistic proposals for dealing with them; to propose new forms of international cooperation on these issues that will influence policies and events in the direction of needed changes; and to raise the levels of understanding and commitment to action of individuals, voluntary organizations, businesses, institutes, and governments. 10. Through our deliberations and the testimony of people at the public hearings we held on five continents, all the commissioners came to focus on one central theme: many present development trends leave increasing numbers of people poor and vulnerable, while at the same time degrading the environment. How can such development serve next century's world
  • 13. of twice as many people relying on the same environment? This realization broadened our view of development. We came to see it not in its restricted context of economic growth in developing countries. We came to see that a new development path was required, one that sustained human progress not just in a few pieces for a few years, but for the entire planet into the distant future. Thus 'sustainable development' becomes a goal not just for the 'developing' nations, but for industrial ones as well. 2. The Interlocking Crises 11. Until recently, the planet was a large world in which human activities and their effects were neatly compartmentalized within nations, within sectors (energy, agriculture, trade), and within broad areas of concern (environment, economics, social). These compartments have begun to dissolve. This applies in particular to the various global 'crises' that have seized public concern, particularly over the past decade. These are not separate crises: an environmental crisis, a development crisis, an energy crisis. They are all one. 12. The planet is passing through a period of dramatic growth and fundamental change. Our human world of 5 billion must make room in a finite environment for another human world. The population could stabilize at between 8 and 14 billion sometime next century, according to UN projections. More than 90 per cent of the increase will occur in the poorest countries, and 90 per cent of that growth in already bursting cities. 13. Economic activity has multiplied to create a $13 trillion world economy, and this could grow five to tenfold in the coming half century. Industrial production has grown more than fiftyfold over the past century, four-fifths of this growth since 1950. Such figures reflect and presage profound impacts upon the biosphere, as the world invests in houses, transport, farms, and industries. Much of the economic growth pulls raw material from forests, soils, seas, and waterways. The World Commission on Environment and Development first met in October 1984. and published its Report 900 days later, in April 1987. Over those few days: The drought-triggered, environment-development crisis in Africa peaked, putting 36 million people at risk, killing perhaps a million. A leak from a pesticides factory in Bhopal, India, killed more than 2,000 people and blinded and injured over 200,000 more. Liquid gas tanks exploded in Mexico City, killing 1,000 and leaving thousands more homeless. The Chernobyl nuclear reactor explosion sent nuclear fallout across Europe, increasing the risks of future human cancers. Agricultural chemicals, solvents, and mercury flowed into the Rhine River during a warehouse fire in Switzerland, killing millions of fish and threatening drinking water in the Federal Republic of Germany and the Netherlands. An estimated 60 million people died of diarrhoeal diseases related to unsafe drinking water and malnutrition; most of the victims were children.
  • 14. 14. A mainspring of economic growth is new technology, and while this technology offers the potential for slowing the dangerously rapid consumption of finite resources, it also entails high risks, including new forms of pollution and the introduction to the planet of new variations of life forms that could change evolutionary pathways. Meanwhile, the industries most heavily reliant on environmental resources and most heavily polluting are growing most rapidly in the developing world, where there is both more urgency for growth and less capacity to minimize damaging side effects. 15. These related changes have locked the global economy and global ecology together in new ways. We have in the past been concerned about the impacts of economic growth upon the environment. We are now forced to concern ourselves with the impacts of ecological stress - degradation of soils, water regimes, atmosphere, and forests upon our economic prospects. We have in the more recent past been forced to face up to a sharp increase in economic interdependence among nations. We are now forced to accustom ourselves to an accelerating ecological interdependence among nations. Ecology and economy are becoming ever more interwoven locally, regionally, nationally, and globally into a seamless net of causes and effects. 16. Impoverishing the local resource base can impoverish wider areas: deforestation by highland farmers causes flooding on lowland farms; factory pollution robs local fishermen of their catch. Such grim local cycles now operate nationally and regionally. Dryland degradation sends environmental refugees in their millions across national borders. Deforestation in Latin America and Asia is causing more floods, and more destructive floods, in downhill, downstream nations. Acid precipitation and nuclear fallout have spread across the borders of Europe. Similar phenomena are emerging on a global scale, such as global warming and loss of ozone. Internationally traded hazardous chemicals entering foods are themselves internationally traded. In the next century, the environmental pressure causing population movements may be increase sharply, while barriers to that movement may be even firmer than they are now. 17. Over the past few decades, life-threatening environmental concerns have surfaced in the developing world. Countrysides are coming under pressure from increasing numbers of farmers and the landless. Cities are filling with people, cars, and factories. Yet at the same time these developing countries oust operate in a world in which the resources gap between most developing and industrial nations is widening, in which the industrial world dominates in the rule-making of some key international bodies and in which the industrial world has already used much of the planet's ecological capital. This inequality is the planet's main 'environmental' problem; it is also its main 'development' problem. 18. International economic relationships pose a particular problem for environmental management in many developing countries. Agriculture, forestry, energy production, and mining generate at least half the gross national product of many developing countries and account for even larger shares of livelihoods and employment. Exports of natural resources remain a large factor in their economies, especially for the least developed. Most of these countries face enormous economic pressures, both international and domestic, to overexploit their environmental resource base. 19. The recent crisis in Africa best and most tragically illustrates the ways in which economics and ecology can interact destructively and trip into disaster. Triggered by drought, its real causes lie deeper. They are to be found in part in national policies that gave too little attention, too late, to the needs of smallholder agriculture and to the threats posed by rapidly rising populations. Their roots extend also to a global economic system that takes more out of a poor continent than it puts in. Debts that they cannot pay force African nations relying on
  • 15. commodity sales to overuse their fragile soils, thus turning good land to desert. Trade barriers in the wealthy nations - and in many developing nations - make it hard for African nations to sell their goods for reasonable returns, putting yet more pressure on ecological systems. Aid from donor nations has not only been inadequate in scale, but too often has reflected the priorities of the nations giving the aid, rather than the needs of the recipients. The Commission has sought ways in which global development can be put on a sustainable path into the 21st Century. Some 5,000 days will elapse between the publication of our report and the first day of the 21st Century. What environmental crises lie in store over those 5,000 days? During the 1970s, twice as many people suffered each year from 'natural' disasters as during the 1960s. The disasters most directly associated with environment/development mismanagement - droughts and floods - affected the most people and increased most sharply in terms of numbers affected. Some 18.5 million people were affected by drought annually in the 1960s, 24.4 million in the 1970s. There were 5.2 million flood victims yearly in the 1960s, 15.4 million in the 1970s. Numbers of victims of cyclones and earthquakes also shot up as growing numbers of poor people built unsafe houses on dangerous ground. The results are not in for the 1960s. But we have seen 35 billion afflicted by drought in Africa alone and tens of millions affected by the better managed and thus less-publicized Indian drought. Floods have poured off the deforested Andes and Himalayas with increasing force. The 1960s seem destined to sweep this dire trend on into a crisis-filled 1990s. 20. The production base of other developing world areas suffers similarly from both local failures and from the workings of international economic systems. As a consequence of the 'debt crisis' of Latin America, that continent's natural resources are now being used not for development but to meet financial obligations to creditors abroad. This approach to the debt problem is short-sighted from several standpoints: economic, political, and environmental. It requires relatively poor countries simultaneously to accept growing poverty while exporting growing amounts of scarce resources. 21. A majority of developing countries now have lower per capita incomes than when the decade began. Rising poverty and unemployment have increased pressure on environmental resources as more people have been forced to rely more directly upon them. Many governments have cut back efforts to protect the environment and to bring ecological considerations into development planning. 22. The deepening and widening environmental crisis presents a threat to national security - and even survival - that may be greater than well-armed, ill-disposed neighbours and unfriendly alliances. Already in parts of Latin America, Asia, the Middle East, and Africa, environmental decline is becoming a source of political unrest and international tension. The recent destruction of much of Africa's dryland agricultural production was more severe than if an invading army had pursued a scorched-earth policy. Yet most of the affected governments still spend far more to protect their people from invading armies than from the invading desert. 23. Globally, military expenditures total about $1 trillion a year and continue to grow. In many
  • 16. countries, military spending consumes such a high proportion of GNP that it itself does great damage to these societies' development efforts. Governments tend to base their approaches to 'security' on traditional definitions. This is most obvious in the attempts to achieve security through the development of potentially planet-destroying nuclear weapons systems. Studies suggest that the cold and dark nuclear winter following even a limited nuclear war could destroy plant and animal ecosystems and leave any human survivors occupying a devastated planet very different from the one they inherited. 24. The arms race - in all parts of the world - pre-empts resources that might be used more productively to diminish the security threats created by environmental conflict and the resentments that are fuelled by widespread poverty. 25. Many present efforts to guard and maintain human progress, to meet human needs, and to realize human ambitions are simply unsustainable - in both the rich and poor nations. They draw too heavily, too quickly, on already overdrawn environmental resource accounts to be affordable far into the future without bankrupting those accounts. They may show profit on the balance sheets of our generation, but our children will inherit the losses. We borrow environmental capital from future generations with no intention or prospect of repaying. They may damn us for our spendthrift ways, but they can never collect on our debt to them. We act as we do because we can get away with it: future generations do not vote; they have no political or financial power; they cannot challenge our decisions. 26. But the results of the present profligacy are rapidly closing the options for future generations. Most of today's decision makers will be dead before the planet feels; the heavier effects of acid precipitation, global warming, ozone depletion, or widespread desertification and species loss. Most of the young voters of today will still be alive. In the Commission's hearings it was the young, those who have the most to lose, who were the harshest critics of the planet's present management. 3. Sustainable Development 27. Humanity has the ability to make development sustainable to ensure that it meets the needs of the present without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs. The concept of sustainable development does imply limits - not absolute limits but limitations imposed by the present state of technology and social organization on environmental resources and by the ability of the biosphere to absorb the effects of human activities. But technology and social organization can be both managed and improved to make way for a new era of economic growth. The Commission believes that widespread poverty is no longer inevitable. Poverty is not only an evil in itself, but sustainable development requires meeting the basic needs of all and extending to all the opportunity to fulfil their aspirations for a better life. A world in which poverty is endemic will always be prone to ecological and other catastrophes. 28. Meeting essential needs requires not only a new era of economic growth for nations in which the majority are poor, but an assurance that those poor get their fair share of the resources required to sustain that growth. Such equity would be aided by political systems that secure effective citizen participation in decision making and by greater democracy in international decision making. 29. Sustainable global development requires that those who are more affluent adopt life-styles within the planet's ecological means - in their use of energy, for example. Further, rapidly growing populations can increase the pressure on resources and slow any rise in living
  • 17. standards; thus sustainable development can only be pursued if population size and growth are in harmony with the changing productive potential of the ecosystem. 30. Yet in the end, sustainable development is not a fixed state of harmony, but rather a process of change in which the exploitation of resources, the direction of investments, the orientation of technological development, and institutional change are made consistent with future as well as present needs. We do not pretend that the process is easy or straightforward. Painful choices have to be made. Thus, in the final analysis, sustainable development must rest on political will. 4. The Institutional Gaps 31. The objective of sustainable development and the integrated nature of the global environment/development challenges pose problems for institutions, national and international, that were established on the basis of narrow preoccupations and compartmentalized concerns. Governments' general response to the speed and scale of global changes has been a reluctance to recognize sufficiently the need to change themselves. The challenges are both interdependent and integrated, requiring comprehensive approaches and popular participation. 32. Yet most of the institutions facing those challenges tend to be independent, fragmented, working to relatively narrow mandates with closed decision processes. Those responsible for managing natural resources and protecting the environment are institutionally separated from those responsible for managing the economy. The real world of interlocked economic and ecological systems will not change; the policies and institutions concerned must. 33. There is a growing need for effective international cooperation to manage ecological and economic interdependence. Yet at the same time, confidence in international organizations is diminishing and support for them dwindling. 34. The other great institutional flaw in coping with environment/development challenges is governments' failure to make the bodies whose policy actions degrade the environment responsible for ensuring that their policies prevent that degradation. Environmental concern arose from damage caused by the rapid economic growth following the Second World War. Governments, pressured by their citizens, saw a need to clean up the mess, and they established environmental ministries and agencies to do this. Many had great success within the limits of their mandates - in improving air and water quality and enhancing other resources. But much of their work has of necessity been after-the-fact repair of damage: reforestation, reclaiming desert lands, rebuilding urban environments, restoring natural habitats, and rehabilitating wild lands. 35. The existence of such agencies gave many governments and their citizens the false impression that these bodies were by themselves able to protect and enhance the environmental resource base. Yet many industrialized and most developing countries carry huge economic burdens from inherited problems such an air and water pollution, depletion of groundwater, and the proliferation of toxic chemicals and hazardous wastes. These have been joined by more recent problems - erosion, desertification, acidification, new chemicals, and new forms of waste - that are directly related to agricultural, industrial, energy, forestry, and transportation policies and practices. 36. The mandates of the central economic and sectoral ministries are also often too narrow, too concerned with quantities of production or growth. The mandates of ministries of industry
  • 18. include production targets, while the accompanying pollution is left to ministries of environment. Electricity boards produce power, while the acid pollution they also produce is left to other bodies to clean up. The present challenge is to give the central economic and sectoral ministries the responsibility for the quality of those parts of the human environment affected by their decisions, and to give the environmental agencies more power to cope with the effects of unsustainable development. 37. The same need for change holds for international agencies concerned with development lending, trade regulation, agricultural development, and so on. These have been slow to take the environmental effects of their work into account, although some are trying to do so. 38. The ability to anticipate and prevent environmental damage requires that the ecological dimensions of policy be considered at the same time as the economic, trade, energy, agricultural, and other dimensions. They should be considered on the same agendas and in the same national and international institutions. 39. This reorientation is one of the chief institutional challenges of the 1990s and beyond. Meeting it will require major institutional development and reform. Many countries that are too poor or small or that have limited managerial capacity will find it difficult to do this unaided. They will need financial and technical assistance and training. But the changes required involve all countries, large and small, rich and poor. II. The Policy Directions 40. The Commission has focused its attention in the areas of population, food security, the loss of species and genetic resources, energy, industry, and human settlements - realizing that all of these are connected and cannot be treated in isolation one from another. This section contains only a few of the Commission's many recommendations. 1. Population and Human Resources 41. In many parts of the world, the population is growing at rates that cannot be sustained by available environmental resources, at rates that are outstripping any reasonable expectations of improvements in housing, health care, food security, or energy supplies. 42. The issue is not just numbers of people, but how those numbers relate to available resources. Thus the 'population problem' must be dealt with in part by efforts to eliminate mass poverty, in order to assure more equitable access to resources, and by education to improve human potential to manage those resources. 43. Urgent steps are needed to limit extreme rates of population growth. Choices made now will influence the level at which the population stabilizes next century within a range of 6 billion people. But this is not just a demographic issue; providing people with facilities and education that allow them to choose the size of their families is a way of assuring - especially for women - the basic human right of self-determination. 44. Governments that need to do so should develop long-term, multifaceted population policies and a campaign to pursue broad demographic goals: to strengthen social, cultural, and economic motivations for family planning, and to provide to all who want them the education, contraceptives, and services required. 45. Human resource development is a crucial requirement not only to build up technical
  • 19. knowledge and capabilities, but also to create new values to help individuals and nations cope with rapidly changing social, environmental, and development realities. Knowledge shared globally would assure greater mutual understanding and create greater willingness to share global resources equitably. 46. Tribal and indigenous peoples will need special attention as the forces of economic development disrupt their traditional life-styles - life-styles that can offer modern societies many lessons in the management of resources in complex forest, mountain, and dryland ecosystems. Some are threatened with virtual extinction by insensitive development over which they have no control. Their traditional rights should be recognized and they should be given a decisive voice in formulating policies about resource development in their areas. (See Chapter 4 for a wider discussion of these issues and recommendations.) 2. Food Security: Sustaining the Potential 47. Growth in world cereal production has steadily outstripped world population growth. Yet each year there are more people in the world who do not get enough food. Global agriculture has the potential to grow enough food for all, but food is often not available where it is needed. 48. Production in industrialized countries has usually been highly subsidized and protected from international competition. These subsidies have encouraged the overuse of soil and chemicals, the pollution of both water resources and foods with these chemicals, and the degradation of the countryside. Much of this effort has produced surpluses and their associated financial burdens. And some of this surplus has been sent at concessional rates to the developing world, where it has undermined the farming policies of recipient nations. There is, however, growing awareness in some countries of the environmental and economic consequences of such paths, and the emphasis of agricultural policies is to encourage conservation. 49. Many developing countries, on the other hand, have suffered the opposite problem: farmers are not sufficiently supported. In some, improved technology allied to price incentives and government services has produced a major breakthrough in food production. But elsewhere, the food-growing small farmers have been neglected. Coping with often inadequate technology and few economic incentives, many are pushed onto marginal land: too dry, too steep, lacking in nutrients. Forests are cleared and productive drylands rendered barren. 50. Most developing nations need more effective incentive systems to encourage production, especially of food crops. In short, the 'terms of trade' need to be turned in favour of the small farmer. Most industrialized nations, on the other hand, must alter present systems in order to cut surpluses, to reduce unfair competition with nations that may have real comparative advantages, and to promote ecologically sound farming practices. 51. Food security requires attention to questions of distribution, since hunger often arises from lack of purchasing power rather than lack of available food. It can be furthered by land reforms, and by policies to protect vulnerable subsistence farmers, pastora1ists, and the landless - groups who by the year 2000 will include 220 million households. Their greater prosperity will depend on integrated rural development that increases work opportunities both inside and outside agriculture. (See Chapter 5 for a wider discussion of these issues and recommendations.)
  • 20. 3. Species and Ecosystems: Resources for Development 52. The planet's species are under stress. There is a growing scientific consensus that species are disappearing at rates never before witnessed on the planet, although there is also controversy over those rates and the risks they entail. Yet there is still time to halt this process. 53. The diversity of species is necessary for the normal functioning of ecosystems and the biosphere as a whole. The genetic material in wild species contributes billions of dollars yearly to the world economy in the form of improved crop species, new drugs and medicines, and raw materials for industry. But utility aside, there are also moral, ethical, cultural, aesthetic, and purely scientific reasons for conserving wild beings. 54. A first priority is to establish the problem of disappearing species and threatened ecosystems on political agendas as a major economic and resource issue. 55. Governments can stem the destruction of tropical forests and other reservoirs of biological diversity while developing them economically. Reforming forest revenue systems and concession terms could raise billions of dollars of additional revenues, promote more efficient, long-term forest resource use, and curtail deforestation. 56. The network of protected areas that the world will need in the future must include much larger areas brought under so.ne degree of protection. Therefore, the cost of conservation will rise - directly and in terms of opportunities for development foregone. But over the long term the opportunities for development will be enhanced. International development agencies should therefore give comprehensive and systematic attention to the problems and opportunities of species conservation. 57. Governments should investigate the prospect of agreeing to a 'Species Convention', similar in spirit and scope to other international conventions reflecting principles of 'universal resources'. They should also consider international financial arrangements to support the implementation of such a convention. (See Chapter 6 for a wider discussion of these issues and recommendations.) 4. Energy: Choices for Environment and Development 58. A safe and sustainable energy pathway is crucial to sustainable development; we have not yet found it. Rates of increase in energy use have been declining. However, the industrialization, agricultural development, and rapidly growing populations of developing nations will need much more energy. Today, the average person in an industrial market economy uses more than 80 times as much energy as someone in sub-Saharan Africa. Thus any realistic global energy scenario must provide for substantially increased primary energy use by developing countries. 59. To bring developing countries' energy use up to industrialized country levels by the year 2025 would require increasing present global energy use by a factor of five. The planetary ecosystem could not stand this, especially if the increases were based on non-renewable fossil fuels. Threats of global warming and acidification of the environment most probably rule out even a doubling of energy use bared on present mixes of primary sources. 60. Any new era of economic growth must therefore be less energy intensive than growth in the past. Energy efficiency policies must be the cutting edge of national energy strategies for sustainable development, and there is much scope for improvement in this direction. Modern
  • 21. appliances can be redesigned to deliver the same amounts of energy-services with only two-thirds or even one-half of the primary energy inputs needed to run traditional equipment. And energy efficiency solutions are often cost-effective. 61. After almost four decades of immense technological effort, nuclear energy has become widely used. During this period, however, the nature of its costs, risks, and benefits have become more evident and the subject of sharp controversy. Different countries world-wide take up different positions on the use of nuclear energy. The discussion in the Commission also reflected these different views and positions. Yet all agreed that the generation of nuclear power is only justifiable if there are solid solutions to the unsolved problems to which it gives rise. The highest priority should be accorded to research and development on environmentally sound and ecologically viable alternatives, as well as on means of increasing the safety of nuclear energy. 62. Energy efficiency can only buy time for the world to develop 'low-energy paths' based on renewable sources, which should form the foundation of the global energy structure during the 21st Century. Most of these sources are currently problematic, but given innovative development, they could supply the same amount of primary energy the planet now consumes. However, achieving these use levels will require a programme of coordinated research, development, and demonstration projects commanding funding necessary to ensure the rapid development of renewable energy. Developing countries will require assistance to change their energy use patterns in this direction. 63. Millions of people in the developing world are short of fuelwood, the main domestic energy of half of humanity, and their numbers are growing. The wood-poor nations must organize their agricultural sectors to produce large amounts of wood and other plant fuels. 64. The substantial changes required in the present global energy mix will not be achieved by market pressures alone, given the dominant role of governments as producers of energy and their importance as consumers. If the recent momentum behind annual gains in energy efficiency is to be maintained and extended,governments need to make it an explicit goal of their policies for energy pricing to consumers, prices needed to encourage the adoption of energy-saving measures may be achieved through several means. Although the Commission expresses no preference, 'conservation pricing' requires that governments take a long-term view in weighing the costs and benefits of the various measures. Given the importance of oil prices on international energy policy, new mechanisms for encouraging dialogue between consumers and producers should be explored. 65. A safe, environmentally sound, and economically viable energy pathway that will sustain human progress into the distant future is clearly imperative. It is also possible. But it will require new dimensions of political will and institutional cooperation to achieve it. (See Chapter 7 for a wider discussion of these issues and recommendations.) 5. Industry: Producing More with Less 66. The world manufactures seven times more goods today than it did as recently as 1950. Given population growth rates, a five- to tenfold increase in manufacturing output will be needed just to raise developing world consumption of manufactured goods to industrialized world levels by the time population growth rates level off next century. 67. Experience in the industrialized nations has proved that anti-pollution technology has been cost-effective in terms of health, property, and environmental damage avoided, and that
  • 22. it has made many industries more profitable by waking them more resource-efficient. While economic growth has continued, the consumption of raw materials has held steady or even declined, and new technologies offer further efficiencies. 68. Nations have to bear the costs of any inappropriate industrialization, and many developing countries are realizing that they have neither the resources nor - given rapid technological change - the time to damage their environments now and clean up later. But they also need assistance and information from industrialized nations to make the best use of technology. Transnational corporations have a special responsibility to smooth the path of industrialization in the nations in which they operate. 69. Emerging technologies offer the promise of higher productivity, increased efficiency, and decreased pollution, but many bring risks of new toxic chemicals and wastes and of major accidents of a type and scale beyond present coping mechanisms. There is an urgent need for tighter controls over the export of hazardous industrial and agricultural chemicals. Present controls over the dumping of hazardous wastes should be tightened. 70. Many essential human needs can be net only through goods and services provided by industry, and the shift to sustainable development must be powered by a continuing flow of wealth from industry. (See Chapter 8 for a wider discussion of these issues and recommendations.) 6. The Urban Challenge 71. By the turn of the century, almost half of humanity will live in cities; the world of the 21st century will be a largely urban world. Over only 65 years, the developing world's urban population has increased tenfold, from around 100 million in 1920 to 1 billion today. In 1940, one person in 100 lived in a city of 1 million or more inhabitants; by 1980, one in 10 lived in such a city. Between 1985 and the year 2000, Third World cities could grow by another three-quarters of a billion people. This suggests that the developing world must, over the next few years, increase by 65 per cent its capacity to produce and manage its urban infrastructure, services, and shelter merely to maintain today's often extremely inadequate conditions. 72. Few city governments in the developing world have the power, resources, and trained personnel to provide their rapidly growing populations with the land, services, and facilities needed for an adequate human life: clean water, sanitation, schools, and transport. The result is mushrooming illegal settlements with primitive facilities, increased overcrowding, and rampant disease linked to an unhealthy environment. Many cities in industrial countries also face problems - deteriorating infrastructure, environmental degradation, inner-city decay, and neighbourhood collapse. But with the means and resources to tackle this decline, the issue for most industrial countries is ultimately one of political and social choice. Developing countries are not in the same situation. They have a major urban crisis on their hands. 73. Governments will need to develop explicit settlements strategies to guide the process of urbanization, taking the pressure off the largest urban centres and building up smaller towns and cities, more closely integrating them with their rural hinterlands. This will mean examining and changing other policies - taxation, food pricing, transportation, health, industrialization - that work against the goals of settlements strategies. 74. Good city management requires decentralization of funds, political power, and personnel - to local authorities, which are best placed to appreciate and manage local needs. But the sustainable development of cities will depend on closer work with the majorities of urban poor
  • 23. who are the true city builders, tapping the skills, energies and resources of neighbourhood groups and those in the 'informal sector'. Much can be achieved by 'site and service' schemes that provide households with basic services and help them to get on with building sounder houses around these. (See Chapter 9 for a wider discussion of these issues and recommendations.) III. International Cooperation and Institutional Reform 1. The Role of the International Economy 75. Two conditions must be satisfied before international economic exchanges can become beneficial for all involved. The sustainability of ecosystems on which the global economy depends must be guaranteed. And the economic partners must be satisfied that the basis of exchange is equitable. For many developing countries, neither condition is set. 76. Growth in many developing countries is being stifled by depressed commodity prices, protectionism, intolerable debt burdens, and declining flows of development finance. If living standards are to grow so as to alleviate poverty, these trends must be reversed. 77. A particular responsibility falls to the World Bank and the International Development Association as the main conduit for multilateral finance to developing countries. In the context of consistently increased financial flows, the World Bank can support environmentally sound projects and policies. In financing structural adjustment, the International Monetary Fund should support wider and longer term development objectives than at present: growth, social goals, and environmental impacts. 78. The present level of debt service of many countries, especially in Africa and Latin America, is not consistent with sustainable development. Debtors are being required to use trade surpluses to service debts, and are drawing heavily on non-renewable resources to do so. Urgent action is necessary to alleviate debt burdens in ways that represent a fairer sharing between both debtors and lenders of the responsibilities and burdens. 79. Current arrangements for commodities could be significantly improved: more compensatory financing to offset economic shocks would encourage producers to take a long-term view, and not to overproduce commodities; and more assistance could be given from diversification programmes. Commodity-specific arrangements can build on the model of the International Tropical Timber Agreement, one of the few that specifically includes ecological concerns 80. Multinational companies can play an important role in sustainable development, especially as developing countries come to rely more on foreign equity capital. But if these companies are to have a positive influence on development, the negotiating capacity of developing countries vis a vis transnationals must be strengthened so they can secure terms which respect their environmental concerns. 81. However, these specific measures must be located in a wider context of effective cooperation to produce an international economic system geared to growth and the elimination of world poverty. (See Chapter 3 for a more detailed discussion of issues and recommendations on the international economy.) 2. Managing the Commons
  • 24. 82. Traditional forms of national sovereignty raise particular problems in managing the 'global commons' and their shared ecosystems - the oceans, outer space, and Antarctica. Some progress has been made in all three areas; much remains to be done. 83. The UN Conference on the Law of the Sea was the most ambitious attempt ever to provide an internationally agreed regime for the management of the oceans. All nations should ratify the Law of the Sea Treaty as soon at possible. Fisheries agreements should be strengthened to prevent current overexploitation, as should conventions to control and regulate the dumping of hazardous wastes at sea. 84. There are growing concerns about the management of orbital space, centering on using satellite technology for monitoring planetary systems; on making the most effective use of the limited capacities of geosynchronous orbit for communications satellites; and on limiting space debris. The orbiting and testing of weapons in space would greatly increase this debris. The international community should seek to design and implement a space regime to ensure that space remains a peaceful environment for the benefit of all. 85. Antarctica is managed under the 1959 Antarctica Treaty. However, many nations outside of that pact view the Treaty System as too limited, both in participation and in the scope of its conservation measures. The Commission's recommendations deal with the safeguarding of present achievements; the incorporation of any minerals development into a management regime; and various options for the future. (See Chapter 10 for more discussion in issues and recommendations on the management of the commons.) 3. Peace, Security, Development, and the Environment 86. Among the dangers facing the environment, the possibility of nuclear war is undoubtedly the gravest. Certain aspects of the issues of peace and security bear directly upon the concept of sustainable development. The whole notion of security as traditionally understood in terms of political and military threats to national sovereignty - must be expanded to include the growing impacts of environmental stress - locally, nationally, regionally, and globally. There are no military solutions to 'environmental insecurity'. 87. Governments and international agencies should assess the cost-effectiveness, in terms of achieving security, of money spent on armaments compared with money spent on reducing poverty or restoring a ravaged environment. 88. But the greatest need is to achieve improved relations among those major powers capable of deploying weapons of mass destruction. This is needed to achieve agreement on tighter control over the proliferation and testing of various types of weapons of mass destruction - nuclear and non nuclear - including those that have environmental implications. (See Chapter 11 for more discussion of issues and recommendations on the links between peace, security, development, and the environment.) 4. Institutional and Legal Change 89. The Report that follows contains throughout (and especially in Chapter 12), many specific recommendations for institutional and legal change. These cannot be adequately summarized here. However, the Commission's main proposals are embodied in six priority areas.
  • 25. 4.1 Getting at the Sources 90. Governments must begin now to make the key national, economic, and sectoral agencies directly responsible and accountable for ensuring that their policies, programmes, and budgets support development that is economically and ecologically sustainable. 91. By the same token, the various regional organizations need to do more to integrate environment fully in their goals and activities. New regional arrangements will especially be needed among developing countries to deal with transboundary environmental issues. 92. All major international bodies and agencies should ensure that their programmes encourage and support sustainable development, and they should greatly improve their coordination and cooperation. The Secretary-General of the United Nations Organization should provide a high level centre of leadership for the UN system to assess, advise, assist, and report on progress made towards this goal. 4.2 Dealing with the Effects 93. Governments should also reinforce the roles and capacities of environmental protection and resource management agencies. This is needed in many industrialized countries, but most urgently in developing countries, which will need assistance in strengthening their institutions. The UN Environment Programme (UNEP) should be strengthened as the principal source on environmental data, assessment, and reporting and as the principal advocate and agent for change and international cooperation on critical environment and natural resource protection issues. 4.3 Assessing Global Risks 94. The capacity to identify, assess, and report on risks of irreversible damage to natural systems and threats to the survival, security, and well being of the world community must be rapidly reinforced and extended. Governments, individually and collectively, have the principal responsibility to do this. UNEP's Earthwatch programme should be the centre of leadership in the UN system on risk assessment 95. However, given the politically sensitive nature of many of the most critical risks, there is also a need for an independent but complementary capacity to assess and report on critical global risks. A new international programme for cooperation among largely non-governmental organizations, scientific bodies, and industry groups should therefore be established for this purpose. 4.4 Making Informed Choices 96. Making the difficult choices involved in achieving sustainable development will depend on the widespread support and involvement of an informed public and of NGOs, the scientific community, and industry. Their rights, roles and participation in development planning, decision-making, and project implementation should be expanded.
  • 26. 4.5 Providing the Legal Means 97. National and international law is being rapidly outdistanced by the accelerating pace and expanding scale of impacts on the ecological basis of development. Governments now need to fill major gaps in existing national and international law related to the environment, to find ways to recognize and protect the rights of present and future generations to an environment adequate for their health and well-being, to prepare under UN auspices a universal Declaration on environmental protection and sustainable development and a subsequent Convention, and to strengthen procedures for avoiding or resolving disputes on environment and resource management issues. 4.6 Investing in our Future 98. Over the past decade, the overall cost-effectiveness of investments in halting pollution has been demonstrated. The escalating economic and ecological damage costs of not investing in environmental protection and improvement have also been repeatedly demonstrated - often in grim tolls of flood and famine. But there are large financial implications: for renewable energy development, pollution control, and achieving less resource intensive forms of agriculture. 99. Multilateral financial institutions have a crucial role to play. The World Bank is presently reorienting its programmes towards greater environmental concerns. This should be accompanied by a fundamental commitment to sustainable development by the Bank. It is also essential that the Regional Development Banks and the International Monetary Fund incorporate similar objectives in their policies and programmes. A new priority and focus is also needed in bilateral aid agencies. 100. Given the limitations on increasing present flows of international aid, proposals for securing additional revenue from the use of international commons and natural resources should now be seriously considered by governments. IV. A Call for Action 101. Over the course of this century, the relationship between the human world and the planet that sustains it has undergone a profound change. 102. When the century began, neither human numbers nor technology had the power radically to alter planetary systems. As the century closes, not only do vastly increased human numbers and their activities have that power, but major, unintended changes are occurring in the atmosphere, in soils, in waters, among plants and animals, and in the relationships among all of these. The rate of change is outstripping the ability of scientific disciplines and our current capabilities to assess and advise. It is frustrating the attempts of political and economic institutions, which evolved in a different, more fragmented world, to adapt and cope. It deeply worries many people who are seeking ways to place those concerns on the political agendas. 103. The onus lies with no one group of nations. Developing countries face the obvious life-threatening challenges of desertification, deforestation, and pollution, and endure most of the poverty associated with environmental degradation. The entire human family of nations would suffer from the disappearance of rain forests in the tropics, the loss of plant and animal species, and changes in rainfall patterns. Industrial nations face the life-threatening challenges
  • 27. of toxic chemicals, toxic wastes, and acidification. All nations may suffer from the releases by industrialized countries of carbon dioxide and of gases that react with the ozone layer, and from any future war fought with the nuclear arsenals controlled by those nations. All nations will have a role to play in changing trends, and in righting an international economic system that increases rather than decreases inequality, that increases rather than decreases numbers of poor and hungry. 104. The next few decades are crucial. The time has come to break out of past patterns. Attempts to maintain social and ecological stability through old approaches to development and environmental protection will increase instability. Security must be sought through change. The Commission has noted a number of actions that must be taken to reduce risks to survival and to put future development on paths that are sustainable. Yet we are aware that such a reorientation on a continuing basis is simply beyond the reach of present decision-making structures and institutional arrangements, both national and international. 105. This Commission has been careful to base our recommendations on the realities of present institutions, on what can and must be accomplished today. But to keep options open for future generations, the present generation must begin now, and begin together. 106. To achieve the needed changes, we believe that an active follow-up of this report is imperative. It is with this in mind that we call for the UN General Assembly, upon due consideration, to transform this report into a UN Programme on Sustainable Development. Special follow-up conferences could be initiated at the regional level. Within an appropriate period after the presentation of this report to the General Assembly, an international conference could be convened to review progress made, and to promote follow up arrangements that will be needed to set benchmarks and to maintain human progress. 107. First and foremost, this Commission has been concerned with people - of all countries and all walks of life. And it is to people that we address our report. The changes in human attitudes that we call for depend on a vast campaign of education, debate, and public participation. This campaign must start now if sustainable human progress is to be achieved. 108. The Members of the World Commission on Environment and Development came from 21 very different nations. In our discussions, we disagreed often on details and priorities. But despite our widely differing backgrounds and varying national and international responsibilities, we were able to agree to the lines along which change must be drawn. 109. We are unanimous in our conviction that the security, well-being, and very survival of the planet depend on such changes, now.
  • 28. Our Common Future, Chapter 1: A Threatened Future I. Symptoms and Causes 1. Poverty 2. Growth 3. Survival 4. The Economic Crisis II. New Approaches to Environment and Development 1. The Earth is one but the world is not. We all depend on one biosphere for sustaining our lives. Yet each community, each country, strives for survival and prosperity with little regard for its impact on others. Some consume the Earth's resources at a rate that would leave little for future generations. Others, many more in number, consume far too little and live with the prospect of hunger, squalor, disease, and early death. 2. Yet progress has been made. Throughout much of the world, children born today can expect to live longer and be better educated than their parents. In many parts, the new-born can also expect to attain a higher standard of living in a wider sense. Such progress provides hope as we contemplate the improvements still needed, and also as we face our failures to make this Earth a safer and sounder home for us and for those who are to come. 3. The failures that we need to correct arise both from poverty and from the short-sighted way in which we have often pursued prosperity. Many parts of the world are caught in a vicious downwards spiral: Poor people are forced to overuse environmental resources to survive from day to day, and their impoverishment of their environment further impoverishes them, making their survival ever more difficult and uncertain. The prosperity attained in some parts of the world is often precarious, as it has been secured through farming, forestry, and industrial practices that bring profit and progress only over the short term. 4. Societies have faced such pressures in the past and, as many desolate ruins remind us, sometimes succumbed to them. But generally these pressures were local. Today the scale of ow interventions in nature is increasing and the physical effects of our decisions spill across national frontiers. The growth in economic interaction between nations amplifies the wider consequences of national decisions. Economics and ecology bind us in ever-tightening networks. Today, many regions face risks of irreversible damage to the human environment that threaten the basis for human progress. 5. These deepening interconnections are the central justification for the establishment of this Commission. We travelled the world for nearly three years, listening. At special public hearings organized by the Commission, we heard from government leaders, scientists, and experts, from citizens' groups concerned about a wide range of environment and development issues, and from thousands of individuals farmers, shanty-town residents, young people, industrialists, and indigenous and tribal peoples.
  • 29. 6. We found everywhere deep public concern for the environment, concern that has led not just to protests but often to changed behaviour. The challenge is to ensure that these new values are more adequately reflected in the principles and operations of political and economic structures. 7. We also found grounds for hope: that people can cooperate to build a future that is more prosperous, more just, and more secure; that a new era of economic growth can be attained, one based on policies that sustain and expand the Earth's resource base; and that the progress that some have known over the last century can be experienced by all in the years ahead. But for this to happen, we must understand better the symptoms of stress that confront us, we must identify the causes, and we must design new approaches to managing environmental resources and to sustaining human development I. Symptoms and Causes 8. Environmental stress has often been seen as the result of the growing demand on scarce resources and the pollution generated by the rising living standards of the relatively affluent. But poverty itself pollutes the environment, creating environmental stress in a different way. Those who are poor and hungry will often destroy their immediate environment in order to survive: They will cut down forests; their livestock will overgraze grasslands; they will overuse marginal land; and in growing numbers they will crowd into congested cities. The cumulative effect of these changes is so far-reaching as to make poverty itself a major global scourge. 9. On the other hand, where economic growth has led to improvements in living standards, it has sometimes been achieved in ways that are globally damaging in the longer term. Much of the improvement in the past has been based on the use of increasing amounts of raw materials, energy, chemicals, and synthetics and on the creation of pollution that is not adequately accounted for in figuring the costs of production processes. These trends have had unforeseen effects on the environment. Thus today's environmental challenges arise both from the lack of development and from the unintended consequences of some forms of economic growth. 1. Poverty 10. There are more hungry people in the world today than ever before in human history, and their numbers are growing. In 1980, there were 340 million people in 87 developing countries not getting enough calories to prevent stunted growth and serious health risks. This total was very slightly below the figure for 1970 in terms of share of the world population, but in terms of sheer numbers, it represented a 14 per cent increase. The World Bank predicts that these numbers are likely to go on growing. /1 I think this Commission should give attention on how to look into the question of more participation for those people who are the object of development. Their basic needs include the right to preserve their cultural identity, and their right not to be alienated from their own society, and their own community. So the point I want to make is that we cannot discuss environment or development without discussing political development. And you cannot eradicate poverty, at least not only by redistributing wealth or income, but there must be more redistribution of power. Aristides Katoppo
  • 30. Publisher WCED Public Hearing Jakarta, 26 March 1985 11. The number of people living in slums and shanty towns is rising, not falling. A growing number lack access to clean water and sanitation and hence are prey to the diseases that arise from this lack. There is some progress, impressive in places. But, on balance, poverty persists and its victims multiply. 12. The pressure of poverty has to be seen in a broader context. At the international level there are large differences in per capita income, which ranged in 1984 from $190 in low income countries (other than China and India) to $11,430 in the industrial market economies. (See Table 1-1) Table 1-1 Population Size and per capita GDP by Groups of Countries Population Per capita GDP Average annual growth rate of per capita GDP, 1965-1984 (millions) (1984 dollars) (per cent) Countries Low-income countries (excluding China, India) 611 190 0.9 China and India 1,778 390 3.2 Lower Middle-income Economies 691 740 1.0 Upper Middle-income Economies 497 1,980 3.1 High-Income Oil Exporters 19 11,350 3.2 Industrial Market Economies 732 11,430 2.4 Source: Based on data in World Bank, World Development Report, 1985. (New York, Oxford University Press, 1986) 13. Such inequalities represent great differences not merely in the quality of life today, but also in the capacity of societies to improve their quality of life in the future. Most of the world's poorest countries depend for increasing export earnings on tropical agricultural products that are vulnerable to fluctuating or declining terms of trade. Expansion can often only be achieved at the price of ecological stress. Yet diversification in ways that will alleviate both poverty and
  • 31. ecological stress is hampered by disadvantageous terms of technology transfer, by protectionism, and by declining financial flows to those countries that most need international finance./2 14. Within countries, poverty has been exacerbated by the unequal distribution of land and other assets. The rapid rise in population has compromised the ability to raise living standards. These factors, combined with growing demands for the commercial use of good land, often to grow crops for exports, have pushed many subsistence farmers onto poor land and robbed them of any hope of participating in their nations' economic lives. The same forces have meant that traditional shifting cultivators, who once cut forests, grew crops, and then gave the forest time to recover, now have neither land enough nor time to let forests re-establish. So forests are being destroyed, often only to create poor farmland that cannot support those who till it. Extending cultivation onto steep slopes is increasing soil erosion in many hilly sections of both developing and developed nations. In any river valleys, areas chronically liable to floods are now farmed. 15. These pressures are reflected in the rising incidence of disasters. During the 1970s, six times as many people died from 'natural disasters' each year as in the 1960s, and twice as many suffered from such disasters. Droughts and floods, disasters among whose causes are widespread deforestation and overcultivation, increased most in terms of numbers affected. There were 18.5 million people affected by droughts annually in the 1960s, but 24.4 billion in the 1970s; 5.2 billion people were victims of floods yearly in the 1960s, compared with 15.4 million in the 1970s./3 The results are not in for the 1980s, but this disaster-prone decade seems to be carrying forward the trend, with droughts in Africa, India, and Latin America, and floods throughout Asia, parts of Africa, and the Andean region of Latin America. 16. Such disasters claim most of their victims among the impoverished in poor nations, where subsistence farmers must make their land more liable to droughts and floods by clearing marginal areas, and where the poor make themselves tore vulnerable to all disasters by living on steep slopes and unprotected shores - the only lands left for their shanties. Lacking food and foreign exchange reserves their economically vulnerable governments are ill-equipped to cope with such catastrophes. 17. The links between environmental stress and developmental disaster are most evident in sub-Saharan Africa. Per capita food production, declining since the 1960s, plummeted during the drought of the 1980s, and at the height of the food emergency some 35 million people were exposed to risk. Human overuse of land and prolonged drought threaten to turn the grasslands of Africa's Sahel region into desert./4 No other region more tragically suffers the vicious cycle of poverty leading to environmental degradation, which leads in turn to even greater poverty. If people destroy vegetation in order to get land, food, fodder, fuel, or timber, the soil is no longer protected. Rain creates surface runoff, and the soil erodes. When the soil is gone, no water is retained and the land can no longer produce enough food, fodder, fuel, or timber, so people need to turn to new land and start the process all over again. All major disaster problems in the Third World are essentially unsolved development problems. Disaster prevention is thus primarily an aspect of development, and this must be a development that takes place within the sustainable limits.
  • 32. Odd Grann Secretary General, Norwegian Red Cross WCED Public Hearing Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 2. Growth 18. In some parts of the world, particularly since the mid-1950s, growth and development have vastly improved living standards and the quality of life. Many of the products and technologies that have gone into this improvement are raw material- and energy-intensive and entail a substantial amount of pollution. The consequent impact on the environment is greater than ever before in human history. 19. Over the past century, the use of fossil fuels has grown nearly thirtyfold, and industrial production has increased move than fiftyfold. The bulk of this increase, about three-quarters in the case of fossil fuels and a little over four-fifths in the case of industrial production, has taken place since 1950. The annual increase in industrial production today is perhaps as large as the total production in Europe around the end of the 1930s./5 Into every year we now squeeze the decades of industrial growth and environmental disruption that formed the basis of the pre-war European economy. 20. Environmental stresses also arise from more traditional forms of production. More land has been cleared for settled cultivation in the past 100 years than in all the previous centuries of human existence. Interventions in the water cycles have increased greatly. Massive dams, most of them built after 1960, impound a large proportion of the river flow. In Europe and Asia, water use has reached 10 per cent of the annual run off, a figure that is expected to rise to 20-25 per cent by the end of the century./6 21. The impact of growth and rising income levels can be seen in the distribution of world consumption of a variety of resource intensive produce. The more affluent industrialized countries use most of the world's metals and fossil fuels. Even in the case of food products a sharp difference exists, particularly in the products that are more resource-intensive. (See Table 1-2.) Table 1-2 Distribution of World Consumption, Averages for 1980-83 Developed Countries (26% of population) Developing Countries (74% of population) Units of Per Capita Consumption Share in World Consumption Share in World Consumption Commodity per cent per capita per cent per capita
  • 33. Food Calories kcal/day 34 3,395 66 2,389 Protein gms/day 38 99 62 Fat gms/day 53 127 47 40 Paper kg/year 85 123 15 8 Steel kg/year 79 459 21 41 Other Metals kg/year 86 26 14 2 Commercial Energy /year 80 20 0.5 Source: WCED estimates based on country-level data from FAO, UN Statistical Office, UNCTAD and American Metals Association 22. In recent years, industrial countries have been able to achieve economic growth using less energy and raw materials per unit of output. This, along with the efforts to reduce the emission of pollutants, will help to contain the pressure on the biosphere. But with the increase in population and the rise in incomes, per capita consumption of energy and materials will go up in the developing countries, as it has to if essential needs are to be met. Greater attention to resource efficiency can moderate the increase, but, on balance, environmental problems linked to resource use will intensify in global terms. 3. Survival 23. The scale and complexity of our requirements for natural resources have increased greatly with the rising levels of population and production. Nature is bountiful, but it is also fragile and finely balanced. There are thresholds that cannot be crossed without endangering the basic integrity of the system. Today we are close to many of these thresholds; we must be ever mindful of the risk of endangering the survival of life on Earth. Moreover, the speed with which changes in resource use are taking place gives little time in which to anticipate and prevent unexpected effects. 24. The 'greenhouse effect', one such threat to life support systems, springs directly from increased resource use. The burning of fossil fuels and the cutting and burning of forests release carbon dioxide (CO2). The accumulation in the atmosphere of CO2 and certain other gases traps solar radiation near the Earth's surface, causing global warming. This could cause sea level rises over the next 45 years large enough to inundate many low lying coastal cities and river deltas. It could also drastically upset national and international agricultural production and trade systems./7
  • 34. The remarkable achievements of the celebrated Industrial Revolution are now beginning seriously to be questioned principally because the environment was not considered at the time. It was felt that the sky was so vast and clear nothing could ever change its colour, our rivers so big and their water so plentiful that no amount of human activity could ever change their quality, and there were trees and natural forests so plentiful that we will never finish them. After all, they grow again. Today we should know better. The alarming rate at which the Earth's surface is being denuded of its natural vegetative cover seems to indicate that the world may soon become devoid of trees through clearing for human developments. Hon. Victoria Chitepo Minister of Natural Resources and Tourism, Government of Zimbabwe WCED Opening Ceremony Harare, 18 Sept 1986 25. Another threat arises from the depletion of the atmospheric ozone layer by gases released during the production of foam and the use of refrigerants and aerosols. A substantial loss of such ozone could have catastrophic effects on human and livestock health and on some life forms at the base of the marine food chain. The 1986 discovery of a hole in the ozone layer above the Antarctic suggests the possibility of a more rapid depletion than previously suspected./8 26. A variety of air pollutants are killing trees and lakes and damaging buildings and cultural treasures, close to and sometimes thousands of miles from points of emission. The acidification of the environment threatens large areas of Europe and North America. Central Europe is currently receiving more than one gramme of sulphur on every square metre of ground each year./9 The loss of forests could bring in its wake disastrous erosion, siltation, floods, and local climatic change. Air pollution damage is also becoming evident in some newly industrialized countries. 27. In many cases the practices used at present to dispose of toxic wastes, such as those from the chemical industries, involve unacceptable risks. Radioactive wastes from the nuclear industry remain hazardous for centuries. Many who bear these risks do not benefit in any way from the activities that produce the wastes. 28. Desertification - the process whereby productive arid and semi-arid land is rendered economically unproductive - and large-scale deforestation are other examples of major threats to the integrity of regional ecosystems. Desertification involves complex interactions between humans, land, and climate. The pressures of subsistence food production, commercial crops, and meat production in arid and semi-arid areas all contribute to this process. 29. Each year another 6 million hectares are degraded to desert-like conditions./10 Over three decades, this would amount to an area roughly as large as Saudi Arabia. More than 11 million hectares of tropical forests are destroyed per year and this, over 30 years, would amount to an area about the size of India./11 Apart from the direct and often dramatic impacts within the immediate area, nearby regions are affected by the spreading of sands or by changes in water regimes and increased risks of soil erosion and siltation. 30. The loss of forests and other wild lands extinguishes species of plants and animals and drastically reduces the genetic diversity of the world's ecosystems. This process robs present
  • 35. and future generations of genetic material with which to improve crop varieties, to make them less vulnerable to weather stress, pest attacks, and disease. The loss of species and subspecies, many as yet unstudied by science, deprives us of important potential sources of medicines and industrial chemicals. It removes forever creatures of beauty and parts of our cultural heritage; it diminishes the biosphere. 31. Many of the risks stemming from our productive activity and the technologies we use cross-national boundaries; many are global. Though the activities that give rise to these dangers tend to be concentrated in a few countries, the risks are shared by all, rich and poor, those who benefit from them and those who do not. Most who share in the risks have little influence on the decision processes that regulate these activities. 32. Little time is available for corrective action. In some cases we may already be close to transgressing critical thresholds. While scientists continue to research and debate causes and effects, in many cases we already know enough to warrant action. This is true locally and regionally in the cases of such threats as desertification, deforestation, toxic wastes, and acidification; it is true globally for such threats as climate change, ozone depletion, and species loss. The risks increase faster than do our abilities to manage them. 33. Perhaps the greatest threat to the Earth's environment, to sustainable human progress, and indeed to survival is the possibility of nuclear war, increased daily by the continuing arms race and its spread to outer space. The search for a more viable future can only be meaningful in the context of a more vigorous effort to renounce and eliminate the development of means of annihilation. 4. The Economic Crisis 34. The environmental difficulties that confront us are not new, but only recently have we begun to understand their complexity. Previously our main concerns centred on the effects of development on the environment. Today, we need to be equally concerned about the ways in which environmental degradation can dampen or reverse economic development. In one area after another, environmental degradation is eroding the potential for development. This basic connection was brought into sharp focus by the environment and development crises of the 1980s. 35. The slowdown in the momentum of economic expansion and the stagnation in world trade in the 1980s challenged all nations' abilities to react and adjust. Developing countries that rely on the export of primary products have been hit particularly hard by falling commodity prices. Between 1980 and 1984, developing countries lost about $55 billion in export earnings because of the fall in commodity prices, a blow felt most keenly in Latin America and Africa./12 36. As a consequence of this period of slow growth in the world economy - together with rising debt service obligations and a decline in the inflow of finance - many developing countries have facet) severe economic crises. Over half of all developing countries actually experienced declining per capita GDP in the years 1982-85 and per capita GDP has fallen, for developing countries as a whole, by around 10 per cent in the 1980s. (See Table 1-3.) Table 1-3 37. The heaviest burden in international economic adjustment has been carried by the world's poorest people. The consequence has been a considerable increase in human distress and the Annual Rate of Increase of Gross Domestic Product in Developing overexploitation of land and natural resources to ensure survival in the short term. Countries, 1976-85
  • 36. 38. Many international economic problems remain unresolved: Developing country indebtedness remains serious; commodity and energy markets are highly unstable; financial flows to developing countries are seriously deficient; protectionism and trade wars are a serious threat. Yet at a time when multilateral institutions, and rules, are more than ever necessary, they have been devalued. And the notion of an international responsibility for development has virtually disappeared. The trend is towards a decline in multilateralism and an assertion of national dominance. II. New Approaches to Environment and Development 39. Human progress has always depended on our technical ingenuity and a capacity for cooperative action. These qualities have often been used constructively to achieve development and environmental progress: in air and water pollution control, for example, and in increasing the efficiency of material and energy use. Many countries have increased food production and reduced population growth rates. Some technological advances, particularly in medicine, have been widely shared. 40. But this is not enough. Failures to manage the environment and to sustain development threaten to overwhelm all countries. Environment and development are not separate challenges; they are inexorably linked. Development cannot subsist upon a deteriorating environmental resource base; the environment cannot be protected when growth leaves out of account the costs of environmental destruction. These problems cannot be treated separately by fragmented institutions and policies. They are linked in a complex system of cause and effect. 41. First, environmental stresses are linked one to another. For example, deforestation, by increasing run off, accelerates soil erosion and siltation of rivers and lakes. Air pollution and acidification play their part in killing forests and lakes. Such links mean that several different problems must be tackled simultaneously. And success in one area, such as forest protection, can improve chances of success in another area, such as soil conservation. 42. Second, environmental stresses and patterns of economic development are linked one to another. Thus agricultural policies may lie at the root of land, water, and forest degradation. Energy policies are associated with the global greenhouse effect, with acidification, and with deforestation for fuelwood in many developing nations. These stresses all threaten economic development. Thus economics and ecology must be completely integrated in decision making and lawmaking processes not just to protect the environment, but also to protect and promote development. Economy is not just about the production of wealth, and ecology is not just about the protection of nature; they are both equally relevant for improving the lot of humankind. How long can we go on and safely pretend that the environment is not the economy, is not health, is not the prerequisite to development, is not recreation? Is it realistic to see ourselves as managers of an entity out there called the environment, extraneous to us, an alternative to the economy, too expensive a value to protect in difficult economic times? When we organize ourselves starting from this premise, we do so with dangerous consequences to our economy, health, and industrial growth. We are now just beginning to realize that we must find an alternative to our ingrained behaviour of burdening future generations resulting from our misplaced
  • 37. belief that there is a choice between economy and the environment. That choice, in the long term, turns out to be an illusion with awesome consequences for humanity. Charles Caccia Member of Parliament, House of Commons WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 43. Third, environmental and economic problems are linked to many social and political factors. For example, the rapid population growth that has so profound an impact on the environment and on development in many regions is driven partly by such factors as the status of women in society and other cultural values. Also, environmental stress and uneven development can increase social tensions. It could be argued that the distribution of power and influence within society lies at the heart of most environment and development challenges. Hence new approaches must involve programmes of social development, particularly to improve the position of women in society, to protect vulnerable groups, and to promote local participation in decision making. 44. Finally, the systemic features operate not merely within but also between nations. National boundaries have become so porous that traditional distinctions between matters of local, national, and international significance have become blurred. Ecosystems do not respect national boundaries. Water pollution moves through shared rivers, lakes, and seas. The atmosphere carries air pollution over vast distances. Major accidents - particularly those at nuclear reactors or at plants or warehouses containing toxic materials - can have widespread regional effects. 45. Many environment economy links also operate globally. For instance, the highly subsidized, incentive-driven agriculture of industrialized market economies generates surpluses that depress prices and erode the viability of the often neglected agriculture of developing countries. Soils and other environmental resources suffer in both systems. Each country may devise national agricultural policies to secure short-tern economic and political gains, but no nation alone can devise policies to deal effectively with the financial, economic, and ecological costs of the agricultural and trade policies of other nations.
  • 38. To successfully advance in solving global problems, we need to develop new methods of thinking, to elaborate new moral and value criteria, and, no doubt, new patterns of behaviour. Mankind is on the threshold of a new stage in its development. We should not only promote the expansion of its material, scientific, and technical basis, but, what is most important, the formation of new value and humanistic aspirations in human psychology, since wisdom and humaneness are the 'eternal truths' that make the basis of humanity. We need new social, moral, scientific, and ecological concepts, which should be determined by new conditions for the life of mankind today and in the future. I.T. Frolov Editor-in-Chief, Communist Magazine WCED Public Hearing Moscow, 6 Dec 1986 46. In the past, responsibility for environmental matters has been placed in environmental ministries and institutions that often have had little or no control over destruction caused by agricultural, industrial, urban development, forestry, and transportation policies and practices. Society has failed to give the responsibility for preventing environmental damage to the 'sectoral' ministries and agencies whose policies cause it. Thus our environmental management practices have focused largely upon after-the-fact repair of damage: reforestation, reclaiming desert lands, rebuilding urban environments, restoring natural habitats, and rehabilitating wild lands. The ability to anticipate and prevent environmental damage will require that the ecological dimensions of policy be considered at the same time as the economic, trade, energy, agricultural, and other dimensions. 47. In most countries, environmental policies are directed at the symptoms of harmful growth; these policies have brought progress and rewards and must be continued and strengthened. But that will not be enough. What is required is a new approach in which all nations aim at a type of development that integrates production with resource conservation and enhancement, and that links both to the provision for all of an adequate livelihood base and equitable access to resources. 48. The concept of sustainable development provides a framework for the integration of environment policies and development strategies - the term 'development' being used here in its broadest sense. The word is often taken to refer to the processes of economic and social change in the Third World. But the integration of environment and development is required in all countries, rich and poor. The pursuit of sustainable development requires changes in the domestic and international policies of every nation. You talk very little about life, you talk too much about survival. It is very important to remember that when the possibilities for life are over, the possibilities for survival start. And there are peoples here in Brazil, especially in the Amazon region, who still live, and these peoples that still live don't want to reach down to the level of survival. Speaker from the floor WCED Public Hearing
  • 39. Sao Paulo, 26-29 Oct 1985 49. Sustainable development seeks to meet the needs and aspirations of the present without compromising the ability to meet those of the future. Far from requiring the cessation of economic growth, it recognizes that the problems of poverty and underdevelopment cannot be solved unless we have a new era of growth in which developing countries play a large role and reap large benefits. 50. Economic growth always brings risk of environmental damage, as it puts increased pressure on environmental resources. But policy makers guided by the concept of sustainable development will necessarily work to assure that growing economies remain firmly attached to their ecological roots and that these roots are protected and nurtured so that they may support growth over the long term. Environmental protection is thus inherent in the concept of sustainable development, as is a focus on the sources of environmental problems rather than the symptoms. 51. No single blueprint of sustainability will be found, as economic and social systems and ecological conditions differ widely among countries. Each nation will have to work out its own concrete policy implications. Yet irrespective of these differences, sustainable development should be seen as a global objective. 52. No country can develop in isolation from others. Hence the pursuit of sustainable development requires a new orientation in international relations. Long term sustainable growth will requite far-reaching changes to produce trade, capital, and technology flows that are more equitable and better synchronized to environmental imperatives. 53. The mechanics of increased international cooperation required to assure sustainable development will vary from sector to sector and in relation to particular institutions. But it is fundamental that the transition to sustainable development be managed jointly by all nations. The unity of human needs requires a functioning multilateral system that respects the democratic principle of consent and accepts that not only the Earth but also the world is one. 54. In the chapters that follow we examine these issues in greater detail and make a number of specific proposals for responding to the crises of a threatened future. Overall, our report carries a message of hope. But it is hope conditioned upon the establishment of a new era of international cooperation based on the premise that every human being - those here and those who are to come - has the right to life, and to a decent life. We confidently believe that the international community can rise, as it must, to the challenge of securing sustainable human progress. Footnotes 1/ World Bank, Poverty and Hunger: Issues and Options for Food Security in developing Countries (Washington, DC: 1986). 2/ Department of International Economic and Social Affairs, Doubling Development Finance: Meeting a Global Challenge, Views and Recommendations of the Committee on Development Planning (New York: UN, 1986) 3/ G. Hagman et al., Prevention Better Than Cure, Report on Human and Environmental Disasters in the Third World (Stockholm: Swedish Red Cross, 1984).
  • 40. 4/ UN, General Assembly, 'The Critical Economic Situation in Africa: Report of the Secretary General', A/S-13/2, New York, 20 May 1986. 5/ Based on data from W.W. Rostow, The World Economy: History and Prospect (Austin: University of Texas Press, 1976); UN, World Energy Supplies in Selected Years 1929-1950 (New York: 1952); UN, Statistical Yearbook 1982 (New York: 1985); UNCTAD, Handbook of International Trade and Development Statistics 1985 Supplement (New York: 1985); W.S. and E.S. Woytinsky, World Population and Production: Trends and Outlook (New York: Twentieth Century Fund, 1953). 6/ USSR Committee for the International Hydrological Decade, World Water Balance and Water Resources of the Earth (Paris: UNESCO, 1978). 7/ WMO, A Report of the International Conference on the Assessment of Carbon Dioxide and other Greenhouse Gases in Climate Variations and Associated Impacts, Villach, Austria, 9-15 October 1985, WMO No. 661 (Geneva: WMO/ICSU/UNEP, 1986). 8/ National Science Foundation, 'Scientists Closer to Identifying Cause of Antarctic Ozone Layer Depletion news release. Washington, DC, 20 October 1986. 9/ J. Lehmhaus et al., Calculated and Observed Data for 1900 Compared at EMEP Measurement Stations', Norwegian Meteorological Institute, EMEP/MSC-W Report 1-86, 1986. 10/ UNEP, 'General Assessment of Progress in the Implementation of the Plan of Action to Combat Desertification 1978-1984', Nairobi, 1984; WCED Advisory Panel on Food Security, Agriculture, Forestry and Environment', Food Security (London: Zed Books, 1987). 11/ World Resources Institute/International Institute for Environment and Development, World Resources 1986 (New York: Basic Books, 1986). 12/ UNCTAD, Trade and Development Report 1986 (New York: 1986).
  • 41. Our Common Future, Chapter 2: Towards Sustainable Development The Concept of Sustainable I. Development II. Equity and the Common Interest III. Strategic Imperatives 1. Reviving Growth 2. Changing the quality of Growth 3. Meeting Essential Human Needs 4. Ensuring a Sustainable Level of Population 5. Conserving and Enhancing the Resource Base 6. Reorienting Technology and Managing Risk 7. Merging Environment and Economics in Decision Making IV. Conclusion 1. Sustainable development is development that meets the needs of the present without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs. It contains within it two key concepts: the concept of 'needs', in particular the essential needs of the world's poor, to which overriding priority should be given; and the idea of limitations imposed by the state of technology and social organization on the environment's ability to meet present and future needs. 2. Thus the goals of economic and social development must be defined in terms of sustainability in all countries - developed or developing, market-oriented or centrally planned. Interpretations will vary, but must share certain general features and must flow from a consensus on the basic concept of sustainable development and on a broad strategic framework for achieving it. 3. Development involves a progressive transformation of economy and society. A development path that is sustainable in a physical sense could theoretically be pursued even in a rigid social and political setting. But physical sustainability cannot be secured unless development policies pay attention to such considerations as changes in access to resources and in the distribution of costs and benefits. Even the narrow notion of physical sustainability implies a concern for social equity between generations, a concern that must logically be extended to equity within each generation. I. The Concept of Sustainable Development 4 The satisfaction of human needs and aspirations in the major objective of development. The essential needs of vast numbers of people in developing countries for food, clothing, shelter, jobs - are not being met, and beyond their basic needs these people have legitimate aspirations for an improved quality of life. A world in which poverty and inequity are endemic will always
  • 42. be prone to ecological and other crises. Sustainable development requires meeting the basic needs of all and extending to all the opportunity to satisfy their aspirations for a better life. 5. Living standards that go beyond the basic minimum are sustainable only if consumption standards everywhere have regard for long-term sustainability. Yet many of us live beyond the world's ecological means, for instance in our patterns of energy use. Perceived needs are socially and culturally determined, and sustainable development requires the promotion of values that encourage consumption standards that are within the bounds of the ecological possible and to which all can reasonably aspire. 6. Meeting essential needs depends in part on achieving full growth potential, and sustainable development clearly requires economic growth in places where such needs are not being met. Elsewhere, it can be consistent with economic growth, provided the content of growth reflects the broad principles of sustainability and non-exploitation of others. But growth by itself is not enough. High levels of productive activity and widespread poverty can coexist, and can endanger the environment. Hence sustainable development requires that societies meet human needs both by increasing productive potential and by ensuring equitable opportunities for all. 7. An expansion in numbers can increase the pressure on resources and slow the rise in living standards in areas where deprivation is widespread. Though the issue is not merely one of population size but of the distribution of resources, sustainable development can only be pursued if demographic developments are in harmony with the changing productive potential of the ecosystem. 8. A society may in many ways compromise its ability to meet the essential needs of its people in the future - by overexploiting resources, for example. The direction of technological developments may solve some immediate problems but lead to even greater ones. Large sections of the population may be marginalized by ill-considered development. 9. Settled agriculture, the diversion of watercourses, the extraction of minerals, the emission of heat and noxious gases into the atmosphere, commercial forests, and genetic manipulation are all examples or human intervention in natural systems during the course of development. Until recently, such interventions were small in scale and their impact limited. Today's interventions are more drastic in scale and impact, and more threatening to life-support systems both locally and globally. This need not happen. At a minimum, sustainable development must not endanger the natural systems that support life on Earth: the atmosphere, the waters, the soils, and the living beings. 10. Growth has no set limits in terms of population or resource use beyond which lies ecological disaster. Different limits hold for the use of energy, materials, water, and land. Many of these will manifest themselves in the form of rising costs and diminishing returns, rather than in the form of any sudden loss of a resource base. The accumulation of knowledge and the development of technology can enhance the carrying capacity of the resource base. But ultimate limits there are, and sustainability requires that long before these are reached, the world must ensure equitable access to the constrained resource and reorient technological efforts to relieve the presume. A communications gap has kept environmental, population, and development assistance groups apart for too long, preventing us from being aware of our common interest and realizing our combined power. Fortunately, the gap is closing. We now know that what unites us is vastly more important than what
  • 43. divides us. We recognize that poverty, environmental degradation, and population growth are inextricably related and that none of these fundamental problems can be successfully addressed in isolation. We will succeed or fail together. Arriving at a commonly accepted definition of 'sustainable development' remains a challenge for all the actors in the development process. 'Making Common Cause' U.S. Based Development, Environment, Population NGOs WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 11. Economic growth and development obviously involve changes in the physical ecosystem. Every ecosystem everywhere cannot be preserved intact. A forest may be depleted in one part of a watershed and extended elsewhere, which is not a bad thing if the exploitation has been planned and the effects on soil erosion rates, water regimes, and genetic losses have been taken into account. In general, renewable resources like forests and fish stocks need not be depleted provided the rate of use is within the limits of regeneration and natural growth. But most renewable resources are part of a complex and interlinked ecosystem, and maximum sustainable yield must be defined after taking into account system-wide effects of exploitation. 12. As for non-renewable resources, like fossil fuels and minerals, their use reduces the stock available for future generations. But this does not mean that such resources should not be used. In general the rate of depletion should take into account the criticality of that resource, the availability of technologies tor minimizing depletion, and the likelihood of substitutes being available. Thus land should not be degraded beyond reasonable recovery. With minerals and fossil fuels, the rate of depletion and the emphasis on recycling and economy of use should be calibrated to ensure that the resource does not run out before acceptable substitutes are available. Sustainable development requires that the rate of depletion of non renewable resources should foreclose as few future options as possible. 13. Development tends to simplify ecosystems and to reduce their diversity of species. And species, once extinct, are not renewable. The loss of plant and animal species can greatly limit the options of future generations; so sustainable development requires the conservation of plant and animal species. 14. So-called free goods like air and water are also resources. The raw materials and energy of production processes are only partly converted to useful products. The rest comes out as wastes. Sustainable development requires that the adverse impacts on the quality of air, water, and other natural elements are minimized so as to sustain the ecosystem's overall integrity. 15. In essence, sustainable development is a process of change in which the exploitation of resources, the direction of investments, the orientation of technological development; and institutional change are all in harmony and enhance both current and future potential to meet human needs and aspirations. II. Equity and the Common Interest 16. Sustainable development has been described here in general terms. How are individuals in the real world to be persuaded or made to act in the common interest? The answer lies partly
  • 44. in education, institutional development, and law enforcement. But many problems of resource depletion and environmental stress arise from disparities in economic and political power. An industry may get away with unacceptable levels or air and water pollution because the people who bear the brunt of it are poor and unable to complain effectively. A forest may be destroyed by excessive felling because the people living there have no alternatives or because timber contractors generally have more influence then forest dwellers. 17. Ecological interactions do not respect the boundaries of individual ownership and political jurisdiction. Thus: In a watershed, the ways in which a farmer up the slope uses land directly affect run-off on farms downstream. the irrigation practices, pesticides, and fertilizers used on one farm affect the productivity of neighbouring ones, especially among small farms. The efficiency of a factory boiler determines its rate of emission of soot and noxious chemicals and affects all who live and work around it. The hot water discharged by a thermal power plant into a river or a local sea affects the catch of all who fish locally. 18. Traditional social systems recognized some aspects of this interdependence and enforced community control over agricultural practices and traditional rights relating to water, forests, and land. This enforcement of the 'common interest' did not necessarily impede growth and expansion though it may have limited the acceptance and diffusion of technical innovations. 19. Local interdependence has, if anything, increased because of the technology used in modern agriculture and manufacturing. Yet with this surge of technical progress, the growing 'enclosure' of common lands, the erosion of common rights in forests and other resources, and the spread of commerce and production for the market, the responsibilities for decision making are being taken away from both groups and individuals. This shift is still under way in many developing countries. If the desert is growing, forest disappearing, malnutrition increasing, and people in urban areas living in very bad conditions, it is not because we are lacking resources but the kind of policy implemented by our rulers, by the elite group. Denying people rights and peoples' interests is pushing us to a situation where it is only the poverty that has a very prosperous future in Africa. And it is our hope that your Commission, the World Commission, will not overlook these problems of human rights in Africa and will put emphasis on it. Because it is only free people, people who have rights, who are mature and responsible citizens, who then participate in the development and in the protection of the environment. Speaker from the floor WCED Public Hearing Nairobi, 23 Sept 1986 20. It is not that there is one set of villains and another of victims. All would be better off if each person took into account the effect ooe" his or her acts upon others. But each is unwilling to assume that others will behave in this socially desirable fashion, and hence all continue to pursue narrow self-interest. Communities or governments can compensate for this isolation
  • 45. through laws, education, taxes, subsidies, and other methods. Well-enforced laws and strict liability legislation can control harmful side effects. Most important, effective participation in decision-making processes by local communities can help them articulate and effectively enforce their common interest. 21. Interdependence is not simply a local phenomenon. Rapid growth in production has extended it to the international plane, with both physical and economic manifestations. There are growing global and regional pollution effects, such as in the more than 200 international river basins and the large number of shared seas. 22. The enforcement of common interest often suffers because areas of political jurisdiction and areas of impact do not coincide. Energy policies in one jurisdiction cause acid precipitation in another. The fishing policies of one state affect the fish catch of another. No supranational authority exists to resolve such issues, and the common interest can only be articulated through international cooperation. 23. In the same way, the ability of a government to control its national economy is reduced by growing international economic interactions. For example, foreign trade in commodities makes issues of carrying capacities and resource scarcities an international concern. (See Chapter 3.) If economic power and the benefits of trade were more equally distributed, common interests would be generally recognized. But the gains from trade are unequally distributed, and patterns of trade in, say, sugar affect not merely a local sugar-producing sector, but the economies and ecologies of the many developing countries that depend heavily on this product. 24. The search for common interest would be less difficult if all development and environment problems had solutions that would leave everyone better off. This is seldom the case, and there are usually winners and losers. Many problems arise from inequalities in access to resources. An inequitable landowner ship structure can lead to overexploitation of resources in the smallest holdings, with harmful effects on both environment and development. Internationally, monopolistic control over resources can drive those who do not share in them to excessive exploitation of marginal resources. The differing capacities of exploiters to commandeer 'free' goods - locally, nationally, and internationally - is another manifestation of unequal access to resources. 'Losers' in environment/development conflicts include those who suffer more than their fair share of the health, property, and ecosystem damage costs of pollution. 25. As a system approaches ecological limits, inequalities sharpen. Thus when a watershed deteriorates, poor farmers suffer more because they cannot afford the same anti-erosion measures as richer farmers. When urban air quality deteriorates, the poor, in their more vulnerable areas, suffer more health damage than the rich, who usually live in more pristine neighbourhoods. When mineral resources become depleted, late-comers to the industrialization process lose the benefits of low-cost supplies. Globally, wealthier nations are better placed financially and technologically to cope with the effects of possible climatic change. 26. Hence, our inability to promote the common interest in sustainable development is often a product of the relative neglect of economic and social justice within and amongst nations. III. Strategic Imperatives 27. The world must quickly design strategies that will allow nations to move from their present, often destructive, processes of growth and development onto sustainable development paths. This will require policy changes in all countries, with respect both to their own development and to their impacts on other nations' development possibilities. (This chapter concerns itself with national strategies. The required reorientation in international economic relations is dealt
  • 46. with in Chapter 3.) 28. Critical objectives for environment and development policies that follow from the concept of sustainable development include: reviving growth; changing the quality of growth; meeting essential needs for jobs, food, energy, water, and sanitation; ensuring a sustainable level of population; conserving and enhancing the resource base: reorienting technology and managing risk; and merging environment and economics in decision making. 1. Reviving Growth 29. As indicated earlier, development that is sustainable has to address the problem of the large number of people who live in absolute poverty - that is, who are unable to satisfy even the most basic of their needs. Poverty reduces people's capacity to use resources in a sustainable manner; it intensifies pressure on the environment. Most such absolute poverty is in developing countries; in many, it has been aggravated by the economic stagnation of the 1980s. A necessary but not a sufficient condition for the elimination of absolute poverty is a relatively rapid rise in per capita incomes in the Third World. It is therefore essential that the stagnant or declining growth trends of this decade be reversed. 30. While attainable growth rates will vary, a certain minimum is needed to have any impact on absolute poverty. It seems unlikely that, taking developing countries as a whole, these objectives can be accomplished with per capita income growth of under 3 per cent. (See Box 2-1.) Given current population growth rates, this would require overall national income growth of around 5 per cent a year in the developing economies of Asia, 5.5 per cent in Latin America, and 6 per cent in Africa and West Asia. 31. Are these orders of magnitude attainable? The record in South and East Asia over the past quarter-century and especially over the last five years suggests that 5 per cent annual growth can be attained in most countries, including the two largest, India and China. In Latin America, average growth rates on the order of 5 per cent were achieved during the 1960s and 1970s, but fell well below that in the first half of this decade, mainly because of the debt crisis./1 A revival of Latin American growth depends on the resolution of this crisis. In Africa, growth rates during the 1960s and 1970s were around 4-4.5 per cent, which at current rates of population growth would mean per capita income growth of only a little over 1 per cent./2 Moreover, during the 1980s, growth nearly halted and in two-thirds of the countries per capita income declined./3 Attaining a minimum level of growth in Africa requires the correction of short-term imbalances, and also the removal of deep-rooted constraints on the growth process. 32. Growth must be revived in developing countries because that is where the links between economic growth, the alleviation of poverty, and environmental conditions operate most directly. Yet developing countries are part of an interdependent world economy; their prospects also depend on the levels and patterns of growth in industrialized nations. The
  • 47. medium-term prospects for industrial countries are for growth of 3-4 per cent, the minimum that international financial institutions consider necessary if these countries are going to play a part in expanding the world economy. Such growth rates could be environmentally sustainable if industrialized nations can continue the recent shifts in the content of their growth towards less material- and energy-intensive activities and the improvement of their efficiency in using materials and energy. Box 2-1 Growth, Redistribution, and Poverty The poverty line is that level of income below which an individual or household cannot afford on a regular basis the necessities of life. The percentage of the population below that line will depend on per capita national income and the manner in which it is distributed. How quickly can a developing country expect to eliminate absolute poverty? The answer will vary from country to country, but much can be learned from a typical case. 1. Consider a nation in which half the population lives below the poverty line and where the distribution of household incomes is as follows: the top one-fifth of households have 50 per cent of total income, the next fifth have 20 per cent, the next fifth have 14 per cent, the next fifth have 9 per cent, and the bottom fifth have just 7 per cent. This is a fair representation of the situation in many low-income developing countries. 2. In this case, if the income distribution remains unchanged, per capita national income would have to double before the poverty ratio drops from 50 to 10 per cent. If income is redistributed in favour of the poor, this reduction can occur sooner. Consider the case in which 25 per cent of the incremental income of the richest one-fifth of the population is redistributed equally to the others. The assumptions here about redistribution reflect three judgements. First, in most situations redistributive policies can only operate on increases in income. Second, in low-income developing countries the surplus that can be skimmed off for redistribution is available only from the wealthier groups. Third, redistributive policies cannot be so precisely targeted that they deliver benefits only to those who are below the poverty line, so some of the benefits will accrue to those who are just a little above it. 3. The number of years required to bring the poverty ratio down from 50 to 10 per cent ranges from: 18-24 years if per capita income grows at 3 per cent, 26-36 years if it grown at 2 per cent, and 51-70 years if it grows only at 1 per cent. In each case, the shorter time is associated with the redistribution of 25 per cent of the incremental income of the richest fifth of the population and the longer period with no redistribution. 4. So with per capita national income growing only at 1 per cent a year, the time required to eliminate absolute poverty would stretch well into the next century. If, however, the aim is to ensure that the world is well on its way towards 5.
  • 48. sustainable development by the beginning of the next century, it is necessary to aim at a minimum of 3 per cent per capita national income growth and to pursue vigorous redistributive policies. 33. As industrialized nations use less materials and energy, however, they will provide smaller markets for commodities and minerals from the developing nations. Yet if developing nations focus their efforts upon eliminating poverty and satisfying essential human needs, then domestic demand will increase for both agricultural products and manufactured goods and some services. Hence the very logic of sustainable development implies an internal stimulus to Third World growth. 34. Nonetheless, in large numbers of developing countries markets are very small; and for all developing countries high export growth, especially of non-traditional items, will also be necessary to finance imports, demand for which will be generated by rapid development. Thus a reorientation of international economic relations will be necessary for sustainable development, as discussed in Chapter 3. 2. Changing the quality of Growth 35. Sustainable development involves more than growth. It requires a change in the content of growth, to make it less Material- and energy-intensive and more equitable in its impact. These changes are required in all countries as part of a package of measures to maintain the stock of ecological capital, to improve the distribution of income, and to reduce the degree of vulnerability to economic crises. 36. The process of economic development must be more soundly based upon the realities of the stock of capital that sustains it. This is rarely done in either developed or developing countries. For example, income from forestry operations is conventionally measured in terms of the value of timber and other products extracted, minus the costs of extraction. The costs of regenerating the forest are not taken into account, unless money is actually spent on such work. Thus figuring profits from logging rarely takes full account of the losses in future revenue incurred through degradation of the forest. Similar incomplete accounting occurs in the exploitation of other natural resources, especially in the case of resources that are not capitalized in enterprise or national accounts: air, water, and soil. In all countries, rich or poor, economic development must take full account in its measurements of growth of the improvement or deterioration in the stock of natural resources. 37. Income distribution is one aspect of the quality of growth, as described in the preceding section, and rapid growth combined with deteriorating income distribution may be worse than slower growth combined with redistribution in favour of the poor. For instance, in many developing countries the introduction of large-scale commercial agriculture may produce revenue rapidly, but may also dispossess a large number of small farmers and make income distribution more inequitable. In the long run, such a path may not be sustainable; it impoverishes many people and can increase pressures on the natural resource base through overcommercialized agriculture and through the marginalization of subsistence farmers. Relying more on smallholder cultivation may be slower at first, but more easily sustained over the long term. People have acquired, often for the first time in history, both an idea of their
  • 49. relative poverty and a desire to emerge from it and improve the quality of their lives. As people advance materially, and eat and live better, what, were once luxuries tend to be regarded as necessities. The net result is that the demand for food, raw materials, and power increases to an even greater degree than the population. As demand increases, a greater and greater strain is put on the finite area of the world's land to produce the products needed. Dr. I. P. Garbouchev Bulgarian Academy of Sciences WCED Public Hearing Moscow, 11 Dec 1986 38. Economic development is unsustainable if it increases vulnerability to crises. A drought may force farmers to slaughter animals needed for sustaining production in future years. A drop in prices may cause farmers or other producers to overexploit natural resources to maintain incomes. But vulnerability can be reduced by using technologies that lower production risks, by choosing institutional options that reduce market fluctuations, and by building up reserves, especially of food and foreign exchange. A development path that combines growth with reduced vulnerability is more sustainable than one that does not. 39. Yet it is not enough to broaden the range of economic variables taken into account. Sustainability requires views of human needs and well-being that incorporate such non-economic variables as education and health enjoyed for their own sake, clean air and water, and the protection of natural beauty. It must also work to remove disabilities from disadvantaged groups, many of whom live in ecologically vulnerable areas, such as many tribal groups in forests, desert nomads, groups in remote hill areas, and indigenous peoples of the Americas and Australasia. 40. Changing the quality of growth requires changing our approach to development efforts to take account of all of their effects. For instance, a hydropower project should not be seen merely as a way of producing more electricity; its effects upon the local environment and the livelihood of the local community must be included in any balance sheets. Thus the abandonment of a hydro project because it will disturb a rare ecological system could be a measure of progress, not a setback to development./4 Nevertheless, in some cases, sustainability considerations will involve a rejection of activities that are financially attractive in the short run. 41. Economic and social development can and should be mutually reinforcing. Money spent on education and health can raise human productivity. Economic developments can accelerate social development by providing opportunities for underprivileged groups or by spreading education more rapidly. 3. Meeting Essential Human Needs 42. The satisfaction of human needs and aspirations is so obviously an objective of productive activity that it may appear redundant to assert its central role in the concept of sustainable development. All too often poverty is such that people cannot satisfy their needs for survival and well-being even if goods and services are available. At the same time, the demands of those not in poverty may have major environmental consequences. 43. The principal development challenge is to meet the needs and aspirations of an expanding developing world population. The most basic of all needs is for a livelihood: that is,
  • 50. employment. Between 1985 and 2000 the labour force in developing countries will increase by nearly 800 million, and new livelihood opportunities will have to be generated for 60 million persons every year./5 The pace and pattern of economic development have to generate sustainable work opportunities on this scale and at a level of productivity that would enable poor households to meet minimum consumption standards. 44. More food is required not merely to feed more people but to attack undernourishment. For the developing world to eat, person for person, as well as the industrial world by the year 2000, annual increases of 5.0 per cent in calories and 5.8 per cent in proteins are needed in Africa; of 3.4 and 4.0 per cent, respectively, in Latin America; and of 3.5 and 4.5 per cent in Asia./6 Foodgrains and starchy roots are the primary sources of calories, while proteins are obtained primarily from products like milk, meat, fish, pulses, and oil-seeds. 45. Though the focus at present is necessarily on staple foods, the projections given above also highlight the need for a high rate of growth of protein availability. In Africa, the task is particularly challenging given the recent declining per capita food production and the current constraints on growth. In Asia and Latin America, the required growth rates in calorie and protein consumption seem to be more readily attainable. But increased food production should not be based on ecologically unsound production policies and compromise long-term prospects for food security. 46. Energy is another essential human need, one that cannot be universally met unless energy consumption patterns change. The most urgent problem is the requirements of poor Third World households, which depend mainly on fuelwood. By the turn of the century, 3 billion people may live in areas where wood is cut faster than it grows or where fuelwood is extremely scarce./7 Corrective action would both reduce the drudgery of collecting wood over long distances and preserve the ecological base. The minimum requirements for cooking fuel in most developing countries appear to be on the order of 250 kilogrammes of coal equivalent per capita per year. This is a fraction of the household energy consumption in industrial countries. In the developing world, mostly in the Third World, we realize that the main problem we have is that we do not have employment opportunities, and most of these people who are unemployed move from rural areas and they migrate into the cities and those who remain behind always indulge in processes - for example charcoal burning - and all this leads to deforestation. So maybe the environmental organizations should step in and look for ways to prevent this kind of destruction. Kennedy Njiro Student, Kenya Polytechnic WCED Public Hearing Nairobi, 23 Sept 1986 47. The linked basic needs of housing, water supply, sanitation, and health care are also environmentally important. Deficiencies in these areas are often visible manifestations of environmental stress. In the Third World, the failure to meet these key needs is one of the major causes of many communicable diseases such as malaria, gastro-intestinal infestations, cholera, and typhoid. Population growth and the drift into cities threaten to make these problems worse. Planners must find ways of relying more on supporting community initiatives and self-help efforts and on effectively using low-cost technologies. See Chapter 9. 4. Ensuring a Sustainable Level of Population
  • 51. 48. The sustainability of development is intimately linked to the dynamics of population growth. The issue, however, is not simply one of global population size. A child born in a country where levels of material and energy use are high places a greater burden on the Earth's resources than a child born in a poorer country. A similar argument applies within countries. Nonetheless, sustainable development can be pursued more easily when population size is stabilized at a level consistent with the productive capacity of the ecosystem. 49. In industrial countries, the overall rate of population growth is under 1 per cent, and several countries have reached or are approaching zero population growth. The total population of the industrialized world could increase from its current 1.2 billion to about 1.4 billion in the year 2025./8 50. The greater part of global population increase will take place in developing countries, where the 1985 population of 3.7 billion may increase to 6.8 billion by 2025./9 The Third World does not have the option of migration to 'new' lands, and the time available for adjustment is much less than industrial countries had. Hence the challenge now is to quickly lower population growth rates, especially in regions such as Africa, where these rates are increasing. 51. Birth rates declined in industrial countries largely because of economic and social development. Rising levels of income and urbanization and the changing role of women all played important roles. Similar processes are now at work in developing countries. These should be recognized and encouraged. Population policies should be integrated with other economic and social development programmes female education, health care, and the expansion of the livelihood base of the poor. But time is short, and developing countries will also have to promote direct measures to reduce fertility, to avoid going radically beyond the productive potential to support their populations. In fact, increased access to family planning services is itself a form of social development that allows couples, and women in particular, the right to self-determination. 52. Population growth in developing countries will remain unevenly distributed between rural and urban areas. UK projections suggest that by the first decade of the next century, the absolute size of rural populations in most developing countries will start declining. Nearly 90 per cent of the increase in the developing world will take place in urban areas, the population of which in expected to rise from 1.15 billion in 1985 to 3.25 million in 2025./10 The increase will be particularly marked in Africa and, to a lesser extent, in Asia. 53. Developing-country cities are growing much faster than the capacity of authorities to cope. Shortages of housing, water, sanitation, and mass transit are widespread. A growing proportion of city-dwellers live in slums and shanty towns, many of them exposed to air and water pollution and to industrial and natural hazards. Further deterioration is likely, given that most urban growth will take place in the largest cities. Thus more manageable cities may be the principal gain from slower rates of population growth. 54. Urbanization is itself part of the development process. The challenge is to manage the process so as to avoid a severe deterioration in the quality of life. Thus the development of smaller urban centres needs to be encouraged to reduce pressures in large cities. Solving the impending urban crisis will require the promotion of self-help housing and urban services by and for the poor, and a more positive approach to the role of the informal sector, supported by sufficient funds for water supply, sanitation, and other services. See Chapter 9. 5. Conserving and Enhancing the Resource Base
  • 52. 55. If needs are to be met on a sustainable basis the Earth's natural resource base must be conserved and enhanced. Major changes in policies will be needed to cope with the industrial world's current high levels of consumption, the increases in consumption needed to meet minimum standards in developing countries, and expected population growth. However, the case for the conservation of nature should not rest only with development goals. It is part of our moral obligation to other living beings and future generations. 56. Pressure on resources increases when people lack alternatives. Development policies must widen people's options for earning a sustainable livelihood, particularly for resource-poor households and in areas under ecological stress. In a hilly area, for instance, economic self-interest and ecology can be combined by helping farmers shift from grain to tree crops by providing them with advice, equipment, and marketing assistance. Programmes to protect the incomes of farmers, fishermen, and foresters against short-term price declines may decrease their need to overexploit resources. 57. The conservation of agricultural resources is an urgent task because in many parts of the world cultivation has already been extended to marginal lands, and fishery and forestry resources have been overexploited. These resources must be conserved and enhanced to meet the needs of growing populations. Land use in agriculture and forestry must be based on a scientific assessment of land capacity, and the annual depletion of topsoil, fish stock, or forest resources must not exceed the rate of regeneration. 58. The pressures on agricultural land from crop and livestock production can be partly relieved by increasing productivity. But short-sighted, short-term improvements in productivity can create different forms of ecological stress, such as the loss of genetic diversity in standing crops, salinization and alkalization of irrigated lands, nitrate pollution of ground-water, and pesticide residues in food. Ecologically more benign alternatives are available. Future increases in productivity, in both developed and developing countries, should be based on the better controlled application of water and agrochemicals, as well as on more extensive use of organic manures and non-chemical means of pest control. These alternatives can be promoted only by an agricultural policy based on ecological realities. (See Chapter 5.) 59. In the case of fisheries and tropical forestry, we rely largely on the exploitation of the naturally available stocks. The sustainable yield from these stocks may well fall short of demand. Hence it will be necessary to turn to methods that produce more fish, fuelwood, and forest products under controlled conditions. Substitutes for fuelwood can be promoted. 60. The ultimate limits to global development are perhaps determined by the availability of energy resources and by the biosphere's capacity to absorb the by-products of energy use./11/ These energy limits may be approached far sooner than the limits imposed by other material resources. First, there are the supply problems: the depletion of oil reserves, the high cost and environmental impact of coal mining, and the hazards of nuclear technology. Second, there are emission problems, most notably acid pollution and carbon dioxide build up leading to global warming. I work with rubber trees in the Amazon. I am here to speak about the tropical forest. We live from this forest they want to destroy. And we want to take this opportunity of having so many people here gathered with the same objective in mind to defend our habitat, the conservation of forest, of tropical forest.
  • 53. In my area, we have about 14-16 native products that we extract from the forest, besides all the other activities we have. So I think this must be preserved. Because it is not only with cattle, not only with pasture lands, and not only with highways that we will be able to develop the Amazon. When they think of falling trees, they always think of building roads and the roads bring destruction under a mask called progress. Let us put this progress where the lands have already been deforested, where it is idle of labour and where we have to find people work, and where we have to make the city grow. But let us leave those who want to live in the forest, who want to keep it as it is. We have nothing written. I don't have anything that was created in somebody's office. There is no philosophy. It is just the real truth, because this is what our life is. Jaime Da Silva Araujo Rubber Tapper Council WCED Public Hearing Sao Paulo, 28-29 Oct 1985 61. Some of these problems can be met by increased use of renewable energy sources. But the exploitation of renewable sources such as fuelwood and hydropower also entails ecological problems. Hence sustainability requires a clear focus on conserving and efficiently using energy. 62. Industrialized countries must recognize that their energy consumption is polluting the biosphere and eating into scarce fossil fuel supplies. Recent improvements in energy efficiency and a shift towards less energy-intensive sectors have helped limit consumption. But the process must be accelerated to reduce per capita consumption and encourage a shift to non polluting sources and technologies. The simple duplication in the developing world of industrial countries' energy use patterns is neither feasible nor desirable. Changing these patterns for the better will call for new policies in urban development, industry location, housing design, transportation systems, and the choice of agricultural and industrial technologies. 63. Non-fuel mineral resources appear to pose fewer supply problems. Studies done before 1960 that assumed an exponentially growing demand did not envisage a problem until well into the next century./12 since then, world consumption of most metals has remained nearly constant, which suggests that the exhaustion of non-fuel minerals is even more distant. The history of technological developments also suggests that industry can adjust to scarcity through greater efficiency in use, recycling, and substitution. More immediate needs include modifying the pattern of world trade in minerals to allow exporters a higher share in the value added from mineral use, and improving the access of developing countries to mineral supplies, as their demands increase. Indigenous peoples are the base of what I guess could be called the environmental security system. We are the gate-keepers of success or failure to husband our resources. For many of us, however, the last few centuries have meant a major loss of control over our lands and waters. We are still the first to know about changes in the environment, but we are now the last to be asked or consulted.
  • 54. We are the first to detect when the forests are being threatened, as they are under the slash and grab economics of this country. And we are the last to be asked about the future of our forests. We are the first to feel the pollution of our waters, as the Ojibway peoples of my own homelands in northern Ontario will attest. And, of course, we are the last to be consulted about how, when, and where developments should take place in order to assure continuing harmony for the seventh generation. The most we have learned to expect is to be compensated, always too late and too little. We are seldom asked to help avoid the need for compensation by lending our expertise and our consent to development. Louis Bruyere President, Native Council of Canada WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 64. The prevention and reduction of air and water pollution will remain a critical task of resource conservation. Air and water quality come under pressure from such activities as fertilizer and pesticide use, urban sewage, fossil fuel burning, the use of certain chemicals, and various other industrial activities. Each of these is expected to increase the pollution load on the biosphere substantially, particularly in developing countries. Cleaning up after the event is an expensive solution. Hence all countries need to anticipate and prevent these pollution problems, by, for instance, enforcing emission standards that reflect likely long-term effects, promoting low-waste technologies, and anticipating the impact of new products, technologies, and wastes. 6. Reorienting Technology and Managing Risk 65. The fulfilment of all these tasks will require the reorientation of technology the key link between humans and nature. First, the capacity for technological innovation needs to be greatly enhanced in developing countries so that they can respond more effectively to the challenges of sustainable development. Second, the orientation of technology development must be changed to pay greater attention to environmental factors. 66. The technologies of industrial countries are not always suited or easily adaptable to the socio-economic and environmental conditions of developing countries. To compound the problem, the bulk of world research and development addresses few of the pressing issues facing these countries, such as arid-land agriculture or the control of tropical diseases. Not enough is being done to adapt recent innovations in materials technology, energy conservation, information technology, and biotechnology to the needs of developing countries. These gaps must be covered by enhancing research, design, development, and extension capabilities in the Third World. 67. In all countries, the processes of generating alternative technologies, upgrading traditional ones, and selecting and adapting imported technologies should be informed by environmental resource concerns. Most technological research by commercial organizations is devoted to product and process innovations that have market value. Technologies are needed that produce 'social goods', such as improved air quality or increased product life, or that resolve problems normally outside the cost calculus of individual enterprises, such as the external costs of pollution or waste disposal.
  • 55. 68. The role of public policy is to ensure, through incentives and disincentives, that commercial organizations find it worthwhile to take fuller account of environmental factors in the technologies they develop. (See Chapter 6.) Publicly funded research institutions also need such direction, and the objectives of sustainable development and environmental protection must be built into the mandates of the institutions that work in environmentally sensitive areas. 69. The development of environmentally appropriate technologies is closely related to questions of risk management. Such systems as nuclear reactors, electric and other utility distribution networks, communication systems, and mass transportation are vulnerable if stressed beyond a certain point. The fact that they are connected through networks tends to make them immune to small disturbances but more vulnerable to unexpected disruptions that exceed a finite threshold. Applying sophisticated analyses of vulnerabilities and past failures to technology design, manufacturing standards, and contingency plans in operations can make the consequences of a failure or accident much less catastrophic. 70. The best vulnerability and risk analysis has not been applied consistently across technologies or systems. A major purpose of large system design should be to make the consequences of failure or sabotage less serious. There is thus a need for new techniques and technologies - as well as legal and institutional mechanisms - for safety design and control, accident prevention, contingency planning, damage mitigation, and provision of relief. 71. Environmental risks arising from technological and developmental decisions impinge on individuals and areas that have little or no influence on those decisions. Their interests must be taken into account. National and international institutional mechanisms are needed to assess potential impacts of new technologies before they are widely used, in order to ensure that their production, use, and disposal do not overstress environmental resources. Similar arrangements are required for major interventions in natural systems, such as river diversion or forest clearance. In addition, liability for damages from unintended consequences must be strengthened and enforced. 7. Merging Environment and Economics in Decision Making 72. The common theme throughout this strategy for sustainable development is the need to integrate economic and ecological considerations in decision making. They are, after all, integrated in the workings of the real world. This will require a change in attitudes and objectives and in institutional arrangements at every level. 73. Economic and ecological concerns are not necessarily in opposition. For example, policies that conserve the quality of agricultural land and protect forests improve the long-term prospects for agricultural development. An increase in the efficiency of energy and material use serves ecological purposes but can also reduce costs. But the compatibility of environmental and economic objectives is often lost in the pursuit of individual or group gains, with little regard for the impacts on others, with a blind faith in science's ability to find solutions, and in ignorance of the distant consequences of today's decisions. Institutional rigidities add to this myopia. 74. One important rigidity is the tendency to deal with one industry or sector in isolation, failing to recognize the importance of intersectoral linkages. Modern agriculture uses substantial amounts of commercially produced energy and large quantities of industrial products. At the same time, the more traditional connection - in which agriculture is a source
  • 56. of raw materials for industry - is being diluted by the widening use of synthetics. The energy-industry connection is also changing, with a strong tendency towards a decline in the energy intensity of industrial production in industrial countries. In the Third World, however, the gradual shift of the industrial base towards the basic material producing sectors is leading to an increase in the energy intensity of industrial production. 75. These inter sectoral connections create patterns of economic and ecological interdependence rarely reflected in the ways in which policy is made. Sectoral organizations tend to pursue sectoral objectives and to treat their impacts on other sectors as side effects, taken into account only if compelled to do so. Hence impacts on forests rarely worry those involved in guiding public policy or business activities in the fields of energy, industrial development, crop husbandry, or foreign trade. Many of the environment and development problems that confront us have their roots in this sectoral fragmentation of responsibility. Sustainable development requires that such fragmentation be overcome. The issues that have been brought forward here, I think, are wide-ranging and maybe you know, maybe you don't know, the answers to all those issues. But at least by hearing all those questions, stories, all these expressions that have been put forward, at least you could have some idea. You don't know the answers nor the solutions, but you could suggest the way to solve many problems and this is by suggesting either to governments, or the UN, or international agencies, to solve any problem the best way: that is to include those with direct interests in it. The beneficiaries, as well as the victims of any development issue should be included, should be heard. I think that is the one thing, maybe that all of us are hearing here, or expecting: that in every development planning or development issue as much as possible to listen and to include, to consult the people concerned. If that is taken care of, at least one step of the problem is resolved. Ismid Hadad Chief Editor, Prisma WCED Public Hearing Jakarta, 26 March 1985 76. Sustainability requires the enforcement of wider responsibilities for the impacts of decisions. This requires changes in the legal and institutional frameworks that will enforce the common interest. Some necessary changes in the legal framework start from the proposition that an environment adequate for health and well-being is essential for all human beings including future generations. Such a view places the right to use public and private resources in its proper social context and provides a goal for more specific measures. 77. The law alone cannot enforce the common interest. It principally needs community knowledge and support, which entails greater public participation in the decisions that affect the environment. This is best secured by decentralizing the management of resources upon which local communities defend, and giving these communities an effective say over the use f these resources. It will also require promoting citizens' initiatives, empowering people's organizations, and strengthening local democracy./13 78. Some large-scale projects, however, require participation on a different basis. Public inquiries and hearings on the development and environment impacts can help greatly in
  • 57. drawing attention to different points of view. Free access to relevant information and the availability of alternative sources of technical expertise can provide an informed basis for public discussion. When the environmental impact of a proposed project is particularly high, public scrutiny of the case should be mandatory and, wherever feasible, the decision should be subject to prior public approval, perhaps by referendum. It has not been too difficult to push the environment lobby of the North and the development lobby of the South together. And there is now in fact a blurring of the distinction between the two, so they are coming to have a common consensus around the theme of sustainable development. The building blocks are there. Environmental concern is common to both sides. Humanitarian concern is common to both sides. The difference lies in the methods of each and the degree to which each side tries to achieve its own economic interest through the development assistance process. The time is right for bridging this gap for some very pragmatic political reasons. First of all, the people of the North do not want to see their taxes wasted. Secondly, they do not want to see growing poverty, and they obviously care for the environment, be it the environment of the North, where they live, or of the South. And the majority of people in the South do not want short-term overpass solutions. In effect, there is a political community of interest, North and South, in the concept of sustainable development that you can build upon. Richard Sandbrook International institute for Environment and Development WCED Public Hearing Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 79. Changes are also required in the attitudes and procedures of both public and private-sector enterprises. Moreover, environmental regulation must move beyond the usual menu of safety regulations, zoning laws, and pollution control enactments; environmental objectives must be built into taxation, prior approval procedures for investment and technology choice, foreign trade incentives, and all components of development policy. 80. The integration of economic and ecological factors into the law and into decision making systems within countries has to be matched at the international level. The growth in fuel and material use dictates that direct physical linkages between ecosystems of different countries will increase. Economic interactions through trade, finance, investment, and travel will also grow and heighten economic and ecological interdependence. Hence in the future, even more so than now, sustainable development requires the unification of economics and ecology in international relations, as discussed in the next chapter. IV. Conclusion 81. In its broadest sense, the strategy for sustainable development aims to promote harmony among human brings and between humanity and nature. In the specific context of the development and environment crises of the 1980s, which current national and international political and economic institutions have not and perhaps cannot overcome, the pursuit of sustainable development requires:
  • 58. a political system that secures effective citizen participation in decision making. an economic system that is able to generate surpluses and technical knowledge on a self-reliant and sustained basis a social system that provides for solutions for the tensions arising from disharmonious development. a production system that respects the obligation to preserve the ecological base for development, a technological system that can search continuously for new solutions, an international system that fosters sustainable patterns of trade and finance, and an administrative system that is flexible and has the capacity for self-correction. 82. These requirements are more in the nature of goals that should underlie national and international action on development. What matters is the sincerity with which these goals are pursued and the effectiveness with which departures from them are corrected Footnotes 1/ UNCTAD, Handbook of International Trade and Development Statistics 1985 Supplement (New York: 1985). 2/ Ibid. 3/ Department of International Economic and Social Affairs (DIESA), Doubling Development Finance, Meeting a Global Challenge. Views and Recommendations of the Committee for Development Planning (New York: UN, 1986). 4/ One example of such a decision to forgo a developmental benefit in the interest of conservation is provided by the dropping of the Silent Valley Hydro project in India. 5/ Based on data from World Bank, World Development Report 1984 (New York: Oxford University Press, 1984). 6/ Based on per capita consumption data from FAO, Production Yearbook 1984 (Rome: 1985) and population projections from DIESA, World Population Prospects: Estimates and Projections as Assessed in 1984 (New York: UN, 1986). 7/ FAO, Fuelwood Supplies in the Developing Countries, Forestry Paper No. 42 (Rome: 1983). 8/ DIESA, World Population Prospects, op. cit. 9/ Ibid. 10/ Ibid. 11/ W. Hafele and W. Sassin, 'Resources and Endowments, An Outline of Future Energy Systems', in P.W. Hemily and M.N. Ozdas (eds.), Science and Future Choice (Oxford:
  • 59. Clarendon Press, 1979). 12/ See, for example, OECD, Interfutures: Facing the Future (Paris: 1979) and Council on Environmental Quality and U.S. Department of State, The Global 2000 Report to the President: Entering the Twenty-First Century, The Technical Report, Vol. Two (Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1980). 13/ See 'For Municipal initiative and Citizen Power', in INDERENA, La Campana Verde y los Concejos Verdes (Bogota, Colombia: 1985).
  • 60. Our Common Future, Chapter 3: The Role of the International Economy The International Economy, the Environment, I. and Development II. Decline in the 1980s 1. The African Continent 2. Latin American Debt III. Enabling Sustainable Development 1. Enhancing the Flow of Resources to Developing Countries 1.1 Increasing the Flow of Finance 1.2 Lending for Sustainable Development 2. Linking Trade. Environment, and Development 2.1 International Commodity Trade 2.2 Protectionism and International Trade 2.3 'Pollution-intensive' Goods 2.4 The Mandates of Multilateral Trade Forums 3. Ensuring Responsibility in Transnational Investment 4. Broadening the Technological Base 4.1 The Diffusion of Environmentally Sound Technologies 4.2 Building Up Technological Capabilities in Developing Countries IV. A Sustainable World Economy 1. Through the ages, people have reached beyond their own borders to obtain essential, valued, or exotic materials. Today's surer communications and larger trade and capital movements have greatly enlarged this process, quickened its pace, and endowed it with far-reaching ecological implications. Thus the pursuit of sustainability requires major changes in international economic relations.
  • 61. I. The International Economy, the Environment, and Development 2. Two conditions must be satisfied before international economic exchanges can become beneficial for all involved. The sustainability of ecosystems on which the global economy depends must be guaranteed. And the economic partners must be satisfied that the basis of exchange is equitable; relationships that are unequal and based on dominance of one kind or another are not a sound and durable basis for interdependence. For many developing countries, neither condition is met. 3. Economic and ecological links between nations have grown rapidly. This widens the impact of the growing inequalities in the economic development and strength of nations. The asymmetry in international economic relations compounds the imbalance, as developing nations are generally influenced by - but unable to influence - international economic conditions. 4. International economic relationships pose a particular problem for poor countries trying to manage their environments, since the export of natural resources remains a large factor in their economies, especially those of the least developed nations. The instability and adverse price trends faced by most of these countries make it impossible for them to manage their natural resource bases for sustained production. The rising burden of debt servicing and the decline in new capital flows intensify those forces that lead to environmental deterioration and resource depletion occurring at the expense of long-term development. 5. The trade in tropical timber, for example, is one factor underlying tropical deforestation. Needs for foreign exchange encourage many developing countries to cut timber faster than forests can be regenerated. This overcutting not only depletes the resource that underpins the world timber trade, it causes the lost of forest-based livelihoods, increases soil erosion and downstream flooding, and accelerates the loss of species and genetic resources. International trade patterns can also encourage the unsustainable development policies and practices that have steadily degraded the croplands and rangelands in the drylands of Asia and Africa; an example of that is provided by the growth of cotton production for export in the Sahel region. (See Box 3-1.)
  • 62. Box 3-1 Cotton Produced for Export in the Sahel In 1963-64, as drought and hunger were taking hold in the Sahel region of Africa, five Sahelian nations - Burkina Faso, Chad, Mali, Niger, and Senegal - produced record amounts of cotton. They harvested 154 million tons of cotton fibre, up from 22.7 million tons in 1961-62. The Sahel as a whole set another record in 1984: It imported a record 1.77 million tons of cereals, up from 200,000 tons yearly in the early 1960s. Over the period that Sahelian cotton harvests were steadily rising, world cotton prices were steadily falling in real terms. These figures do not suggest that Sahelian nations should plough up all cotton to plant sorghum and millet. But the fact that farmers who can grow cotton cannot grow enough food to feed themselves suggests that cash crops are getting too much attention and food crops too little. Source: J. Giri, 'Retrospective de l'Economie Sahelienne', Club du Sahel, Paris, 1984. 6. Growth in many developing countries also requires external capital inflows. Without reasonable flows, the prospect for any improvements in living standards is bleak. As a result, the poor will be forced to overuse the environment to ensure their own survival. Long-term development thus becomes much harder, and in some cases impossible. Yet trends in the movement of capital are worrying. Net resource flows to developing countries have fallen in real terms; in aggregate, there is now actually an outflow. (See Table 3-1) The increase of international capital flows to developing countries expected over the rest of the 1980s is only half that thought necessary to restore growth to levels where a reduction in poverty can occur./1 7. A mere increase in flows of capital to developing countries will not necessarily contribute to development. Domestic efforts are of paramount importance. More external funding is also required, but it must come in ways that are sensitive to the environmental impacts. The point is that the reduction of poverty itself is a precondition for environmentally sound development. And resource flows from rich to poor flows improved both qualitatively and quantitatively are a precondition for the eradication of poverty. Table 3-1 Net Transfer of Resources to Capital-Importing Developing Countries 1979 1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985 (billion dollars)
  • 63. Net Transfer from Loans (all IDCs)* 30.7 0.8 27.7 0.8 -8.6 -22.0 -41.0 Net Transfer from all Resource Flows (all IDCs)** 41.4 39.3 41.5 10.1 -0.3 -12.5 -31.0 Net Transfer from all Resource Flows (to Latin America) 15.6 11.9 11.4 -16.7 -25.9 -23.2 -30.0 * Net transfers on loans are net capital flows minus net interest paid. All loans, official and private, short and long-term, are included together with IMF credit ** Total net resource flows relate to net loan transfers, grants and net direct investment (less net direct investment income) Source: UN, World Economic Survey 1986 (New York: 1986). II. Decline in the 1980s 8. The pressures of poverty and rising populations make it enormously difficult for developing countries to pursue environmentally sound policies even in the best of circumstances. But when international economic conditions are bad, the problems can become unmanageable. During the 1980s, economic growth rates declined sharply or even turned negative in much of the Third World, particularly in Africa and Latin America. Over the five years from 1981 to 1985, population growth outstripped economic growth in most developing countries./2 9. Deteriorating terms of trade, rising debt service obligations, stagnating flows of aid, and growing protectionism in the developed market economies caused severe external payment problems. The increased cost of foreign borrowing, at a time when exports were depressed, also helped to plunge many developing countries into debt crises. Austerity programmes laid down by the IMF as a prerequisite for extending credit to meet short-term balance-of- payments needs became particularly onerous after the debt crisis. Growth was cut back and many social objectives fell by the wayside, including those having to do with employment, health, education, environment, and human settlements. We know that the world lives through an international finance crisis, which increases the misery and the poverty in the Third World arid we sacrifice even more our environment, though we know that this situation can be reversed, if we can use correctly new technology and knowledge. But for this we have to find a new ethic that will include the relationship between man and nature above all. Sergio Dialetachi Speaker from the floor WCED Public Hearing Sao Paulo, 26-29 Oct 1985 10. This was a radical change from the 1960s and 1970s. Then it was rapid economic growth
  • 64. that was seen as an ecological threat. Now it is recession, austerity, and falling living standards. The decline of the 1980s has aggravated pressures on the environment in several ways: Austerity measures and general recessionary conditions have brought sharp declines in per capita incomes and increased unemployment. This forces more people back into subsistence agriculture, where they draw heavily on the natural resource base and thus degrade it. Austerity programmes inevitably include government cutbacks in both the staff and expenditure of fledgling, weak environmental agencies, undermining even the minimal efforts being made to bring ecological considerations into development planning. Conservation always taken a back seat in times of economic stress. As economic conditions have worsened in developing countries and debt pressures have mounted, planners have tended to ignore environmental planning and conservation in both industrial and rural development projects. 11. The critical situations in sub Saharan Africa and the debt strapped countries of Latin America demonstrate, in an extreme way, the damaging impacts that unreformed international economic arrangements are having on both development and the environment. 1. The African Continent 12. Africa on the whole has been caught up in a series of downward spirals: poverty and hunger leading to environmental degradation, deteriorating agriculture, and hence more poverty and hunger; falling savings and a neglect of new investment in the wake of growing poverty; high infant mortality, poverty, and lack of education; high population growth rates; and a flight from rural hunger to the cities, leading to explosive levels of urban growth and squalor, compounding the problems of inadequate food supplies. 13. The situation is not everywhere so bleak. Some nations have coped well, and some far-reaching and courageous policy reforms begun in the last few years have begun to bear fruit. Encouragement also comes from South Asia, where a comparable crisis 20 years ago has given way to an upward spiral of rising food production, diminishing (but still vast) poverty, slowing population growth, rising savings and investment, and greater attention to the long-term questions of environmental management and appropriate technology. 14. Among the many causes of the African crisis, the workings of the international economy stand out. Sub-Saharan Africa's economic well-being depends even more than low-income Asia's on developments in the world economy. Within the last decade, many sub-Saharan countries have been hit by adverse trends in commodity terms of trade and external shocks such as higher oil prices, fluctuating exchange rates, and higher interest rates. Over the last 10 years, the prices of major commodities such as copper, iron ore, sugar, ground-nuts, rubber, timber, and cotton have fallen significantly. In 1985, the terms of trade of sub-Saharan countries (except oil-exporting countries) were 10 per cent below 1970 levels. In countries eligible for funds from the International Development Association (IDA), the average fall was
  • 65. well over 20 per cent, with even greater drops in some, including Ethiopia, Liberia, Sierra Leone, Zaire, and Zambia./3 15. The problem has been compounded by growing difficulties in attracting development capital from the industrial world. At the same time, debt repayments and interest charges have risen Debt service rose in sub-Saharan Africa as a whole from 15 per cent of export earnings in 1980 to 31 per cent in 1985./4 This combination of events has led to a situation where net resource transfers to the area fell from an estimated $10 billion a year in 1982 to $1 billion in 1985./5 Thus nations have been able to import far less. In countries eligible for IDA loans, the import volume per person in 1984 was only 62 per cent of the volume in 1970./6 Imports for agriculture - machinery, fertilizers, and pesticides - and of essential supplies to meet basic needs have all been cut. The combination of diverse international and internal factors cut per capita incomes by 16 per cent in sub-Saharan Africa between 1960 and 1985./7 16. The economic difficulties of sub-Saharan countries have had devastating social impacts. Declining per capita rood production has contributed to growing undernourishment. The recent drought placed some 35 million lives at risk in 1984/85, and as the drought receded some 19 million people continued to suffer famine./8 Malnutrition and hunger have weakened much of the population, reducing their productivity, and made more of them (especially children and the old) more susceptible to debilitating diseases and premature death. The crisis has reversed progress in supplying safe drinking water and sanitation. The seriousness of the African crisis cannot be overemphasized and in its entirety, it should really engage the whole world. The lives of 400 million people living in Africa today are imperilled. And many more people yet to be born will face a very bleak future unless effective solutions are found and found quickly. It requires of course very little imagination to appreciate the fact that it is not only Africa that is in danger. In the long term the entire world economy could be threatened not only because of the indivisibility of human welfare but because of Africa's crucial position in the global economy as a source of a large number of vital raw materials. Maxime Ferrari Director, UNEP Regional Office for Africa WCED Public Hearing Harare, 18 Sept 1986 17. It is now more widely recognized that it is necessary to deal with the long-term causes rather than the symptoms. The vast misery brought on by the drought in Africa is now generally acknowledged, and the world community has responded with a substantial emergency programme. But emergency food aid is only a short-term reaction, and, at best, a partial answer. The roots of the problem lie in national and international policies that have bo far prevented African economies from realizing their full potential for economic expansion and thus for easing poverty and the environmental pressures that it generates. 18. The resolution lies in large part with African decision makers, but the international community also has a heavy responsibility to support Africa's adjustment efforts with adequate aid and trade arrangements and to see to it that more capital flows into poorer nations than out. These two complementary aspects of the resolution of the problems have been fully recognized by the African countries themselves/9 and generally acknowledged by the
  • 66. international community./10 The World Bank estimates that even if external economic conditions are favourable over the next five years, and even if African governments implement key policy reforms, a substantial gap will still remain between the finance or debt relief available on current donor policies and the amounts needed to prevent a further deterioration in the living standards of low-income Africa./11 And there is no money in this grim equation for restoring the damaged environment. 19. The international community must realize that Africa cannot pull itself out of the planet's most serious economic and ecological crisis without much more long-term assistance than is currently envisioned. In addition, greatly increased external financing for development must be accompanied by policy changes that recognize the need to avoid environmental degradation. 2. Latin American Debt 20. Debt is an acute problem for many countries of Africa. But, because of the magnitudes of debt involved, it has had its most visible impact in some middle-income countries - particularly in Latin America. The debt crisis remains a threat to international financial stability, but its main impact so far has been on the process of development, both in its economic and ecological aspects. Of the total world debt of around $950 billion in 1985, roughly 30 per cent was owed by four countries: Argentina, Brazil, Mexico, and Venezuela. Their debts constitute roughly two-thirds of the outstanding loans of banks to developing countries./12 21. In the 1970s, Latin America's economic growth was facilitated by external borrowing. Commercial banks were happy to lend to growing countries rich in natural resources. Then major changes in international conditions made the debt unsustainable. A global recession restricted export markets, and tight monetary policies forced up global interest rates to levels far exceeding any in living memory. Bankers, alarmed by deteriorating creditworthiness, stopped lending. A flight of indigenous capital from developing countries compounded the problem. 22. The ensuing crisis forced governments into austerity policies to cut back imports. As a result, Latin American imports fell by 40 per cent in real terms over three years./13 The consequent economic contraction reduced per capita gross domestic product by an average of B per cent in the eight main Latin American countries./14 Much of the burden was carried by the poor, as real wages fell and unemployment rose. Growing poverty and deteriorating environmental conditions are clearly visible in every major Latin American country. 23. Further, the lack of new credit and the continuing burden of debt service forced these countries to service their debts by running trade surpluses. The net transfers from seven major Latin American countries to creditors rose to almost $39 billion in 1984, and in that year 35 per cent of export earnings went to pay interest on overseas debt./15 This massive drain represents 5 to 6 per cent of the region's GDP, around a third of the internal savings, and nearly 40 per cent of export earnings. It has been achieved by adjustment policies that impose severe and regressively skewed cuts in wages, social services, investment, consumption, and employment, both public and private, further aggravating social inequity and widespread poverty. Pressures on the environment and resources have increased sharply in the search for new and expanded exports and replacements for imports, together with the deterioration and overexploitation of the environment brought about by the swelling number of the urban and rural poor in desperate struggle for survival. A substantial part of Latin America's rapid growth in exports are raw materials, food, and resource-based manufactures.
  • 67. The impact of the present crisis on Latin America has been compared, in its depth and extension, with the Great Depression of 1929-32. The crisis has made it clear that, although the need to protect the environment against the traditional problems of deterioration and depletion continues to be a valid objective, policy-makers responsible for environmental management ought to avoid negative attitudes in the face of the need for economic reactivation and growth. The expansion, conservation, maintenance, and protection of the environment can make an essential contribution to the improvement of the standard of living, to employment, and to productivity. Osvaldo Sunkel Coordinator, Joint ECLAC/UNEP Development and Environment Unit WCED Public Hearing Sao Paulo, 28-29 Oct 1985 24. So Latin American natural resources ate being used not for development or to raise living standards, but to meet the financial requirements of industrialized country creditors. This approach to the debt problem raises questions of economic, political, and environmental sustainability. To require relatively poor countries to simultaneously curb their living standards, accept growing poverty, and export growing amounts of scarce resources to maintain external creditworthiness reflects priorities few democratically elected governments are likely to be able to tolerate for long. The present situation is not consistent with sustainable development. This conflict is aggravated by the economic policies of some major industrial countries, which have depressed and destabilized the international economy. In order to bring about socially and environmentally sustainable development it is indispensable, among other elements, for industrial countries to resume internationally expansionary policies of growth, trade, and investment. The Commission noted that, in these circumstances, some debtor countries have felt forced to suspend or limit the outflow of funds. 25. Growing numbers of creditor banks and official agencies are realizing that many debtors simply will not be able to keep servicing their debts unless the burden is eased. Measures under discussion include additional new lending, forgiveness of part of the debt, longer-term rescheduling, and conversion to softer terms. But a necessary sense of urgency is lacking. Any such measures must incorporate the legitimate interests of creditors and debtors and represent a fairer sharing of the burden of resolving the debt crisis. III. Enabling Sustainable Development 26. Developing countries have sought, for many years, fundamental changes in international economic arrangements so as to make them more equitable, particularly with regard to financial flows, trade, transnational investment, and technology transfer./16 Their arguments must now be recast to reflect the ecological dimensions, frequently overlooked in the past. 27. In the short run, for most developing countries except the largest a new era of economic growth hinges on effective and coordinated economic management among major industrial countries - designed to facilitate expansion, to reduce real interest rates, and to halt the slide to protectionism. In the longer term, major changes are also required to make consumption and production patterns sustainable in a context of higher global growth. 28. International cooperation to achieve the former is embryonic, and to achieve the latter, negligible. In practice, and in the absence of global management of the economy or the
  • 68. environment, attention must be focused on the improvement of policies in areas where the scope for cooperation is already defined: aid, trade, transnational corporations, and technology transfer. 1. Enhancing the Flow of Resources to Developing Countries 29. Two interrelated concerns lie at the heart of our recommendations on financial flows: one concerns the quantity, the other the 'quality of resource flows to developing countries. The need for more resources cannot be evaded. The idea that developing countries would do better to live within their limited means is a cruel illusion. Global poverty cannot be reduced by the governments of poor countries acting alone. At the same time, more aid and other forms of finance, while necessary, are not sufficient. Projects and programmes must be designed for sustainable development. 1.1 Increasing the Flow of Finance 30. As regards the quantity of resources, the stringency of external finance has already contributed to an unacceptable decline in living standards in developing countries. The patterns and the needs of the heavily indebted countries that rely mainly on commercial finance have been described, along with those of low-income countries that depend on aid. But there are other poor countries that have made impressive progress in recent years but still face immense problems, not least in countering environmental degradation. Low-income Asia has a continuing need for large amounts of aid; in general, the main recipients in this region have a good record of aid management. Without such aid it will be much more difficult, to sustain the growth that, together with poverty-focused programmes, could improve the lot of hundreds of millions of the 'absolute poor'. The universal importance of ecological problems can hardly be denied. Their successful solution will increasingly require coordinated activities not only within every country's economy but also within the scope of international cooperation. Ecological problems are unprecedented in the history of mankind. Dr. Todor I. Bozninov Committee for Environment Protection, Bulgaria WCED Public Hearing Moscow, 8 Dec 1986 31. To meet such needs requires that the main donors and lending institutions re-examine their policies. Official development assistance (ODA) levels have stagnated in absolute terms, and most donor countries fall well short of internationally agreed targets. Commercial lending and lending by export credit agencies has fallen sharply. As part of a concerted effort to reverse these trends it is vitally important for development that there should be a substantial increase in resources available to the World Bank and IDA. Increased commercial bank lending is also necessary for major debtors. 1.2 Lending for Sustainable Development 32. In the past, development assistance has not always contributed to sustainable development
  • 69. and in some cases detracted from it. Lending for agriculture, forestry, fishing, and energy has usually been made on narrow economic criteria that take little account of environmental effects For instance, development agencies have sometimes promoted chemical-dependent agriculture, rather than sustainable, regenerative agriculture. It is important therefore that there should be a qualitative as well as a quantitative improvement. 33. A larger portion of total development assistance should go to investments needed to enhance the environment and the productivity of the resource sectors. Such efforts include reforestation and fuelwood development, watershed protection, soil conservation, agroforestry, rehabilitation of irrigation projects, small scale agriculture, low-cost sanitation measures, and the conversion of crops into fuel. Experience has shown that the most effective efforts of this type are small projects with maximum grass-roots participation. The programmes most directly related to the objective of sustainable development may therefore involve higher local costs, a higher ratio of recurrent to capital costs, and a greater use of local technology and expertise. 34. A shift towards projects of this kind would also require donors to re-examine the content of their aid programmes, particularly with regard to commodity assistance, which has sometimes served to reduce rather than enhance the possibilities for sustainable development. (See Chapter 5.) The industrialized world's demands for raw materials, higher productivity, and material goods have imposed serious environmental impacts and high economic costs not only in our own countries, but also on the developing world. The existing international patterns of financial, economic trade and investment policies further add to the problems. We must all be willing to examine our relations in international trade, investments, development assistance, industry, and agriculture in light of the consequences these may have for underdevelopment and environmental destruction in the Third World. We must even be willing to go further and implement the means necessary to alienate these symptoms. Rakel Surlien Former Minister of Environment Government of Norway WCED Opening Ceremony Oslo, 24 June 1985 35. The major priority is for sustainability considerations to be diffused throughout the work of international financial institutions. The roles of the World Bank and the IMF are particularly crucial because their lending conditions are being used as benchmarks for parallel lending by other institutions - commercial banks and export credit agencies. It is important in this context that sustainability considerations be taken into account by the Bank in the appraisal of structural adjustment lending and other policy-oriented lending directed to resource-based sectors - agriculture, fishing, forestry, and energy in particular - as well as specific projects. 36. A similar shift of emphasis is required in respect of adjustment programmes undertaken by developing countries. To date, 'adjustment' - particularly under IMF auspices - has led more often than not to cutbacks in living standards in the interest of financial stabilization. Implicit in many suggested plans for coping with the debt crisis is the growing recognition that future
  • 70. adjustment should be growth-oriented. Yet it also needs to be environmentally sensitive. 37. The IMF also has a mandate for structural adjustment lending, as in its new Structural Adjustment Facility. There has been a strongly expressed demand from developing-country borrowers for the Fund to take into account wider and longer-term development objectives than financial stabilization: growth, social goals, and environmental impacts. 38. Development agencies, and the World Bank in particular, should develop easily usable methodologies to augment their own appraisal techniques and to assist developing countries to improve their capacity for environmental assessment. 2. Linking Trade, Environment, and Development 39. The importance of foreign trade to national development has greatly increased for most countries in the post-war period. (See Table 3-2.) This is one measure of the extent to which trade has made nations, economically and ecologically, more interdependent. Patterns of world trade also have changed markedly. First, the value of trade in manufactured goods grew at a faster rate than that in primary products other than fuel, and a growing number of developing countries have emerged as major exporters of such goods. Manufactured goods now account for twice the value of developing countries' non-oil exports./17 (See Chapter 8.) Second, the industrialized market economies have come to depend more on fuel imports from developing countries, which accounted for 43 per cent of consumption in 1980-81 compared with only 16 per cent in 1959-60 and even less in pre-war years./18 40. The dependence of the developed market economies on other mineral imports from the developing countries has also grown, and the share of these imports in consumption increased from 19 per cent in 1959-60 to 30 per cent in 1980-81./19 Non-renewable resources like fuels and minerals, as well as manufactured goods, are now far more important than tropical products and other agricultural materials in the flow of primary products from developing to industrial countries. In fact, the flow of food grains is in the opposite direction. 41. The main link between trade and sustainable development is the use of non-renewable raw materials to earn foreign exchange. Developing countries face the dilemma of having to use commodities as exports, in order to break foreign exchange constraints on growth, while also having to minimize damage to the environmental resource base supporting this growth. There are other links between trade and sustainable development; if protectionism raises barriers against manufactured exports, for example, developing nations have less scope for diversifying away from traditional commodities. And unsustainable development may arise not only from overuse of certain commodities but from manufactured goods that are potentially polluting. 2.1 International Commodity Trade 42. Although a growing number of developing countries have diversified into manufactured exports, primary commodities other than petroleum continue to account for more than one-third of the export earnings of the group as a whole. Dependence on such exports is particularly high in Latin America (52 per cent) and Africa (62 per cent)./20 The countries recognized as 'least developed' for the purposes of the UN Special Programme use primary commodities for 73 per cent of their export earnings./21 43. Non-oil commodity prices fell during the early 1980s, not only in real but also in nominal terms. By early 1985, the UNCTAD commodity price index was 30 per cent below the 1980
  • 71. average./22 This recent weakness of commodity prices may not be only a temporary phenomenon. Commodity prices have not yet recovered from the depth of the world recession despite increased economic growth in consuming countries. The reasons may be partly technological (an acceleration in raw material substitution); partly monetary, caused by the high cost of holding stocks of commodities; and partly due to increases in supplies by countries desperate to earn foreign exchange. Table 3-2 The Growing Importance of Trade 1950 1982 Economic Group (exports as a per cent of GDP or NMP) Developed Market Economies 7.7 15.3 Developing Market Economies 15.5 23.8 Socialist Countries of Eastern Europe 3.4* 16.6* Socialist Countries of Asia 2.9* 9.7* * percentages to net material product (NMP). Source: Based on UNCTAD, Handbook of International Trade and Development Statistics, 1985 Supplement (New York: United Nations, 1985). 44. These countries are turning the terms of trade against themselves, earning less while exporting more. The promotion of increased volumes of commodity exports has led to cases of unsustainable overuse of the natural resource base. While individual cases may not exactly fit this generalization, it has been argued that such processes have been at work in ranching for beef, fishing in both coastal and deep sea waters, forestry, and the growing of some cash crops. Moreover, the prices of commodity exports do not fully reflect the environmental costs to the resource base. In a sense, then, poor developing countries are being caused to subsidize the wealthier importers of their products. 45. The experience of oil has of course been different from that of most other commodities. (See Chapter 7.) It does provide one example of producers combining to restrict output and raise prices in ways that greatly increased export earnings while conserving the resource base and promoting energy saving and substitution on a large scale. Recent events suggest that regulation of the market by producers is very difficult in the long term, whether or not it is desirable in the wider, global interest, and in any event the conditions have not existed for other commodity exporters to operate in a like manner. Any arrangement encompassing measures to enhance the export earnings of producers, as well as to ensure the resource basis, would require consumer as well as producer support. 46. In recent years, Third World commodity exporters have sought to earn more by doing the
  • 72. first-stage processing of raw materials themselves. This first stage often involves subsidized energy, other concessions, and substantial pollution costs. But these countries often find that they do not gain much from this capital- and energy-intensive first-stage processing, as the price spread shifts in favour of downstream products, most of which continue to be manufactured mainly in industrial countries. Tariff escalation in the industrial market economies reinforces this tendency. 47. The main international response to commodity problems has been the development of international commodity agreements to stabilize and raise developing countries' earnings from these exports. But real progress has been very limited and in fact there have been reversals. Moreover, environmental resource considerations have not played any part in commodity agreements, with the notable exception of the International Tropical Timber Agreement./23 48. Commodity agreements have not been easy to negotiate, and regulation of commodity trade has been notoriously controversial and difficult. Current arrangements could be improved in two crucial respects: Larger sums for compensatory financing to even out economic shocks - as under the IMF's Compensatory Financing Facility - would encourage producers to take a long-term view, and not to overproduce commodities where production is close to the limits of environmental sustainability during periods of market glut. Where producers need to diversify from traditional, single-crop production patterns, more assistance could be given for diversification programmes. The second window of the Common Fund could be used for promoting resource regeneration and conservation./24 49. Individual governments can better use renewable resources such as forests and fisheries to ensure that exploitation rates stay within the limits of sustainable yields and that finances are available to regenerate resources and deal with all linked environmental effects. As for non-renewable resources like minerals, governments should ensure that: the leaseholder undertakes exploration aimed at adding to proven reserves at least the amount extracted; that the ratio of production to proven reserve remains below a pre-specified limit; that the funds generated by royalties are used in a way that compensates for the declining income when the resource deposit is exhausted; and that the leaseholder is responsible for land restoration and other environmental control measures in the urea affected by mining. I think it is also of importance for the Commission to note the problem of negotiation of contracts on resource development. We have been trying for 10 years to include provisions on environment. We have been successful only to get from the investors a very broad description of what should be done in environmental protection. If you go into details you get problems with the lawyers and so on. That hampers then the investment. For us, of course, it is a choice of whether to loosen the grip a little bit or if you maintain that, then of course, there will be no investment in the country. If an appeal could be made to the multinationals, mainly to understand that what has
  • 73. been done in timber should also be applied to other agreements like coffee, tin, and others. I think this would be a great help. Speaker from the floor Government agency WCED Public Hearing Jakarta, 26 March 1985 50. Relevant international organizations such as various UN agencies, the World Bank, and regional groups could develop further their work on model contracts and guidelines incorporating these principles. 2.2 Protectionism and International Trade 51. The increase in protectionism in industrial countries stifles export growth and prevents diversification from traditional exports. The success of some Far Eastern developing countries in increasing exports of labour-intensive manufactured goods shows the development potential of such trace. However, other countries - especially low-income Asian and Latin American nations - seeking to follow the same route have found themselves severely handicapped by growing trade barriers, particularly in textiles and clothing. If developing countries are to reconcile a need for rapid export growth with a need to conserve the resource base, it is imperative that they enjoy access to industrial country markets for non traditional exports where they enjoy a comparative advantage. In many cases, the problems of protectionism relate to manufactures; but there are cases - sugar is a good example - where industrial countries employ agricultural trade restrictions in ways that are damaging ecologically as well as economically. (See Box 3-2.) 2.3 'Pollution-intensive' Goods 52. The processing of certain raw materials - pulp and paper, oil, and alumina, for example - can have substantial environmental side effects. Industrial countries have generally been more successful than developing ones in seeing to it that export product prices reflect the costs of environmental damage and of controlling that damage. Thus in the case of exports from industrial countries, these costs are paid by consumers in importing nations, including those in the Third World. But in the case of exports from developing countries, such costs continue to be borne entirely domestically, largely in the form of damage costs to human health, property, and ecosystems. Box 3-2 Sugar and Sustainable Development Thirty million poor people in the Third World depend on sugar cane for their survival. Many developing countries have a genuine comparative advantage in production and could earn valuable foreign exchange by expanding output. Some small states - Fiji, Mauritius, and several Caribbean islands - depend for their economic survival on cane sugar exports.
  • 74. Industrial countries have actively promoted, and protected, beet sugar production, which competes with cane and has had quite damaging effects on developing countries: High-cost, protected beet production encourages artificial sweeteners; quotas have kept out Third World imports (except for some guaranteed imports as under the EEC's Sugar Protocol); and surpluses are dumped on world markets depressing prices. In the 1986 World Development Report, the World Bank estimated that industrial countries' sugar policies cost developing countries About $7.4 billion in lost revenues during 1963, reduced their real income by about $2.1 billion and increased price instability by about 25 per cent. Over and above the increased developing country poverty that results from these practices, the promotion of beet production in industrial countries has had adverse ecological side effects. Modern beet growing is highly capital-intensive, it depends heavily on chemical herbicides, and the crop has poorer regenerative properties than others. The same product could be grown in developing countries, as cane, more cheaply, using more labour and fewer chemical additives. 53. In 1980 the industries of developing countries exporting to OECD members would have incurred direct pollution control costs of $5.5 billion if they had been required to meet the environmental standards then prevailing in the United States, according to a study conducted for this Commission./25 If the pollution control expenditures associated with the materials that went into the final product are also counted, the costs would have mounted to $14.2 billion. The evidence also suggests that OECD imports from developing countries involve products that entail higher average environmental and resource damage costs than do overall OECD imports./26 These hypothetical pollution control costs probably understate the real costs of environmental and resource damage in the exporting countries. Furthermore, these costs relate only to environmental pollution and net to the economic damage costs associated with resource depletion. 54. The fact that these costs remain hidden means that developing countries are able to attract more investment to export manufactured goods than they would under a more rigorous system of global environmental control. Many Third World policymakers see this as beneficial in that it gives developing countries a comparative advantage in 'pollution-intensive' goods that should be exploited. They also see that passing along more of the real costs could reduce the competitive position of their country in some markets, and thus regard any pressure in this direction as a form of disguised protectionism from established producers. Yet it is in developing countries' own long-term interests that more of the environmental and resource costs associated with production be reflected in prices. Such changes must come from the developing countries themselves. 2.4 The Mandates of Multilateral Trade Forums 55. Although a number of UNCTAD research projects have considered the links between trade and environment, these issues have not been taken up systematically by intergovernmental organizations. The mandates of these organizations - principally GATT and UNCTAD - should include sustainable development. Their activities should reflect concern with the impacts of trading patterns on the environment and the need for more effective instruments to integrate
  • 75. environment and development concerns into international trading arrangements. 56. International organizations dealing with trade will find it easier to reorientate their activities if each nation designates a lead agency with a broad mandate to assess the effects of international trade on sustaining the environmental and resource base of economic growth. This agency could be responsible for raising sustainability issues in the work of UNCTAD, GATT, OECD, CMEA, and other relevant organizations. 3. Ensuring Responsibility in Transnational Investment 57. Overseas investment activity by companies in market economies has grown substantially over the past 40 years. (See Box 3-3.) Foreign affiliates now account for 40 per cent of sales, 33 per cent of net assets, and 56 per cent of net earnings for 380 of the largest industrial corporations in the market economies, according to data compiled by the UN Centre for Transnational Corporations./27 A high proportion of transnational investment is within industrial market economies, another aspect of the growing integration of these economies. 58. Transnationals play an important role as owners, as partners in joint ventures, and as suppliers of technology in the mining and manufacturing sectors in many developing countries, especially in such environmentally sensitive areas as petroleum, chemicals, metals, paper, and automobiles. They also dominate world trade in many primary commodities. 59. In recent years, many developing countries have begun to take a more positive view of the role TNC investment can play in their development process. This has been somewhat influenced by these countries' needs for foreign exchange and their awareness of the role that foreign investment might play in providing it. Effective cooperation with TNCs is possible in creating equal conditions for all parties. This can be attained by a strict observance of the principle of sovereignty of the host country For their part, many corporations have recognized the need to share managerial skills and technological know-how with host country nationals and to pursue profit-seeking objectives within a framework of long-tern sustainable development. Box 3-3 The Role of Transnational Corporations In 1983 chemicals accounted for roughly one-fourth of the stock of foreign direct investment in manufacturing in developing countries by companies from four leading countries - Japan (23 per cent), the United States (23 per cent), the United Kingdom (27 per cent), and the Federal Republic of Germany (14 per cent). Agriculture, mining, and other extractive industries accounted for 38 per cent of the stock of U.S. investment in developing countries in 1983, 29 per cent of the stock of Japanese investment in 1983, 21 per cent of the total FRG investment in 1981-83, and 9 per cent of the stock of U.K. investment in 1978. Eighty to ninety per cent of the trade in tea, coffee, cocoa, cotton, forest products, tobacco, jute, copper, iron ore, and bauxite is controlled in the case of each commodity by the three to six largest transnationals.
  • 76. Source: UN Centre on Transnational Corporations, Environmental Aspects of the Activities of Transnational Corporations: A Survey (New York: UN, 1985). 60. But mutual suspicions still exist, usually because of an asymmetry in bargaining power between large corporations and small, poor, developing countries. Negotiations are often made one sided by a developing country's lack of information, technical unpreparedness, and political and institutional weaknesses. Suspicions and disagreements remain, particularly concerning the introduction of new technologies, the development of natural resources, and the use of the environment. If multinationals are to play a larger role in development, these conflicts and suspicions must be reduced. 61. Strengthening the bargaining posture and response of developing countries vis a vis transnationals is therefore critical. Where nations lack indigenous capacity to deal with large TNCs, regional and other international institutions should assist. As indicated earlier, they could expand existing help in the form of model agreements with transnationals for different situations, such an lease agreements for the exploitation of a mineral resource. They could also field technical assistance and advisory teams when a country negotiates with a transnational. 62. Transnational can have a substantial impact on the environment and resources of other countries and on the global commons. Both the home and host countries of TNCs share responsibilities and should work together to strengthen policies in this sphere. For example, information on policies and standards applied to and followed by corporations when investing in their own home country, especially concerning hazardous technologies, should be provided to host countries. Moreover, the policies of some industrialized countries that major investments are subject to prior environmental assessment should be considered for application to investments made elsewhere and should be broadened to include sustainability criteria. The information and recommendations thus arrived at should be shared with the host countries, which of course would retain the final responsibility. 63. Despite their importance, international measures regarding transnational have been generally lacking and have proved extremely difficult to negotiate. The codes of conduct for transnational corporations formulated by the OECD and under discussion in the UN should deal explicitly with environmental matters and the objective of sustainable development. More detailed and specific instruments are needed for other problems. In particular, when introducing a new technology, plant, product, or process, or when setting up a joint venture in a developing country, the parties involved must also recognize and accept certain special responsibilities. (See Chapter 8.) 4. Broadening the Technological Base 64. The promotion of resource productivity is largely the work of domestic economic policy. But the international economy impinges on possibilities for productivity improvement in several ways, particularly in the transfer of technology from one country to another. 4.1 The Diffusion of Environmentally Sound Technologies 65. The promotion of sustainable development will require an organized effort to develop and diffuse new technologies, such as for agricultural production, renewable energy systems, and
  • 77. pollution control. Much of this effort will be based on the international exchange of technology: through trade in improved equipment, technology-transfer agreements, provision of experts, research collaboration, and so on. Hence the procedures and policies that influence these exchanges must stimulate innovation and ensure ready and widespread access to environmentally sound technologies. 66. The real challenge is to ensure that the new technologies reach all those who need them, overcoming such problems as the lack of information and in some cases an inability to pay for commercially developed technologies. The measures required at the national level to deal with these problems are discussed in Part II of this report. However, both these issues also arise in the international diffusion of technology. Transfer of technology should be also looked upon as being a social process. Actually, ideally, it is the people themselves who have to make the selection, not us. So, to sum it up I think, talking about technology it is very important to, perhaps, understand that we are dealing here with a process of change. Technologies cannot be directly transferred except by relating this to a social process. So, actually technology is not an independent variable in this case, but it is very much dependent of social change. M. Nashihin Hasan Speaker from the floor WCED Public Hearing Jakarta, 26 March 1985 67. Developing countries paid about $2 billion in 1960 by way of royalties and fees, mainly to industrial countries./28 The gap in scientific and technological capabilities is particularly wide in areas of direct relevance to the objectives of sustainable development, including biotechnology and genetic engineering, new energy sources, new materials and substitutes, and low-waste and non-polluting technologies. 68. The principal policy issue as regards the impact of payments is the impact of patents and proprietary rights. In 1980, industrialized market economies accounted for 65 per cent of the world total of patents granted, and the socialist countries of Eastern Europe held 29 per cent./29 Developing countries held only 6 per cent, and most of these had been granted to non-residents. Proprietary rights are a key element in the commercial development of technology. But their application in certain areas may hamper the diffusion of environmentally sound technologies and may increase inequities. 69. In the past, publicly funded research provided new technology to small producers, particularly farmers, on a full or subsidized basis. The situation is not very different now, and in areas such as new seed varieties there is some reason to believe proprietary rights could act as a major barrier to developing countries' acquisition of new technologies. International cooperation is essential to maintain the flow of genetic material and to ensure an equitable sharing of gains. 4.2 Building Up Technological Capabilities in Developing Countries 70. At present, most of the global research and development effort is devoted to military purposes or the commercial objectives of large corporations. Little of this is of direct relevance
  • 78. to conditions in developing countries. In many areas the gap in technological capabilities is narrowing, but these efforts must be supported by international assistance, especially in such key areas as biotechnology. Unless action is taken to accumulate biological knowledge, valuable information as well as vital genetic variety will be lost forever, and developing countries will be at a permanent disadvantage in adapting the new biotechnologies to their own needs. 71. Developing countries therefore have to work, individually and together, to build up their technological capabilities. The creation and enhancement of the infrastructure for research and technology is a precondition for such cooperation. The countries concerned could share the burden by establishing cooperative research projects along the lines of the International Agricultural Research Centres./30 Mission-oriented cooperative research ventures could be developed in areas such as dryland agriculture, tropical forestry, pollution control in small enterprises, and low-cost housing. Specific responsibilities would be assigned to institutions and corporations in the participating countries, and the agreement could provide for the equitable sharing and widespread diffusion of the technologies developed. IV. A Sustainable World Economy 72. If large parts of the developing world are to avert economic, social, and environmental catastrophes, it is essential that global economic growth be revitalized. In practical terms, this means more rapid economic growth in both industrial and developing countries, freer market access for the products of developing countries, lower interest rates, greater technology transfer, and significantly larger capital flows, both concessional and commercial. 73. But many people fear that a more rapidly growing world economy will apply environmental pressures that are no more sustainable than the pressures presented by growing poverty. The increased demand for energy and other non-renewable raw materials could significantly raise the price of these items relative to other goods. 74. The Commission's overall assessment is that the international economy must speed up world growth while respecting the environmental constraints. Some favourable trends have been noted in the pattern of consumption and production in industrial countries, which collectively still consume most of the world's non-renewable resources. 75. Sustaining these trends will make it easier for developing countries to grow by diversifying their own economies. But for them to emerge from dependence a general acceleration of global economic growth is not enough. This would mean a mere perpetuation of existing economic patterns, though perhaps at a higher level of incomes. It must be ensured that the economies of developing countries grow fast enough to outpace their growing internal problems and fast enough for that first leap needed to acquire momentum. A continuation of economic growth and diversification, along with the development of technological and managerial skills, will help developing countries mitigate the strains on the rural environment, raise productivity and consumption standards, and allow nations to move beyond dependence on one or two primary products for their export earnings. 76. Future patterns of agricultural and forestry development, energy use, industrialization, and human settlements can be made far less material-intensive (see Chapters 5, 7, 8, and 9), and hence both more economically and environmentally efficient. Under these conditions, a new era of growth in the world economy can widen the options available to developing countries. 77. Reforms at an international level are now needed to deal simultaneously with economic and ecological aspects in ways that allow the world economy to stimulate the growth of developing countries while giving greater weight to environmental concerns. Such an agenda requires deep
  • 79. commitment by all countries to the satisfactory working of multilateral institutions, such as the multilateral development banks; to the making and observance of international rules in fields such as trade and investment; and to constructive dialogue on the many issues where national interests do not immediately coincide but where negotiation could help to reconcile them. 78. The Commission therefore regrets but cannot ignore the recent decline in multilateral cooperation in general and a negative attitude to dialogue on development in particular. At first sight, the introduction of an environmental dimension further complicates the search for such cooperation and dialogue. But it also injects an additional element of mutual self-interest, since a failure to address the interaction between resource depletion and rising poverty will accelerate global ecological deterioration. 79. New dimensions of multilateralism are essential to human progress. The Commission feels confident that the mutual interests involved in environment and development issues can help generate the needed momentum and can secure the necessary international economic changes that it will make possible. Footnotes 1/ Department of International Economic and Social Affairs (DIESA), Doubling Development Finance: Meeting a Global Challenge. Views and Recommendations of the Committee on Development Planning (New York: UN, 1986) 2/ Ibid. 3/ World Bank, Financing Adjustment with Growth in Sub-Saharan Africa (Washington, DC, 1986). 4/ IMF, World Economic Outlook, October 1986. 5/ UN, World Economic Survey 1986 (New York, 1986). 6/ World Bank, op. cit. 7/ Ibid. 8/ UN, General Assembly, 'The Critical Economic Situation in Africa: Report of the Secretary General', A/S-13/2, New York, 20 May 1986. 9/ Organization of African Unity Assembly of Heads of State of Government, Africa's Priority Programme of Action 1986-1991 (Addis Ababa, 1985). 10/ UN General Assembly, United Nations Programme of Action for African Economic Recovery and Development (New York, 1986). 11/ World Bank, op. cit. 12/ Bank of International Settlements, International Banking and Financial Markets Developments. (Basle, 1986). 13/ Inter-American Development Bank, Economic and Social Progress in Latin America (Washington, DC, 1986).
  • 80. 14/ Unpublished data from UN Economic Commission on Latin America. 15/ Ibid. 16/ See, for example, UN, 'Programme of Action on a New International Economic Order', General Assembly Resolution 3202 (S-VI), 1 May 1974. 17/ see GATT, International Trade 1985-86 (Geneva, 1986). 18/ UNCTAD, Handbook of International Trade and Development Statistics, 1977 and 1985 Supplements (New York: UN, 1977 and 1985). 19/ Ibid. 20/ UNCTAD, Statistical Pocketbook (New York: UN, 1984). 21/ Ibid. 22/ UNCTAD, Trade and Development Report (New York: UN, 1986). 23/ Alister MacIntyre, UNCTAD, statement at WCED Public Hearings, Oslo, 1985. 24/ The Common Fund is an international arrangement for the stabilization of prices for a group of commodities of particular interest to developing countries. The Second Window of the fund is meant to provide resources for promotional and research measures. 25/ I. Halter and J.H. Loudon, 'Environmental Costs and the Patterns of North-South Trade', prepared for WCED, 1986. 26/ Ibid. 27/ UN Centre on Transnational Corporations, Transnational Corporations in World Development Third Survey (New York: UN, 1983). 28/ Ibid. 29/ Commonwealth Working Group, Technological Change (London: Commonwealth Secretariat, 1985). 30/ The reference is to the activities of the international institutes that work under the umbrella of the Consultative Group on International Agricultural Research of the World Bank.
  • 81. Our Common Future, Chapter 4: Population and Human Resources I. The Links with Environment and Development II. The Population Perspective 1. Growth in Numbers 2. Changes in Mobility 3. Improved Health and Education III. A Policy Framework 1. Managing Population Growth 2. Managing Distribution and Mobility 3. From Liability to Asset 3.1 Improving Health 3.2 Broadening Education 3.3 Empowering Vulnerable Groups Footnotes Chapter 4: Population and Human Resources 1. In 1985. some 80 million people were added to a world population of 4.8 billion. Each year the number of human beings increases, but the amount of natural resources with which to sustain this population, to improve the quality of human lives. and to eliminate mass poverty remains finite. On the other hand, expanding knowledge increases the productivity of resources. 2. Present rates of population growth cannot continue. They already compromise many governments' abilities to provide education, health care, and food security for people, much less their abilities to raise living standards. This gap between numbers and resources is all the more compelling because so much of the population growth is concentrated in low-income countries, ecologically disadvantaged regions, and poor households. 3. Yet the population issue is not solely about numbers. And poverty and resource degradation can exist on thinly populated lands, such as the drylands and the tropical forests. People are the ultimate resource. Improvements in education, health, and nutrition allow them to better use the resources they command, to stretch them further. In addition, threats to the sustainable use of resources come as much from inequalities in people's access to resources and from the ways in which they use them as from the sheer numbers of people. Thus concern over the 'population problem' also calls forth concern for human progress and human equality. 4. Nor are population growth rates the challenge solely of those nations with high rates of increase. An additional person in an industrial country consumer far more and places far greater pressure on natural resources than an additional person in the Third World. Consumption patterns and preferences are as important as numbers of consumers in the conservation of resources.
  • 82. 5. Thus many governments must work on several fronts to limit population growth; to control the impact of such growth on resources and, with increasing knowledge, enlarge their range and improve their productivity; to realize human potential so that people can better husband and use resources; and to provide people with forms of social security other than large numbers of children. The means of accomplishing these goals will vary from country to country, but all should keep in mind that sustainable economic growth and equitable access to resources are two of the more certain routes towards lower fertility rates. 6. Giving people the means to choose the size of their families is not just a method of keeping population in balance with resources; it is a way of assuring - especially for women the basic human right of self-determination. The extent to which facilities for exercising such choices are made available is itself a measure of a nation's development. In the same way. enhancing human potential not only promotes development but helps to ensure the right of all to a full and dignified life. I. The Links with Environment and Development 7. Population growth and development are linked in complex ways. Economic development generates resources that can be used to improve education and health. These improvements, along with associated social changes, reduce both fertility and mortality rates. On the other hand, high rates of population growth that eat into surpluses available for economic and social development can hinder improvements in education and health. 8. In the past, the intensification of agriculture and the production of higher yields helped nations cope with the increasing population pressures on available land. Migration and international trade in food and fuels eased the pressure on local resources. They permitted and helped sustain the high population densities of some industrialized countries. 9. The situation is different in most of the developing world. There, improvements in medicine and public health have led to a sharp drop in mortality rates and have accelerated population growth rates to unprecedented levels. But fertility rates remain high; much human potential remains unrealized, and economic development is stalled. Agricultural intensification can go some way towards restoring a balance between food production and population, but there are limits beyond which intensification cannot go. (See Box 4-1.) 10. The very possibility of development can be compromised by high population growth rates. Moreover, most developing countries do not have the resources to wait for a few generations before population stabilizes. The option of migration to new lands is virtually closed. And low levels of economic and social development combined with changing trade production relationships limit possibilities of using international trade to augment access to resources. Hence, in the absence of deliberate measures, the imbalance between population growth and resource development will worsen. 11. Population pressure is already forcing traditional farmers to work harder, often on shrinking fame on marginal land, just to maintain household income. In Africa and Asia, rural population nearly doubled between 1950 and 1985, with a corresponding decline in land availability./1 Rapid population growth also creates urban economic and social problems that threaten to make cities wholly unmanageable. (See Chapter 9.) 12. Larger investments will be needed just to maintain the current inadequate levels of access to education, health care, and other services. In many cases, the resources required are just not available. Health, housing conditions, and the quality of education and public services all
  • 83. deteriorate; unemployment, urban drift, and social unrest increase. Box 4-1 The Food/Population Balance The potential population-supporting capacity of land in developing countries has been assessed in a joint study by FAO and the International Institute for Applied Systems Analysis. Data on soil and land characteristics were combined with climatic data to calculate the potential yields of major crops, to select the optimum crops, and to derive the overall potential for calorie production. Three levels of crop production were calculated: the first at a low level of technology with no fertilizer or chemicals, traditional crop varieties, and no soil conservation; the second at an intermediate level, where the most productive crop mix is used on half the land along with fertilizers, improved varieties, and some soil conservation; and the third at a high level of technology with an ideal crop mix and technology on all lands. The population-supporting capacity was determined by dividing the total calorie production by a minimum per capita intake level. This figure was then compared with the medium-variant UN population projections. The 117 developing countries covered in the study, taken together, can produce enough food to feed one-and-a-half times their projected population in the year 2000. even at a low level of technology. But the picture is less hopeful in the cases of individual countries. At the low level of technology, 64 countries with a population of around 1.1 billion lack the resources to feed themselves. With the most advanced agricultural methods, the number of countries where food production potential would fall short of requirements drops to 19, with a total population of 100 million. Most are high-income West Asian countries and some small island states. Many of these countries have the capacity to earn enough foreign exchange to import their food requirements. In the others, the real issue is the modernization of agriculture on a sustainable basis. Some researchers have assessed the 'theoretical' potential for global food production. One study assumes that the area under food production can be around 1.5 billion hectares (close to the current level) and that average yields could go up to 5 tons of grain equivalent per hectare (as against the present average of 2 tons of grain equivalent}. Allowing for production from rangelands and marine sources, the total 'potential' is placed at 8 billion tons of grain equivalent. How many people can this sustain? The present global average consumption of plant energy for food, seed, and animal feed amounts to about 6,000 calories daily, with a range among countries of 3,000-15,000 calories, depending on the level of meat consumption. On this basis, the potential production could sustain a little more than 11 billion people. But if the average consumption rises substantially - say, to 9,000 calories - the population carrying capacity of the Earth comes down to 7.5 billion. These figures could be substantially higher if the area under food production and the productivity of 3 billion hectares of permanent pastures ran be increased on a sustainable basis. Nevertheless, the data do suggest, that meeting the food needs of an ultimate world population of
  • 84. around 10 billion would require tone changes in food habits, as well as greatly improving the efficiency of traditional agriculture. B. Gilland. 'Considerations on World Population and Food Supply'. Population and Development Review. Vol. 9. No. 2. pp. 203-11; G M. Higgins et al., Potential Population supporting Capacities of Lands in the Developing World (Rome: FAO. 1982); D.J. Maler (ed.). Rapid Population Growth and Human Carrying Capacity. Staff Working Papers No. 690 (Washington, D.C.: World Bank, 1985). 13. Industrial countries seriously concerned with high population growth rates in other parts of the world have obligations beyond simply supplying aid packages of family planning hardware. Economic development, through its indirect impact on social and cultural factors, lowers fertility rates. International policies that interfere with economic development thus interfere with a developing nation's ability to manage its population growth. A concern for population growth must therefore be a part of a broader concern for a more rapid rate of economic and social development in the developing countries. 14. In the final analysis, and in both the developed and developing worlds, the population issue is about humane and not about numbers. It is misleading and an injustice to the human condition to see people merely fit; consumers. Their well being and security old age security, declining child mortality, health care, and so on are the goal o( development Almost any activity that increases well-being and security lessens peoples' desires to have more children than they and national ecosystems can support. II. The Population Perspective 1. Growth in Numbers 15. Population growth accelerated in the middle of the 18th century with the advent of the Industrial Revolution and associated improvements in agriculture, not just in the regions that are more developed but elsewhere as well. The recent phase of deceleration started around 1950 with the sharp reduction in mortality rates in the developing countries. Since 1970 it has been fashionable to draw a distinction between population and environment as two crisis areas, but often times we forget that population is in fact a very integral part of the environment and therefore when we are addressing ourselves to population we are looking at not only the physical, biological, and chemical environments, we are also looking at the socio-cultural or socio-economic environment in which these development programmes are being set. And population makes much more sense if you are talking of population within a context. Dr. J.O. Oucho Population Studies and Research institute WCED Public Hearing Nairobi. 23 Sept 1986 16. Between 1950 and 1985. world population grew at an annual rate of 1.9 per cent, compared
  • 85. with 0.8 per cent in the half-century preceding 1950./2 population growth is now concentrated in the developing regions of Asia, Africa, and Latin America, which accounted for 85 per cent of the increase of global population since 1950. (See Table 4-1.) 17. The processes of population growth are changing in most developing countries as birth and death rates fall. In the early 1950s, practically all developing countries had birth rates over 40 and death rates over 20, the major exception being the low death rates in Latin America. (These rates refer to the annual number of births and deaths per 1,000 population.) Today the situation is quite different: Thirty-two per cent of the people in the Third World live in countries - such as China and the Republic of Korea - with birth rates below 25 and death rates below 10. Forty-one per cent are in countries where birth rates have fallen, but not as much as death rates, and their populations are growing at around 2 per cent - doubling, in other words, every 34 years. Such countries include Brazil, India, Indonesia, and Mexico. The remaining 27 per cent live in countries, such as Algeria, Bangladesh. Iran, and Nigeria, where death rates have fallen slightly but birth rates remain high. Overall population growth is in the range of 2.5 to 3 per cent (doubling every 28 to 23 years), with even higher growth rates in some countries, such as Kenya./3 18. In the industrial world, fertility rates have declined and the population is not growing rapidly. In fact, it has stabilized in many countries. Still, the population in North America, Europe, the USSR, and Oceania is expected to increase by 230 million by the year 2025. which is as many people as live in the United States today. Table 4-1 World Population 1950-85: Key Facts Size and Rates 1950 1960 1970 1980 1985 Total Population (billions) World 2.5 3.0 3.7 4.4 4.8 More developed regions 0.83 0.94 1.05 1.14 1.17 Less developed regions 1.68 2.07 2.65 3.31 3.66 Annual Growth * (per cent) World 1.8 2.0 1.9 1.7 More developed regions 1.3 1.0 0.8 0.6 Less developed regions 2.1 2.5 2.3 2.0 Urban Population (per cent)
  • 86. World 29 34 37 40 41 More developed regions 54 67 67 70 72 Less developed regions 17 22 25 29 31 * Data are for growth over previous decade or, for last column, over previous five years. Source: Department of International Economic and Social Affairs, World Population Prospects: Estimates and Projections as Assessed in 1984 (New York: UN, 1986) 19. The acceleration of population growth in the Third World and the decline in fertility levels in industrial countries are (changing age distribution patterns radically. In developing countries, the young predominate. In 1900, 39 per cent of developing country populations were younger than 15; the figure for industrialized countries was only 23 per cent./4 Yet in these countries, the proportion of the elderly is growing. Those 65 or older accounted for 11 per cent of the population in 1980; in developing countries, they represented only 4 per cent./5 Thus in the industrial world, relatively fewer people of working age will bear the burden of supporting relatively larger numbers of older people. 20. A changing age structure helps to set patterns of future population growth. The large number of young people in developing countries means large numbers of future parents, so that even if each person produces fewer children. The total number of births will continue to increase. Population growth can continue to grow for some decades after fertility rates decline to the 'replacement level' of slightly over two children on average per couple. Thus in many nations, high population growth over the next few generations are assured. 21. Population projections indicate an increase in global population from 4.8 billion in 1985 to 6.1 billion by 2000, and to 8.2 billion by 2025. (See Table 4 2.) More than 90 pet cent of this increase is expected in developing regions. Large differences exist among countries in these areas, and the momentum of population growth is higher in Africa than in Latin America or Asia. In some developing countries, such as China, population growth rates are already well below 2 per cent and are expected to fall below 1 per cent by the beginning of the next century./6 22. Reflecting the 'momentum' of population growth, long term UN projections show that at the global level: if replacement-level fertility is reached in 2010, global population will stabilize at 7.7 billion by 2060; if this rate is reached in 2025, population will stabilize at 10.2 billion by 2095; if. however, the rate is reached only in 2065, global population in 2100 would be 14.2 billion./7 23. These projections show that the world has real choices. Policies to bring down fertility rates could make a difference of billions to the global population next century. The greater part of the differences between the three variants is accounted for by South Asia. Africa, and Latin America. Hence much depends on the effectiveness of population policies in these regions. 2. Changes in Mobility 24. The number of people in Europe, Japan. North America. and the Soviet Union quintupled
  • 87. between 1750 and 1950. and these regions' share in world population increased sharply over thin period./8 By the latter part of the 19th century, there was growing concern about population pressures in Europe. Migration to North America, Australia, and New Zealand helped to some extent. At its peak between 1881 and 1910, permanent emigration absorbed nearly 20 per rent of the increase in population in Europe./9 25. Today, however, migration in not a major factor in determining population distribution among countries. Between 1970 and 1980 permanent emigration as a percentage of population increase fell to 4 per cent in Europe and was only 2.5 per cent in Latin America. The corresponding percentages in Asia and Africa were very much lower./10 Thus the option of emigration to new lands has not been and will not be a significant element in relieving demographic pressures in developing countries In effect, this reduces the time available to bring population into balance with resources. 26. Within countries, populations are more mobile. Improved communications have enabled large movements of people. Sometimes as a natural response to the growth of economic opportunities in different places. Some governments have actively encouraged migration from densely to sparsely settled areas. A more recent phenomenon is the flight of 'ecological refugees' from areas of environmental degradation. Table 4-2 Current and Projected Population Size and Growth Rates* Population Annual Growth Rate 1950 1985 2000 1985 2000 2025 to to to 1985 2000 2025 Region (billion) (per cent) World 4.8 6.1 8.2 1.9 1.6 1.2 Africa 0.66 0.87 1.62 2.6 3.1 2.5 Latin America 0.41 0.55 0.78 2.6 2.0 1.4 Asia 2.82 3.55 4.54 2.1 1.6 1.0 North America 0.26 0.30 0.35 1.3 0.8 0.6 Europe 0.49 0.51 0.52 0.7 0.3 0.1 USSR 0.28 0.31 0.37 1.7 0.8 0.6 Oceania 0.02 0.03 0.04 1.9 1.4 0.9 * Medium-variant projections. Source: Department of International Economic and Social Affairs, World Population Prospects; Estimates and Projections as Assessed in 1984 (New York: UN, 1986).
  • 88. 27. Much of the movement is from countryside to city. (See Chapter 9.) In 1985. some 40 per cent of the world's population lived in cities; the magnitude of the urban drift can be seen in the fact that since 1950, the increase in urban population has been larger than the increase in rural population both in percentage and in absolute terms. This shift is most striking in developing countries, where the number of city-dwellers quadrupled during this period./11 3. Improved Health and Education 28. Improvements in the health and education of all, but especially of women and in conjunction with other social changes that raise the status of women, can have a profound effect in bringing down population growth rates. In an initial period, however, better health care means that more babies live to reproduce and that women reproduce over longer time spans. Table 4-3 Health Indicators Life Expectancy at Birth Infant Mortality Rates 1950-55 1980-85 1960-65 1980-85 Region (years) (deaths per 1,000 live births) World 49.9 64.6 117 81 Africa 37.5 49.7 157 114 Asia 41.2 57.9 133 87 South America 52.3 64.0 101 64 North America 64.4 71.1 43 27 Europe 65.3 73.2 37 16 USSR 61.7 70.9 32 25 Oceania 61.0 67.6 55 39 Source: WCED, based on data in World Resources Institute / International Institute for Environment and Development, World Resources 1986 (New York: Basic Books, 1986). 29. The 'health status' of a society is a complex concept that cannot be measured easily. Two widely available indicators that reflect at least some aspects of a given society's health are life expectancy and infant mortality rates. (See Table 4-3.) These statistics suggest that health has improved virtually everywhere; and, at least with regard to these two indicators, the gap between industrial and developing regions has narrowed. 30. Many factors can increase life expectancy and reduce mortality rates: two are worth emphasizing. First, although generally speaking national wealth buys national health, some relatively poor nations and areas, such as China, Sri Lanka, and the Indian state of Kerala, have achieved remarkable success in lowering infant mortality and improving health through increases in education, especially of women; the establishment of primary health clinics; and
  • 89. other health care programmes./12 Second, the principal reductions in mortality rates in the industrial world came about before the advent of modern drugs; they were due to improved nutrition, housing, and hygiene. The recent gains in developing countries have also been largely due to public health programmes, particularly for the control of communicable diseases. 31. Education is another key dimension of 'population quality'. The past few decades have seen a great expansion of educational facilities in virtually all countries. In terms of school enrolment, literacy rates, the growth in technical education, and the development of scientific skills, much progress has been achieved. (See Table 4-4.) III. A Policy Framework 32. Excessive population growth diffuses the fruits of development over increasing numbers instead of improving living standards in many developing countries: a reduction of current growth rates is an imperative for sustainable development. The critical issues are the balance between population size and available resources and the rate of population growth in relation to the capacity of the economy to provide for the basic needs of the population, not just today but for generations. Such a long-term view is necessary because attitudes to fertility rarely change rapidly and because, even after fertility starts declining, past increases in population impart a momentum of growth as people reach child-bearing age. However a nation proceeds towards the goals of sustainable development and lower fertility levels, the two are intimately linked and mutually reinforcing. 33. Measures to influence population size cannot be effective in isolation from other environment/development issues. The number, density, movement, and growth rate of a population cannot be influenced in the short run if these efforts are being overwhelmed by adverse patterns of development in other areas. Population policies must have a broader focus than controlling numbers: Measures to improve the quality of human resources in terms of health, education, and social development are as important. 34. A first step may be for governments to abandon the false division between 'productive' or 'economic' expenditures and 'social' expenditures. Policymakers must realize that spending on population activities and on other efforts to raise human potential is crucial to a nation's economic and productive activities and to achieving sustainable human progress - the end for which a government exists. 1. Managing Population Growth 35. Progress in population policies is uneven. Some countries with serious population problems have comprehensive policies. Some go no further than the promotion of family planning. Some do not do even that. 36. A population policy should set out and pursue broad national demographic goals in relation to other socio-economic objectives. Social and cultural factors dominate all others in affecting fertility. The most important of these is the roles women play in the family, the economy, and the society at large Fertility rates fall as women's employment opportunities outside the home and farm, their access to education, and their age at marriage all rise. Hence policies meant to lower fertility rates not only must include economic incentives and disincentives, but must aim to improve the position of women in society. Such policies should essentially promote women's rights. Table 4-4
  • 90. Male and Female Enrolment Ratios, by Region, 1960 and 1982 Male Female Region 1960 1982 1960 1982 World First Level 92.2 101.3 7.1 87.3 Second Level 31.3 53.3 23.1 42.5 Africa First Level 56.2 89.2 32.0 72.1 Second Level 7.3 29.6 2.9 19.5 Latin America and Caribbean First Level 75.0 106.2 71.2 103.3 Second Level 14.9 46.6 13.6 48.5 North America First Level 117.4 119.7 116.4 119.9 Second Level 69.4 85.4 71.4 86.6 Asia First Level 94.9 100.1 63.1 79.9 Second Level 29.3 49.3 16.6 32.9 Europe and USSR First Level 103.4 105.4 102.7 104.5 Second Level 46.5 76.2 44.6 81.3 Oceania First Level 102.2 102.9 100.7 98.9 Second Level 53.8 71.1 58.8 72.0 Note; The figures are percentages of appropriate groups receiving a given level of education. As many older children are in primary school percentages can be over 100. Source: WCED, based on data in UNESCO, 'A Summary Statistical Review of Education in the World, 1960-1982, Paris, July 1984. 37. Poverty breeds high rates of population growth: Families poor in income, employment, and social security need children first to work and later to sustain elderly parents. Measures to provide an adequate livelihood for poor households, to establish and enforce minimum-age child labour laws, and to provide publicly financed social security will all lower fertility rates.
  • 91. Improved public health and child nutrition programmes that bring down infant mortality rates - so parents do not need 'extra' children as insurance against child death - can also help to reduce fertility levels. The environment is the business of everybody, development is the business of everybody, life and living is the business of everybody. I think the solution will be found in encouraging mass environmental literacy so that there can be democratic and literate decisions, because if decisions are taken by a few without the incorporation of the opinion of the masses, the NGOs especially included, the likelihood is that the situations will not succeed. They will be imposed from above, the people will not respond positively to them, and the project is lost before it is launched. Joseph Ouma Dean of School of Environmental Studies, Moi University WCED Public Hearing Nairobi, 23 Sept 1986 38. All these programmes are effective in bringing down birth rates only when their benefits are shared by the majority. Societies that attempt to spread the benefits of economic growth to a wider segment of the population may do better at lowering birth rates than societies with both faster and higher levels of economic growth but a less even sharing of the benefits of that growth. 39. Thus developing-country population strategies must deal not only with the population variable as such but also with the underlying social and economic conditions of underdevelopment. They must be multifaceted campaigns: to strengthen social, cultural, and economic motivations for couples to have small families and. through family planning programmes, to provide to all who want them the education, technological means, and services required to control family size. 40. Family planning services in many developing countries suffer by being isolated from other programmes that reduce fertility and even from those that increase motivation to use such services. They remain separate both in design and implementation from such fertility-related programmes as nutrition, public health, mother and child care, and preschool education that take place in the same area and that are often funded by the same agency. 41. Such services must therefore be integrated with other efforts to improve access to health care and education. The clinical support needed for most modern contraceptive methods makes family planning services heavily dependent on the health system. Some governments have successfully combined population programme: with health, education, and rural development projects, and implemented them as part of major socio-economic programmes in villages or regions. This integration increases motivation, improves access, and raises the effectiveness of investments in family planning. 42. Only about 1.5 per cent of official development aid now goes for population assistance./13 Regrettably, some donor countries have cut back on their assistance for multilateral population programmes and so weakened them; this must be reversed. 43. Zimbabwe is one nation that has successfully integrated its family planning efforts not only with its rural health services but also with efforts to improve women's abilities to organize
  • 92. group activities and earn money through their own labour. The government's initial efforts were aimed less at limiting population growth than at assisting women to space births in the interests of mother and child health and at helping infertile women to bear children. But gradually families have begun to use the contraceptives made available for child spacing as a way to limit fertility. Zimbabwe now leads sub-Saharan Africa in the use of modern contraceptive methods./14 2. Managing Distribution and Mobility 44. Population distribution across a country's different regions is influenced by the geographical spread of economic activity and opportunity. Most countries are committed in theory to balancing regional development, but are rarely able to do this in practice. Governments able to spread employment opportunities throughout their nations and especially through their countrysides will thus limit the rapid and often uncontrolled growth of one or two cities. China's effort to support village-level industries in the countryside is perhaps the most ambitious of this sort of national programme. 45. Migration from countryside to city is not in itself a bad thing; it is part of the process of economic development and diversification. The issue is not so much the overall rural urban shift but the distribution of urban growth between large metropolitan cities and smaller urban settlements. (See Chapter 9.) 46. A commitment to rural development implies more attention to realizing the development potential of all regions, particularly those that are ecologically disadvantaged (See Chapter 6.) This would help reduce migration from these areas due to lack of opportunities. But governments should avoid going too far in the opposite direction, encouraging people to cove into sparsely populated areas such as tropical moist forests, where the land may not be able to provide sustainable livelihoods. Demographic phenomena constitute the heart of the African Development problematique. They are the data that lead most analysts to project a continuing and deepening crisis in Africa. There is no doubt of the imperative and urgent need for a far reaching population policy to be adopted and vigorously implemented by African governments. One issue of relevance that requires further research is the use of the tax system as a means for controlling population growth and discouraging rural-urban migration. To slow down population growth, should families without children be given a tax incentive or tax break? Should a tax penalty be imposed for each child after a fixed number of children, considering that the tax system has not solved the population migration problem? Adebayo Adedeji Executive Director, Economic Commission for Africa WCED Public Hearing Harare, 18 Sept 1986 3. From Liability to Asset
  • 93. 47. When a population exceeds the carrying capacity of the available resources, it can become a liability in efforts to improve people's welfare. But talking of population just as numbers glosses over an important point: People are also a creative resource, and this creativity is an asset societies must tap. To nurture and enhance that asset, people's physical well-being must be improved through better nutrition, health care, and so on. And education must be provided to help them become more capable and creative, skilful, productive, and better able to deal with day-to-day problems. All this has to be achieved through access to and participation in the processes of sustainable development. 3.1 Improving Health We in Asia, I feel, want to have an equilibrium between the spiritual and material life. I noticed that you have tried to separate religion from the technological side of life. Is that not exactly, the mistake in the West in developing technology, without ethics, without religion? If that is the case, and we have the chance to develop a new direction, should we not advise the group on technology to pursue a different kind of technology which has as its base not only the rationality, but also the spiritual aspect? Is this a dream or is this something we cannot avoid? Speaker from the floor WCED Public Hearing Jakarta, 26 March 1985 48. Good health is the foundation of human welfare and productivity. Hence a broad-based health policy is essential for sustainable development. In the developing world, the critical problems of ill health are closely related to environmental conditions and development problems. 49. Malaria is the most important parasitic disease in the tropics, and its prevalence is closely related to wastewater disposal and drainage. Large dams and irrigation systems have led to sharp increases in the incidence of schistosomiasis (snail fever) in many areas. Inadequacies in water supply and sanitation are direct causes of other widespread and debilitating diseases such as diarrhoeas and various worm infestations. 50. Though much has been achieved in recent years, 1.7 billion people lack access to clean water, and 1.2 billion to adequate sanitation./15 Many diseases can be controlled not just through therapeutic interventions but also through improvements in rural water supply, sanitation, and health education. In this sense, they really require a developmental solution. In the developing world, the number of water taps nearby is a better indication of the health of a community than is the number of hospital beds. 51. Other examples of links between development, environmental conditions, and health include air pollution and the respiratory illnesses it brings, the impact of housing conditions on the spread of tuberculosis, the effects of carcinogens and toxic substances, and the exposure to hazards in the workplace and elsewhere. 52. Many health problems arise from the nutritional deficiencies that occur in virtually all developing countries, but most acutely in low-income areas. Most malnutrition is related to a shortage of calories or protein or both, but some diets also lack specific elements and compounds, such as iron and iodine. Health will be greatly improved in low-income areas by
  • 94. policies that lead to the production of more of the cheap foods the poor traditionally eat - coarse grains and root crops. 53. These health, nutrition, environment, and development links imply that health policy cannot be conceived of purely in terms of curative or preventive medicine, or even in terms of greater attention to public health. Integrated approaches are needed that reflect key health objectives in areas such as food production; water supply and sanitation: industrial policy, particularly with regard to safety and pollution; and the planning of human settlements. Beyond this, it is necessary to identify vulnerable groups and their health risks and to ensure that the socio-economic factors that underlie these risks are taken into account in other areas of development policy. 54. Hence. WHO's 'Health for All' strategy should be broadened far beyond the provision of medical workers and clinics, to cover health-related interventions in all development activities./16 Moreover, this broader approach must be reflected in institutional arrangements to coordinate all such activities effectively. 55. Within the narrower area of health care, providing primary health care facilities and making sure that everyone has the opportunity to use them are appropriate starting points. Maternal and child health care are also particularly important. The critical elements here are relatively inexpensive and can have a profound impact on health and well-being. An organized system of trained birth attendants, protection against tetanus and other childbirth infections, and supplemental feeding can dramatically reduce maternal mortality. Similarly, low-cost programmes to assure immunization, teach and supply oral dehydration therapy against diarrhoeas, and encourage breast-feeding (which in turn can reduce fertility) can increase child survival rates dramatically. 56. Health care must be supplemented by effective health education. Some parts of the Third World may soon face growing numbers of the illnesses associated with life-styles in industrial nations - cancer and heart disease especially. Few developing nations can afford the expensive treatment required for the latter diseases, and should begin efforts now to educate their citizens on the dangers of smoking and of high-fat diets. 57. A rapid spread of acquired immune deficiency syndrome (AIDS) in both developed and developing nations could drastically alter all countries' health priorities. AIDS is threatening to kill millions of people and disrupt the economies of many countries. Governments should overcome any lingering shyness and rapidly educate their people about this syndrome and about the ways in which it is spread. International cooperation on research and the handling of the disease is essential. 58. Another major health problem with international ramifications is the increase in drug addiction. It is a problem closely linked to organized crime in the production of drugs, in large-scale international traffic in these drugs, and in the networks for distribution. It distorts the economy in many poor producing areas and destroys people the world over. International cooperation is essential in tackling this scourge. Some countries have to deploy considerable financial resources to halt the production and traffic in narcotics and to promote crop diversification and rehabilitation schemes in the producing areas, which are generally impoverished. To sustain their efforts, greater international assistance is essential 59. Most medical research focuses on pharmaceuticals, vaccines. and other technological interventions for disease management. Much of this research is directed at the diseases of industrialized countries, as their treatment accounts for a substantial part of the sales of pharmaceutical companies. More research is urgently needed on the environmentally related
  • 95. tropical diseases that are the major health problem in the Third World, This research should focus not merely on new medicines, but also on public health measures to control these diseases. Existing arrangements for international collaboration on tropical disease research should be greatly strengthened. Education and communication are vitally important in order to impress each individual of his or her responsibility regarding the healthy future of the earth. The best way for students to recognize that their action can make a difference is to have projects organized by the school or community on which the students can work. Once convinced that they can help, people tend to change both their attitude and their behaviour. New attitudes towards the environment will be reflected in decisions at home and in corporate boardrooms around the world. Bernice Goldsmith Student, North Toronto Collegiate WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 3.2 Broadening Education 60. Human resource development demands knowledge and skills to help people improve their economic performance. Sustainable development requires changes in values and attitudes towards environment and development - indeed, towards society and work at home, on farms, and in factories. The world's religions could help provide direction and motivation in forming new values that would stress individual and joint responsibility towards the environment and towards nurturing harmony between humanity and environment. 61. Education should also be geared towards making people more capable of dealing with problems of overcrowding and excessive population densities, and better able to improve what could be called 'social carrying capacities'. This is essential to prevent ruptures in the social fabric, and schooling should enhance the levels of tolerance and empathy required for living in a crowded world. Improved health, lower fertility, and better nutrition will depend on greater literacy and social and civic responsibility. Education can induce all these, and can enhance a society's ability to overcome poverty, increase incomes, improve health and nutrition, and reduce family size. 62. The investment in education and the growth in school enrolment during the past few decades are signs of progress. Access to education is increasing and will continue to do so. Today almost all the world's boys are getting some form of primary education. In Asia and Africa, however, enrolment rates for girls are much lower than for boys at all levels. A large gap also exists between developed and developing countries in enrolment rates beyond primary schools, as Table 4-4 indicated. 63. UN projections of enrolment rates for the year 2000 suggest a continuation of these trends. Thus despite the growth in primary education, illiteracy will continue to rise in terms of sheer numbers: there will be more than 900 million people unable to read and write at the end of the century. By then, girls' enrolment rates are still expected to be below the current rates for boys in Asia. As for secondary education, developing countries are not expected to attain even the 1960 industrial country levels by the year 2000./17
  • 96. 64. Sustainable development requires that these trends be corrected. The main task of education policy must be to make literacy universal and to close the gaps between male and female enrolment rates. Realizing these goals would improve individual productivity and earnings, as well as personal attitudes to health, nutrition, and child-bearing. It can also instill a greater awareness of everyday environmental factors. Facilities for education beyond primary school must be expanded to improve skills necessary for pursuing sustainable development. 65. A major problem confronting many countries is the widespread unemployment and the unrest that it leads to. Education has often been unable to provide the skills needed for appropriate employment. This is evident in the large numbers of unemployed people who have been trained for white-collar employment in swelling urban populations. Education and training should also be directed towards the acquisition of practical and vocational skills, and particularly towards making people more self-reliant. All this should be supported by efforts to nurture the informal sector and the participation of community organizations. 66. Providing facilities is only the beginning. Education must be improved in quality and in relevance to local conditions. In many areas, it should be integrated with children's participation in farm work, a process requiring flexibility in the school system. It should impart knowledge relevant for the proper management of local resources. Rural schools must teach about local soils, water, and the conservation of both, about deforestation and how the community and the individual can reverse it. Teachers must be trained and the curriculum developed so that students learn about the agricultural balance sheet of an area. 67. Most people base their understanding of environmental processes and development on traditional beliefs or on information provided by a conventional education. Many thus remain ignorant about ways in which they could improve traditional production practices and better protect the natural resource base. Education should therefore provide comprehensive knowledge, encompassing and cutting across the social and natural sciences and the humanities, thus providing insights on the interaction between natural and human resources, between development and environment. 68. Environmental education should be included in and should run throughout the other disciplines of the formal education curriculum at all levels - to foster a sense of responsibility for the state of the environment and to teach students how to monitor, protect, and improve it. These objectives cannot be achieved without the involvement of students in the movement for a better environment, through such things as nature clubs and special interest groups. Adult education, on-the-job training, television, and other less formal methods must be used to reach out to as wide a group of individuals as possible, as environmental issues and knowledge systems now change radically in the space of a lifetime. 69. A critical point of intervention is during teacher training. The attitudes of teachers will be key in increasing understanding of the environment and its. links with development. To enhance the awareness and capabilities of teachers in this area, multilateral and bilateral agencies must provide support for the relevant curriculum development in teacher training institutions, for the preparation of teaching aids, and for other similar activities. Global awareness could be fostered by encouraging contacts among teachers from different countries, for instance in specialized centres set up for this purpose. I am here as the son of a small nation, the Krenak Indian Nation. We live in the valley of the Rio Doce. which is the frontier of Espirito Santo with the State of Minas Gerais. We are a micro-country - a micro-nation.
  • 97. When the government took our land in the valley of Rio Doce, they wanted to give us another place somewhere else. But the State, the government will never understand that we do not have another place to go. The only possible place for the Krenak people to live and to re-establish our existence, to speak to our Gods, to speak to our nature, to weave our lives is where our God created us. It is useless for the government to put us in a very beautiful place, in a very good place with a lot of hunting and a lot of fish. The Krenak people, we continue dying and we die insisting that there is only one place for us to live. My heart does not become happy to see humanity's incapacity. I have no pleasure at all to come here and make these statements. We can no longer see the planet that we live upon as if it were a chess-board where people just move things around. We cannot consider the planet as something isolated from the cosmic. We are not idiots to believe that there is possibility of life for us outside of where the origin of our life is. Respect our place of living, do not degrade our living condition, respect this life. We have no arms to cause pressure, the only thing we have is the right to cry for our dignity and the need to live in our land. Ailton Krenak Coordinator of Indian Nations Union WCED Public Hearing Sao Paulo. 28-29 Oct 1985 3.3 Empowering Vulnerable Groups 70. The processes of development generally lead to the gradual integration of local communities into a larger social and economic framework. But some communities - so-called indigenous or tribal peoples - remain isolated because of such factors as physical barriers to communication or marked differences in social and cultural practices. Such groups are found in North America, in Australia, in the Amazon Basin, in Central America, in the forests and hills of Asia, in the deserts of North Africa, and elsewhere. 71. The isolation of many such people has meant the preservation of a traditional way of life in close harmony with the natural environment. Their very survival has depended on their ecological awareness and adaptation. But their isolation has also meant that few of them have shared in national economic and social development; this may be reflected in their poor health, nutrition, and education. 72. With the gradual advance of organized development into remote regions, these groups are becoming less isolated. Many live in areas rich in valuable natural resources that planners and 'developers' want to exploit, and this exploitation disrupts the local environment so as to endanger traditional ways of life. The legal and institutional changes that accompany organized development add to such pressures. 73. Growing interaction with the larger world is increasing the vulnerability of these groups, since they are often left out of the processes of economic development. Social discrimination, cultural barriers, and the exclusion of these people from national political processes makes these groups vulnerable and subject to exploitation. Many groups become dispossessed and
  • 98. marginalized, and their traditional practices disappear. They become the victims of what could be described as cultural extinction. 74. These communities are the repositories of vast accumulations of traditional knowledge and experience that links humanity with its ancient origins. Their disappearance is a loss for the larger society, which could learn a great deal from their traditional skills in sustainably managing very complex ecological systems. It is a terrible irony that as formal development reaches more deeply into rain forests, deserts, and other isolated environments, it tends to destroy the only cultures that have proved able to thrive in these environments. 75. The starting point for a just and humane policy for such groups is the recognition and protection of their traditional rights to land and the other resources that sustain their way of life - rights they may define in terms that do not fit into standard legal systems. These groups' own institutions to regulate rights and obligations are crucial for maintaining the harmony with nature and the environmental awareness characteristic of the traditional way of life. Hence the recognition of traditional rights must go hand in hand with measures to protect the local institutions that enforce responsibility in resource use. And this recognition must also give local communities a decisive voice in the decisions about resource use in their area. 76. Protection of traditional rights should be accompanied by positive measures to enhance the well-being of the community in ways appropriate to the group's life-style. For example, earnings from traditional activities can be increased through the introduction of marketing arrangements that ensure a fair price for produce, but also through steps to conserve and enhance the resource base and increase resource productivity. 77. Those promoting policies that have an impact on the lives of an isolated, traditional people must tread a fine line between keeping them in artificial, perhaps unwanted isolation and wantonly destroying their life-styles. Hence broader measures of human resource development are essential. Health facilities must be provided to supplement and improve traditional practices; nutritional deficiencies have to be corrected, and educational institutions established. These steps should precede new projects that open up an area to economic development. Special efforts should also be made to ensure that the local community can derive the full benefit of such projects, particularly through jobs. 78. In terms of sheer numbers, these isolated, vulnerable groups are small. But their marginalization is a symptom of a style of development that tends to neglect both human and environmental considerations. Hence a more careful and sensitive consideration of their interests is a touchstone of a sustainable development policy. Footnotes 1/ Department of International Economic and Social Affairs (DIESA). World Population Prospects; Estimates and Projections as Assessed in 1984 (New York: United Nations, 1986). 2/ Ibid. 3/ Based on data from UNCTAD, Handbook of International Trade and Development Statistics 1985 Supplement (New York: 1985). 4/ World Bank, World Development Report 1984 (New York: Oxford University Press, 1984).
  • 99. 5/ Ibid. 6/ DIESA. op. cit. 7/ UN. Population Bulletin of the United Nations. No. 14. 1982 (New York: 1983). 8/ C. Clark, Population Growth and Land Use (New York: St. Martin's Press. 1957). 9/ World Bank. op. cit. 10/ Ibid. 11/ DIESA, op. cit. 12/ WHO, Intersectoral Linkages and Health Development, Case Studies in India (Kerala State), Jamaica. Norway. Sri Lanka and Thailand (Geneva: 1984). 13/ World Bank, op. cit. 14/ L. Timberlake. Only One Earth: Living for the Future (London: BBC/Earthscan. 1987). 15/ UNEP, The State of the Environment: Environment and Health (Nairobi: 1986). 16/ WHO. Global Strategy for Health for All by the Year 2000 (Geneva: 1981). 17/ UNESCO. A Summary Statistical Review of Education in the World. 1960-82 (Paris: 1984).
  • 100. Our Common Future, Chapter 5: Food Security: Sustaining The Potential I. Achievements II. Signs of Crisis 1. Impact of Subsidies 2. Neglect of the Small Producer 3. Degradation of the Resource Base 3.1 Loss of Soil Resources 3.2 Impact of Chemicals 3.3 Pressure on Forests 3.4 Advancing Deserts III. The Challenge IV. Strategies for Sustainable Food Security 1. Government Intervention 2. A Global Perspective 3. The Resource Base 3.1 Land Use 3.2 Water Management 3.3 Alternatives to Chemicals 3.4 Forestry and Agriculture 3.5 Aquaculture 4. Productivity and yields 4.1 The Technological Base 4.2 Human Resources 4.3 Productivity of Inputs 5. Equity 5.1 Land Reforms 5.2 Subsistence Farmers and Pastoralists 5.3 Integrated Rural Development 5.4 Food Availability Fluctuations V. Food for the Future Footnotes Chapter 5 Food Security: Sustaining The Potential 1. The world produces more food per head of population today than ever before in human history. In 1985, it produced nearly 500 kilogrammes per head of cereals and root crops, the primary sources of food./1 Yet amid this abundance, more than 730 million people did not eat enough to lead fully productive working lives./2 There are places where too little is grown;
  • 101. there are places where large numbers cannot afford to buy food. And there are broad areas of the Earth, in both industrial and developing nations, where increases in food production are undermining the base for future production. 2. The agricultural resources and the technology needed to feed growing populations are available. Much has been achieved over the past few decades. Agriculture does not lack resources; it lacks policies to ensure that the food is produced where it is needed and in a manner that sustains the livelihoods of the rural poor. He can meet this challenge by building on our achievements and devising new strategies for sustaining food and livelihood security. I. Achievements 3. Between 1950 and 1985, cereal production outstripped population growth, increasing from around 700 million tons to over 1,800 million tons, an annual growth rate of around 2.7 per cent./3 This increase helped to meet escalating demands for cereals caused by population growth and rising incomes in developing countries and by growing needs for animal feed in developed countries. Yet regional differences in performance have been large. (See Table 5-1.) 4. As production has increased sharply in some regions and demand in others, the pattern of world trade in foods, especially cereals, has changed radically. North America exported barely 5 million tons of foodgrains yearly before the Second World War; it exported nearly 120 million tons during the 1980s. Europe's grain deficit is very much lower now. and the bulk of North American exports are to the USSR. Asia, and Africa. Three countries - China, Japan, and the USSR - took half the world exports in the early 1980s; much of the rest went to relatively wealthy developing countries, such as Middle Eastern oil exporters. Several poor agricultural countries, especially in sub-Saharan Africa, have become net importers of foodgrains. Still, although one-fourth of sub-Saharan Africa's population relied on imported grains in 1984, that region's imports have accounted for less than 10 per cent of world grain trade thus far in the 1980s./4 Table 5-1 Two Decades of Agricultural Development Per Capita Food Production (Index 1961-64 = 100) Per Capita Gross Cropped Area (Hectares) Per Hectare Fertilizer use (kg.) 1961-64 1981-84 1964 1984 1964 1984 World 100 112 0.44 0.31 29.3 85.3 North America 100 121 1.05 0.90 47.3 93.2 Western Europe 100 131 0.11 0.25 114.4 124.1 Eastern Europe and USSR 100 128 0.84 0.71 30.4 122.1 Africa 100 88 0.74 0.35 1.8 9.7 Near East* 100 107 0.53 0.35 6.9 53.6
  • 102. Far East** 100 116 0.10 0.20 4.4 45.4 Latin America 100 108 0.49 0.45 11.6 11.4 CPE's of Asia*** 100 135 0.17 0.10 15.5 170.3 * An FAO grouping that includes West Asia plus Egypt, Libya and Sudan ** An FAO grouping that covers South and South-East Asia excluding the centrally planned economies of Asia. *** An FAO grouping of Centrally Planned Economies of Asia which covers China, Kampuchea, North Korea. Mongolia and Vietnam. 5. Other foods besides grains are changing the patterns of world food demand and production. Demand for milk and meat is growing as incomes rise in societies that prefer animal protein. and much agricultural development in the industrialized nations has been devoted to meeting these demands. In Europe, meat production more than tripled between 1950 and 1984, and milk production nearly doubled./5 Meat production for exports increased sharply, particularly in the rangelands of Latin America and Africa. World meat exports have risen from around 2 million tons in 1950-52 to over 11 million tons in 1984./6 6. To produce this milk and meat required in 1984 about 1.4 billion cattle and buffaloes, 1.6 billion sheep and goats, 800 million pigs, and a great deal of poultry - all of which weigh more than the people on the planet./7 Most of these animals graze or browse or are fed local plants collected for them. However, rising demands for livestock feedgrains led to sharp increases in the production of cereals such as corn, which accounted for nearly two-thirds of the total increase in grain production in North America and Europe between 1950 and 1985. 7. This unprecedented growth in food production has been achieved partly by an extension of the production base: larger cropped areas, more livestock, more fishing vessels, and so on. But most of it is due to a phenomenal rise in productivity. Population increases have meant a decline in the area of cropped land in most of the world in per capita terms. And as the availability of arable land has declined, planners and farmers have focused on increasing productivity. In the past 35 years this has been achieved by: using new seed varieties designed to maximize yields, facilitate multiple cropping, and resist disease; applying more chemical fertilizers, the consumption of which rose more than ninefold/8; using more pesticides and similar chemicals, the use of which increased thirty-two- fold/9; and increasing irrigated area, which more than doubled./10 8. Global statistics mask substantial regional differences. (See Box 5-1.) The impacts of new technology have been uneven, and in some respects the agricultural technology gap has widened. For instance, average African foodgrain productivity declined in relation to European productivity from roughly one-half to about one-fifth over the past 35 years. Even in Asia, where new technology has spread rapidly, productivity in relation to European levels dropped./11 Similar 'technology gaps' have emerged between regions within countries. 9. The past few decades have seen the emergence of three broad types of food production systems, 'Industrial agriculture', capital- and input-intensive and usually large-scale, is dominant in North America, Western and Eastern Europe, Australia and New Zealand, and in
  • 103. some small areas in developing countries. 'Green Revolution agriculture' is found in uniform, resource-rich, often flat and irrigated areas in the agricultural heartlands of some developing countries. It is more widespread in Asia but is also found in parts of Latin America and North Africa. Though initially the new technologies may have favoured large farmers, they are today accessible to a growing number of small producers. 'Resource-poor agriculture' relies on uncertain rain rather than irrigation and is usually found in developing regions difficult to farm - drylands, highlands, and forests - with fragile soils. This includes most of sub-Saharan Africa and the remoter areas of Asia and Latin America. Here, per capita production has been declining and hunger is a critical problem. But today, all three systems of food production display signs of crises that endanger their growth. II. Signs of Crisis 10. Agricultural policies in practically all countries have focused on output growth. Despite this, it has proved far more difficult to raise world agricultural output by a consistent 3 per cent a year in the mid-1980s than it was in the mid-1950s. Moreover, production records have been offset by the appearance Box 5-1 Regional Perspectives on Agricultural Development Africa a drop in per capita food output of about 1 per cent a year since the beginning of the 1970s a focus on cash crops and a growing dependence on imported food, fostered by pricing policies and foreign exchange compulsions major gaps in infrastructure for research, extension, input supply, and marketing degradation of the agricultural resource base due to desertification, droughts, and other processes large untapped potential of arable land, irrigation, and fertilizer use West Asia and North Africa improvements in productivity due to better irrigation, the cultivation of high-yielding varieties, and higher fertilizer use limited arable land and considerable amounts of desert, making food self-sufficiency a challenge a need for controlled irrigation to cope with dry conditions South and East Asia increased production and productivity, with some countries registering grain surpluses rapid growth in fertilizer use in some countries and extensive development of irrigation government commitments to be self-reliant in food, leading to national research centres, development of high-yielding seeds, and the fostering of location-specific technologies little unused land, and extensive, unabated deforestation growing numbers of rural landless
  • 104. Latin America declining food imports since 1980, as food production kept pace with population growth over the last decade government support in the form of research centres to develop high-yielding seeds and other technologies inequitable distribution of land deforestation and degradation of the agricultural resource base, fueled partly by foreign trade and debt crisis a huge land resource and high productivity potential, though most of the potentially arable land is in the remote, lightly populated Amazon Basin, where perhaps only 20 per cent of the land is suitable for sustainable agriculture North America and Western Europe North America the world's leading source of surplus foodgrain, though the rate of increase in output per hectare and in total productivity slowed in the 1970s subsidies for production that are ecologically and economically expensive depressing effect of surpluses on world markets and consequent impact on developing countries a resource base increasingly degraded through erosion, acidification, and water contamination in North America, some scope for future agricultural expansion in frontier areas that can be intensively farmed only at high cost Eastern Europe and the Soviet Union food deficits met through imports, with the Soviet Union being the world's largest grain importer increased government investment in agriculture accompanied by eased farm distribution and organization to meet desires for food self-reliance, leading to production increases in meat and root crops pressures on agricultural resources through soil erosion. acidification, salinization, alkalization, and water contamination of linked economic and ecological crises: Industrialized countries are finding it increasingly difficult to manage their surplus food production, the livelihood base of millions of poor producers in developing countries is deteriorating, and the resource base for agriculture is under pressure virtually everywhere. 1. Impact of Subsidies 11. The food surpluses in North America and Europe result mainly from subsidies and other incentives that stimulate production even in the absence of demand. Direct or indirect subsidies, which now cover virtually the entire food cycle, have become extremely expensive. In the United States, the cost of farm support has grown from $2.7 billion in 1980 to $25.8 billion in 1986. In the EEC, such costs have risen from $6.2 billion in 1976 to $21.5 billion in 1986./12 12. It has become politically more attractive, and usually cheaper, to export surpluses - often as food aid - rather than to store them. These heavily subsidized surpluses depress the international market prices of commodities such as sugar and have created severe problems for several developing countries whose economies are based on agriculture. Non-emergency food
  • 105. aid and low-priced imports also keep down prices received by Third World farmers and reduce the incentive to improve domestic food production. 13. The environmental consequences of a heavily subsidized production system are becoming evident within industrialized nations/13; lower productivity as soil quality declines due to intensive soil cultivation and overuse of chemical fertilizers and pesticides/14; the destruction of the countryside, through clearing of hedgerows, park: belts, and other protective cover and the levelling, occupation, and cultivation of marginal land and watershed protection areas; and nitrate pollution of ground-water aquifers due to the often subsidized overuse of nitrate fertilizers, 14. The financial, economic, and environmental effects of the current incentive systems are beginning to be questioned by many governments and groups, including farm organizations. A particular area of concern is the impact of these policies on developing countries. They depress international prices of products, such as rice and sugar, that are important exports for many developing countries and so reduce exchange earnings of developing countries. They increase the instability of world prices. And they discourage the processing of agricultural commodities in the producing countries./15 15. It is in the interests of all, including the farmers, that the policies be changed. Indeed, in recent years some conservation-oriented changes have taken place and some subsidy systems have increasingly stressed the need to retire land from production. The financial and economic burden of subsidies must be reduced. The harm that these policies do to the agriculture of developing countries by disrupting world markets must be eliminated. 2. Neglect of the Small Producer 16. The new technology behind increases in agricultural productivity requires scientific and technological skills, a system for technology extension and other services for farmers, and commercial orientation in farm management. In many' parts of Asia, in particular, small farmers have shown a remarkable capacity to use new technology once they are given incentives and adequate financial and infrastructural support. Small cash-crop farmers in Africa have demonstrated the potential of the smallholder on that continent, and in the last few years successes have been recorded in food crops also. But ecologically disadvantaged areas and land-poor rural masses have not benefited from advances in technology and will not until governments are willing and able to redistribute land and resources, and give them the necessary support and incentives. 17. Agricultural support systems seldom take into account the special circumstances of subsistence farmers and herders. subsistence farmers cannot afford the high cash outlay of modern inputs. Many are shifting cultivators who do not have a clear title to the land they use. They may plant a variety of crops on one plot to meet their own needs, and are thus unable to use methods developed for large stands of a single crop. 18. Many herders are nomadic and difficult to reach with education, advice, and equipment. They, like subsistence farmers, depend on certain traditional rights, which are threatened by commercial developments. They herd traditional breeds, which are hardy but rarely highly productive. 19. Women farmers, though they play a critical role in food production, are often ignored by
  • 106. programmes meant to improve production. In Latin America, the Caribbean, and Asia they form a large agricultural labour force, while most of sub-Saharan Africa's food is grown by women. Yet almost all agricultural programmes tend to neglect the special needs of women farmers. I think that at a forum like this there always tends to be someone standing up and saying you forgot my issue. I think my serious sensitivity to women!s role vis-a-vis the environment. Especially in Africa, I think it has been clearly stated over and again that women are responsible for between 60 to 90 per cent of the food production, processing, and marketing. No one can really address the food crisis in Africa or many of the other crises that seem to exist here without addressing the question of women, and really seeing that women are participants in decision-making processes at the very basic all the way through up the highest level. Mrs. King The Greenbelt Movement WCED Public Hearing Nairobi. 23 Sept 1986 3. Degradation of the Resource Base 20. Short-sighted policies are leading to degradation of the agricultural resource base on almost every continent: soil erosion in North America: soil acidification in Europe; deforestation and desertification in Asia. Africa, and Latin America; and waste and pollution of water almost everywhere. Within 40-70 years, global warming may cause the flooding of important coastal production areas. Some of these effects arise from trends in energy use and industrial production. Some arise from the pressure of population on limited resources. But agricultural policies emphasizing increased production at the expense of environmental considerations have also contributed greatly to this deterioration. 3.1 Loss of Soil Resources 21. Increases in cropped areas in recent decades have often extended cultivation in marginal lands prone to erosion. By the late 1970s, soil erosion exceeded soil formation on about a third of U.S. cropland, much of it in the midwestern agricultural heartland./16 In Canada, soil degradation has been costing farmers $1 billion a year./17 In the USSR, the extension of cultivation to the so-called Virgin Lands was a major plank of agricultural policy, but now it is believed that much of this land is marginal./18 In India, soil erosion affects 25-30 per cent of the total land under cultivation./19 Without conservation measures, the total area of rainfed cropland in developing countries in Asia, Africa, and Latin America would shrink by 544 million hectares over the long term because of soil erosion and degradation, according to an FAO study./20 22. Erosion makes soil less able to retain water, depletes it of nutrients, and reduces the depth available for the roots to take hold. Land productivity declines. Eroded topsoil is carried to rivers. lakes, and reservoirs, silts up ports and waterways, reduces reservoir storage capacity, and increases the incidence and severity of floods.
  • 107. 23. Poorly designed and implemented irrigation systems have caused waterlogging, salinization, and alkalization of soils. FAO and UNESCO estimate that as much as half the world's irrigation schemes suffer in some degree from these problems./21 These estimates indicate that some 10 million hectares of irrigated land are being abandoned each year. 24. Soil degradation erodes the overall resource base for agriculture. The loss of croplands encourages farmers to overuse the remaining land and to move into forests and onto rangelands. Sustainable agriculture cannot be based on methods that mine and deplete the soil, 3.2 Impact of Chemicals 25. Chemical fertilizers and pesticides have played a large role in production increases since the Second World War, but clear warnings have been raised against over-reliance on them. The run-off of nitrogen and phosphates from excess use of fertilizers damages water resources, and such damage is spreading. 26. Using chemicals to control insects, pests, weeds, and fungi enhances productivity, but overuse threatens the health of humans and the lives of other species. Continuing, long-term exposure to pesticide and chemical residues in food, water, and even in the air is hazardous, particularly to children. A 1983 study estimated that approximately 10.000 people died each year in developing countries from pesticide poisoning and about 400,000 suffered acutely./22 The effects are not limited to the area where pesticides are used but travel through the food chain. 27. Commercial fisheries have been depleted, bird species endangered, and insects that prey on pests wiped out. The number of pesticide-resistant insect pest species worldwide has increased and many resist even the newest chemicals. The variety and severity of pest infestations multiply, threatening the productivity of agriculture in the areas concerned. 28, The use of agricultural chemicals is not in itself harmful. In fact, the level of use is still quite low in many regions. In these areas, response rates are high and the environmental consequences of residues are not yet a problem. Hence these regions would benefit by using more agrochemicals. However, the growth in the use of chemicals tends to be concentrated precisely where they may be doing more overall harm than good. 3.3 Pressure on Forests 29. Forests are crucial for maintaining and improving the productivity of agricultural land. Yet agricultural expansion, a growing world timber trade, and woodfuel demand have destroyed much forest cover. Although this destruction has occurred worldwide, today the greatest challenge is in developing countries, particularly in tropical forests. (See Chapter 6.) 30. Growing populations and the decreasing availability of arable land lead poor farmers in these countries to seek new land in forests to grow more food. Some government policies encourage the conversion of forests to pastures and others encourage large resettlement schemes in forests. There is nothing inherently wrong with clearing forests for farming, provided that the land is the best there is for new farming, can support the numbers encouraged to settle upon it, and is not already serving a more useful function, such as watershed protection. But often forests are cleared without forethought or planning.
  • 108. 31. Deforestation most severely disrupts mountainous areas and upland watersheds and the ecosystems that depend on them. The uplands influence precipitation, and the state of their soil and vegetation systems influence how this precipitation is released into the streams and rivers and onto the croplands of the plains below. The growing numbers and growing severity of both floods and droughts in many parts of the world have been linked to the deforestation of upland watersheds./23 3.4 Advancing Deserts 32. Some 29 per cent of the earth's land area suffers slight, moderate, or severe desertification; an additional 6 per cent is classified as extremely severely desertified./24 In 1984, the world's drylands supported some 850 million people, of whom 230 million were on lands affected by severe desertification./25 33. The process of desertification affects almost every region of the globe, but it is most destructive in the drylands of South America, Asia, and Africa; for these three areas combined. 18.5 per cent (870 million hectares) of productive lands are severely desertified. Of the drylands in developing countries. Africa's Sudano-Sahelian zones and, to a lesser extent, some countries south of this zone suffer the most. In their arid and semi-arid lands are to be found 80 per cent of the moderately affected and 85 per cent of the severely affected people./26 34. Land permanently degraded to desert-like conditions continues to grow at an annual rate of 6 million hectares./27 Each year. 21 million additional hectares provide no economic return because of the spread of desertification./28 These trends are expected to continue despite some local improvements. 35, Desertification is caused by a complex mix of climatic and human effects. The human effects, over which we have more control, include the rapid growth of both human and animal populations, detrimental land use practices (especially deforestation), adverse terms of trade, and civil strife. The cultivation of cash crops on unsuitable rangelands has forced herders and their cattle onto marginal lands. The unfavourable international terms of trade for primary products and the policies of aid donors have reinforced pressures to encourage increasing cash-crop production at any cost. 36. A Plan of Action conceived by UNEP and drawn up at the 1977 UN Conference on Desertification has led to some slight, mainly local gains./29 Progress on the plan has been hampered by lack of financial support from the international community, by inadequacies of the regional organizations established to respond to the regional nature of the problem, and by the lack of involvement of grass-roots communities. Small farmers are held responsible for environmental destruction as if they had a choice of resources to depend on for their livelihood, when they really don't. In the context of basic survival, today's needs tend to overshadow consideration for the environmental future. It is poverty that is responsible for the destruction of natural resources, not the poor. Geoffrey Bruce Canadian International Development Agency WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26/27 May 1986
  • 109. III. The Challenge 37. Food demand will increase as populations increase and their consumption patterns change. In the remaining years of this century, about 1.3 billion people will be added to the human family (see Chapter 4); rising incomes, however, may account for 30 to 40 per cent of the increased demand for food in developing countries and about 10 per cent in industrial nations./30 Thus over the next few decades, the global food system must be managed to increase food production by 3 to 4 per cent yearly. 38. Global food security depends not only on raising global production, but on reducing distortions in the structure of the world food market and on shifting the focus of food production to food-deficit countries, regions, and households. Many of the countries not growing enough food to feed themselves possess the largest remaining reservoirs of untapped agricultural resources. Latin America and sub-Saharan Africa have much unused land. although its quality and quantity vary greatly from nation to nation and much of it is ecologically vulnerable./31 The Soviet Union and parts of North America have significant amounts of frontier land suitable for agriculture; only Asia and Europe are truly land-starved. 39. Global food security also depends on ensuring that all people, even the poorest of the poor, can get food. While on the world scale this challenge requires a reappraisal of global food distribution, the task weighs more immediately and heavily on national governments. Inequitable distribution of production assets, unemployment, and underemployment are at the heart of the problem of hunger in many countries. 40. Rapid, sound agricultural development will mean not only more food but more opportunities for people to earn money to purchase food. Thus when countries with untapped agricultural resources provide food by importing more, they are effectively importing unemployment. By the same token, countries that are subsidizing food exports are increasing unemployment in food-importing countries. This marginalizes people, and marginalized people are forced to destroy the resource base to survive. Shifting production to food-deficit countries and to the resource-poor farmers within those countries is a way of securing sustainable livelihoods. 41. Conserving the agricultural resource base and livelihood security of the poor can be mutually supportive in three ways. First, secure resources and adequate livelihoods lead to good husbandry and sustainable management. Second, they ease rural-to-urban migration, stimulate agricultural production from resources that otherwise would be underused, and reduce the need for food to be produced elsewhere. Third, by combating poverty, they help to slow population growth. 42. Shifting the focus of production to food-deficit countries will also reduce pressures on agricultural resources in the industrialized market economies, enabling them to move towards more sustainable agricultural practices. Incentive structures can be changed so that instead of encouraging overproduction, they encourage farm practices that improve soil and water quality. Government budgets will be relieved of the burdens of storing and exporting surplus products. 43. This shift in agricultural production will be sustainable only if the resource base is secure. As indicated, this is far from the case today. Thus to achieve global food security, the resource base for food production must be sustained, enhanced, and, where it has been diminished or destroyed, restored.
  • 110. There are many contradictions in agricultural development. The blind imitation of models developed under different circumstances will have to give way to the realities and conditions existing in Africa. Large areas of virgin land have been opened up for export crops whose prices keeps declining. This is not in the interest of developing countries. There are so many problems to be overcome that we forget that every problem is an opportunity to do something positive. This is an opportunity for us to think of conservation and environment in a broad educational context. In doing so, we will be able to capture the next generation and demonstrate the wonder and the benefits of the world around them. Adolfo Mascarenhas IUCN Harare Office WCED Public Hearing Harare. 18 Sept 1986 IV. Strategies for Sustainable Food Security 44. Food security requires more than good conservation programmes, which can be - and usually are - overridden and undermined by inappropriate agricultural, economic, and trade policies. Nor is it just a matter of adding an environmental component to programmes. Food strategies must take into account all the policies that bear upon the threefold challenge of shifting production to where it is most needed, of securing the livelihoods of the rural poor, and of conserving resources. 1. Government Intervention 45. Government intervention in agriculture is the rule in both industrial and developing countries, and it is here to stay. Public investment in agricultural research and extension services, assisted farm credit and marketing services, and a range of other support systems have all played parts in the successes of the last half-century. In fact, the real problem in many developing countries is the weakness of these systems. 46. Intervention has taken other forms as well. Many governments regulate virtually the entire food cycle - inputs and outputs, domestic sales, exports, public procurement, storage and distribution, price controls and subsidies - as well as imposing various land use regulations: acreage, crop variety, and so on. 47. In general, patterns of government intervention suffer three basic defects. First, the criteria that underlie the planning of these interventions lack an ecological orientation and are often dominated by short-term considerations. These criteria should discourage environmentally unsound farm practices and encourage farmers to maintain and improve their soils, forests, and waters. 48. The second defect is that agricultural policy tends to operate within a national framework with uniform prices and subsidies, standardized criteria for the provision of support services, indiscriminate financing of infrastructure investments, and so forth. Policies that vary from region to region are needed to reflect different regional needs, encouraging farmers to adopt practices that are ecologically sustainable in their own areas.
  • 111. The problem in agriculture is not faceless. I as a farmer am a potential victim of the system that we now operate under. Why are approximately a quarter of Canadian farmers facing the immediate prospects of farm bankruptcy? It is directly related to the general concept of a cheap food policy that has constituted a cornerstone of federal agricultural policy since the beginning of settlement. We regard the current cheap food policy as a form of economic violence that is contributing towards soil exploitation and the growing impersonal relationship between farmers and the soil for economic survival. It is a policy of industrialization that can lead only towards disaster economically for us as farmers, and environmentally for us all as Canadians and as world citizens. Wayne Easter President, National Farmers' Union WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26/27 May 1986 49. The importance of regional policy differentiation can be easily illustrated: Hill areas may require incentive prices for fruits and subsidized supplies of foodgrains to induce farmers to shift towards horticulture, which may be ecologically more sustainable. In areas prone to wind and water erosion, public intervention through subsidies and other measures should encourage farmers to conserve soil and water. Farmers on land over recharge areas for underground aquifers subject to nitrate pollution might be given incentives to maintain soil fertility and increase productivity by means other than nitrate fertilizers. 50. The third defect in government intervention lies in incentive structures. In industrialized countries, overprotection of farmers and overproduction represent the accumulated result of tax reliefs, direct subsidies, and price controls. Such policies are now studded with contradictions that encourage the degradation of the agricultural resource base and. in the long run, do more harm than good to the agricultural industry. Some governments now recognize this and are making efforts to change the focus of the subsidies from production growth to conservation. 51. On the other hand, in most developing countries the incentive structure is weak. Market interventions are often ineffective for lack of an organizational structure for procurement and distribution. Farmers are exposed to a high degree of uncertainty, and price support systems have often favoured the urban dweller or are limited to a few commercial crops, leading to distortions of cropping patterns that add to destructive pressures on the resource base. In some cases, price controls reduce the incentive to produce. What is required, in many cases, is nothing less than a radical attempt to turn the 'terms of trade' in favour of farmers through pricing policy and government expenditure reallocation. 52. Strengthening food security from a global point of view requires reducing incentives that force overproduction and non-competitive production in the developed market economies and enhancing those that encourage food production in developing countries. At the same time, these incentive structures must be redesigned to promote farming practices that conserve and enhance the agricultural resource base. 2. A Global Perspective
  • 112. 53. Trade in agricultural products tripled between 1950 and 1970; it has doubled since then. Yet, when it comes to farming, countries are at their most conservative, continuing to think mainly in local or national terms and concerned, above all, to protect their own farmers at the expense of competitors. 54. Shifting food production towards food-deficit countries will require a major shift in trading patterns. Countries must recognize that all parties lose through protectionist barriers, which reduce trade in food products in which some nations may have genuine advantage. They must begin by redesigning their trade, tax, and incentive systems using criteria that include ecological and economic sustainability and international comparative advantage. 55. The incentive-driven surpluses in developed market economies increase pressures to export these surpluses at subsidized prices or as non-emergency food aid. Donor and receiving countries should be responsible for the impacts of aid and use it for long-term objectives. It can be beneficially used in projects to restore degraded lands, build up rural infrastructure, and raise the nutrition level of vulnerable groups. 3. The Resource Base 56. Agricultural production can only be sustained on a long-term basis if the land, water, and forests on which it is based are not degraded. As suggested, a reorientation of public intervention will provide a framework for this. But more specific policies that protect the resource base are needed to maintain and even enhance agricultural productivity and the livelihoods of all rural dwellers. 3.1 Land Use 57. The initial task in enhancing the resource base will be to delineate broad land categories: enhancement areas, which are capable of sustaining intensive cropping and higher population and consumption levels; prevention areas, which by common consent should not be developed for intensive agriculture or. where developed, should be converted to other uses; and restoration areas, where land stripped of vegetative cover has either totally lost its productivity or had it drastically reduced. 58. Identifying land according to 'best use' criteria requires information that is not always available. Most industrial nations possess inventories and descriptions of their lands, forests, and waters that are detailed enough to provide a basis for delineating land categories. Few developing countries have such inventories, but they can and should develop them quickly using satellite monitoring and other rapidly changing techniques./32 59. Selection of land for each category could be made the responsibility of a board or commission representing the interests involved, especially the poor and more marginalized segments of the population. The process must be public in character, with publicly agreed criteria that combine the best use approach with the level of development required to sustain livelihood. Classifying land according to best use will determine variations in infrastructure provision, support services, promotional measures, regulatory restrictions, fiscal subsidies, and other incentives and disincentives. 60. Lands identified as prevention areas should be denied supports and subsidies that would encourage their development for intensive agriculture. But such areas might well support
  • 113. certain ecologically and economically sustainable uses such as grazing. fuelwood plantations, fruit farming, and forestry. Those redesigning support systems and incentives should focus on a broader range of crops, including those that enhance grazing, soil and water conservation, and so on. 61. In vast areas today natural factors and land use practices have reduced productivity to a point too low to sustain even subsistence farming. Treatment of these areas must vary from site to site. Governments should give priority to establishing a national policy and multidisciplinary programmes and to creating or strengthening institutions to restore such areas. Where these already exist, they should be better coordinated and designed. The UN Plan of Action to Combat Desertification, which is already in place, requires more support, particularly financial. 62. Restoration may require limits on human activities so as to permit the regeneration of vegetation. This can be difficult where there are large herds of animals or large numbers of people. for the agreement and participation of the local people are of the highest importance. The state, with the cooperation of those living locally, could protect these areas by declaring them national reserves. Where these areas are privately held, the state might wish either to purchase the land from the owners or to provide incentives for its restoration. Intensive agriculture may quickly exhaust the soil cover. causing its degradation, unless some special soil protection measures aimed at constant restoration and expanded reproduction of fertility are taken. The task of agriculture is thus not confined to obtaining the biological product but extends to constant maintenance and augmentation of soil fertility. Otherwise we will very quickly consume what by right belongs to our children, grandchildren, and great-grandchildren, to say nothing of more distant descendants. It is this misgiving - that our generation lives to a certain extent at the expense of the coming generations, thoughtlessly drawing on the basic reserves of soil fertility accumulated in the millennia of the biospheric development. instead of living off the current annual increment - that causes the increasing concern of scientists dealing with the state of the planetary soil cover. B. G. Rozanov Moscow State University WCED Public Hearing Moscow, 11 Dec 1986 3.2 Water Management 63. Improvements in water management are essential to raise agricultural productivity and to reduce land degradation and water pollution. Critical issues concern the design of irrigation projects and the efficiency of water use. 64. Where water is scarce, an irrigation project should maximize productivity per unit of water; where water is plentiful, it must maximize productivity per unit of land. But local conditions will dictate how much water can be used without damaging the soil. Salinization. alkalization, and waterlogging can be avoided by a more careful approach to drainage, maintenance, cropping patterns. the regulation of water quantities, and more rational water charges. Many of these objectives will be easier to realize in small-scale irrigation projects. But whether small or
  • 114. large, the projects must be designed with the abilities and aims of the participating farmers in mind, and then involve them in the management. 65. In some areas excessive use of ground-water is rapidly lowering the water table - usually a case where private benefits are being realized at society's expense. Where ground-water use exceeds the recharge capacity of local aquifers, regulatory or fiscal controls become essential. The combined use of ground and surface water can improve the timing of water availability and stretch limited supplies. 3.3 Alternatives to Chemicals 66. Many countries can and should increase yields by greater use of chemical fertilizers and pesticides, particularly in the developing world. But countries can also improve yields by helping farmers to use organic nutrients more efficiently. Hence governments must encourage the use of more organic plant nutrients to complement chemicals. Pest control must also be based increasingly on the use of natural methods. (See Box 5-2) These strategies require changes in public policies, which now encourage the increased use of chemical pesticides and fertilizers. The legislative, policy, and research capacity for advancing non-chemical and less-chemical strategies must be established and sustained. 67. Chemical fertilisers and pesticides are heavily subsidized in many countries. These subsidies promote chemical use precisely in the more commercially oriented agricultural areas where their environmental damage may already outweigh any increases in productivity they bring. Hence different regions will require different policies to regulate and promote chemical use. 68. Legislative and institutional frameworks for controlling agrochemicals must be greatly strengthened everywhere. 69, Industrialized countries must tighten controls on pesticide exports. (See Chapter 8.) Developing countries must possess the basic legislative and institutional instruments to manage the use of agricultural chemicals within their countries. And they will need technical and financial assistance to do so. 3.4 Forestry and Agriculture 69. Undisturbed forests protect watersheds, reduce erosion. offer habitats for wild species, and play key roles in climatic systems. They are also an economic resource providing timber, fuelwood, and other products. The crucial task is to balance the need to exploit forests against the need to preserve them. 70. Sound forest policies can be based only on an analysis of the capacity of the forests and the land under them to perform various functions. Such an analysis might lead to some forests being cleared for intensive cultivation, others for livestock; some forestland might be managed for increased timber production or agroforestry use and some left intact for watershed protection, recreation, or species conservation. The extension of agriculture into forest areas must be based on scientific classification of land capacities. 71. Programmes to preserve forest resources must start with the local people who are both victims and agents of destruction, and who will bear the burden of any new management scheme./33 They should be at the centre of integrated forest management, which is the basis of sustainable agriculture.
  • 115. 72. Such an approach would entail changes in the way governments set development priorities, as well as the evolution of greater responsibility to local governments and communities. Contracts covering forest use will have to be negotiated, or overall environmental sustainability of forest exploitation and overall environmental and ecosystem conservation. Prices for forest products need to reflect the true resource value of the goods. Box 5-2 Natural Systems of Nutrient Supply and Peat Control Crop residues and farmyard manure are potential sources of soil nutrients. Organic wastes reduce run-off, increase the take-up of other nutrients, and improve soil's water-holding and erosion-resistance capacity. Using farmyard manure, especially in conjunction with intercropping and crop rotation, can greatly lower production costs. Overall systems efficiency is enhanced if manure or vegetable biomass is anaerobically digested in biogas plants, yielding energy for cooking and to run pumps, motors, or electric generators. Natural systems of biological nitrogen fixation through the use of certain annual plants, trees, and micro-organisms have a high potential. Integrated pest management (IPM) reduces the need for agrochemicals. improves a country's balance of payments. releases foreign exchange for other development projects, and creates jobs where they are most needed. IPM requires detailed information about pests and their natural enemies, seed varieties tailored to resist pests, integrated cropping patterns, and farmers who support the approach and are willing to modify farm practices to adopt it. 73. Portions of forests may be designated as prevention areas. These are predominantly national parks, which could be set aside from agricultural exploitation to conserve soil, water, and wildlife. They may also include marginal lands whose exploitation accelerates land degradation through erosion or desertification. In this connection, the reforestation of degraded forest areas is of utmost importance. Conservation areas or national parks can also conserve genetic resources in their natural habitats. (See Chapter 6.) 74. Forestry can also be extended into agriculture. Farmers can use agroforestry systems to produce food and fuel. In such systems, one or more tree crops are combined with one or more food crops or animal farming on the same land, though sometimes at different times. Well-chosen crops reinforce each other and yield more food and fuel than when grown separately. The technology is particularly suitable for small farmers and for poor-quality lands. Agroforestry has been practised by traditional farmers everywhere. The challenge today is to revive the old methods, improve them, adapt them to the new conditions. and develop new ones./34 75. International forestry research organizations should work in various tropical countries in various ecosystems along the lines now followed by the Consultative Group on International Agricultural Research. There is considerable scope for institution building and additional research on forestry's role in agricultural production, for example by developing models that better predict the effects on water and soil loss of removing specific portions of forest cover.
  • 116. 3.5 Aquaculture 76. Fisheries and aquaculture are critical to food security in that they provide both protein and employment. The greater part of world fish supply comes from marine fisheries, which yielded 76.8 million tons in 1983. Landings have increased by 1 million tons per year over the past few years; by the end of the century, a catch of around 100 million tons should be possible./35 This is well short of the projected demand. There are indications that much of the naturally available freshwater fish stocks are fully exploited or damaged by pollution. 77. Aquaculture. or 'fish-farming', which differs from conventional fishing in that fish are deliberately reared in controlled water bodies, can help meet future needs. Yields from aquaculture have doubled during the last decade and now represent about 10 per cent of world production of fishery products./36 A five- to tenfold increase is projected by the year 2000, given the necessary scientific, financial, and organizational support./37 Aquaculture can be undertaken in paddy fields, abandoned raining excavations, small ponds, and many other areas with some water, as well as on various commercial scales: individual, family, cooperative, or corporate. The expansion of aquaculture should be given high priority in developing and developed countries. 4. Productivity and yields 78. The conservation and enhancement of agriculture's resource base will increase production and productivity. But specific measures are required to make inputs more effective. This is best done by strengthening the technological and human resource base for agriculture in developing countries. Thus at the root of this environmental problem is a land problem that has to be solved if any serious ecological policy is to be taken - and reorientation of the agricultural policy has to be undertaken. I believe that any conservationist policy has to be followed by a coherent agricultural policy that will meet the need not only of preservation as such but also meet the needs of the Brazilian population. Julio M.G. Gaiger President, National Indian Support Association WCED Public Hearing Sao Paulo. 28/29 Oct 1985 4.1 The Technological Base Blends of traditional and modern technologies offer possibilities for improving nutrition and increasing rural employment on a sustainable basis. Biotechnology, including tissue culture techniques, technologies for preparing value-added products from biomass, micro-electronics, computer sciences, satellite imagery, and communication. technology are all aspects of frontier technologies that can improve agricultural productivity and resource management./38 80. Providing sustainable livelihoods for resource-poor farmers presents a special challenge for agricultural research. The major advances in agricultural technology in recent decades are better suited to stable, uniform, resource-rich conditions with good soils and ample water supplies. New technologies are most urgently needed in sub-Saharan Africa and the remoter
  • 117. areas of Asia and Latin America, which typically have unreliable rainfall, uneven topography, and poorer soils, and hence are unsuited to Green Revolution technologies. 81. To serve agriculture in these areas, research has to be less centralized and more sensitive to farmers' conditions and priorities. Scientists will need to start talking to poor farmers and basing research priorities on growers' priorities. Researchers must learn from and develop the innovations of farmers and not just the reverse. More adaptive research should be done right on the farm, using research stations for referral and with farmers eventually evaluating the results. 82. Commercial enterprises can help develop and diffuse technology, but public institutions must provide the essential framework for agricultural research and extension. Pew academic and research institutions in developing regions are adequately funded. The problem is most acute in the low-income countries, where expenditure on agricultural research and extension amounts to 0.9 per cent of total agricultural income, as against 1.5 per cent in the middle-income countries./39 Research and extension efforts must be greatly expanded, especially in areas where climate, soils, and terrain pose special problems. 83. These areas particularly will need new seed varieties, but so will much developing-country agriculture. At present, 55 per cent of the world's scientifically stored plant genetic resources is controlled by institutions in industrial countries, 31 per cent by institutions in developing countries, and 14 per cent by International Agricultural Research centres./40 Much of this genetic material originated in developing countries. These gene banks must increase their inventories of material, improve their storage techniques, and ensure that the resources are readily accessible to research centres in developing countries. 84. Private companies increasingly seek proprietary rights to improved seed varieties, often without recognizing the rights of the countries from which the plant matter was obtained. This could discourage countries rich in genetic resources from making these internationally available and thus reduce the options for seed development in all countries. The genetic research capabilities of developing countries are so limited that agriculture there could become excessively dependent on private gene banks and seed companies elsewhere. Thus international cooperation and a clear understanding on the sharing of gains are vital in critical areas of agricultural technology, such as the development of new seed varieties. 4.2 Human Resources 85. The technological transformation of traditional agriculture will be difficult without a matching effort to develop human resources. (See Chapter 4.) This means educational reforms to produce researchers more attuned to the needs of rural peoples and agriculture. Illiteracy is still widespread among the rural poor. But efforts to promote literacy should focus attention on functional literacy covering the efficient use of land, water, and forests. 86. Despite women's critical role in agriculture, their access to education and their representation in research, extension, and other support services is woefully inadequate. Women should be given the same educational opportunities as men. There should be more female extension workers, and women should participate in field visits. Women should be given more power to take decisions regarding agricultural and forestry programmes. 4.3 Productivity of Inputs 87. In traditional agriculture, local organic material provided farmers with sources of energy,
  • 118. nutrients, and ways of controlling pests. Today, these needs are increasingly met by electricity, petroleum products, chemical fertilizers, and pesticides. The cost of these inputs forms a growing proportion of agricultural costs, and wasteful use does economic and ecological harm. 88. One of the most important energy-related needs is mechanical power for irrigation. The efficiency of pumps could be greatly improved by providing appropriate incentives for equipment producers and farmers, and through effective extension work. Energy for irrigation pumps can also be provided by wind generators or by conventional internal combustion engines running on biogas produced from local biomass wastes. Solar dryers and solar coolers can save agricultural products. These non-conventional sources should be promoted, particularly in areas poor in energy resources. 89. Nutrients are lost when fertilizers are improperly applied. Often they leach away with the flow of water in a field and degrade local water supplies. Similar problems of waste and destructive side effects occur in the use of pesticides. Hence extension systems and chemical manufacturers will need to give priority to programmes to promote careful and economical use of these expensive, toxic materials. 5. Equity 90. The challenge of sustainable agriculture is to raise not just average productivity and incomes, but also the productivity and incomes of those poor in resources. And food security is not just a question of raising food production, but of ensuring that the rural and urban poor do not go hungry during the short term or midst a local food scarcity. All this requires the systematic promotion of equity in food production and distribution. 5.1 Land Reforms 91. In many countries where land is very unequally distributed land reform is a basic requirement. Without it, institutional and policy changes meant to protect the resource base can actually promote inequalities by shutting the poor off from resources and by favouring those with large farms, who are better able to obtain the limited credit and services available. By leaving hundreds of millions without options, such changes can have the opposite of their intended effect, ensuring the continued violation of ecological imperatives. 92. Given institutional and ecological variations, a universal approach to land reform is impossible. Each country should work out its own programme of land reform to assist the land-poor and to provide a base for coordinated resource conservation. The redistribution of land is particularly important where large estates and vast numbers of the land-poor coexist. Crucial components include the reform of tenancy arrangements, security of tenure, and the clear recording of land rights. In agrarian reforms the productivity of the land and. in forest areas, the protection of forests should be a major concern. 93. In areas where holdings are fragmented into many non-contiguous plots, land consolidation can ease the implementation of resource conservation measures. Promoting cooperative efforts by small farmers - in pest control or water management, for instance - would also help conserve resources. 94. In many countries women do not have direct land rights; titles go to men only. In the interests of food security, land reforms should recognize women's role in growing food. Women, especially those heading households, should be given direct land rights.
  • 119. 5.2 Subsistence Farmers and Pastoralists 95. Subsistence farmers, pastoralists, and nomads threaten the environmental resource base when processes beyond their control squeeze their numbers onto land or into areas that cannot support them. 96. The traditional rights of subsistence farmers, particularly shifting cultivators, pastoralists. and nomads, must therefore be protected from encroachments. Land tenure rights and communal rights in particular must be respected. When their traditional practices threaten the resource base, their rights may have to be curtailed, but only when alternatives have been provided. Most of these groups will need to be helped to diversify their livelihoods by entering the market economy through employment programmes and some cash-crop production. 97. Research should give early attention to the varied requirements of the mixed farming typical in subsistence agriculture. Extension and input supply systems must become more mobile to reach shifting cultivators and nomads and priority given to public investment to improve their cropland, grazing areas, and water sources. 5.3 Integrated Rural Development 98. Rural populations will continue to increase in many countries. With existing patterns of land distribution, the number of smallholders and landless households will increase by about 50 million, to nearly 220 million, by the year 2000./41 Together, these groups represent three-quarters of the agricultural households in developing countries./42 Without adequate livelihood opportunities, these resource-poor households will remain poor and be forced to overuse the resource base to survive. 99. Considerable effort has gone into creating strategies of integrated rural development, and the requirements and pitfalls are well known. Experience has shown that land reform is necessary but alone is not enough without support through the distribution of inputs and rural services. Smallholders, including - indeed especially - women, must be given preference when allocating scarce resources, staff, and credit. Small farmers must also be more involved in formulating agricultural policies. 100. Integrated rural development also requires resources to absorb the large increases in rural working populations expected in most developing countries through non-agricultural work opportunities, which should be promoted in rural areas. Successful agricultural development and the growth in incomes should open up opportunities in service activities and small-scale manufacturing if supported by public policy. 5.4 Food Availability Fluctuations 101. Environmental degradation can make food shortages more frequent and more severe. Hence sustainable agricultural development will reduce the season-to-season variability in food supplies. But such systems cannot eliminate it. There will be weather-induced fluctuations, and the growing dependence on only a few crop varieties over large areas may amplify the effects of weather and pest damage. Often it is the poorest households and the ecologically disadvantaged regions that suffer most from these shortages. 102. Food stocks are crucial in dealing with shortages. At present, the world stock of cereals is
  • 120. on the order of 20 per cent of annual consumption: The developing world controls about one-third of the stock and the industrial world, two-thirds. More than half the developing-country stock is in two countries - China and India. Stock levels in most of the others provide only for immediate operational requirements; there is little by way of a reserve./43 As agriculture production is being developed, a rising number of farmers have been able to purchase tractors. But they find that, after using them for a year, it becomes much more expensive than they expected because they have to spend a tremendous amount of money on expensive spare parts. Perhaps we might recommend that Indonesia establish a factory that makes these spare parts, before they continue encouraging introduction of tractors in agriculture. For this reason, a number of loans that the government has been providing for farmers to modernize their agricultural techniques, particularly buying tractors, have not been paid back. If the tractors were still running, they could probably pay back their loans. In fact, now these tractors are becoming a problem themselves, because they sit around getting rusty. and thus turning into pollution. Andi Mappasala Chairman. Yayasan Tellung Poccoe WCED Public Hearing Jakarta. 26 March 1985 103. The food stocks of industrialized countries are essentially surpluses, and provide a basis for emergency assistance, which must be maintained. But emergency food aid is a precarious basis for food security: developing countries should build up national stocks in surplus years to provide reserves as well as encouraging development of food security at the household level. To do this, they will need an effective system of public support for measures facilitating the purchase, transportation, and distribution of food. The provision of strategically located storage facilities is critical both to reduce post-harvest losses and to provide a base for quick interventions in emergencies. 104. During most food shortages, poor households not only cannot produce food but also lose their usual sources of income and cannot buy the food that is available. Hence food security also requires that machinery is available promptly to put purchasing power in the hands of disaster-struck households, through emergency public works programme, and through measures to protect small farmers from crop failures. V. Food for the Future 105. The challenge of increasing food production to keep pace with demand, while retaining the essential ecological integrity of production systems, is colossal both in its magnitude and complexity. But we have the Knowledge we need to conserve our land and water resources. New technologies provide opportunities for increasing productivity while reducing pressures on resources. A new generation of farmers combine experience with education. With these resources at our command, we can meet the needs of the human family. Standing in the way is the narrow focus of agricultural planning and policies. 106. The application of the concept of sustainable development to the effort to ensure food security requires systematic attention to the renewal of natural resources. It requires a holistic approach focused on ecosystems at national, regional. and global levels, with coordinated land
  • 121. use and careful planning of water usage and forest exploitation. The goal of ecological security should be embedded firmly in the mandates of FAO. other UN organizations that deal with agriculture, and all other appropriate international agencies. It will also require an enhancement and reorientation of international assistance. (See Chapter 3.) 107. The agricultural systems that have been built up over the past few decades have contributed greatly to the alleviation of hunger and the raising of living standards. They have served their purposes up to a point. But they were built for the purposes of a smaller, more fragmented world. New realities reveal their inherent contradictions. These realities require agricultural systems that focus as much attention on people as they do on technology, as much on resources as on production, as much on the long term as on the short term. Only such systems can meet the challenge of the future. Footnotes 1/ Based on data from FAO, Production Yearbook 1985 (Rome: 1986). 2/ Based on World Bank estimates for 1980, according to which 340 million people in developing countries (excluding China) did not have enough income to attain a minimum calorie standard that would prevent serious health risks and stunted growth in children, and 730 million were below a higher standard that would allow an active working life. See World Bank, Poverty and Hunger: Issues and Options for Food Security in Developing Countries (Washington. DC: 1986). 3/ FAO, Yearbook of Food and Agriculture Statistics, 1951 (Home: 1952); FAO, Production Yearbook 1985. op. cit. 4/ FAO, Yearbook of Food and Agricultural Statistics, Trade Volume, Part 2 1951 and Trade Yearbook 1982 and 1984 (Rome: 1952. 1983, and 1985). 5/ FAO, Trade Yearbook 1968 and Commodities Review and Outlook 1984-85 (Rome: 1969 and 1986). 6/ FAO, Yearbook of Food and Agricultural Statistics, Trade Volume, Part 2 1954 (Rome: 1955); FAO, Commodities Review, op. cit. 7/ FAO, Production Yearbook 1984 (Rome: 1985). 8/ L.R. Brown. 'Sustaining World Agriculture,' in L.R. Brown et al., State of the World 1987 (London: W.W. Norton. 1987). 9/ A. Gear (ed.), The Organic Food Guide (Essex: 1983). 10/ USSR Committee for the International Hydrological Decade, World Water Balance and Water Resources of the Earth (Paris: UNESCO, 1978). 11/ FAO, Yearbook of Food and Agricultural Statistics 1951 and Production Yearbook 1984. op. cit. 12/ 'Dairy, Prairie', The Economist, 15 November 1986. 13/ WCED Advisory Panel on Food Security, Agriculture, Forestry and Environment, Food Security (London: Zed Books. 1987).
  • 122. 14/ The term pesticides is used in a generic sense in this report and covers insecticides, herbicides. fungicides, and similar agricultural inputs. 15/ World Bank. World Development Report 1986 (New York: Oxford University Press. 1986). 16/ Brown, op. cit. 17/ Standing Committee on Agriculture. Fisheries and Forestry. Soil at Risk: Canada's Eroding Future, A Report on Soil Conservation to the Senate of Canada (Ottawa: 1984). 18/ Brown, op. cit. 19/ Centre for Science and Environment, The State of India's Environment 1984-85 (New Delhi: 1985). 20/ FAO, Land, Food and People (Rome: 1984). 21/ I. Szabolcs. 'Agrarian Change', prepared for WCED, 1985. 22/ Gear. op. cit./ 23/ J. Bandyopadhyay, 'Rehabilitation of Upland Watersheds', prepared for WCED, 1985. 24/ UNEP. 'General Assessment of Progress in the Implementation of the Plan of Action to Combat Desertification 1978-1984'. Nairobi, 1984; WCED Advisory Panel, op. cit. 25/ UNEP, op. cit. 26/ Ibid. 27/ Ibid. 28/ Ibid. 29/ Ibid. 30/ FAO, Agriculture Towards 2000 (Rome: 1981) 31/ FAO, Potential Population Supporting Capacities of Lands in the Developing World (Rome: 1982). 32/ The land capability classification developed by the U.S. Bureau of Land Management is an example of how the problem could be approached. A broader type of classification is implicit in FAO, Potential Population Supporting Capacities. 33/ INDERENA, Caguan-Cagueta Report (Bogota, Colombia: 1985). 34/ The agroforestry programmes implemented in India are examples of such an approach. They have been adopted enthusiastically by many farmers. 35/ FAO. World Food Report (Rome: 1985); WCED Advisory Panel, op. cit. 36/ WCED Advisory Panel, op. cit. 37/ Ibid.
  • 123. 38/ Ibid. 39/ FAO, World Food Report, op. cit. 40/ Data from Dag Hammarskjold Foundation, Sweden, in Centre for Science and Environment, op. cit. 41/ FAO estimates quoted in WCED Advisory Panel, op. cit. 42/ Ibid. 43/ FAO, Food Outlook (Rome: 1986).
  • 124. Our Common Future, Chapter 6: Species and Ecosystems: Resources for Development I. The Problem: Character and Extent II. Extinction Patterns and Trends III. Some Causes of Extinction IV. Economic Values at Stake V. A New Approach; Anticipate and Prevent VI. International Action for National Species 1. Some Current Initiatives 2. Setting Priorities VII. Scope for National Action VIII. The Need for Action Footnotes Chapter 6 Species and Ecosystems: Resources for Development 1. Conservation of living natural resources - plants, animals, and micro-organisms, and the non-living elements of the environment on which they depend - is crucial for development. Today, the conservation of wild living resources is on the agenda of governments; nearly 4 per cent of the Earth's land area is managed explicitly to conserve species and ecosystems, and all but a small handful of countries have national parks. The challenge facing nations today is no longer deciding whether conservation is a good idea, but rather how it can be implemented in the national interest and within the means available in each country. I. The Problem: Character and Extent 2. Species and their genetic materials promise to play an expanding role in development, and a powerful economic rationale is emerging to bolster the ethical, aesthetic, and scientific cases for preserving them. The genetic variability and germplasm material of species make contributions to agriculture, medicine, and industry worth many billions of dollars per year. 3. Yet scientists have intensively investigated only one in every 100 of Earth's plant species, and a far smaller proportion of animal species. If nations can ensure the survival of species, the world can look forward to new and improved foods, new drugs and medicines, and new raw materials for industry. This - the scope for species to make a fast-growing contribution to human welfare in myriad forms - is a major justification for expanded efforts to safeguard Earth's millions of species.
  • 125. 4. Equally important are the vital life processes carried out by nature, including stabilization of climate, protection of watersheds and soil, preservation of nurseries and breeding grounds, and so on. Conserving these processes cannot be divorced from conserving the individual species within natural ecosystems. Managing species and ecosystems together is clearly the most rational way to approach the problem. Numerous examples of workable solutions to local problems are available./1 5. Species and natural ecosystems make many important contributions to human welfare. Yet these very important resources are seldom being used in ways that will be able to meet the growing pressures of future high demands for both goods and services that depend upon these natural resources. 6. There is a growing scientific consensus that species are disappearing at rates never before witnessed on the planet. But there is also controversy over those rates and the risks they entail. The world is losing precisely those species about which it knows nothing or little; they are being lost in the remotest habitats. The growing scientific concern is relatively new and the data base to support it fragile. But it firms yearly with each new field report and satellite study. 7. Many ecosystems that are rich biologically and promising in material benefits are severely threatened. Vast stocks of biological diversity are in danger of disappearing just as science is learning how to exploit genetic variability through the advances of genetic engineering. Numerous studies document this crisis with examples from tropical forests, temperate forests, mangrove forests, coral reefs, savannas, grasslands, and arid zones./2 Although most of these studies are generalized in their documentation and few offer lists of individual species at risk or recently extinct, some present species-by-species details. (See Box 6-1.) 8. Habitat alteration and species extinction are not the only threat. The planet is also being impoverished by the loss of races and varieties within species. The variety of genetic riches inherent in one single species can be seen in the variability manifested in the many races of dogs, or the many specialized types of maize developed by breeders./3 9. Many species are losing whole populations at a rate that quickly reduces their genetic variability and thus their ability to adapt to climatic change and other forms of environmental adversity. For example, the remaining gene pools of major crop plants such as maize and rice amount to only a fraction of the genetic diversity they harboured only a few decades ago, even though the species themselves are anything but threatened. Thus there can be an important difference between loss of species and loss of gene reservoirs. 10. Some genetic variability inevitably will be lost, but all species should be safeguarded to the extent that it is technically, economically, and politically feasible. The genetic landscape is constantly changing through evolutionary processes, and there is more variability than can be expected to be protected by explicit government programmes. So in terms of genetic conservation, governments must be selective, and ask which gene reservoirs most merit a public involvement in protective measures. However, as a more general proposition, governments should enact national laws and public policies that encourage individual, community, or corporate responsibility for the protection of gene reservoirs. 11. But before science can focus on new ways to conserve species, policy makers and the general public for whom policy is made must grasp the size and the urgency of the threat. Species that are important to human welfare are not just wild plants that are relatives of agricultural crops, or animals that are harvested. Species such as earthworms, bees, and termites may be far more important in terms of the role they play in a healthy and productive ecosystem. It would be
  • 126. grim irony indeed if just as new genetic engineering techniques begin to let us peer into life's diversity and use genes more effectively to better the human condition, we looked and found this treasure sadly depleted. Box 6-1 Some Examples of Species Extinction In Madagascar, until about mid-century, there were 12,000 plant species and probably around 190,000 animal species, with at least 60 per cent of them endemic to the island's eastern strip of forest (that is, found nowhere else on Earth). At least 93 per cent of the original primary forest has been eliminated. Using these figures, scientists estimate that at least half the original species have already disappeared, or are on the point of doing so. Lake Malawi in Central Africa holds over 500 cichlid fish species, 99 per cent of them endemic. The lake is only one-eighth the size of North America's Great Lakes, which feature just 173 species, fewer than 10 per cent of which are endemic. Yet Lake Malawi is threatened through pollution from industrial installations and the proposed introduction of alien species. Western Ecuador is reputed to have once contained between 8,000 and 10,000 plant species, some 40 and 60 per cent of them endemic. Given that there are between 10 and 30 animal species for every one plant species in similar areas, western Ecuador must have contained about 200,000 species. Since 1960, almost all the forests of western Ecuador have been destroyed to make way for banana plantations, oil wells, and human settlements. The number of species thus eliminated is difficult to judge, but the total could well number 50.000 or more - all in just 25 years. The Pantanal area of Brazil contains 110,000 square kilometres of wetlands, probably the most extensive and richest in the world. They support the largest and most diversified populations of waterfowl in South America. The area has been classified by UNESCO as 'of international importance'. Yet it suffers increasingly from agricultural expansion, dam construction, and other forms of disruptive development. Sources: W. Rauh. 'Problems of Biological Conservation in Madagascar', in D. Bramwell (ed.), Plants and Islands (London: Academic Press, 1979): D.C.N. Barel et al., 'Destruction of Fisheries in Africa's Lakes', Nature, Vol. 315, pp. 19-20, 1985; A.H. Gentry. 'Patterns of Neotropical Plant Species Diversity', Evolutionary Biology. Vol. 15, pp.1-84, 1982; D.A. Scott and M. Carbonell, 'A Directory of Neotropical Wetlands', IUCN. Gland. Switzerland. 1985. Our Atlantic forest, this mass of tropical forest that is a narrow stretch from the North to the South, has been reduced drastically. This forest is characterised by a large number of endemic species, that is species that only exist in this area, and only exist in Brazil. And consequently, it is up to us, Brazilians, to shoulder the responsibility of keeping these species in existence. Ibsen de Gusmao Camara President, Brazilian Foundation for Preservation of Nature
  • 127. WCED Public Hearing Sao Paulo. 28-29 Oct 1985 II. Extinction Patterns and Trends 12. Extinction has been a fact of life since life first emerged. The present few million species are the modern-day survivors of the estimated half-billion species that have ever existed. Almost all past extinctions have occurred by natural processes, but today human activities are overwhelmingly the main cause of extinctions. 13. The average duration of a species is some 5 million years. The best current estimates are that on average 900,000 species have become extinct every 1 million years during the last 200 million years, so the average 'background rate' of extinction has been very roughly one in every one and one-ninth years./4 The present human-caused rate is hundreds of times higher, and could easily be thousands of times higher./5 We do not know. We have no accurate figures on the current rates of extinctions, as most of the species vanishing are those least documented, such as insects in tropical forests. 14. Although tropical moist forests are by far the richest biological units in terms of genetic diversity and by far the most threatened through human activities, other major ecological zones are also under pressure. Arid and semi-arid lands harbour only a very small number of species compared with tropical forests. But because of the adaptations of these species to harsh living conditions, they feature many potentially valuable biochemicals, such as the liquid wax of the jojoba shrub and the natural rubber of the guayule bush. Many of these are threatened by. among other things, the expansion of livestock herding. 15. Coral reefs, with an estimated half-million species in their 400,000 square kilometres, are being depleted at rates that may leave little but degraded remnants by early next century. This would be a great loss, in that coral-reef organisms, by virtue of the 'biological warfare' they engage in to ensure living space in crowded habitats, have generated an unusual number and variety of toxins valuable in modern medicine./6 16. Tropical moist forests cover only 6 per cent of the Earth's land surface but contain at least half the Earth's species (which totals 5 million at a minimum, but could be as many as 30 million). They may contain 90 per cent or even more of all species. The mature tropical forests that still exist cover only 900 million hectares, out of the 1.5-1.6 billion hectares that once stood. Between 7.6 million and 10 million hectares are eliminated outright each year, and at least a further 10 million hectares are grossly disrupted annually./7 But these figures come from surveys of the late 1970s, and since then deforestation rates have probably accelerated. 17. By the end of the century, or shortly thereafter, there could be little virgin tropical moist forest left outside of the Zaire Basin and the western half of Brazilian Amazonia, plus some areas such as the Guyana tract of forest in northern South America and parts of the island of New Guinea. The forests in these zones are unlikely to survive beyond a few further decades, as world demand for their produce continues to expand and as the number of forestland farmers increases. 18. If deforestation were to continue in Amazonia at present rates until the year 2000, but then halted completely (which is unlikely), about 15 per cent of plant species would be lost. Were Amazonia's forest cover to be ultimately reduced to those areas now established as parks and reserves, 66 per cent of plant species would eventually disappear, together with almost 69 per cent of bird species and similar proportions of all other major categories of species. Almost 20
  • 128. per cent of the Earth's species are found in Latin American forests outside of Amazonia; another 20 per cent are found in forests of Asia and Africa outside the Zaire Basin./8 All these forests are threatened, and if they were to disappear, the species loss could amount to hundreds of thousands. 19. Unless appropriate management measures are taken over the longer term, at least one-quarter, possibly one-third, and conceivably a still larger share of species existing today could be lost. Many experts suggest that at least 20 per cent of tropical forests should be protected, but to date well under 5 per cent has been afforded protection of any sort - and many of the tropical forest parks exist only on paper. 20. Even the most effectively managed parks and protected areas are unlikely to provide a sufficient answer. In Amazonia, if as much as half the forest were to be safeguarded in some way or another but the other half were to be eliminated or severely disrupted, there might well not be enough moisture in the Amazonian ecosystem to keep the remaining forest moist./9 It could steadily dry up until it became more like an open woodland - with the loss of most of the species adapted to tropical moist forest conditions. 21. More widespread climatic changes are likely to emerge within the foreseeable future as the accumulation of 'greenhouse gases' in the atmosphere leads to global warming early in the next century. (See Chapter 7.) Such a change will produce considerable stress for all ecosystems, making it particularly important that natural diversity be maintained as a means of adaptation. Twenty years ago, as we decided to intensify our forest exploitation, we just thought the resource is available, and we just took it. At the time, we also thought the intensive selecting out of the trees being cut wouldn't destroy forest regeneration. Because not all of the trees were being cut. But we forgot that we don't know yet about how the tropical forest should be rehabilitated. An indigenous species such as meranti, I don't know the name in English, meranti, rami, is our high-valued wood, a timber that cannot make a shadow in its particular period of growth. And it cannot survive without that shadow. And we still didn't think about it, we just accepted the technology from the West that we have to cut, to exploit our forest. Emmy H. Dharsono NGO Network for Forest Conservation WCED Public Hearing Jakarta, 26 March 1985 III. Some Causes of Extinction 22. The tropics, which host the greatest number and diversity of species, also host most developing nations, where population growth is fastest and poverty is most widespread. If farmers in these countries are forced to continue with extensive agriculture, which is inherently unstable and leads to constant movement, then farming will tend to spread throughout remaining wildlife environments. But if they are helped and encouraged to practise more intensive agriculture, they could make productive use of relatively limited areas, with less impact on wildlands. 23. They will need help: training, marketing support, and fertilizers, pesticides, and tools they can afford. This will require the full support of governments, including ensuring that
  • 129. conservation policies are designed with the benefit of agriculture foremost in mind. It may be expedient to stress the value to farmers rather than to wildlife of this programme, but in fact the destinies of the two are intertwined. Species conservation is tied to development, and the problems of both are more political than technical. 24. Population growth is a major threat to conservation efforts in many developing nations. Kenya has allocated 6 per cent of its territory as parks and reserves in order to protect its wildlife and to earn foreign exchange through tourism. But Kenya's present population of 20 million people is already pressing so hard on parks that protected land is steadily being lost to invading farmers. And the country's population is projected to grow fourfold in the next 40 years./10 25. Similar population pressures threaten parks in Ethiopia, Uganda. Zimbabwe, and other countries in which a growing but impoverished peasantry is forced to depend on a dwindling natural resource base. The prospects are bleak for parks that do not make important and recognizable contributions to national development objectives. 26. Brazil, Colombia, Indonesia. Cote d'lvoire, Kenya, Madagascar, Peru, the Philippines. Thailand, and other nations with an unusual abundance of species already suffer a massive flow of farmers from traditional homelands into virgin territories. These areas often include tropical forests. perceived by the migrants encouraged to farm there as 'free' lands available for unimpeded settlement. The people who are already living on such lands at low population densities and with only traditional rights to the land are often swept aside in the rush to develop lands that might better be left in extensively used forest. 27. Many tropical countries with large forest resources have provoked wasteful 'timber booms' by assigning harvesting rights to concessionaires for royalty, rent, and tax payments that are only a small fraction of the net commercial value of the timber harvest. They have compounded the damage caused by these incentives by offering only short-term leases, requiring concessionaires to begin harvesting at once, and adopting royalty systems that induce loggers to harvest only the best trees while doing enormous damage to the remainder. In response, logging entrepreneurs in several countries have leased virtually the entire productive forest area within a few years and have overexploited the resource with little concern for future productivity (while unwittingly opening it for clearing by slash-and-burn cultivators)./11 28. In Central and South America, many governments have encouraged the large-scale conversion of tropical forests to livestock ranches. Many of these ranches have proved ecologically and economically unsound, as the underlying soils are soon depleted of nutrients; weed species replace planted grasses, and pasture productivity declines abruptly. Yet tens of millions of hectares of tropical forest have been lost to such ranches, largely because governments have underwritten the conversions with large land grants, tax credits and tax holidays, subsidized loans, and other inducements./12 29. The promotion of tropical timber imports into certain industrial countries, through low tariffs and favourable trade incentives, combined with weak domestic forest policies in tropical countries and with high costs and disincentives to harvesting in industrial countries, also drives deforestation. Some industrial countries typically import unprocessed logs either duty-free or at minimal tariff rates. This encourages developed country industries to use logs from tropical forests rather than their own, a pattern that is reinforced by domestic restrictions on the amounts that can be cut in domestic forests. All of us in Africa are slowly waking up to the fact the African crisis is essentially an
  • 130. environmental problem that has precipitated such adverse symptoms as drought, famine, desertification, overpopulation, environmental refugees, political instability, widespread poverty, etc. We are awaking to the fact that if Africa is dying it is because her environment has been plundered, overexploited, and neglected. Many of us in Africa are also waking up to the realization that no good Samaritans will cross the seas to come to save the African environment. Only we Africans can and should be sufficiently sensitive to the well-being of our environment. Mrs. Rahab W. Mwatha The Greenbelt Movement WCED Public Hearing Nairobi, 23 Sept 1986 IV. Economic Values at Stake 30. Species conservation is not only justified in economic terms. Aesthetic, ethical, cultural, and scientific considerations provide ample grounds for conservation. For those who demand an accounting, the economic values inherent in the genetic materials of species are alone enough to justify species preservation. 31. Today, industrialized nations record far greater financial benefits from wild species than do developing countries, though unrecorded benefits to people living in the tropical countryside can be considerable. But the industrial countries have the scientific and industrial capacity to convert the wild material for industrial and medical use. And they also trade a higher proportion of their agricultural produce than do developing nations. Northern crop breeders are increasingly dependent on genetic materials from wild relatives of maize and wheat, two crops that play leading roles in the international grain trade. The U.S. Department of Agriculture estimates that contributions from plant genetic material lead to increases in productivity that average around l per cent annually, with a farm-gate value of well over $1 billion (1980 dollars)./13 32. The U.S. maize crop suffered a severe setback in 1970. when a leaf fungus blighted croplands, causing losses to farmers worth more than $2 billion. Then fungus-resistant genetic material was found in genetic stocks that had originated in Mexico./14 More recently, a primitive species of maize was discovered in a montane forest of south-central Mexico./15 This wild plant is the most primitive known relative of modern maize and was surviving in only three tiny patches covering a mere four hectares in an area threatened with destruction by farmers and loggers. The wild species is a perennial; all other forms of maize are annuals. Its cross-breeding with commercial varieties of maize opens up the prospect that farmers could be spared the annual expense of ploughing and sowing, since the plant would grow again yearly of its own accord. The genetic benefits of this wild plant, discovered when not more than a few thousand last stalks remained, could total several thousand million dollars a year./16 33. Wild species likewise contribute to medicine. Half of all prescriptions dispensed have their origins in wild organisms./17 The commercial value of these medicines and drugs in the United States now amounts to some $14 billion a year./18 Worldwide, and including non-prescription materials plus pharmaceuticals, the estimated commercial value exceeds $40 billion a year./19 Industry also benefits from wildlife./20 34. Wildlife-derived materials contribute gums, oils, resins, dyes, tanning, vegetable fats and
  • 131. waxes, insecticides, and many other compounds. Many wild plants bear oil-rich seeds that can help in the manufacture of fibres, detergents, starch, and general edibles. For instance, the Fevillea genus of rain-forest vines in western Amazonia bear seeds with such a high oil content that a hectare of such vines in an original forest could produce more oil than a hectare of commercial oil palm plantation./21 35. A few plant species contain hydrocarbons rather than carbohydrates./22 Certain of these plants can flourish in areas that have been rendered useless through such activities as strip-mining. Hence land that has been degraded by extraction of hydrocarbons such as coal could be rehabilitated by growing hydrocarbons on the surface. Moreover, unlike an oil well, a 'petroleum plantation' need never run dry. 36. The emerging field of genetic engineering, by which science devises new variations of life forms, does not render wild genes useless. In fact, this new science must be based on existing genetic material and makes such material even more valuable and useful. Extinction, according to Professor Tom Eisner of Cornell University, 'no longer means the simple loss of one volume from the library of nature. It means the loss of a loose-leaf book whose individual pages, were the species to survive, would remain available in perpetuity for selective transfer and improvement of other species./23 And Professor Winston Brill of the University of Wisconsin has noted: 'We are entering an age in which genetic wealth, especially in tropical areas such as rain forests, until now a relatively inaccessible trust fund, is becoming a currency with high immediate value./24 37. Genetic engineering may mean that agriculture's Green Revolution will be superseded by a 'Gene Revolution'. This technology raises hopes of eventually harvesting crops from deserts, from seawater, and from other environments that did not previously support farming. Medical researchers foresee their own Gene Revolution bringing more innovative advances during the last two decades of this century than occurred during the previous 200 years. 38. Many of the nations with the least capacity for managing living resources are those richest in species; the tropics, which contain at least two-thirds of all species and a still greater proportion of threatened species, roughly coincide with the area generally referred to as the Third World. Many developing nations recognize the need to safeguard threatened species but lack the scientific skills, institutional capacities, and funds necessary for conservation. Industrial nations seeking to reap some of the economic benefits of genetic resources should support the efforts of Third World nations to conserve species; they should also seek ways to help tropical nations and particularly the rural people most directly involved with these species realize some of the economic benefits of these resources. It will not be possible to restore the population of 'oomurasaki' - our purple emperor butterfly - to the previous level. The forest for oomurasaki requires weeding, planting of trees, and care and maintenance. The forest will be handed down to the succeeding generations. Isn't it wonderful to think that you are linked to the succeeding generations by handing down the forest where many oomurasaki fly and people enjoy themselves? It would be nice if we could develop into the hearts of the children the love and affection for nature. We hope to make the forest we are making our gift to the children who will live in the 21st century. Mika Sakakibara Student, Tokyo University of Agriculture and Technology
  • 132. WCED Public Hearing Tokyo. 27 Feb 1987 V. A New Approach; Anticipate and Prevent 39. The historical approach of establishing national parks that are somehow isolated from the greater society has been overtaken by a new approach to conservation of species and ecosystems that can be characterized as 'anticipate and prevent.' This involves adding a new dimension to the now-traditional and yet viable and necessary step of protected areas. Development patterns must be altered to make them more compatible with the preservation of the extremely valuable biological diversity of the planet. Altering economic and land use patterns seems to be the best long-term approach to ensuring the survival of wild species and their ecosystems. 40. This more strategic approach deals with the problems of species depletion at their sources in development policies. anticipates the obvious results of the more destructive policies, and prevents damage now. A useful tool in promoting this approach is the preparation of National Conservation Strategies (NCS), which bring the processes of conservation and development together. Preparing an NCS involves government agencies, non-governmental organizations, private interests, and the community at large in analysis of natural resource issues and assessment of priority actions. In this way. it is hoped that sectoral interests will better perceive their interrelationships with other sectors and new potentials for conservation and development will be revealed. 41. The link between conservation and development and the need to attack the problem at the source can be seen clearly in the case of tropical forests. Sometimes it is government policy, not economic necessity, that drives the overexploitation and destruction of these resources. The direct economic and fiscal costs of this overexploitation - in addition to those of species extinction - are huge. The result has been wasteful exploitation of the tropical forests, the sacrifice of most of their timber and non-timber values. enormous losses of potential revenue to the government, and the destruction of rich biological resources. 42. Third World governments can stem the destruction of tropical forests and other reservoirs of biological diversity while achieving economic goals. They can conserve valuable species and habitat while reducing their economic and fiscal burdens. Reforming forest revenue systems and concession terms could raise billions of dollars of additional revenues, promote more efficient, long-term forest resource use. and curtail deforestation. Governments could save themselves enormous expense and revenue loss, promote more sustainable land uses, and slow down the destruction of tropical forests by eliminating incentives for livestock ranching. 43. The link between conservation and development also requires some changes in trade patterns. This has been recognized in the establishment in 1986 of the International Tropical Timber Organization, based in Yokohama, Japan, which seeks to rationalize trade flows. It has been set up to implement the first commodity agreement that incorporates a specific conservation component. 44. Numerous other opportunities can be found to encourage both species conservation and economic productivity. Many governments maintain unrealistically low taxes on rural land, while allowing settlers to establish title to 'virgin' land by converting it to farmland. Thus wealthy landowners can keep huge, underused estates at little or no cost, while land-hungry peasants are encouraged to clear forests to establish marginal holdings. Reforms of tax and tenure systems could increase productivity on existing holdings and reduce the pressures to
  • 133. expand cultivation into forests and upland watersheds. 45. Well-designed ecosystem conservation contributes to the predominant' goals of sustainable development in a number of ways. Safeguards for critical tracts of wildlands can serve also to safeguard agricultural land, for example. This is particularly true for upland forests of the tropics, which protect valley fields from floods and erosion, and waterways and irrigation systems from siltation. 46. A case in point is the Duraoga-Bone Reserve in Indonesia's northern Sulawesi, covering some 3,000 square kilometres of upland forest. It protects large populations of most of Sulawesi's endemic mammals, and many of the island's 80 endemic bird species. It also protects the Dumoga Valley Irrigation Scheme, funded by a World Bank loan, set up in the flatlands below to achieve a tripling of rice production on more then 13,000 hectares of prime agricultural land./25 Similar examples include the Canaima National Park in Venezuela, which protects domestic and industrial water supplies for a major hydropower facility that, in turn, provides electricity to the nation's key industrial centre and its capital city. 47. One conclusion from this connection is that governments could think of 'parks for development', insofar as parks serve the dual purpose of protection for species habitats and development processes at the same time. National efforts to anticipate and prevent the adverse consequences of development policies in any of these areas would surely yield much more for species conservation than all the measures of the past 10 years in support of park building, ranger patrols, anti-poaching units, and the other conventional forms of wildlife preservation. The 3rd World Congress on National Parks, held in Bali, Indonesia, in October 1982, brought this message from protected area managers to the policy makers of the world, demonstrating the many contributions that protected areas managed in the modern way are making to sustaining human society. VI. International Action for National Species 48. Species and their genetic resources - whatever their origins - plainly supply benefits to all human beings. Wild genetic resources from Mexico and Central America serve the needs of maize growers and consumers globally. The principal cocoa-growing nations are in West Africa, while the genetic resources on which modern cocoa plantations depend for their continued productivity are found in the forests of western Amazonia. 49. Coffee growers and drinkers depend for the health of the crop on constant supplies of new genetic material from coffee's wild relatives, principally located in Ethiopia. Brazil, which supplies wild rubber germplasm to Southeast Asia's rubber plantation, itself depends on germplasm supplies from diverse parts of the world to sustain its sugar-cane, soybean, and other leading crops. Without access to foreign sources of fresh germplasm year by year, the nations of Europe and North America would quickly find their agricultural output declining. 50. The Earth's endowment of species and natural ecosystems will soon be seen as assets to be conserved and managed for the benefit of all humanity. This will necessarily add the challenge of species conservation to the international political agenda. 51. At the heart of the issue lies the fact that there is often a conflict between the short-term economic interest of the individual nations and the long-term interest of sustainable development and potential economic gains of the world community at large. A major thrust in actions to conserve genetic diversity must therefore be directed at making it more economically attractive both in the short term and in the longer perspective to protect wild species and their ecosystems. Developing countries must be ensured an equitable share of the economic profit
  • 134. from the use of genes for commercial purposes. 1. Some Current Initiatives 52. A number of international measures are already being tried. But they are limited in scope, only partially successful, and reactive in nature. UNESCO operates a clearing-house for information on natural areas and genetic resources. Its World Heritage Fund supports the management of a handful of exceptional ecosystems around the world, but all these activities receive small budgets. UNESCO has sought to establish a global system of Biosphere Reserves representing the Earth's 200 'biotic provinces' and harbouring sample communities of species. But only one-third of the needed reserves have been established, even though instituting and operating the rest would cost only about $150 million a year./26 53. UN agencies such as FAO and UNEP run programmes concerned with threatened species, genetic resources, and outstanding ecosystems. But their combined activities are tiny in the face of the large needs. Among national agencies, the U.S. Agency for International Development leads the field in recognizing the value of species conservation. Legislation passed by the U.S. Congress in 1986 will make available $2.5 million a year for this purpose./27 Again, this should be considered an important gesture compared with what has been done to date by bilateral agencies, but trifling compared with the needs and opportunities. 54. IUCN, working in close collaboration with UNEP, WWF, the World Bank, and various international technical assistance agencies, has established a 'Conservation Monitoring Centre', to provide data on species and ecosystems for any part of the world quickly and easily. This service, which is available to all, can help ensure that development projects are designed with full information available about the species and ecosystems that might be affected. Technical assistance is also available for nations, sectors, and organizations interested in establishing local data bases for their own applications. 55. Species problems tend to be perceived largely in scientific and conservationist terms rather than as a leading economic and resource concern. Thus the issue lacks political clout. One important initiative that attempts to put conservation more squarely on the agenda of international development concerns has been the Tropical Forestry Action Plan. This collaborative effort coordinated by FAO involves the World Bank, IUCN, the World Resources Institute, and UNDP, along with numerous other collaborating institutions. The broad-based effort proposes the formulation of national forestry reviews, national forestry plans, identification of new projects, enhanced cooperation between development aid agencies at work in the forestry sector. and increased flows of technical and financial resources into forestry and related fields such as' smallholder agriculture. 56. Establishing norms and procedures with respect to resource issues is at least as important as increased funding. Precedents for such norms include the Convention on Wetlands of International Importance, the Convention on Conservation of Islands for Science (both of which safeguard prime habitats and their species), and the Convention on International Trade in Endangered Species. These three precedents all help, although the first two are essentially reactive attempts to devise 'species refuges'. As deforestation progresses, it reduces the quality of life of millions of people in developing countries; their survival is threatened by the loss of the vegetation upon which they depend for their sources of household energy and many other goods. If tropical forests continue to be cleared at the current rate, at least 556 million acres
  • 135. (225 million hectares) will be cleared by the year 2000; if destruction of the tropical rain forests continues unabated, an estimated 10 to 20 per cent of the earth's plant and animal life will be gone by the year 2000. Reversing deforestation depends on political leadership and appropriate policy changes by developing-country governments to support community-level initiatives. The key ingredient is active participation by the millions of small farmers and landless people who daily use forests and trees to meet their needs. J. Gustave Speth President, World Resources Institute WCED Public Hearing Sao Paulo. 28-29 Oct 1985 2. Setting Priorities 57. A first priority is to establish the problem of disappearing species and threatened ecosystems on political agendas as a major resource issue. The World Charter for Nature, adopted by the UN in October 1982, was an important step towards this objective. 58. Governments should investigate the prospect of agreeing to a 'Species Convention', similar in spirit and scope to the Law of the Sea Treaty and other international conventions reflecting principles of 'universal resources'. A Species Convention, such as a draft prepared by IUCN, should articulate the concept of species and genetic variability as a common heritage. 59. Collective responsibility for the common heritage would not mean collective international rights to particular resources within nations. This approach need not interfere with concepts of national sovereignty. But it would mean that individual nations would no longer be left to rely on their own isolated efforts to protect species within their borders. 60. Such a Convention would need to be supported by a financial arrangement that would have the active backing of the community of nations. Any such arrangement, and there are several possibilities, must not only seek to ensure the conservation of genetic resources for all people, but assure that the nations that possess many of these resources obtain an equitable share of the benefits and earnings derived from their development. This would greatly encourage the conservation of species. One such arrangement might be a Trust Fund to which all nations could contribute, with those benefiting most from the use of these resources contributing an appropriate share. Governments of tropical forest nations could receive payments to support the conservation of given areas of forest, with such payments rising or falling depending on the degree to which the forests are maintained and protected./28 61. The sums required for effective conservation are large. Traditional-type conservation needs in tropical forests alone require outlays of $170 million a year for at least five years./29 However, the network of protected areas that the world will need by the year 2050 must include much larger areas brought under some degree of protection and a sophisticated degree of flexibility in management techniques./30 62. More funds will also be required for conservation activities outside protected areas: wildlife management, ecodevelopment areas, education campaigns, and so on. Other approaches of a less expensive sort include the conservation of wild gene reservoirs of special significance through 'genetic conservation areas' in countries well endowed with biological wealth. Much of this work can be carried out by citizens' groups and other non-governmental means.
  • 136. 63. International development agencies - the World Bank and other major lending banks. UN agencies, and bilateral agencies -should give comprehensive and systematic attention to the problems and opportunities of species conservation. Although the international trade in wildlife and wildlife products is considerable, to date the economic values inherent in genetic variability and ecological processes have been generally disregarded. Possible measures include environmental impact analyses of development projects with particular attention to species' habitats and life-support systems, identification of crucial localities featuring exceptional concentrations of species with exceptional levels of endemism that face exceptional degrees of threat, and special opportunities for linking species conservation with development aid. VII. Scope for National Action 64. As indicated earlier, governments need to follow a new approach in this field - one of anticipating the impact of their policies in numerous sectors and acting to prevent undesirable consequences. They should review programmes in areas such as agriculture, forestry, and settlements that serve to degrade and destroy species' habitats. Governments should determine how many more protected areas are needed, especially in the spirit of how such areas can contribute to national development objectives, and make further provision for protection of gene reservoirs (for instance, primitive cultivated varieties) that may not normally be preserved through conventional protected areas. 65. In addition, governments need to reinforce and expand existing strategies. Urgent needs include better wildlife and protected-area management, more protected areas of a non-conventional type (such as the ecological stations that are proving reasonably successful in Brazil), more game cropping and ranching projects (such as the crocodile schemes in India, Papua New Guinea, Thailand, and Zimbabwe), more promotion of wildlife-based tourism, and stronger anti-poaching measures (even though relatively few species are threatened by poaching, compared with the vast numbers threatened by habitat loss). National Conservation Strategies, such as those already prepared in over 25 countries, can be important tools for coordinating conservation and development programmes. 66. Other measures governments could take to confront the crisis of disappearing species, recognizing that it constitutes a major resource and development challenge, include consideration of species conservation needs and opportunities in land use planning and the explicit incorporation of their genetic resource stocks into national accounting systems. This could entail establishing a natural-resource accounting system that directs particular attention to species as high-value yet little-appreciated resources. Finally, they should support and expand programmes of public education to ensure that the species question receives the attention it deserves throughout the entire population. 67. Every nation has only limited resources at its disposal for dealing with conservation priorities. The dilemma is how to use these resources most effectively. Cooperation with neighbouring nations sharing species and ecosystems can help streamline programmes as well as share expenses for regional initiatives. Explicit efforts to save particular species will be possible for only relatively few of the more spectacular or important ones. Agonizing as it will be to make such choices, planners need to make conservation strategies as systematically selective as possible. No one cares for the prospect of consigning threatened species to oblivion. But insofar as choices are already being made, unwittingly, they should be made with selective discretion that takes into account the impact of the extinction of a species upon the biosphere or on the integrity of a given ecosystem. 68. But even though public effort may be concentrated on a few species, all species are
  • 137. important and deserve some degree of attention; this might take the form of tax credits to farmers willing to maintain primitive cultivars. an end to incentives to clear virgin forest, the promotion of research attention from local universities, and the preparation of basic inventories of native flora and fauna by national institutions. The world is unfortunately not what we would like it to be. The problems are many and great. Actually, they can only be solved with cooperation and quick-wittedness. I represent an organization called 'Nature and Youth'. I know that I have full support among our members when I say that we are worried about the future if drastic changes do not take place, concerning the world's way of treating our essential condition, nature. We who work with youth, and are youth ourselves in Norway today, know very well how the destroying of nature leads to an apathetic fear among youth concerning their future and how it will turn out. It is of great importance that common people get the chance to take part in deciding how nature should be treated. Frederic Hauge Nature and Youth WCED Public Hearing Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 VIII. The Need for Action 69. There are numerous signs that the loss of species and their ecosystems is being taken seriously as a phenomenon that carries practical implications for people all around the world, now and for generations to come. 70. The recent rise in public concern can be seen in such developments as the growth in Kenya's Wildlife Clubs. now numbering more than 1,500 school clubs with around 100.000 members./31 A parallel development in conservation education has occurred in Zambia. In Indonesia, some 400 conservation groups have joined together under the banner of the Indonesian Environmental Forum and exert strong political influence./32 In the United States, membership of the Audubon Society reached 385,000 in 1985./33 In the Soviet Union, nature clubs have over 35 million members./34 All of these indicate that the public puts a value on nature that is beyond the normal economic imperatives. 71. In response to this popular concern, governments have been moving to help species threatened within their borders, primarily through the establishment of additional protected areas. Today, the worldwide network of protected areas totals more than 4 million square kilometres, roughly equivalent to the size of most of the countries of Western Europe combined, or twice the size of Indonesia. In terms of continental coverage, protected areas in Europe (outside the USSR) amounted by 1985 to 3.9 per cent of territory; in the USSR, to 2.5 per cent; in North America, to 8.1 per cent; in South America, to 6.1 per cent; in Africa, to 6.5 per cent; and in Asia (outside the USSR) and Australia, to 4.3 per cent each./35 72. Since 1970, the networks have expanded in extent by more than 80 per cent, around two-thirds of which are in the Third World. But a great deal more remains to be done; a consensus of professional opinion suggests that the total expanse of protected areas needs to
  • 138. be at least tripled if it is to constitute a representative sample of Earth's ecosystems./36 73. There is still time to save species and their ecosystems. It is an indispensable prerequisite for sustainable development. Our failure to do so will not be forgiven by future generations. Footnotes 1/ J. McNeely and K. Miller (eds.), National Parks Conservation and Development; The Role of Protected Areas in Sustaining Society, Proceedings of the World Congress on National Parks (Washington, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press, 1984). 2/ W.B. Banage. 'Policies for the Maintenance of Biological Diversity', prepared for WCED, 1986; P.R. Ehrlich and A.H. Ehrlich. Extinction (New York: Random House. 1981); D. Western (ed.), Conservation 2100, Proceedings of Wildlife Conservation International and New York Zoological Society Conference, 21-24 October 1986 (New York: Zoological Society, in press); N. Myers, 'Tropical Deforestation and Species Extinctions, The Latest News', Futures, October 1985; R. Lewin, 'A Mass Extinction Without Asteroids', Science, 3 October 1986; P.H. Raven. 'Statement from Meeting of IUCN/WWF Plant Advisory Group', Las Palmas, Canary Islands, 24-25 November 1985; M.E. Soule (ed.), Conservation Biology: Science of Scarcity and Diversity (Sunderland, Mass.: Sinauer Associates, 1986); E.O. Wilson (ed.), Biodiversity, Proceedings of National Forum held by National Academy of Sciences and Smithsonian Institution, 21-24 September 1986 (Washington, DC: National Academy Press, forthcoming). 3/ O.H. Frankel and M.E. Soule. Conservation and Evolution (Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1981): CM. Schonewald-Cox et al. (eds.). Genetics and Conservation (Menlo Park. Calif.: Benjamin/Cummings Publishing Company Inc., 1983). 4/ D.D. Raup. 'Biological Extinction in Earth History', Science. 28 March 1986. 5/ Wilson, op. cit.; Ehrlich and Ehrlich, op. cit.; Myers. 'The Latest News', op. cit.; Soule. op. cit. 6/ G.D. Ruggieri and N.D. Rosenberg, The Healing Sea (New York: Dodd Mead and Co., 1978). 7/ FAO/UNEP. Tropical Forest Resources. Forestry Paper No. 30 (Rome: 1982); J.M. Melillo et al., 'A Comparison of Recent Estimates of Disturbance in Tropical Forests', Environmental Conservation. Spring 1985; N. Myers. The Primary Source (New York: W.W. Norton, 1984); Myers 'The Latest News', op. cit.; J. Molofsky et al., 'A Comparison of Tropical Forest Surveys', Carbon Dioxide Program. U.S. Department of Energy. Washington DC. 1986. 8/ D. Simberloff, 'Are We On the Verge of a Mass Extinction in Tropical Rain Forests?' in D.K. Elliott (ed.), Dynamics of Extinction (Chichester. UK: John Wiley & Sons. 1986); Raven. op. cit. 9/ E. Salati and P.B. Vose, 'Amazon Basin: A System in Equilibrium', Science, 13 July 1984. 10/ Department of International Economic and Social Affairs, World Population Prospects: Estimates and Projections as Assessed in 1984 (New York: UN. 1986). 11/ R. Repetto. 'Creating Incentives for Sustainable Forestry Development', World Resources
  • 139. Institute. Washington. DC, August 1985. 12/ Ibid. 13/ Agricultural Research Service, Introduction, Classification. Maintenance. Evaluation, and Documentation of Plant Germplasm (Washington. DC: U.S. Department of Agriculture. 1985). 14/ L.A. Tatum. 'The Southern Corn Leaf Blight Epidemic', Science. Vol. 171. pp. 1113-16, 1971. 15/ H.H. Iltis et al., 'Zea diploperennis (Gramineae), a New Teosinte from Mexico', Science, 12 January 1979. 16/ A.C. Fisher. 'Economic Analysis and the Extinction of Species', Department of Energy and Resources. University of California. Berkeley. 1982. 17/ N.R. Farnsworth and D.D. Soejarto. 'Potential Consequence of Plant Extinction in the United States on the Current and Future Availability of Prescription Drugs', Economic Botany, Vol. 39. pp. 231-40. 1985. 18/ N. Myers, A Wealth of Wild Species (Boulder, Colo.: Westview Press. 1983). 19/ Ibid. 20/ M.L. Oldfield, 'The Value of Conserving Genetic Resources', National Park Service. U.S. Department of the Interior. Washington, DC, 1984; L.H. Princen, 'New Crop Development for Industrial Oils', Journal of the American Oil Chemists' Society, Vol. 56, pp. 845-48, 1979. 21/ A.H. Gentry and R. Wettach, 'Fevillea - A New Oilseed from Amazonian Peru', Economic Botany, Vol. 40, pp. 177-85, 1986. 22/ M. Calvin. 'Hydrocarbons from Plants: Analytical Methods and Observations', Naturwissenschaften. Vol. 67, pp. 525-33, 1980; C.W. Hinman et al., 'Five Potential New Crops for Arid Lands', Environmental Conservation. Winter 1985. 23/ T. Eisner. 'Chemicals. Genes, and the Loss of Species'. Nature Conservancy News, Vol. 33. No. 6, pp. 23-24, 1983. 24/ W.J. Brill. 'Nitrogen Fixation: Basic to Applied', American Scientist, Vol. 67, pp. 458-65. 1979. 25/ McNeely and Miller, op. cit. 26/ UNESCO, International Coordinating Council of Man and the Biosphere. MAB Report Series No. 58 (Paris: 1985). 27/ Letter to N. Myers, Consultant in Environment and Development, from Senator W. Roth (R-Del.), U.S. Congress, Washington. DC. 28/ R.A. Sedjo, Testimony before the Subcommittee on Human Rights and international Organizations. Foreign Affairs Committee, U.S. House of Representatives, 12 September 1984. 29/ International Task Force. Tropical Forests: A Call for Action (Washington, DC: World Resources Institute, 1985).
  • 140. 30/ R.L. Peters and J.D.S. Darling, 'The Greenhouse Effect of Nature Reserves', Bioscience, Vol. 35, pp. 707-17. 1984. 31/ 'Kenya's Wildlife Clubs' (Brochure). Ed Wilson. WWF Regional Office for East and Central Africa, personal communication, 3 February 1987. 32/ Centre for Environmental Studies, Environmental NGO's in Developing Countries (Copenhagen: 1985). 33/ Membership figure from Audubon circulation in Ulrich's Periodicals (New York: R.W. Bowker, 1985). 34/ Prof. Yazan, IUCN Vice-President and Regional Counsellor, IUCN Bulletin. Vol. 17, Nos. 7-9. 35/ List of National Parks and Equivalent Reserves (IUCN: 1985). 36/ McNeely and Miller, op. cit.
  • 141. Our Common Future, Chapter 7: Energy: Choices for Environment and Development Energy, Economy, I. and Environment II. Fossil Fuels: The Continuing Dilemma 1. Managing Climatic change 2. Reducing Urban-Industrial Air Pollution 3. Damage from the Long-Range Transport of Air Pollution III. Nuclear Energy: Unsolved Problems 1. The Peaceful Atom 2. The Growing Understanding of Nuclear Issues 3. The Current International Situation 4. Conclusions and Recommendations IV. Wood Fuels: The Vanishing Resource V. Renewable Energy: The Untapped Potential VI. Energy Efficiency: Maintaining the Momentum VII. Energy Conservation Measures VIII. Conclusion 1. Energy is necessary for daily survival. Future development crucially depends on its long-term availability in increasing quantities from sources that are dependable, safe, and environmentally sound. At present, no single source or mix of sources is at hand to meet this future need. 2. Concern about a dependable future for energy is only natural since energy provides 'essential services' for human life - heat for warmth, cooking, and manufacturing, or power for transport and mechanical work. At present, the energy to provide these services comes from fuels - oil, gas, coal, nuclear, wood, and other primary sources (solar, wind, or water power) - that are all useless until they are converted into the energy services needed, by machines or other kinds of end-use equipment, such as stoves, turbines, or motors. In many countries worldwide, a lot of primary energy is wasted because of the inefficient design or running of the equipment used to convert it into the services required; though there is an encouraging growth
  • 142. in awareness of energy conservation and efficiency. 3. Today's primary sources of energy are mainly non-renewable: natural gas, oil, coal, peat, and conventional nuclear power. There are also renewable sources, including wood, plants, dung, falling water, geothermal sources, solar, tidal, wind, and wave energy, as well as human and animal muscle-power. Nuclear reactors that produce their own fuel ('breeders') and eventually fusion reactors are also in this category. In theory, all the various energy sources can contribute to the future energy mix worldwide. But each has its own economic, health, and environmental costs, benefits, and risks - factors that interact strongly with other governmental and global priorities. Choices must be made, but in the certain knowledge that choosing an energy strategy inevitably means choosing an environmental strategy. 4. Patterns and changes of energy use today are already dictating patterns well into the next century. We approach this question from the standpoint of sustainability. The key elements of sustainability that have to be reconciled are: sufficient growth of energy supplies to meet human needs (which means accommodating a minimum of 3 per cent per capita income growth in developing countries); energy efficiency and conservation measures, such that waste of primary resources is minimized; public health, recognizing the problems of risks to safety inherent in energy sources; and protection of the biosphere and prevention of more localized forms of pollution. 5. The period ahead must be regarded as transitional from an era in which energy has been used in an unsustainable manner. A generally acceptable pathway to a safe and sustainable energy future has not yet been found. We do not believe that these dilemmas have yet been addressed by the international community with a sufficient sense of urgency and in a global perspective. I. Energy, Economy, and Environment 6. The growth or energy demand in response to industrialization, urbanization, and societal affluence has led to an extremely uneven global distribution of primary energy consumption./1 The consumption of energy per person in industrial market economies, for example, is more than 80 times greater than in sub-Saharan Africa. (See Table 7-1.) And about a quarter of the world's population consumes three-quarters of the world's primary energy. Table 7-1 Global Primary Energy Consumption Per Capita, 1984 GNP Per Capita Energy Consumption Mid-1984 Population Total Consumption (1984 dollars) (kW per capita*) (million) (TW) World Bank GNP Economy Category
  • 143. Low Income 260 0.41 2,390 0.99 Sub-Saharan Africa 210 0.08 258 0.02 Lower-middle 740 0.57 691 0.39 Upper-middle 1,950 1.76 497 0.87 Sub-Saharan Africa 660 0.25 148 0.04 High-Income Oil Exporters 11,250 5.17 19 0.10 Industrial Market Economies 11,430 7.01 733 5.14 East European Non-Market Economies 6.27 389 2.44 World 2.11** 4.718 9.94 *kW per capita is kW years/year per capita. ** Population-weighted average energy consumption (kW/capita) for first three main categories is 0.654 and for industrial market and East European categories is 6.76. Source: Based on World Bank, World Development Report 1985 (New York: Oxford University Press, 1986). 7. In 1980, global energy consumption stood at around 10TW./2 (See Box 7-1.) if per capita use remained at the same levels as today, by 2025 a global population of 6.2 billion/3 would need about 14TW (over 4TW in developing and over 9TW in industrial countries) - an increase of 40 per cent over 1980. But if energy consumption per head became uniform worldwide at current industrial country levels, by 2025 that same global population would require about 55TW. Box 7-1 Energy Units A variety of units are used to measure energy production and use in physical terms. This chapter user; the kilowatt (kW); the Gigawatt (GW), which is equal to 1 million kW; and the Terawatt (TW), which is equal to 1 billion kilowatts. One kilowatt - a thousand watts of energy - if emitted continuously for a year is lkW year. Consuming 1 kW year/year is equivalent to the energy liberated by burning 1,050 kilogrammes - approximately 1 ton - of coal annually. Thus a TW year is equal to approximately 1 billion tons of coal. Throughout the chapter, TW years/year is written as TW. 8. Neither the 'low' nor the 'high' figure is likely to prove realistic, but they give a rough idea of the range within which energy futures could move, at least hypothetically. Many other scenarios can be generated in-between, some of which assume an improved energy base for the developing world. For instance, if the average energy consumption in the low- and middle-income economies trebled and doubled, respectively, and if consumption in the high-income oil-exporting and industrial market and non-market countries remained the same as today,
  • 144. then the two groups would be consuming about the same amounts of energy. The low- and middle-income categories would need 10.5TW and the three 'high' categories would use 9.3TW - totalling 20TW globally, assuming that primary energy is used at the same levels of efficiency as today. 9. How practical are any of these scenarios? Energy analysts have conducted many studies of global energy futures to the years 2020-2030./4 Such studies do not provide forecasts of future energy needs, but they explore how various technical, economic, and environmental factors may interact with supply and demand. Two of these are reviewed in Box 7-2, though a much wider range of scenarios - from 5TW up to 63TW - are available. In general, the lower scenarios (14.4TW by 2030,/5 11.2TW by 2020./6 and 5.2 by 2030/7) require an energy efficiency revolution. The higher scenarios (18.8TW by 2025./8 24.7TW by 2020,/9 and 35.2 by 2030/10) aggravate the environmental pollution problems that we have experienced since the Second World War.
  • 145. Box 7-2 Two Indicative Energy Scenarios Case A: High Scenario By the year 2030, a 35TW future would involve producing 1.6 tines as much oil, 3.4 times as much natural gas, and nearly 5 times as much coal as in 1960. This increase in fossil fuel use implies bringing the equivalent of a new Alaska pipeline into production every one to two years. Nuclear capacity would have to be increased 30 times over 1960 levels - equivalent to installing a new nuclear power station generating 1-gigawatt of electricity every two to four days. This 35TW scenario is still well below the 55TW future that assumes today's levels of energy consumption per capita in industrial countries are achieved in all countries. Case B: Low Scenario Taking the 11.2TW scenario as a highly optimistic example of a strong conservation strategy. 2020 energy demand in developing and industrial countries is quoted as 7.3TW and 3.9TW respectively, as compared with 3.3TW and 7.0TW in 1980. This would mean a saving of 3.1TW in industrial countries by 2020 and an additional requirement of 4.0TW in developing countries. Even if developing countries were able to acquire the liberated primary resource, they would still be left with a shortfall of 0.9TW in primary supply. Such a deficit is likely to be much greater (possibly two to three times), given the extreme level of efficiency required for this scenario, which is unlikely to be realized by most governments. In 1980, the following breakdown of primary supply was quoted: oil, 4.2TW; coal, 2.4; gas, 1.7; renewables, 1.7; and nuclear, 0.2. The question is - where will the shortfall in primary energy supply come from? This rough calculation serves to illustrate that the postulated average growth of around 30 per cent per capita in primary consumption in developing countries will still require considerable amounts of primary supply even under extremely efficient energy usage regimes. Sources: The 35TW scenario was originated in Energy Systems Group of the International Institute for Applied Systems Analysis, Energy in a Finite World - A Global Systems Analysis, (Cambridge, Mass.: Ballinger, 1981); all other calculations are from J. Goldemberg et al., 'An End-Use Oriented Global Energy Strategy', Annual Review of Energy, Vol. 10, 1985. 10. The economic implications of a high energy future are disturbing. A recent World Bank Study indicates that for the period 1960-95, a 4.1 per cent annual growth in energy consumption, approximately comparable to Case A in Box 7-2, would require an average annual investment of some $130 billion (in 1982 dollars) in developing countries alone. This would involve doubling the share of energy investment in terms of aggregate gross domestic product./11 About half of this would have to come from foreign exchange and the rest from internal spending on energy in developing countries. 11. The environmental risks and uncertainties of a high energy future are also disturbing and give rise to several reservations. Four stand out: the serious probability of climate change generated by the 'greenhouse effect' of gases
  • 146. emitted to the atmosphere, the most important of which is carbon dioxide (CO2) produced from the combustion of fossil fuels/12; urban-industrial air pollution caused by atmospheric pollutants from the combustion of fossil fuels/13; acidification of the environment from the same causes/14; and the risks of nuclear reactor accidents, the problems of waste disposal and dismantling of reactors after their service life is over, and the dangers of proliferation associated with the use of nuclear energy. Along with these, a major problem arises from the growing scarcity of fuelwood in developing countries. If trends continue, by the year 2000 around 2.4 billion people may be living in areas where wood is extremely scarce./15 12. These reservations apply at even lower levels of energy use. A study that proposed energy consumption at only half the levels of Case A (Box 7-2) drew special attention to the risks of global warning from CO2./16 The study indicated that a realistic fuel mix - a virtual quadrupling of coal and a doubling of gas use, along with 1.4 times as much oil - could cause significant global warming by the 2020s. No technology currently exists to remove CO2 emissions from fossil fuel combustion. The high coal use would also increase emissions of oxides of sulphur and nitrogen, much of which turns to acids in the atmosphere. Technologies to remove these latter emissions are now required in some countries in all new and even some old facilities, but they can increase investment costs by 15-25 per cent./17 If countries are not prepared to incur these expenses, this path becomes even more infeasible, a limitation that applies much more to the higher energy futures that rely to a greater extent on fossil fuels. A near doubling of global primary energy consumption will be difficult without encountering severe economic, social, and environmental constraints. Energy is, put most simply, the fundamental unit of the physical world. As such, we cannot conceive of development without changes in the extent or the nature of energy flows. And because it is so fundamental, every one of those changes of flows has environmental implications. The implications of this are profound. It means that there is no such thing as a simple energy choice. They are all complex. And they all involve trade-offs. However, some of the choices and some of the trade-offs appear to be unequivocally better than others, in the sense that they offer more development and less environmental damage. David Brooks Friends of the Earth WCED Public Hearings Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 13. This raises the desirability of a lower energy future, where GDP growth is not constrained but where investment effort is switched away from building more primary supply sources and put into the development and supply of highly efficient fuel-saving end-use equipment. In this way, the energy services needed by society could be supplied at much reduced levels of primary energy production. Case B in Box 7-2 allows for a 50 per cent fall in per capita primary energy consumption in industrial countries and a 30 per cent increase in developing countries./18 By using the most energy-efficient technologies and processes now available in all sectors of the
  • 147. economy, annual global per capita GDP growth rates of around 3 per cent can be achieved. This growth is at least as great as that regarded in this report as a minimum for reasonable development. But this path would require huge structural changes to allow market penetration of efficient technologies, and it seems unlikely to be fully realizable by most governments during the next 40 years. 14. The crucial point about these lower, energy-efficient futures is not whether they are perfectly realisable in their proposed time frames. Fundamental political and institutional shifts are required to restructure investment potential in order to move along these lower, more energy-efficient paths. 15. The Commission believes that there is no other realistic option open to the world for the 21st century. The ideas behind these lower scenarios are not fanciful. Energy efficiency has already shown cost-effective results. In many industrial countries, the primary energy required to produce a unit of GDP has fallen by as much as a quarter or even a third over the last 13 years, much of it from implementing energy efficiency measures./19 Properly managed, efficiency measures could allow industrial nations to stabilize their primary energy consumption by the turn of the century. They would also enable developing countries to achieve higher levels of growth with much reduced levels of investment, foreign debt, and environmental damage. But by the early decades of the 21st century they will not alleviate the ultimate need for substantial new energy supplies globally. II. Fossil Fuels: The Continuing Dilemma 16. Many forecasts of recoverable oil reserves and resources suggest that oil production will level off by the early decades of the next century and then gradually fall during a period of reduced supplies and higher prices. Gas supplies should last over 200 years and coal about 3.000 years at present rates of use. These estimates persuade many analysts that the world should immediately embark on a vigorous oil conservation policy. 17. In terms of pollution risks, gas is by far the cleanest fuel, with oil next and coal a poor third. But they all pose three interrelated atmospheric pollution problems: global warming,/20 urban industrial air pollution,/21 and acidification of the environment./22 Some of the wealthier industrial countries may possess the economic capacity to cope with such threats. Most developing countries do not. 18. These problems are becoming more widespread particularly in tropical and subtropical regions, but their economic, social, and political repercussions are as yet not fully appreciated by society. With the exception of CO2, air pollutants can be removed from fossil fuel combustion processes at costs usually below the costs of damage caused by pollution./23 However, the risks of global warming make heavy future reliance upon fossil fuels problematic. 1. Managing Climatic change 19. The burning of fossil fuels and, to a lesser extent, the loss of vegetative cover, particularly forests, through urban-industrial growth increase the accumulation of CO2 in the atmosphere. The pre-industrial concentration was about 280 parts of carbon dioxide per million parts of air by volume. This concentration reached 340 in 1980 and is expected to double to 560 between the middle and the end of the next century./24 Other gases also play an important role in this 'greenhouse effect', whereby solar radiation is trapped near the ground, warming the globe and changing the climate.
  • 148. 20. After reviewing the latest evidence on the greenhouse effect in October 1985 at a meeting in Villach, Austria, organized by the WMO, UNEP, and ICSU, scientists from 29 industrialized and developing countries concluded that climate change must be considered a 'plausible and serious probability. They further concluded that: 'Many important economic and social decisions are being made today on ... major water resource management activities such as irrigation and hydropower; drought relief; agricultural land use; structural designs and coastal engineering projects; and energy planning - all based on the assumption that past climatic data, without modification, are a reliable guide to the future. This is no longer a good assumption'./25 21. They estimated that if present trends continue, the combined concentration of CO2 and other greenhouse gases in the atmosphere would be equivalent to a doubling of CO2 from pre-industrial levels, possibly as early as the 2030s, and could lead to a rise in global mean temperatures 'greater than any in man's history'./26 Current modelling studies and 'experiments' show a rise in globally averaged surface temperatures, for an effective CO2 doubling, of somewhere between 1.5°C and 4.5°C, With the warming becoming more pronounced at higher latitudes during winter than at the equator. 22. An important concern is that a global temperature rise of 1.5-4.5°C, with perhaps a two to three times greater warming at the poles, would lead to a sea level rise of 25-140 centimetres./27 A rise in the upper part of this range would inundate low-lying coastal cities and agricultural areas, and many countries could expect their economic, social, and political structures to be severely disrupted. It would also alow the 'atmospheric heat-engine', which is driven by the differences between equatorial and polar temperatures, thus influencing rainfall regimes./28 Experts believe that crop and forest boundaries will move to higher latitudes; the effects of warmer oceans on marine ecosystems or fisheries and food chains are also virtually unknown. 23. There is no way to prove that any of this will happen until it actually occurs. The key question is: How much certainty should governments require before agreeing to take action? If they wait until significant climate change is demonstrated, it may be too late for any countermeasures to be effective against the inertia by then stored in this massive global system. The very long time lags involved in negotiating international agreement on complex issues involving all nations have led some experts to conclude that it is already late./29 Given the complexities and uncertainties surrounding the issue, it is urgent that the process start now. A four track strategy is needed, combining: improved monitoring and assessment of the evolving phenomena; increased research to improve knowledge about the origins, mechanisms, and effects of the phenomena; the development of internationally agreed policies for the reduction of the causative gases; and adoption of strategies needed to minimize damage and cope with the climate changes, and rising sea level. 24. No nation has either the political mandate or the economic power to combat climatic change alone. However, the Villach statement recommended such a four track strategy for climate change, to be promoted by governments and the scientific community through WMO, UNEP, and ICSU - backed by a global convention if necessary./30
  • 149. It is difficult to imagine an issue with more global impacts on human societies and the natural environment than the greenhouse effect. The signal is unclear but we may already be witnessing examples, if not actual greenhouse effects, in Africa. The ultimate potential impacts of a greenhouse warming could be catastrophic. It is our considered judgement that it is already very late to start the process of policy consideration. The process of heightening public awareness, of building support for national policies, and finally for developing multilateral efforts to slow the rate of emissions growth will take time to implement. The greenhouse issue is an opportunity as well as a challenge; not surprisingly, it provides another important reason to implement sustainable development strategies. Irving Mintzer World Resources Institute WCED Public Hearing Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 25. While these strategies are being developed, more immediate policy measures can and should be adopted. The most urgent are those required to increase and extend the recent steady gains in energy efficiency and to shift the energy mix more towards renewables. Carbon dioxide output globally could be significantly reduced by energy efficiency measures without any reduction of the tempo of GDP growth./31 These measures would also serve to abate other emissions and thus reduce acidification and urban-industrial air pollution. Gaseous fuels produce less carbon dioxide per unit of energy output than oil or coal and should be promoted, especially for cooking and other domestic uses. 26. Gases other than carbon dioxide are thought to be responsible for about one-third of present global warming, and it is estimated that they will cause about half the problem around 2030./32 some of these, notably chlorofluorocarbons used as aerosols, refrigeration chemicals, and in the manufacture of plastics, may be more easily controlled than CO2. These, although not strictly energy-related, will have a decisive influence on policies for managing carbon dioxide emissions. 27. Apart from their climatic effect, chlorofluorocarbons are responsible to a large extent for damage to the earth's stratospheric ozone./33 The chemical industry should make every effort to find replacements, and governments should require the use of such replacements when found (as some nations have outlawed the use of these chemicals as aerosols). Governments should ratify the existing ozone convention and develop protocols for the limitation of chlorofluorocarbon emissions, and systematically monitor and report implementation. 28. A lot of policy development work is needed. This should proceed hand in hand with accelerated research to reduce remaining scientific uncertainties. Nations urgently need to formulate and agree upon management policies for all environmentally reactive chemicals released into the atmosphere by human activities, particularly those that can influence the radiation balance on earth. Governments should initiate discussions leading to a convention on this matter. 29. If a convention on chemical containment policies cannot be implemented rapidly, governments should develop contingency strategies and plans for adaptation to climatic
  • 150. change. In either case, WMO, UNEP, WHO, ICSU, and other relevant international and national bodies should be encouraged to coordinate and accelerate their programmes to develop a carefully integrated strategy of research, monitoring, and assessment of the likely impacts on climate, health, and environment of all environmentally reactive chemicals released into the atmosphere in significant quantities. 2. Reducing Urban-Industrial Air Pollution 30. The past three decades of generally rapid growth worldwide have seen dramatic increases in fuel consumption for heating and cooling, automobile transport, industrial activities, and electricity generation. Concern over the effects of increasing air pollution in the late 1960s resulted in the development of curative measures, including air-quality criteria, standards, and add-on control technologies that can remove pollutants cost-effectively. All these greatly reduced emissions of some of the principal pollutants and cleaned air over many cities. Despite this, air pollution has today reached serious levels in the cities of several industrial and newly industrialized countries as well as in those of most developing countries, which in some cases are by now the world's most polluted urban areas. 31. The fossil fuel emissions of principal concern in terms of urban pollution, whether from stationary or mobile sources, include sulphur dioxide, nitrogen oxides, carbon monoxide, various volatile organic compounds, fly ash, and other suspended particles. They can injure human health and the environment, bringing increased respiratory complaints, some potentially fatal. But these pollutants can be contained so as to protect human health and the environment and all governments should take steps to achieve acceptable levels of air quality. 32. Governments can establish and monitor air quality goals and objectives, allowable atmospheric loadings, and related emission criteria or standards, as some successfully do already. Regional organizations can support this effort. Multilateral and bilateral development assistance agencies and development banks should encourage governments to require that the most energy-efficient technology be used when industries and energy utilities plan to build new or extend existing facilities. 3. Damage from the Long-Range Transport of Air Pollution 33. Measures taken by many industrialized countries in the 1970s to control urban and industrial air pollution (high chimney stacks, for example) greatly improved the quality of the air in the cities concerned. However, it quite unintentionally sent increasing amounts of pollution across national boundaries in Europe and North America, contributing to the acidification of distant environments and creating new pollution problems. This was manifest in growing damage to lakes, soils, and communities of plants and animals./34 Failure to control automobile pollution in some regions has seriously contributed to the problem. 34. Thus atmospheric pollution, once perceived only as a local urban-industrial problem involving people's health, is now also seen as a much more complex issue encompassing buildings, ecosystems, and maybe even public health over vast regions. During transport in the atmosphere, emissions of sulphur and nitrogen oxides and volatile hydrocarbons are transformed into sulphuric and nitric acids, ammonium salts, and ozone. They fall to the ground, sometimes many hundreds or thousands of kilometres from their origins, as dry particles or in rain, snow, frost, fog, and dew. Few studied of their socio-economic costs are available, but these demonstrate that they are quite large and suggest that they are growing rapidly./35 They damage vegetation, contribute to land and water pollution, and corrode
  • 151. buildings, metallic structures and vehicles, causing billions of dollars in damage annually. 35. Damage first became evident in Scandinavia in the 1960s. Several thousand lakes in Europe, particularly in southern Scandinavia/36, and several hundreds in North America/37 have registered a steady increase in acidity levels to the point where their natural fish populations have declined or died out. The same acids enter the soil and groundwater, increasing corrosion of drinking water piping in Scandinavia./38 36. The circumstantial evidence indicating the need for action on the sources of acid precipitation is mounting with a speed that gives scientists and governments little time to assess it scientifically. Some of the greatest observed damage has been reported in Central Europe, which is currently receiving more than one gramme of sulphur on every square metre of ground each year, at least five times greater than natural background./39 There was little evidence of tree damage in Europe in 1970. In 1962, the Federal Republic of Germany reported visible leaf damage in its forest plot samples nationwide, amounting in 1983 to 34 per cent, and rising in 1985 to BO per cent./40 Sweden reported light to moderate damage in 30 per cent of its forests, and various reports from other countries in Eastern and Western Europe are extremely disquieting. So far an estimated 14 per cent of all European forestland is affected./41 37. The evidence is not all in, but many reports show soils in parts of Europe becoming acid throughout the tree rooting layers,/42 particularly nutrient-poor soils such as those of Southern Sweden/43 The precise damage mechanisms are not known, but all theories include an air pollution component. Root damage/44 and leaf damage appear to interact - affecting the ability of the trees both to take up water from the soil and to retain it in the foliage, so that they become particularly vulnerable to dry spells and other stresses. Europe may be experiencing an immense change to irreversible acidification, the remedial costs of which could be beyond economic reach./45 (See Box 7-3.) Although there are many options for reducing sulphur, nitrogen, and hydrocarbon emissions, no single pollutant control strategy is likely to be effective in dealing with forest decline. It will require a total integrated mix of strategies and technologies to improve air quality, tailored for each region. A forest in an ecosystem that exists under certain environmental conditions, and if you change the conditions, the system is going to change. It is a very difficult task for ecologists to foresee what changes are going to be because the systems are so enormously complex. The direct causes behind an individual tree dying can be far removed from the primary pressure that brought the whole system into equilibrium. One time it might be ozone, another time it may be SO2, a third time it may be aluminium poisoning. I can express myself by an analogy: If there is famine, there are relatively few people who die directly from starvation: they die from dysentery or various infectious diseases. And in such a situation, it is not of very much help to send medicine instead of food. That means that in this situation, it is necessary to address the primary pressures against the ecosystem. Alf Johnels Swedish Museum of Natural History WCED Public Hearing Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 38. Evidence of local air pollution and acidification in Japan and also in the newly
  • 152. industrialized countries of Asia, Africa, and Latin America is beginning to emerge. China and the Republic of Korea seem particularly vulnerable, as do Brazil, Colombia, Ecuador, and Venezuela. So little is known about the likely environmental loading of sulphur and nitrogen in these region and about the acid-neutralizing capacity of tropical lakes and forest soils that a comprehensive programme of investigation should be formulated without delay./46 39. Where actual or potential threats from acidification exist, governments should map sensitive areas, assess forest damage annually and soil impoverishment every five years according to regionally agreed protocols, and publish the findings. They should support transboundary monitoring of pollution being carried out by agencies in their region and, where there is no such agency, create one or give the job to any suitable regional body. Governments in many regions could gain significantly from early agreement to prevent transboundary air pollution and the enormous damage to their economic base now being experienced in Europe and North America. Even though the exact causes of the damage are hard to prove, reduction strategies are certainly within reach and economic. They could be viewed as a cheap insurance policy compared with the vast amount of potential damage these strategies avoid.
  • 153. Box 7-3 The Damage and Control Costs of Air Pollution It is very difficult to quantify damage control costs, not least because cost figures are highly dependent on the control strategy assumed. However, in the eastern United States, it has been estimated that halving the remaining sulphur dioxide emissions from existing sources would cost $5 billion a year, increasing present electricity rates by 2-3 per cent. If nitrogen oxides are figured in, the additional costs might be as high as $6 billion a year. Materials corrosion damage alone is estimated to cost $7 billion annually in 17 states in the eastern United states. Estimates of the annual costs of securing a 55 to 65 per cent reduction in the remaining sulphur emissions in the countries of the European Economic Community between 1980 and 2000 range from $4.6 billion to $6.7 billion (1982 dollars) per year. Controls on stationary boilers to reduce nitrogen levels by only 10 per cent annually by the year 2000 range between $100,000 and $400,000 (1982 dollars). These figures translate into a one-time increase of about 6 per cent in the price of electrical power to the consumer. Studies place damage costs due to material and fish losses alone at $3 billion a year, while damage to crops, forests, and health are estimated to exceed $10 billion per year. Technologies for drastically reducing oxides of nitrogen and hydrocarbons from automobile exhaust gases are readily available and routinely used in North America and Japan, but not in Europe. Japanese laboratory studies indicate that air pollution and acid rain can reduce some wheat and rice crop production, perhaps by as much as 30 per cent. Sources: U.S. Congress, Office of Technology Assessment, Acid Rain and Transported Air Pollutants: Implications for Public Policy (Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1985); U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Acid Deposition Assessment (Washington, DC: 1985); I.M. Torrens, 'Acid Rain and Air Pollution: A Problem of Industrialization', prepared for WCED, 1985; P. Mandelbaum, Acid Rain - Economic Assessment (New York: Plenum Press, 1985); M. Hashimoto, 'National Air quality Management Policy of Japan', prepared for WCED, 1985; OECD, The State of the Environment (Paris: 1985). III. Nuclear Energy: Unsolved Problems 1. The Peaceful Atom 40. In the years following the Second World War, the nuclear knowledge that under military control had led to the production of atomic weapons was redeployed for peaceful 'energy' purposes by civilian technologists. Several benefits were obvious at the time. 41. It was also realized that no energy source would ever be risk-free. There was the danger of nuclear war, the spread of atomic weapons, and nuclear terrorism. But intensive international cooperation and a number of negotiated agreements suggested that these dangers could be avoided. For instance, the Nonproliferation Treaty (NPT), drafted in its final form in 1969, included a promise by signatory governments possessing nuclear weapons and expertise to pursue and undertake nuclear disarmament ad also to assist the non-nuclear signatories in
  • 154. developing nuclear power, but strictly for peaceful purposes only. Other problems, such as radiation risks, reactor safety, and nuclear waste disposal were all acknowledged as very important but, with the right amount of effort, containable. 42. And now, after almost four decades of immense technological effort to support nuclear development, nuclear energy has become widely used. Some 30 governments produce from nuclear generators a total of about 15 per cent of all the electricity used globally. Yet it has not met earlier expectations that it would be the key to ensuring an unlimited supply of low-cost energy. However, during this period of practical experience with building and running nuclear reactors, the nature of the costs, risks and benefits have become much more evident and as such, the subject of sharp controversy. 2. The Growing Understanding of Nuclear Issues 43. The potential for the spread of nuclear weapons is one of the most serious threats to world peace. It is in the interest of all nations to prevent proliferation of nuclear weapons. All nations therefore should contribute to the development of a viable non-proliferation regime. The nuclear weapon states must deliver on their promise to reduce the number and ultimately eliminate nuclear weapons in their arsenals and the role those weapons play in their strategies. And the non-nuclear-weapon states must cooperate in providing credible assurances that they are not moving towards a nuclear weapon capability. The health risks for the development of peaceful uses of nuclear technology, including nuclear electricity, are very small when compared with the benefits from the use of nuclear radiation for medical diagnosis treatment. The safe application of nuclear radiation technology promises many benefits in environmental clean-up and in increasing world food supplies by eliminating spoilage. With a recent and very notable exception, the international cooperation that has marked the development of nuclear power technology provides an excellent model by which to address common environmental and ethical problems posed by the development of other technologies. Ian Wilson Vice-President, Canadian Nuclear Association WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 44. Most schemes for non-proliferation mandate an institutional separation between military and civilian uses of nuclear energy. But for countries with full access to the complete nuclear fuel cycle, no technical separation really exists. Not all states operate the necessary clear-cut administrative separation of civilian and military access. Cooperation is needed also among suppliers and buyers of civilian nuclear facilities and materials and the International Atomic Energy Agency, in order to provide credible safeguards against the diversion of civilian reactor programmes to military purposes, especially in countries that do not open all their nuclear programmes to IAEA inspection. Thus, there still remains a danger of the proliferation of nuclear weapons.
  • 155. 2.1 Costs 45. The costs of construction and the relative economics of electricity generating stations - whether powered by nuclear energy, coal, oil or gas - are conditioned by the following factors throughout the service life of a plant: the cost of borrowing money to finance plant construction, the impact of inflation; the duration of the period of planning, licensing, and construction; the cost of fuel and maintenance ; the costs of protective measures, to ensure safe operation; and waste disposal costs (land, air, and water pollution containment) and the costs of dismantling at the end of service life. 46. All these factors vary widely depending on differing institutional, legal, and financial arrangements in different countries. Cost generalizations and comparisons are therefore unhelpful or misleading. However, costs associated with several of these factors have increased more rapidly for nuclear stations during the last 5-10 years, so that the earlier clear cost advantage of nuclear over the service life of the plant has been reduced or lost altogether./47 Nations should therefore look very closely at cost comparisons to obtain the best value when choosing an energy path. 2.2 Health and Environment Risks 47. Very strict codes of safety practice are implemented in nuclear plants so that under officially approved operating conditions, the danger from radiation to reactor personnel and especially to the general public is negligible. However, an accident occurring in a reactor may in certain very rare canes be serious enough to cause an external release of radioactive substances. Depending upon the level of exposure, people are under a certain level of risk of becoming ill from various forms of cancer or from alteration or genetic material, which may result in hereditary defects. 48. Since 1928, the International Commission on Radiological Protection (ICRP) has issued recommendations on radiation dosage levels above which exposure is unacceptable. These have been developed for occupationally exposed workers and for the general public. The 'Nuclear Safety Standards (NUSS) codes of IAEA were developed in 1975 to reduce safety differences among member states. Neither system is in any way binding on governments, if an accident occurs, individual governments have the responsibility of deciding at what level of radioactive contamination pasture land, drinking water, milk, meat, eggs, vegetables, and fish, are to be banned for consumption by livestock or humans. 49. Different countries - even different local government authorities within a country - have different criteria. Some have none at all, ICRP and NUSS notwithstanding. States with more rigorous standards may destroy large amounts of food or may ban food imports from a neighbour states with more permissive criteria. This causes great hardship to farmers who may not receive any compensation for their losses. It may also cause trade problems and political
  • 156. tension between states. Both of these difficulties occurred following the Chernobyl disaster, when the need to develop at least regionally conformable contamination criteria and compensation arrangements was overwhelmingly demonstrated. 2.3 Nuclear Accidents Risks 50. Nuclear safety returned to the newspaper headlines following the Three Mile Island (Harrisburg, United States) and the Chernobyl (USSR) accidents. Probabilistic estimates of the risks of component failure, leading to a radioactive release in Western style light water reactors wore made in 1975 by the U.S. Nuclear Regulatory Commission./48 The most serious category of release through containment failure was placed at around 1 in 1,000,000 years of reactor operation. Post-accident analysis of both Harrisburg and Chernobyl - a completely different type of reactor - have shown that in both cases, human operator error was the main cause. They occurred after about 2,000 and 4,000 reactor-years respectively./49 The frequencies of such occurrences are well nigh impossible to estimate probabilistically. However, available analyses indicate that although the risk of a radioactive release accident is small, it is by no means negligible for reactor operations at the present time. 51. The regional health and environment effects of an accident are largely predictable from radioactive fall-out studies following early atomic weapons testing in the atmosphere and have been confirmed in practice following the Chernobyl accident. What could not be confidently predicted before Chernobyl were the local effects of such an accident. A much clearer picture is now emerging as a result of the experiences there when a reactor exploded, following a series of infringements of the official safety regulations, on 26 April 1986, causing the worst reactor accident ever experienced. As a result, the whole district had to be managed on something like a 'war footing' and efforts resembling a large military operation were needed to contain the damage. 2.4 Radioactive Waste Disposal 52. Civil nuclear energy programmes worldwide have already generated many thousands of tons of spent fuel and high-level waste. Many governments have embarked on large-scale programmes to develop ways of isolating these from the biosphere for the many hundreds of thousands of years that they will remain hazardously radioactive. 53. But the problem of nuclear waste disposal remains unsolved. Nuclear waste technology has reached an advanced level of sophistication./50 This technology has not however been fully tested or utilized and problems remain about disposal. There is particular concern about future recourse to ocean dumping and the disposal of contaminated waste in the territories of small or poor states that lack the capacity to impose strict safeguards. There should be a clear presumption that all countries that generate nuclear waste dispose of it within their own territories or under strictly monitored agreements between states. 3. The Current International Situation 54. During the last 25 years, a growing awareness of the difficulties outlined above has resulted in a wide range of reactions from technical experts, the public, and governments. Many experts still feel that so much can be learned from the problems experienced up to now. They argue that if the public climate allows then to solve the nuclear waste disposal and decommissioning issues and the cost of borrowing money remains reasonably below its 1980-82 peak, in the
  • 157. absence of viable new supply alternatives there is no reason why nuclear energy should not emerge as a strong runner in the 1990s. At the other extreme, many experts take the view that there are so many unsolved problems and too many risks for society to continue with a nuclear future. Public reactions also vary. Some countries have exhibited little public reaction, in others there appears to be a high level of anxiety that expresses itself in anti-nuclear results in public opinion polls or large anti-nuclear campaigns. Today the assessment of practical consequences can be based on practical experience. The consequences of Chernobyl has made Soviet specialists once again pose a question: Is not the development of nuclear energy on an industrial scale premature? Will it not be fatal to our civilization, to the ecosystem of our planet? On our planet so rich in all sorts of energy sources, this question can be discussed quite calmly. We have a real choice in this, both on a state and a governmental level, and also on the level of individuals and professionals. We must put all our efforts to improve the technology itself, to develop and elaborate strict standards and norms of quality, of safety of a technology. We must work for the creation of anti-accident centres and centres devoting themselves to compensating for the losses to the environment. The upgrading of the industrial level of safety and the solution of the problem of the relations between man and machine would be a lot more natural thing to do than concentrating the efforts on only one element of the energy structure in the world. This would benefit the whole of humanity. V. A. Legasov Member, Academy of Sciences of the USSR WCED Public Hearing Moscow, 8 Dec 1986 55. And so, whilst some states still remain nuclear-free, today nuclear reactors supply about 15 per cent of all the electricity generated. Total electricity production worldwide is in turn equivalent to around 15 per cent of global primary energy supply. Roughly one-quarter of all countries worldwide have reactors. In 1986, there were 366 working and a further 140 planned,/51 with 10 governments possessing about 90 per cent of all installed capacity (more than 5 GW (e)). Of these, there are 8 with a total capacity of more than 9 GW (e),/52 which provided the following percentages of electric power in 1985: France, 65; Sweden, 42; Federal Republic of Germany, 31; Japan, 23; United Kingdom, 19; United States, 16; Canada, 13; and USSR, 10. According to IAEA, in 1985 there were 55 research reactors worldwide, 33 of them in developing countries./53 56. Nevertheless, there is little doubt that the difficulties referred to above have in one way or another contributed to a scaling back of future nuclear plans - in some countries, to a de facto nuclear pause. In Western Europe and North America, which today have almost 75 per cent of current world capacity, nuclear provides about one-third of the energy that was forecast for it 10 years ago. Apart from France, Japan, the USSR, and several other East European countries that have decided to continue with their nuclear programmes, ordering, construction, and licensing prospects for new reactors in many other countries look poor. In fact, between 1972 and 1986, earlier global projections of estimated capacity for the year 2000 have been revised downwards by a factor of nearly seven. Despite this, the growth of nuclear at around 15 per cent a year over the last 20 years is still impressive./54
  • 158. 57. Following Chernobyl, there were significant changes in the nuclear stance of certain governments. Several - notably China, the Federal Republic of Germany, France, Japan, Poland, United Kingdom, United States, and the USSR - have maintained or reaffirmed their pro-nuclear policy. Others with a 'no nuclear' or a 'phase-out' policy (Australia, Austria, Denmark, Luxembourg, New Zealand, Norway, Sweden - and Ireland with an unofficial anti-nuclear position) have been joined by Greece and the Philippines. Meanwhile, Finland, Italy, the Netherlands, Switzerland, and Yugoslavia are re-investigating nuclear safety and/or the anti-nuclear arguments, or have introduced legislation tying any further growth of nuclear energy and export/import of nuclear reactor technology to a satisfactory solution of the problem of disposal of radioactive wastes. Several countries have been concerned enough to conduct referenda to test public opinion regarding nuclear power. 4. Conclusions and Recommendations 58. These national reactions indicate that as they continue to review and update all the available evidence, governments tend to take up three possible positions: remain non-nuclear and develop other sources of energy: regard their present nuclear power capacity as necessary during a finite period of transition, to safer alternative energy sources; or adopt and develop nuclear energy with the conviction that the associated problems and risks can and must, be solved with a level of safety that is both nationally and internationally acceptable. The discussion in the Commission also reflected these tendencies, views, and positions. 59. But whichever policy is adopted, it is important that the vigorous promotion of energy-efficient practices in all energy sectors and large-scale programmes of research, development, and demonstration for the safe and environmentally benign use of all promising energy sources, especially renewables, be given the highest, priority. 60. Because of potential transboundary effects, it is essential that governments cooperate to develop internationally agreed codes of practice covering technical, economic, social (including health and environment aspects), and political components of nuclear energy. In particular, international agreement must be reached on the following specific items: full governmental ratification of the conventions on 'Early Notification of a Nuclear Accident' (including the development of an appropriate surveillance and monitoring system) and on 'Assistance in the Case of a Nuclear Accident or Radiological Emergency' as recently developed by IAEA; emergency response training - for accident containment and for decontamination and long-term clean-up of affected sites, personnel, and ecosystems; the transboundary movement of all radioactive materials - including fuels, spent fuels, and other wastes by land, sea, or air; a code of practice on liability and compensation; standards for operator training and international licensing;
  • 159. codes of practice for reactor operation, including minimum safety standards; the reporting of routine and accidental discharges from nuclear installations; effective, internationally harmonized minimum radiological protection standards; agreed site selection criteria as well as consultation and notification prior to the siting of all major civil nuclear - related installations; standards for waste repositories; standards for the decontamination and dismantling of time-expired nuclear reactors; and problems posed by the development of nuclear powered shipping. 61. For many reasons, especially including the failure of the nuclear weapons states to agree on disarmament, the Nonproliferation Treaty has not proved to be a sufficient instrument to prevent the proliferation of nuclear weapons, which still remains a serious danger to world peace. We therefore recommend in the strongest terms the construction of an effective international regime covering all dimensions of the problem. Both nuclear weapons states and non nuclear weapons states, should undertake to accept safeguards in accordance with the statutes of IAEA. 62. Additionally, an international regulatory function is required, including inspection of reactors internationally. This should be quite separate from the role of IAEA in promoting nuclear energy. 63. The generation of nuclear power is only justifiable if there are solid solutions to the presently unsolved problems to which it gives rise. The highest priority must be accorded to research and development on environmentally sound and economically viable alternatives, as well as on means of increasing the safety of nuclear energy. IV. Wood Fuels: The Vanishing Resource 64. Seventy per cent of the people in developing countries use wood and, depending on availability, burn anywhere between an absolute minimum of about 350 kilogrammes to 2,900 kilogrammes of dry wood annually, with the average being around 700 kilogrammes per person./55 Rural woodfuel supplies appear to be steadily collapsing in many developing countries, especially in Sub-Saharan Africa./56 At the same time, the rapid growth of agriculture, the pace of migration to cities, and the growing numbers of people entering the money economy are placing unprecedented pressures on the biomass base/57 and increasing the demand for commercial fuels: from wood and charcoal to kerosene, liquid propane, gas, and electricity. To cope with this, many developing country governments have no option but to immediately organize their agriculture to produce large quantities of wood and other plant fuels. 65. Wood is being collected faster than it can regrow in many developing countries that still rely predominantly on biomass wood, charcoal, dung, and crop residues - for cooking, for heating their dwellings, and even for lighting. FAO estimates suggest that in 1900, around 1.3 billion people lived in wood-deficit areas./58 If this population-driven overharvesting continues at present rates, by the year 2000 some 2.4 billion people may be living in areas where wood is 'acutely scarce or has to be obtained elsewhere'. These figures reveal great human hardship. Precise data on supplies are unavailable because much of the wood is not commercially traded
  • 160. but collected by the users, principally women and children, but there is no doubt that millions are hard put to find substitute fuels, and their numbers are growing. 66. The fuelwood crisis and deforestation - although related are not the same problems. Wood fuels destined for urban and industrial consumers do tend to come from forests. But only a small proportion of that used by the rural poor comes from forests. Even in these cases, villagers rarely chop down trees; most collect dead branches or cut them from trees./59 67. When fuelwood is in short supply, people normally economize; when it is no longer available, rural people are forced to burn such fuels as cow dung, crop stems and husks, and weeds. Often this does no harm, since waste products such as cotton stalks are used. But the burning of dung and certain crop residues may in some cases rob the soil of needed nutrients. Eventually extreme fuel shortages can reduce the number of cooked meals and shorten the cooking time, which increases malnourishment. 68. Many urban people rely on wood, and most of this is purchased. Recently, as the price of wood fuels has been rising, poor families have been obliged to spend increasing proportions of their income on wood. In Addis Ababa and Maputo, families may spend a third to half of their incomes this way./60 Much work has been done over the past 10 years to develop fuel-efficient stoves, and some of these new models use 30-50 per cent less fuel. These, as well as aluminium cooking pots and pressure cookers that also use much less fuel, should be made more widely available in urban areas. Fuelwood and charcoal are, and will remain, the major sources of energy for the great majority of rural people in developing countries. The removal of trees in both semiarid and humid land in African countries is a result to a large extent of increasing V. Renewable Energy: The Untapped Potential 73. Renewable energy sources could in theory provide 10-13TW annually - equal to current global energy consumption./63 Today they provide about 2TW annually, about 21 per cent of the energy consumed worldwide, of which 15 per cent is biomass and 6 per cent hydropower. However, most of the biomass is in the form of fuelwood and agricultural and animal wastes. As noted above, fuelwood can no longer be thought of as a 'renewable' resource in many areas, because consumption rater have overtaken sustainable yields. 74. Although worldwide reliance on all these sources has been growing by more than 10 per cent a year since the late 1970s, it will be some time before they make up a substantial portion of the world's energy budget. Renewable energy systems are still in a relatively primitive stage of development. But they offer the world potentially huge primary energy sources, sustainable in perpetuity and available in one form or another to every nation on Earth. But it, will require a substantial and sustained commitment to further research and development if their potential is to be realized. 75. Wood as a renewable energy source is usually thought of as naturally occurring trees and shrubs harvested for local domestic use. Wood, however, is becoming an important feedstock, specially grown for advanced energy conversion processes in developing as well as industrial countries for the product ion of process heat, electricity, and potentially for other fuels, such as combustible gases and liquids. 76. Hydropower, second to wood among the renewables, has been expanding at nearly 4 per
  • 161. cent annually. Although hundreds of thousands of megawatts of hydropower have been harnessed throughout the world, the remaining potential is huge./64 In neighbouring developing countries, interstate cooperation in hydropower development could revolutionize supply potential especially in Africa. In the choice of resources to be utilized we should not stare at renewable resources of energy blindly, we should not blow it out of proportion, we should not promote it for the sake of the environment per se. Instead we should develop and utilize all resources available, renewable sources of energy included, as a long-term endeavour requiring a continuous and sustained effort that will not be subject to short-term economic fluctuations, in order that we, in Indonesia, will achieve a successful and orderly transition to a more diversified and balanced structure of energy supply and environmentally sound energy supply system, which is the ultimate goal of our policy. Speaker from the floor WCED Public Hearings Jakarta, 26 March 1985 77. Solar energy use is small globally, but it is beginning to assume an important place in the energy consumption patterns of some countries. Solar water and household heating is widespread in many parts of Australia, Greece, and the Middle East. A number of East European and developing countries have active solar energy programmes, and the United States and Japan support solar sales of several hundred million dollars a year. With constantly improving solar thermal and solar electric technologies, it is likely that their contribution will increase substantially. The cost of photovoltaic equipment has fallen from around $500-600 per peak watt to $5 and is approaching the $1-2 level where it can compete with conventional electricity production./65 But even at $5 per peak watt, it still provides electricity to remote places more cheaply than building power lines. 78. Wind power has been used for centuries - mainly for pumping water. Recently its use has been growing rapidly in regions such as California and Scandinavia. In these cases the wind turbines are used to generate electricity for the local electricity grid. The costs of wind-generated electricity, which benefited initially from substantial tax incentives, have fallen dramatically in California in the last five years and may possibly be competitive with other power generated there within a decade./66 Many countries have successful but small wind programmes, but the untapped potential is still high. 79. The fuel alcohol programme in Brazil produced about 10 billion litres of ethanol from sugar-cane in 1984 and replaced about 60 per cent of the gasoline that would have been required./67 The cost has been estimated at $50-60 per barrel of gasoline replaced. When subsidies are removed, and a true exchange rate is used, this is competitive at 1981 oil prices. With present lower oil prices, the programme has become uneconomical. But it saves the nation hard currency, and it provides the additional benefits of rural development, employment generation, increased self-reliance, and reduced vulnerability to crises in the world oil markets. 80. The use of geothermal energy, from natural underground heat sources, has been increasing at more than 15 per cent per year in both industrial and developing countries. The experience gained during the past decades could provide the basis for a major expansion of geothermal-capacity./ 68 By contrast, technologies for low-grade heat via heat pumps or from solar ponds
  • 162. and ocean thermal gradients are promising but still mostly at the research and development stage. 81. These energy sources are not without their health and environment risks. Although they range from rather trivial to very serious problems, public reactions to them are not necessarily in proportion to the damage sustained. For instance, some of the commonest difficulties with solar energy are, somewhat surprisingly, the injuries from roof falls during solar thermal maintenance and the nuisance of sun-glare off their glass surfaces. Or a modern wind turbine can be a significant noise nuisance to people living nearby. Yet, these apparently small problems often arouse very strong public reactions. 82. But these are still minor issues compared with the ecosystem destruction at hydropower sites or the uprooting of homesteads in the areas to be flooded, as well as the health risks from toxic gases generated by rotting submerged vegetation and soils, or from waterborne diseases such as schistosomiasis (snail fever). Hydrodams also act as an important barrier to fish migration and frequently to the movement of land animals. Perhaps the worst problem they pose is the danger of catastrophic rupture of the dam-wall and the sweeping away or flooding of human settlements downstream - about once a year somewhere in the world. This risk is small but not insignificant. 83. One of the most widespread chronic problems is the eye and lung irritation caused by woodsmoke in developing countries. When agricultural wastes are burned, pesticide residues inhaled from the dusts or smoke of the crop material can be a health problem. Modern biofuel liquids have their own special hazards. Apart from competing with food crops for good agricultural land, their production generates large quantities of organic waste effluent, which if not used as a fertilizer can cause serious water pollution. Such fuels, particularly methanol, may produce irritant or toxic combustion products. All these and many other problems, both large and small, will increase as renewable energy systems are developed. 84. Most renewable energy systems operate best at small to medium scales, ideally suited for rural and suburban applications. They are also generally labour-intensive, which should be an added benefit where there if surplus labour. They are less susceptible than fossil fuels to wild price fluctuations and foreign exchange costs. Most countries have some renewable resources, and their use can help nations move towards self-reliance. 85. The need for a steady transition to a broader and more sustainable mix of energy sources is beginning to become accepted. Renewable energy sources could contribute substantially to this, particularly with new and improved technologies, but their development will depend in the short run on the reduction or removal of certain economic and institutional constraints to their use. These are formidable in many countries. The high level of hidden subsidies for conventional fuels built into the legislative and energy programmes of most countries distorts choices against renewables in research and development, depletion allowances, tax write-offs, and direct support of consumer prices. Countries should undertake a full examination of all subsidies and other forms of support to various sources of energy and remove those that are not clearly justified. 86. Although the situation is changing rapidly in some jurisdictions, electrical utilities in most have a supply monopoly on generation that allows them to arrange pricing policies that discriminate against other, usually small, suppliers./69 In some countries a relaxation of this control, requiring utilities to accept power generated by industry, small systems, and individuals, has created opportunities for the development of renewables. Beyond that, requiring utilities to adopt an end-use approach in planning, financing, developing, and marketing energy can open the door to a wide range of energy-saving measures as well as
  • 163. renewables. 87. Renewable energy sources require a much higher priority in national energy programmes. Research, development, and demonstration projects should command funding necessary to ensure their rapid development and demonstration. With a potential of 10TW or so, even if 3-4TW were realized, it would make a crucial difference to future primary supply, especially in developing countries, where the background conditions exist for the success of renewables. The technological challenges of renewables are minor compared with the challenge of creating the social and institutional frameworks that will ease these sources into energy supply systems. 88. The Commission believes that every effort should be made to develop the potential for renewable energy, which should form the foundation of the global energy structure during the 21st Century. A much more concerted effort must be mounted if this potential is to be realized. But a major programme of renewable energy development will involve large costs and high risks, particularly massive-scale solar and biomass industries. Developing countries lack the resources to finance all but a small fraction of this cost although they will be important users and possibly even exporters. Large-scale financial and technical assistance will therefore be required. VI. Energy Efficiency: Maintaining the Momentum 89. Given the above analysis, the Commission believes that energy efficiency should be the cutting edge of national energy policies for sustainable development. Impressive gains in energy efficiency have been made since the first oil price shock in the 1970s. During the past 13 years, many industrial countries saw the energy content of growth fall significantly as a result of increases in energy efficiency averaging 1.7 per cent annually between 1973 and 1983./70 And this energy efficiency solution costs less, by savings made on the extra primary supplies required to run traditional equipment. 90. The cost-effectiveness of 'efficiency' as the most environmentally benign 'source' of energy is well established. The energy consumption per unit of output from the most efficient processes and technologies is one-third to less than one-half that of typically available equipment./71 91. This is true of appliances for cooking, lighting and refrigeration, and space cooling and heating - needs that are growing rapidly in most countries and putting severe pressures on the available supply systems. It is also true of agricultural cultivation and irrigation systems, of the automobile, and of many industrial processes and equipment. 92. Given the large disproportion in per capita energy consumption between developed and developing countries in general, it is clear that the scope and need for energy saving is potentially much higher in industrial than in developing countries. Nonetheless, energy efficiency is important everywhere. The cement factory, automobile, or irrigation pump in a poor country is fundamentally no different from its equivalent in the rich world. In both, there is roughly the same scope for reducing the energy consumption or peak power demand of these devices without loss of output or welfare. But poor countries will gain much more from such reductions. 93. The woman who cooks in an earthen pot over an open fire uses perhaps eight times more energy than an affluent neighbour with a gas stove and aluminium pans. The poor who light their homes with a wick dipped in a jar of kerosene get one-fiftieth of the illumination of a 100-watt electric bulb, but use just as much energy. These examples illustrate the tragic paradox of poverty. For the poor, the shortage of money is a greater limitation than the
  • 164. shortage of energy. They are forced to use 'free' fuels and inefficient equipment because they do not have the cash or savings to purchase energy-efficient fuels and end-use devices. Consequently, collectively they pay much more for a unit of delivered energy services. 94. In most cases, investments in improved end-use technologies save money over time through lowered energy-supply needs The costs of improving the end-use equipment is frequently much less than the cost of building more primary supply capacity. In Brazil, for example, it has been shown that for a discounted total investment of $4 billion in more efficient end-use technologies (such as more efficient refrigerators, street-lighting, or motors) it would be feasible to defer construction of 21 gigawatts of new electrical supply capacity, corresponding to a discounted capital savings for new supplies of $19 billion in the period 1986 to 2000./72 We must change our attitude towards consumption goods in developed countries and we must create technological advances that will allow us to carry on economic development using less energy. We must ask ourselves can we solve the problems of underdevelopment without using or increasing the tremendous amount of energy used by these countries. The idea that developing countries use very little energy is an incorrect idea. We find that the poorest countries of all have a different problem; their problem is inefficient use of energy. Medium countries such as Brazil use more efficient and modern sources of fuel. The great hope for these countries is that the future will be built not based on technologies of the past, but using advanced technology. This will allow them to leap forward in relation to countries that are already developed. Jose Goldemberg President, Companhia Energetica de Sao Paulo WCED Public Hearing Brasilia, 30 Oct 1985 95. There are many examples of successful energy efficiency programmes in industrial countries. The many methods used successfully to increase awareness include information campaigns in the media, technical press, and schools; demonstrations of successful practices and technologies; free energy audits; energy 'labelling' of appliances; and training in energy-saving techniques. These should be quickly and widely extended. Industrialized countries account for such a large proportion of global energy consumption that even small gains in efficiency can have a substantial impact on conserving reserves and reducing the pollution load on the biosphere. It is particularly important that consumers, especially large commercial and industrial agencies, obtain professional audits of their energy use. This kind of energy 'book-keeping' will readily identify those places in their consumption patterns where significant savings can be made. 96. Energy pricing policies play a critical role in stimulating efficiency. At present, they sometimes include subsidies and seldom reflect the real costs of producing or importing the energy, particularly when exchange rates are undervalued. Very rarely do they reflect the external damage costs to health, property, and the environment. Countries should evaluate all hidden and overt subsidies to see how far real energy costs can be passed on to the consumer. The true economic pricing of energy - with safeguards for the very poor - needs to be extended in all countries. Large numbers of countries both industrial and developing are already adopting such policies.
  • 165. 97. Developing countries face particular constraints in saving energy. Foreign exchange difficulties can make it hard to purchase efficient but costly energy conversion and end-use devices. Energy can often be saved cost-effectively by fine-tuning already functioning systems./73 But governments and aid agencies may find it less attractive to fund such measures than to invest in new large-scale energy supply hardware that is perceived as a more tangible symbol of progress. 98. The manufacture, import, or sale of equipment conforming to mandatory minimal energy consumption or efficiency standards is one of the most powerful and effective tools in promoting energy efficiency and producing predictable savings. International cooperation may be required when such equipment is traded from nation to nation. Countries and appropriate regional organizations should introduce and extend increasingly strict efficiency standards for equipment and mandatory labelling of appliances. 99. Many energy efficiency measures cost nothing to implement. But where investments are needed, they are frequently a barrier to poor households and small-scale consumers, even when pay-back times are short. In these latter cases, special small loan or hire-purchase arrangements are helpful. Where investment costs are not insurmountable, there are many possible mechanisms for reducing or spreading the initial investment, such as loans with favourable repayment periods and 'invisible' measures such as loans repaid by topping up the new, reduced energy bills to the pre-conservation levels. 100. Transport has a particularly important place in national energy and development planning. It is a major consumer of oil, accounting for 50-60 per cent of total petroleum use in most developing countries./74 It is often a major source of local air pollution and regional acidification of the environment in industrial and developing countries. Vehicle markets will grow much more rapidly in developing countries, adding greatly to urban air pollution, which in many cities already exceeds international norms. Unless strong action is taken, air pollution could become a major factor limiting industrial development in many Third World cities. 101. In the absence of higher fuel prices, mandatory standards providing for a steady increase in fuel economy may be necessary. Either way, the potential for substantial future gains in fuel economy is enormous. If momentum can be maintained, the current average fuel consumption of approximately 10 litres per 100 kilometres in the fleet of vehicles in use in industrial countries could be cut in half by the turn of the century./75 102. A key issue is how developing countries can rapidly improve the fuel economy of their vehicles when these are, on average, used for twice as long those as in industrial countries, cutting rates of renewal and improvement in half. Licensing and import agreements should be reviewed to ensure access to the best available fuel efficient designs and production processes. Another important fuel-saving strategy especially in the growing cities of developing countries is the organizing of carefully planned public transport systems. 103. Industry accounts for 40 60 pet cent of all energy consumed in industrial countries and 10-40 per cent in developing countries. (See Chapter 6.) There has been significant improvement in the energy efficiency of production equipment, processes, and products. In developing countries, energy savings of as much as 20-30 per cent could be achieved by such skilful management of industrial development. 104. Agriculture worldwide is only a modest energy consumer, accounting for about 3.5 per cent of commercial energy use in the industrial countries and 4.5 per cent in developing countries as a whole./76 A strategy to double food production in the Third World through
  • 166. increases in fertilizers, irrigation, and mechanization would add 140 million tons of oil equivalent to their agricultural energy use. This is only some 5 per cent of present world energy consumption and almost certainly a small part of the energy that could be saved in other sectors in the developing world through appropriate efficiency measures./77 105. Buildings offer enormous scope for energy savings, and perhaps the most widely understood ways of increasing energy efficiency are in the home and workplace. Buildings in the tropics are now commonly designed to avoid as much direct solar heating as possible by having very narrow east- and west-facing walls, but with long sides facing north and south and protected from the overhead sun by recessed windows or wide sills. 106. An important method of heating buildings is by hot water produced during electricity production and piped around whole districts, providing both heat and hot water. This extremely efficient use of fossil fuels demands a coordination of energy supply with local physical planning, which few countries are institutionally equipped to handle./78 Where it has been successful, there has usually been local authority involvement in or control of regional energy-services boards, such as in Scandinavia and the USSR. Given the development of these or similar institutional arrangements, the cogeneration of heat and electricity could revolutionize the energy efficiency of buildings worldwide. VII. Energy Conservation Measures 107. There is general agreement that the efficiency gains achieved by some industrialized countries over the past 13 years were driven largely by higher energy prices, triggered by higher oil prices. Prior to the recent fall in oil prices, energy efficiency was growing at a rate of 2.0 per cent annually in some countries, having increased gradually year by year./79 108. It is doubtful whether such steady improvements can be maintained and extended if energy prices are held below the level needed to encourage the design and adoption of more energy-efficient homes, industrial processes, and transportation vehicles. The level required will vary greatly within and between countries, depending on a wide range of factors. But whatever it is, it should be maintained. In volatile energy markets, the question is how. 109. Nations intervene in the 'market price' of energy in a variety of ways. Domestic taxes (or subsidies) on electrical power rates, oil, gas and other fuels are most common. They vary greatly between and even within countries where different states, provinces, and sometimes even municipalities have the right to add their own tax. Although taxes on energy have seldom been levied to encourage the design and adoption of efficiency measures, they can have that result if they cause energy prices to rise beyond a certain level - a level that varies greatly among jurisdictions. 110. Some nations also maintain higher than market prices on energy through duties on imported electricity, fuel, and fuel products. Others have negotiated bilateral pricing arrangements with oil and gas producers in which they stabilize prices for a period of time. 111. In most countries, the price of oil eventually determines the price of alternative fuels. Extreme fluctuations in oil prices, such as the world has experienced recently, endanger programmes to encourage conservation. Many positive energy developments worldwide that made sense with oil above $25 per barrel, are harder to justify at lower prices. Investments in renewables, energy-efficient industrial processes, transport vehicles, and energy-services may be reduced. Most are needed to ease the transition to a safer and more sustainable energy future beyond this century. This goal requires a long, uninterrupted effort to succeed.
  • 167. 112. Given the importance of oil prices on international energy policy, the Commission recommends that new mechanisms for encouraging dialogue between consumers and producers be explored. 113. If the recent momentum behind annual gains in energy efficiency is to be maintained and extended, governments need to make it an explicit goal of their policies for energy pricing to consumers. Prices needed to encourage the adoption of energy-saving measures may be achieved by any of the above means or by other means. Although the Commission expresses no preference, conservation pricing requires that governments take a long-term view in weighing the costs and benefits of the various measures. They need to operate over extended periods, dampening wild fluctuations in the price of primary energy, which can impair progress towards energy conservation. VIII. Conclusion 114. It is clear that a low energy path is the best way towards a sustainable future. But given efficient and productive uses of primary energy, this need not mean a shortage of essential energy services. Within the next 50 years, nations have the opportunity to produce the same levels of energy services with as little as half the primary supply currently consumed. This requires profound structural changes in socio-economic and institutional arrangements and is an important challenge to global society. 115. More importantly, it will buy the time needed to mount major programmes on sustainable forms of renewable energy, and so begin the transition to a safer, more sustainable energy era. The development of renewable sources will depend in part on a rational approach to energy pricing to secure a stable matrix for such progress. Both the routine practice of efficient energy use and the development of renewables will help take pressure off traditional fuels, which are most needed to enable developing countries to realize their growth potential worldwide. 116. Energy is not so much a single product as a mix of products and services, a mix upon which the welfare of individuals, the sustainable development of nations, and the life-supporting capabilities of the global ecosystem depend. In the past, this mix has been allowed to flow together haphazardly, the proportions dictated by short-term pressures on and short-term goals of governments, institutions, and companies. Energy is too important for its development to continue in such a random manner. A safe, environmentally sound, and economically viable energy pathway that will sustain human progress into the distant future is clearly imperative. It is also possible. But it will require new dimensions of political will and institutional cooperation to achieve it. Footnotes 1/ World Bank, World Development Report 1986 (New York: Oxford University Press, 1986). 2/ British Petroleum Company, BP Statistical Review of World Energy (London: 1986). 3/ Medium variant in Department of International Economic and Social Affairs, World Population Prospects as Assessed in 1980, Population Studies No. 78 (Annex), and Long Range Population Projections of the World and Major Regions 2025-2150, Five Variants as Assessed in 1980 (New York: UN, 1981).
  • 168. 4/ For a useful comparison of various scenarios, see J. Goldemberg et al., 'An End-Use Oriented Global Energy strategy', Annual Review of Energy, Vol. 10, 1985; and W. Keepin et al., 'Emissions of CO2 into the Atmosphere', in B. Bolin et al. (eds.), The Greenhouse Effect, Climate Change and Ecosystems (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1986). 5/ U. Colombo and O. Bernadini, 'A Low Energy Growth Scenario and the Perspectives for Western Europe', Report for the Commission of the European Communities Panel on Low Energy Growth, 1979. 6/ Goldemberg et al., 'Global Energy Strategy', op. cit. 7/ A.B. Lovins et al., 'Energy Strategy for Low Climatic Risk', Report for the German Federal Environment Agency, 1981. 8/ J.A. Edmonds et al., 'An Analysis of Possible Future Atmospheric Retention of Fossil Fuel CO2', Report for U.S. Department of Energy, DOE/OR/21400 1, Washington, DC, 1984. 9/ J-R Frisch (ed.), Energy 2000-2020: World Prospects and Regional Stresses, World Energy Conference (London: Graham and Trotman, 1983). 10/ Energy Systems Group of the International Institute for Applied Systems Analysis, Energy in a Finite World - A Global Systems Analysis (Cambridge, Mass.: Ballinger, 1981). 11/ World Bank, The Energy Transition in Developing Countries (Washington, DC: 1983). 12/ World Meteorological Organization, A Report of the International Conference on the Assessment of the Role of Carbon Dioxide and of Other Greenhouse Gases in Climate Variations and Associated Impacts, Villach, Austria, 9-15 October 1985, WMO No. 661 (Geneva: WMO/ICSU/UNEP, 1986). 13/ B.N. Lohani, 'Evaluation of Air Pollution control Programmes and Strategies in Seven Asian Capital Cities', prepared for WCED, 1986; H. Weidner, 'Air Pollution Control Strategies and Policies in the Federal Republic of Germany', prepared for WCED, 1986; M. Hashimoto, 'National Air quality Management Policy of Japan', prepared for WCED, 1985; CETESB, 'Air Pollution Control Programme and Strategies in Brazil - Sao Paulo and Cubatao Areas, 1985', prepared for WCED, 1985. 14/ National Research Council, Acid Deposition: Long Term Trends (Washington, DC: National Academy Press, 1985); L.P. Muniz and H. Leiverstad, 'Acidification Effects on Freshwater Fish', in D. Drablos and A. Tollan (eds.), Ecological Impact of Acid Precipitation (Oslo: SNSF, 1980); L. Hallbacken and C.O. Tamm, 'Changes in Soil Acidity from 1927/ to 1982- 4 in a Forest Area of South West Sweden', Scandinavian Journal of Forest Research, No. 1, pp. 219-32, 1986. 15/ FAO, Fuelwood Supplies in the Developing Countries, Forestry Paper No. 42 (Rome: 1983); Z. Mikdashi, 'Towards a New Petroleum Order', Natural Resources Forum, October 1986. 16/ Edmonds et al., op. cit. 17/ I.M. Torrens, 'Acid Rain and Air Pollution, A Problem of Industrialization', prepared for WCED, 1985.
  • 169. 18/ Goldemberg et al., 'Global Energy Strategy', op. cit. 19/ British Petroleum Company, op. cit. 20/ WMO, Report of International Conference, op. cit.; I. Mintzer, 'Societal Responses to Global Warming', submitted to WCED Public Hearings, Oslo, 1985; F.K. Hare, 'The Relevance of Climate', submitted to WCED Public Hearings, Ottawa, 1986. 21/ Lohani, op. cit.; Weidner, op. cit.; Hashimoto, op. cit.; CETESB, op. cit. 22/ Torrens, op. cit.; F. Lixun and D. Zhao, 'Acid Rain in China', prepared for WCED, 1985; H. Rodhe, 'Acidification in Tropical Countries', prepared for WCED, 1985; G.T. Goodman, 'Acidification of the Environment, A Policy Ideas Paper', prepared for WCED, 1986. 23/ Torrens, op. cit. 24/ Bolin et al., op. cit. 25/ WMO, Report of International Conference, op. cit. 26/ Ibid. 27/ Ibid. 28/ Goldemberg et al., 'Global Energy Strategy', op. cit. 29/ Mintzer, op. cit. 30/ WMO, Report of International Conference, op. cit. 31/ D.J. Rose et al., Global Energy Futures and CO2 - Induced Climate Change, MITEL Report 83-015 (Cambridge, Mass.: Massachusetts Institute of Technology, 1983); A.M. Perry et al., 'Energy Supply and Demand Implication of CO2', Energy, Vol. 7, pp. 991-1004, 1982. 32/ Bolin et al., op. cit. 33/ G. Brasseur, The Endangered Ozone Layer: New Theories on Ozone Depletion', Environment, Vol. 29, No. 1, 1987. 34/ National Research Council, op. cit.; Muniz and Leiverstad, op. cit. 35/ OECD, The State of the Environment (Paris: 1985). 36/ Muniz and Leiverstad, op. cit. 37/ National Research Council, op. cit. 38/ National Swedish Environmental Protection Board, Air Pollution and Acidification (Solna, Sweden, 1986). 39/ J. Lehmhaus et al., 'Calculated and Observed Data for 1980 Compared at EMEP Measurement Stations', Norwegian Meteorological Institute, EMEP/MSO W Report 1 86, 1986; C.B. Epstein and M. Oppenheimer, 'Empirical Relation Between Sulphur Dioxide Emissions and Acid Deposition Derived from Monthly Data', Nature, No. 323, pp. 245-47, 1985.
  • 170. 40/ 'Neuartige Waldschaden in der Bundesrepublik Deutschland', Das Bundesministerium fur Ernahrung, Landwirtschaft und Forsten, 1983; 'Waldschaden Sernebungen', Das Bundesministerium fur Ernahrung, Landwirtschaft und Forsten, 1985; S. Nilsson, 'Activities of Teams of Specialists: Implications of Air Pollution Damage to Forests for Roundwood Supply and Forest Products Markets: Study on Extent of Damage', TIM/R 124 Add.1 (Restricted), 1986. 41/ S. Postel, 'Stabilizing Chemical Cycles' (after Allgemeine Forst Zeitschrift, Nos. 46 (1985) and 41 (1986)); in L.R. Brown et al., State of the World 1987 (London: W.W. Norton, 1987). 42/ T. Paces, 'Weathering Rates of Eneiss and Depletion of Exchangeable Cations in Soils Under Environmental Acidification', Journal Ecological Society, No. 143, pp. 673-77, 1986; T. Paces, 'Sources of Acidification in Contra] Europe Estimated from Elemental Budgets in Small Basins', Nature, No. 315, pp. 31-36, 1985. 43/ Hallbacken and Tamm, op. cit. 44/ G. Tyler et al., 'Metaller i Skogsmark - Deposition och omsattning', SNV PM 1692, Solna, Sweden, 1983. 45/ 'Neuartige Waldschaden', 1983, op. cit; Paces, 'Weathering Rates', op. cit. 46/ Rodhe, op. cit, 47/ R. Eden et al., Energy Economics (New York: Cambridge University Press, 1981); Nuclear Energy Agency, Projected Costs of Generating Electricity from Nuclear and Coal-Fired Power Stations for Commissioning in 1995 (Paris: OECD, 1986). 48/ Nuclear Regulatory Commission, Physical Processes in Reactor Meltdown Accidents, Appendix VIII to Reactor Safety Study (WASH-1400) (Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1975). 49/ S. Islam and K. Lindgren, 'How many reactor accidents will there be?', Nature, No. 122, pp. 691-92, 1986; A.W.K. Edwards, 'How many reactor accidents?' Nature, No. 324, pp 417-18, 1986. 50/ F.L. Parker et al., The Disposal of High Level Radioactive Waste - 1984, Vols. 1 & 2 (Stockholm: The Beijer Institute, 1984); F.L. Parker and R.E. Kasperson, International Radwaste Policies (Stockholm: The Beijer Institute, in press). 51/ International Atomic Energy Agency, Nuclear Power: Status and Trends, 1986 Edition (Vienna: 1986). 52/ 'World List of Nuclear Power Plants', Nuclear News, August 1986. 53/ IAEA Bulletin, Summer 1986. 54/ C, Flavin, 'Reassessing Nuclear Power', in Brown et al., op. cit.; British Petroleum Company, op. cit. 55/ G. Foley, 'Wood Fuel and Conventional Fuel Demands in the Developing World', Ambio, Vol. 14 No. 5, 1985. 56/ FAO, Fuelwood Supplies, op. cit.; FAO/UNEP, Tropical Forest Resources, Forestry
  • 171. Paper No. 30 (Rome: 1982). 57/ The Beijer Institute, Energy, Environment and Development in Africa, Vols, 1-10 (Uppsala, Sweden: Scandinavian Institute of African Studies, 1984 87); 'Energy Needs in Developing Countries', Ambio, Vol. 14, 1985; E.N. Chidumayo, 'Fuelwood and Social Forestry', prepared for WCED, 1985; G.T. Goodman, 'Forest-Energy in Developing Countries: Problems and Challenges', International Union of Forest Research Organizations, Proceedings, Ljubljana, Yugoslavia, 1986. 58/ FAO, Fuelwood Supplies, op. cit. 59/ Beijer Institute, op. cit.; J. Bandyopadhyay, 'Rehabilitation of Upland Watersheds', prepared for WCED, 1986. 60/ Beijer Institute, op. cit. 61/ R. Overend, 'Bioenergy Conversion Process: A Brief State of the Art and Discussion of Environmental Implications', International Union of Forestry Research Organization, Proceedings, Ljubljana, Yugoslavia, 1986. 62/ W. Fernandes and S. Kulkarni (eds.), Towards a New Forest Policy: People's Rights and Environmental Needs (New Delhi, India: Indian Social Institute, 1983); P.N. Bradley et al., 'Development Research and Energy Planning in Kenya', Ambio, Vol. 14, No. 4; R. Hosier, 'Household Energy Consumption in Rural Kenya', Ambio, Vol 14, No. 4, 1985; 1985; R. Engelhard et al., 'The Paradox of Abundant On-Farm Woody Biomass, Yet Critical Fuelwood Shortage: A Case Study of Kakamega District (Kenya)', International Union of Forest Research Organization, Proceedings, Ljubljana, Yugoslavia, 1986. 63/ D. Deudney and C. Flavin, Renewable Energy: The Power to Choose (London: W.W. Norton, 1983). 64/ World Resources Institute/International Institute Environment and Development, World Resources 1987 (New York, Basic Books, in press). 65/ Ibid. 66/ Ibid. 67/ Goldemberg et al., 'Global Energy Strategy', op. cit.; J. Goldemberg et al., 'Ethanol Fuel: A Use of Biomass Energy in Brazil', Ambio, Vol. 14, pp. 293-98, 1985; J. Goldemberg et al., 'Basic Needs and Much More, With One Kilowatt Per Capita', Ambio, Vol. 14, pp. 190-201, 1985. 68/ WRI/IIED, op. cit. 69/ N.J.D. Lucas, 'The Influence of Existing Institutions on the European Transition from Oil', The European, pp. 173-89, 1981. 70/ OECD, op. cit. 71/ E. Hirst et al., 'Recent Changes in U.S. Energy Consumption, What Happened and Why?' in D.J. Rose (ed.), Learning About Energy (New York: Plenum Press, 1986). 72/ H.S. Geller, 'The Potential for Electricity Conservation in Brazil', Companhia Energetica de Sao Paulo, Sao Paulo, Brazil, 1985.
  • 172. 73/ World Bank, Energy Transition in Developing Countries, op. cit. 74/ G. Leach et al., Energy and Growth; A Comparison of Thirteen Industrialized and Developing Countries (London: Butterworth, 1986). 75/ MIT International Automobile Program, The Future of the Automobile (London: George Allen & Unwin, 1984). 76/ FAO, Agriculture; Towards 2000 (Rome: 1981). 77/ Ibid. 78/ Lucas, op. cit. 79/ OECD, op. cit.
  • 173. Our Common Future, Chapter 8: Industry: Producing More With Less Industrial Growth I. and its Impact 1. The Changing structure of World Industry 2. Environmental Decline and Response II. Sustainable Industrial Development in a Global Context 1. Industrialization in the Third World 2. Use of Energy and Raw Materials 3. Promises and Risks of New Technologies III. Strategies for Sustainable Industrial Development Establish Environmental Goals, Regulations, Incentives, and Standards 1. 2. Make More Effective Use of Economic Instruments 3. Broaden Environmental Assessments 4. Encourage Action by Industry 5. Increase Capacity to Deal with Industrial Hazards 6. Strengthen International Efforts to Help Developing Countries 1. Industry is central to the economies of modern societies and an indispensable motor of growth. It is essential to developing countries, to widen their development base and meet growing needs. And though industrialized countries are said to be moving into a post industrial, information-based era, this shift must be powered by a continuing flow of wealth from industry./1 2. Many essential human needs can be met only through goods and services provided by industry. The production of food requires increasing amounts of agrochemicals and machinery. Beyond this, the products of industry form the material basis of contemporary standards of living. Thus all nations require and rightly aspire to efficient industrial bases to meet changing needs. 3. Industry extracts materials from the natural resource base and inserts both products and
  • 174. pollution into the human environment. It has the power to enhance or degrade the environment; it invariably does both. (See Chapter 2 for a discussion of the concept of sustainable development within the context of industry and resource use.) I. Industrial Growth and its Impact 4. As recently as 1950, the world manufactured only one-seventh of the goods it does today, and produced only one-third of the minerals. Industrial production grew most rapidly between 1950 and 1973, with a 7 per cent annual growth in manufacturing and a 5 per cent growth in mining. Since then growth rates have slowed, to about 3 per cent yearly between 1973 and 1985 in manufacturing and virtually zero growth in mining./2 5. That earlier, rapid growth in production was reflected in the rising importance of manufacturing in the economies of virtually all countries. By 1982, the relative share of value added to gross domestic product by manufacturing (the 'manufacturing value added', or MVA) ranged from 19 per cent in developing countries as a whole to 21 per cent in industrialized market economies and 51 per cent of net material product in centrally planned economies. (See Table 8-1.) If the extractive industries are taken into account, the share is even higher. Table 8-1 Share of Manufacturing Value Added in GDP, by Economic Grouping and Income Group 1960 1970 1980 1962 Group of Countries per cent Developing Countries 14.2 16.6 19.0 19.0 Low income 11.2 13.8 15.0 15.0 Lower-middle income 11.0 13.5 16.4 16.6 Intermediate income 10.6 14.4 17.1 17.6 Upper-middle income 19.4 21.6 24.1 23.3 High income 17.2 16.2 17.2 17.9 Developed Market Economies 25.6 26.3 27.9 27.1 Centrally Planned Economies* 32.0 42.4 50.5 50.8 * Figures refer to the share of manufacturing value added (estimated) in net material product. Data are constant (1975) prices. Source: UNIDO, World Industry: A Statistical Review 1985 (Vienna: 1966). 1. The Changing structure of World Industry 6. In recent years, the trend of the 1950s and 1960s has been reversed. Manufacturing has declined in importance relative to other sectors of the economy. In many countries, this decline
  • 175. has been in progress since 1973. It is most noticeable in the case of industrial market economies, but the share of MVA in GDP has also declined in nearly half the 95 developing countries surveyed by UNIDO./3 This may reflect the growing interaction between industry and all fields of science and technology and the increasing integration of industry and services, as well as industry's ability to produce more with less. 7. The relative importance of industry as an employer has been declining for some time in developed countries. But the shift in jobs towards the service sector has accelerated sharply over the past 15 years with the increasing adoption of new processes and technologies. Economists continue to argue over whether the advent of an information-based economy will further depress employment in industry or will expand job opportunities overall./4 8. Most developing countries started at independence with virtually no modern industry. Then during the 1960s and 1970s their industrial production, employment, and trade consistently grow faster than these sectors in developed market economies. By 1984, developing countries accounted for 11.6 per cent of world MVA (still well short of the 'Lima target' of 25 per cent adopted by UNIDO in 1975). The centrally planned economies of Eastern Europe had raised their share of world MVA from 15.2 per cent in 1963 to 24.9 per cent in 1984./5 9. The international trade in manufactured goods, which has consistently grown fatter than has world manufacturing output, is one of the factors underlying the changing geography of industrialization. Many developing nations, particularly newly industrialized countries (NICs), have shared in this growth and made spectacular progress in industrialization. Taking the Third World as a whole, exports of manufactured goods have grown steadily relative to primary exports, rising from 13.3 per cent of their total non-oil exports in 1960 to 54.7 per cent in 1982. (See Table 8-2.) 10. In general, developing-country industrial production is diversifying and moving into more capital intensive areas such as metal products, chemicals, machinery, and equipment. And heavy industries, traditionally the most polluting, have been growing in relation to light industries. At the same time, the share of industries involved in food products, and to a lesser extent in textiles and clothing, has fallen significantly. 2. Environmental Decline and Response 11. Industry and its products have an impact on the natural resource base of civilization through the entire cycle of raw materials exploration and extraction, transformation into products, energy consumption, waste generation, and the use and disposal of products by consumers. These impacts may be positive, enhancing the quality of a resource or extending its uses. Or they may be negative, as a result of process and product pollution and of depletion or degradation of resources. 12. The negative environmental impacts of industrial activity were initially perceived as localized problems of air, water, and land pollution. Industrial expansion following the Second World War took place without much awareness of the environment and brought with it a rapid rise in pollution, symbolized by the Lob Angeles smog; the proclaimed 'death' of Lake Erie; the progressive pollution of major rivers like the Meuse, Kibe, and Rhine; and chemical poisoning by mercury in Minamata. These problems have also been found in many parts of the Third World as industrial growth, urbanization, and the use of automobiles spread./6 13. Public concern grew rapidly and forced a broad debate on environment conservation and economic growth. The possibility that the process of industrial growth would run into material
  • 176. resource constraints became an important theme in this debate. Although non-renewable resources are by definition exhaustible, recent assessments suggest that few minerals are likely to run out in the near future. Table 8-2 Composition of the Merchandise Trade of Developing Countries Exports Imports 1960 1970 1980 1982 1960 1970 1980 1982 Item (billions of dollars) Primary Commodities 25 45 452 369 11 17 166 166 Non-oil 17 27 107 93 8 12 79 73 Petroleum 6 18 345 277 3 5 87 92 Manufactures 3 9 101 112 17 39 288 296 Total 27 55 553 481 28 56 454 462 Total Non-oil 20 36 208 204 25 51 367 370 (per cent) Primary Commodities Including Oil 90.4 82.6 81.8 76.8 38.8 30.1 36.6 35.9 Non-oil 62.3 49.2 19.4 19.2 28.4 21.7 17.5 15.9 Petroleum 28.1 33.4 62.4 57.5 10.4 8.4 19.1 20.0 Manufactures 9.6 17.4 18.1 23.2 61.2 69.9 63.4 64.1 Share in Non-oil Exports Share in Non-oil Imports Primary Commodities (Non-oil) 86.7 73.9 51.6 45.3 32.7 23.7 71.6 19.8 Manufactures 13.3 26.1 48.4 54.7 68.3 76.3 78.4 80.2 Source: UNIDO, Industry in a Changing World (New York 1983); for 1982, WCED estimates based on UN, 1983 International Trade Statistics Yearbook, Vol. 1 (New York: 1985) 14. By the late 1960s, growing awareness and public concern led to action by governments and industry in both industrial and some developing countries. Environmental protection and resource conservation policies and programmes were established, along with agencies to administer them. Initially policies focused on regulatory measures aimed at reducing
  • 177. emissions. Later a range of economic instruments were considered - taxation, pollution charges, and subsidies for pollution control equipment - but only a few countries introduced them. Expenditures rose, gradually at first, reaching 1.0 per cent and as high as 2.0 per cent of GNP in some industrial countries by the late 1970s. 15. Industry also responded to these problems by developing new technologies and industrial processes designed to reduce pollution and other adverse environmental impacts. Expenditures on pollution control measures rose rapidly in some highly polluting industries; and corporations began to set up their own environmental policy and control units. Guidelines and codes of conduct were published covering safety of products and plant operations, trade practices, technology transfer, and international cooperation./7 National and international industry associations have also developed guidelines and voluntary codes of practice./8 I am one of the patients of air pollution. When Japanese economy grew very rapidly, my asthma deteriorated. I am 39 years old. I was hospitalized when I was 18 until I was 23 because of my severe asthma. I had no joy of life, no joie de vivre in those five years. I got a job and went to work but I cannot work as long a time as ordinary people. For the last 10 years I can hardly work. And when the law was enacted, the law concerning the abatement of pollution, it has given me compensation. That is my only income, from the compensation that this law provides. And if I should suffer another disease on top of asthma, I really don't know what to do. Yoshi Suzuki Association of Patients of Pollution and Their Families WCED Public Hearing Tokyo, 27 Feb 1987 16. The results were mixed, but during the decade a number of industrial countries experienced a significant improvement in environmental quality. There was a considerable roll back in air pollution in many cities and water pollution in many lakes and rivers. Certain chemicals were controlled. 17. But these achievements were limited to some industrial countries. Taking the world as a whole, fertilizer run-off and sewage discharges into rivers, lakes, and coastal waters have increased, with resulting impacts on fishing, drinking water supply, navigation, and scenic beauty. The water quality of most major rivers has not markedly improved over the years. It is, in fact, worsening in many of them, as it is in many smaller rivers. Industrialized countries still suffer from 'traditional' forms of air and land pollution. Levels of sulphur and nitrogen oxides (NOV), suspended particulates, and hydrocarbons remain high and in some cases have increased. Air pollution in parts of many Third World cities has risen to levels worse than anything witnessed in the industrial countries during the 1960s./9 18. It is becoming increasingly clear that the sources and causes of pollution are far more diffuse, complex, and interrelated - and the effects of pollution more widespread, cumulative, and chronic - than hitherto believed. Pollution problems that were once local are now regional or even global in scale. Contamination of soils, ground-water, and people by agrochemicals is widening and chemical pollution has spread to every corner of the planet. The incidence of major accidents involving toxic chemicals has grown. Discoveries of hazardous waste disposal sites - at Love Canal in the United States, for example, and at Lekkerkek in the Netherlands, Vac in Hungary, and Georgswerder in the Federal Republic of Germany - have drawn attention
  • 178. to another serious problem. It is absolutely clear now that the present scale and rate of development of the productive forces require a different approach to the questions connected with environmental protection and rational utilization of natural resources. This is a task of immense economic and social significance. For actually it is a question of people's health and a caring approach to the national wealth of each country. Moreover, it is also a question of the future. And on the solution depends the conditions in which the coming generations will live. A. P. Semyonov Central Council of Trade Unions WCED Public Hearing Moscow, 8 Dec 1986 19. In the light of this and the growth trends projected through the next century, it is evident that measures to reduce, control, and prevent industrial pollution will need to be greatly strengthened. If they are not, pollution damage to human health could become intolerable in certain cities and threats to property and ecosystems will continue to grow. Fortunately, the past two decades of environmental action have provided governments and industry with the policy experience and the technological means to achieve more sustainable patterns of industrial development. 20. At the beginning of the 1970s, both governments and industry were deeply worried about the costs of proposed environmental measures. Some felt that they would depress investment, growth, jobs, competitiveness, and trade, while driving up inflation. Such fears proved misplaced. A 1984 survey by OECD of assessments undertaken in a number of industrial countries concluded that expenditures on environmental measures over the past two decades had a positive short term effect on growth and employment as the increased demand they generated raised the output of economies operating at less than full capacity. The benefits, including health, property, and ecosystem damages avoided, have been significant. More important, these benefits have generally exceeded costs./10 21. Costs and benefits have naturally varied among industries.One method of estimating the cost of pollution abatement in industry compares expenditures on new plants and equipment that have pollution control facilities to hypothetical expenditures on new plants without such features. Studies using this comparison in the United States found that pollution abatement expenditures foe new plant and equipment for all manufacturing industries in that country in 1984 amounted to $4.53 billion, or 3.3 per cent of total new expenditures. The chemical industry spent $580 million (3.8 per cent) on such equipment./11 Similar studies in the Japanese steel industry found that new investment in pollution control equipment reached as high as 21.3 per cent of total investment in 1976 and even today remains around 5 per cent./12 22. Firms involved in food processing, iron and steel, non-ferrous metals, automobiles, pulp and paper, chemicals, and electric power generation - all major polluters have borne a high proportion of the total pollution control investment by industry. Such costs provided a strong incentive for many of these industries to develop a broad range of new processes and cleaner and more efficient products and technologies. In fact, some firms that a decade ago established teams to research and develop innovative technologies to meet new environmental standards are today among the most competitive in their fields, nationally and internationally.
  • 179. 23. Waste recycling and reuse have become accepted practices in many industrial sectors. In some industrialized countries technologies to scrub sulphur and nitrogen compounds from smokestack gases made remarkable advances in a relatively short time. New combustion techniques simultaneously raise combustion efficiency and reduce pollutant emissions./13 Innovative products and process technologies are also currently under development that promise energy- and resource-efficient modes of production, reducing pollution and minimizing risks of health hazards and accidents. 24. Pollution control has become a thriving branch of industry in its own right in several industrialized countries. High-pollution industries such as iron and steel, other metals, chemicals, and energy production have often led in expanding into the fields of pollution control equipment, detoxification and waste disposal technology, measurement instruments, and monitoring systems. Not only have these industries become more efficient and competitive, but many have also found new opportunities for investment, sales, and exports. Looking to the future, a growing market for pollution control systems, equipment, and services is expected in practically all industrialized countries, including NICs. II. Sustainable Industrial Development in a Global Context 25. If industrial development is to be sustainable over the long term, it will have to change radically in terms of the quality of that development, particularly in industrialized countries. But this is not to suggest that industrialization has reached a quantitative limit, particularly in developing countries. Even today, according to UNIDO, world industrial output would have to be increased by a factor of 2.6 if consumption of manufactured goods in developing countries were to be raised to current industrial country levels./14 Given expected population growth, a five- to tenfold increase in world industrial output can be anticipated by the time world population stabilizes sometime in the next century. Such growth has serious implications for the future of the world's ecosystems and its natural resource base. Our ecological movement is not against industry, but we must think of the social function of industries and that pollution and progress are not the same thing. Pollution is not the synonym of progress and therefore time has come for new development concepts to come up. Pollution should not be a synonym of progress because we know that pollution is controlled and when you do not control pollution you are transferring this pollution to the community of the whole. Fabio Feldman Lawyer for Victims of Cubatao WCED Public Hearing Sao Paulo, 28-29 Oct 1985 26. In general, industries and industrial operations should be encouraged that are more efficient in terms of resource use, that generate less pollution and waste, that are based on the use of renewable rather than non renewable resources, and that minimize irreversible adverse impacts on human health and the environment. 1. Industrialization in the Third World 27. Growing populations and high proportions of young people in the Third World are leading to large increases in the labour force. Agriculture cannot absorb them. Industry must provide
  • 180. these expanding societies not only with employment but with products and services. They will experience massive increases in the production of basic consumer goods and a concomitant build-up of industrial infrastructure - iron and steel, paper, chemicals, building materials, and transportation. All this implies considerable increase in energy and raw material use, industrial hazards and wastes, accidents, and resource depletion. 28. The problems and prospects for industrial development vary among the countries of the Third World, which differ greatly in size and resources. There are some large countries with abundant natural resources and a substantial domestic market that provide a base for wide-ranging industrial development. Smaller, resource-rich countries are trying to build up an export-oriented processing industry. Several developing countries have based much of their industrial development on export industries in garments, consumer electronics, and light engineering. In many countries, however, industrial development is restricted to a few consumer-goods industries that cater to relatively small domestic markets. 29. The developing countries' share in world production of iron and steel rose from 3.6 per cent in 1955 to 17.3 per cent in 1984, when four countries - Brazil, China, India, and the Republic of Korea - produced more than 10 million tons of steel each, as much as in many medium-sized industrialized countries./15 At the same time that this industry is contracting in many developed countries, it is expected to expand by 38 million tons between 1982 and 1990 in the developing world. Latin America is projected to account for 41 per cent of this rise, Southeast Asia for 36 per cent, the Middle East for 20 per cent, and Africa for 1.3 per cent./16 30. Many developing countries still depend heavily on their exports of minerals and other commodities, mostly in unprocessed or only intermediately processed forms. In the case of several major minerals such as aluminium and nickel, a few transnational corporations control the whole industry, from mining through final processing./17 Some countries have been moderately successful in increasing the share of refined products in their exports. Yet most of these 'manufactured' goods are processed further in the industrial country that imports them. Thus in 1980, only 39 per cent of all Third World exports of manufactured goods were ready for final use, while 43 per cent of its total exports were unprocessed./18 This ratio should improve as developing nations move into the further stages of processing. These improvements should be speeded up. 31. The expected growth in basic industries foreshadows rapid increases in pollution and resource degradation unless developing countries take great care to control pollution and waste, to increase recycling and reuse, and to minimize hazardous wastes. These countries do not have the resources to industrialize now and repair the damage later; nor will they have the time, given the rapid pace of technological progress. They can profit from the improvements in resource and environmental management being achieved in industrialized countries, and so avoid the need for expensive clean-ups. Such technologies can also help them reduce ultimate costs and stretch scarce resources. And they can learn from the mistakes of developed countries, 32. Economies of scale are no longer always the primary consideration. New technologies in communications, information, and process control allow the establishment of small-scale, decentralized, widely dispersed industries, thus reducing levels of pollution and other impacts on the local environment. There may, however, be trade-offs to be made: small-scale raw material processing, for example, is often labour-intensive and widely dispersed but intensive in the use of energy. Such dispersed industries could relieve big cities of some of their population and pollution pressures. They could provide non-farming jobs in the countryside, produce consumer goods that cater to local markets, and help spread environmentally sound technologies.
  • 181. 2. Use of Energy and Raw Materials 33. Industrial growth is widely seen as inevitably accompanied by corresponding increases in energy and raw material consumption. In the past two decades, however, this pattern appears to have fundamentally changed. As growth has continued in the developed market economies, the demand for many basic materials, including energy and water, has levelled off; in some cases, it has actually declined in absolute terms. 34. Energy consumption per unit of GDP in OECD countries has been dropping at a rate of 1-3 per cent every year since the late 1960s. Between 1973 and 1983, these nations improved energy efficiency by 1.7 per cent annually./19 Industrial water consumption per unit of production has also declined. Older pulp and paper mills typically used about 160 cubic metres of water per ton of pulp; those built during the 1970s, however, used only 70. With advanced techniques that keep water circulating within a closed system, and with proper staff training, use rates could be lowered to 20-30 cubic metres per ton of pulp./20 35. An integrated steel mill uses about 80-200 tons of water for every ton of crude steel. However, since only about 3 tons of water per ton of crude steel are lost, mostly by evaporation, recycling can greatly reduce consumption./21 Closed water circulation systems are not unique to the steel industry or to developed market economies. Between 1975 and 1980, the chemical industry's output in the USSR increased by 76 per cent, but the total consumption of fresh water remained at the 1975 level./22 And between 1981 and 1986, Soviet industrial output increased by 25 per cent but industrial water consumption remained constant./23 36. Declines in consumption of other raw materials began much earlier. In fact, the amount of raw materials needed for a given unit of economic output has been dropping over this entire century, except in wartime, for practically all non-agricultural commodities./24 A recent study of consumption trends of seven basic materials in the United States bears this out,/25 as do studies in Japan. Japan used only 60 per cent as much raw materials for every unit of industrial production in 1984 as it used in 1973./26 These efficiency trends do not result from a decline in manufacturing in favour of service industries, for over these periods the output of the manufacturing sector continued to grow The productivity and efficiency of resource use are constantly improving, and industrial production is steadily switching away from heavily material intensive products and processes. 37. The two oil price hikes of the 1970s shocked many countries into saving money by promoting conservation measures, switching to other fuels, and raising overall energy efficiency. These events demonstrated the importance of energy pricing policies that take into account their current stock, depletion rates, availability of substitutes, and any unavoidable environmental damage associated with their extraction or processing. (See Chapter 7.) They also indicated the potential of similar pricing policies for other raw materials. I think there must be a persistent push, a persistent effort towards establishing some kind of international code for areas of technologies having high environmental risks. At the moment not many in Indonesia would be considered as very knowledgeable industries. We need also this kind of thing in order to guarantee some kind of minimum safety for countries like ours to develop within the context of international economic relations. Speaker from the floor
  • 182. WCED Public Hearing Jakarta, 26 March 1985 38. Some have referred to these processes as the increasing 'de-materialization' of society and the world economy. Yet even the most industrially advanced economies still depend on a continued supply of basic manufactured goods. Whether made domestically or imported, their production will continue to require large amounts of raw materials and energy, even if developing countries progress rapidly in the adoption of resource-efficient technologies. To sustain production momentum on a global level, therefore, policies that inject resource efficiency considerations into economic, trade, and other related policy domains are urgently needed, particularly in industrial countries, along with strict observance of environmental norms, regulations, and standards. 3. Promises and Risks of New Technologies 39. Technology will continue to change the social, cultural, and economic fabric of nations and the world community. With careful management, new and emerging technologies offer enormous opportunities for raising productivity and living standards, for improving health, and for conserving the natural resource base. Many will also bring new hazards, requiring an improved capacity for risk assessment and risk management. (See Chapter 12.) 40. Information technology based chiefly on advances in micro-electronics and computer science is of particular importance. Coupled with rapidly advancing means of communication, it can help improve the productivity, energy and resource efficiency, and organizational structure of industry. 41. New materials such it fine ceramics, rare metals and metal alloys, high-performance plastics, and now composites allow more flexible approaches to production. They also contribute to energy and resource conservation, as in general they require less energy to manufacture and, being lighter, contain less matter than conventional materials. 42. Biotechnology will have major implications for the environment. The products of genetic engineering could dramatically improve human and animal health. Researchers are finding new drugs, new therapies, and new ways of controlling disease vectors. Energy derived from plants could increasingly substitute for non-renewable fossil fuels. New high-yield crop varieties and those resistant to unfavourable weather conditions and pests could revolutionize agriculture. Integrated pest management will become more common. Biotechnology could also yield cleaner and more efficient alternatives to many wasteful processes and polluting products. New techniques to treat solid and liquid wastes could help solve the pressing problem of hazardous waste disposal./27 43. Advances in space technology, now the almost exclusive domain of industrial countries, also hold promise for the Third World, even for agriculture-based economies. Weather forecasting services provided through a satellite and communications network can help farmers in deciding when to plant, water, fertilize, and harvest crops. Remote sensing and satellite imagery could facilitate optimal use of the Earth's resources, permitting the monitoring and assessment of long-term trends in climatic change, marine pollution, soil erosion rates, and plant cover. (See Chapter 10.) 44. These new technologies and the Green Revolution blur the traditional distinctions between agriculture, industry, and services. And they make it possible for developments in one sector to
  • 183. more radically affect those in another. Agriculture has become virtually an 'industry' in developed countries. Agriculture-related services - especially for regional weather forecasting, storage, and transport - are becoming ever more important. New techniques of tissue culture and genetic engineering could soon generate plant strains able to fix nitrogen from the air, a development that would drastically affect the fertilizer industry, but that would also reduce the threat of pollution by agrochemicals. 45. The chemical and energy industries are moving increasingly into the seeds business, providing new seeds that meet specific local conditions and requirements - but that may also need specific fertilizers and pesticides. Here research and development, production, and marketing need to be carefully guided so as not to make the world even more dependent on a few crop varieties - or on the products of a few large transnational 46. Yet new technologies are not all intrinsically benign, nor will they have only positive impacts on the environment. The large-scale production and widespread use of new materials, for example, may create hitherto unknown health hazards (such as the use of gallium arsenate in the microchip industry.)/28 Risk research might be carried out and products manufactured where safeguards are weak or where people are unaware of the dangers. The need for caution in introducing a new technology is reinforced by the experience of the Green Revolution, which, despite formidable achievements, raises concerns over dependence on relatively few crop strains and large doses of agrochemicals. New life forms produced by genetic engineering should be carefully tested and assessed for their potential impact on health and on the maintenance of genetic diversity and ecological balance before they are introduced to the market, and thus to the environment./29 III. Strategies for Sustainable Industrial Development 47. Resource and environmental considerations must be integrated into the industrial planning and decision-making processes of government and industry. This will allow a steady reduction in the energy and resource content of future growth by increasing the efficiency of resource use, reducing waste, and encouraging resource recovery and recycling. 1. Establish Environmental Goals, Regulations, Incentives, and Standards 48. In dealing with industrial pollution and resource degradation, it is essential that industry, government, and the public have clear benchmarks. Where the workforce and financial resources permit, national governments should establish clear environmental goals and enforce environmental laws, regulations, incentives, and standards on industrial enterprises. In formulating such policies, they should give priority to public health problems associated with industrial pollution and hazardous wastes. And they must improve their environmental statistics and data base relating to industrial activities. 49. The regulations and standards should govern such matters as air and water pollution, waste management, occupational health and safety of workers, energy and resource efficiency of products or processes, and the manufacture, marketing, use, transport, and disposal of toxic substances. This should normally be done at the national level, with local governments being empowered to exceed, but not to lower, national norms. In preparing environmental regulations, it is important that flexible systems are adopted without specifying a particular process or technology and recognizing that governments differ greatly in their capacity to formulate legal standards and enforce them. 50. Regulations to control the impacts of industrial activity across national boundaries and on
  • 184. the international commons are also needed. Existing or future international conventions dealing with transfrontier pollution or management of shared natural resources should enshrine certain key principles: the responsibility of every state not to harm the health and environment of other nations, liability and compensation for any damage caused by transfrontier pollution, and equal right of access to remedial measures by all parties concerned. 2. Make More Effective Use of Economic Instruments 51. Pollution is a form of waste, and a symptom of inefficiency in industrial production. When industries recognize pollution as a cost, they are sometimes motivated to make investments in improved products and processes to increase efficiency and hence to reduce the pollution and waste they generate, particularly when there are economic incentives to do so, it largely depends on whether such investments will increase their economic performance. 52. But there are limits to what society can expert industry operating in competition with other industries to do voluntarily. Regulations imposing uniform performance standards are essential to ensure that industry makes the investments necessary to reduce pollution and waste and to enable them to compete on an equal footing. 53. Air and water have traditionally been regarded as 'free' goods, but the enormous costs to society of past and present pollution show that they are not free. The environmental costs of economic activity are not encountered until the assimilative capacity of the environment has been exceeded. Beyond that point, they cannot be avoided. They will be paid. The policy question is how and by whom they will be paid, not whether. Basically, there are only two ways. The costs can be 'externalized' - that is, transferred to various segments of the community in the form of damage costs to human health, property, and ecosystems. Or they can 'internalized' - paid by the enterprise. The enterprise may invest in measures to prevent the damages and, if the market for its product allows, pass the costs along to the consumer. Or it may invest in measures to restore unavoidable damage replanting forests, restocking fish, rehabilitating land after mining. Or it may compensate victims of health and property damage. In these cases, too, the costs may be passed on to the consumer. 54. Enterprises may be encouraged to invest in preventive, restorative, or compensatory measures with subsidies of various kinds. Indeed, in most industrialized and many developing countries, subsidies are a common way of encouraging companies to invest in measures needed to prevent external damage. But in this case, of course, it is the taxpayer who pays, rather than the consumer of the product. Moreover, if the subsidies are large and paid to industries operating in an international market, they can lead to trade distortions and should be avoided. 55. In 1972, the member countries of OECD agreed to base their environmental policies on a Polluter Pays Principle (PPP)./30 Essentially an economic efficiency measure, PPP is intended to encourage industries to internalize environmental costs and reflect them in the prices of products. At the same time, state regulations in CMEA countries are carried out through government bodies that allow environmental concerns to be taken into account. We move towards attacking the sources and not the effects. But we also meet
  • 185. environmental questions in our markets, among our own employees and in our local environment. This definitely provides experiences that underline the need for a more complete and comprehensive thinking about the systems of which environment becomes an integral part. We also, as industry, meet the problems of international relations and environment, unfortunately very often in the way of hidden trade barriers or difficulties in cooperation between authorities. Rolf Marstrander Director, Environment Affairs, Norsk Hydro WCED Public Hearing Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 56. In the case of OECD, the guidelines on PPP were intended to discourage subsidies that could lead to distortions in trade. Countries agreed to phase out the use of subsidies over varying periods of time. (See Chapter 3 for the application of PPP to international trade and investment.) 57. Incentives to reduce pollution can be enhanced by other measures. Energy and water pricing policies, for example, can push industries to consume less. Product redesign and technological innovations leading to safer products, more efficient processes, and recycling of raw materials can also be promoted by a more effective, integrated use of economic incentives and disincentives, such as investment tax breaks, low-interest loans, depreciation allowances, pollution or waste charges, and non-compliance fees. 58. Sometimes the way in which other policy objectives are promoted unintentionally reduces the effectiveness of environmental programmers. For example, subsidies on raw materials or water supply or energy to promote the development of industry in remote areas may well dilute the pressure to conserve resources. Governments should examine whether existing economic policies, instruments, or subsidies provided to various industry-based programmes and projects contribute effectively to the promotion of environmentally sound and resource efficient practices. 3. Broaden Environmental Assessments 59. An increasing number of countries require that certain major investments be subject to an environmental impact assessment. This broader environmental assessment should he applied not only to products and projects, but also to policies and programmed, especially major macroeconomic, finance, and sectoral policies that induce significant impacts on the environment. 60. Many developing countries, particularly in Asia and Latin America, have adopted systems for environmental impact assessment. But the lack of institutional capacity and skilled personnel mean that these are often conducted by outside consultants, without quality checks. In some cases, government authorities would benefit from a second opinion on the environmental documentation they receive. Interested governments should create an independent international assessment body to help developing countries, upon request, evaluate the environmental impact and sustainability of planned development projects. 4. Encourage Action by Industry 61. Industry's response to pollution and resource degradation has not been and should not be
  • 186. limited to compliance with regulations. It should accept a broad sense of social responsibility and ensure an awareness of environmental considerations at a levels. Towards this end, all industrial enterprises, trade associations, and labour unions should establish company wide or industry-wide policies concerning resource and environmental management, including compliance with the laws and requirements of the country in which they operate. 62. International trade associations play a major role in Betting standards and disseminating information, which must be significantly expanded. They should establish and make widely available sectoral guidelines for assessing the sustainability and potential hazards of new facilities, for developing accident contingency plans, and for selecting pollution control or waste treatment technologies. Such key industry associations as the International Chamber of Commerce and the European Council of Chemical Manufacturers' Federation that have taken important and encouraging leadership roles in dealing with environmental issues should now take a lead in addressing the broader concerns inherent in sustainable development. 63. With limited resources at their disposal, small and medium- sized industries often find themselves unable to afford the changes necessary to meet environmental regulations and product controls. Small scale businesses such as metal working, machine tools, printing, and tanning and dying are frequently among the worst offenders of environmental regulations in any country. New technologies, especially micro-electronics, already allow small industries inexpensive means to control an entire production process. Energy-saving biological systems may be well suited to the needs of small and medium sized industries for pollution control or waste disposal. 64. Small and medium scale enterprises, constituting the largest segment of industry in most nations, need information and may in some cases require financial and technical assistance from the public sector. Management and worker training can help them incorporate cleaner technologies and environmental planning into work patterns. Governments should encourage cooperative efforts smaller firms in joint research and development on environmental issues, for example, or joint use of pollution control or waste treatment facilities. 5. Increase Capacity to Deal with Industrial Hazards 65. Chemical products have greatly improved health and life expectancies; increased agricultural production; raised comfort, convenience, and the general quality of life; and expanded economic opportunities. The chemical industry is also one of the most dynamic sectors in most countries, including many developing ones. Yet this industry, together with its products, can have a particularly severe impact on the environment. It has given rise to a host of new problems both of product and process pollution. It continues to generate an increasingly wider range of products and wastes whose effects, especially long-term ones, on human health and the environment are not precisely known. Major accidents have taken place, and the safety record of the industry has been challenged in recent years. 66. In a world more and more dependent on chemical products and highly complex large-scale technologies, accidents with catastrophic consequences are likely to increase. Some of the heavy metals and non-metallic minerals, such as asbestos, also pose serious hazards to health and the environment. Various hazardous products and processes are already built into current systems of production and the technological structure of contemporary society, and it will be a long time before these can be replaced with less dangerous, inherently safer technologies and systems. Some highly toxic chemicals that are known to cause cancer and birth defects and have long-term genetic effects are already in the environment in significant concentrations, and may take decades to be diffused.
  • 187. 5.1 Chemicals 67. Chemicals represent about 10 per cent of total world trade in terms of value,/31 some 70,000-80,000 chemicals are now on the market - and hence in the environment./32 The figure is only an informed estimate because no complete inventory has been done. Some 1,000-2,000 new chemicals enter the commercial market each year, many without adequate prior testing or evaluation of effects. 68. According to a U.S. National Research Council sample of 65,725 chemicals in common use, data required for complete health hazard evaluations were available for only 10 per cent of pesticides and 18 per cent of drugs. No toxicity data existed for nearly 80 per cent of the chemicals used in commercial products and processes inventoried under the Toxic Substances Control Act./33 This situation is now beginning to change as governments move gradually from a system of post-market testing to one of pre-market testing of all new chemicals. 69. By 1986, more than 500 chemicals and chemical products had been banned altogether or had their uses severely restricted in the country of origin./34 In addition, an unknown number of chemicals are withdrawn from clearance processes every year in the light of control agency concerns, or are never submitted to national control agencies for clearance. Some of these end up on the export market. 70. In industrial countries, in an increasingly interdependent and effective system, chemical control agencies share test results and notify each other of new restrictions on chemicals. A ban or restriction in one country is thus often quickly followed by a review and appropriate action in the others. 71. Importing developing countries do not, as a rule, share in this system. Recently, some industrial countries undertook to require their industry to provide a one-time notification to importing countries of chemicals that they have formally banned or severely restricted. They agreed to provide prior notification of the proposed export/import of such chemicals and they also agreed to provide the importing country with the information that led them to ban or restrict the chemical, if it is requested. While the intent behind this system is laudable, it is difficult to see how it can work for importing countries that have no control institutions to receive the notification or professional capacity to assess the information. 72. Third World importers have no way to effectively control trade in chemicals that have been banned or severely restricted in exporting countries. Thus these countries badly need the infrastructure to assess the risks associated with chemical use. In view of the seriousness of this situation, the Commission recommends that all governments, particularly those of the major chemical-producing countries, should: undertake that no new chemicals be placed on international markets until the health and environmental impacts have been tested and assessed; reinforce on-going efforts to obtain international agreement on the selection of existing chemicals for priority testing, on criteria and procedures for their assessment, and on a system for international sharing of the tasks and the resources required; strictly regulate the export to developing countries of those chemicals for which authorization for domestic sale has not been sought or given, by extending requirements for prior notification and information exchange to them; and
  • 188. support the establishment in existing regional organizations of units qualified to receive such prior notification and information, to assess it and to advise governments in the region on the risks associated with the use of these chemicals, in order to permit individual governments to weigh these risks against benefits they may perceive from importation of the chemicals. 73. Consumer awareness should be increased. Governments should encourage the establishment of information centres on chemical products used by consumers and strengthen the international networks of information exchange, assessment, and data banks now evolving in the UN and elsewhere./35 Another essential step is the adoption and enforcement of regulations on the packaging and labelling of chemicals whose use may be potentially harmful, to ensure that clear directions are provided in common local languages. Consumer unions and other non-governmental organizations should take the lead in collecting and distributing comparative risk information on ingredients in consumer products such as cleaning agents and pesticides. The most explosive development in the establishment of chemical and pollutive industry has come in developing countries. This is an outright danger. The last accidents are but a few of those that may come. However, we recognize that considerable responsibility tests on the trade union movement in the individual countries in pressing for influence on authorities and managements to avoid both such accidents and investments from companies that do net follow acceptable standards. Technology development has improved environment in the industrial parts of the world. The new production and information systems make it more difficult, then, for the developing countries to use cheap labour as a means to attract industry to their countries. The future for these countries does not look very bright, unless the international society takes it upon itself to affect a sharing of production technology and resources. This is politically difficult indeed. Juul Bjerke International Confederation of Free Trade Unions WCED Public Hearing Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 74. The chemical producer and user industries, as the source of the risks associated with chemicals and as the greatest beneficiary of their use should bear the responsibility for ensuring (and the liability for not ensuring) that their products meet the highest standards of safety, have the fewest adverse side effects on health and the environment, and are handled with appropriate care by workers and users. This will require the fullest possible disclosure of information about the properties and production processes of chemical substances and on comparative risks, not only to the regulatory authorities but also to the workers, consumers, and residents of the community in which a chemical industry operates. 5.2 Hazardous Wastes 75. Industrialized countries generate about 90 per cent of the world's hazardous wastes. Although all estimates have a wide margin of error, given considerable differences in definition of 'hazardous waste', in 1984 some 325 million to 375 million tons were generated
  • 189. worldwide,/36 around 5 million tons of which were in the newly industrialized and developing areas of the world./37 76. In OECD member countries alone, thousands of waste disposal sites exist, many of which are likely to require some form of remedial action. Clean-up is expensive: Estimates include $10 billion for the Federal Republic of Germany, more than $1.5 billion for the Netherlands, $20-100 billion for the United States, and at least $60 million for Denmark (in 1966 dollars)./38 A large number of potentially hazardous sites may also exist in concentrated industrial-urban areas in centrally planned economies as well as in developing countries. Some form of government intervention is required through regulatory action or financial support. 77. Waste management in developing countries suffers from a variety of problems. Frequent and heavy rains in the tropics, for instance, leach wastes into the soils under landfills or even cause them to overflow. With little or no pretreatment of wastes, this could contaminate water supplies or cause local people to be directly exposed to the wastes. Land-filling generally occurs close to industrial states that are surrounded by poor neighbourhoods or shanty towns./39 These dangers point up the need for land use planning in developing countries, and the mote urgent need to actually implement and enforce such plans. 78. The overriding policy objective must be to reduce the amount of waste generated and to transform an increasing amount into resources for use and reuse. This will reduce the volume that otherwise must be treated or disposed of through incineration, land disposal, or dumping at sea. This is first and foremost a problem of industrialized countries. But it is also a problem in NICs and developing countries, where rapid industrialization is bringing the same severe problems of hazardous waste management. 78. The amount of wastes crossing national frontiers is increasing and is likely to continue to do so. Between 1962 and 1983, wastes transported in Western Europe for disposal in another country virtually doubled, reaching some 250,000- 425,000 tons (1-2 per cent of the total hazardous wastes generated)./40 This increase may be attributed partly to the availability of relatively low-cost, legal, land-based disposal facilities in some countries. For example, about 4,000 shipments of hazardous wastes went from the Netherlands to the German Democratic Republic in 1984. And the Federal Republic of Germany sent about 20,000 shipments to the German Democratic Republic the preceding year. International transport of wastes meant for disposal at sea, either by incineration or dumping, amounted to about 1.8 million tons in 1983./41 Small and poor countries are especially vulnerable to offshore dumping, as has occurred in the waters of the Pacific and the Caribbean. 80. Some countries have recently proposed what amounts to a commodity trade in hazardous (including radioactive) wastes. Strengthened international cooperation in this area is vitally important, and several international bodies have taken up the matter./42 An international agreement currently being developed by OECD is to be based on three important principles: equally strict controls on shipments to non member countries; prior notification to and consent from the country of final destination, whether member or non-member country; and a guarantee of existence of adequate disposal facilities in the recipient country. UNEP has drawn up extensive draft guidelines, but as of now there is no effective mechanism either to monitor or to control hazardous waste trade and dumping./43 Governments and international organizations must more actively support efforts to achieve an effective international regime to control the transfrontier movement of hazardous wastes. 5.3 Industrial Accidents
  • 190. 81. Accidents involving toxic chemicals and radioactive materials can occur in plants in any region. According to a survey carried out by the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, 6,928 accidents of varying severity occurred at U.S. plants between 1980 and 1965 - an average of five a day./44 82. In 1984, liquid gas storage tanks exploded in Mexico City, killing 1,000 people and leaving thousands more homeless. Only months after the Bhopal tragedy in India, which killed over 2,000 people and injured 200,000 more, an accident at a plant in West Virginia in the United States operated by the parent company of the Bhopal facility resulted in emergency evacuation of residents and some health problems. The accidental release in 1976 of the highly toxic and mutagenic chemical dioxin at Seveso, Italy, and the ensuing saga of drums of contaminated soil being passed around Europe, also showed that in industrial countries regulations can be evaded and minimum safety standards breached. 83. In early November 1986, a fire at a warehouse of a chemicals manufacturer in Basel, Switzerland, sent toxic fumes into France and the Federal Republic of Germany and released toxic chemicals into the Rhine, causing massive fish kills and affecting the vital water supply in countries downstream, all the way to the Netherlands. Scientists investigating the Rhine agreed that it could be years before the damaged riverine ecosystems would return to their former statue./45 84. Thus incidents at Mexico City, Bhopal, Chernobyl, and Basel - all occurring within the short lifetime of this Commission raised public concern about industrial disasters. They also demonstrated the likelihood of significant increases in the frequency and magnitude of industrial accidents with catastrophic consequences. 85. These events point to the need to strengthen national capabilities and the framework for bilateral and regional cooperation. National and local governments should: survey hazardous industrial operations and adopt, and enforce regulations or guidelines on the safe operation of industrial plants and on the transport, handling, and disposal of hazardous materials; adopt land use policies or regional development plans that would require or provide incentives to industries that have a high pollution or accident potential to locate away from population centres, and that would discourage people from moving close to plants and waste disposal sites; ensure that plant workers are provided with full information about the products and technologies they handle, and are given adequate training in safe operational procedures and emergency preparedness; and involve local governments and community residents in major siting decisions and emergency preparedness planning. In industry, we feel it must now be made mandatory for any firm that is potentially polluting nature through liquid gas or particle emissions to enrol their staff in short but instructive courses of environmental education. Too often firms pollute not just through accident or design but through gross ignorance by the labour involved of the destructive effect on the environment. Donald Aubrey
  • 191. Society to Overcome Pollution WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 86. Increasingly, the consequences of accidents may seriously affect neighbouring countries. Nations should enter into arrangements with other nations that could be seriously affected by an accident in hazardous facilities located on its territory, under which they would agree to: notify each other of the location and essential characteristics of existing hazardous installations, an accident in which could spill over and affect lives, property, and ecosystems in the other; prepare contingency plans covering potential accidents in these installations; provide prompt alert, full information, and mutual assistance in case of accidents; establish criteria for selection of sites for new hazardous facilities, which would then be subject to the above; and establish standards for the liability and compensation for any damage caused by transfrontier pollution. 87. Industrial accidents and their consequences are to a large extent unpredictable. In order to better identify risks, governments, international organizations, and industry itself should promote further development of technology/risk assessment methodologies, establish data banks on such assessments conducted, and make them easily available to all countries. 6. Strengthen International Efforts to Help Developing Countries 88. Pollution-intensive, resource-based industries are growing fastest in developing countries. These governments will thus have to substantially strengthen their environmental and resource management capabilities. Even where policies, laws, and regulations on the environment exist, they may not be consistently enforced. Many developing nations have begun to build up their educational and scientific infrastructure, but their technical and institutional capacity for making the most of imported or new technologies remains small. Some countries thus continue to depend on outside technical and managerial skills for the maintenance of industrial operations. For lack of capital, they often find that a new industry can only be started with the support of foreign aid, commercial loans, a direct investment, or a joint venture with a transnational corporation. 89. The importance of private investment and the key role of transnational corporations have already been highlighted. (See Chapter 3.) It is inconceivable that a successful transition to sustainable development can be achieved unless the policies and practices are reoriented around sustainable development objectives. Those external agencies that support and facilitate private investment, particularly export credit and investment insurance organizations, should also incorporate sustainable development criteria into their policies and practices. 90. The problems of developing-country governments are compounded by the vagaries of the international economic system, such as high debts, high interest rates, and declining terms nf trade for commodities. These do not encourage hard-pressed governments to spend high proportions of their meagre resources on environmental protection and resource management. (See Chapter 3.)
  • 192. 91. The developing countries themselves will eventually have to bear the consequences of inappropriate industrialization, and the ultimate responsibility for ensuring the sustainability of their development rests with each government. They must define their own environmental goals and development objectives, and establish clear priorities among competing demands on their scarce resources. They will also need to search for more self-reliant means of industrial and technological development. The choices are theirs, but they will need all the assistance - technical, financial, and institutional - that the international community can muster to help them set an environmentally sound and sustainable course of development. 92. Large industrial enterprises, and transnational corporations in particular, have a special responsibility. They are repositories of scarce technical skills, and they should adopt the highest safety and health protection standards practicable and assume responsibility for safe plant and process design and for staff training. The transnational should also institute environmental and safety audits of their plants measured against standards at other subsidiaries, not just against those of other local companies, which may have less stringent requirements These audits and their follow-up should be made available to governments and other interested parties. 93. Particular care is required in dealing with toxic chemicals and hazardous wastes, and in contingency planning for accidents. The views of non-governmental organizations and the local community should be sought in planning new industrial facilities. The relevant national and local authorities must be fully informed about the properties, potentially harmful effects, and any potential risks to the community of the technology, process, or product being introduced. The necessary information should be disclosed to nearby residents in an easily understandable manner. The enterprises must cooperate with the local government, and community in contingency planning and in devising clearly defined mechanisms for relief and compensation to pollution or accident victims. 94. Many developing countries need information on the nature of industry-based resource and environmental problems, on risks associated with certain processes and products, and on standards and other measures to protect health and ensure environmental sustainability. They also need trained people to apply such information to local circumstances. International trade associations and labour unions should develop special environmental training programmes for developing countries and disseminate information on pollution control, waste minimization, and emergency preparedness plans through local chapters. Footnotes 1/ As will be noted later in this chapter, the conventional classification of economic activities into three sectors - primary (agriculture and mining), secondary (manufacturing), and tertiary (commerce and other services) - has become increasingly ambiguous. Some economic activities cut across all three. Furthermore, the services sector has begun to occupy an important place of its own in industrialized economies. In this chapter, however, the term 'industry' will be used in the traditional sense to include mining and quarrying, manufacturing, construction, electricity, water, and gas. 2/ GATT, International Trade 1985-66 (Geneva: 1986). 3/ UNIDO, Industry in the 1980s: Structural Change and Interdependence (New York: 1985).
  • 193. 4/ See, for example, W.W. Leontief, The Impact of Automation (Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1986); F. Duchin, 'Automation and its Effects on Employment', in E. Collings and L. Tanner (eds.), Employment Implications of the Changing Industrial Base (New York: Ballinger Books, 1984); J. Rada, The Impact of Micro-electronics (Geneva: ILO, 1980); and D. Werneke, Microelectronics and Office Jobs (Geneva: ILO, 1983). 5/ UNIDO, Industry and Development: Global Report 1985 (New York: 1985). 6/ WHO, Urban Air Pollution 1973-1980 (Geneva: 1984); World Resources Institute/International Institute for Environment and Development, World Resources 1986 (New York: Basic Books, 1986). 7/ The UN Commission on Transnational Corporations has been working on a comprehensive code since 1977 but the sections on environmental and consumer protection have been virtually agreed. For other examples, see FAO, 'Code of Conduct on the Distribution and Use of Pesticides', Rome, 1985; UNEP, 'Guidelines on Risk Management and Accident Prevention in the Chemical Industry', adopted in 1982; and OECD, 'Declaration of OECD Member Countries on International Investment and Multinational Enterprise', 1976. and 'Clarification of the Environmental Concerns Expressed in Paragraph 2 of the General Policies Chapter of the OECD Guidelines for Multinational Enterprises', Paris, 1985. 8/ See, for example, International Chamber of Commerce, 'Environmental Guidelines for World industry', Paris, 1976 (revised in 1981 and 1986); Hellenic Marine Environment Protection Association, 'To Save the Seas, Declaration of a Voluntary Commitment' and 'Guidelines for the Officers of HELMEPA Member Vessels', Athens, 1982; and U.S. National Agricultural Chemicals Association, 'Guidelines on Labelling Practices for Pesticide Products in Developing Areas of the World', Washington, DC, 1985. 9/ UNEP, State of the Environment 1982 (Nairobi: 1982). 10/ OECD, 'The Impact of Environmental Measures on the Rate of Economic Growth, Rate of Inflation, Productivity and International Trade', Background Papers Prepared for the International Conference on Environment and Economics, Vol. I (Paris: 1984). 11/ U.S. Department of Commerce, 'Plant and Equipment Expenditures by Business for Pollution Abatement', Survey of Current Business, February 1986. 12/ Japanese Ministry of International Trade and Industry, data compiled annually for the Industrial Structural Council, Tokyo, 1970-86. 13/ The UN Economic Commission for Europe compiles and publishes a 'compendium of low-and non-waste technologies'. A special department in the French Ministry of Environment collects and disseminates information on clean processes and technologies ('les techniques propres'). 14/ UNIDO, Industry in the 1980s, op. cit. 15/ N. Namiki, 'International Redeployment of Pollution-Intensive Industries and The Role of Multinational Corporations', prepared for WCED, 1986. 16/ OECD, Developments in Steel Making Capacity in Non-OECD Market Economy Countries (Paris: 1985). 17/ Namiki, op. cit.
  • 194. 18/ UNIDO, Industry in a Changing World (New York: 1983). 19/ OECD, The State of the Environment 1985 (Paris: 1985). 20/ 'Industry Experience with Environmental Problem Solving', background paper prepared for the World Industry Conference on Environmental Management, organized by the International Chamber of Commerce and the UN Environmental Programme, Versailles, 14-16 November 1984. 21/ Ibid. 22/ UNEP, The World Environment 1972-1982 (Nairobi: 1982). 23/ V. Anikeev, Director of the Department on Environment and Rational Use of Natural Resources, GOSPLAN, during a visit by WCED to the GOSPLAN headquarters, Moscow, 12 December 1986. 24/ P.F. Drucker, 'The Changed World Economy', Foreign Affairs, Spring 1986. 25/ E.D. Larson et al. 'Beyond the Era of Materials', Scientific American, June 1986. 26/ Drucker, op. cit. 27/ For a discussion of various possibilities for industrial application of biotechnology, see J. Elkington, Double Dividends? U.S. Biotechnology and Third World Development, WRI Papers, No. 2 (Washington, DC: World Resources Institute, 1986). 28/ The 1986 annual report of the Japanese Environment Agency to the Parliament dealt extensively with this topic of the potential environmental impacts and risks posed by the new technologies. Quality of the Environment in Japan 1986 (Tokyo: 1987). 29/ The U.S. Government recently announced a comprehensive regulatory policy for ensuring the safety of biotechnology research and products. See 'Coordinated Framework for Regulation of Biotechnology', Federal Register, 26 June 1986. 30/ See OECD, 'Guiding Principles Concerning International Economic Aspects of Environmental Policies', Council Recommendation C(72)128, Paris, 26 May 1972. 31/ OECD, Economic Aspects of International Chemicals Control (Paris: 1983). 32/ The Conservation Foundation, 'Chemicals Policy in the Global Environment', paper prepared for WCED, 1986. 33/ National Research Council, Toxicity Testing (Washington, DC: National Academy Press, 1984). 34/ See 'Consolidated List of Products Whose Consumption and/or Sale Have Been Banned, Withdrawn, Severely Restricted or Not Approved by Governments', compiled by the United Nations, 1st revised edition, DIESA/WP/1, 1986. 35/ Notable examples include the International Programme on Chemical Safety (UNEP/WHO /ILO), International Register of Potentially Toxic Chemicals (UNEP), International Agency for Research on Cancer (WHO), and the UN's 'Consolidated List', op. cit. 36/ H. Yakowitz, 'Global Aspects of Hazardous Waste Management', prepared for WCED, 1985;
  • 195. U.S. Congress, Office of Technology Assessment, Superfund Strategy (Washington DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1985). U.S. estimates include wastewater in very dilute form. The result is a much larger estimate of total hazardous wastes for the United States than for other countries. 37/ Some other sources quote figures as high as 34 million tons for Brazil alone, and 22 million and 13.6 million tons for Mexico and India, respectively. See H. J. Leonard, 'Hazardous Wastes: The Crisis Spreads' National Development, April 1986. 38/ Estimates quoted in an OECD Secretariat paper, Paris, 1986. 39/ UNEP, 'Transfrontier Movements of Hazardous Wastes With Regard to Developing Countries', prepared for the Working Group of Experts on Environmentally Sound Management of Hazardous Wastes, Munich, 1984. 40/ Yakowitz, op. cit. 41/ OECD, Background Papers for Conference on International Cooperation Concerning Transfrontier Movements of Hazardous Wastes, Basel, Switzerland, 26-27 March 1985. 42/ See EEC, 'Supervision and Control of Transfrontier Shipments of Hazardous Waste', Council Directive, Brussels, December 1984; OECD, Resolution of the Council C(85)100, Paris, June 1985. 43/ UNEP "Transfrontier Movements', op. cit. See also M.J. Suess and J.W. Huismans (eds.), Management of Hazardous Waste: Policy Guidelines and Code of Practice (Copenhagen: WHO Regional Office for Europe, 1983). 44/ Preliminary findings of a study conducted for U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, 'Acute Hazardous Data Base Washington', D.C., 1985, quoted in Yakowitz, op. cit. 45/ See, for example, La Suisse, 3-9 November; Die Welt, 10 November; Die Zeit, 14 November; Der Spiegel, 17 November; International Herald Tribune, 14-16 November 1986.
  • 196. Our Common Future, Chapter 9: The Urban Challenge I. The Growth of Cities 1. The Crisis in Third World Cities 2. The Situation in Industrial World Cities II. The Urban Challenge in Developing Countries 1. National Urban Strategies 2. Strengthening Local Authorities 3. Self-Reliance and Citizen Involvement 4. Housing and Services for the Poor 5. Tapping More Resources III. International Cooperation 1. Cooperation Among Developing Countries 2. International Support 1. By the turn of the century, almost half the world will live in urban areas - from small towns to huge megacities./1 The world's economic system is increasingly an urban one, with overlapping networks of communications, production, and trade./2 This system, with its flows of information, energy, capital, commerce, and people, provides the backbone for national development. A city's prospects - or a town's - depend critically on its place within the urban system, national and international. So does the fate of the hinterland, with its agriculture, forestry, and mining, on which the urban system depends. 2. In many nations, certain kinds of industries and service enterprises are now being developed in rural areas. But they receive high-quality infrastructure and services, with advanced telecommunications systems ensuring that their activities are part of the national (and global) urban-industrial system. In effect, the countryside is being 'urbanized'. Table 9-1 Proportion of Population Living In Urban Areas, 1950-2000 1950 1985 2000
  • 197. (Per cent) World Total 29.2 41.0 46.6 More Developed Regions 53.8 71.5 74.4 Less Developed Regions 17.0 31.2 39.3 Africa 15.7 29.7 39.0 Latin America 41.0 69.0 76.8 (Temperate South America) (64.8) (84.3) 88.6 (Tropical South America) (35.9) (70.4) (79.4) Asia 16.4 28.1 35.0 (China) (11.0) (20.6) (25.1) (India) (17.3) (25.5) (34.2) (in Millions) World Total 734.2 1982.8 2853.6 More Developed Regions 447.3 838.8 949.9 Less Developed Regions 1144.0 1903.7 Africa 35.2 164.5 340.0 Latin America 67.6 279.3 419.7 Asia 225.8 791.1 1242.4 Source: 'Urban and Rural Population Projections. 1984 Unofficial Assessment', Population Division. United Nations, New York. I. The Growth of Cities 3. This is the century of the 'urban revolution'. In the 35 years since 1950, the number of people living in cities almost tripled, increasing by 1.25 billion. In the more developed regions, the urban population nearly doubled, from 447 million to 838 million. In the less developed world, it quadrupled, growing from 286 million to 1.14 billion. (See Table 9-1.) 4. Over only 60 years, the developing world's urban population increased tenfold, from around 100 million in 1920 to close to 1 billion in 1980. At the same time, its rural population more than doubled. In 1940, only one person in eight lived in an urban centre, while about one in 100 lived in a city with a million or more inhabitants (a 'million city'). By 1960, more than one in five persons lived in an urban centre, and one in 16 in a 'million city'. By 1980, nearly one in three persons was an urban dweller and one in 10 a 'million city'
  • 198. resident./3 5. The population of many of sub-Saharan Africa's larger cities increased more than sevenfold between 1950 and 1980 Nairobi, Dar es Salaam, Nouakchott, Lusaka, Lagos, and Kinshasa among them./4 (See Table 9-2.) During these same 30 years, populations in many Asian and Latin American cities (such as Seoul, Baghdad, Dhaka, Amman, Bombay, Jakarta, Mexico City, Manila, Sao Paulo, Bogota, and Managua) tripled or quadrupled. In such cities, net immigration has usually been a greater contributor than natural increase to the population growth of recent decades. 6. In many developing countries, cities have thus grown far beyond anything imagined only a few decades ago and at speeds without historic precedent. (See Box 9-1.) But some experts doubt that developing nations will urbanize as rapidly in the future as in the last 10-40 years, or that megacities will grow as large as UN projections suggest. Their argument is that many of the most powerful stimuli to rapid urbanization in the past have less influence today, and that changing government policies could reduce the comparative attractiveness of cities, especially the largest cities, and slow rates or urbanization. 7. The urban population growth rate in developing countries as a whole has been slowing down from 5.2 per cent per annum in the late 1950s to 3.4 per cent in the 1950s./5 It is expected to decline even further in the coming decades. Nevertheless, if current trends hold. Third World cities could add a further three-quarters of a billion people by the year 2000. Over the same time, the cities of the industrial world would grow by a further 111 million./6 8. These projections put the urban challenge firmly in the developing countries, in the space of just 15 years (or about 5,500 days), the developing world will have to increase by 65 per cent its capacity to produce and manage its urban infrastructure, services, and shelter - merely to maintain present conditions. And in many countries, this must be accomplished under conditions of great economic hardship and uncertainty, with resources diminishing relative to needs and rising expectations. Table 9-2 Examples of Rapid Population Growth in Third World Cities 1950 Most Recent Figure UN Projections for 2000 Mexico City 3.05 16.0 (1982) 22.3 Sao Paulo 2.7 12.6 (1980) 24.0 Bombay 3.0 (1951) 8.2 (1981) 16.0 Jakarta 1.45 6.2 (1977) 12.8 Cairo 2.5 8.5 (1979) 13.2 Delhi 1.4 (1951) 5.8 (1981) 9.6 Manila 1.78 5.5 (1980) 11.1 Lagos 0.27 (1952) 4.0 (1980) 8.3
  • 199. Bogota 0.61 3.9 (1985) 9.6 Nairobi 0.14 0.83 (1979) 5.3 Dar es Salaam 0.15 (1960) 0.9 (1981) 4.6 Greater Khartoum 0.18 1.05 (1978) 4.3 Amman 0.03 0.78 (1978) 1.5 Nouakchott 0.0058 0.25 (1982) 1.1 Managua 0.11 0.51 (1980) 1.1 Santa Cruz 0.059 0.26 (1976) 1.0 Source: Recent census data used whenever possible; if none available, an estimate by the city government or a local research group has been used. UN projections for the year 2000 from Department of International Economic and Social Affairs, Estimates and Projections of Urban. Rural and City Populations 1950-2025 (the 1982 Assessment). ST/ESA/SER.R/58. New York. 1985 and from UN, Urban, Rural and City Populations 1950-2000 (as Assessed in 1978). Population Studies No. 68 (New York, 1980). Other data from Jorge E. Hardoy and David Satterthwaite, Shelter: Need and Response (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1981), with some figures updated with more recent census data. 1. The Crisis in Third World Cities 9. Few city governments in the developing world have the power, resources, and trained staff to provide their rapidly growing populations with the land, services, and facilities needed for an adequate human life: clean water, sanitation, schools, and transport. The result is mushrooming illegal settlements with primitive facilities, increased overcrowding, and rampant disease linked to an unhealthy environment. Box 9-1 Dominating Cities Nairobi, Kenya: In 1975, Nairobi had 57 per cent of all Kenya's manufacturing employment and two-thirds of its industrial plants. In 1979, Nairobi contained around 5 per cent of the national population. Manila, Philippines: Metropolitan Manila produces one-third of the nation's gross national product, handles 70 per cent of all imports, and contains 60 per cent of the manufacturing establishments. In 1981, it contained around 13 per cent of the national population. Lima, Peru: The metropolitan area of Lima accounts for 43 per cent of gross domestic product, for four-fifths of bank credit and consumer goods production, and for more than nine-tenths of capital goods production in Peru. In 1981, it was home to around 21 per cent of Peruvians.
  • 200. Lagos, Nigeria: In 1978, Lagos' metropolitan area handled over 40 per cent of the nation's external trade, accounted for over 57 per cent of total value added in manufacturing, and contained over 40 per cent of Nigeria's highly skilled workers. It contains only some 5 per cent of the national population. Mexico City, Mexico: In 1970, with some 24 per cent of Mexicans living there, the capital contained 30 per cent of the manufacturing jobs, 28 per cent of employment in commerce, 38 per cent of jobs in services, 69 per cent of employment in national government, 62 per cent of national investment in higher education, and 80 per cent of research activities. In 1965, it contained 44 per cent of national bank deposits and 61 per cent of national credits. Sao Paulo, Brazil: Greater Sao Paulo, with around one-tenth of Brazil's national population in 1980, contributed one-quarter of the net national product and over 40 per cent of Brazil's industrial value-added. Source: J.E. Hardoy and D. Satterthwaite, 'Shelter, Infrastructure and Services in Third World Cities', Habitat International, Vol. 10, No 4, 1986. 10. In most Third World cities, the enormous pressure for shelter and services has frayed the urban fabric. Much of the housing used by the poor is decrepit. Civic buildings are frequently in a state of disrepair and advanced decay. So too is the essential infrastructure of the city; public transport is overcrowded and overused, as are roads, buses and trains, transport stations, public latrines, and washing points. Water supply systems leak, and the resulting low water pressure allows sewage to seep into drinking water. A large proportion of the city's population often has no piped water, storm drainage, or roads./7 Given the distribution of incomes, given the foreseeable availability of resources national, local, and worldwide given present technology, and given the present weakness of local government and the lack of interest of national governments in settlement problems, I don't see any solution for the Third World city. Third World cities are and they will increasingly become centres of competition for a plot to be invaded where you can build a shelter, for a room to rent, for a bed in a hospital, for a seat in a school or in a bus, essentially for the fewer stable adequately paid jobs, even for the space in a square or on a sidewalk where you can display and sell your merchandise, on which so many households depend. The people themselves organize and help construct most new housing units in Third World cities and they do so without the assistance from architects, planners, and engineers, nor from local or national governments. Furthermore, in many cases, national and local governments are frequently harassing these groups. The people themselves are becoming increasingly the true builders and designers of Third World cities and quite often the managers of their own districts. Jorge Hardoy International Institute for Environment and Development WCED Public Hearing Sao Paulo, 28-29 Oct 1985
  • 201. 11. A growing number of the urban poor suffer from a high incidence of diseases; most are environmentally based and could be prevented or dramatically reduced through relatively small investments. (See Box 9-2.) Acute respiratory diseases, tuberculosis, intestinal parasites, and diseases linked to poor sanitation and contaminated drinking water (diarrhoea, dysentery, hepatitis, and typhoid) are usually endemic; they are one of the major causes of illness and death, especially among children. In parts of many cities, poor people can expect to see one in four of their children die of serious malnutrition before the age of five, or one adult in two suffering intestinal worms or serious respiratory infections./8 12. Air and water pollution might be assumed to be less pressing in Third World cities because of lower levels of industrial development. But in fact hundreds of such cities have high concentrations of industry. Air, water, noise, and solid waste pollution problems have increased rapidly and can have dramatic impacts on the life and health of city inhabitants, on their economy, and on jobs. Even in a relatively small city, just one or two factories dumping wastes into the only nearby river can contaminate everyone's drinking, washing, and cooking water. Many slums and shanties crowd close to hazardous industries, as this is land no one else wants. This proximity has magnified the risks for the poor, a fact demonstrated by great loss of life and human suffering in various recent industrial accidents. Box 9-2 Environmental Problems in Third World Cities Out of India's 3,119 towns and cities, only 209 had partial and only 8 had full sewage and sewage treatment facilities. On the river Ganges, 114 cities each with 50,000 or more inhabitants dump untreated sewage into the river every day. DDT factories, tanneries, paper and pulp mills, petrochemical and fertilizer complexes, rubber factories, and a host of others use the river to get rid of their wastes. The Hoogly estuary (near Calcutta) is choked with untreated industrial wastes from more than 150 major factories around Calcutta. Sixty per cent of Calcutta's population suffer from pneumonia, bronchitis, and other respiratory diseases related to air pollution. Chinese industries, most of which use coal in outdated furnaces and boilers, are concentrated around 20 cities and ensure a high level of air pollution. Lung cancer mortality in Chinese cities is four to seven times higher than in the nation as a whole, and the difference is largely attributable to heavy air pollution. In Malaysia, the highly urbanized Klang Valley (which includes the capital, Kuala Lumpur) has two to three times the pollution levels of major cities in the United States, and the Klang river system is heavily contaminated with agricultural and industrial effluents and sewage. Sources: Centre for science and Environment, State of India's Environment: A Citizens' Report (New Delhi: 1983); Vaclav Smil, The Bad Earth: Environmental Degradation in China (London: Zed Press, 1986); Sahabat Alam Malaysia, The State of Malaysian Environment 1983-84 - Towards Greater Environmental Awareness (Penang, Malaysia: 1983).
  • 202. 13. The uncontrolled physical expansion of cities has also had serious implications for the urban environment and economy. Uncontrolled development makes provision of housing, roads, water supply, sewers, and public services prohibitively expensive. Cities are often built on the most productive agricultural land, and unguided growth results in the unnecessary loss of this land. Such losses are most serious in nations with limited arable land, such as Egypt. Haphazard development also consumes land and natural landscapes needed for urban parks and recreation areas. Once an area is built up, it is both difficult and expensive to re-create open space. 14. In general, urban growth has often preceded the establishment of a solid, diversified economic base to support the build-up of housing, infrastructure, and employment. In many places, the problems are linked to inappropriate patterns of industrial development and the lack of coherence between strategies for agricultural and urban development. The link between national economies and international economic factors has been discussed in Part I of this report. The world economic crisis of the 1980s has not only reduced incomes, increased unemployment, and eliminated many social programmes, it has also exacerbated the already low priority given to urban problems, increasing the chronic shortfall in resources needed to build, maintain, and manage urban areas./9 2. The Situation in Industrial World Cities 15. The Commission's focus on the urban crisis in developing countries is not meant to imply that what transpires in the cities of the industrial world is not of crucial importance to sustainable development globally. It is. These cities account for a high share of the world's resource use, energy consumption, and environmental pollution. Many have a global reach and draw their resources and energy from distant lands, with enormous aggregate impacts on the ecosystems of those lands. 16. Nor is the emphasis on Third World cities meant to imply that problems within the cities of industrialized countries are not serious. They are. Many face problems of deteriorating infrastructure, environmental degradation, inner-city decay, and neighbourhood collapse. The unemployed, the elderly, and racial and ethnic minorities can remain trapped in a downward spiral of degradation and poverty, as job opportunities and the younger and better-educated individuals leave declining neighbourhoods. City or municipal governments often face a legacy of poorly designed and maintained public housing estates, mounting costs, and declining tax bases. 17. But most industrial countries have the means and resources to tackle inner-city decay and linked economic decline. Indeed, many have succeeded in reversing these trends through enlightened policies, cooperation between the public and private sectors, and significant investments in personnel, institutions, and technological innovation./10 Local authorities usually have the political power and credibility to take initiatives and to assess and deploy resources in innovative ways reflecting unique local conditions. This gives them a capacity to manage, control, experiment, and lead urban development. In centrally planned economies, the ability to plan and implement plans for urban development has been significant. The priority given to collective goods over private consumption may also have increased the resources available for urban development. 18. The physical environment in many cities of the industrial world has improved substantially over the decades. According to the historical records of many major centres - like London, Paris, Chicago, Moscow, and Melbourne - it was not too long ago that a major part of their
  • 203. population lived in desperate circumstances amid gross pollution. Conditions have improved steadily during the past century, and this trend continues, although the pace varies between and within cities. Large cities by definition are centralized, manmade environments that depend mainly on food, water, energy, and other goods from outside. Smaller cities, by contrast, can be the heart of community-based development and provide services to the surrounding countryside. Given the importance of cities, special efforts, and safeguards are needed to ensure that the resources they demand are produced sustainably and that urban dwellers participate in decisions affecting their lives. Residential areas are likely to be more habitable if they are governed as individual neighbourhoods with direct local participation. To the extent that energy and other needs can be met on a local basis, both the city and surrounding areas will be better off. 'Sustainable Development and How to Achieve It' Global Tomorrow Coalition WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 19. In most urban areas, almost everyone is served by refuse collection today. Air quality has generally improved, with a decline in the emission of particles and sulphur oxides. Efforts to restore water quality have met with a mixed record of success because of pollution from outside of cities, notably nitrates and other fertilizers and pesticides. Many coastal areas, however, close to major sewage outlets, show considerable deterioration. There is rising concern about chemical pollutants in drinking water and about the impacts of toxic wastes on groundwater quality. And noise pollution has tended to increase. 20. Motor vehicles greatly influence environmental conditions in the cities of the industrial world. A recent slowdown in the growth rate of vehicle numbers, stricter emission standards for new vehicles, the distribution of lead-free gasoline, improvements in fuel efficiency, improved traffic management policies, and landscaping have all helped reduce the impacts of urban traffic. 21. Public opinion has played a critical role in the drive to improve urban conditions. In some cities, public pressure has triggered the abandonment of massive urban development projects, fostered residential schemes on a more human scale, countered indiscriminate demolition of existing buildings and historic districts, modified proposed urban highway construction, and led to transformation of derelict plots into playgrounds. 22. The problems that remain are serious but they affect relatively limited areas, which makes them much more tractable than those of Cairo or Mexico City, for example. Certain aspects of urban decline even provide opportunities for environmental enhancement. The exodus of population and economic activities, while creating severe economic and social difficulties, reduces urban congestion, allows new uses for abandoned buildings, protects historic urban districts from the threat of speculative demolition and reconstruction, and contributes to urban renewal. The de-industrialization of these cities is often counterbalanced by the growth of the services sector, which brings its own problems. But this trend creates opportunities to remove heavy industrial pollution sources from residential and commercial areas.
  • 204. 23. The combination of advanced technology, stronger national economies, and a developed institutional infrastructure give resilience and the potential for continuing recovery to cities in the industrial world. With flexibility, space for manoeuvre, and innovation by local leadership, the issue for industrial countries is ultimately one of political and social choice. Developing countries are not in the same situation. They have a major urban crisis on their hands. II. The Urban Challenge in Developing Countries 24. Settlements - the urban network of cities, towns, and villages - encompass all aspects of the environment within which societies' economic and social interactions take place. Internationally, the major cities of the world constitute a network for the allocation of investment and for the production and sale of most goods and services. These centres are the first to be plugged into this network, through air- and seaports and telecommunications. New technologies usually arrive and are first put into practice in large and then smaller cities. Only if centres are firmly connected to this network can they hope to attract investment in technologies and manufacturing goods for world markets. Nationally, cities are veritable incubators of economic activities. Some enterprises are large-scale but the vast majority are small, doing everything from selling snack foods to mending shoes and building houses. The growth of these activities is the foundation of the domestic economy. 1. National Urban Strategies 25. The natural evolution of this network of settlements, however, has caused apprehension in most developing countries. Of particular concern has been the phenomenal growth of often one or two major cities. In some countries, the desire to limit this growth has led to spatial policies designed to accelerate the development of secondary centres. Underlying this has been a particular concern that unbalanced growth is increasing interregional disparities and creating economic and social imbalances that can have serious consequences in terms of national unity and political stability. 26. Although far from conclusive, the available evidence suggests that most attempts by central governments to balance spatial development have been both expensive and ineffective. Major macroeconomic, social, and sectoral policies have often been directly opposed to the decentralization policy. Investments supported by governments and aid agencies have followed the same centralizing logic as private investments, and have built transportation facilities, educational and health institutions, and urban infrastructure and services where the demand exists - in the major city. Rural-urban migration has followed the same pattern. A major reason why so many migrants in recent decades went to cities such as Nairobi, Manila, Lagos, Mexico City, Sao Paulo, Rangoon, or Port au Prince was the dominant role each centre came to play in its national economy. We see that the increasing urban drift is inevitable: There are a lot of 'push' factors working in the rural areas. Rural pluralization is caused by absence of land reform, by the increase of absentee landownership, by the displacement of the Green Revolution. Resides the 'push' factors of the rural areas, there are, of course, the 'pull' factors, the glamour of the Big city, the higher pay of urban jobs as compared to rural income possibilities. So the informal sector of Jakarta has grown; maybe from the 7 million population of Jakarta, 3 or 4 million - at least two-thirds - are the result of the urban drift.
  • 205. George Adicondro Director, Irian Jaya, Rural Community Development Foundation WCED Public Hearing Jakarta, 26 March 1985 27. The macroeconomic and pricing policies pursued by governments further reinforced this concentration. The major cities, often the capital, usually receive a disproportionately large share of the total national expenditure on education and on subsidies to reduce the prices of water, corn, electric power, diesel fuel, and public transport. Railroad freight rates sometimes favour routes that pass through the capital. Property taxes in the city and surrounding districts may be undervalued. New or expanded industries given a boost by the import substitution policies are encouraged to establish in or near the capital./11 28. Agricultural and food policies have also tended to promote rapid growth of larger cities. Low or even negative economic supports for agricultural products have driven smallholders off their land and added to the numbers of the rural poor. Urban food prices, held low by subsidies, have served to attract many of them to cities. In recent years, however, some developing countries have found it possible to begin to shift more income from the major cities to the rural areas and smaller towns. In some cases, policies to promote small landholdings and intensive farming have had this effect. Increasing production, a growth in agricultural employment, and higher average incomes have stimulated the development of small and intermediate centres in the agricultural regions they serve./12 29. There are some important lessons to be learned about spatial strategies for urban development: Nothing much short of coercion will prevent the growth of the major city in the early stages of development. The key to successful intervention is timing, to encourage deconcentration only when the advantages of concentration are diminishing. Avoid policy interventions that increase the attractiveness of the major city, particularly subsidies on food and energy, overly generous provision of urban infrastructure and other services, and excessive concentration of administrative power in the capital. The best way to encourage the growth of secondary centres is to build on the natural economic advantages of their regions, especially in resource processing and marketing, and the decentralized provision of government services. Rural and urban development strategies and approaches should be complementary rather than contradictory: The development of secondary centres is to the direct economic benefit of the resource areas they serve. 30. The job opportunities and housing provided by cities are essential to absorb the population growth that the countryside cannot cope with; as long as price controls and subsidies do not interfere, the urban market should offer advantages to rural producers. But there are obviously conflicts of interest between developing country city-dwellers and farmers. A major thrust of the discussion on food security (see Chapter 5) was to assert the importance of decisively turning the 'terms of trade' in favour of farmers, especially small farmers, through pricing and exchange rate policies. Many developing countries are not implementing such policies, partly for fear of losing the support of politically powerful urban factions. Thus they fail both to stem
  • 206. urban drift and to improve food security. 31. These considerations can provide the basis for developing an explicit national settlements strategy and policies within which innovative and effective local solutions to urban problems can evolve and flourish. Every government has such a strategy in effect, but it is most often implicit in a range of macroeconomic, fiscal, budget, energy, and agricultural policies. These policies have usually evolved incrementally in response to the pressures of the day and, almost invariably, they contradict each other and the stated settlement goals of the government. A national urban strategy could provide an explicit set of goals and priorities for the development of a nation's urban system and the large, intermediate, and small centres within it. Such a strategy must go beyond physical or spatial planning, it requires that governments take a much broader view of urban policy than has been traditional. 32. With an explicit strategy, nations can begin to reorient those central economic and major sectoral policies that now reinforce megacity growth, urban decline, and poverty. They can likewise promote more effectively the development of small and intermediate urban centres, the strengthening of their local governments, and the establishment of services and facilities needed to attract development initiatives and investment. Ministries of Planning, Finance, Industry, Agriculture, and so on would have clear goals and criteria against which to assess the effects of their policies and expenditures on urban development. Contradictory policies and programmes could be changed. At the very least, the spatial biases inherent in macroeconomic and fiscal policies, annual budgets, pricing structures, and sectoral investment plans could be exposed and assessed. Within such a strategy, the traditional tools of urban policy, including land use planning and control, would stand a better chance of being effective. 33. The formulation of such a strategy is clearly a central government responsibility. Beyond this, however, the role of central governments should be primarily to strengthen the capacity of local governments to find and carry through effective solutions to local urban problems and stimulate local opportunities. 2. Strengthening Local Authorities 34. The institutional and legal structures of local government in most developing nations are inadequate for these purposes. In most African and Asian nations the structure of urban government goes hack to the colonial period and was designed to deal with predominantly rural and agricultural societies. It was never intended to cope with rapid urbanization or to manage cities of several million inhabitants. Newly independent governments inherited a framework of laws and procedures totally inappropriate to deal with the urban processes they were about to confront. Yet in many nations, this inherited framework remains largely in place. 35. Where the immediate colonial past is less evident, as in most Latin American nations, the political, institutional, and legal frameworks for local government are often just as inappropriate and inadequate. As in Asia and Africa, most are based on models imported from Europe or North America. This has made it difficult for them to influence the direction of urbanization and to manage the problems of large, rapidly expanding urban centres. It has created cities that are energy and material-intensive and dependent on imports, and that add to the burden on the national economy, including pressures on trade and balance of payments. 36. Urban development cannot be based on standardized models, imported or indigenous. Development possibilities are particular to each city and must be assessed within the context of its own region. What works in one city may be totally inappropriate in another. Although technical help from central agencies may be needed, only a strong local government can ensure
  • 207. that the needs, customs, urban forms, social priorities, and environmental conditions of the local area are reflected in local plans for urban development. But local authorities have not been given the political power, decision making capacity, and access to revenues needed to carry out their functions. This leads to frustration, to continuing criticism of local government for insufficient and inefficient services, and to a downward spiral of weakness feeding on weakness. A lot of youth in the Third World countries and even adults are unemployed. We want simple technologies whereby one particular person can do a kind of a job that could have provided job opportunities to several hundreds. What are we doing with the surplus potential energy? So again I say that development is people, it is not high technology, it is not modernization, it is not westernization. But it should be culturally relevant. Jan Selego World Vision International WCED Public Hearing Nairobi, 23 Sept 1986 37. The lack of political access is a major weakness of local government in many developing countries. Most local governments have difficulties getting enough revenue to cover their operating expenses, let alone to make new investments to extend services and facilities. Even richer city governments have access to the equivalent of only $10-50 per inhabitant to invest each year. Despite these weaknesses, the trend in recent decades has been for national governments to reduce the financial capacity of local governments in real terms. 38. The result is growing centralization and continuing weaknesses at both the central and local level. Instead of doing a few things well, central authorities end up doing too many things, none of them well. Human and financial resources get stretched too thin. Local governments do not gain the expertise, authority, and credibility needed to deal with local problems. 39. To become key agents of development, city governments need enhanced political, institutional, and financial capacity, notably access to more of the wealth generated in the city. Only in this way can cities adapt and deploy some of the vast array of tools available to address urban problems - tools such as land title registration, land use control, and tax sharing. 3. Self-Reliance and Citizen Involvement 40. In most developing countries between one-fourth and one-half of the economically active urban population cannot find adequate, stable livelihoods. With few jobs available in established businesses or government services, people have to find or create their own sources of income. These efforts have resulted in the rapid growth of what has been termed the 'informal sector', which provides much of the cheap goods and services essential to city economies, business, and consumers. 41. Thus, while many poor people may not be officially employed, most are working - in unregistered factories end construction firms, selling goods on street corners, making clothes in their homes, or as servants or guards in better-off neighbourhoods. Most of the so-called unemployed are in fact working 10-15 hours a day, six to seven days a week. Their problem is not so much underemployment as underpayment.
  • 208. 42. Most house building, maintenance, or upgrading in the cities of developing countries is done outside official plans and usually in illegal settlements. This process mobilizes untapped resources, contributes to capital formation, and stimulates employment. These informal sector builders represent an important source of urban employment, in particular for low and unskilled labour. They are not capital- or technology-intensive, they are not energy-intensive, and as a rule they do not impose a drain on foreign exchange. In their way, they contribute their share to attaining some of the nation's major development objectives. Moreover, they are flexible in responding to local needs and demands, catering in particular to poorer households, which usually have nowhere else to turn. Many governments have begun to see the wisdom of tolerating rather than quashing their work. Large-scale bulldozing of squatter communities is now rarer, although it still happens. 43. Governments should give more support to the informal sector, recognizing its vital functions in urban development. Some governments have done so, facilitating loans and credit to small entrepreneurs, building cooperatives, and neighbourhood improvement associations. Providing tenure to those living in illegal settlements is basic to this process, as is easing some building and housing regulations. 44. Multilateral and bilateral development assistance agencies should follow suit, and some are beginning to do so. Non-governmental and private voluntary organizations are springing up in many countries to provide cost-effective channels for assistance, ensuring that it gets to those who can use it. A much larger proportion of assistance could be channelled directly through these organizations. 45. The above measures would also reinforce self-reliance and local governance by the poor in their own neighbourhood associations. Left to their own devices, the poor in many Third World cities have organized to fill gaps in services left by the local government. Among other things, community groups mobilize and organize fund-raising or mutual self-help to deal with security, environmental, and health problems within the immediate area. 46. Governments should move from a position of neutrality or antagonism to active support for such efforts. A few have actually institutionalized such programmes so that public ministries or agencies work continuously with community organizations. In the Indian city of Hyderabad, for example, an Urban Community Development Department set up by the municipal corporation works directly with community groups and non-government organizations in poorer neighbourhoods. By 1983, some 223 organizations had been formed by residents in low-income areas, plus 135 youth organizations and 99 women's groups./13 In this way governments can become partners and sponsors of the people who are the main builders of their cities. The shantytowns have found their own technique, their own resources without any assistance from anyone else, and they solved their housing problems. The real problem is not that. It is the poverty, the lack of planning, the lack of technical assistance, the lack of financing to buy construction materials, the lack of urban equipment. To change this housing policy for human settlements, they should stimulate self-construction, instead of financing these large housing complexes. It would have been much better and would have cost less to help the people to carry out the self-construction.
  • 209. Generally speaking, it seems clear that without meeting the basic needs of human beings, concern for the environment has to be secondary. Man has to survive, answer, and attend first to his basic survival needs - food, housing, sanitation - and then to the environment. Walter Pinto Costa President, Environmental and Sanitation Association WCED Public Hearing Sao Paulo, 28-29 Oct 1985 4. Housing and Services for the Poor 47. In most developing-world cities, there is little low-cost housing. Generally those on low incomes either rent rooms - whether in tenements or cheap boarding-houses, or in someone else's house or shack - or they build or buy a house or shack in an illegal settlement. There are many kinds and degrees of illegality, and these influence the extent to which governments tolerate the existence of such settlements, or even provide them with public services and facilities. 48. Whatever form it takes, low-income accommodation generally shares three characteristics. First, it has inadequate or no infrastructure and services - including piped water, sewers, or other means of hygienically disposing of human wastes. Second, people live in crowded and cramped conditions under which communicable diseases can flourish, particularly when malnutrition lowers resistance. Third, poor people usually build on land ill-suited for human habitation: floodplains, dusty deserts, hills subject to landslide, or next to polluting industries. They choose these sites because the land's low commercial value means they stand a better chance of not being evicted. 49. Landownership structures and the inability or unwillingness of governments to intervene in these structures are perhaps the main factors contributing to 'illegal' settlements and chaotic urban sprawl. When half or more of a city's workforce has no chance of obtaining a legal plot on which a house can be built, let alone of affording to buy or rent a house legally, the balance between private landownership rights and the public good must be quickly rethought. 50. Given urbanization trends in most developing countries, there is no time to wait for slow and uncertain programmes. Government intervention must be reoriented so that limited resources are put to maximum effect in improving housing conditions for the poor. The options for intervention are many (see Box 9-3), but governments should be guided by these seven priorities: provide legal tenure to those living in 'illegal' settlements, with secure titles and basic services provided by public authorities; ensure that the land and other resources people need to build or improve their housing are available; supply existing and new housing areas with infrastructure and services; set up neighbourhood offices to provide advice and technical assistance on how housing can be built better and cheaper, and on how health and hygiene can be improved;
  • 210. plan and guide the city's physical expansion to anticipate and encompass needed land for new housing, agricultural land, parks, and children's play areas; consider how public intervention could improve conditions for tenants and those living in cheap rooming or boarding-houses; and change housing finance systems to make cheap loans available to lower-income and community groups. 51. Most cities urgently need a large and continuous increase in the availability of cheap housing plots convenient to the main centres of employment. Only government intervention can achieve this, but no general prescriptions are possible. Societies differ too much in how they view private landownership and land use rights, in how they use different instruments such as direct grants, tax write-offs, or deduction of mortgage interest, and in how they treat land speculation, corruption, and other undesirable activities that often accompany processes of this kind. Although the means are particular to each nation, the end must be the same: governments ensuring that there are cheaper, better-serviced, better-located, legal alternatives to illegal plots. If this need is not met, the uncontrolled growth of cities - and its accompanying high costs - will not be stopped. 52. Besides land, building materials are another major cost for people putting up their own houses. Government support for the production of materials and of certain structural components, fixtures, and fittings could reduce housing costs and create many jobs. Small neighbourhood workshops often have cost advantages because of the low cost of transport from the workshop to the building site. Box 9-3 Three Ways to Use $20 Million to Improve Conditions in a City of 1 Million Option 1: Build 2,000 public housing units for poor families (with an average of six family members), each costing $10,000. Conditions are improved for 12,000 people, but little cost recovery is possible for poor families. If the city's population grows at 5 per cent annually, 630.000 new inhabitants will be added over 10 years, so only a tiny fraction of total population will have benefited. Option 2: Establish a 'site-and-service scheme', whereby poor families are responsible for building their houses on an allocated site supplied with piped water, connection to a sewer system, and electricity, roads, and drainage. At $2,000 per plot, this means housing for some 60,000 people - about 10 per cent of the city's population growth over 10 years. Option 3: Allocate $100,000 to a neighbourhood organization representing 1,000 poor households (6,000 people) in an existing low-income settlement. It chooses to improve drainage and roads, build a health clinic, establish a cooperative to produce
  • 211. inexpensive building materials and components, and reblock the settlement to improve access roads and provide 50 new plots. With $10 million, 100 such community initiatives are supported, reaching 600,000 people and providing 5,000 new housing plots. Many new jobs are stimulated. The remaining $10 million is spent on installing piped water; at $100 per household, all 600,000 people reached. 53. The majority of building codes and standards are ignored because following them would produce buildings too expensive for most people. A more effective approach might be to set up neighbourhood offices to provide technical advice on how health and safety can be improved at minimum cost. Good professional advice can lower building costs and improve quality, and might be more effective than prescribing what can or cannot be built. 54. Many poor people rent accommodation; half or more of a city's entire population may be tenants. Increasing the availability of house sites, materials, and credits does little for those who must rent. One possibility is financial support to non-governmental, non-profit organizations to purchase end develop property specifically for rental units. A second is support for tenants to buy out landlords and convert tenancy into cooperative ownership. 55. Governments, especially those strapped for resources, may claim that piped water supplies and sewage disposal systems are too expensive. As a consequence, poor people may have to pay water vendors far more per litre of water than middle- or upper-income groups pay public agencies to pipe water into their homes. Western water-borne sewage systems and treatment plants may be prohibitively expensive. But other techniques and systems cost between one-tenth and one-twentieth as much per household, and most of these use much less water. Moreover, lower-cost technology can be upgraded over time, as money becomes available./14 56. Major improvements can be made relatively cheaply in all these areas. But costs will remain low only if low-income groups are encouraged to participate fully in defining what they need, in deciding what they will contribute to the new services, and in doing the job with their own hands. This cooperation depends on establishing the new relationship between citizens and government called for earlier. 5. Tapping More Resources 57. The available resources in or close to cities are often underused. Many landowners leave well-located sites undeveloped in order to benefit later from their increasing value as the city grows. Many public agencies have land that could be put to better use, such as the area next to stations and harbours controlled by railway and port authorities. Several countries have introduced special programmes to encourage public and private cooperation in the development of such lands, a trend that should be encouraged. There is a general need to find innovative and effective ways of pooling land for the common good. Most cities have mechanisms for acquiring land either at market rates (which means that schemes are never implemented), or at arbitrarily low confiscatory rates (where the alliance of political forces and landlords blocks the acquisition anyway). 58. Governments should also consider supporting urban agriculture. This may have less relevance in cities where land markets are highly commercialized and land for housing is in short supply. But in most cities, especially those with less commercialized land markets, considerable potential exists. Many African cities already realize this. Urban agriculture, especially on city fringes, is undertaken by people as a way to feed themselves, in other
  • 212. instances, the process is more commercialized, with enterprises specializing in vegetable production for sale within the city. 59. Officially sanctioned and promoted urban agriculture could become an important component of urban development and make more food available to the urban poor. The primary purposes of such promotion should be to improve the nutritional and health standards of the poor, help their family budgets (50-70 per cent of which is usually spent on food), enable them to earn some additional income, and provide employment. Urban agriculture can also provide fresher and cheaper produce, more green space, the clearing of garbage dumps, and recycling of household waste./15 I'm an expert in slum dwelling. We're establishing a small, tiny organization trying to organize slum dwellers, because we see so many slums. Slums in the city, slums in the villages, slums in the forests. I have worked for four years to motivate my fellow slum dwellers to become transmigrants, and they finally migrated to ten places all over Indonesia. They are still in very good communication with me. They're still sending me letters, and they say that life is not better in the transmigration areas. Living in the shadows in the urban slums or living in the shadows in the transmigration site is just the same. When I go back to my people, the slum dwellers, tonight they will ask me what I have got from this meeting in the big hotel. They won't ask for information, just 'Have you brought some money for us to build new houses?' Syamsuddin Nainggolan Founder, Yayasan Panca Bakti WCED Public Hearing Jakarta, 26 March 1986 60. Another poorly used resource is solid wastes, the disposal of which has become a major problem in many cities, with much of it dumped and uncollected. Promoting the reclamation, reuse, or recycling of materials can reduce the problem of solid waste, stimulate employment, and result in savings of raw materials. Composting can support urban agriculture. If a municipal government lacks the resources to collect household wastes regularly, it can support existing community-based schemes. In many cities, literally thousands of people already make a living sorting through wastes by hand on municipal tips. Investing in a more capital-intensive, automatic recycling plant could be doubly counterproductive if it unnecessarily consumes scarce capital or if a plant would destroy many people's livelihoods. But an immediate need here is to give health advice and provide health care services to those who are making a living off municipal tips./16 III. International Cooperation 61. The future will be predominantly urban, and the most immediate environmental concerns of most people will be urban ones. The effectiveness of efforts to improve urban life depends largely on the health of national economies. In many developing countries, this is linked closely to the state of the world economy. An improvement in international economic relations (see Chapter 3) would perhaps do more than anything else to enhance the capacity of developing countries to address their linked urban and environmental problems. But beyond that is the need to strengthen cooperation among developing countries and to increase various types of
  • 213. direct support from the international community. 1. Cooperation Among Developing Countries 62. Developing countries can do a great deal together to develop the policy concepts, programmes, and institutions needed to tackle the urban crisis they share. Although the management problems confronting Caracas, Dakar, or Delhi have little relevance to those confronting London or Paris, the cities of Latin America, West Africa, or South Asia have much in common. As they formulate broad national urban strategies, it is important that they share experiences on the management of their growing megacities, on the development of small and intermediate centres, on strengthening local government, on upgrading illegal settlements, on crisis-response measures, and on a range of other problems that are more or less unique to the Third World. 63. Further research could provide the basis for rethinking the Third World city. It could also feed in-country training programmes (or, for smaller nations, regional training programmes) for city and municipal government staff. Good policy proposals and good training courses depend on good local information and analysis; far too little of all three of these is found within developing countries and cities. 2. International Support 64. A greater flow of international resources is required to support the efforts of developing countries to tackle the unfolding urban crisis. An agreed definition of 'urban development assistance' does not exist, but the Development Assistance Committee recently estimated that total bilateral and multilateral aid for urban programmes averaged about $900 million per year over 1980-84./17 It is also estimated that to date fewer than 5 per cent of the developing world's urban population has been reached by a housing or neighbourhood upgrading project sponsored by a development assistance agency. This level of support needs to be increased significantly. Moreover, the scope of support should be broadened and its quality and terms improved. 65. In addition, development assistance agencies should increase aid and technical assistance in three areas: to set up infrastructure funds for local governments; to undertake tasks such as reorganizing local tax assessments and collection, preparing or updating maps of property ownership, and setting up technical teams to advise households and community groups on improving housing; for in-country training courses and on-the job training for local officials. 66. Part of the increased aid should go directly to community groups, using intermediaries such as national or international NGOs. Several bilateral aid programmes have already demonstrated the cost-effectiveness of this approach; various NGOs have been responsible for many successful community based schemes to improve housing and provide basic services. They are generally more successful at reaching the poorest. More aid should also go to supporting independent research groups working in housing and urban issues, particularly those providing advice to local governments and community groups; many are doing so already, especially in Latin America.
  • 214. Box 9-4 Misunderstanding Women's Needs in Housing Projects Housing projects often use a gridiron layout that does not allow women to work in their house and at the same time keep an eye on their own or their neighbours' children. House designs and plot sizes rarely consider the fact that many women will want to use their houses as workshops (to make clothes, for instance) or as shops, which in fact are often forbidden in low-income housing projects. Application procedure for low-income housing sometimes requires 'husbands' to apply; this excludes women-headed households - between 30 and 50 per cent of all households. Women's special needs in different cultures are ignored - in Islamic societies, for example, women's need for private open space within the house is rarely considered in house designs, while their need for relatively sheltered pathways to get to shops and clinics is not acknowledged in site layouts. Source: Based on C.O.N. Moser, 'Housing Policy: Towards a Gender Awareness Approach', Working Paper #71, Development Planning Unit, London, 1985. 67. International cooperation can also contribute to developing low cost technologies for urban needs and studying ways of meeting the housing needs of women. (See Box 9-4.) 68. Many technical agencies within the UN system have the appropriate knowledge bases to play a valuable role in advising and supporting governments, notably the UN Centre for Human Settlements (UNCHS, or Habitat). They should identify the information and guidelines that city governments need and the form in which it can be made accessible and usable by them. This could be patterned, for example, upon the ongoing efforts to prepare guidebooks for community workers on identifying disease vectors and mobilizing communities to deal with them, and on interventions to promote child survival and health. More generally. Habitat can strengthen international cooperation at the global level, as in the UN International Year of Shelter for the Homeless. The capacity of the UN system to provide leadership on human settlements issues through Habitat needs to be strengthened. Footnotes 1/ This chapter draws heavily on four background papers prepared for WCED: I. Burton, 'Urbanization and Development', 1985; J.E. Hardoy and D. Satterthwaite, 'Shelter, Infrastructure and Services in Third World Cities', 1985 (printed in Habitat International, Vol. 10, No. 4, 1986); J.E. Hardoy and D. Satterthwaite, 'Rethinking the Third World City, 1986; and I. Sachs, 'Human Settlements: Resource and Environmental Management', 1985. 2/ See J. Jacobs, Cities and the Wealth of Nations (New York: Random House, 1984). 3/ UN, The Growth in the World's Urban and Rural Population 1920-1980, Population Studies No. 44 (New York: 1969); UN, Urban, Rural and City Populations 1950-2000 (as assessed in 1978), Population Studies No. 68 (New York: 1980). 4/ The expansion of 'city' or 'metropolitan area' boundaries accounts for some of the
  • 215. population growth in Table 9 2. The UN projections are based on extrapolating past trends. This method often provides a poor guide to future trends, especially long-term ones. But the data base with which to make better projections ie not available. 5/ UNCHS (Habitat) position paper for October 1986 DAC meeting on Urban Development, OECD document DAC (86)47, 27 August 1986. 6/ Department of International Economic and Social Affaire, 'Urban and Rural Population Projections, 1984' (unofficial assessment), UN, New York, 1986. 7/ J.E. Hardoy and D. Satterthwaite, Shelter: Need and Response; Housing, Land and Settlement Policies in Seventeen Third World Nations (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1981). For the situation in Sao Paulo, See Jorge Wilhelm, 'Sao Paulo: Environmental Problems of the Growing Metropolis', submitted to WCED Public Hearings, Sao Paulo, 1985. 8/ J.E. Hardoy and D. Satterthwaite, 'Third World Cities and the Environment of Poverty', Geoforum, Vol. 15, No. 3, 1984. See also World Social Prospects Association, The Urban Tragedy (Geneva: UNITAR, 1986). 9/ See Osvaldo Sunkel, 'Debt, Development and Environment', submitted to WCED Public Hearings, Sao Paulo, 1985; Ricardo Jordan S., 'Population and the Planning of Large Cities in Latin America', paper submitted to the International Conference on Population and the Urban Future, Barcelona, Spain, 19-22 May 1986. 10/ G. Scimemi, 'Cita e Ambiente', DAEST, Instituto Universtario di Architectura, Venezia, 1987. See also, The State of the Environment in OECD Member Countries (Paris: OECD, 1979 and 1985). 11/ I. Scott, Urban and Spatial Development in Mexico (London: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1982). 12/ See Chapter 8 in J.E. Hardoy and D. Satterthwaite (eds.), Small and Intermediate Urban Centres; Their role in Regional and National Development in the Third World (London: Hodder and Stoughton, 1986). 13/ UNCHS, 'Habitat Hyderabad Squatter Settlement Upgrading Project, India', project monograph produced for the International Year of Shelter for the Homeless, Nairobi, 1986 14/ J. M. Kalbermatten et al., Appropriate Technology for Water Supply and Sanitation; a Summary of Technical and Economic Options (Washington DC: World Bank, 1980). 15/ D. Silk, 'Urban Agriculture', prepared for WCED, 1986. 16/ N. Khouri-Dagher, 'Waste Recycling: Towards Greater urban Self-Reliance', prepared for WCED, 1985. 17/ See draft annotated agenda for October 1986, DAC Meeting on Urban Development. OECD document DAC (86)15. The World Bank definition of urban development assistance was used, which includes fostering urban efficiency and alleviating poverty, shelter, urban transport, integrated urban development, and regional development on secondary cities.
  • 216. Our Common Future, Chapter 10: Managing The Commons Oceans: I. The Balance of Life 1. The Balance Under Threat 2. Oceans Management II. Space: A Key to Planetary Management 1. Remote Sensing from Space 2. The Geosynchronous Orbit 3. The Pollution of Orbital Space 4. Nuclear Power in Orbit 5. Towards a Space Regime III. Antarctica: Towards Global Cooperation 1. Guard Present Achievements 2. Anticipate Pressures for Mineral Development 3. Promote Evolution of Antarctic Treaty System 4. Establish a Means for More Effective Communication 1. The traditional forms of national sovereignty are increasingly challenged by the realities of ecological and economic interdependence. Nowhere is this more true than in shared ecosystems and in 'the global commons' - those parts of the planet that fall outside national jurisdictions. Here, sustainable development can be secured only through international cooperation and agreed regimes for surveillance, development, and management in the common interest. But at stake is not just the sustainable development of shared ecosystems and the commons, but of all nations whose development depends to a greater or lesser extent on their rational management. 2. By the same token, without agreed, equitable, and enforceable rules governing the rights and duties of states in respect of the global commons, the pressure of demands on finite resources will destroy their ecological integrity over time. Future generations will be impoverished, and the people who suffer most will be those who live in poor countries that can least assert their own claims in a free-for-all.
  • 217. 3. Management of the various commons - the oceans, outer space, and Antarctica - is at different stages of evolution, as is the very 'commonality' of these areas. In the Law of the Sea, the international community has developed one of the most ambitious and advanced of international conventions ever for the seas and the sea-bed. But a few countries have so far declined to adhere to the multilateral regime that had been the subject of protracted global negotiations, and this is blocking implementation of certain key aspects. Boundaries have been drawn on the oceans to separate the common seas from national Exclusive Economic Zones (EEZs), but as the common and claimed waters form interlocked ecological and economic systems, and as the health of one depends on the health of the other, both are discussed in this chapter. As for outer space, the least tapped global commons, discussion of joint management has only just begun. Antarctica has been covered for over a quarter of a century by a binding Treaty. Many states that are not party to it feel they should by right have a stake in the management of what they see as a part of the global commons. I. Oceans: The Balance of Life 4. In the Earth's wheel of life, the oceans provide the balance./1 Covering over 70 per cent of the planet's surface, they play a critical role in maintaining its life-support systems, in moderating its climate, and in sustaining animals and plants, including minute, oxygen-producing phytoplankton. They provide protein, transportation, energy, employment, recreation, and other economic, social, and cultural activities. 5. The oceans also provide the ultimate sink for the by-products of human activities. Huge, closed septic tanks, they receive wastes from cities, farms, and industries via sewage outfalls, dumping from barges and ships, coastal run-off, river discharge, and even atmospheric transport. In the last few decades, the growth of the world economy, the burgeoning demand for food and fuel, and accumulating discharges of wastes have begun to press against the bountiful limits of the oceans. 6. The oceans are marked by a fundamental unity from which there is no escape, interconnected cycles of energy, climate, marine living resources, and human activities move through coastal waters, regional seas, and the closed oceans. The effects of urban, industrial, and agricultural growth are contained within no nation's Exclusive Economic Zone; they pass through currents of water and air from nation to nation, and through complex food chains from species to species, distributing the burdens of development, if not the benefits, to both rich and poor. 7. Only the high seas outside of national jurisdiction are truly 'commons'; but fish species, pollution, and other effects of economic development do not respect these legal boundaries. Sound management of the ocean commons will require management of land-based activities as well. Five zones bear on this management: inland areas, which affect the oceans mostly via rivers; coastal lands - swamps, marshes, and so on - close to the sea, where human activities can directly affect the adjacent waters; coastal waters - estuaries, lagoons, and shallow waters generally - where the effects of land-based activities are dominant; offshore waters, out roughly to the edge of the continental shelf; and the high seas, largely beyond the 200-mile EEZs of coastal states' control. 8. Major fisheries are found mostly in offshore waters, while pollution affecting them comes mostly from inland sources and is concentrated in coastal waters. Formal international management is essential in the areas beyond the EEZs, although greater international cooperation, including improved frameworks to coordinate national action, is needed for all areas.
  • 218. 1. The Balance Under Threat 9. Today, the living resources of the sea are under threat from overexploitation, pollution, and land-based development. Most major familiar fish stocks throughout the waters over the continental shelves, which provide 95 per cent of the world's fish catch, are now threatened by overfishing. 10. Other threats are more concentrated. The effects of pollution and land development are most severe in coastal waters and semi-enclosed seas along the world's shore-lines. The use of coastal areas for settlement, industry, energy facilities, and recreation will accelerate, as will the upstream manipulation of estuarine river systems through dams or diversion for agriculture and municipal water supplies. These pressures have destroyed estuarine habitats as irrevocably as direct dredging, filling, or paving. Shore-lines and their resources will suffer ever increasing damage if current, business-as-usual approaches to policy, management, and institutions continue. The world's environmental problems are greater than the sum of those in each country. Certainly, they can no longer be dealt with purely on a nation-state basis. The World Commission on Environment and Development must strike at this fundamental problem by recommending specific ways for countries to cooperate to surmount sovereignty, to embrace international instruments in order to deal with global threats. The growing trend towards isolationism demonstrates that the current rhythm of history is out of harmony with human aspirations, even with its chances for survival. The challenge ahead is for us to transcend the self-interests of our respective nation-states so as to embrace a broader self-interest -- the survival of the human species in a threatened world. Hon. Tom McMillan Minister of Environment, Government of Canada WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 11. Certain coastal and offshore waters are especially vulnerable to ecologically insensitive onshore development, to competitive overfishing, and to pollution. The trends are of special concern in coastal areas where pollution by domestic sewage, industrial wastes, and pesticide and fertilizer run-off may threaten not only human health but also the development of fisheries. 12. Even the high seas are beginning to show some signs of stress from the billions of tons of contaminants added each year. Sediments brought to the oceans by great rivers such as the Amazon can be traced for as much as 2,000 kilometres out to sea./2 Heavy metals from coal-burning plants and some industrial processes also reach the oceans via the atmosphere. The amount of oil spilled annually from tankers now approaches 1.5 million tons./3 The marine environment, exposed to nuclear radiation from past nuclear weapons tests, is receiving more exposure from the continuing disposal of low-level radioactive wastes. 13. New evidence of a possible rapid depletion of the ozone layer and a consequent increase in ultraviolet radiation poses a threat not only to human health but to ocean life. Some scientists
  • 219. believe that this radiation could kill sensitive phytoplankton and fish larvae floating near the ocean's surface, damaging ocean food chains and possibly disrupting planetary support systems./4 14. High concentrations of substances such as heavy metals, organochlorines, and petroleum have been found on the oceans' surface. With continued accumulation, these could have complex and long lasting effects./5 The sea-floor is a region of complex physical, chemical, and biological activity where microbial processes play a major role, but as yet serious damage is known to have occurred only in very localized regions. Although these findings are encouraging, given accelerating pressures and the inadequacy of present data, they provide no grounds for complacency. 2. Oceans Management 15. Looking to the next century, the Commission is convinced that sustainable development, if not survival itself, depends on significant advances in the management of the oceans. Considerable changes will be required in our institutions and policies and more resources will have to be committed to oceans management. 16. Three imperatives lie at the heart of the oceans management question: The underlying unity of the oceans requires effective global management regimes. The shared resource characteristics of many regional seas make forms of regional management mandatory. The major land-based threats to the oceans require effective national actions based on international cooperation. 17. Mutual dependence has increased in recent years. The Law of the Sea Convention, with the establishment of the 200-mile EEZs, has put an additional 35 per cent of the oceans surface under national control with regard to management of natural resources. It has also provided an institutional setting that could lead to better management of these areas, given that single governments may be expected to manage more rationally resources over which they have sole control. However, this expectation ignores the realities of short sighted political and economic goals. 18. An international ecosystem approach is required for the management of these resources for sustained use. Significant gains have been made in past decades, nationally and internationally, and many essential components have been put in place. But they do not add up to a system that reflects the imperatives mentioned above. Where the EEZs of several states come together in semi-enclosed or regional seas, integrated management requires varying degrees of international cooperation, such as joint monitoring and research on migratory species and measures to combat pollution and regulate actions whose effects reach across boundaries. 19. When it comes to the high seas beyond national jurisdiction, international action is essential. The sum of the multiple conventions and programmes now in place do not and cannot represent such a regime. Even the separate UN programmes cannot easily be coordinated, given the structure of the United Nations./6 20. The Commission believes that a number of actions are urgently needed to improve regimes for oceans management. Thus the Commission proposes measures to:
  • 220. strengthen capacity for national action, especially in developing countries; improve fisheries management; reinforce cooperation in semi-enclosed and regional seas; strengthen control of ocean disposal of hazardous and nuclear wastes; and advance the Law of the Sea. 2.1 National Action 21. Coastal governments should launch an urgent review of the legal and institutional requirements for integrated management of their EEZs, and of their roles in arrangements for international cooperation. This review should be undertaken within the framework of a clear statement of national goals and priorities. Reducing overexploitation of fisheries in coastal and offshore waters might be one such goal. The rapid clean-up of municipal and industrial pollution discharging into critical marine habitats could be another. Others might include strengthening national research and management capacity, and producing an inventory of coastal and marine resources. 22. Given the increased pressures on coastal and marine resources projected through the year 2000, all coastal states should have a complete inventory of these assets. Drawing on senior experts from national and international agencies, nations could deploy the latest satellite mapping and other techniques to put together an inventory of these resources and then monitor changes in them. 23. Many developing countries will require assistance to strengthen their legal and institutional frameworks needed for integrated management of coastal resources. Many small island and maritime developing countries lack the economic or military means to prevent the exploitation of their coastal resources or the pollution of their waters by powerful countries or companies. This has become a major concern in the Pacific in particular, and threatens the political stability of the region. International development banks and development assistance agencies should establish programmes to support the development of this Institutional capacity. 2.2 Fisheries Management 24. World fisheries have been expanding since the Second World War, with the global catch rising at a steady 6-7 per cent annually from 20 million to 65 million tons between 1950 and 1969. But after 1970, as more and more stocks were depleted, the average annual growth in catches fell to only about 1 per cent. (See Table 10-1.) With conventional management practices, the growth era in fisheries is over. Even assuming restored productivity in now depleted stocks, and an increased harvest from underutilized fisheries, FAO sees only a gradual increase in catches, perhaps rising from current levels of over 80 million tons to about 100 million. This does not augur well for future food security, especially in low-income countries where fish are a principal source of animal protein and where millions secure their livelihoods from fisheries activities./7 25. Overexploitation threatens many stocks as economic resources. Several of the world's largest fisheries - the Peruvian anchoveta, several North Atlantic herring stocks, and the
  • 221. Californian sardine - have collapsed following periods of heavy fishing. In some of the areas affected by these collapses, and in other rich fisheries such as the Gulf of Thailand and off West Africa, heavy fishing has been followed by marked changes in species composition./8 The reasons for these changes are not well understood, and more research is needed into the responses of marine resources to exploitation so that managers can receive better scientific advice. Greater support for such work is urgently needed, and this support must include additional assistance to developing countries in increasing their research capacity and their knowledge of their own resources. 26. One factor leading to the establishment of extended EEZs was the concern of coastal states, both industrialized and developing, over the depletion of fisheries off their coasts. A large number of conventions had been established covering most major fisheries, but they proved inadequate in most cases. Participating countries were in general unable to overcome the difficulties of allocating shares to limited common resources. Improved management was seen as an urgent need, and open access was perceived as the main obstacle to it. 27. The advent of extended EEZs under the Law of the Sea Convention was expected to solve or at least alleviate the problem. Coastal states were required to introduce effective conservation and management of the living resources in their EEZs. They could also control the activities of foreign fishermen and develop their own fisheries. 28. Industrial countries have been much more successful in doing this than developing countries. In the north-west Atlantic, the annual catch by long-range fleets has declined from over 2 million tons before 1974 to around a quarter of a million tons in 1983, and the share of the catch taken by the United States and Canada has risen from under 50 per cent to over 90 per cent. Table 10-1 World Fish Catch in Major Fisheries, 1979-84 1979 1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 Region (thousand tons) North Atlantic 14,667 14,676 14,489 13,597 13,891 13,940 North Pacific 20,303 20,733 21,908 22,603 23,666 26,416 Central Atlantic 6,064 6,867 6,833 7,239 7,210 1,164 Central Pacific 7,536 7,910 6,478 8,175 7,648 8,531 Indian Ocean 3,541 3,693 3,728 3,852 4,061 4,362 South Atlantic 4,420 3,895 4,037 4,340 4,314 3,957 South Pacific 7,242 6,619 7,240 8,328 6,724 8,684 Inland 7,240 7,603 8,138 8,455 9,131 9,716 Total* 71,014 71,996 74,850 76,590 76,846 82,770
  • 222. Developed 37,143 38,234 38,890 39,265 37,991 42,412 Developing 33,871 33,758 35,961 37,326 36,655 40,358 Developing countries catch as per cent of world total 47.7 46.9 48.0 48.7 48.0 46.6 * Columns do not add to totals due to rounding. Source: Based on data in FAO, Yearbooks of Fishery Statistics (Rome: 1979-84). 29. Yet long-range industrial fishing fleets still catch about 5 million tons annually in developing regions. Off West Africa, for example, over half the total catch is still taken by such fleets./9 This is due partly to the fact that many of the biggest resources lie off thinly populated areas - the western edge of the Sahara and off Namibia. But it is also due to the common lack of locally available capital, and to a shortage of local expertise in many technical aspects of fisheries, especially processing and marketing. 30. Coastal developing countries can usually obtain some modest revenue in the form of licence fees, but this represents only a fraction of what they could earn from a full national use of the resource. Another 10-15 million tons of so far underutilized or unexploited resources could be added to the existing fisheries off their coasts./10 There is a pressing need for these resources to be managed sustainably, for the benefit of developing countries and in ways that help to meet global nutritional needs. The opinion of the public is what you see here in this room. You see important leaders from all over Brazil, from all over the country that have come here, from the rubberman that was under a palmtree yesterday and was here speaking to the U.N. Commission and leaders that are independent. The Brazilian population yearned to have someone to speak to. Someone who will listen, who will not sort of mystify things, and someone who will not trick them. So there is an enormous expectation with regards to the seriousness of your Commission. Randau Marques Journalist WCED Public Hearing Sao Paulo, 28-29 Oct 1985 31. Whaling offers another example. Recognizing that the history of whaling up to the 1960s was that of overexploitation, the International Whaling Commission (IWC), the main international body regulating whaling, has taken a series of conservation measures since the early 1970s and now all stocks that are below a certain level have been classified as protected from commercial whaling. 32. In its early days, the IWC was dominated by whaling nations. After 1979, non-whaling nations became an increasingly significant majority of the membership. This change was reflected in the IWC's decisions, which increasingly opted in cases of scientific doubt for a cautious approach and the reduction of catch levels or the cessation of whaling altogether on certain stocks.
  • 223. 33. This trend culminated in the moratorium decision of 1982. Members have the right to object and continue commercial whaling or to catch whales for scientific purposes. There is a strongly held view in conservation circles that whaling for scientific purposes can be used as a loophole by whaling nations. Permissions for such hunting should be stringently applied by IWC members, or the IWC's credibility will be undermined. 34. An important political factor in recent developments hat been the ability of the U.S. Government to invoke legislation that enables contracts for fishing in U.S. waters to be withheld from nations that undermine marine conservation agreements. The value of such fishery concessions is large and the legislation has significant political and economic leverage. Another important factor has been the strength of the NGOs in organizing support for anti-whaling actions, lobbying governments and organizing boycotts of fish and other products from whaling nations. 35. By early 1987, whaling was restricted to scientific catches by Iceland and the Republic of Korea and to a small catch by Norway, which continued to object to the moratorium, but which planned to halt its commercial whaling following the 1967 season. And there were catches by Japan and the Soviet Union. The Soviet Union had indicated it would observe the moratorium after the 1987 Antarctic season, and Japan had withdrawn its objection to the moratorium with effect from 1988. However, Japan may continue whaling for scientific purposes./11 In addition, some whaling was being performed by native peoples in the Soviet Union and Alaska. 36. If the moratorium is observed and whaling for scientific purposes is not abused, commercial whaling will no longer be a major threat to the conservation of whale stocks taken as a whole. The annual rate of increase of these stocks, however, is unlikely to exceed a few per cent. Thus substantial whale populations will probably not be observed much before the second half of the next century. 2.3 Cooperation on Regional Seas 37. A large number of agreements have been entered into on regional seas. The Commission has not attempted to evaluate them all, but given the Commission's origin in the UNEP Governing Council and the General Assembly resolution, it has given special attention to UNEP's Regional Seas Programme. This programme now brings together over 130 states bordering 11 different shared seas around the world, states that have an interest in cooperating for their own and mutual benefit. 38. UNEP provides the initial impetus by bringing governments together to develop a flexible legal framework within which further agreements can be negotiated as needs require and politics allow. UNEP also provides some initial seed money for programme development, but the governments of the region themselves are meant to take over funding and management, drawing on the technical advice of UN and other agencies. The result is a gradually evolving action-oriented programme rooted in the needs of the regions as perceived by the governments concerned. Fourteen UN agencies and over 40 international and regional organizations participate in the worldwide programme. 39. The political strategy behind the programme' and the requirement that management and financing be undertaken by the participating countries have clearly been crucial to its success. But it is one thing to contribute a few million dollars for research, and quite another to incorporate the resulting findings into land-based development plans and to enforce strong pollution control programmes. The massive U.S.-Canadian clean up of the Great Lakes over the
  • 224. past 15 years cost $8.85 billion for partial treatment of municipal and industrial wastes./12 Huge investments will also be required to roll back land-based pollution along UNEP's regional seas. Yet nowhere have the sums been committed under agreed schedules to construct the necessary urban and industrial pollution control systems and to underwrite policies to control agricultural run-off. The programme now has to confront the regional seas challenge through the year 2000 - moving beyond general agreement on goals and research to a solid schedule of investment on a scale that will make a difference. 2.4 Measures to Control Ocean Disposal of Waste 40. The Convention on the Prevention of Marine Pollution by Dumping of Wastes and Other Matter (London Dumping Convention), which has world-wide application, was concluded in November 1972 and entered into force on 30 August 1975./13 Its political evolution parallels that of the International Whaling Commission. Initially, it consisted largely of dumping states, but non-dumping states are now in the majority. At present it has 61 contracting parties, and secretariat facilities are provided by the International Maritime Organization. The dumping of wastes is regulated by the three annexes to the Convention:/14 on extremely dangerous substances including high-level radioactive wastes, the dumping of which is prohibited, (Annex I); on somewhat less noxious substances, the dumping or which can be permitted only by 'prior special permit' (Annex II); and all other substances, which can be dumped only after a general permit has been obtained from national authorities (Annex III). Although the Convention applies to all wastes dumped deliberately at sea, the ocean disposal of radioactive wastes has attracted the most attention. It is this question that the Commission considers here. 41. Prior to 1963, the United Kingdom, Switzerland, Belgium, and the Netherlands had been dumping low-level wastes regularly at the north-east Atlantic dumpsite in international waters off the coast of Spain. Despite protests from representatives of these nations at the London Dumping Convention meeting that they would ignore a moratorium resolution on low-level wastes and carry out dumping during 1983, a de facto moratorium - which all countries honour but to which some have not formally agreed - went into and remains in effect. Under it, no disposal should take place until it can be demonstrated that it is environmentally safe. 42. In 1985, the London Dumping Convention voted to extend indefinitely the moratorium on the ocean dumping of low-level radioactive wastes./15 As a result, the burden of proof that such activities are safe was effectively reversed, being put on those nations who want to dump. This revolutionary reversal, though not binding, reflects the changed composition of the London Dumping Convention. 43. In 1986, the London Dumping Convention established an intergovernmental panel of experts to examine the issue of comparative risks of land- and sea-based options for disposal of radioactive waste. Without prejudging this assessment, the Commission would urge all states to continue to refrain from disposing of either low or high- level wastes at sea or in the sea-bed. Moreover, it would seem prudent to anticipate continuing opposition to sea dumping and to actively pursue the siting and development of environmentally safe, land based methods of disposal. Why must we gamble with the lives of innocent children in order to generate plutonium for bombs? Even to contemplate dumping radioactive waste in waters that belong to all of us as part of our global heritage is an outrage. For us to make such important decisions on behalf of future generations without taking into
  • 225. account the morality of using international waters as an exclusive rubbish bin is an arrogant act. Peter Wilkinson Greenpeace WCED Public Hearing Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 44. Several other conventions regulate the dumping of wastes in the north-east Atlantic and North Sea, the Mediterranean Sea, and the Baltic Sea. Most of the Regional Seas Conventions also include a general provision calling on contracting parties to take all appropriate measures to prevent and reduce pollution caused by dumping. 45. Land-based sources of nuclear waste have become significant in the North Sea, where high levels of radioactivity have been found in fish, and could threaten other seas./16 The Convention for the Prevention of Marine Pollution from Land Based Sources (Paris Convention) was ratified in 1978 by eight states and the European Economic Community. While it has achieved some international cooperation, its silence on nuclear plants and its acceptance of the 'best available technology' principle in determining permitted levels of radioactive discharges clearly needs to be reviewed. 46. The Law of the Sea Convention requires states to establish national laws and regulations to 'prevent, reduce and control pollution of the marine environment from dumping'. It also requires express prior approval by the coastal state for dumping in the territorial sea, in the EEZs, and onto the continental shelf. The legislative history of this Article indicates that coastal states have not only the right to act but a duty to do so. States also have an obligation under the Law of the Sea to ensure that their activities do not injure the health and environment of neighbouring states and the commons. 47. The Commission encourages the London Dumping Convention to reaffirm the rights and responsibilities of states to control and regulate dumping within the 200-mile EEZ. It is urgent that they do so, as oceans and food chains respect no boundaries. 48. Moreover, all states should undertake to report releases of toxic and radioactive substances from land-based sources into any body of water to the appropriate Convention Secretariat so that they may begin to report on the aggregate releases into various seas. Competent authorities must be designated to keep records of the nature and quantities of wastes dumped. Beyond that, regional institutions should forward this information to the London Dumping Convention Secretariat. 2.5 The Law of the Sea 49. The United Nations Conference on the Law of the Sea was the most ambitious attempt ever to provide an internationally agreed regime for the management of the oceans. The resulting Convention represents a major step towards an integrated management regime for the oceans. It has already encouraged national and international action to manage the oceans./17 50. The Convention reconciled widely divergent interests of states, and established the basis for a new equity in the use of the oceans and their resources. It confirmed that coastal states are empowered to exercise sovereignty over their territorial sea, sea- bed and subsoil, and the superjacent air space, up to a distance of 12 nautical miles. It redefined the rights of coastal
  • 226. states concerning the continental shelf. It established Exclusive Economic Zones of up to 200 nautical miles within which the coastal state may exercise sovereign rights with regard to the management of national resources, living and non-living, in the waters, sea bed, and subsoil. 51. The Convention removed 35 per cent of the oceans as a source of growing conflict between states. It stipulates that coastal states must ensure that the living resources of the EEZs are not endangered by overexploitation. Thus, governments now have not only the legal power and the self-interest to apply sound principles of resource management within this area, but they have an obligation to do so. The Convention calls for regional cooperation in formulating and implementing conservation and management strategies for living marine resources, including cooperation in the exchange of scientific information, the conservation and development of stocks, and the optimum use of highly migratory species. 52. Similarly, coastal states now have a clear interest in the sound management of the continental shelf and in the prevention of pollution from land- and sea-based activities. Under the Convention, coastal states may adopt laws and regulations for their EEZs compatible with international rules and standards to combat pollution from vessels. 53. The Convention also defines the waters, sea bed, and subsoil beyond the limits of national jurisdiction, and recognizes this as international. Over 45 per cent of the planet's surface, this sea-bed area and its resources are declared to be the 'common heritage of mankind', a concept that represents a milestone in the realm of international cooperation. The Convention would bring all mining activities in the sea-bed under the control of an International Seabed Authority. 54. By early 1987, the Convention had been signed by 159 nations, and 32 countries had ratified it. However, a small number of significant states had indicated that they were unlikely to ratify it./18 The reasons for this rest largely with the regime proposed to manage the common sea bed. 55. Despite this, many of the Convention's other provisions have been broadly accepted and have already entered into international law and practice in various ways. This process should be encouraged, especially as regards those provisions that relate to the environment. This Commission believes that the Convention should be ratified by the major technological powers and come into force. Indeed, the most significant initial action that nations can take in the interests of the oceans' threatened life-support system is to ratify the Law of the Sea Convention. II. Space: A Key to Planetary Management 56. Outer space can play a vital role in ensuring the continued habitability of the Earth, largely through space technology to monitor the vital signs of the planet and aid humans in protecting its health. According to the 1967 Outer Space Treaty, outer space, including the moon and other celestial bodies, is not subject to national appropriation by claim of sovereignty, by means of use of occupation, or by any other means. The UN Committee on the Peaceful Uses of Outer Space has been labouring to see that these ideals remain on the agenda. This Commission, in view of these developments, considers space as a global commons and part of the common heritage of mankind. 57. The future of the space as a resource will depend not so much on technology as on the slow and difficult struggle to create sound international institutions to manage this resource. It will depend most of all upon humanity's ability to prevent an arms race in space.
  • 227. 1. Remote Sensing from Space 58. If humanity is going to respond effectively to the consequences of changes human activity has induced - the build-up of atmospheric carbon dioxide, depletion of stratospheric ozone, acid precipitation, and tropical forest destruction - better data on the Earth's natural systems will be essential. 59. Today several dozen satellites contribute to the accumulation of new knowledge about the Earth's systems: for example, about the spread of volcanic gases, enabling scientists for the first time to describe the specific links between a major natural disturbance of the upper atmosphere and changes in the weather thousands of miles away./19 60. Satellites also played a key scientific role after the 1986 discovery of a 'hole' in the ozone layer over Antarctica. When ground-based observers noted this phenomenon, archived satellite data were examined and provided a record of seasonal ozone fluctuation extending back nearly a decade./20 And scientists have been able to follow closely the unfolding of the drought in the Sahel region of Africa in the 1980s. Satellite-generated maps correlating rainfall patterns and biomass have served as a tool in understanding droughts and helped in the targeting of relief aid. We need a kind of new earth/space monitoring system. I think that it goes farther than simply an earth environmental system. It's a combined earth/space monitoring system, a new agency that would have the resources to be able to monitor, report, and recommend in a very systematic way on the earth/space interaction that is so fundamental to a total ecological view of the biosphere. Maxwell Cohen University of Ottawa WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 61. Recently, an international and interdisciplinary group of scientists has proposed a major new initiative - the International Geosphere-Biosphere Programme (IGBP) to be coordinated through ICSU. It would investigate the biosphere using many technologies, including satellites. This proposal seemed in 1987 to be gaining momentum; it was already influencing the budget decisions of several nations on allocations for future satellite launches and is increasing coordination between existing efforts. 62. The primary frustration about this wealth of data is that the information is dispersed among governments arid institutions, rather than being pooled. UNEP's Global Environment Monitoring System is a modest effort to pool space data relevant to the Earth's habitability. It should be strengthened. But most such efforts are underfunded, undercoordinated, and inadequate to the tasks. 63. The primary responsibility for action rests initially with national governments, cooperating to pool, store and exchange data. In time, international efforts might be funded through some direct global revenue source or through contributions from individual nations. (See Chapter 12.)
  • 228. 2. The Geosynchronous Orbit 64. From an economic point of view, the most valuable part of the Earth's orbital space is the geosynchronous orbit, a band of space 36,000 kilometres, above the equator./21 Most communication and many weather satellites - as well as many military orbits - are in geosynchronous orbit. To prevent signals to and from the satellites interfering with one another, satellites must be placed some distance apart, effectively limiting the number that can use this valuable band to 180. Thus, the geosynchronous orbit is not only a valuable but also a scarce and limited global resource. 65. The growth in satellite communication traffic during the 1970s led to many predictions that slots would soon be saturated. Thus conflict emerged over the use and ownership of the geosynchronous orbit, largely between industrial nations that have the capacity to put satellites in this orbit and the equatorial developing nations that do not but that lie beneath this band of space. 66. The first effort to devise a property regime for geosynchronous orbit was the 1976 Bogota Declaration, signed by seven equatorial countries./22 These countries declared that the orbits above them were extensions of their territorial airspace. The Bogota Declaration has been challenged by some nations that see it as contradicting the 'non-appropriation' principle of the Outer Space Treaty. Another group of developing countries proposed a licensing system for the use of geosynchronous orbits./23 Countries would be awarded slots that could then be sold, rented, or reserved for future use. 67. Another way of managing this resource and capturing its rental value for the common interest would be for an international body to own and license the slots to bidders at an auction. Such an alternative would be analogous to the Seabed Authority in the Law of the Sea Convention. 66. Industrial countries have opposed the creation of a property rights regime for geosynchronous orbit, especially a regime that granted rights to slots to countries that cannot now use them. They argue that a regime of prior allocation would drive up costs and reduce the incentive of the private sector to develop and use this orbit. Others, who see a rapidly growing role for satellite communications, argue that regulatory regimes should be established before competition makes such a step more difficult. 69. Since satellite communications involve the use of radio waves, a de facto regime for the parcelling out of slots in geosynchronous orbit has emerged through the activities of the International Telecommunications Union (ITU) in the past several years. The ITU allocates the use of the radio waves (those parts of the electromagnetic spectrum used for communication)./24 The highly technical character of the task of parcelling out radio waves, combined with the fact that strict compliance is necessary to allow any user to enjoy access to this resource, has produced a successful international resource regime, based on three regional conferences, for effective management of the resource./25 Whether this approach will endure depends in large part upon the perceived justice of the decisions reached by the regional conferences. 3. The Pollution of Orbital Space 70. Debris in orbit is a growing threat to human activities in space. In 1981, a panel of experts convened by the American Institute of Aeronautics and Astronautics concluded that the
  • 229. growth of space debris could pose 'an unacceptable threat' to life in space within a decade./26 This debris consists of spent fuel tanks, rocket shells, satellites that no longer function, and shrapnel from explosions in space: it is concentrated in the region between 160 and 1,760 kilometres above the Earth. 71. With greater care in the design and disposal of satellites, much of it could be avoided. However, the creation of debris is an integral and unavoidable consequence of the testing and use of space weapons. The contribution of military activities to the Earth's 'debris belt' could grow greatly if plans to place large numbers of satellite based weapons and weapons-related sensors are realized. 72. The most important measure to minimize space debris, therefore, is to prevent the further testing and deployment of space based weapons or weapons designed tor use against objects in space. 73. Clean up would be expensive. It has been proposed that the major powers lead an international effort to retrieve the larger pieces of space debris from orbit. Such work would involve the design, construction, and launch of vehicles that could manoeuvre in space and grapple with large, jagged, tumbling space objects. The proposal has elicited little enthusiasm. 4. Nuclear Power in Orbit 74. Many spacecraft are nuclear-powered and threaten contamination if they fall to the Earth./27 There are two basic approaches to the problem: Ban or regulate. The option of banning all radioactive materials from space is the simplest to enact. It would eliminate the problem and would also severely stunt the further development of space-based warfare systems. A total ban should exempt scientific uses in deep-space, as small amounts of fissionable materials have been essential for the powering of deep-space probes. A ban on reactors in space would be easy to monitor, because reactors produce waste heat detectable by infrared sensors at great distances. Verifying the absence of small nuclear power systems would be more difficult, but still possible. 75. A wide variety of methods are available for regulating the use of radioactive materials in space. The most important include limiting the size of reactors permitted in orbit, requiring shielding around radioactive material sufficient to withstand reentry into the Earth's atmosphere, and requiring deep space disposal of spacecraft that contain radioactive material. All are technologically feasible, but would add cost and complexity to missions. Nevertheless, these measures should be implemented, as a minimum step. 5. Towards a Space Regime 76. Soon after the aeroplane was invented, it became obvious that collisions would occur unless a general air traffic control regime was established. This model offers a useful way to think about the need for and contents of a space regime. The creation of 'rules of the road' for orbital space could ensure that the activities of some do not degrade the resource for all. Utilization of spacecraft for solving the problems of forestry provides a good example of the peaceful use of space. Taking into account the interests of the present and future generations, there is no other more favourable area of space technology application than environmental protection, to study the natural
  • 230. resources of Earth and control their rational utilization and reproduction. We think that in the forthcoming years international cooperation in this field will be further expanded. L. E. Mikhailov USSR State Committee on Forestry WCED Public Hearing Moscow, 11 Dec 1986 77. Orbital space cannot be effectively managed by any one country acting alone. The inherently international character of orbital space has been recognized by a majority of nations in the Outer Space Treaty. The international community should seek to design and implement a space regime to ensure that space remains a peaceful environment for the benefit of all. 78. An essential step towards efficient management of the space resource is to abandon the notion that because outer space in general is unlimited, orbital space can absorb all human activity. Because of the speeds involved, orbital space is for practical purposes much 'closer' than the atmosphere. A system of space traffic control in which some activities were forbidden and others harmonized cuts a middle path between the extremes of a sole Space Authority and the present near anarchy. 79. The electromagnetic spectrum has been effectively regulated by international agreement, and through this regulation has begun to emerge the beginnings of a space regime for geosynchronous orbital space. An extension of this type of approach to control debris and the use of nuclear materials in orbit is the next logical step. 80. A fine balance must be struck between regulating activities too late and regulating non-existent activities too soon. Regulating activities on the Moon, for example, beyond the general principles laid out in the Outer Space Treaty is clearly premature. But regulating space debris and nuclear materials in Earth orbit is clearly overdue. III. Antarctica: Towards Global Cooperation 81. The Antarctic continent - larger than the United states and Mexico combined - for over a generation has been managed under a regime of multilateral cooperation that has secured environmental protection. Signed on 1 December 1959, the Antarctic Treaty has been the vehicle for a number of important initiatives in pursuit of its two primary objectives: to maintain Antarctica for peaceful uses only, prohibiting all military activities, weapons testing, nuclear explosions, and disposal of radioactive wastes; and to promote freedom of scientific investigation in Antarctica and international cooperation to that end./28 82. The fact that the 'question of Antarctica' is today on the UN agenda/29 indicates the reality that there is a debate in the international community over the future management of the continent. Under the combined pressures of economic, technological, environmental, and other trends, there are new initiatives to establish a regime for minerals exploitation. New questions about equitable management are presenting challenges that may reshape the political context of the continent within the next decade./30 83. During the forthcoming period of change, the challenge is to ensure that Antarctica is managed in the interests of all humankind, in a manner that conserves its unique environment, preserves its value for scientific research, and retains its character as a demilitarized, non-nuclear zone of peace.
  • 231. 84. Responsibility for guiding change at present rests initially with the countries party to the Antarctic Treaty./31 Eighteen nations now enjoy full decision-making status under the Treaty, with these consultative parties exercising their rights and carrying out their obligations in peaceful cooperation despite their divergent views on the territorial claims to parts of the continent. An additional 17 nations have observer status at the biennial Antarctic Treaty System (ATS) meetings. 85. The Antarctic Treaty is open to accession by any state that is a member of the United Nations, and by others invited to accede. To become a Consultative Party, a state must demonstrate concrete interest in Antarctica by conducting substantial scientific research there. The Treaty nations feel that this system is applied flexibly and opens the Treaty to all nations with a genuine interest in Antarctica. Many developing nations without the resources to conduct research on the continent feel that this condition effectively excludes most of the world's nations./32 86. But the question of participation is not polarized between industrial and developing countries. Not all industrialized countries are members of the Treaty, and Argentina, Brazil, Chile, China, India, and Uruguay have consultative status under it, while several additional developing countries have acceded to it. However, the overwhelming majority of developing countries, including all those of Africa, remain outside the arrangements. 87. There is furthermore no general agreement as to whether Antarctica is part of the international commons. For example, seven states maintain territorial claims. Moreover, many developing countries reject the idea that what they regard as the common heritage of mankind should be managed by some countries to the exclusion of others. Many of them see the Antarctic Treaty System as the exclusive preserve of the rich and technologically advanced countries. Some object to what they consider the exclusivity of the Treaty system, with countries self-appointed to determine the future of the continent. Although the Consultative Parties assert that they have managed Antarctica in the interests of all peoples, several nations maintain that these interests should not be defined by the Consultative Parties alone; this view has gained many new sources of expression since 1959. Despite the present debate over the continent's future, many nations outside the Treaty have recognized the trusteeship role played by the Treaty nations in protecting the environment of Antarctica./33 88. The Commission does not propose to adjudicate the status of Antarctica. But it sees it as essential that the continent be managed and protected in a responsible manner that takes into account the common interests at stake, it notes also that the legal and management regimes are in the midst of a process of change leading to wider participation. 89. The Antarctic Treaty Consultative Parties have endeavoured to demonstrate a strong concern for the protection of the continent's environment and the conservation of its natural resources. (See Box 10-1.) In 1964, they adopted the 'Agreed Measures for the Conservation of Antarctic Fauna and Flora',/34 which amount to a conservation protocol to the Treaty. At subsequent biennial meetings, they have continued to develop environmental principles and measures to guide the planning and execution of their activities. Additional measures would improve the scope and effectiveness of environmental protection, and it would be useful to consider means to ensure that the record of compliance with these measures is widely known. 90. The Consultative Parties have also played a leading role in the promulgation of two important international conventions relating to conservation of living resources: the 1972 Convention on the Conservation of Antarctic Seals and the 1980 Convention on the Conservation of Antarctic Marine Living Resources./35 The second arose out of concern that
  • 232. the depletion of Antarctic fish stocks, particularly shrimp like krill, could have severe and unpredictable effects on related and dependent species. It adopts an 'ecosystem approach' to resource management./36 91. Taken together, these legal instruments and accompanying protocols and recommendations, along with the non governmental body the Scientific Committee on Antarctic Research (SCAR), constitute what is referred to as the Antarctic Treaty System. This system demonstrates the evolution that has taken place under the Antarctic Treaty since it entered into force. 92. Several international NGOs have begun to monitor the adequacy of and compliance with environmental protection and conservation measures in Antarctica and have frequently been critical of these measures. They have also sought observer status at ATS meetings and greater involvement in the formulation and review of Antarctic policies. Some UK agencies are concerned with southern hemisphere meteorology, oceanography, or fishing and have become involved in Antarctic science and politics. A concrete result of this interest has been invitations extended to WMO, FAO, IOC, IUCN, IWC, SCAR, and the Scientific Committee on Oceanic Research to attend as observers meetings of the Commission for the Conservation of Antarctic Marine Living Resources (CCAMLR). The European Economic Community is also a CCAMLR member as a result of its member states ceding competence to it with respect to fisheries management policies. Box 10-1 Antarctica's Unique Treaty Arrangements Under the Antarctic Treaty, the seven states claiming territory there have agreed with non-claimant parties to the Treaty to Bet aside the disputed territorial status of Antarctica in order to carry out agreed-upon activities in the area. While the Treaty is in force, no acts or activities taking place will 'constitute a basis for asserting, supporting or denying a claim to territorial sovereignty in Antarctica', nor may any new claim, or enlargement of an existing claim, be asserted. Decisions are taken by consensus, which guarantees to both claimant and non-claimant states that no activity or management practice prejudicial to their position on the territorial status of Antarctica will be approved. The Treaty provides for on-site inspection at any time in any or all areas of Antarctica by designated nationals of the consultative parties. Source: Based on Lee Kimball, 'Testing the Great Experiment' Environment, September 1985. 93. For the ATS to remain viable into the next century, it will need to continue to evolve and adapt itself to deal with new issues and new circumstances. Although the Treaty could run indefinitely, in 1991 any of the Consultative Parties may call for a general conference of the signatory nations, to review its operation. 1. Guard Present Achievements
  • 233. 94. Although further change in the management status of Antarctica is inevitable, it is essential that such change not jeopardize the achievements of the Treaty System in the areas of peace, science, conservation, and environment. Antarctica has been an agreed zone of peace for nearly 30 years, free of all military activities, nuclear tests, and radioactive wastes. This is a foundation on which humanity must build. 95. Cooperation in scientific investigation has steadily expanded; it must be further strengthened, especially concerning Antarctica's role in global atmospheric and oceanic circulation and world climate. At the same time, more efforts should be made to secure full participation in such research. Means must be found to expand consultation and participation and to extend the benefits of international cooperation in Antarctic science and technology to the international community as a whole. The most cruel environmental threat comes from the environmental movement itself as we see the animal rights laws systematically destroy our way of life and violate our right as aboriginal peoples to our traditions and values. Yet our people, including the Arctic people, need development. The challenge is to find strategies for development that meet the needs of the people and the environment. Rhoda Inuksu Inuit Indian WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 96. Several suggestions along these lines have been made. They include establishing a fund to facilitate the participation of interested developing countries in Antarctic science, and inviting more scientists from developing nations to join projects and visit scientific stations. Given the costly technologies involved in Antarctic science, possibilities should be explored for sharing Antarctic base and logistics capabilities with interested non-consultative states. The right to consultative status could be extended to states participating in scientific activities on a joint basis. 97. As Antarctic activities multiply, sound conservation will also require increased data collection, monitoring, and environmental assessment. The interactive and cumulative effects of these projects must be carefully reviewed and areas of unique scientific and environmental value protected. 2. Anticipate Pressures for Mineral Development 98. Minerals of various kinds are known to exist in Antarctica, but the minerals talks have triggered false assumptions about the imminence of their development. Even given the most optimistic growth trends, it seems clear that more accessible sources will be developed elsewhere long before Antarctica attracts major investment. Only two minerals have been found that might exist in concentrations suitable for exploitation - coal in the Transantarctic Mountains and iron in the Prince Charles Mountains. Mining them would be a fool's venture./37 The costs would be prohibitive, and sufficient coal and iron can be found closer to the main markets. 99. Circumstantial evidence suggests the existence of offshore oil and gas, but no deposits have yet been discovered. The USSR, Japan, France, the United Kingdom, and the Federal Republic
  • 234. of Germany have surveyed Antarctica's continental shelves. The surveys were of a scientific nature, but, coinciding as they did with the first serious discussions of a minerals regime, were viewed by some observers as signalling commercial interests. 100. The 18 Consultative Parties are conducting negotiations among themselves to complete an agreed legal framework for determining the environmental acceptability of possible minerals exploration and development in Antarctica and to govern any such activities./38 Treaty members felt that it would be more difficult to agree on such a regime after actual finds have been made. The negotiations in many ways are an expression of the idea that prevention is better than cure, forethought preferable to afterthought. 101. Antarctica is an enormous continent where claims to sovereignty are in dispute and where there are no agreed legal bases for issuing licences, leasing or selling mineral rights, or receiving royalty payments. These delicate questions have now been raised and will not lie silent until they have been answered within an internationally agreed framework. Until these matters are resolved, and protection of the Antarctic environment is assured, it seems unlikely that any nation or group of nations will be able to invest securely in developing the continent's mineral resources./39 102. Given the absence of technologies tested in the ultimate extremities of Antarctic conditions, the lack of agreement on procedures to assess and take account of the impacts of any development, and the sparse data base, it could take a generation or more of dedicated research and technological development to ensure that minerals exploitation would not destroy the Antarctic's fragile ecosystem and its place in global environmental processes. Thus it is important that no minerals activity takes place until these conditions have changed, and then only in consonance with a regime that guarantees implementation of the most stringent standards needed to protect the continent's environment and share the proceeds equitably. 3. Promote Evolution of Antarctic Treaty System 103. In the years ahead, activities in Antarctica will expand in kind and scale, as will the numbers of participants in such activities. Further efforts must be made to ensure effective management of those activities and an orderly expansion of participation in such management. A variety of options are being discussed by the international community. More effective management, including expanded participation, could evolve gradually through the existing Treaty System. But given the extent of probable change and the lure of mineral wealth, however remote, such an approach could be too slow to retain political support. Another is that the above goals might be reached through the negotiation of an entirely new system. However, neither of these approaches would be free of difficulty. Yet another alternative would be to intensify efforts to make the Treaty System more universal, more open, and responsive to expressions of concrete and legitimate concern and interest in Antarctica. 4. Establish a Means for More Effective Communication 104. As activities under the different treaties increase, so does the importance of coordination among the advisory and decision making authorities responsible for various areas. Antarctica may require the establishment of somewhat more formal institutions than have governed the first generation of activities, in order to foster better communication and coordination both within and outside the Treaty System.
  • 235. Some unique objects like Lake Baikal and Siberia, the Great Lakes in Africa and North America, are part of our global patrimony. They are some of the absolute values our planet possesses and their significance transcends any national boundaries. We should learn how to foresee their future and how to anticipate the after-effects of large-scale engineering projects. Since people's interests vary, it cannot be taken for granted that people will accept scholars' recommendations and come to agreement on that score. And their agreement is of special importance in situations where global problems are involved and where the human race as a whole may be threatened with perils generated by the absence of such agreement. What is needed today is the moulding of a new ethos and new arrangements for building an understanding among people, countries, and regions. And as a first step we should produce new knowledge, concentrate our research efforts on maintaining life on earth, and develop a system distributing and disseminating knowledge and new moral criteria in a way that makes it available to billions of people who inhabit our planet. Academician N.N. Moiseev USSR Academy of Sciences WCED Public Hearing Moscow, 8 Dec 1986 105. Antarctica is on the agenda of the UN General Assembly and will probably remain so. Nothing will happen, however, unless the participants in the debate find terms of reference that can command broad-based support and an agreed upon means to explore and give effect to improved management. 106. To focus on longer-term strategies to preserve and build on the achievements of the existing Treaty System, nations must create the means to foster dialogue among politicians, scientists, environmentalists, and industries from countries within and outside it. A good place to start would be the development of closer working relationships between the parties to Antarctic regimes and the international organizations within and outside the UN system that have responsibilities for science and technology, conservation, and environmental management. 107. National policy processes could also be structured to provide for dialogue with concerned industries, public interest organizations, and expert advisors, perhaps through an Antarctic advisory committee. The U.S. Government has been in the forefront of those countries appointing industry and public interest advisors to its delegations to Consultative Parties meetings. Australia, New Zealand, and Denmark have more recently followed suit. 108. Hammering out an internationally supported consensus on Antarctica is a huge task requiting time and patience. And the lure of minerals increases with every new rumour of a find. Yet such a consensus is the only way to prevent a tragic plundering of the silent continent, and to maintain Antarctica as a symbol of peaceful international cooperation and environmental protection. Footnotes
  • 236. 1/ This section draws on F. Szekely, 'The Marine and Coastal Environment', prepared for WCED, 1986; J. Beddington, 'Whaling', prepared for WCED, 1986; V. Sebek, 'Policy Paper on Dumping', prepared for WCED, 1986. 2/ M.W. Holdgate et al., 'The Marine Environment', in The World Environment 1972-1982 (Dublin: Tycooly International Publishing Ltd., 1982). 3/ See National Academy of Sciences, Oil in the Sea (Washington, DC: National Academy Press, 1985); and OECD, Maritime Transport, 1984 (Paris: 1986). 4/ 'Scientists Closer to Identifying Cause of Antarctic Ozone Depletion', National Science Foundation News, 20 October 1986; Ad Hoc Working Group of Legal and Technical Experts for the Elaboration of a Protocol on the Control of Chlorofluorocarbons to the Vienna Convention for the Protection of the Ozone Layer (Vienna Group), 'Report of the Second Part of the Workshop on the Control of Chlorofluorocarbons, Leesburg, USA, UNEP/WG.151 /Background 2, Na.86-2184, UNEP, Nairobi, 15 October 1986; A.S. Miller and I.M. Mintzer, The Sky Is the Limit: Strategies for Protecting the Ozone Layer, WRI Research Report No. 3 (Washington, DC: World Resources Institute, 1986). 5/ GESAMP in a recent evaluation of the present state of the health of the oceans, 'The Health of the Oceans', Regional Seas Reports and Studies No. 16, UNEP, Nairobi, 1982. 6/ M. Bertrand, 'Some Reflections on Reform of the United Nations', Joint Inspection Unit, United Nations, Geneva, 1985. 7/ E.P. Eckholm, Down to Earth (London: Pluto Press, Ltd., 1982). 8/ J.A. Gulland and S. Garcia, 'Observed! Patterns in Multispecies Fisheries.' in R.M. May (ed.), Exploitation of Marine Communities (Berlin: Springer-Verlag, 1984); FAO, 'Review of the State of World Fishery Resources', Fisheries Circular 710 (rev. 4), Rome, 1985. 9/ Dr J. Gulland, Marine Resources Assessment Group, Imperial College of Science and Technology, London, personal communication, 20 January 1987. 10/ FAO, op. cit. 11/ IWC, Report of the IWC 36th Session, 1986 (Cambridge: forthcoming). 12/ 1965 Report on Great Lakes Water Quality: Great Lakes Water quality Board Report to the International Joint Commission (Windsor, Ont.: IJC, 1985). 13/ IMO, 'The Provisions of the London Dumping Convention, 1972', and Decisions made by the Consultative Meetings of Contracting Parties, 1975-1984. 14/ Dumping in the Convention means any deliberate disposal at sea of material and substances of any kind, form, or description from vessels, aircraft, platform, or other artificial structures, as well as the disposal of vessels, aircraft, platforms, or other artificial structures themselves. 15/ Twenty-five nations, led by Spain, Australia, and New Zealand, supported the resolution, while Canada, France, South Africa, Switzerland, the United Kingdom, and the United States voted against. 16/ U. Grimas and A. Svansson, Swedish Report on the Skagerak (Stockholm: National Environmental Protection Board, 1985).
  • 237. 17/ United Nations, Final Act of the Third Conference on the Law of the Sea, Montego Bay, Jamaica, December 1982. In its final form, the Convention is composed of 17 main parts (320 articles), dealing with the territorial sea and contiguous zone; straits used for international navigation; archipelagic states; exclusive economic zone; continental shelf; high seas; regime of islands; enclosed or semi-enclosed seas; right of access of land-locked states to and from the sea and freedom of transit; the area, protection, and preservation of the marine environment; marine scientific research; development and transfer of marine technology; settlement of disputes; general provisions; and final provisions. There are nine annexes to the Convention: highly migratory species; Commission on the Limits of the Continental Shelf; basic conditions of prospecting; exploration and exploitation; statute of the International Tribunal for the Law of the Sea; Statute of the Enterprise; conciliations; arbitration and special arbitration and participation by international organizations. Under the Convention, coastal states may adopt laws and regulations in the EEZ compatible with international rules and standards to combat pollution from vessels. 18/ Among other things, declaration by the President of the United States, on 9 July 1982, and L.O.S. Bulletin, July 1985, issued by the Office of the Special Representative of the Secretary General for the Law of the Sea Convention. 19/ W. Sullivan, 'Eruption in Mexico Tied to Climate Shift Off Peru.' New York Times, 12 December 1982. 20/ R. Kerr, 'Taking Shots at Ozone Hole Theories,' Science, 14 November 1986. 21/ When the speed of a satellite matches the speed of the planet's rotation, the satellite is stationary relative to particular places on the Earth. There is only one band or arc, directly above the equator, where it is possible to achieve geosynchronous orbit. 22/ The general case for a regulatory regime and several alternative regimes are spelled out in K.G. Gibbons, 'Orbital Saturation: The Necessity for International Regulation of Geosynchronous Orbits', California Western International Law Journal, Winter 1979 23/ A summary of Third World views is found in H.J. Levin, 'Orbit and Spectrum Resource Strategies: Third World Demands', Telecommunications Policy, June 1981. 24/ The allocation is done every 10 years at World Administrative Radio Conferences (WARCs), the last of which was held in 1979. U.S. Congress, Office ooe Technology Assessment, Radiofrequency Use and Management: Impacts from the World Administrative Radio Conference of 1979 (Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1980). 25/ These conferences are described in G. Coding, Jr., 'The USA and the 1985 Space WARC', and A.M. Rutkowski, 'Space WARC: The Stake of the Developing Countries, the GEO and the WARC-ORB 85 Conference', Space Policy, August 1985. 26/ AIAA Technical Committee on Space Systems, Space Debris, July 1981. 27/ The United States has launched 23 spacecraft that relied at least in part upon nuclear power sources: one source was a reactor; the rest were radioactive materials the decay heat of which is converted into electricity (thermoelectric generators). By the end of 1986 the Soviet Union had launched 31 nuclear-powered spacecraft, almost all of which contained fission reactors, and it currently operates all of the reactor-powered satellites. 28/ 'Antarctic: A Continent in Transition', Fact Sheet Folio, International Institute for Environment and Development, London, 1986.
  • 238. 29/ In 1983, the Seventh Summit Conference of the Non-Aligned Countries included a paragraph on Antarctica in its communique. That same year, the question of Antarctica was put on the agenda of the UN General Assembly. The debate resulted in a consensus resolution asking for the elaboration of a special report by the Secretary General, which was debated by the UN General Assembly at its 39th Session in November 1984. The consensus has not been maintained. At subsequent General Assembly sessions, resolutions on Antarctica have been passed over the objections of the parties to the Treaty, moat of whom chose not to participate in the vote. 30/ L. Kimball, 'Testing the Great Experiment', Environment, September 1985. 31/ 'Antarctic Treaty', concluded 1 December 1959 and entered into force 23 June 1961, summarized in M.J. Bowman and D.J. Harris (eds.), Multilateral Treaties: Index and Current Status (London: Butterworths, 1964). 32/ They include the original seven claimants: Argentina, Australia, Chile, France, New Zealand, Norway, and the United Kingdom; an additional five who were original signatories: Belgium, Japan, South Africa, USSR and the United States; plus six who have since acceded to the Treaty and become full Consultative Parties: Poland (1977), the Federal Republic of Germany (1981), Brazil and India (1983), and China and Uruguay (1985). Any country can accede to the Treaty, becoming a full 'Consultative Party' providing, and during such time as, it demonstrates an interest in the continent through the presence of a substantial scientific activity. Seventeen other countries have acceded to the Treaty, but do not hold consultative status. Since 1983, they have been invited to attend Antarctic Treaty meetings as observers. 33/ Both in their declaration of principles concerning the environment and in the text of the Convention on the Conservation of Antarctic Marine Living Resources, the Consultative Parties insist that the primary responsibility for these matters lies with them by virtue of their status as Consultative Parties, a proposition that Parties to the Convention who are not also Parties to the Treaty are obliged to affirm. 34/ 'Agreed Measures for the Conservation of Antarctic Fauna and Flora', agreed 2-13 June 1984, reprinted in W.M. Bush (ed.), Antarctica and International Law (London: Oceana Publications, 1982). 35/ 'Convention for the Conservation of Antarctic Seals', concluded 11 February 1972 and entered into force 11 March 1978, summarized in Bowman and Harris, op. cit.; 'Convention on the Conservation of Antarctic Marine Living Resources', concluded 20 May 1980 and entered into force 7 April 1981, summarized in ibid. See also J.N. Barnes, 'The Emerging Convention on the Conservation of Antarctic Marine Living Resources: An Attempt to Meet the New Realities of Resource Exploitation in the Southern Ocean', in J.I. Charney (ed.), New Nationalism and the Use of Common Spaces (Totowa, NJ: Allenheld Publishers, 1982). 36/ J.A. Beddington and R.M. May, 'The Harvesting ooe Interacting Species in a Natural Ecosystem', Scientific American, November 1982. 37/ J.H. Zumborge, 'Mineral Resources and Geopolitics in Antarctica', American Scientist, January-February 1979: G. Pontecorvo, 'The Economics of the Resources of Antarctica', in Charney, op. cit. 38/ L. Kimball, 'Unfreezing International Cooperation in Antarctica', Christian Science Monitor, 1 August 1982. 39/ D. Shapley, 'Antarctic Up for Grabs', Science 82, November 1982.
  • 239. Our Common Future, Chapter 11: Peace, Security, Development, and the Environment Environmental Stress as a I. Source of Conflict II. Conflict as a Cause of Unsustainable Development 1. Nuclear War - Threat to Civilization 2. Other Weapons of Mass Destruction 3. The Costs of the 'Arms Culture' 4. World Armaments and the Growth of the 'Arms Culture' III. Towards Security and Sustainable Development 1. Principles 2. Cooperative Management 3. The Importance of Early Warning 4. Disarmament and Security 1. Among the dangers facing the environment, the possibility of nuclear war, or military conflict of a lesser scale involving weapons of mass destruction, is undoubtedly the gravest. Certain aspects of the issues of peace and security bear directly upon the concept of sustainable development. Indeed, they are central to it. 2. Environmental stress is both a cause and an effect of political tension and military conflict./1 Nations have often fought to assert or resist control over raw materials, energy supplies, land, river basins, sea passages, and other key environmental resources. Such conflicts are likely to increase as these resources become scarcer and competition for them increases. 3. The environmental consequences of armed conflict would be most devastating in the case of thermo-nuclear war. But there are damaging effects too from conventional, biological, and chemical weapons, as well as from the disruption of economic production and social organization in the wake of warfare and mass migration of refugees. But even where war is prevented, and where conflict is contained, a state of 'peace' might well entail the diversion into armament production of vast resources that could, at least in part, be used to promote sustainable forms of development. 4. A number of factors affect the connection between environmental stress, poverty, and security, such as inadequate development policies, adverse trends in the international economy, inequities in multi-racial and multi-ethnic societies, and pressures of population
  • 240. growth. These linkages among environment, development, and conflict are complex and, in many cases, poorly understood. But a comprehensive approach to international and national security must transcend the traditional emphasis on military power and armed competition The real sources of insecurity also encompass unsustainable development, and its effects can become intertwined with traditional forms of conflict in a manner that can extend and deepen the latter. I. Environmental Stress as a Source of Conflict 5. Environmental stress is seldom the only cause of major conflicts within or among nations. Nevertheless, they can arise from the marginalization of sectors of the population and from ensuing violence. This occurs when political processes are unable to handle the effects of environmental stress resulting, for example, from erosion and desertification. Environmental stress can thus be an important part of the web of causality associated with any conflict and can in some cases be catalytic. 6. Poverty, injustice, environmental degradation, and conflict interact in complex and potent ways. One manifestation of growing concern to the international community is the phenomenon of 'environmental refugees'/2 The immediate cause of any mass movement of refugees may appear to be political upheaval and military violence. But the underlying causes often include the deterioration of the natural resource base and its capacity to support the population. 7. Events in the Horn of Africa are a case in point. In the early 1970s, drought and famine struck the nation of Ethiopia. Yet it has been found that the hunger and human misery were caused more by years of overuse of soils in the Ethiopian highlands and the resulting severe erosion than by drought. A report commissioned by the Ethiopian Relief and Rehabilitation Commission found: 'The primary cause of the famine was not drought of unprecedented severity, but a combination of long-continued bad land use and steadily increased human and stock populations over decades'./3 8. Wars have always compelled people to leave their homes and their lands, to become refugees. Also, the wars in our time have forced large numbers of people to leave their homelands. In addition, we now have the phenomenon of environmental refugees. In 1984-85, some 10 million Africans fled their homes, accounting for two-thirds of all refugees worldwide. Their flight was not surprising in a region where 35 million suffered from famine. Many of them swarmed into cities. But many others moved across national boundaries, heightening interstate tensions. Cote d'Ivoire, Ghana, and Nigeria have been generous in welcoming refugees from the desertified Sahel. Tanzania, Zambia, and Zimbabwe have also been receiving large numbers of refugees. Yet, the Cote d'Ivoire, for instance, which depends for much of its export revenues on timber, is suffering rapid deforestation caused in part by land hunger, and one-third of landless people are immigrants. Agriculture destroys 4.5 times as much forestland in the Cote d'Ivoire as logging does./4 9. Almost 1 million Haitian 'boat people', one-sixth of the entire populace, have fled that island nation, an exodus fuelled in large part by environmental degradation. Haiti suffers some of the world's most severe erosion, down to bedrock over large parts of some regions, so that even farmers with reasonable amounts of land cannot make a living. According to a US Agency for International Development (USAID) report, 'The social and economic effects of environmental degradation are great, and contribute to the growing outflow from rural areas. Thousands of rural Haitians leave their homes each year for Port au Prince, other Caribbean islands and the United States in search of employment and better living conditions./5 El Salvador, one of the
  • 241. most troubled nations of Central America, is also one of the most environmentally impoverished, with some of the worst erosion rates in the region. The fundamental causes of the present conflict are as much environmental as political, stemming from problems of resource distribution in an overcrowded land, according to a draft USAID environmental profile of El Salvador./6 Today we cannot secure security for one state at the expense of the other. Security can only be universal, but security cannot only be political or military, it must be as well ecological, economical, and social. It must ensure the fulfilment of the aspirations of humanity as a whole. A. S. Timoshenko Institute of State and Law, USSR Academy of Sciences WCED Public Hearing Moscow, 11 Dec 1986 10. South Africa reveals similar problems. The inhuman policy of apartheid is at the core of the state of political conflict in Southern Africa. One of the many ways by which apartheid institutionalizes both conflict and environmental degradation is by allocating, through the 'homelands' system, 14 per cent of the nation's land to 72 per cent of the population./7 Young working-age blacks flee the overcultivated and overgrazed 'homelands' to seek work in the cities, where, on top of the squalor of overcrowded townships, they encounter extreme socio-economic inequality and racial segregation. They fight back. Repression intensifies, and the victims seek refuge over the border - whereupon the South African regime widens the conflict into neighbouring states. The entire region is becoming caught up in the ensuing violence, which could well ignite wider conflict drawing in major powers. 11. In addition to the interrelated problems of poverty, injustice, and environmental stress, competition for non-renewable raw materials, land, or energy can create tension. It was the quest for raw materials that underlay much of the competition between colonial powers and the subjugation of their holdings. Conflicts in the Middle East inevitably contain the seeds of great power intervention and global conflagration, in part because of the international interest in oil. 12. As unsustainable forms of development push individual countries up against environmental limits, major differences in environmental endowment among countries, or variations in stocks of usable land and raw materials, could precipitate and exacerbate international tension and conflict. And competition for use of the global commons, such as ocean fisheries and Antarctica, or for use of more localized common resources in fixed supply, such as rivers and coastal waters, could escalate to the level of international conflict and to threaten international peace and security. 13. Global water use doubled between 1940 and 1980, and it is expected to double again by 2000, with two thirds of the projected water use going to agriculture. Yet 80 countries, with 40 per cent of the world's population, already suffer serious water shortages./8 There will be growing competition for water for irrigation, industry, and domestic use. River water disputes have already occurred in North America (the Rio Grande), South America (the Rio de la Plata and Parana), South and Southeast Asia (the Mekong and the Ganges), Africa (the Nile), and the Middle East (the Jordan, Litani, and Orontes, as well as the Euphrates).
  • 242. How can the world of nature and the community of peoples with their national economies be harmonized? Posing the question this way suggests that the two are separate. But not so. Humanity, the human species, exists and it supported within the world of nature. And I mean that not figuratively but literally. We are deep-air animals living inside an ecological system. We draw boundaries, of course, on the ecosphere for national and regional purposes. But it is all of one piece. When, therefore, we optimistically declare that economic development and environmental maintenance can go along hand in hand, this qualifier must immediately be added: only if the maintenance of the ecosphere is made the first priority. Economic development must be secondary, guided by strict ecological standards. These fundamental ideas are far from being universally accepted. Stanley Rowe Saskatchewan Environmental Society WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 14. Fisheries, whether coastal or oceanic, are fundamental to the diets of many countries. For some countries, fishing is a key economic sector, and overfishing poses immediate dangers to several national economies. In 1974 Iceland, largely dependent on its fishing industry, found itself embroiled with the United Kingdom in a 'cod war'. Similar tensions exist in the Japanese and Korean seas and on both sides of the South Atlantic. The 1986 declaration of an exclusive fishery zone around the Falkland/Malvinas Islands has further unsettled relations between Britain and Argentina. Disputes over fishing rights in the South Pacific and the search for tuna by distant-water fleets led to increased competition for diplomatic and fisheries advantages by the major powers in that region in 1986. Fisheries-related disputes may well become more frequent as nations harvest fish stocks beyond the level of sustainable yields. 15. Environmental threats to security are now beginning to emerge on a global scale. The most worrisome of these stem from the possible consequences of global warming caused by the atmospheric build-up of carbon dioxide and other gases./9 (See Chapter 7.) Any such climatic change would quite probably be unequal in its effects, disrupting agricultural systems in areas that provide a large proportion of the world's cereal harvests and perhaps triggering mass population movements in areas where hunger is already endemic. Sea levels may rise during the first half of the next century enough to radically change the boundaries between coastal nations and to change the shapes and strategic importance of international waterways - effects both likely to increase international tensions. The climatic and sea-level changes are also likely to disrupt the breeding grounds of economically important fish species. Slowing, or adapting to, global warming is becoming an essential task to reduce the risks of conflict. II. Conflict as a Cause of Unsustainable Development 16. Arms competition and armed conflict create major obstacles to sustainable development. They make huge claims on scarce material resources. They pre-empt human resources and wealth that could be used to combat the collapse of environmental support systems, the poverty, and the underdevelopment that in combination contribute so much to contemporary political insecurity. They may stimulate an ethos that is antagonistic towards cooperation among nations whose ecological and economic interdependence requires them to overcome
  • 243. national or ideological antipathies. 17. The existence of nuclear weapons and the destructive potential inherent in the velocity and intensity of modern conventional warfare have given rise to a new understanding of the requirements for security among nations. In the nuclear age nations can no longer obtain security at each other's expense. They must seek security through cooperation, agreements, and mutual restraint; they must seek common security./10 Hence interdependence, which is so fundamental in the realm of environment and economics, is a fact also in the sphere of arms competition and military security. Interdependence has become a compelling fact, forcing nations to reconcile their approach to 'security'. 1. Nuclear War - Threat to Civilization 18. The likely consequences of nuclear war make other threats, to the environment pale into insignificance. Nuclear weapons represent a qualitatively new step in the development of warfare. One thermo-nuclear bomb can have an explosive power greater than that of all the explosives Used in wars since the invention of gunpowder. In addition to the destructive effects of blast and heat, immensely magnified by these weapons, they introduce a new lethal agent - ionizing radiation - that extends lethal effects over both space and tine. 19. In recent years, scientists have in addition called our attention to the prospect of 'nuclear winter'. It has been most authoritatively explored by some 300 scientists from the United States, the USSR, and more than 30 other countries - working on a collaborative basis in some cases across ideological divides./11 All youth organizations believe that environmental issues stand high on the priority list of global problems. However, their solution depends on the preservation of peace on our planet. The quest of solutions to ecological problems is impossible without the curbing of the arms race, for the arms race absorbs tremendous intellectual and material resources of mankind. The solution of ecological problems also depends on the way of life of young people and their value orientation. Dr. I.I. Russin Moscow State University WCED Public Hearing Moscow, 8 Dec 1986 20. The theory contends that the smoke and dust ejected into the atmosphere by a nuclear war could absorb enough solar radiation to remain aloft for some time, preventing sunlight from reaching the surface of the earth, causing a widespread and prolonged cooling of land areas. There would be severe repercussions for plant life generally and for agriculture in particular, disrupting the production of food to sustain survivors of the war. Great uncertainties remain about the scale and linkages determining environmental effects, but large-scale environmental perturbations are considered probable. A nuclear war cannot be won, and must never be fought. In the aftermath, there would be no difference between so called victor and vanquished. The nuclear-weapon states must spare no effort to conclude a verifiable agreement on banning all nuclear weapon tests. 21. The findings on nuclear winter are vitally important too for non-aligned nations, predominantly in the South, which are not parties to the East West conflict. They cannot
  • 244. expect to avoid the potentially disastrous environmental consequences of nuclear war in the northern hemisphere. The aftermath of such a war would envelop the world. There is a danger that nuclear weapons will spread to more and more countries and be used in what begins as a limited regional conflict. Beyond the five recognized nuclear-weapon states, at least six others have a widely acknowledged potential nuclear weapons capability; a dozen others are not far behind. The nuclear-weapon states cannot expect the non-nuclear-weapon states to abstain from exercising the nuclear option in the absence of real progress on the road to nuclear disarmament. It is imperative, therefore, that the probable consequences of nuclear war be recognized universally and that all states become involved in efforts to prevent the proliferation - and above all the use of nuclear weapons. 2. Other Weapons of Mass Destruction 22. Other forms of war and other weapons of mass destruction have large scale effects or both human societies and the human environment. Biological warfare could release new agents of disease that would prove difficult to control. Recent advances in biotechnology multiply the potentially lethal applications of such weapons. Likewise, the deliberate manipulation of the environment (for example, through artificial earthquakes and floods) would have consequences far beyond the borders of those involved in a conflict, were they ever used. Chemical agents can seriously damage the environment, as demonstrated by the defoliants used in South-east Asia. The dangerous and environmentally unpredictable consequences of biological and chemical weapons have led to international agreements banning their use./12 But there is need for further efforts to strengthen the regimes to which these agreements contribute. In particular, the Geneva protocol prohibiting the use of chemical weapons should be supplemented by agreements prohibiting the production and stockpiling of such weapons. 23. Military applications of new technologies now threaten lo make outer space a focus of international competition and conflict. (See Chapter 10.) Most countries in the international community see space as a global commons that should benefit humanity as a whole and be preserved from military competition - a feeling reflected in the 1967 Outer Space Treaty, under which nations agreed not to deploy weapons of mass destruction there. Governments should now agree on measures to prevent an arms race in space and stop it on Earth. Failing such agreement, the arms race could expand, with dire consequences for humanity. 3. The Costs of the 'Arms Culture' 24. The absence of war is not peace; nor does it necessarily provide the conditions for sustainable development. Competitive arms races breed insecurity among nations through spirals of reciprocal fears. Nations need to muster resources to combat environmental degradation and mass poverty. By misdirecting scarce resources, arms races contribute further to insecurity. 25. The coexistence of substantial military spending with unmet human needs has long evoked concern. President Eisenhower, for example, observed at the end his term in office that 'every gun that is made, every warship launched, every rocket fired represents, in the final analysis, a theft from those who hunger and are not fed, who are cold and are not clothed'./13 26. Global military spending in 1985 was well in excess of $900 billion./14 This was more than the total income of the poorest half of humanity. It represented the equivalent of almost $1,000 for every one of the world's 1 billion poorest. Put another way, military spending surpassed the combined gross national products of China, India, and the African countries
  • 245. south of the Sahara. Moreover, global military spending has risen not only absolutely but proportionately - from an estimated 4.7 per cent of world output in 1960 to over 6 per cent - representing an increase of about 150 per cent in real (constant price) terms. Three-quarters of current expenditure is in the industrial world./15 27. The true cost of the arms race is the loss of what could have been produced instead with scarce capital, labour skills, and raw materials. The plants that manufacture weapons, the transport of those weapons, and the mining of minerals for their production all place enormous demands on energy and mineral resources and are a major contributor to pollution and environmental deterioration. 28. The distorting effects of the 'arms culture' are most striking in the deployment of scientific personnel. Half a million scientists are employed on weapons research world-wide, and they account to: around half of all research and development expenditure./16 This exceeds the total combined spending on developing technologies for new energy sources, improving human health, raising agricultural productivity, and controlling pollution. Military research and development - $70-80 billion world-wide in 1984 - is growing at twice the rate of military spending as a whole./17 At the same time, there is a paucity of resources available for monitoring global climatic change, for surveying the ecosystems of disappearing rain forests and spreading deserts, and for developing agricultural technologies appropriate to rainfed, tropical agriculture. 29. Nations are seeking a new era of economic growth. The level of spending on arms diminishes the prospects for such an era - especially one that emphasizes the more efficient use of raw materials, energy, and skilled human resources. It also has a bearing, albeit indirect, on the willingness of rich countries to provide development assistance to developing countries. Clearly, there is no simple correspondence between reduced defence spending and increased aid. There are other reasons aside from domestic resource constraints for a reluctance to expand aid, and nations cannot wait for disarmament before devoting more resources to ensuring sustainable development. Nonetheless, increased defence spending puts pressure on other budgetary items, and aid is an easy target, despite being a relatively small outlay for most donor countries./18 30. Although redeployment is clearly possible, resources currently employed in military applications cannot be redeployed quickly or easily elsewhere in other sectors or other countries. There are technical problems in achieving such a transformation, not least the contribution made by military spending to jobs in economies with high unemployment. And beyond the technical problems are questions of political will. Nonetheless, some countries - China, Argentina, and Peru, for example - have recently shown that it is both technically and politically possible to make substantial shifts from military to civilian spending within a short time./19 4. World Armaments and the Growth of the 'Arms Culture' 31. Traditionally, nations have adhered to an 'arms culture'. They find themselves locked into arms competitions fuelled among other things by powerful vested interests in the 'military-industrial complex' as well as in the armed forces themselves. Industrial nations account for most of the military expenditures and the production and transfer of arms in international society. However, the influence of this 'arms culture' is not confined to these nations. It is present also in the developing world, fostered both by the desire of many governments to seek security through acquisition of arms and by a burgeoning world arms trade.
  • 246. I have here listened to people speaking about financial crises, famine, pollution, and social injustice at various levels. As an ecologist, I cannot see any of these questions without linking them to the armaments question and to the nuclear issue. Poverty generates tensions and conflicts, urban and rural violence. The indigenous people are still awaiting solutions for their problems. All this depends on money and nevertheless we are spending money on our nuclear programmes. They say that this has peaceful objectives. This is not true because precious money is being spent on this. The greatest crime: the death of hope, the death of all of the rights we all have, especially that of the young of believing in a future, the hope for a normal life, a difficult life but something that appears as a challenge to live it the best we can. We have a right to this chance. Cacilda Lanuza Brazilian Ecological Movement WCED Public Hearing Sao Paulo, 28- 29 Oct 1985 32. Since the early 1960s, military spending in developing countries as a whole has increased fivefold. Their share of total spending increased from under one-tenth to almost a quarter of a far larger total./20 Some developing countries, such as the Republic of Korea, have achieved a high level of development in spite of military spending. But systematic analysis suggests that increases in military spending have had negative effects on economic performance./21 33. Moreover, defence expenditure is one of the most import-intensive of activities, usually creating a large secondary demand for imported spares, ammunition, servicing, training, and fuel. It has been estimated that 20 per cent of the external debt acquired by non-oil developing countries in the decade to 1982 could be attributed to arms imports./22 And high levels of arms spending motivated by a variety of reasons have undoubtedly contributed to the severity of the crises of development in Africa, where military spending rose, in real terms, by 7.8 per cent per annum between 1971 and 1982, and arms imports rose by 18.5 per cent./23 it should be noted in this connection that in the case of the Frontline States they have been compelled to expand their armed forces because of the threat from South Africa. 34. The development of an 'arms culture' in many developing countries presents particular dangers in the context of environmental and poverty-induced stresses. There are already numerous simmering disputes in the Third World - over 40 unresolved - many arising from boundaries defined in colonial times. 35. Sophisticated weapons can help convert the potential into actual conflict. According to the UN Group of Governmental Experts on the Relationship Between Disarmament and Development: There can no longer be the slightest doubt that resource scarcities and ecological stresses constitute real and imminent threats to the future well-being of all people and nations. These challenges are fundamentally non-military and it is imperative that they be addressed accordingly. If this is not recognized, ... there is a grave risk that the situation will deteriorate to the point of crisis where, even with low probability of success, the use of force could be seen as a way to produce results quickly enough. This is far from being a remote possibility. In recent years, there has been a marked tendency
  • 247. in international relations to use or to threaten to use military force in response to non-military challenges to security./24 36. The situation in many developing countries presents particular dangers in the context of environmental and poverty-induced stresses. Large-scale movements of refugees, competition for scarce water and fertile lands, deposits of oil and raw materials, ill-defined boundaries, and so on all add to tensions and increase possibilities for conflict. The importation of armaments by developing countries has increased also because of these real or potential conflicts. It is sometimes encouraged by the arms manufacturers because of the important profits that can themselves sustain the manufacture of arms in the exporting countries. The export of arms have been evaluated at more than $35 billion annually. The arms trade is estimated to have absorbed over $300 billion over the last two decades, three-quarters in the form of sales to developing countries./25 III. Towards Security and Sustainable Development 1. Principles 37. The first step in creating a more satisfactory basis for managing the interrelationships between security and sustainable development is to broaden our vision. Conflicts may arise not only because of political and military threats to national sovereignty; they may derive also from environmental degradation and the pre-emption of development options. 38. There are, of course, no military solutions to 'environmental insecurity'. And modern warfare can itself create major internationally shared environmental hazards. Furthermore, the idea of national sovereignty, has been fundamentally modified by the fact of interdependence in the realm of economics, environment, and security. The global commons cannot be managed from any national centre: The nation state is insufficient to deal with threats to shared ecosystems. Threats to environmental security can only be dealt with by joint management and multilateral procedures and mechanisms. Environment must also be an approach to development. Environment is a social justice issue and environment even is a peace and security issue. The barriers to achieving sustainable development are great, as might be expected in a major historical transformation, but they are far from insurmountable. We approach the millennium in a world in which global interdependence is the central reality, but where absolute poverty and environmental degradation cloud our vision of a common future, and where a geopolitical climate dominated by nuclear terrorism and increasing militarization saps the idealism of the young and the will to dream in us all. Ralph Torrie On Behalf of Canadian Environment, Development and Peace Organizations WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 2. Cooperative Management 39. Already, environmental stresses are encouraging cooperation among nations, giving some
  • 248. indication of ways to proceed. Antarctica is subject to a far-reaching agreement that provides a collective approach to management. (See Chapter 10.) There are now various institutional systems, often of complex and advanced form, to foster bilateral and regional cooperation for marine fisheries in order to regulate maximum sustainable yields and the distribution of catches. One of the main threats to the oceans the dumping of highly toxic wastes has so far been managed by the London Dumping Convention. As for international water bodies, impressive progress has been made by the bilateral U.S.-Canadian Commission for the Great Lakes. The Mediterranean Convention, only one of the many such treaties concluded within the context of the UNEP Regional Seas Programme, brings together coastal nations in an arrangement to monitor and combat pollution at sea. 40. Some of the most challenging problems require cooperation among nations enjoying different systems of government, or even subject to antagonistic relations. The 1986 Chernobyl reactor accident in the Soviet Union has resulted in two agreements covering international cooperation in cases of such accidents. In the future, the nation concerned will immediately alert neighbouring states; they, in turn, will offer assistance at cost and free of liability./26 The 1979 Convention on Transboundary Pollution has provided a framework for monitoring and assessing damage from pollutants causing acid rain in Europe./27 41. Cooperation on environmental issues among developing countries has often been made difficult by poor communications. Nonetheless, many now participate in UNEP's Regional Seas Programme. The nations of the Sahel have formed a regional organization to deal with desertification, and there ie emerging a body of successful case histories with respect to river basin development: Witness the joint management programmes in Africa for the Senegal River Basin.
  • 249. Box 11-1 Spending on Military Versus Environmental Security The world spent well over $900 billion on military purposes in 1985, more than $2.5 billion a day. The real cost is what the same resources might otherwise be used for: An Action Plan for Tropical Forests would cost $1.3 billion a year over the course of five years. This annual sum is the equivalent of half a day of military expenditure worldwide. Implementing the UN Action Plan for Desertification would cost $4.5 billion a year during the last two decades of this century - the equivalent of less than two days of military spending. One of the greatest environmental hazards in the Third World is lack of clean water for household use, contributing to 80 per cent of disease. The UN Water and Sanitation Decade, although given only a small fraction of support needed, would have cost $30 billion a year during the 1980s. This is the approximate equivalent of 10 days of military spending. To supply contraceptive materials to all women already motivated to use family planning would cost an additional $1 billion per year on top of the $2 billion spent today. This additional $1 billion is the equivalent of 10 hours of military spending. Sources: International Task Force, Tropical Forests: A Call for Action (Washington, DC: World Resources Institute, 1965); Dr M.K. Tolba, 'Desertification and the Economics of Survival', UNEP Information 86/2. 25 March 1986; A. Agarwal et al., Water, Sanitation and Health for All? (London: IIED/Earthscan, 1981); World Bank, World Development Report, 1984 (New York: Oxford University Press, 1984). 3. The Importance of Early Warning 42. Since it is often uncertainty and insecurity that prompts international conflict, it is of the utmost importance that governments become aware of imminent environmental stress before the damage actually threatens core national interests. Governments are usually not well equipped with this kind of foresight. 43. It would be highly desirable if the appropriate international organizations, including appropriate UN bodies and regional organizations, were to pool their resources and draw on the most sophisticated surveillance technology available - to establish a reliable early wanting system for environmental risks and conflict. (See Chapter 12.) such a system would monitor indicators of risks and potential disputes, such as soil erosion, growth in regional migration, and uses of commons that are approaching the thresholds of sustainability. The organizations would also offer their services for helping the respective countries to establish principles and institutions for joint management.
  • 250. 4. Disarmament and Security 44. Action to reduce environmental threats to security requires a redefinition of priorities, nationally and globally. Such a redefinition could evolve through the widespread acceptance of broader forms of security assessment and embrace military, political, environmental, and other sources of conflict. 45. A broader approach to security assessment would no doubt find many cases in which national, regional, and global security could be enhanced through expenditures quite small in relation to the levels of military spending. Four of the most urgent global environmental requirements - relating to tropical forests, water, desertification, and population - could be funded with the equivalent of less than one month's global military spending. (See Box 11-1.) It is difficult to shift budgetary resources, but individual governments have already shown that transformation is possible, given political will. In some of the countries most seriously affected by environmental stress and poverty, the sums required to alleviate these conditions are small in relation to what is now spent on disaster relief, let alone military activities./28 However, these sums must be spent quickly, before deteriorating conditions require much larger expenditures. 46. But in terms of the aggregate resources involved in arms spending and the potential throat to the environment from war, the greatest need is to improve relations among those major powers capable of deploying weapons of mass destruction. This is needed to achieve agreement on tighter control over the proliferation and testing of various types of weapons of mass destruction nuclear and non-nuclear including those that have environmental implications./29 47. A substantial number of agreements already show the potential for negotiated, multilateral solutions. President Reagan and General Secretary Gorbachev made substantial progress towards strategic arms agreement, which must be carried forward to reverse the alarming trends of several decades. Apparently, the two major powers came close to agreeing on intermediate range systems in Europe, to be followed by agreements banning forward deployment of shorter range systems. It would alleviate significantly the pressures exercised by nuclear weapons on the security order in Europe. In addition, they are moving towards, a 50 per cent reduction agreement on strategic systems, followed by total elimination agreements. They also need to agree on effective measures to prevent an arms race in space. Successful negotiations would contribute significantly to stemming the spread of nuclear weapons as the major nuclear-weapon states would deliver on their promise to build down their nuclear arsenals. Such progress is consistent with the basic needs of our times and the right of humanity to have the spectre of nuclear destruction removed from the face of the Earth. 48. Nations must turn away from the destructive logic of an 'arms culture' and focus instead or their common future. The level of armaments and the destruction they could bring about bear no relation to the political conflict that triggered the arms competition in the first place. Nations must not become prisoners of their own arms race. They must face the common danger inherent in the weapon of the nuclear age. They must face the common challenge of providing for sustainable development and act in concert to remove the growing environmental sources of conflict. Footnotes
  • 251. 1/ For some preliminary analyses along these lines, see L. Timberlake and J. Tinker, 'Environment and Conflict: Links Between Ecological Decay, Environmental Bankruptcy and Political and Military Instability, Earthscan Briefing Document. Earthscan, London, 1964; N. Myers, 'The Environmental Dimension to Security Issues', The Environmentalist, Winter 1986; R.H. Ullman, 'Redefining Security', International Security, Summer 1983; and A.H, Westing (ed.), Global Resources and International Conflict (Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1986). 2/ E. El-Hinnawi, Environmental Refugees (Nairobi: UNEP, 1985). 3/ Relief and Rehabilitation Commission, 'Drought and Rehabilitation in Wollo and Tigrai', Addis Ababa, 1975. 4/ L. Timberlake, Africa in Crisis (London: International Institute for Environment and Development/Earthscan, 1985). 5/ Project Paper for Haiti Agroforestry Outreach Project (Project 521-0122), U.S. Agency for International Development, Washington, DC, 1981. 6/ National Park Service/U.S. Man and the Biosphere Secretariat, 'Draft Environmental Profile of El Salvador', Bureau of Science and Technology, U.S. Agency for International Development, Washington, DC, April 1982. See also T.P. Anderson, The War of the Dispossessed: Honduras and El Salvador 1969 (Lincoln, Neb.: University of Nebraska Press, 1981); W.H. Durham, Scarcity and Survival in Central America: Ecological Origins of the Soccer War (Stanford, Calif.: Stanford University Press, 1979). 7/ D. Smith, 'Update: Apartheid in South Africa', Queen Mary College, London, 1984. 8/ M. Falkenmark, 'New Ecological Approach to the Water Cycle: Ticket to the Future', Ambio, Vol. 13, No. 3, 1964; S. Postel, Water: Rethinking Management in an Age of Scarcity, Worldwatch Paper 62 (Washington, DC: WorldWatch Institute, 1984). 9/ B. Bolin et al., The Greenhouse Effect: Climatic Change and Ecosystems (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1986); National Research Council, Changing Climate (Washington, DC: National Academy Press, 1983); S. Seidel and D. Keyes, Can We Delay a Greenhouse Warming? (Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, 1983). 10/ Independent Commission on Disarmament and Security Issues under the Chairmanship of Olof Palme, Common Security (London: Pan Books, 1982). 11/ SCOPE, Environmental Consequences of Nuclear War (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1985). Some of the other major studies on the nuclear winter scenario are R. Turco et al., 'Nuclear Winter: Global Consequences of Multiple Nuclear Explosions', Science, 23 December 1983; P. Ehrlich et al., The Cold and the Dark: The World After Nuclear War (New York: W.W. Norton, 1984); M.A. Hartwell and T.C. Hutchinson, Environmental Consequences of Nuclear War, Volume II: Ecological and Agricultural Effects (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1985); National Research Council, The Effects on the Atmosphere of a Major Nuclear Exchange (Washington, DC: National Academy Press, 1985); A. Ginsberg et al., 'Global Consequences of a Nuclear War: A Review of Recent Soviet Studies', World Armaments and Disarmament, SIPRI Yearbook 1985 (London: Taylor & Francis, 1985); A.B. Pittock et al., Environmental Consequences of Nuclear War, Volume I: Physical and Atmospheric Effects (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1986); S.L. Thompson and S.H. Schneider, 'Nuclear Winter Reappraised', Foreign Affairs, Summer 1986. The effects of nuclear war are explored in Y.I. Chazor et al., The Danger of
  • 252. Nuclear War: Soviet Physicians' Viewpoint (Moscow: Novosti Press, 1982); S. Glasstone and P.J. Dolan (eds.), The Effects of Nuclear Weapons, 3rd ed. (Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing office, 1977); National Academy of Sciences, Long-term Worldwide Effects of Multiple Nuclear Weapon Detonations (Washington, DC: National Academy Press, 1975); Office of Technology Assessment, U.S. Congress, The Effects of Nuclear War (Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1980); UN, Comprehensive Study of Nuclear Weapons (A/35/392) (New York: 1980); World Health Organization, Effects of Nuclear War on Health and Health Services (Geneva: 1984). 12/ Outright banning of particularly lethal weapons has its origin in the St. Petersburg Declaration banning the use of 'dum-dum bullets' and the Hague war rules outlining the use of shaped charges (1899). Also relevant are the Geneva Protocol banning the military use of chemical and bacteriological weapons (1925); the Convention on the Prohibition of the Development, Production, and Stockpiling of Bacteriological and Toxin Weapons (1975); and the Convention on the Prohibition of Military or Any Other Hostile Use of Environmental Modification Techniques (1978). 13/ The Eisenhower quote is taken from his final, valedictory address (Speech to the American Society of Newspaper Editors Washington, DC, April, 1953) which also includes the more famous reference to the 'military-industrial complex'. 14/ Estimates from R.L. Sivard, World Military and Social Expenditures (Washington, DC: World Priorities, Inc., 1986). More details in M. Brzoska et al., 'World Military Expenditure and Arms Production', SIPRI Yearbook, op. cit. The figure of total military spending is necessarily approximate because of the enormous problems of aggregating spending in different - and often non-convertible - currencies and from countries with different statistical conventions. According to Sivard, total military spending in 1983 was $728 billion. On the basis of trends and preliminary data, a figure of at least $900 billion and possibly $1,000 billion in current prices and exchange rates seems appropriate for 1986. 15/ Sivard, 1986 edition, op. cit., SIPRI Yearbook, op. cit. 16/ Sivard, 1986 edition, op. cit., SIPRI Yearbook, op. cit. 17/ M. Ackland-Hood, 'Military Research and Development Expenditure', SIPRI Yearbook, op. cit. 18/ According to calculations based on OECD Development Assistance Committee data, which are not universally accepted, together with Sivard, total non-military development aid measured in net concessional flows from industrial to developing countries represents roughly 5 per cent of the amount spent by all industrial countries on armaments. For the United States, foreign aid accounts for 4 per cent of armaments spending, and for the USSR, 1.5 per cent. In Austria, Denmark, the Netherlands, Norway, and Sweden, by contrast, the proportion is close to 30 per cent, and it is over 10 per cent for Australia, Belgium, Canada, France, FRG, and Switzerland, 19/ According to L.H. Brown et al., in State of the World 1986 (London: W.W. Norton, 1986), China in 1972 spent 14 per cent of its gross national product (GNP) on military purposes, one of the highest levels in the world. Since 1970 (except for 1979), the government has systematically reduced this until by 1985 it amounted to only 7.5 per cent In mid 1985 the government announced it would cut the armed forces to 3.2 million, a drop of 24 per cent. In Argentina, by 1984 new President Raul Alfonsin had cut arms outlays to half their peak level of 1980 (nearly 4 per cent of GNP) by reordering priorities and shifting resources to social programmes.
  • 253. Peruvian President Alan Garcia Perez, on taking office in mid-1985, announced he would reduce military outlays, which then totalled 5 per cent of GNP, or one-quarter of the federal budget. First he cancelled half the order for 26 French Mirage fighter planes. 20/ Over 1960-81, Third World military expenditures grew by some 7 per cent per year, as compared with 3.7 per cent in the industrial world. In 1960, Third World military expenditures accounted for less than one-tenth of the global total 1981 for more than one fifth of a far larger total. R.L. Sivard, World Military and Social Expenditures (Washington, DC: World Priorities, Inc., 198b). 21/ L. Taylor, 'Military Economics in the Third World', prepared for The Independent Commission on Disarmament and Security Issues, 1981. 22/ R. Tullberg, 'Military Related Debt in Non-Oil Developing Countries', SIPRI Yearbook, op. cit. 23/ R. Luckham, 'Militarization in Africa', SIPRI Yearbook, op. cit. 24/ I. Thorsson et al., Relationship Between Disarmament and Development, Disarmament Study Review No. 5 (A/36/536) (New York: UN Department of Political and Security Council Affairs, 1982). 25/ Arms Export from L.R. Brown et al., op. cit, based on U.S. Arms Control and Disarmament Agency; estimate of cumulative spending on the arine trade in Sivard, 1985 edition, op. cit. 26/ 'Negotiations on Agreement Concerning Nuclear Safety Reach Consensus', press release (PR8-86/17), IAEA, 15 August 1986. 27/ 'Convention on Long-Range Transboundary Air Pollution' concluded 13 November 1979 and entered into force 16 March 1983, summarized in M.J. Bowman and D.J. Harris (eds.), Multilateral Treaties: Index and Current Status (London: Butterworths, 1984). 28/ The amount that the United Nations has recently budgeted for Ethiopia to cater for anti-erosion, reforestation, and related measures under its Anti-Desertification Plan suggests that no more than $50 million a year would have been required to counter much of the highlands' problem if the investment had been undertaken in due time. By contrast, the amount required to counter Ethiopia's famine during 1985 amounted to $500 million for relief measures alone. Between 1976 and 1980 Ethiopia spent an average of $225 million a year on military activities. 29/ Among international treaties specifically designed to protect the global commons from militarization are the Antarctic Treaty (1959); the Moscow Treaty Banning Nuclear Weapons Tests in the Atmosphere, in Outer Space and Under Water (1963); the Outer Space Treaty (1967); the Treaty of Tlatelolco (1967); the Treaty on the Non Proliferation of Nuclear Weapons (1968); and the Sea Bed Treaty (1971).
  • 254. Our Common Future, Chapter 12: Towards Common Action: Proposals For institutional and Legal Change The Challenge for Institutional I. and Legal Change 1. Shifting the Focus to the Policy Sources 2. New Imperatives for International Cooperation II. Proposals for Institutional and Legal Change 1. Getting at the Sources 1.1 National Policies and Institutions 1.2 Regional and Interregional Action 1.3 Global Institutions and Programmes 2. Dealing With the Effects 2.1 National Environmental Protection and Natural Resources Management Agencies 2.2 Strengthen the United Nations Environment Programme 2.2.1 Focus on Environmental Protection Issues 2.2.2 Priority to Global Environmental Assessment and Reporting 2.2.3 Strengthen International Environmental Cooperation 2.2.4. Increase the Revenue and Focus of the Environment Fund 3. Assessing Global Risks 4. Making Informed Choices 4.1 Increase the Role of the Scientific Community and Non-Governmental Organizations 4.2 Increase Cooperation with Industry
  • 255. Providing 5. the Legal Means 5.1 Recognizing Rights and Responsibilities 5.2 A Universal Declaration and a Convention on Environmental Protection and Sustainable Development 5.3 Strengthen and Extend Existing International Conventions and Agreements 5.4 Avoiding and Settling Environmental Disputes 6. Investing in Our Future 6.1 National Action 6.2 International Action 6.2.1 Reorienting Multilateral Financial Institutions 6.2.2 Reorienting Bilateral Aid Agencies 6.2.3 New Sources of Revenue and Automatic Financing III. A Call for Action 1. In the middle or the 20th century, we saw our planet from space for the first time. Historians may eventually find that this vision had a greater impact on thought than did the Copernican revolution of the 16th century, which upset humans' self-image by revealing that the Earth is not the centre of the universe. From space, we see a small and fragile ball dominated not by human activity and edifice but by a pattern of clouds, oceans, greenery, and soils. Humanity's inability to fit its activities into that pattern is changing planetary systems fundamentally. Many such changes are accompanied by life-threatening hazards, from environmental degradation to nuclear destruction. These new realities, from which there is no escape, must be recognized - and managed. 2. The issues we have raised in this report are inevitably of far reaching importance to the quality of life on earth - indeed to life itself. We have tried to show how human survival and well-being could depend on success in elevating sustainable development to a global ethic. In doing so, we have called for such major efforts as greater willingness and cooperation to combat international poverty, to maintain peace and enhance security world-wide, and to manage the global commons. We have called for national and international action in respect of population, food, plant and animal species, energy, industry, and urban settlements. The previous chapters have described the policy directions required. 3. The onus for action lies with no one group of nations. Developing countries face the challenges of desertification, deforestation, and pollution, and endure most of the poverty associated with environmental degradation. The entire human family of nations would suffer from the disappearance of rain forests in the tropics, the loss of plant and animal species, and
  • 256. changes in rainfall patterns. Industrial nations face the challenges of toxic chemicals, toxic wastes, and acidification. All nations may suffer from the releases by industrialized countries of carbon dioxide and of gases that react with the ozone layer, and from any future war fought with the nuclear arsenals controlled by those nations. All nations will also have a role to play in securing peace, in changing trends, and in righting an international economic system that increases rather than decreases inequality, that increases rather than decreases numbers of poor and hungry. In the case of environmental problems, it is obvious that the problems cannot be solved by one group, one group working in separation. You cannot say because people are dying of poisoning, it is the Ministry of Health that will solve it. Or to say because it comes from factories, it is the Ministry of Industry. That is impossible. I think the problems need a more holistic approach. The United Nations Organization, as a professional organization, has developed this fragmentation. It started automatically with no bad intention at all. But at the same time, the member countries requested and national bodies also requested entry points in recipient countries. So WHO corresponds with the Ministry of Health, UNESCO corresponds with the Ministry of Education, FAO corresponds with the Ministry of Agriculture the fragmentation is getting worse. Speaker from the floor Government Agency WCED Public Hearing Jakarta, 26 March 1985 4. The time has come to break out of past patterns. Attempts to maintain social and ecological stability through old approaches to development and environmental protection will increase instability. Security must be sought through change. The Commission has noted a number of actions that must be taken to reduce risks to survival and to put future development on paths that are sustainable. 5. Without such reorientation of attitudes and emphasis, little can be achieved. We have no illusions about 'quick-fix' solutions. We have tried to point out some pathways to the future. But there is no substitute for the journey itself, and there is no alternative to the process by which we retain a capacity to respond to the experience it provides. We believe this to hold true in all the areas covered in this report. But the policy changes we have suggested have institutional implications, and it is to these we now turn emphasizing that they are a complement to, not a substitute for, the wider policy changes for which we call. Nor do they represent definitive solutions, but rather first steps in what will be a continuing process. 6. In what follows we put forward, in the first place, what are essentially conceptual guidelines for institutions at the national level. We recognize that there are large differences among countries in respect of population size, resources, income level, management capacity, and institutional traditions, only governments themselves can formulate the changes they should make. Moreover, the tools for monitoring and evaluating sustainable development are rudimentary and require further refinement. 7. We also address, in more specific terms, the question of international institutions. The preceding chapters have major implications for international cooperation and reforms, both
  • 257. economic and legal. The international agencies clearly have an important role in making these changes effective, and we endeavour to set out the institutional implications, especially as regards the United Nations system. I. The Challenge for Institutional and Legal Change 1. Shifting the Focus to the Policy Sources 8. The next few decades are crucial for the future of humanity. Pressures on the planet are now unprecedented and are accelerating at rates and scales new to human experience: a doubling of global population in a few decades, with most of the growth in cities; a five- to tenfold increase in economic activity in less than half a century; and the resulting pressures for growth and changes in agricultural, energy, and industrial systems. Opportunities for more sustainable forms of growth and development are also growing. New technologies and potentially unlimited access to information offer great promise. 9. Each area of change represents a formidable challenge in its own right, but the fundamental challenge stems from their systemic character. They lock together environment and development, once thought separate; they lock together 'sectors' such as industry and agriculture; and they lock countries together as the effects of national policies and actions spill over national borders. Separate policies and institutions can no longer cope effectively with these interlocked issues. Nor can nations, acting unilaterally. 10. The integrated and interdependent nature of the new challenges and issues contrasts sharply with the nature of the institutions that exist today. These institutions tend to be independent, fragmented, and working to relatively narrow mandates with closed decision processes. Those responsible for managing natural resources and protecting the environment are institutionally separated from those responsible for managing the economy. The real world of interlocked economic and ecological systems will not change; the policies and institutions concerned must. 11. This new awareness requires major shifts in the way governments and individuals approach issues of environment, development, and international cooperation. Approaches to environment policy can be broadly characterized in two ways. One, characterized as the 'standard agenda', reflects an approach to environmental policy, laws, and institutions that focuses on environmental effects. The second reflects an approach concentrating on the policies that are the sources of those effects./1 These two approaches represent distinctively different ways of looking both at the issues and at the institutions to manage them. 12. The effects-oriented 'standard agenda' has tended to predominate as a result of growing concerns about the dramatic decline in environmental quality that the industrialized world suffered during the 1950s and 1960s. New environmental protection and resource management agencies were added on to the existing institutional structures, and given mainly scientific staffs./2 13. These environment agencies have registered some notable successes in improving environmental quality during the past two decades./3 They have secured significant gains in monitoring and research and in defining and understanding the issues in scientific and technical terms. They have raised public awareness, nationally and internationally. Environmental laws have induced innovation and the development of new control technologies, processes, and products in most industries, reducing the resource content of growth./4
  • 258. 14. However, most of these agencies have been confined by their own mandates to focusing almost exclusively on the effects. Today, the sources of these effects must be tackled. While these existing environmental protection policies and agencies must be maintained and even strengthened, governments now need to take a much broader view of environmental problems and policies. 15. Central agencies and major sectoral ministries play key roles in national decision making. These agencies have the greatest influence on the form, character, and distribution of the impacts of economic activity on the environmental resource base. It is these agencies, through their policies and budgets, that determine whether the environmental resource base is enhanced or degraded and whether the planet will be able to support human and economic growth and change into the next century. 16. The mandated goals of these agencies include increasing investment, employment, food, energy, and other economic and social goods. Most have no mandate to concern themselves with sustaining the environmental resource capital on which these goals depend. Those with such mandates are usually grouped in separate environment agencies or, sometimes, in minor units within sectoral agencies. In either case, they usually learn of new initiatives in economic and trade policy, or in energy and agricultural policy, or of new tax measures that will have a severe impact on resources, long after the effective decisions have been taken. Even if they were to learn earlier, most lack the authority to ensure that a given policy is implemented. 17. Environmental protection and sustainable development must be an integral part of the mandates of all agencies of governments, of international organizations, and of major private-sector institutions. These must be made responsible and accountable for ensuring that their policies, programmes, and budgets encourage and support activities that are economically and ecologically sustainable both in the short and longer terms.They must be given a mandate to pursue their traditional goals in such a way that those goals are reinforced by a steady enhancement of the environmental resource base of their own national community and of the small planet we all share. 2. New Imperatives for International Cooperation 18. National boundaries have become so porous that traditional distinctions between local, national, and international issues have become blurred. Policies formerly considered to be exclusively matters of 'national concern' now have an impact on the ecological bases of other nations' development and survival. Conversely, the growing reach of some nations' policies - economic, trade, monetary, and most sectoral policies - into the 'sovereign' territory of other nations limits the affected nations' options in devising national solutions to their 'own' problems. This fast-changing context for national action has introduced new imperatives and new opportunities for international cooperation. 19. The international legal framework must also be significantly strengthened in support of sustainable development. Although international law related to environment has evolved rapidly since the 1972 Stockholm Conference, major gaps and deficiencies must still be overcome as part of the transition to sustainable development. Much of the evidence and conclusions presented in earlier chapters of this report calls into question not just the desirability but even the feasibility of maintaining an international system that cannot prevent one or several states from damaging the ecological basis for development and even the prospects for survival of any other or even all other states.
  • 259. 20. However, just at the time when nations need increased international cooperation, the will to cooperate has sharply declined. By the mid-1980s, multilateral institutions were under siege for many, and often contradictory, reasons. The UN system has come under increasing attack for either proposing to do too much or, more frequently, for apparently doing too little. Conflicting national interests have blocked significant institutional reforms and have increased the need for fundamental change./5 By the mid-1980s, funds for many international organizations had levelled off or declined in both relative and absolute terms. 21. Bilateral development assistance has declined as a percentage of GNP in many industrial countries, falling even further below the targets proposed in the early 1970s./6 The benefits and effectiveness of aid have come under serious question, in part because of criticism based on environmental considerations./7 Yet, sustainable development creates the need for even greater international aid and cooperation. 22. Nations must now confront a growing number, frequency, and scale of crises. A major reorientation is needed in many policies and institutional arrangements at the international as well as national level. The time has come to break away. Dismal scenarios of mounting destruction of national and global potential for development - indeed, of the Earth's capacity to support life - are not inescapable destiny. One of the most hopeful characteristics of the changes the world is racing through is that invariably they reflect great opportunities for sustainable development, providing that institutional arrangements permit sustainable policy options to be elaborated, considered, and implemented. II. Proposals for Institutional and Legal Change 23. The ability to choose policy paths that are sustainable requires that the ecological dimensions of policy be considered at the same time as the economic, trade, energy, agricultural, industrial, and other dimensions - on the same agendas and in the same national and international institutions. That is the chief institutional challenge of the 1990s. 24. There are significant proposals for institutional and legal change in previous chapters of our report. The Commission's proposals for institutional and legal change at the national, regional, and international levels are embodied in six priority areas: getting at the sources, dealing with the effects, assessing global risks, making informed choices, providing the legal means, and investing in our future. Together, these priorities represent the main directions for institutional and legal change needed to make the transition to sustainable development. Concerted action is needed under all six. 1. Getting at the Sources
  • 260. 1.1 National Policies and Institutions 25. The way countries achieve sustainable development will vary among the many different political and economic systems around the world. Governments differ greatly in their capacity to monitor and evaluate sustainable development, and many will need assistance. Several features should be common to most countries. 26. Sustainable development objectives should be incorporated in the terms of reference of those cabinet and legislative committees dealing with national economic policy and planning as well as those dealing with key sectoral and international policies. As an extension of this, the major central economic and sectoral agencies of governments should now be made directly responsible and fully accountable for ensuring that their policies, programmes, and budgets support development that is ecologically as well as economically sustainable. 27. Where resources and data permit, an annual report and an audit on changes in environmental quality and in the stock of the nation's environmental resource assets are needed to complement the traditional annual fiscal budget and economic development plans./8 These are essential to obtain an accurate picture of the true health and wealth of the national economy, and to assess progress towards sustainable development./9 All governments should develop a 'foreign policy for the environment' as one major way of improving the international coordination of national environmental policies. But in the long-term perspective, and here I think the World Commission could have an important message, I think that it will be politically sound and wise to get support from the NGOs to prepare for changes that have to take place anyway sooner or later. So I think it would be politically wise to look into that in a much broader way than what has been done so far. Mats Segnestam Swedish Society for the Conservation of Nature WCED Public Hearing Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 28. Governments who have not done so should consider developing a 'foreign policy for the environment'./10 A nation's foreign policy needs to reflect the fact that its policies have a growing impact on the environmental resource base of other nations and the commons, just as the policies of other nations have an impact on its own. This is true of certain energy, agricultural, and other sectoral policies discussed in this report, as well as certain foreign investment, trade, and development assistance policies and those concerning the import or export of hazardous chemicals, wastes, and technology. 1.2 Regional and Interregional Action 29. The existing regional and subregional organisations within and outside the UN system need to be strengthened and made responsible and accountable for ensuring that their programmes and budgets encourage and support sustainable development policies and
  • 261. practices. In some areas, however, especially among developing countries, new regional and subregional arrangements will be needed to deal with transboundary environmental resource issues. 30. Some countries already enjoy comparatively well developed bilateral and regional structures, although many of them lack the mandate and support required to carry out the greatly expanded role they must assume in the future. These include many specialized bilateral organizations such as the Canada/USA International Joint Commission; subregional agencies in Europe such as the different Commissions for the Rhine River, the Danube River, and the Baltic Sea; and organizations such as the CMEA, OECD, and EEC. These bodies provide member countries with a strong foundation on which to build. Although most of them have effective programmes for international cooperation on environmental protection and natural resources management, these programmes will need to be strengthened and adapted to new priorities. The regional organizations in particular need to do more to integrate environment fully in their macroeconomic, trade, energy, and other sectoral programmes. 31. Similar organizations among developing countries should be strengthened, particularly at bilateral and subregional levels. Organizations such as the Organization of African Unity, the Southern Africa Development Coordination Conference, the Gulf Cooperation Council, the Arab League, the Organisation of American States, the Association of South East Asian Nations, and the South Asian Association for Regional Cooperation could work together to develop contingency plans and the capacity to respond quickly to critical situations and issues. They need in such bodies to develop comparable economic and environmental statistics, base-line quantity and quality surveys of shared resources, and early-warning capabilities to reduce environment and development hazards. They could develop and apply in concert basic common principles and guidelines concerning environmental protection and resource use, particularly with respect to foreign trade and investment. In this respect, developing countries have much to gain through sharing their common experiences and taking common action. 32. A new focus on the sustainable use and management of transboundary ecological zones, systems, and resources is also needed. There are, for example, over 200 distinct biogeographic zones in the world. Moreover, most non-island countries in the world share at least one international river basin. The entire national territories of nearly one-quarter of those countries is part of an international river, basin. Yet over one-third of the 200 major international river basins in the world are not covered by any international agreement, and fewer than 30 have any cooperative institutional arrangements. These gaps are particularly acute in Africa, Asia, and Latin America, which together have 144 international river basins./11 33. Governments, directly and through UNEP and IUCN, should support the development of regional and subregional cooperative arrangements for the protection and sustained use of transboundary ecological systems with joint action programmes to combat common problems such as desertification and acidification. 1.3 Global Institutions and Programmes 34. At the global level, an extensive institutional capacity exists that could be redirected towards sustainable development. The United Nations, as the only intergovernmental organization with universal membership, should clearly be the locus for new institutional initiatives of a global character. 35. Although the funds flowing to developing countries through UN programmes represents a
  • 262. relatively small portion of total ODA flows, the UN can and should be a source of significant leadership in the transition to sustainable development and in support of developing countries in effecting this transition. Under existing conditions the UN system's influence is often fragmented and less effective than it might be because of the independent character of the specialized agencies and endemic weaknesses of coordination. However, recent moves towards organizational reform and greater economy and efficiency could improve the capacity of the UN to provide this leadership, and should include sustainable development as an important criterion. In retrospect, even if the institutional and policy goals of the decade had been achieved, one is left with the feeling that most developing countries would be only marginally better off than they are today. The reason for this is a striking and humbling one. Although governments, environmentalists, and the aid agencies kept their eye on the environmental ball during the 1970s and the early 1980s, recent events have starkly demonstrated that they were watching the wrong ball. While the world was worrying about the environmental impacts of investments, controlling pollution, and conserving resources, we collectively failed to notice the dramatic decline in what had complacently been called 'renewable resources'. David Runnals International Institute for Environment and Development WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 36. All major international bodies and agencies of the UN system should be made responsible and accountable for ensuring that their programmes and budgets encourage and support development policies and practices that are sustainable. Governments, through parallel resolutions in the respective governing bodies, should now begin to reorient and refocus the mandates, programmes, and budgets of key agencies to support sustainable development. They should also insist on much greater coordination and cooperation among them. 37. Each agency will need to redeploy some staff and financial resources to establish a small but high-level centre of leadership and expertise. That centre should be linked to the programme planning and budget processes. 38. Each agency should be directly responsible (or ensuring that the environmental and resource aspects of programmes and projects are properly taken into account when they are being planned, and that the financial resources needed are provided directly from its own budget. In line with these new responsibilities, the following bodies should also assume full financial responsibility within their own budgets for certain programmes presently supported by the Environment Fund of UNEP: WHO on 'Environmental Health', FAO on 'Agricultural Chemicals and Residues', UNDRO on 'Natural Disasters', UNIDO on 'Industry and Transport', ILO on 'Working Environment', UNDA on 'Arms Race and the Environment', DIESA on 'Environmental Aspects of Development Planning and Cooperation', UNESCO on 'Education', and UNDP on 'Technical Cooperation'. UNEP (discussed extensively in the next section) should continue to cooperate closely with these agencies and help identify new programme needs and monitor performance. 39. As in each agency, there is also a need for a high-level centre of leadership for the UN system as a whole with the capacity to assess, advise, assist, and report on progress made and needed for sustainable development. That leadership should be provided by the Secretary-
  • 263. General of the United Nations Organization. 40. Governments at the UN General Assembly should therefore take the necessary measures to reinforce the system-wide responsibility and authority of the UN Secretary-General concerning interagency coordination and cooperation generally, and for achieving sustainable development specifically. This will require that the representatives of those same governments in the governing bodies of all major UN organizations and specialized agencies take complementary measures. This could be done as an integral part of the parallel resolutions just proposed on building sustainable development objectives and criteria into the mandates, programmes, and budget of each agency 41. To help launch and guide the interagency coordination and cooperation that will be needed, the UN Secretary-General should constitute under his chairmanship a special UN Board for Sustainable Development. The principal function of the Board would be to agree on combined tasks to be undertaken by the agencies to deal effectively with the many critical issues of sustainable development that cut across agency and national boundaries. 2. Dealing With the Effects 42. Governments should also strengthen the role and capacity of existing environmental protection and resource management agencies./12 2.1 National Environmental Protection and Natural Resources Management Agencies 43. Strengthening of environmental agencies is needed most urgently in developing countries. Those that have not established such agencies should do so as a matter of priority. In both cases, bilateral and multilateral organizations must be prepared to provide increased assistance for institutional development. Some of this increased financial support should go to community groups and NGOs, which are rapidly emerging as important and cost-effective partners in work to protect and improve the environment locally and nationally, and in developing and implementing national conservation strategies. 44. Industrialized countries also need greatly strengthened environmental protection and resource management agencies. Most face a continuing backlog of pollution problems and a growing range of environment and resource management problems too. In addition, these agencies will be called upon to advise and assist central economic and sectoral agencies he they take up their new responsibilities for sustainable development. Many now provide institutional support, technical advice, and assistance to their counterpart agencies in developing countries, and this need will grow. And, almost inevitably, they will play a larger and more direct role in international cooperation, working with other countries and international agencies trying to cope with regional and global environmental problems. 2.2 Strengthen the United Nations Environment Programme 45. When UNEP was established in 1972, the UN General Assembly gave it a broad and challenging mandate to stimulate, coordinate, and provide policy guidance for environmental action throughout the UN system./13 That mandate was to be carried out by a Governing Council of 58 member states, a high-level UN interagency Environment Coordination Board (ECB),/14 a relatively small secretariat located in Nairobi, and a voluntary fund set initially at a
  • 264. level of $100 million for the first five years. UNEP's principal task was to exercise leadership and a catalytic influence on the programmes and projects of other international organizations, primarily in but also outside the UN system. Over the past 10 years, the Environment Fund has levelled off at around $30 million annually, while its range of tasks and activities have increased substantially. 46. This Commission has recommended a major reorientation and refocusing of programmes and budgets on sustainable development in and among all UN organizations. Within such a new system-wide commitment to and priority effort on sustainable development, UNEP should be the principal source on environmental data, assessment, reporting, and related support for environmental management as well as be the principal advocate and agent for change and cooperation on critical environment and natural resource protection issues. The major priorities and functions of UNEP should be: to provide leadership, advice, and guidance in the UN system on restoring, protecting, and improving the ecological basis for sustainable development; to monitor, assess, and report regularly on changes in the state of the environment and natural resources (through its EarthWatch programme); to support priority scientific and technological research on critical environmental and natural resource protection issues; to develop criteria and indicators for environmental quality standards and guidelines for the sustainable use and management of natural resources; to support and facilitate the development of action plans for key ecosystems and issues to be implemented and financed by the governments directly concerned; to encourage and promote international agreements on critical issues identified by Earthwatch and to support and facilitate the development of international law, conventions, and cooperative arrangements for environmental and natural resource conservation and protection; to support the development of the institutional and professional capacity of developing countries in all of these areas and help them develop specific programmes to deal with their problems and advise and assist development assistance agencies in this respect; and to provide advice and assistance to the United Nations Development Programme, the World Bank, and other UN organizations and agencies regarding the environmental dimensions of their programmes and technical assistance projects, including training activities. The environment has quickly deteriorated in certain areas and we don't know where to put the thresholds for nature's tolerance. We must move very fast towards a consensus on the necessity for taking urgent action. There is a strong popular support for this in our country. The findings of several opinion polls tell us that ecological issues have heightened priority. People feel anxious about the legacy our generation will be passing on to the next one. A new environmental awareness has germinated among large sections of the community and mainly among young people.
  • 265. Dr. Litre V. Nagy Environment Protection Committee of the Patriotic People's Front, Hungary WCED Public Hearing Moscow, 6 Dec 1986 2.2.1 Focus on Environmental Protection Issues 47. UNEP has been a key agent in focusing the attention of governments on critical environmental problems (such as deforestation and marine pollution), in helping develop many global and regional action plans and strategies (as on desertification), in contributing to the negotiation and implementation of international conventions (on Protection of the Ozone Layer, for example), and in preparing global guidelines and principles for action by governments (such as on marine pollution from land-based sources). UNEP's Regional Seas Programme has been particularly successful, and could serve as a model for some other areas of special concern, especially international river basins. 48. UNEP's catalytic and coordinating role in the UN system can and should be reinforced and extended. In its future work in critical environmental protection issues, UNEP should focus particularly on: developing, testing, and helping to apply practical and simple methodologies for environmental assessment at project and national levels; extending international agreements (such as on chemicals and hazardous wastes) more widely; extending the Regional Seas Programme; developing a similar programme for international river basins; and identifying the need for and advising other UN organizations and agencies in establishing and carrying out technical assistance and training courses for environmental protection and management. 2.2.2 Priority to Global Environmental Assessment and Reporting 49. Although more is known about the state of the global environment now than a decade ago, there are still major gaps and a limited international capability for monitoring, collecting, and combining basic and comparable data needed for authoritative overviews of key environmental issues and trends. Without such, the information needed to help set priorities and develop effective policies will remain limited. 50. UNEP, as the main UN source for environmental data, assessment, and reporting, should guide the global agenda for scientific research and technological development "or environmental protection. To this end, the data collection, assessment, and state of the environment reporting sections (Earthwatch) of UNEP need to be significantly strengthened as a major priority. The Global Environment Monitoring System should be expanded as rapidly as possible, and the development of the Global Resource Information Database should be accelerated to bridge the gap between environmental assessment and management. Special priority should be accorded to providing support to developing countries to enable them to participate fully in and derive maximum benefits from these programmes.
  • 266. 2.2.3 Strengthen International Environmental Cooperation 51. The UNEP Governing Council cannot fulfil its primary role of providing leadership and policy guidance in the UN system nor have a significant influence on national policies unless governments increase their participation and the level of representation. National delegations to future meetings should preferably be led by Ministers, with their senior policy and scientific advisers. Special provisions should be made for expanded and more meaningful participation by major non governmental organizations at future sessions. 2.2.4. Increase the Revenue and Focus of the Environment Fund 52. The UNEP voluntary funding base of $30 million annually is too limited and vulnerable for an international fund dedicated to serving and protecting the common interests, security, and future of humanity. Six countries alone provided over 75 per cent of the 1985 contributions to the Environment Fund (the United States, Japan, USSR, Sweden, FRG, and UK)./15 Considering the critical importance of renewed efforts on environmental protection and improvement, the Commission appeals to all governments to substantially enlarge the Environment Fund both through direct contributions by all members of the UN and through some of the sources cited later in this chapter in the section 'Investing in Our Future'. 53. A substantial enlargement of the Environment Fund seems unlikely in the current climate of financial austerity. Any additional funds made available by states for UN development programmes and activities will likely be channelled largely through UNDP and the development programmes of other UN agencies. Moreover, as recommended earlier, the budgets of all of those agencies should be deployed so that environmental considerations are built into the planning and implementation of all programmes and projects. 54. The Environment Fund can be made more effective by refocusing the programme on fewer activities. As other UN agencies assume full responsibility for certain activities now provided through the Environment Fund and finance them entirely from their own budgets, some resources will be released for other purposes. These should be concentrated on the principal functions and priority areas identified earlier. 55. Expanding support and cooperation with NGOs capable of carrying out elements of UNEP's programme will also increase the effectiveness of the Environment Fund. Over the last decade, non-governmental organizations and networks have become increasingly important in work to improve environmental protection locally, nationally, and internationally. However, financial support from the Environment Fund for cooperative projects with NGOs declined in both absolute and relative terms in the last 10 years, from $4.5 million (23 per cent of the Fund) in 1976 to $3.6 million (13 per cent) in 1985./16 The amount and proportion of Environment Fund resources for cooperation and projects with NGOs should be significantly increased by using the capacities of those NGOs that can contribute to UNEP's programmes on a cost-effective basis. 3. Assessing Global Risks 56. The future - even a sustainable future - will be marked by increasing risk./17 The risks associated with new technologies are growing./18 The numbers, scale, frequency, and impact of natural and human-caused disasters are mounting.19/ The risks of irreversible damage to natural systems regionally (for example through acidification, desertification, or deforestation) and globally (through ozone layer depletion or climate change) are becoming significant./20
  • 267. 57. Fortunately, the capacity to monitor and map Earth change and to assess risk is also growing rapidly. Data from remote sensing platforms in space can now be merged with data from conventional land-based sources. Augmented by digital communications and advanced information analysis, photos, mapping, and other techniques, these data can provide up-to-date information on a wide variety of resource, climatic, pollution, and other variables./21 High-speed data communications technologies, including the personal computer, enable this information to be shared by individuals as well as corporate and governmental users at costs that are steadily falling. Concerted efforts should be made to ensure that all nations gain access to them and the information they provide either directly or through the UNEP Earthwatch and other special programmes. 58. Governments, individually and collectively, have the principal responsibility to collect their information systematically and use it to assess risks, but to date only a few have developed a capacity to do so. Some intergovernmental agencies have a capacity to collect and assess information required for risk assessment, such as FAO on soil and forest cover and on fisheries; WMO on climate; UNEP on deserts, pollutants, and regional seas; quasi-governmental organizations like IUCN have a similar capacity. These are only a few examples from a long list. But no intergovernmental agency has been recognized as the centre of leadership to stimulate work on risk assessment and to provide an authoritative source of reports and advice on evolving risks. This gap needs to be filled both within and among governments. Beyond our proposal that the global environment assessment and reporting functions of UNEP should be significantly strengthened, the Commission would now propose that UNEP's Earthwatch be recognized as the centre of leadership on risk assessment in the UN system. 59. But neither UNEP nor other intergovernmental organizations can be expected to carry out these important functions alone. To be effective, given the politically sensitive nature of many of the most critical risks, intergovernmental risk assessment needs to be supported by independent capacities outside of government. Several national science academies and international scientific groups such as ICSU and its Scientific Committee on Problems of the Environment, with special programmes such as the newly inaugurated International Geosphere-Biosphere Programme (see Chapter 10); the Man and the Biosphere Programme of UNESCO; quasi-governmental bodies such as IUCN; and certain industry groups and NGOs are active in this field. But, again, there is no recognized international non-governmental centre of leadership through which the efforts of these groups can be focused and coordinated. 60. During the 1970s, the growing capacity of computers led various governments, institutes, and international bodies to develop models for integrated policy analysis. They have provided significant insights and offer great promise as a means of anticipating the consequences of interdependent trends and of establishing the policy options to address them./22 Without suggesting any relationship between them, early attempts were all limited by serious inconsistencies in the methods and assumptions employed by the various sources on which they depended for data and information./23 Although significant improvements have been made in the capability of models and other techniques, the data base remains weak./24 61. There is an urgent need to strengthen and focus the capacities of these and other bodies to complement and support UNEP's monitoring and assessment functions by providing timely, objective, and authoritative assessments and public reports on critical threats and risks to the world community. To meet this need, we recommend the establishment of a Global Risks Assessment Programme: to identify critical threats to the survival, security, or well-being of all or a majority of
  • 268. people, globally or regionally; to assess the causes and likely human, economic, and ecological consequences of those threats, and to report regularly and publicly on their findings; to provide authoritative advice and proposals on what should or must be done to avoid, reduce, or, if possible, adapt to those threats; and to provide an additional source of advice and support to governments and intergovernmental organizations for the implementation of programmes and policies designed to address such threats. 62. The Global Risk Assessment Programme would not requite the creation of a new international institution as such, as it should function primarily as a mechanism for cooperation among largely non-governmental national and international organizations, scientific bodies, and industry groups. To provide intellectual leadership and guide the programme, there should be a steering group composed of eminent individuals who together would reflect a broad cross-section of the major areas of knowledge, vocations, and regions of the world, as well as the major bodies active in the field. 63. The steering group would serve as the focal point for identifying the risks to be addressed by the programme, agreeing on the research needed to assess those risks, and coordinating the work among the various participating bodies. It could form special consortia and task forces made up of experts from these bodies and it would also establish special expert and advisory groups consisting of world-known authorities in specialized areas of science, economics, and law. The steering group would be responsible for the overall evaluation of results, for their wide dissemination, and for follow-up activities. 64. The steering group would also be charged with helping mobilize funds for implementing the programme through contributions by the Environment Fund of UNEP, states, foundations, and other private sources. Funding would principally be for the purpose of financing the various activities that would be carried out by other organizations as part of the programme, with only a small portion required to meet the costs of the steering group. 4. Making Informed Choices 65. As is evident from this report, the transition to sustainable development will require a range of public policy choices that are inherently complex and politically difficult. Reversing unsustainable development policies at the national and international level will require immense efforts to inform the public and secure its support. The scientific community, private and community groups, and NGOs can play a central role in this. If the NGO community is to translate its commitment to sustainable development into effective action, we will need to see a matching level of commitment from the governmental and intergovernmental communities, in genuine partnership with NGOs. The success and cost-effectiveness of NGO action is to an important degree a function of their spontaneity and freedom of action. Both among NGOs and amongst governments, we must find ways to engender a new period of international cooperation. The urgency of our tasks no longer permits us to spill our energies in fruitless and destructive conflict. Whilst we fight our wars of ideology on the face of this planet, we are losing our productive
  • 269. relationship with the planet itself. David Bull Environmental Liaison Centre WCED Public Hearing Nairobi, 23 Sept 1986 4.1 Increase the Role of the Scientific Community and Non-Governmental Organizations 66. Scientific groups and NGOs have played - with the help of young people/25 - a major part in the environmental movement from its earliest beginnings. Scientists were the first to point out evidence of significant environmental risks and changes resulting from the growing intensity of human activities. Other non-governmental organizations and citizens' groups pioneered in the creation of public awareness and political pressures that stimulated governments to act. Scientific and non-governmental communities played a vital role in the United Nations Conference on the Human Environment in Stockholm./26 67. These groups have also played an indispensable role since the Stockholm Conference in identifying risks, in assessing environmental impacts and designing and implementing measures to deal with them, and in maintaining the high degree of public and political interest required as a basis for action. Today, major national 'State of the Environment' reports are being published by some NGOs (in Malaysia, India, and the United States, for instance)./27 Several international NGOs have produced significant reports on the status of and prospects for the global environment and natural resources./28 68. The vast majority of these bodies are national or local in nature, and a successful transition to sustainable development will require substantial strengthening of their capacities. To an increasing extent, national NGOs draw strength from association with their counterparts in other countries and from participation in international programmes and consultations. NGOs in developing countries are particularly in need of international support - professional and moral as well as financial - to carry out their roles effectively. 69. Many international bodies and coalitions of NGOs are now in place and active. They play an important part in ensuring that national NGOs and scientific bodies have access to the support they require. These include regional groups providing networks linking together environment and development NGOs in Asia, Africa, Eastern and Western Europe, and North and South America. They also include a number of regional and global coalitions on critical issues such as pesticides, chemicals, rain, seeds, genetic resources, and development assistance. A global network for information exchange and joint action is provided through the Environment Liaison Centre (ELC) in Nairobi. ELC has over 230 NGO member groups, with the majority from developing countries, and is in contact with 7,000 others. 70. Only a few international NGOs deal on a broad basis with both environment and development issues, but this is changing rapidly. One of them, the International Institute for Environment and Development, has long specialized in these issues and pioneered the conceptual basis for the environment/development relationship. Most of them work with and support related organizations in the developing world. They facilitate their participation in international activities and their links with counterparts in the international community. They provide instruments for leadership and cooperation among a wide variety of organizations in their respective constituencies. These capabilities will be ever more important in the future.
  • 270. An increasing number of environment and development issues could not be tackled without them. 71. NGOs should give a high priority to the continuation of their present networking on development cooperation projects and programmes, directed at the improvement of the performance of NGO bilateral and multilateral development programmes. They could increase their efforts to share resources, exchange skills, and strengthen each other's capacities through greater international cooperation in this area. In setting their own house in order, 'environment' NGOs should assist 'development' NGOs in reorienting projects that degrade the environment and in formulating projects that contribute to sustainable development. The experience gained would provide a useful basis for continuing discussions with bilateral and multilateral agencies as to steps that these agencies might take to improve their performance. 72. In many countries, governments need to recognize and extend NGOs' right to know and have access to information on the environment and natural resources; their right to be consulted and to participate in decision making on activities likely to have a significant effect on their environment; and their right to legal remedies and redress when their health or environment has been or may be seriously affected. 73. NGOs and private and community groups can often provide an efficient and effective alternative to public agencies in the delivery of programmes and projects. Moreover, they can sometimes reach target groups that public agencies cannot. Bilateral and multilateral development assistance agencies, especially UNDP and the World Bank, should draw upon NGOs in executing programmes and projects. At the national level, governments, foundations, and industry should also greatly extend their cooperation with NGOs in planning, monitoring, and evaluating as well as in carrying out projects when they can provide the necessary capabilities on a cost-effective basis. To this end, governments should establish or strengthen procedures for official consultation and more meaningful participation by NGOs in all relevant intergovernmental organizations. 74. International NGOs need substantially increased financial support to expand their special roles and functions on behalf of the world community and in support of national NGOs. In the Commission's view, the increased support that will allow these organizations to expand their services represents an indispensable and cost-effective investment. The Commission recommends that these organizations be accorded high priority by governments, foundations, and other private and public sources of funding. 4.2 Increase Cooperation with Industry 75. Industry is on the leading edge of the interface between people and the environment. It is perhaps the main instrument of change that affects the environmental resource bases of development, both positively and negatively. (See Chapter 8.) Both industry and government, therefore, stand to benefit from working together more closely. 76. World industry has taken some significant steps through voluntary guidelines concerning industry practices on environment, natural resources, science, and technology. Although few of these guidelines have been extended to or applied regionally in Africa, Asia, or Latin America, industry continues to address these issues through various international associations. 77. These efforts were advanced significantly by the 1984 World Industry Conference on Environmental Management (WICEM)./29 Recently, as a follow-up to WICEM, several major
  • 271. corporations from a number of developed countries formed the International Environment Bureau to assist developing countries with their environment/development needs. Such initiatives are promising and should be encouraged. Cooperation between governments and industry would be further facilitated if they established joint advisory councils for sustainable development - for mutual advice, assistance, and cooperation in helping to shape and implement policy, laws, and regulations for more sustainable forms of development. Internationally, governments in cooperation with industry, and NGOs should work through appropriate regional organizations to develop basic codes of conduct for sustainable development, drawing on and extending relevant existing voluntary codes, especially in Africa, Asia, and Latin America. 78. The private sector also has a major impact on development through commercial bank loans from within and outside countries. In 1983, for example, the proportion of the total net receipts of developing countries from private sources, mostly in the form of commercial bank loans, was greater than all ODA that year. Since 1963, as indebtedness worsened, commercial bank lending to developing countries has declined./30 79. Efforts are being made to stimulate private investment. These efforts should be geared to supporting sustainable development. The industrial and financial corporations making such investments, and the export credit, investment insurance, and other programmes that facilitate them, should incorporate sustainable development criteria into their policies. 5. Providing the Legal Means 80. National and international law has traditionally lagged behind events. Today, legal regimes are being rapidly outdistanced by the accelerating pace and expanding scale of impacts on the environmental base of development. Human laws must be reformulated to keep human activities in harmony with the unchanging and universal laws of nature. There is an urgent need; to recognize and respect the reciprocal rights and responsibilities of individuals and states regarding sustainable development, to establish and apply new norms for state and interstate behaviour to achieve sustainable development, to strengthen and extend the application of existing laws and international agreements in support of sustainable development, and to reinforce existing methods and develop new procedures for avoiding and resolving environmental disputes. 5.1 Recognizing Rights and Responsibilities 81. Principle 1 of the 1972 Stockholm Declaration said that 'Man has the fundamental right to freedom, equality and adequate conditions of life, in an environment of a quality that permits a life of dignity and well-being'./31 It further proclaimed the solemn responsibility of governments to protect and improve the environment for both present and future generations. After the Stockholm Conference, several states recognized in their Constitutions or laws the right to an adequate environment and the obligation of the state to protect that environment.
  • 272. 82. Recognition by states of their responsibility to ensure an adequate environment for present as well as future generations is an important step towards sustainable development. However, progress will also be facilitated by recognition of, for example, the right of individuals to know and have access to current information on the state of the environment and natural resources, the right to be consulted and to participate in decision making on activities likely to have a significant effect on the environment, and the right to legal remedies and redress for those whose health or environment has been or may be seriously affected. What are we to do? It is axiomatic that we as individuals or groups of individuals share territory in resources. We need to define common norms of behaviour. This is true whether we are speaking of a family, small town, a province or country, or the world community. However, the definition of common norms of behaviour is not in itself sufficient for the creation of a body of rules and regulation. To operate effectively, certain basic conditions must be fulfilled: the existence of a general will among members of the community to accept and adhere to regulations; the existence of a political framework not only for defining and quantifying common behaviour or norms, but also for adopting existing rules to change within the community; a means of determining compliance with international rules and regulations; and, finally, the means for enforcement. Fergus Watt World Association of World Federalists WCED Public Hearing Ottawa, 26-27 May 1986 83. The enjoyment of any right requires respect for the similar rights of others, and recognition of reciprocal and even joint responsibilities. States have a responsibility towards their own citizens and other states: to maintain ecosystems and related ecological processes essential for the functioning of the biosphere; to maintain biological diversity by ensuring the survival and promoting the conservation in their natural habitats of all species of flora and fauna; to observe the principle of optimum sustainable yield in the exploitation of living natural resources and ecosystems; to prevent or abate significant environmental pollution or harm; to establish adequate environmental protection standards; to undertake or require prior assessments to ensure that major new policies, projects, and technologies contribute to sustainable development; and to make all relevant information public without delay in all cases of harmful or potentially harmful releases of pollutants, especially radioactive releases. 84. It is recommended that governments take appropriate steps to recognize these reciprocal rights and responsibilities./32 However, the wide variation in national legal systems and
  • 273. practices makes it impossible to propose an approach that would be valid everywhere. Some countries have amended their basic laws or constitution; others are considering the a 'option of a special national law or charter setting out the rights and responsibilities of citizens and the state regarding environmental protection and sustainable development Others may wish to consider the designation of a national council or public representative or 'ombudsman' to represent the interests and rights of present and future generations and act as an environmental watchdog, alerting governments and citizens to any emerging threats. 5.2 A Universal Declaration and a Convention on Environmental Protection and Sustainable Development 85. Building on the 1972 Stockholm Declaration, the 1982 Nairobi Declaration, and many existing international conventions and General Assembly resolutions, there is now a need to consolidate and extend relevant legal principles in a new charter to guide state behaviour in the transition to sustainable development. It would provide the basis for, and be subsequently expanded into, a Convention, setting out the sovereign rights and reciprocal responsibilities of all states on environmental protection and sustainable development. The charter should prescribe new norms for state and interstate behaviour needed to maintain livelihoods and life on our shared planet, including basic norms for prior notification, consultation, and assessment of activities likely to have an impact on neighbouring states or global commons. These could include the obligation to alert and inform neighbouring states in the event of an accident likely to have a harmful impact on their environment. Although a few such norms have evolved in some bilateral and regional arrangements, the lack of wider agreement on such basic rules for interstate behaviour undermines both the sovereignty and economic development potential of each and all states. 86. We recommend that the General Assembly commit itself to preparing a universal Declaration and later a Convention on environmental protection and sustainable development. A special negotiating group could be established to draft a Declaration text for adoption in 1986. Once it is approved, that group could then proceed to prepare a Convention, based on and extending the principles in the Declaration, with the aim of having an agreed Convention text ready for signature by states within three to five years. To facilitate the early launching of that process the Commission has submitted for consideration by the General Assembly, and as a starting point for the deliberations of the special negotiating group, a number of proposed legal principles embodied in 22 Articles which were prepared by its group of international legal experts. These proposed principles are submitted to assist the General Assembly in its deliberations and have not been approved or considered in detail by the Commission. A summary of the principles and Articles appears as Annexe 1 of this report. 5.3 Strengthen and Extend Existing International Conventions and Agreements 87. In parallel, governments should accelerate their efforts to strengthen and extend existing and more specific international conventions and cooperative arrangements by: acceding to or ratifying existing global and regional conventions dealing with environment and development, and applying them with more vigour and rigour; reviewing and revising those relevant conventions that need to be brought in line with the latest available technical and scientific information; and
  • 274. negotiating new global and regional conventions or arrangements aimed at promoting cooperation and coordination in the field of environment and development (including, for example, new conventions and agreements on climate change, on hazardous chemicals and wastes, and on preserving biological diversity). Law does not stand alone. It depends on the functioning of many things. Experience from the past 15 years of development has taught us that there is a danger that bureaucracy with all its strength coming from the West, in Indonesia's case because of the oil and gas revenues, will strangle the community with so many laws. They have, for instance, laws that ask every gathering of five or more people to have permission from the police. Sometimes I feel that maybe the best government is the one who governs the least. In this case, I feel that sometimes the Asian countries learn from each other. Adi Sasono Institute for Development Studies WCED Public Hearing Jakarta, 26 March 1985 88. It is recommended that the UNEP secretariat, in close cooperation with the IUCN Environmental Law Centre, should help in these efforts. 5.4 Avoiding and Settling Environmental Disputes 89. Many disputes can be avoided or more readily resolved if the principles, rights, and responsibilities cited earlier are built into national and international legal frameworks and are fully respected and implemented by many states. Individuals and states are more reluctant to act in a way that might lead to a dispute when, as in many national legal systems, there is an established and effective capacity as well as ultimately binding procedures for settling disputes. Such a capacity and procedures are largely lacking at the international level, particularly environmental and natural resource management issues./33 90. it is recommended that public and private organizations and NGOs help in this area by establishing special panels or rosters of experts with experience in various forms of dispute settlement and special competence on the legal and substantive aspects of environmental protection, natural resources management, and sustainable development. In addition, a consolidated inventory and referral system or network for responding to requests for advice and assistance should be established in avoiding or receiving such disputes. 91. To promote the peaceful and early settlement of international disputes on environmental and resource management problems, it is recommended that the following procedure be adopted. States should be given up to 18 months to reach mutual agreement on a solution or on a common dispute settlement arrangement. If agreement is not reached, then the dispute can be submitted to conciliation at the request of any one of the concerned states and, if still unresolved, thereafter to arbitration or judicial settlement. 92. This proposed new procedure raises the possibility of invoking a binding process of dispute settlement at the request of any state. Binding settlement is not the preferred method for settling international disputes. But such a provision is now needed not only as a last resort to avoid prolonged disputes and possible serious environmental damage, but also to
  • 275. encourage and provide an incentive for all parties to reach agreement within a reasonable time on either a solution or a mutually agreed means, such as mediation. 93. The capabilities of the Permanent Court of Arbitration and the International Court of Justice to deal with environmental and resource management problems also should be strengthened. States should make greater use of the World Court's capacity under Article 26 of its Statute to form special chambers for dealing with particular cases or categories of cases, including environmental protection or resource management cases. The Court has declared its willingness and readiness to deal with such cases fully and promptly. 6. Investing in Our Future 94. We have endeavoured to show that: it makes long-term economic sense to pursue environmentally sound policies. But potentially very large financial outlays will be needed in the short term in such fields as renewable energy development, pollution control equipment, and integrated rural development. Developing countries will need massive assistance for this purpose, and more generally to reduce poverty. Responding to this financial need will be a collective investment in the future 6.1 National Action 95. Past experience teaches us that these outlays would be good investments. By the late 1960s, when some industrial countries began to mount significant environmental protection programmes, they had already incurred heavy economic costs in the form of damage to human health, property, natural resources, and the environment. After 1970, in order to roll back some of this damage, they saw expenditures on environmental pollution measurer, alone rise from about 0.3 per cent of GNP in 1970 to somewhere between 1.5 per cent and, in some countries, 2.0 per cent around the end of the decade. Assuming low levels of economic growth in the future, these same countries will probably have to increase expenditures on environmental protection somewhere between 20 to 100 per cent just to maintain current levels of environmental quality./34 First, if the problems of environmental degradation and of poverty, particularly in the Third World, are to be solved, a continued economic development is essential. Second, we must reconcile environmental protection with economic growth. There is a growing consensus that this is perfectly possible and desirable. Third, there is also a great consensus that the application of strict environmental standards is good for economic growth, as well as for the environment, and that they encourage innovation, promote inventiveness and efficiency, and generate employment. Fourth, to achieve the goals of sustainable development, good environment, and decent standards of life for all involves very large changes in attitude. Stanley Clinton-Davis Commissioner for Environment European Economic Community WCED Public Hearing Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 96. These figures relate only to expenditures to control environmental pollution.
  • 276. Unfortunately, similar figures are not available on the level of expenditures made to rehabilitate lands and natural habitats, re-establish soil fertility, reforest areas, and undertake other measures to restore the resource base. But they would be substantial. 97. Nations, industrial and developing, that did not make these investments have paid much more in terms of damage costs to human health, property, natural resources, and the environment. And these costs continue to rise at an accelerating pace. Indeed, countries that have not yet instituted strong programmes now face the need for very large investments. Not only do they need to roll back the first generation of environmental damage, they also need to begin to catch up with the rising incidence of future damage. If they do not, their fundamental capital assets, their environmental resources, will continue to decline. 98. In strictly economic terms, the benefits of these expenditures have been generally greater than the costs in those countries that have made them./35 Beyond that, however, many of these countries found that economic, regulatory, and other environmental measures could be applied in ways that would result in innovation by industry. And those companies that did respond innovatively are today often in the forefront of their industry. They have developed new products, new processes, and entire plants that use less water, energy, and other resources per unit of output and are hence more economic and competitive. 99. Nations that begin to reorient major economic and sectoral policies along the lines proposed in this report can avoid much higher future levels of spending on environmental restoration and curative measures and also enhance their future economic prospects. By making central and sectoral agencies directly responsible for maintaining and enhancing environmental and resource stocks, expenditures for environmental protection and resource management would gradually be built into the budgets of those agencies for measures to prevent damage. The unavoidable costs of environmental and resource management would thus be paid only once. We must have a true participation of all of the society in the decision-making and More particularly in the allocation of resources. And why so? because all of us are perfectly aware that there will never be sufficient resources for everything that we wish, but if the population participates in the decision making it will benefit those who need the most and it will express their thought about the allocation of resources and it will give us the certainty that that which is bring done is the legitimate aspiration of the people. Aristides Marquee National Council for Urban Development WCED Public Hearing Brasilia, 30 Oct 1985 6.2 International Action 100. Developing countries, as noted earlier, need a significant increase in financial support from international sources for environmental restoration, protection, and improvement and to help them through the necessary transition to sustainable development. 101. At the global level, there is an extensive institutional capacity to channel this support. This consists of the United Nations and its specialized agencies: the multilateral development
  • 277. banks, notably the World Bank; other multilateral development cooperation organizations, such as those of the European Economic Community; national development assistance agencies, most of whom cooperate within the framework of the Development Assistance Committee of OECD or of OPEC; and other international groups, such as the Consultative Group on International Agricultural Research, that play an important role and influence on the quality and nature of development assistance. Together, the development organizations and agencies are responsible for the transfer of about $35 billion of ODA annually to developing countries. In addition, they are the source of most technical assistance and policy advice and support to developing countries. 102. These organizations and agencies are the principal instruments through which the development partnership between industrial and developing countries operates and, collectively, their influence is substantial and pervasive. It is imperative that they play a leading role in helping developing countries make the transition to sustainable development. Indeed, it is difficult to envisage developing countries making this transition in an effective and timely manner without their full commitment and support. 6.2.1 Reorienting Multilateral Financial Institutions 103. The World Bank, IMF, and Regional Development Banks warrant special attention because of their major influence on economic development throughout the world. As indicated in Chapter 3, there is an urgent need for much larger flows of concessional and non-concessional finance through the multilateral agencies. The role of the World Bank is especially important in this respect, both as the largest single source of development lending and for its policy leadership, which exerts a significant influence on both developing countries and donors. The World Bank has taken a significant lead in reorienting its lending programmes to a much higher sensitivity to environmental concerns and to support for sustainable development. This is a promising beginning. But it will not be enough unless and until it is accompanied by a fundamental commitment to sustainable development by the World Bank and the transformation of its internal structure and processes so as to ensure its capacity to carry this out. The same is true of other multilateral development banks and agencies. 104. The IMF also exerts a major influence on the development policies of developing countries and, as described in Chapter 3, there is deep concern in many countries that the conditions that accompany its lending are undermining sustainable development. It is therefore essential that the IMF, too, incorporate sustainable development objectives and criteria into its policies and programmes. 105. Several countries have already formally instructed their representatives on the Board of the World Bank to ensure that the environmental impacts of projects proposed for approval have been assessed and adequately taken into account. We recommend that other governments take similar action, not only with regard to the World Bank but also in the Regional Banks and the other institutions. In this way they can support the ongoing efforts within the Banks and other institutions to reorient and refocus their mandates, programmes, and budgets to support sustainable development. The transition to sustainable development by the development assistance agencies and the IMF would be facilitated by the establishment of a high-level office in each agency with the authority and resources to ensure that all policies, projects, and loan conditions support sustainable development, and to prepare and publish annual assessments and reports on progress made and needed. A first step is to develop simple methodologies for such assessments, recognizing that they are at present experimental and need further work.
  • 278. 106. In making these changes, the multilateral financial institutions fortunately have some base on which to build. In 1980, they endorsed a Declaration of Environmental Policies and Procedures Relating to Economic Development. Since then they have been meeting and consulting through the Committee of International Development Institutions on the Environment (CIDIE)./36 Some have articulated clear policies and project guidelines for incorporating environmental concerns and assessments into their planning and decision making, but only a few have assigned staff and resources to implementing them, notably the World Bank, which is now considering even further institutional changes to strengthen this work. Overall, as pointed out by the UNEP Executive Director in his statement reviewing the first five years of work. CIDIE has not yet truly succeeded in getting environmental considerations firmly ingrained in development policies. "There has been a distinct lack of action by several multilaterals." CIDIE members have "gone along with the Declaration in principle more than in major shifts in action."/37 107. In order to marshal and support investing its in conservation projects and national conservation strategies that enhance the resource base for development, serious consideration should be given to the development of a special international banking programme or facility/38 linked to the World Bank. Such a special conservation banking programme or facility could provide leans and facilitate joint financing arrangements for the development and protection of critical habitats and ecosystems, including those of international significance, supplementing efforts by bilateral aid agencies, multilateral financial institutions, and commercial banks. 106. In the framework of the Council of Mutual Economic Assistance (CMEA), there has been since the early 1970s a Committee for Environmental Protection with the participation of the heads of appropriate organizations in the member states. This Committee coordinates the relevant research and development programmes and, in some cases, organizes technical assistance for the interested member states, involving the Investment Bank of CMEA. 6.2.2 Reorienting Bilateral Aid Agencies 109. Bilateral aid agencies presently provide nearly four times as much total ODA as is provided by international organizations. As indicated in Chapter 3, a new priority and focus in bilateral aid agencies is needed in three main areas: new measures to ensure that all projects support sustainable development; special programmes to help restore, protect, and improve the ecological basis for development in many developing countries; and special programmes for strengthening the institutional and professional capacities needed for sustainable development. 110. Proposals for special bilateral aid programmes in the areas of agriculture, forestry, energy, industry, human settlements, and genetic resources are made in earlier chapters of this report. The first two priority areas in this chapter also contain proposals for strengthening the institutional and professional capacities in developing countries. The focus here is therefore on the first area: new measures to ensure that all bilateral aid projects support sustainable development. The problems of today do not come with a tag marked energy or economy or
  • 279. CO2 or demography, nor with a label indicating a country or a region. The problems are multi-disciplinary and transnational or global. The problems are not primarily scientific and technological. In science we have the knowledge and in technology the tools. The problems are basically political, economic, and cultural. Per Lindblom International Federation of Institutes of Advanced Studies WCED Public Hearing Oslo, 24-25 June 1985 111. Over the past decade, bilateral aid agencies have gradually given more attention to the environmental dimensions of their programmes and projects. A 1980 survey of the environmental and practices of six major bilateral aid agencies indicated that only one, USAID, had systematic and enforceable procedures backed by the staff resources necessary to carry them out./39 Since then, others have made some progress on the policy level, increased funds for environmental projects, and produced guidelines or checklists to guide their programmes. However, a 1983 study of those guidelines concluded that there was little evidence of their systematic application./40 112. An important step towards concerted action was taken in 1986 with the adoption by OECD of a recommendation to member governments to include an environmental assessment policy and effective procedures for applying it in their bilateral aid programmes./41 It is based on a detailed analysis and studies carried out by a joint group of governmental experts from both the Development Assistance Committee and the Environmental Committee./42 The recommendation includes proposals for adequate staff and financial resources to undertake environmental assessments and a central office in each agency to supervise implementation and to assist developing countries wishing to improve their capacities for conducting environmental assessments. We urge all bilateral aid agencies to implement this recommendation as quickly as possible, it is essential, of course, that this should not reduce aid flows in the aggregate or slow disbursements or represent a new form of aid conditionality. 6.2.3 New Sources of Revenue and Automatic Financing 113. We have made a series of proposals for institutional change within and among the organizations and specialized agencies of the UN system in the sections on 'Getting at the Sources' and 'Dealing with the Effects'. Most of those changes will not require additional financial resources but can be achieved through a reorientation of existing mandates, programmes, and budgets and a redeployment of present staff. Once implemented, those measures will make a major difference in the effective use of existing resources in making the transition to sustainable development. 114. Nevertheless, there is also a need to increase the financial resources for new multilateral efforts and programmes of action for environmental protection and sustainable development. These new funds will not be easy to come by if the international organizations through which they flow have to continue to rely solely on traditional sources of financing: assessed contributions from governments, voluntary contributions by governments, and funds borrowed in capital markets by the World Bank and other international financial institutions. 115. Assessed contributions from governments have traditionally been used largely for the administrative and operating costs of international organizations; they are not intended for
  • 280. multilateral assistance. The total assessed contributions from governments are much smaller than the amount provided through voluntary contributions and the prospects of raising significant, additional funds through assessed contributions are limited. 116. Voluntary contributions by governments give the overall revenue system some flexibility, but they cannot be adjusted readily to meet new or increased requirements. Being voluntary, the flow of these funds is entirely discretionary and unpredictable. The commitments are also extremely short-term, as pledges are normally made only one or two years in advance. Consequently, they provide little security or basis for effective planning and management of international actions requiring sustained, longer-term efforts. Most of the limited funds provided so far for international environmental action have come through voluntary contributions, channelled principally through UNEP and NGOs. 117. Given the current constraints on major sources and modes of funding, it is necessary to consider new approaches as well as new sources of revenue for financing international action in support of sustainable development. The Commission recognizes that such proposals may not appear politically realistic at this point in time. It believes, however, that - given the trends discussed in this report - the need to support sustainable development will become so imperative that political realism will come to require it. 118. The search for other, and especially more automatic, sources and means for financing international action goes almost as far back as the UN itself. It was not until 1977, however, when the Plan of Action to Combat Desertification was approved by the UN General Assembly that governments officially accepted, but never implemented, the principle of automatic transfers. That Plan called for the establishment of a special account that could draw resources not only from traditional sources but also from additional measures of financing, 'including fiscal measures entailing automaticity'./43 119. Since then, a series of studies and reports/44 have identified and examined a growing list of new sources of potential revenue, including: revenue from the use of international commons (from ocean fishing and transportation, from sea-bed mining, from Antarctic resources, or from parking charges for geostationary communications satellites, for example; taxes on international trade (such as a general trade tax; taxes on specific traded commodities, on invisible exports, or on surpluses in balance of trade; or a consumption tax on luxury goods); and international financial measures (a link between special drawing rights and development finance, for example, or IMF gold reserves and sales). 120. In its 1980 report, the Brandt Commission called for raising additional funds from more automatic sources such as those cited above. In its follow-up report in 1983, the Brandt Commission strongly urged that these most 'futuristic' of all the Report's proposals not be lost completely from view./45 Nevertheless, they again rank below the short term horizon of the international agenda. 121. The World Commission on Environment and Development was specifically given the mandate by the UN General Assembly to look once again beyond that limited horizon. We have done so and, given the compelling nature, pace, and scope of the different transitions affecting our economic and ecological systems as described in this report, we consider that at least some of those proposals for additional and more automatic sources of revenue are fast becoming
  • 281. less futuristic and more necessary. This Commission particularly considers that the proposals regarding revenue from the use of international commons and natural resources now warrant and should receive serious consideration by governments and the General Assembly. III. A Call for Action 122. Over the course of this century, the relationship between the human world and the planet that sustains it has undergone a profound change. When the century began, neither human numbers nor technology had the power to radically alter planetary systems. As the century closes, not only do vastly increased human numbers and their activities have that power, but major, unintended changes are occurring in the atmosphere, in soils, in waters, among plants and animals, and in the relationships among all of these. The rate of change is outstripping the ability of scientific disciplines and our current capabilities to assess and advise. It is frustrating the attempts of political and economic institutions, which evolved in a different, more fragmented world, to adapt and cope. It deeply worries many people who are seeking ways to place those concerns on the political agendas. 123. We have been careful to base our recommendations on the realities of present institutions, on what can and must be accomplished today. But to keep options open for future generations, the present generation must begin now, and begin together, nationally and internationally. 124. To achieve the needed change in attitudes and reorientation of policies and institutions, the Commission believes that an active follow-up of this report is imperative. It is with this in mind that we call for the UN General Assembly, upon due consideration, to transform this report into a UN Programme of Action on Sustainable Development. Special follow-up conferences could be initiated at the regional level. Within an appropriate period after the presentation of the report to the General Assembly, an international Conference could be convened to review progress made and promote follow-up arrangements that will be needed over time to set benchmarks and to maintain human progress within the guidelines of human needs and natural laws. 125. The Commissioners came from 21 very different nations. In our discussions, we disagreed often on details and priorities. But despite our widely differing backgrounds and varying national and international responsibilities, we were able to agree to the lines along which institutional change must be drawn. 126. We are unanimous in our conviction that the security, well-being, and very survival of the planet depend on such changes, now. Footnotes 1/ The characteristics and differences of the two approaches are described in our inaugural report, 'Mandate for Change: Key Issues, Strategy and Workplan', Geneva, 1985. 2/ L.G. Uy, 'Combating the Notion of Environment as Additionality: A study of the Integration of Environment and Development and a Case for Environmental Development as Investment', Centre for Environmental Studies, University of Tasmania, Hobart, Tasmania, 1985 (to be published). 3/ OECD, Environment and Economics, Vols. I and II. Background Papers for the
  • 282. International Conference on Environment and Economics (Paris: 1984). 4/ OECD, 'The Impact of Environmental Policies on Industrial Innovation', in Environment and Economics, Vol. III. op. cit. 5/ R. Bertrand, 'Some Reflections on Reform of the United Nations'. Joint Inspection Unit, UN, Geneva, 1985. 6/ V. Fernando, 'Development Assistance, Environment and Development', paper prepared for WCED, Geneva, 1985. 7/ 'List of Projects with Possible Environmental Issues' transmitted to Congress by U.S. Agency for International Development, 1967, as included in Public Law 9? -591. 8/ L. Gagnon, Union Québecoise pour la Conservation de la Nature, Québec, 'Pour Une Révision des Sciences Economiques', submitted to WCED Public Hearings, Ottawa, 1986. See also the review of the state-of-the art concerning natural resource accounts, including detailed case studies from Norway and France, in OECD, Information and Natural Resources (Paris: 1986). 9/ T. Friend, 'Natural Resource Accounting ant? its Relationship with Economic and Environmental Accounting', Statistics Canada, Ottawa, September 1966. 10/ The need for an explicit 'foreign policy for environment' was raised in different ways in the discussion at many WCED public hearings, but originally in a joint submission by Nordic NGOs to the Public Hearings in Oslo, 1985. 11/ See 'Report of the Secretary-General: Technical and Economic Aspects of International River Basin Development', UN E/C.7/35, New York, 1972. An updated list of relevant international agreements was provided by the IUCN Environmental Law Centre. See also Department of Technical Cooperation for Development, Experiences in the Development and Management of International River and Lake Basins, Proceedings of the UN Interregional Meeting of International River Organizations held at Dakar, Senegal, in May 1981 (New York: UN, 1983). 12/ In 1982, there were environment and natural resource management agencies operating in 144 countries. At the time of the 1972 Stockholm Conference, only 15 industrial countries and 11 developing countries had such agencies. World Environment Centre, World Environment Handbook (New York: 1985). 13/ See General Assembly resolution 2997 (XXVII) of 16 December 1972 on 'Institutional and financial arrangements for international environmental cooperation'. 14/ The Environment Coordination Board was abolished in 1977 and its functions assumed by the Administrative Committee on Coordination (ACC). See General Assembly Resolution 32/197, Annex, para 54. The ACC subsequently established a Committee of Designated Officials for Environmental Matters (DOEM). 15/ In addition to the Environment Fund there were 1.8 special Trust Funds with contributions totalling $5-6 million in 1985. See UNEP, 1985 Annual Report (Nairobi: 1986). 16/ Ibid., Annex V, Table B.
  • 283. 17/ J. Urquhart and K. Heilmann, Risk Watch: The Odds of Life (Bicester, UK: Facts on File, 1984). 18/ 'Risk Assessment and Risk Control', Issue Report, Conservation Foundation, Washington, DC, 1985: C. Schweigman et al., '"Agrisk", Appraisal of Risks in Agriculture in Developing Countries', University of Groningen, The Netherlands, 1981. 19/ A. Wijkman and L. Timberlake, Natural Disasters: Acts of God and Acts of Men? (London: Earthscan for the International Institute for Environment and Development and the Swedish Red Cross, 1984). 20/ WMO, A Report of the International Conference on the Assessment of the Role of Carbon Dioxide and of Other Greenhouse Gases in Climate Variations and Associated impacts. Villach, Austria, 9-15 October 1985, WMO No. 661 (Geneva: WMO/ICSU/UNEP, 1986). 21/ For an overview of the current technological capabilities and possibilities, see A. Khosla, Development Alternatives, New Delhi, 'Decision Support Systems for Sustainable Development', prepared for WCED, 1986. 22/ See M.C. McHale et al., Ominous Trends and Valid Hopes: A Comparison of Five World Reports (Minneapolis, Minn.: Hubert Humphrey Institute of Public Affairs, (year?) for a comparison of North-South: A Programme for Survival (Cambridge, Mass.: MIT Press, 1980); World Bank, World Development Report 1980 (Washington, DC: 1980); U.S. Department of State and Council on Environmental quality, Global 2000 Report to the President: Entering the Twenty First Century (Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1980); IUCN/WWF/UNEP, World Conservation Strategy (Gland, Switzerland: 1980); and OECD, Interfutures: Facing the Future, Mastering the Probable and Managing the Unpredictable (Paris: 1979). See also D. Meadows et al. Groping In the Dark - The First Decade of Global Modelling (Chichester, UK: John Wiley & Sons, 1982) for an analysis of various models. 23/ See C.O. Barney, Study Director, Global 2000 Report, op. cit. 24/ See OECD, Economic and Ecological Interdependence. (Paris: 1982). 25/ The importance of involving youth in nature conservation and environmental protection and improvement activities were emphasized in many presentations at WCED Public Hearings. See, for example the report 'Youth Nature Conservation Movement in the Socialist Countries' to the Public Hearing at Moscow, December 1986. 26/ For an overview of the role and contribution of NGOs to environment and development action at the national and international levels, see 'NGOs and Environment-Development Issues', report to WCED by the Environment Liaison Centre, Nairobi, 1986. It includes a selection of 20 case studies of successful NGO environmental action around the world. 27/ NGOs in Chile, Colombia, the Federal Republic of Germany, and Turkey have also published 'State of the Environment' reports. Official reports have appeared in Australia, Austria, Canada, Denmark, Finland, France, Ireland, Israel, Japan, the Netherlands, the Philippines, Poland, Spain, Sweden, the United States, and Yugoslavia. 28/ See, for example, the annual State of the World report by WorldWatch Institute, the World Resources Report by World Resources Institute and the International Institute for Environment and Development, and the World Conservation Strategy by IUCN.
  • 284. 29/ Report of the World Industry Conference on Environmental Management sponsored by the International Chamber of Commerce and UNEP, 1984; see particularly the principles adopted by OECD in 1985 as a clarification of the OECD Guiding Principles for Multinational Enterprises in International Legal Materials, vol 25, No. 1 (1986); see also the presentation to WCED Public Hearings, Oslo, June 1985, on 'World Industry Conference Follow-Up' by the Chairman of the Environment Committee of the International Chamber of Commerce. 30/ See P.S. Thacher 'International Institutional Support: The International System, Funding and Technical Assistance', paper presented to the World Conservation Strategy Conference, Ottawa, Canada, June 1986. 31/ United Nations, Report of the United Nations Conference on the Human Environment, document A/CONF.48/14/Rev.1, Chapter 1 (New York: 1972). 32/ These and other principles have been developed as proposed Articles for a Convention in the report to WCED by its Experts Group on Environmental Law. Their report also contains a commentary on the legal precedents and references for each Article. See Legal Principles for Environmental Protection and Sustainable Development (Dordrecht, The Netherlands: Martinus Nijhoff, in press). 33/ For an overview of dispute settlement procedures, mechanisms, and needs, see R.E. Stein and G. Grenville Wood, 'The Settlement of Environmental Disputes: A Forward Look', prepared for WCED, 1985. 34/ OECD, Environment and Economics, Vol. I, op. cit. 35/ OECD, Environment and Economics, Results of the International Conference on Environment and Economics (Paris: 1985. 36/ For a summary report on the work of the Committee of International Development Institutions on the Environment, see UNEP, 1985 Annual Report, op. cit. 37/ Statement by Dr M.K. Tolba, UNEP Executive Director, at the opening of the sixth session of CIDIE, hosted by the Organization of American States, Washington, DC, June 1985. 38/ A proposal for a World Conservation Bank was made by M. Sweatman of the International Wilderness Leadership Foundation at the WCED Public Hearings, Ottawa, 1986. 39/ R.D.G. Johnson and R.O. Blake, Environmental and Bilateral Aid (London: International Institute for Environment and Development, 1960). 40/ J. Horberry, Environmental Guidelines Survey: An Analysis of Environmental Procedures and Guidelines Governing Development Aid (London and Gland: IIED and IUCN, 1963). 41/ 'Environmental Assessment ooe Development Assistance Projects and Programmes', OECD Council Recommendation C(85)104 (Paris: OECD, 20.6.85); 'Measures Required to Facilitate the Environmental Assessment of Development Assistance Projects and Programmes' OECD Council Recommendation C(86)26 (final) OECD, Paris, 20 November 1986. 42/ 'Final Report on Environmental Assessment and Development Assistance' OECD Environment Monograph No 4 (Paris: OECD, 1986).
  • 285. 43/ Report of the United Nations Conference on Desertification, document A/CONF.74/36 (New York: UN, 1977). 44/ See for example, E.B. Steinberg and J.A. Yager, 'New Means of Financing International Needs', The Brookings Institution, Washington, DC, 1978; 'Additional Measures and Means of Financing for the Implementation of the Plan of Action to Combat Desertification', document UNEP/GC.6/9/Add.1, 1978; UN, 'Study on Financing the United Nations Plan of Action to Combat Desertification: report of the Secretary-General', General Assembly document A/35/396, 1980; Dag Hammarskjold Foundation 'The Automatic Mobilization of Resources for Development', Development Dialogue, No. 1, 1981; UN, 'Study on Financing the Plan of Action to Combat Desertification: Report of the Secretary-General', General Assembly document A/36/141, 1981. 45/ Independent Commission on International Development Issues, North-South: A Programme for Survival (London: Pan Books, 1980); Common Crisis, North-South: Cooperation for World Recovery (London: Pan Books, 1983).
  • 286. Our Common Future, Annexe 1: Summary of Proposed Legal Principles for Environmental Protection and Sustainable Development Adopted by the WCED Experts Group on Environmental Law I. General Principles, Rights, and Responsibilities Fundamental Human Right 1. All human beings have the fundamental right to an environment adequate for their health and well being. Inter-Generational Equity 2. States shall conserve and use the environment and natural resources for the benefit of present and future generations. Conservation and Sustainable Use 3. States shall maintain ecosystems and ecological processes essential for the functioning of the biosphere, shall preserve biological diversity, and shall observe the principle of optimum sustainable yield in the use of living natural resources and ecosystems. Environmental Standards and Monitoring 4. States shall establish adequate environmental protection standards and monitor changes in and publish relevant data on environmental quality and resource use. Prior Environmental Assessments 5. States shall make or require prior environmental assessments of proposed activities which may significantly affect the environment or use of a natural resource. Prior Notification, Access, and Due Process 6. States shall inform in a timely manner all persons likely to be significantly affected by a planned activity and to grant them equal access and due process in administrative and judicial proceedings. Sustainable Development and Assistance 7. States shall ensure that conservation is treated as an integral part of the planning and implementation of development activities and provide assistance to other States, especially to developing countries, in support of environmental protection and sustainable development.
  • 287. General Obligation to Cooperate 8. States shall cooperate in good faith with other States in implementing the preceding rights and obligations. II. Principles, Rights and Obligations Concerning Transboundary Natural Resources and Environmental Interferences Reasonable and Equitable Use 9. States shell use transboundary natural resources in a reasonable and equitable manner. Prevention and Abatement 10. States shall prevent or abate any transboundary environmental interference which could cause or causes significant harm (but subject to certain exceptions provided for in #11 and #12 below). Strict Liability 11. States shall take all reasonable precautionary measures to limit the risk when carrying out or permitting certain dangerous but beneficial activities and shall ensure that compensation is provided should substantial transboundary harm occur even when the activities were not known to be harmful at the time they were undertaken. Prior Agreements When Prevention Costs Greatly Exceed Harm 12. States shall enter into negotiations with the affected State on the equitable conditions under which the activity could be carried out when planning to carry out or permit activities causing transboundary harm which is substantial but far less than the cost of prevention. (If no agreement can be reached, see Art. 22). Non-Discrimination 13. States shall apply as a minimum at least the same standards for environmental conduct and impacts regarding transboundary natural resources and environmental interferences as are applied domestically (i.e., do not do to others what you would not do to your own citizens). General Obligation to Cooperate on Transboundary Environmental Problems 14. States shall cooperate in good faith with other States to achieve optimal use of transboundary natural resources and effective prevention or abatement of transboundary environmental interferences. Exchange of Information
  • 288. 15. States of origin shall provide timely and relevant information to the other concerned States regarding transboundary natural resources or environmental interferences. Prior Assessment and Notification 16. States shall provide prior and timely notification and relevant information to the other concerned States and shall make or require an environmental assessment of planned activities which may have significant transboundary effects. Prior Consultations 17. States of origin shall consult at an early stage and in good faith with other concerned States regarding existing or potential transboundary interferences with their use of a natural resource or the environment. Cooperative Arrangements for Environmental Assessment and Protection 18. States shall cooperate with the concerned States in monitoring, scientific research and standard setting regarding transboundary natural resources and environmental interferences. Emergency Situations 19. States shall develop contingency plans regarding emergency situations likely to cause transboundary environmental interferences and shall promptly warn, provide relevant information to and co-operate with concerned States when emergencies occur. Equal Access and Treatment 20. States shall grant equal access, due process and equal treatment in administrative and judicial proceedings to all persons who are or may be affected by transboundary interferences with their use of a natural resource or the environment. III. State Responsibility 21. States shall cease activities which breach an international obligation regarding the environment and provide compensation for the harm caused. IV. Peaceful Settlement of Disputes 22. States shall settle environmental disputes by peaceful means. If mutual agreement on a solution or on other dispute settlement arrangements is not reached within 18 months, the dispute shall be submitted to conciliation and, if unresolved thereafter, to arbitration or judicial settlement at the request of any of the concerned States. Footnote * This summary is based on the more detailed legal formulations in the report to the
  • 289. Commission by the international legal experts group. (See Annexe 2 for a list of group members.) This summary highlights only the main thrusts of the principles and Articles and is not a substitute for the full text is published in Legal Principles for Environmental Protection and Sustainable Development (Dordrecht, The Netherlands: Martinus Nijhoff Publishers, in press).
  • 290. Our Common Future, Annexe 2: The Commission and its Work The Commissioners Chairman Vice-Chairman Members The Commission's Mandate The Commission's Work Members of the Secretariat Senior Professional Staff: General Services and Support Staff: Inaugural Meeting & Workplan Public Hearings Expert Special Advisors Advisory Panel on Energy Advisory Panel on Industry Advisory Panel of Food Security Advisory Panel Reports Financia1 Contributions Other Contributions Further Activities Acknowledgements The World Commission on Environment and Development was created as a consequence of General Assembly resolution 38/161 adopted at the 38th Session of the United Nations in the fall of 1983. That resolution called upon the Secretary General to appoint the Chairman and
  • 291. Vice Chairman of the Commission rind in turn directed them to jointly appoint the remaining members, at least half of whom were to be selected from the developing world. The Secretary General appointed Mrs. Gro Harlem Brundtland of Norway, then leader of the Norwegian Labour Party, as Chairman and Dr. Mansour Khalid, the former Minister of Foreign Affairs from Sudan, as Vice-Chairman. They together appointed the remaining members of the Commission. The Commission has functioned as an independent body. All its members have served the Commission in their individual capacities, not as representatives of their governments. The Commission has thus been able to address any issues, to solicit any advice, and to formulate and present any proposals and recommendations that it considered pertinent and relevant. In pursuing its mandate, the commission has paid careful attention to the Terms of Reference suggested by the General Assembly in Resolution 38/161 and has operated in close collaboration with the Intergovernmental Inter-sessional Preparatory Committee of the Governing Council of the UN Environment Programme, which has itself been preparing an intergovernmental report on environmental perspectives to the year 2000 and beyond. After the Commission's report has been discussed by UNEP's Governing Council, it is to be submitted to the General Assembly of the United Nations for its consideration during its 42nd Session in the fall of 1987. The Commissioners Chairman Gro Harlem Brundtland, Norway. Prime Minister, Parliamentary Leader of the Labour Party 1981 86, Member of Parliament from 1977, Minister of Environment 1974-79. Associate Director Oslo school Health Services 1968-74. Vice-Chairman Mansour Khalid, Sudan. Deputy Prime Minister 1976, Minister of Education 1975-76, President, UN Security Council 1972, Minister of Foreign Affairs 1971 75, Minister of Youth and Social Affairs 1969-71. Members Susanna Agnelli, Italy. Italian Senator, writer, Undersecretary of State for Foreign Affairs. Member of the Independent Commission on International Humanitarian Issues. Member of the European Parliament 1979-81, Mayor of Monte Argentario 1974-84, Member of Chamber of Deputies 1976-83. Saleh Abdulrahman Al-Athel, Saudi Arabia. President of King Abdulaziz City for Science and Technology; Vice-President for Graduate Studies and Research, King Saud University 1976-64; Dean, College of Engineering, King Saud University 1975-76. Pablo Gonzalez Casanova, Mexico. Professor of Political and social Sciences, National Autonomous University of Mexico, President of the Latin American Association of Sociology. [In August 1986, for personal reasons, Pablo Gonzalez Casanova ceased to participate in the work of the Commission.]
  • 292. Bernard T. G. Chidzero, Zimbabwe. Minister of Finance, Economic Planning and Development; Chairman, Development Committee of the World Bank and the International Monetary Fund; Member, UN Committee for Development Planning; Member, Board of the World Institute for Development Economics and Research; Director, Commodities Division, United Nations Conference on Trade and Development (UNCTAD) 1968-1977; Deputy Secretary General, UNCTAD 1977-80. Lamine Mohamed Padika, Cote d'Ivoire. Minister of Marine Affairs, Chairman of the National Council for Environment, Secretary of State for Marine Affairs 1974-76. Volker Hauff, Federal Republic of Germany. Member of Parliament; Vice Chairman, Social Democratic Party Parliamentary Group, Responsible for Environment; Minister for Transportation 1980-82; Minister for Research and Technology 1979-80; Parliamentary Secretary of State for Science Research and Technology 1972-78. Istvan Lang, Hungary. Secretary General of the Hungarian Academy of Sciences; Deputy Secretary General 1970-85, and Executive secretary 1963-70, Section of Biology, Hungarian Academy of Sciences; Research Institute of Soil Science and Agricultural Chemistry, Hungarian Academy of Sciences 1955-63. Ma Shijun, Peoples Republic of China. Director of the Research Center of Ecology, Academia Sinica, Chairman of the Commission of Environmental Sciences, President of the Ecological Society of China. Margarita Marino do Botero, Colombia. Chairman, Fundacion El Colegio de Villa de Leyva (The Green College); Director General, National Institute of Renewable Natural Resources and the Environment (INDERENA) 1983-86; Director, Office of International Affairs, INDERENA 1978-83; Regional Consultant, United Nations Environment Programme 1973-77. Nagendra Singh, India. President of the International Court of Justice, President of IMO Assembly 1969, President of ILO Maritime Session 1971, President of the Indian Academy of Environmental Law and Research, President of the National Labour Law Association of India, Life Member of the Board of Governors of the International Council for Environmental Law, Member of the Permanent Court of Arbitration; Deputy Chairman of CEPLA (IUCN); Chancellor of the University of Goa; Fellow of the British Academy. Paulo Nogueira-Neto, Brazil. Federal District Secretary of Environment, Science and Technology, National Council of Environment; Federal Secretary of the Environment 1974-86; Associate Professor, Department of Ecology, University of Sao Paulo; President, Association for the Defence of the Environment 1954-83; President, Sao Paulo State Forest Council 1967-74. Saburo Okita, Japan. President, International University; Advisor to the Ministry of Foreign Affairs; Advisor to the Environment Agency; Executive Committee Member of the Club of Rome; Chairman, World Wildlife Fund Japan; Chairman, Advisory Committee for External Economic Issues 1984-85; Government Representative for External Economic Relations 1980-81; Foreign Minister 1979-80; Member of the Pearson Commission 1968-69. Shridath S. Ramphal, Guyana. Secretary General of the Commonwealth of Nations, Minister for Foreign Affairs 1972-75, Minister of Justice 1973-75, Minister of State for Foreign Affairs 1967-72, Attorney General 1966-72. William Doyle Ruckelshaus, United States. Attorney, Perkins, Coie; Administrator, U.S.
  • 293. Environmental Protection Agency 1970-73, 1983-84; Senior Vice President for Law and Corporate Affairs, Weyerhaeuser company 1976-83; Acting Director of the Federal Bureau of Investigation 1973; Deputy Attorney General, US Department of Justice 1973. Mohamed Sahnoun, Algeria. Algerian Ambassador to the United States; Chief of Algerian Permanent Mission to the United Nations 1982-84; Algerian Ambassador, Paris 1979-82; Algerian Ambassador, Bonn 1975-79; Deputy Secretary General, Arab League 1973-74; Deputy Secretary General, Organization of African Unity 1964-73. Emil Salim, Indonesia. Minister of State for Population and the Environment; Minister of State for Development Supervision and the Environment 1978-83; Member People's Consultative Assembly 1977-32; Minister of Communications 1973-78; Minister of State for Administrative Reform; Deputy Chairman, National Planning Board 1971-81. Bukar Shaib, Nigeria. Minister of Agriculture, Water Resources and Rural Development 1983-86, Special Advisor to the President of Nigeria 1980-83, Nigerian Ambassador to Rome 1979, Permanent Secretary, Federal Ministry of Agriculture and Water Resources 1968-78. Vladimir Sokolov, USSR. Director, Institute of Evolutionary Animal Morphology and Ecology, USSR Academy of Sciences; Professor and Head of Department oh Vertebrate Zoology, Faculty of biology, Moscow State University; Deputy Chairman, Section of Chemical and Technological and Biological Sciences, Presidium, USSR Academy of Sciences. Janez Stanovnik, Yugoslavia. Member, Presidium of the Socialist Republic of Slovenia; Professor, University of Ljubljana; Executive Secretary, UN Economic Commission for Europe 1967-83: Member of the Federal Cabinet and Federal Executive Council 1966-67. Maurice Strong, Canada. President, American Water Development, Inc.: former Under- Secretary General and Special Advisor to the Secretary-General of the United Nations; Executive Director of the United Nations Office for Emergency Operations in Africa 1985-86; Chairman of the Board, Petro-Canada 1976-78; Executive Director, United Nations Environment Programme 1973-75; Secretary-General, United Nations Conference on the Human Environment 1970-72. Jim MacNeill, Canada. Secretary-General of the Commission and ex officio member; Director of Environment, OECD 1978-84; Secretary (Deputy Minister), Canadian Ministry of State for Urban Affaire 1974-76; Canadian Commissioner General, UN Conference on Human Settlements 1975-76; Assistant Secretary, Canadian Ministry of State for Urban Affairs 1972-74. The Commission's Mandate The Commission's Mandate, officially adopted at its Inaugural Meeting in Geneva on 1-3 October 1984, states: The World Commission on Environment and Development has been established at a time of unprecedented growth in pressures on the global environment, with grave predictions about the human future becoming commonplace. The Commission is confident that it is possible to build a future that is more prosperous, more just, and more secure because it rests on policies and practices that serve to expand and sustain the ecological basis of development.
  • 294. The Commission is convinced, however, that this will no happen without significant changes in current approaches: changes in perspectives, attitudes and life styles; changes in certain critical policies and the ways in which they are formulated and applied; changes in the nature of cooperation between governments, business, science, and people; changes in certain forms of international cooperation which have proved incapable of tackling many environment and development issues; changes, above all, in the level of understanding and commitment by people, organizations and governments. The World Commission on Environment and Development therefore invites suggestions, participation, and support in order to assist it urgently: to re-examine the critical issues of environment and development and to formulate innovative, concrete, and realistic action proposals to deal with them; 1. to strengthen international cooperation on environment and development and to assess and propose new forms of cooperation that can break out of existing patterns and influence policies and events in the direction of needed change; and 2. to raise the level of understanding and commitment to action on the part of individuals, voluntary organizations, businesses, institutes, and governments. 3. The Commission solicits the views of those individuals, scientific institutes, non-governmental organizations, specialized agencies, and other bodies of the United Nations, and national governments concerned with environment and development issues. It requests their support and it will facilitate their participation in the work of the Commission. It wishes especially to hear the views of youth. In fulfilling its tasks, the Commission will pay careful attention to the Terms of Reference suggested by the General Assembly of the United Nations in resolution 38/161, in which the General Assembly welcomed the establishment of the Commission. The Commission's Work In May of 1984, an Organizational Meeting of the Commission was held in Geneva to adopt its rules of procedure and operation and to appoint a Secretary General to guide its work. In July of 1964, a Secretariat was established in Geneva, temporarily at the Centre de Morillon and later at the Palais Wilson. Members of the Secretariat Members of the Secretariat have included: Secretary General: Jim MacNeill Senior Professional Staff:
  • 295. Nitin Desai, Senior Economic Advisor Vitus Fernando, Senior Programme Officer Branislav Gosovic, Senior Programme Officer Marie-Madeleine Jacquemier, Finance and Administrative Officer Kazu Kato, Director of Programmes Warren H. Lindner, Secretary of the Commission and Director of Administration Elisabeth Monosovski, Senior Programme Officer Gustavo Montero, Programme Planning Officer Shimwaa'i Muntemba, Senior Programme Officer Janos Pasztor, Senior Programme Officer Peter Robbs, Senior Public Information Advisor Vicente Sanchez, Director of Programmes Linda Starke, Editor Peter Stone, Director of Information Edith Surber, Finance and Administrative Officer General Services and Support Staff: Brita Baker Elisabeth Bohler-Goodship Marie-Pierre Destouet Marian Doku Tamara Dunn Teresa Harmand Aud Loen Jelka de Marsano Chedra Mayhew Christel Ollesch Ellen Permato Guadalupe Quesado
  • 296. Mildred Raphoz Evelyn Salvador Iona D'Souza Kay Streit Vicky Underhill Shane Vanderwert Inaugural Meeting & Workplan The Commission held its first official meeting in Geneva on 1-3 October 1984. During that meeting, the Commission agreed upon its Mandate, the key issues it would address in the course of its deliberations, the strategy it would employ to achieve its objectives, and the workplan and timetable that would be used to guide its work. Immediately following that meeting, the Commission publicly released its principal working document, 'Mandate for Change'. At its Inaugural Meeting, the Commission selected eight key issues for analysis during the course of its work: Perspectives on Population, Environment, and Sustainable Development; Energy: Environment and Development; Industry: Environment and Development; Food Security, Agriculture, Forestry, Environment, and Development; Human Settlements: Environment and Development; International Economic Relations, Environment, and Development; Decision Support Systems for Environmental Management; and International Cooperation. It agreed that it would examine these issues from the perspective of the year 2000 and beyond and from the perspective of their common sources in economic, social, and sectoral policies. At its Inaugural Meeting, the Commission also decided that its processes would be open, visible, and participatory and that in conducting its work, strategies would be employed to ensure it of receiving the broadest range of views and advice on the key issues it was addressing. Public Hearings The Commission therefore decided that it would hold deliberative meetings in all regions of the world and that it would take the occasion of those meetings to get a first hand view of environment and development issues in those regions. It also decided to use these visits to hold open Public Hearings where senior government representatives, scientists and experts, research institutes, industrialists, representatives of non-governmental organizations, and the
  • 297. general public could openly express their concerns to the Commission and submit their views and advice on issues of common concern. These Public Hearings, which are a unique feature of the Commission, have become its 'trademark', demonstrating both to the Commissioners and the participants that the issues addressed by the Commission are indeed of global concern and do transcend national boundaries and disparate cultures. Hundreds of organizations and individuals gave testimony during the Public Hearings and over 800 written submissions constituting more than 10,000 pages of material were received by the Commission in connection with them. The Public Hearings have been of immeasurable benefit to the Commissioners and the Secretariat, and the gratitude of the Commission is extended to all who contributed to their success. Deliberative meetings, site visits, and/or Public Hearings of the Commission were held in Jakarta, Indonesia, 27-31 March 1985: Oslo, Norway, 21-28 June 1985; Sao Paulo and Brasilia, Brazil, 25 October-4 November 1985; Vancouver, Edmonton, Toronto, Ottawa, Halifax, and quebec City, Canada, 21-31 May 1986; Harare, Zimbabwe, 15-19 September, Nairobi, Kenya, 20-23 September 1986; Moscow, USSR, 6-12 December 1986; and Tokyo, Japan, 23-28 February 1987. Special working group meetings of the Commission were also held in Geneva, Moscow, and Berlin (West). Expert Special Advisors To further widen its base of information and advice, the Commission appointed a group of expert Special Advisors to assist it and the Secretariat in the analysis of the key issues. These included Edward S. Ayensu on Food Security and Forestry, Gamani Corea on International Economic Relations, Gordon T. Goodman on Energy. Ashok Khosla on Decision Support Systems for Environmental Management, Robert D. Munro on International Cooperation and Legal Regimes, Michael Royston on Industry, Johan Jorgen Hoist on Environment and Security, and Guy-Olivier Segond on Youth. The Chairman was also advised by Hans Christian Bugge and Morten Wetland. Later in its work, the Commission appointed Lloyd Timberlake as Special Editorial Advisor. To assist it in its work in three of the key issue areas - Energy, Industry, and Food Security - the Commission constituted Advisory Panels of leading experts to advise it on the recommendations and conclusions it should consider making. The chairmen and members of the Commission's Advisory Panels were: Advisory Panel on Energy Chairman: Enrique Iglesias, Foreign Minister of Uruguay Members: Abdlatif Y. Al-Hamad (Kuwait) Toyoaki Ikuta (Japan) Gu Jian (China) Al Noor Kassum (Tanzania)
  • 298. Ulf Lantzke (deceased) (Federal Republic of Germany) Wangari Maathai (Kenya) David J. Rose (deceased) (United States) Prero Shankar Jha (India) Carl Tham (Sweden) Gyorgy Vajda (Hungary) Advisory Panel on Industry Chairman: Umberto Colombo (Italy), President of ENfcA Members: Betsy Ancker-Johnson (United States) M.J. Flux (United Kingdom) Arnoldo Jose Gabaldon (Venezuela) Alexander C. Helfrich (Netherlands) Charles Levinson (Canada) Finn Lied (Norway) George P. Livanos (Greece) Mohamed Mazouni (Algeria) Thomas McCarthy (United States) Jose E. Mind]in (Brazil) Keichi Oshima (Japan) Roger Strelow (United States) Naval Tata (India) Erna Witoelar (Indonesia) Advisory Panel of Food Security Chairman: M.S. Swarainathan (India), Director General of the International Rice Research Institute Members: Nyle Brady (United States)
  • 299. Robert Chambers (United Kingdom) K. Chowdhry (India) Gilberto Gallopin (Argentina) Joe Hulse (Canada) Kenneth King (Guyana) V. Malima (Tanzania) Samir Radwan (Egypt) Lu Liang Shu (China) Advisory Panel Reports The reports of the three Advisory Panels were submitted to the Commission for its consideration during its meeting in Canada in May of 1986 and have since been published under the titled Energy 2000, Industry 2000, and Food 2000. The Commission was also assisted in its review of legal rights and principles by a group of international legal experts chaired by Robert Munro (Canada) with Johan G. Lammers (Netherlands) as Rapporteur. The members of the group included Andronico Adede (Kenya), Francoise Burhenne (Federal Republic of Germany), Alexandre-Charles Kiss (France), Stephen McCaffrey (United States), Akio Morishima (Japan), Zaki Mustafa (Sudan), Henri Smets (Belgium), Robert Stein (United States), Alberto Szekely (Mexico), Alexandre Timoehenko (USSR), and Amado Tolentino (Philippines) Their report was submitted to and considered by the Commission during its meeting in Harare in September 1986. It will be published under the title Legal Principles for Environmental Protection and Sustainable Development. During the course of its work, the Commission also engaged experts, research institutes, and academic centres of excellence from around the globe to prepare more than 75 studies and reports relating to the eight key issues for the Commission's review and consideration. These studies and reports provided an invaluable resource base for the final reports of the Commission's Advisory Panels and for the final chapters of this report. Financial Contributions Initial funding to permit the Commission to commence its work came from the governments of Canada, Denmark, Finland, Japan, the Netherlands, Norway, Sweden, and Switzerland. Each of these 'sponsoring' governments had been instrumental in the creation of the Commission and during the course of the Commibeion'r work, each of them increased their contribution beyond their original pledge. In addition to the 'sponsoring' group of countries, the Commission has also received untied financial contributions from the governments of Cameroon, Chile, the Federal Republir of Germany, Hungary, Oman, Portugal, and Saudi Arabia. Significant contributions have also been received from the Kord Foundation and the John D. and Catherine T. MacArthur Foundation, as well as from NOPAD and SIDA. Other Contributions
  • 300. The City and Canton of Geneva restored and furnished one wing of the Palais Wilson and provided that to the Commission's Secretariat free of rent and utilities. The local costs of the Commission's meetings in Indonesia, Brazil, Zimbabwe, and the USSR were covered by the host governments. The costs of the Commission's working group meeting in Moscow were also covered by the Soviet Government. The costs of the working group meeting in Berlin (West) were covered by the Federal Republic of Germany. The Arab Fund for Economic and Social Development hosted and covered all of the costs of a meeting in Kuwait of the Advisory Panel on Energy. The accounts of the Commission have been audited by Hunzikei and Associates of Geneva. The Commission's sincere appreciation is extended to all the governments, foundations, and institutes that provided the financial and other support necessary for it to complete its work, including those that contributed funds too late to be acknowledged here. Further Activities Between the issuance of this report and its consideration by the UN General Assembly during its 42nd Session in the fall of 1987, the Commission will be meeting during a series of regional presentational meetings with senior governmental representatives, the business and scientific communities, non-governmental organizations, and the press to discuss this report and, it is hoped, to build a body of public and governmental support for the recommendations and conclusions. There are no plans for the Commission to continue after its report has been considered by the General Assembly, and it will officially cease its operations on 31 December 1987. Acknowledgements Since its creation in late 1963, the Commission has received advice and support from thousands of individuals, institutes, and organizations the world over, many of whom are listed here. Many laboured long hours in preparing submissions for the Public Hearings, reports for the Advisory Panels, and studies for submission to the Commission. Without their dedication, cooperation, and advice as well as that of the Special Advisors and the chairmen and members of the Advisory Panels and Legal Experts Group, this report would not have been possible. The Commission's sincerest appreciation is extended to them all. (Affiliations and titles are as of the date of communication with the Commission. Verification of all the following names and titles was not possible, and the Commission apologizes for any inaccuracies.)